Financial accounting [Third edition] 9780133427882, 9781292019543, 1292019549, 0133427889, 9781292074795, 1292074795

ALERT:Before you purchase, check with your instructor or review your course syllabus to ensure that youselect the correc

786 110 161MB

English Pages 768 [769] Year 2014;2015

Report DMCA / Copyright

DOWNLOAD PDF FILE

Table of contents :
Cover......Page 1
Title Page......Page 4
Contents......Page 12
Business, Accounting, and You......Page 36
The Definition of a Business......Page 37
The General Concept of Value......Page 38
Business Owners and Other Stakeholders......Page 39
Operating the Business......Page 40
The Types of Businesses......Page 41
The Legal Forms of Businesses......Page 42
Generally Accepted Accounting Principles......Page 44
Accounting Ethics: A Matter of Trust ......Page 45
What Is the Role of Accountingin a Business?......Page 46
How Do You Measure a BusinessTransaction?......Page 47
How Do You Record Business Transactions Using the Accounting Equation?......Page 48
Stockholders’ Equity......Page 49
The Income Statement......Page 55
The Statement of Cash Flows......Page 57
Relationships Among the Financial Statements......Page 58
Accounting, Business, and You—Putting It All Together......Page 59
Summary......Page 60
Accounting Practice......Page 63
Apply Your Knowledge......Page 84
Know Your Business......Page 85
Business, Accounting, and You......Page 88
Organizing Accounts......Page 89
Stockholders’ Equity......Page 90
What Is Double-Entry Accounting?......Page 91
How Are the General Journal and GeneralLedger Used to Keep Track of BusinessTransactions?......Page 93
Applying Transaction Analysis......Page 95
Balancing the T-Accounts......Page 102
How Is a Trial Balance Prepared, and WhatIs It Used For?......Page 104
Correcting Errors......Page 105
Preparation of Financial Statements......Page 106
Summary......Page 109
Accounting Practice......Page 110
Know Your Business......Page 134
Business, Accounting, and You......Page 137
Revenue Recognition and Matching Principles......Page 139
What Is the Role of Adjusting Entries, and WhenAre They Prepared?......Page 140
Accruing Revenues......Page 141
Adjusting Deferred Revenues......Page 142
Adjusting Deferred Expenses......Page 143
The Adjusted Trial Balance......Page 148
Preparing the Financial Statements......Page 150
Completing the Accounting Cycle......Page 152
The Three Closing Entries: Revenues, Expenses, and Dividends......Page 153
Summary of the Adjusting and Closing Processes......Page 155
Summary......Page 158
Accounting Practice......Page 160
Know Your Business......Page 189
Comprehensive Problem......Page 192
Business, Accounting, and You......Page 194
What Are the Relationships AmongManufacturers, Wholesalers, Retailers,and Customers?......Page 195
How Do Periodic and Perpetual Inventory Systems Differ?......Page 196
Purchase Returns and Allowances......Page 197
Purchase Discounts......Page 198
How Do You Account for the Sale of Inventory?......Page 199
Credit Sales......Page 200
Sales Returns and Allowances......Page 201
Sales Allowances......Page 202
Sales Discounts......Page 203
How Do You Account for Freight Charges and Other Selling Expenses?......Page 204
Costs Related to the Receipt of Goods from Suppliers......Page 205
Costs Related to Delivering Goods to Customers......Page 206
Other Selling Costs......Page 208
The Income Statement......Page 209
The Balance Sheet......Page 212
Summary......Page 215
Accounting Practice......Page 218
Know Your Business......Page 240
Business, Accounting, and You......Page 243
What Inventory Costing Methods Are Allowed?......Page 244
Cost Flow Versus Physical Flow of Inventory......Page 245
Inventory Cost Flows......Page 247
Specific-Identification Method......Page 248
First-In, First-Out (FIFO) Method......Page 249
Last-In, First-Out (LIFO) Method......Page 250
Average Cost Method......Page 251
Journalizing Inventory Transactions......Page 252
What Effect Do the Different Costing Methods Have on Net Income?......Page 253
What Else Determines How Inventory Is Valued?......Page 255
Inventory Shrinkage......Page 257
How Do Inventory Errors Affect the Financial Statements?......Page 258
Is It Possible to Estimate the Value of Inventory If the Inventory Is Accidentally Destroyed?......Page 259
Summary......Page 263
Accounting Practice......Page 265
Know Your Business......Page 287
Comprehensive Problem......Page 289
Business, Accounting, and You......Page 291
Understandable......Page 292
Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP) in the United States......Page 293
Differences Between FASB and IFRS......Page 294
Elements of an Internal Control System......Page 296
Employee Embezzlement......Page 300
The Factors Usually Present When Fraud Is Committed......Page 301
Audits......Page 303
Audit Opinions......Page 304
The Legal Responsibilities of Accountants......Page 305
Ethical Responsibilities of Accountants......Page 306
Summary......Page 308
Accounting Practice......Page 310
Apply Your Knowledge......Page 317
Know Your Business......Page 320
Business, Accounting, and You......Page 323
Cash Sales......Page 324
Credit/Debit Card Processing......Page 325
Internal Controls over Cash Receipts......Page 326
Internal Control over Cash Payments......Page 327
Purchase and Payment Process......Page 328
Preparing the Bank Reconciliation......Page 329
Book Side of the Reconciliation......Page 330
Online Banking ......Page 334
Types of Receivables......Page 335
The Direct Write-Off Method......Page 336
Direct Write-Off Method: Recovery of Accounts Previously Written Off ......Page 337
Estimating the Amount of Uncollectible Accounts......Page 338
Writing Off Uncollectible Accounts Under the Allowance Method......Page 341
Allowance Method: Recovery of Accounts Previously Written Off......Page 342
How Are Accounts Receivable Reported on the Balance Sheet?......Page 343
Identifying the Maturity Date......Page 344
Computing Interest on a Note......Page 345
Accruing Interest Revenue......Page 346
Summary ......Page 350
Accounting Practice......Page 353
Apply Your Knowledge......Page 379
Know Your Business......Page 380
Setting Up the Petty Cash Fund......Page 382
Replenishing the Petty Cash Fund......Page 383
Changing the Petty Cash Fund......Page 384
Accounting Practice......Page 385
Business, Accounting, and You......Page 388
What Are the Different Types of Long-Term Assets?......Page 389
land and land improvements......Page 390
Machinery and Equipment......Page 391
Lump-Sum (Basket) Purchase of Assets......Page 392
How Are Fixed Assets Depreciated?......Page 393
Measuring Depreciation ......Page 394
Depreciation Methods......Page 395
Partial Year Depreciation......Page 399
Changing the Useful Life of a Depreciable Asset......Page 400
Using Fully Depreciated Assets......Page 401
Extraordinary Repairs......Page 402
What Happens When a Fixed Asset Is Disposed?......Page 403
Specific Intangibles......Page 406
How Are Natural Resources Accounted For?......Page 408
What Are Other Assets?......Page 409
How Are Long-Term Assets Reported on the Balance Sheet?......Page 410
Summary......Page 412
Accounting Practice......Page 415
Apply Your Knowledge......Page 435
Know Your Business......Page 436
Business, Accounting, and You......Page 439
What Are the Differences Among Known, Estimated, and Contingent Liabilities?......Page 440
Notes Payable......Page 441
Unearned Revenues......Page 443
Estimated Warranty Liability......Page 444
How Do You Account for a Contingent Liability?......Page 445
Notes Payable......Page 446
Bonds Payable......Page 448
Lease Liabilities......Page 454
How Are Liabilities Reported on the Balance Sheet?......Page 456
Summary......Page 460
Accounting Practice......Page 463
Apply Your Knowledge......Page 483
Know Your Business......Page 484
Business, Accounting, and You......Page 487
How Are Corporations Organized?......Page 488
Classes of Stock......Page 490
How Is the Issuance of Stock Recorded?......Page 491
Issuing Common Stock......Page 492
How Are Cash Dividends Accounted For? ......Page 493
Declaring and Paying Dividends......Page 494
Dividing Dividends Between Preferred and Common Shareholders......Page 495
Dividends on Cumulative and Noncumulative Preferred Stock......Page 496
Stock Dividends......Page 497
Recording Stock Dividends......Page 498
Stock Splits......Page 500
Treasury Stock Basics......Page 502
Sale of Treasury Stock......Page 503
How Is Stockholders’ Equity Reported on the Balance Sheet?......Page 506
Summary......Page 508
Accounting Practice......Page 510
Know Your Business......Page 537
Business, Accounting, and You......Page 540
What Is the Statement of Cash Flows?......Page 542
How Does a Business Create a Statement of Cash Flows?......Page 543
Sources and Uses of Cash: Categorizing Changes as Operating, Investing, or Financing......Page 544
Statement of Cash Flows: Two Formats......Page 546
How Is the Statement of Cash Flows Prepared Using the Indirect Method?......Page 547
Cash Flows from Operating Activities......Page 549
Cash Flows from Investing Activities......Page 551
Cash Flows from Financing Activities......Page 553
Noncash Investing and Financing Activities......Page 555
How Is the Statement of Cash Flows Prepared Using the Direct Method?......Page 558
Cash Flows from Operating Activities......Page 559
Summary......Page 565
Accounting Practice......Page 566
Apply Your Knowledge......Page 594
Know Your Business......Page 595
Comprehensive Problem......Page 597
Business, Accounting, and You......Page 600
What Is Financial Analysis?......Page 601
Step Two: Understand the Environment in Which a BusinessOperates......Page 602
Step Four: Analyze the Business’s Operations......Page 603
What Measures Does Someone Use to Analyze the Performance of a Business?......Page 604
The Techniques of Financial Analysis......Page 605
Vertical Analysis......Page 607
Horizontal Analysis......Page 608
Question 1: Is the Business a Going Concern?......Page 610
An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc.......Page 611
Question 2: How Is the Business Earning a Net Income or Loss?......Page 612
An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc.......Page 614
An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc. ......Page 615
Question 4: How Is the Business Investing Its Money, and Is It Using Its Assets Efficiently?......Page 616
An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc.......Page 617
Question 5: Is the Business Generating Enough Net Income to Reward the Stockholders for the Use of Their Money?......Page 618
An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc.......Page 619
How Do You Put Everything Together to Make Decisions?......Page 621
What Are Red Flags in Financial Statement Analysis?......Page 623
Summary......Page 626
Accounting Practice......Page 628
Apply Your Knowledge......Page 653
Know Your Business......Page 654
Appendix A Columbia Sportswear Company 2012 Annual Report to Shareholders......Page 656
Future Value......Page 724
Future-Value Tables......Page 725
Future Value of an Annuity......Page 726
Present Value......Page 727
Present Value of an Annuity......Page 728
Accounting Practice......Page 730
B......Page 732
C......Page 733
H......Page 734
L......Page 735
P......Page 736
S......Page 737
V......Page 738
Z......Page 739
A......Page 740
B......Page 742
C......Page 743
D......Page 745
E......Page 746
F......Page 747
G......Page 748
I......Page 749
L......Page 750
N......Page 751
P......Page 752
Q......Page 753
S......Page 754
U......Page 756
W......Page 757
Credits......Page 758
Recommend Papers

Financial accounting [Third edition]
 9780133427882, 9781292019543, 1292019549, 0133427889, 9781292074795, 1292074795

  • 0 0 0
  • Like this paper and download? You can publish your own PDF file online for free in a few minutes! Sign Up
File loading please wait...
Citation preview

Financial Accounting

For these Global Editions, the editorial team at Pearson has collaborated with educators across the world to address a wide range of subjects and requirements, equipping students with the best possible learning tools. This Global Edition preserves the cutting-edge approach and pedagogy of the original, but also features alterations, customization, and adaptation from the North American version.

Global edition

Global edition

Global edition

Financial Accounting third edition

Robert Kemp • Jeffrey Waybright

third edition Kemp • Waybright

This is a special edition of an established title widely used by colleges and universities throughout the world. Pearson published this exclusive edition for the benefit of students outside the United States and Canada. If you purchased this book within the United States or Canada you should be aware that it has been imported without the approval of the Publisher or Author. Pearson Global Edition

KEMP_1292019549_mech.indd 1

07/03/14 2:15 PM

Financial Accounting

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 1

03/04/14 1:22 PM

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 2

03/04/14 1:22 PM

Financial Accounting Third Edition Global Edition Robert Kemp University of Virginia

Jeffrey Waybright Spokane Community College

Boston Columbus Indianapolis New York San Francisco Upper Saddle River Amsterdam Cape Town Dubai London Madrid Milan Munich Paris Montréal Toronto Delhi Mexico City São Paulo Sydney Hong Kong Seoul Singapore Taipei Tokyo

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 3

03/04/14 1:22 PM

Editor in Chief: Donna Battista Acquisitions Editor: Lacey Vitetta Senior Editorial Project Manager: Karen Kirincich Associate Editor, Global Edition: Toril Cooper Development Editor: Mignon Tucker, JD, Brava 360° Solutions Editorial Assistant: Christine Donovan Marketing Manager: Alison Haskins Managing Editor: Jeff Holcomb Senior Production Project Manager: Roberta Sherman Publisher, Global Edition: Angshuman Chakraborty Associate Print and Media Editor, Global Edition: M Vikram Kumar Publishing Administrator, Global Edition: Aditya Remy Shah

Senior Project Editor, Global Edition: Vaijyanti Senior Manufacturing Controller, Production, Global Edition: Trudy Kimber Manufacturing Buyer: Carol Melville Art Director: Anthony Gemmellaro Cover Designer: PreMedia Global Cover Photo: isak55/Shutterstock Media Producer: James Bateman MyAccountingLab Content Project Manager: Martha LaChance Supplements Editor: Jill Kolongowski Associate Project Manager, Rights and P­ ermissions: Samantha Graham

Credits and acknowledgments borrowed from other sources and reproduced, with permission, in this textbook appear on the appropriate page within text [or on page 757]. Pearson Education Limited Edinburgh Gate Harlow Essex CM20 2JE England and Associated Companies throughout the world Visit us on the World Wide Web at: www.pearsonglobaleditions.com © Pearson Education Limited 2015 The rights of Robert Kemp to be identified as the author of this work have been asserted by him in accordance with the Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988. Authorized adaptation from the United States edition, entitled Financial Accounting, 3rd edition, ISBN 978-0-13-342788-2, by Robert Kemp, published by Pearson Education © 2015. All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise, without either the prior written permission of the publisher or a license permitting restricted copying in the United Kingdom issued by the Copyright Licensing Agency Ltd, Saffron House, 6–10 Kirby Street, London EC1N 8TS. All trademarks used herein are the property of their respective owners. The use of any trademark in this text does not vest in the author or publisher any trademark ownership rights in such trademarks, nor does the use of such trademarks imply any affiliation with or endorsement of this book by such owners. British Library Cataloguing-in-Publication Data A catalogue record for this book is available from the British Library 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 15 14 13 12 11 ISBN 13: 978-1-292-01954-3 ISBN 10:    1-292-01954-9 Typeset in 10/12 Meridian by Integra Printed by Ashford Colour Press Ltd, Gosport

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 4

03/04/14 1:22 PM

Dedication I dedicate this book to my beloved children: Adam, Meg, and Sarah. I also dedicate this book to their spouses and children. They give meaning to my life and are my dream come true. Robert Kemp I would like to dedicate this book to my colleagues in the Business Department at Spokane Community College. Jeffrey Waybright

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 5

03/04/14 1:22 PM

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 6

03/04/14 1:22 PM

About the Authors Robert S. Kemp, DBA, CPA Professor Kemp is the Ramon W. Breeden, Sr. Research Professor at the McIntire School of Commerce, University of Virginia. He is a certified public accountant and possesses a baccalaureate, master’s, and doctorate in business administration. Professor Kemp is an accomplished scholar, conducting research and writing in the theory and practice of contemporary business. He currently is conducting research in the funding of pensions, the management of financial institutions, and corporate finance. His scholarly works include 70 completed projects, including monographs, articles, cases, research presentations, and working papers. His work is published in, among other places, The Financial Review; The Journal of Financial Research; Advances in Accounting, A Research Journal; Benefits Quarterly; The Journal of Mathematics Applied in Business and Industry; The Journal of Accountancy; The Journal of Commercial Bank Lending; The Journal of Bank Accounting and Auditing; and The Journal of Business Economics. Professor Kemp is likewise an accomplished teacher, to both University students and executives throughout the world. During his 34 years at the University of Virginia, he has taught numerous undergraduate and graduate courses. He has taught classes using lectures, case studies, discussion groups, and distance learning. His consistently high evaluations by students reflect his devotion to the classroom. This high quality is likewise seen in his teaching of business executives. He has worked with and taught for organizations such as Bank of America, the FDIC, Navigant—Tucker Alan, the Siberian Banking Institute, the Barents Group, KPMG, Gerson Lehrman, Wellington Management, the Russian Bankers Association, the Central Asian American Enterprise Fund, the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants, and the Consumer Bankers Association.

Jeffrey Waybright teaches accounting at Spokane Community College, which is part of a multi-college district in eastern Washington. He has been a full-time, tenured community college instructor for more than 21 years. In addition to teaching at the community college level, he has also taught upper division courses for Linfield College. Jeffrey is a co-recipient of the Washington Society of CPA’s Outstanding Educator Award. Jeffrey received his BA in business administration (emphasis in accounting) and MBA from Eastern Washington University. Before becoming a professor, Jeffrey spent eight years as a practicing CPA in Washington State and still holds his license. During his teaching career, he has taught in many disciplines of accounting including financial, managerial, computerized, and payroll accounting as well as in the disciplines of economics, business math, and general business. Jeffrey developed online courses in accounting, teaches online and traditional courses for financial and managerial accounting, and advises students. Jeffrey is passionate about teaching students the subject of accounting.

7

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 7

03/04/14 1:23 PM

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 8

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Brief Contents

Chapter 1

Business, Accounting, and You 35



Chapter 2

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions 87



Chapter 3

Adjusting and Closing Entries 136



Chapter 4

Accounting for a Merchandising Business 193



Chapter 5

Inventory 242



Chapter 6

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics 290



Chapter 7

Cash and Receivables 322



Chapter 8

Long-Term and Other Assets 387



Chapter 9

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt 438



Chapter 10

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings 486



Chapter 11

The Statement of Cash Flows 539



Chapter 12

Financial Statement Analysis 599



Appendix A

Columbia Sportswear Company 2012 Annual Report to Shareholders 655



Appendix B

Time Value of Money—Future and Present Value Concepts 723



Company Index

731

Glindex

739

Credits

757

9

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 9

03/04/14 1:23 PM

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 10

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Contents Chapter 1

Accounting, Business, and You—Putting It All Together 58

Business, Accounting, and You 35

Summary 59

Business, Accounting, and You 35

Accounting Practice 62

What Is a Business, and Why Study Accounting? 36 The Definition of a Business 36 The General Concept of Value 37 Business Owners and Other Stakeholders 38 The Goal of a Business 39

How Does a Business Operate? 39

Apply Your Knowledge 83 Know Your Business 84

Chapter 2

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions 87

Resources Needed to Start and Operate a Business 39

Business, Accounting, and You 87

Operating the Business 39

How Are Accounts Used to Keep Business Transactions Organized? 88

The Cost of Money 40

How Are Businesses Organized? 40 The Types of Businesses 40 The Legal Forms of Businesses 41

What Is Accounting, and What Are the Key Accounting Principles and Concepts? 43 Generally Accepted Accounting Principles 43 International Financial Reporting Standards 44 The Business Entity Principle 44

Organizing Accounts 88 Assets 89 Liabilities 89 Stockholders’ Equity 89

What Is Double-Entry Accounting? 90 Normal Balance 92

How Are the General Journal and General Ledger Used to Keep Track of Business Transactions? 92

The Reliability (Objectivity) Principle 44

Transaction Analysis 94

The Cost Principle 44

Applying Transaction Analysis 94

Accounting Ethics: A Matter of Trust 44

Balancing the T-Accounts 101

What Is the Role of Accounting in a Business? 45

How Is a Trial Balance Prepared, and What Is It Used For? 103

How Do You Recognize a Business Transaction? 46

Correcting Errors 104

Cash Accounting 46

Preparation of Financial Statements 105

Accrual Accounting 46

Summary 108

How Do You Measure a Business Transaction? 46

Accounting Practice 109

How Do You Record Business Transactions Using the Accounting Equation? 47

Apply Your Knowledge 133

Transaction Analysis 48 Stockholders’ Equity 48

How Do You Report Business Transactions Using Financial Statements? 54 The Income Statement 54 The Statement of Retained Earnings 56 The Balance Sheet 56 The Statement of Cash Flows 56 Relationships Among the Financial Statements 57

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 11

Know Your Business 133

Chapter 3

Adjusting and Closing Entries 136 Business, Accounting, and You 136 How Does a Company Accurately Report Its Income? 138 Revenue Recognition and Matching Principles 138

What Is the Role of Adjusting Entries, and When Are They Prepared? 139

11

03/04/14 1:23 PM

12

Contents Accruing Revenues 140

Summary 214

Accruing Expenses 141

Accounting Practice 217

Adjusting Deferred Revenues 141

Apply Your Knowledge 239

Adjusting Deferred Expenses 142

Know Your Business 239

How Are Financial Statements Prepared from an Adjusted Trial Balance? 147

Chapter 5

The Adjusted Trial Balance 147

Inventory 242

Preparing the Financial Statements 149

Business, Accounting, and You 242

How Does a Company Prepare for a New Accounting Period? 151 Completing the Accounting Cycle 151 The Three Closing Entries: Revenues, Expenses, and Dividends 152 Post-Closing Trial Balance 154 Summary of the Adjusting and Closing Processes 154 Summary 157 Accounting Practice 159 Apply Your Knowledge 188 Know Your Business 188 Comprehensive Problem 191

Chapter 4

Accounting for a Merchandising Business 193 Business, Accounting, and You 193 What Are the Relationships Among Manufacturers, Wholesalers, Retailers, and Customers? 194 How Do Periodic and Perpetual Inventory Systems Differ? 195 How Do You Account for the Purchase of Inventory? 196 Cash and Credit Purchases 196 Purchase Returns and Allowances 196 Purchase Discounts 197

How Do You Account for the Sale of Inventory? 198 Cash Sales 199 Credit Sales 199 Sales Returns and Allowances 200 Sales Returns 201 Sales Allowances 201 Sales Discounts 202

How Do You Account for Freight Charges and Other Selling Expenses? 203 Costs Related to the Receipt of Goods from Suppliers 204 Costs Related to Delivering Goods to Customers 205 Other Selling Costs 207

How Do You Prepare a Merchandiser’s Financial Statements? 208 The Income Statement 208 The Statement of Retained Earnings 211 The Balance Sheet 211

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 12

What Inventory Costing Methods Are Allowed? 243 Cost Flow Versus Physical Flow of Inventory 244

How Are the Four Inventory Costing Methods Applied? 246 Inventory Cost Flows 246 Specific-Identification Method 247 First-In, First-Out (FIFO) Method 248 Last-In, First-Out (LIFO) Method 249 Average Cost Method 250 Journalizing Inventory Transactions 251

What Effect Do the Different Costing Methods Have on Net Income? 252 What Else Determines How Inventory Is Valued? 254 How Is Inventory Reported on the Balance Sheet? 256 Inventory Shrinkage 256

How Do Inventory Errors Affect the Financial Statements? 257 Is It Possible to Estimate the Value of Inventory If the Inventory Is Accidentally Destroyed? 258 Summary 262 Accounting Practice 264 Apply Your Knowledge 286 Know Your Business 286 Comprehensive Problem 288

Chapter 6

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics 290 Business, Accounting, and You 290 What Are the Rules that Govern Accounting? 291 Understandable 291 Relevant 292 Reliable 292 Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP) in the United States 292 Generally Accepted Accounting Principles Around the World: IFRS 293 Differences Between FASB and IFRS 293

What Is Internal Control? 295 Elements of an Internal Control System 295

What Is Fraud, and Who Commits It? 299 Management Fraud 299

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Contents Employee Embezzlement 299

Computing Interest on a Note 344

The Factors Usually Present When Fraud Is Committed 300

Accruing Interest Revenue 345

What Is a Certified Public Accountant (CPA)? 302

Summary 349

Audits 302

Accounting Practice 352

Audit Opinions 303

Apply Your Knowledge 378

What Are the Legal and Ethical Responsibilities of Accountants? 304 The Legal Responsibilities of Accountants 304 Ethical Responsibilities of Accountants 305

Know Your Business 379

Appendix 7A 381 What Is a Petty Cash Fund? 381 Setting Up the Petty Cash Fund 381

Summary 307

Replenishing the Petty Cash Fund 382

Accounting Practice 309

Changing the Petty Cash Fund 383

Apply Your Knowledge 316

13

Accounting Practice 384

Know Your Business 319

Chapter 7

Cash and Receivables 322 Business, Accounting, and You 322 What Are the Different Types of Sales? 323 Cash Sales 323 Credit Card Sales 324 Debit Card Sales 324 Credit/Debit Card Processing 324 Sales on Account 325

What Internal Control Procedures Should Be Used for Cash? 325 Internal Controls over Cash Receipts 325 Internal Control over Cash Payments 326 Purchase and Payment Process 327 The Bank Reconciliation 328 Preparing the Bank Reconciliation 328 Book Side of the Reconciliation 329 Online Banking 333

How Is Cash Reported on the Balance Sheet? 334 How Do You Account for Receivables? 334 Types of Receivables 334 Internal Control over Accounts Receivable 335 Accounting for Uncollectible Accounts Receivable 335

How Do You Account for Uncollectible Accounts? 335 The Direct Write-Off Method 335 Direct Write-Off Method: Recovery of Accounts Previously Written Off 336 The Allowance Method 337

Chapter 8

Long-Term and Other Assets 387 Business, Accounting, and You 387 What Are the Different Types of Long-Term Assets? 388 How Is the Cost of a Fixed Asset Calculated? 389 Land and Land Improvements 389 Buildings 390 Machinery and Equipment 390 Furniture and Fixtures 391 Lump-Sum (Basket) Purchase of Assets 391

How Are Fixed Assets Depreciated? 392 Measuring Depreciation 393 Depreciation Methods 394 Comparing Depreciation Methods 398 Partial Year Depreciation 398 Changing the Useful Life of a Depreciable Asset 399 Using Fully Depreciated Assets 400

How Are Costs of Repairing Fixed Assets Recorded? 401 Ordinary Repairs 401 Extraordinary Repairs 401 Betterments 402

What Happens When a Fixed Asset Is Disposed? 402 How Do You Account for Intangible Assets? 405 Specific Intangibles 405 Accounting for Research and Development Costs 407

Estimating the Amount of Uncollectible Accounts 337

How Are Natural Resources Accounted For? 407

Writing Off Uncollectible Accounts Under the Allowance Method 340

What Are Other Assets? 408

Allowance Method: Recovery of Accounts Previously Written Off 341

How Are Long-Term Assets Reported on the Balance Sheet? 409

How Are Accounts Receivable Reported on the Balance Sheet? 342 How Do You Account for Notes Receivable? 343

Summary 411 Accounting Practice 414

Identifying the Maturity Date 343

Apply Your Knowledge 434

Origination of Notes Receivable 344

Know Your Business 435

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 13

03/04/14 1:23 PM

14

Contents

Chapter 9

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt 438 Business, Accounting, and You 438 What Are the Differences Among Known, Estimated, and Contingent Liabilities? 439 How Do You Account for Current Liabilities of a Known Amount? 440 Accounts Payable 440 Notes Payable 440 Sales Tax Payable 442

How Are Stock Dividends and Stock Splits Accounted For? 496 Stock Dividends 496 Recording Stock Dividends 497 Stock Splits 499 Stock Dividends and Stock Splits Compared 501

How Is Treasury Stock Accounted For? 501 Treasury Stock Basics 501 Purchase of Treasury Stock 502 Sale of Treasury Stock 502

How Is Stockholders’ Equity Reported on the Balance Sheet? 505

Accrued Expenses (Accrued Liabilities) 442

Summary 507

Unearned Revenues 442

Accounting Practice 509

Current Portion of Long-Term Debt 443

Apply Your Knowledge 536

How Do You Account for Current Liabilities of an Uncertain Amount? 443 Estimated Warranty Liability 443

Know Your Business 536

Chapter 11

How Do You Account for a Contingent Liability? 444

The Statement of Cash Flows 539

How Do You Account for Long-Term Debt? 445

Business, Accounting, and You 539

Notes Payable 445 Bonds Payable 447 Lease Liabilities 453

How Are Liabilities Reported on the Balance Sheet? 455 Summary 459 Accounting Practice 462 Apply Your Knowledge 482 Know Your Business 483

Appendix 9A: Payroll.com (Please visit MyAccountingLab) 9A-1

What Is the Statement of Cash Flows? 541 How Does a Business Create a Statement of Cash Flows? 542 The Logic of How the Statement of Cash Flows Is Prepared 543 Sources and Uses of Cash: Categorizing Changes as Operating, Investing, or Financing 543 Statement of Cash Flows: Two Formats 545

How Is the Statement of Cash Flows Prepared Using the Indirect Method? 546 Cash Flows from Operating Activities 548 Cash Flows from Investing Activities 550

Chapter 10

Cash Flows from Financing Activities 552

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings 486

Net Change in Cash and Cash Balances 554

Business, Accounting, and You 486 How Are Corporations Organized? 487 What Makes Up the Stockholders’ Equity of a Corporation? 489 Stockholders’ Rights 489 Classes of Stock 489 Par Value, Stated Value, and No-Par Stock 490

How Is the Issuance of Stock Recorded? 490 Issuing Common Stock 491 Issuing Preferred Stock 492

How Are Cash Dividends Accounted For? 492

Noncash Investing and Financing Activities 554

How Is the Statement of Cash Flows Prepared Using the Direct Method? 557 Cash Flows from Operating Activities 558 Summary 564 Accounting Practice 565 Apply Your Knowledge 593 Know Your Business 594 Comprehensive Problem 596

Chapter 12

Financial Statement Analysis 599

Dividend Dates 493

Business, Accounting, and You 599

Declaring and Paying Dividends 493

What Is Financial Analysis? 600

Dividing Dividends Between Preferred and Common Shareholders 494

Step One: Understand a Business’s Model and Strategy 601

Dividends on Cumulative and Noncumulative Preferred Stock 495

Step Two: Understand the Environment in Which a Business Operates 601

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 14

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Contents Step Three: Analyze the Content of the Financial Statements and Other Information, Making Adjustments If Desired 602

Summary 625

Step Four: Analyze the Business’s Operations 602

Apply Your Knowledge 652

Step Five: Use the Financial Analysis to Make Decisions 603

Know Your Business 653

What Measures Does Someone Use to Analyze the Performance of a Business? 603 The Techniques of Financial Analysis 604 Vertical Analysis 606 Horizontal Analysis 607

15

Accounting Practice 627

Appendix A

Columbia Sportswear Company 2012 Annual Report to Shareholders 655

Trend Percentages 609 Question 1: Is the Business a Going Concern? 609

Appendix B

An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc. 610

Time Value of Money—Future and Present Value Concepts 723

Question 2: How Is the Business Earning a Net Income or Loss? 611 An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc. 613 Question 3: Where Is the Business Getting Its Money, and Can It Pay Its Debt Obligations? 614 An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc. 614 Question 4: How Is the Business Investing Its Money, and Is It Using Its Assets Efficiently? 615 An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc. 616 Question 5: Is the Business Generating Enough Net Income to Reward the Stockholders for the Use of Their Money? 617

Future Value 723 Future-Value Tables 724 Future Value of an Annuity 725

Present Value 726 Present-Value Tables 727 Present Value of an Annuity 727 Accounting Practice 729

An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc. 618

How Do You Put Everything Together to Make Decisions? 620

Company Index 731

Seeing the Impact of Decisions 622

Glindex 739

What Are Red Flags in Financial Statement Analysis? 622

Credits 757

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 15

03/04/14 1:23 PM

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 16

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Preface Changes to this Edition Chapter 1  Business, Accounting, and You • Added Real World Accounting Video summary of David Hitchner, owner and ­manager of ABC Wine, to set the chapter content in a real world business context for students. • Added two questions to the Self Checks that assess student understanding of the Real World Accounting Videos. • Changed 50% of the exercises and problems to provide diverse practice and teaching opportunities for students and teachers. • EXCEL is now in MyAccountingLab. For every chapter, instructors have the option to assign students 2 end-of-chapter problems that can be completed in an Excel-simulated environment, auto graded and visible in the grade book. Excel ­remediation will be available to students.

Chapter 2  Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions • Changed chapter introduction company from Best Buy to Target. • Added Real World Accounting Video of Julie Gaines, owner and manager of Fishs Eddy, to set the chapter content in a real world business context for students. • Animated each hybrid equation example so that students can drill themselves as many times as needed on the interrelationship of the journal entries, t-accounts, and general ledger when posting transactions. Available in the eText only, located in MyAccountingLab®. • Changed 50% of the exercises and problems to provide diverse practice and teaching opportunities for students and teachers. • Added two questions to the Self Checks that assess student understanding of the Real World Accounting Videos. • Updated Continuing Financial Statement Analysis featuring Target using the 2012 annual report. • Designated two Excel problems and exercises that can be automatically graded in MyAccountingLab. These materials are designated by a “Try It In Excel” icon. • Updated the end of chapter material related to Under Armour and Columbia Sportswear using the 2012 annual reports.

Chapter 3  Adjusting and Closing Entries • Changed chapter introduction company from Best Buy to Disney. • Added Real World Accounting Video of Jeanette Cebollero, the chief financial ­officer (CFO) of Rosa Mexicano Restaurants, to set the chapter content in a real world business context for students. 17

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 17

03/04/14 1:23 PM

18

Preface

• Animated each hybrid equation example so that students can drill themselves as many times as needed on the interrelationship of the journal entries, t-accounts, and general ledger when posting transactions. Available in the etext only, located in MyAccountingLab. • Changed 50% of the exercises and problems to provide diverse practice and teaching opportunities for students and teachers. • Added two questions to the Self Checks that assess student understanding of the Real World Accounting Videos. • Updated Continuing Financial Statement Analysis featuring Target using the 2012 annual report. • Designated two Excel problems and exercises that can be automatically graded in MyAccountingLab. These materials are designated by a “Try It In Excel” icon. • Updated the end of chapter material related to Under Armour and Columbia Sportswear using the 2012 annual reports.

Chapter 4  Accounting for a Merchandising Business • Changed chapter introduction company from Best Buy to Toys R Us. • Added Real World Accounting Video of Noah Lenovitz, a partner and chief ­operating officer of Fishs Eddy, to set the chapter content in a real world business context for students. • Changed 50% of the exercises and problems to provide diverse practice and teaching opportunities for students and teachers. • Added two questions to the Self Checks that assess student understanding of the Real World Accounting Videos. • Updated Continuing Financial Statement Analysis featuring Target using the 2012 annual report. • Designated two Excel problems and exercises that can be automatically graded in MyAccountingLab. These materials are designated by a “Try It In Excel” icon. • Updated the end of chapter material related to Under Armour and Columbia Sportswear using the 2012 annual reports.

Chapter 5  Inventory • Changed chapter introduction company from Best Buy to Toys R Us. • Added Real World Accounting Video of Keith Beavers, owner and operator of ABC Wines, to set the chapter content in a real world business context for students. • Changed 50% of the exercises and problems to provide diverse practice and teaching opportunities for students and teachers. • Added two questions to the Self Checks that assess student understanding of the Real World Accounting Videos. • Updated Continuing Financial Statement Analysis featuring Target using the 2012 annual report. • Designated two Excel problems and exercises that can be automatically graded in MyAccountingLab. These materials are designated by a “Try It In Excel” icon. • Updated the end of chapter material related to Under Armour and Columbia Sportswear using the 2012 annual reports.

Chapter 6  The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics • Added Real World Accounting Video of Vince Molinari, CEO and founder of Gate Technologies, to set the chapter content in a real world business context for students. • Changed 50% of the exercises and problems to provide diverse practice and teaching opportunities for students and teachers.

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 18

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Preface

19

• Added two questions to the Self Checks that assess student understanding of the Real World Accounting Videos. • Updated Continuing Financial Statement Analysis featuring Target using the 2012 annual report. • Designated two Excel problems and exercises that can be automatically graded in MyAccountingLab. These materials are designated by a “Try It In Excel” icon. • Updated the end of chapter material related to Under Armour and Columbia Sportswear using the 2012 annual reports.

Chapter 7  Cash and Receivables • Changed chapter introduction company from Best Buy to Hershey. • Added Real World Accounting Video of Zachary Mack, owner and founder of Alphabet City Beer Company, to set the chapter content in a real world business context for students. • Changed 50% of the exercises and problems to provide diverse practice and teaching opportunities for students and teachers. • Added two questions to the Self Checks that assess student understanding of the Real World Accounting Videos. • Updated Continuing Financial Statement Analysis featuring Target using the 2012 annual report. • Designated two Excel problems and exercises that can be automatically graded in MyAccountingLab. These materials are designated by a “Try It In Excel” icon. • Updated the end of chapter material related to Under Armour and Columbia Sportswear using the 2012 annual reports.

Chapter 8  Long-Term and Other Assets • Changed chapter introduction company from Best Buy to AT&T. • Added Real World Accounting Video of Jason Berry of Rosa Mexicano Restaurants to set the chapter content in a real world ­business context for students. • Changed 50% of the exercises and problems to provide diverse practice and teaching opportunities for students and teachers. • Added two questions to the Self Checks that assess student understanding of the Real World Accounting Videos. • Updated Continuing Financial Statement Analysis featuring Target using the 2012 annual report. • Designated two Excel problems and exercises that can be automatically graded in MyAccountingLab. These materials are designated by a “Try It In Excel” icon. • Updated the end of chapter material related to Under Armour and Columbia Sportswear using the 2012 annual reports.

Chapter 9  Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt • Changed chapter introduction company from Best Buy to Ford. • Added Real World Accounting Video of Bill Mercer, Controller of Sheffield Pharmaceuticals, to set the chapter content in a real world business context for students. • Changed 50% of the exercises and problems to provide diverse practice and teaching opportunities for students and teachers. • Added two questions to the Self Checks that assess student understanding of the Real World Accounting Videos. • Updated Continuing Financial Statement Analysis featuring Target using the 2012 annual report. • Designated two excel problems and exercises that can be automatically graded in MyAccountingLab. These materials are designated by a “Try It In Excel” icon.

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 19

03/04/14 1:23 PM

20

Preface

• Updated the end of chapter material related to Under Armour and Columbia Sportswear using the 2012 annual reports.

Chapter 10  Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings • Changed chapter introduction company from Best Buy to Apple. • Added Real World Accounting Video of Howard Greenstone, President and CEO of Rosa Mexicano Restaurants, to set the chapter content in a real world business context for students. • Changed 50% of the exercises and problems to provide diverse practice and teaching opportunities for students and teachers. • Added two questions to the Self Checks that assess student understanding of the Real World Accounting Videos. • Updated Continuing Financial Statement Analysis featuring Target using the 2012 annual report. • Designated two Excel problems and exercises that can be automatically graded in MyAccountingLab. These materials are designated by a “Try It In Excel” icon. • Updated the end of chapter material related to Under Armour and Columbia Sportswear using the 2012 annual reports.

Chapter 11  The Statement of Cash Flows • Changed chapter introduction company from Best Buy to Delta Airlines. • Added Real World Accounting Video of Peter Kranes, managing director of Fishs Eddy, to set the chapter content in a real world business context for students. • Changed 50% of the exercises and problems to provide diverse practice and teaching opportunities for students and teachers. • Added two questions to the Self Checks that assess student understanding of the Real World Accounting Videos. • Updated Continuing Financial Statement Analysis featuring Target using the 2012 annual report. • Designated two Excel problems and exercises that can be automatically graded in MyAccountingLab. These materials are designated by a “Try It In Excel” icon. • Updated the end of chapter material related to Under Armour and Columbia Sportswear using the 2012 annual reports. • Added an all new comprehensive problem that would make an excellent capstone problem for the course.

Chapter 12  Financial Statement Analysis • Added Real World Accounting Video of David Drake of LDJ Capital to set the chapter content in a real world business context for students. • Changed 50% of the exercises and problems to provide diverse practice and teaching opportunities for students and teachers. • Added two questions to the Self Checks that assess student understanding of the Real World Accounting Videos. • Updated Continuing Financial Statement Analysis featuring Target using the 2012 annual report. • Designated two Excel problems and exercises that can be automatically graded in MyAccountingLab. These materials are designated by a “Try It In Excel” icon. • Updated the end of chapter material related to Under Armour and Columbia Sportswear using the 2012 annual reports.

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 20

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Dear Colleagues, We are very excited about the newest edition of Kemp and Waybright’s Financial Accounting. After you have had a chance to look at this edition’s changes, we think you will be as excited about our latest edition as we are. Practical Approach: Accounting from a Business Perspective The goal and focus of the third edition of Financial Accounting is all about helping students learn. We believe the text and supporting materials tackle challenging topics in a pragmatic, easily understood manner so that they understand not only accounting but its critical role in the business world. After this course ends, it is our hope that your students will have mastered the basic concepts of financial accounting and can apply them to everyday business decisions. Execution: Ensuring Student Success Every feature in Financial Accounting is about helping you, the faculty, help your students achieve this goal. Based on our years of teaching, we believe we have created a complete package of instructional materials, using traditional and digital methods. For example, examine how each topic is introduced, explained, and demonstrated. Notice how students not only learn the topic, but also see how it is applied in the real world. Moreover, the end of chapter exercises, problems, and cases, prepared by us, create a progressive and appropriately challenging learning experience. For this edition, we developed more than 15 hybrid equation simulations, so that students can test their understanding of the relationship between the general journal, journal entries, and the impact on the accounting equation. These materials were all crafted carefully to help you ensure that your students have more of those “I get it” moments. Assessment: Ensuring Your Success We are first and foremost teachers. It’s our passion. We understand the challenges you face as teachers. For example, in order to assure continuity between the text and the assessments, we prepared the test bank and solutions manual. In addition to all the updated, automatically graded homework assignments in MyAccountingLab, we added gradable Excel simulation problems so that you can easily evaluate student performance using Excel. We love this text. Every day, we see how this text and supporting materials help students learn in and out of the classroom. We believe you too will love this text. We believe you will quickly see how Financial Accounting, with all of its supporting materials, creates success in your students. Thank you for looking at Financial Accounting. We believe the third edition of Financial Accounting is unique. It’s special. We hope you’ll look at it, compare it to other books, and think about what is best for your students and you. If you do, we think there is one obvious choice. It’s Kemp and Waybright’s Financial Accounting. It’s all about success for you and your students. Best wishes, Bob Kemp Robert S. Kemp, DBA, CPA Ramon W. Breeden Senior Research Professor McIntire School of Commerce The University of Virginia

Jeffrey Waybright Jeffrey Waybright, CPA, MBA Accounting Instructor Spokane Community College

21

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 21

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Visual Walk-Through Chapter Openers Business, Accounting, and You ties the business concept directly to the accounting topics covered in the chapters using a variety of well-known US and international companies as examples.

Adjusting and Closing Entries

3

Step One

Adjusting and Closing Entries

Step Eight

54

1

Understand the revenue recognition and matching principles

2

Understand the four types of adjustments, and prepare adjusting entries

3

Prepare financial statements from an adjusted trial balance

4

Prepare closing entries and a post-closing trial balance

It’s December 31st and closing time at Disney. Everyone has worked hard. The year has come to a close. Millions of transactions have occurred and been recorded by the accountants. It’s time to wrap up the year and tabulate the score for Disney. How does Disney conclude a year’s activities and prepare for a new year? There has to be an end for a new beginning. Think of a sporting event. There must be an end to the game. At the end of the game, the scorekeeper must make sure the score accurately reflects what happened. Accountants are the scorekeepers of the business. They have activities to complete at the end of each accounting period. They may need to go back and make sure they have recognized, measured, and reported all the business’s transactions. Given the rules of Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP), they may need to adjust the scorecard to better reflect what happened. They then need to summarize the transactions and prepare the final reports.

102

NEW!

and measuring the business transactions. This part of the process will be explored throughout the book. However, the rules for recording and reporting business transactions are based on a set of proven techniques that have evolved over time. The result is a set of standard, universally accepted procedures that work. The key to using these techniques and procedures is understanding: (1) accounts and (2) doubleentry accounting. So why is this important to you? Whether you want to be an accountant or manager, you need to understand how business transactions are recorded. The final report card, good or bad, is a result of this recording process. Would you want to play a game where you do not understand how the score is recorded and ultimately reported? Probably not. Understanding how accountants record business transactions is very important.

Step Seven

Step Three Prepare an unadjusted trial balance

Step Four

Step Six

Step Five

Journalize and post adjusting entries

Prepare an adjusted trial balance

Here in Chapter 3, we will learn how to prepare steps four, five, seven, and eight. The accounting cycle is repeated for every accounting period. The accounting period can be defined as a month, a quarter, or a year. The annual accounting period for most large companies runs the calendar year from January 1 through December 31, although some companies use a fiscal year that does not coincide with the calendar year. A fiscal year is any consecutive 12-month period that a business chooses. It may begin on any day of the year and end 12 months later. Usually, the fiscal year-end date is the low point in business activity for the year. Although we will focus primarily on an annual time period, usually financial statements are prepared monthly, quarterly, or semiannually so that businesses have an idea of how they are doing before the year ends.

Real World Accounting Video In the Real World Accounting Video, Jeanette Cebollero, the chief financial officer (CFO) of Rosa Mexicano Restaurants, talks about the accounting function. Look at the video.

Real Business Videos Real Business Videos bring accounting to life in the business world. Denoted by an icon in the chapter openers and developed by the author, interviews with CFOs, financial analysts, investment bankers, and Real World Accounting Video small business owners highlight chapter concepts and help students understand that accounting is the In the Real World Accounting Video, Julie Gaines, owner and manager of Fishs Eddy, language talks of about business. Self-check two each chapter, assess student understanding of the real what it means to own and operatequestions, a business. Look at the video.in Think about what Julie is saying. And then realize how important accounting is to the business videos and the concepts illustrated. success of a business. How Are Accounts Used to Keep Business Transactions Organized?

1

Step Two Post transactions to the general ledger

Journalize and post closing entries

Prepare financial statements

Fiscal year Any consecutive, 12-month period that a business adopts as its accounting year.

Chapter 2

Recognize, measure and journalize transactions

Prepare a post-closing trial balance

Business, Accounting, and You Learning Objectives

103

Whether you are an accountant or a manager who uses accounting information, you need to understand the process used by accountants to adjust and conclude (close) a business’s financial records. Why? Because they affect the reports used to manage the business. They affect the final score used to judge a business’s success. In Chapter 2, we learned about journalizing and posting transactions for a business, as well as how to prepare a trial balance and financial statements. These were steps one, two, three, and six of the accounting cycle. Once again the accounting cycle looks like this:

Define accounts and understand how they are used in accounting

Accounts The basic summary device of accounting; the detailed record of all the changes in a specific asset, liability, or stockholders’ equity item as a result of transactions.

As we discussed in Chapter 1, accounting provides useful information to various users. In order for the information to be useful, it has to be detailed. Therefore, to convey the detail required, accountants will create many categories in which to track information. These categories are referred to as accounts. We have already seen accounts in use. When recording transactions in the accounting equation in Chapter 1, we created accounts such as Cash, Equipment, and Accounts Payable.

Question & Answer Format mirrors those valuable teachable moments in the classroom when a student asks a question that gets straight to the heart of the topic.

Organizing Accounts Numbering helps keep the accounts organized. Account numbers usually have two or more digits. The first digit indicates the type of account. Generally, if an account starts with: • • • • •

1, it is an asset account. 2, it is a liability account. 3, it is a stockholders’ equity account other than a revenue or expense account. 4, it is a revenue account. 5, it is an expense account.

Accounts that start with 6, 7, 8, or 9 are used by some businesses to record special types of accounts such as other revenues and expenses. After the first digit, the remaining digits in an account number are used to specify the exact account. For example, Cash may be numbered 101 and Accounts Receivable may be numbered 131. A gap in numbers is usually left between the different accounts to allow for additional accounts to be added later. A listing of all of the accounts is referred

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 22

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Earnings

Retained Earnings

Dividends

Service Revenue

Bal 3,200

Bal 9,500 000 7,400 00

Salaries Expense

Bal 7,000 00 0 250 50 0 150 50 0 7,400 Bal 7,400 00 0 Bal -0--

Bal

550 550 Bal 1,100

Rent Expense Bal 1,000

Supplies Expense Bal

300

Depreciation Expense, Equipment 350

Bal

Utilities Expense Bal

NEW!

154

Hybrid Approach Animations The authors introduce unique hybrid visuals to illustrate the connection between the accounting equation and journalizing transactions. In Chapters 2 and 3 of the eText, students can journalize transactions, create T-Accounts, and test their understanding of the relationship between journal entries and the accounting equation. Eighteen animations will allow students to practice over and over again until they comprehend these critical accounting concepts.

400

Step 2 GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account Mar 31 Retained Earnings

Debit

Credit

3,150

Salaries Expense

1,100 00

Rent Expense

1,000 00

Supplies Expense

300 00

Depreciation Expense, Equipment

350 50

Utilities Expense

400 00

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Liabilities ties

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Retained Earnings 3,150

Bal 9,500 000 00 7,400

Retained Earnings

Dividends Bal 3,200

Dividends

Revenues

Expenses

Service Revenue Bal 7,000 00 0 50 0 250 150 500 7,400 Bal 7,400 00 0 Bal -0--

Salaries Expense Bal

550 550 Bal 1,100 Bal -0-

Bal 1,000 -0Bal

Bal Bal

300 -0-

Case 1. Jilian Carter was preparing the adjusting journal entries for Jilian’s Java, a business that uses the accrual basis of accounting, in order to prepare the adjusted trial balance and financial statements. She knew that $610 of salaries related to the current accounting period had accrued but wouldn’t be paid until the next period. Jilian thought that simply not including the adjustment for these salaries would mean that salaries expense would be lower and reported net income would be higher than it would have been if she had made the adjustment. Further, she knew that the Salaries Payable account would be zero, so the liabilities reported on the balance sheet would be less and her business would look even better. Besides, she reasoned that these salaries would be reported eventually, so it was merely a matter of showing them in one period instead of another. Dismissing the reporting as just a timing issue, she ignored the adjustment for the additional salaries expense. Is Jilian acting unethically by failing to record the adjustment for accrued salaries? Does it matter that, shortly into the new accounting period, the salaries will ultimately be paid? Is it really simply a matter of timing? What are the potential problems of failing to include all the adjusting journal entries? Case 2. Brent Robertson and his banker were reviewing the quarterly income statements for his consulting business, Robertson and Associates, Inc. The banker was impressed with the growth of sales revenue and net income for the second quarter of this year as compared to the second quarter of last year. Brent knew it had been a good quarter, but didn’t think it had been spectacular. Suddenly, Brent realized that he failed to close out the revenue and expense accounts for the prior quarter, which ended in March. Because those temporary accounts were not closed out, their balances were included in the second quarter amounts for the current year. Brent then realized that the banker had the financial statements but not the general ledger or any trial balances. Thus, the banker would not be able to see that the accounting cycle from the first quarter was not properly closed and that this failure was creating a misstated income statement for the second quarter of the current year. The banker then commented that the business appeared to be performing so well that he would approve a line of credit for the business. Brent decided to not say anything because he did not want to lose the line of credit. Besides, he thought, it really did not matter that the income statement was misstated because his business would be sure to repay any amounts borrowed. Should Brent have informed the banker of the mistake made, and should he have redone the second quarter’s income statement? Was Brent’s failure to close the prior quarter’s revenue and expense accounts unethical? Does the fact that the business will repay the loan matter?

Know Your Business

300

Depreciation Expense, Equipment Bal Bal

350 -0-

350

Utilities Expense Bal Bal

400 -0-

Adjusting and Closing Entries

Ethics in Action

1,000

Supplies Expense

Chapter 3

Apply Your Knowledge

1,100

Rent Expense

400

155

Requirements 1. Open T-accounts for the following accounts and their balances as of December 31, 2011. (Note that amounts from the Columbia Sportswear financial statements are in thousands.)

Accumulated Depreciation ................................................................................. Accrued Salaries, Bonus, Vacation, and Other Benefits...................................... Accrued Import Duties ....................................................................................... Accrued Product Warranties .............................................................................. Other Accrued Liabilities ....................................................................................

$275,886 $ 55,958 $ 11,258 $ 10,452 $ 26,828

2. Using the following information for Columbia Sportswear’s 2012 operations, make the appropriate journal entries. a. Full payment of the December 31, 2011, balances in the accrued liability accounts. b. Depreciation expense, $27,157. c. Accrued salaries and benefits expense, $55,728. d. Accrued import duty expense, $15,023. e. Accrued product warranty expense, $10,209. f. Accrued other (miscellaneous) expenses, $24,230. 3. Post the journal entries to the T-accounts you set up. Check the updated ending balances in each account against the balances reported by Columbia Sportswear as of December 31, 2012.

Industry Analysis Purpose: To help you understand and compare the performance of two companies in the same industry. Go to the Columbia Sportswear Company Annual Report located in Appendix A . Now access the 2012 Annual Report for Under Armour, Inc. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Industry Analysis in Chapter 1. Requirement 1. By reviewing the financial statements of both companies, can you determine which method of accounting, cash or accrual basis, each of the companies used? How did you determine this? If one of the companies used the cash basis and the other used the accrual basis, would it affect your ability to compare the two companies? Explain your answer.

Financial Analysis

Small Business Analysis

Purpose: To help familiarize you with the financial reporting of a real company in order to further your understanding of the chapter material. This case will help you to better understand the effect of adjusting journal entries on the financial statements. You know that adjusting journal entries are entered in the journal and then posted to the ledger accounts. We do not have access to the journals and ledgers used by Columbia Sportswear, but we can see some of the adjusted accounts on the company’s financial statements. Refer to the Columbia Sportswear income statements, “Statements of Operations,” and the Columbia Sportswear balance sheets, in Appendix A. Also find footnote 6 titled “Property, Plant, and Equipment, Net” and footnote 9 titled “Accrued Liabilities,” which are two of the many footnotes included after the financial statements.

Purpose: To help you understand the importance of cash flows in the operation of a small business. It’s the end of the month, and cash flow has been a little slow, as it usually is during this time of the accounting period. It just seems to be a little slower this month. You know that Wednesday the 31st is payday, which always requires a large cash outlay. However, you also know that your bank is looking for a set of financial statements as of the end of the month because the loan on your building is coming up for renewal soon. Based on some of the previous meetings with your bankers, they are always concerned with the cash balance, so you want to have your cash balance as high as possible. You come up with a tentative plan you believe will not only preserve some of your cash balance at the end of the month but also will help your bottom line, your net income. That’s the other thing that the bankers are always concerned about. You don’t want to make any mistakes

The Perfect Balance of Small ­Business ­Perspective and ­Corporate Coverage Not every student will graduate and become part of a large corporation, which is why it’s ­important for students to understand how financial ­accounting applies in small business scenarios as well as corporate ones.

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 23

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

73

Focus on Decision Making shows students how to make financially sound business decisions and to evaluate risk and the impact of those decisions on a company.

Focus On Decision Making How Does Accounting Report Business Transactions?

Think of the school you are attending. What are some of the transactions that are conducted every day at your school? How would the following transactions be recorded? Make sure you think through each of these transactions and understand that you need to acknowledge the total transaction. 1. You enroll in class and pay the school your tuition. 2. Your school hires your teacher, who teaches your class. 3. Your school pays the utilities that make your classroom comfortable. 4. You buy a ticket to an athletic event, concert, or other special activity. 5. Your school pays for advertising to promote the athletic event, concert, or other special activity. Managers need good information about all the aspects of a business transaction. They need accounting systems to recognize, measure, record, and report the entire transaction. Financial statements must report the total transaction and how everything in a business works together.

How They Do It: A Look at Business

Businesses produce income by using assets financed with money. Think about Target, the large discount retailer. Target buys and sells goods such as clothing, groceries, electronics, and toys. Target sells these goods in large buildings. To earn more net income, Target tries to sell more goods. However, as sales increase, Target needs more assets. The more assets Target has, the more financing it needs. It needs money to finance the growing amount of clothing, groceries, electronics, and toys it sells. It also needs money to finance new and bigger buildings. Target gets this money from either borrowing the money (which increases Target’s liabilities) or from its owners (stockholders’ equity). For the year ended February 2, 2013, Target had revenues of $73.3 billion, expenses of $70.3 billion, and net income of $3 billion. As of February 2, 2013, Target had assets of $48.2 billion. These assets were financed with liabilities of $31.6 billion and stockholders’ equity of $16.6 billion. As can be seen by comparing its 2012 and 2013 financial statements, Target grew its assets. For the year ended January 28, 2012, Target had revenues of $69.9 billion, expenses of $66.9 billion, and net income of $3 billion. As of January 28, 2012, Target had assets of $46.6 billion, liabilities of $30.8 billion, and stockholders equity of $15.8 billion. Target increased its assets, and thus its financing, in hopes of seeing net income increase in the future.

Adjusting and Closing Entries

Decision Guidelines focus students on the key business decisions that require a firm understanding of the accounting concepts in each chapter.UPDATED!

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analyze

How can I tell how well a business is performing?

A company’s financial statements will provide information regarding the performance of the company.

The income statement reflects how profitable a business has been for a specified period of time. The statement of retained earnings shows how much of a company’s earnings have been distributed to the stockholders during the period. And the balance sheet reflects the business’s financial position on a given date. In other words, it shows what assets the business has and who has rights to those assets.

Adjusting and Closing Entries

153

Requirements 1. Journalize the transactions that occurred in July. Omit explanations.

UPDATED!

2. Using the four-column accounts from the continuing problem in Chapter 2, post the transactions to the ledger creating new ledger accounts as necessary. Omit posting references. Calculate the new account balances at July 31. 3. Prepare the unadjusted trial balance for Aqua Magic, Inc., at July 31.

How Does a Company Prepare for a New Accounting Period?

4. Journalize and post the adjusting entries for July based on the following adjustment information. a. Record the expired rent. b. Supplies on hand, $250. c. Depreciation; $180 equipment, $50 furniture, $420 vehicles. d. Services performed but unbilled, $2,200. e. Accrued salaries, $625. f. Unearned service revenue earned as of July 31, $1,100. 6.

Completing the Accounting Cycle

4

Prepare closing entries and a post-closing trial Prepare the income statement and statement of retained earnings for the threebalance

5. Prepare an adjusted trial balance for Aqua Magic, Inc., at the end of July.

month period May 1 through July 31, 2014. Also prepare a balance sheet at July 31, 2014. Closing entries Journal entries 7. Prepare and post closing entries. that are prepared at the end of the 8. Prepare a post-closing trial balance at July 31, 2014.

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem

accounting period. Closing entries zero out the revenue, expense, and dividend accounts so accounting can begin for the next period.

Let’s look at Target again. Think about the business of Target. Now return to that place on Target’s website called “investor relations.” Look at Target’s 2012 financial statements contained in its 2012 annual report. Go to: http://investors.target.com/phoenix.zhtml?c=65828&p=irol-reportsAnnual. On page 33 of the financial statements, you’ll find Target’s income statement for the year ending February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidate Statement of Operations). On page 35, you’ll find Target’s balance sheet as of February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position). On page 37, you’ll find Target’s statement of retained earnings for the year ending February 2, 2013. It’s a part of Target’s statement titled Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Investment. Now answer the following questions:

We have now seen steps one through six in the accounting cycle completed for Osborne Consulting. The entire accounting cycle can be completed by finishing steps seven and eight. Step seven of the accounting cycle is the journalizing and posting of the closing entries, and step eight is the preparation of a post-closing trial balance. In order to complete the accounting cycle, closing entries must be journalized and posted. Earlier in the chapter, we processed the transactions for Osborne Consulting and prepared the financial statements at the end of March. If we continue recording information in the revenue, expense, and dividend accounts, we will lose track of what activity happened prior to April compared to what happens in April and beyond, making it impossible to prepare accurate financial statements for the next accounting period. In order to not confuse the transactions from the two different periods, the revenue, expense, and dividend accounts must be reset to zero before we start recording transactions for April. It is similar to resetting the scoreboard at the end of a game before you start a new game. Because we must keep the accounting equation in balance, we cannot just erase the balances in the revenue, expense, and dividend accounts because it would cause the equation to become unbalanced. To keep the accounting equation in balance and still be able to zero out these accounts, we will use closing entries. Closing entries are utilized to accomplish two things:

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem uses Target’s 2012 annual report to familiarize students with reading and interpreting financial statements in each chapter. By the end of the text, they have completely analyzed the financial statements.

1. Look at Target’s income statement. Is Target profitable? Does it have a positive net income or a negative net income (loss) for the year ending February 2, 2013? How does that compare with the year ending February 2, 2013? 2. Look at Target’s statement of shareholders’ investment. How does Target’s net income flow into its balance sheet? 3. Look at Target’s balance sheet. What assets does Target own? How much has Target invested in each type of assets and in total assets? 4. Look at Target’s balance sheet. How does Target finance its assets? How much liabilities and shareholders’ equity does Target have?

Temporary accounts The revenue, expense, and dividend accounts; these accounts are closed at the end of the accounting period.

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 24

117

• The revenue, expense, and dividend account balances from the current accounting period are set back to zero so accounting for the next period can begin. • The revenue, expense, and dividend account balances from the current accounting period are transferred into Retained Earnings so the accounting equation stays in balance. Transferring the revenue and expense account balances into Retained Earnings actually transfers the Net Income, or Net Loss, for the current period into Retained Earnings. Transferring the dividend account balance into Retained Earnings decreases Retained Earnings by the amount of dividends for the period. The revenue, expense, and dividend accounts are known as temporary accounts. They are called temporary because they are used temporarily to record activity for a specific period, the accounting period, and then they are closed into Retained Earnings. It is easy to remember the temporary accounts if you think of the color RED. The R in RED stands for revenues, the E stands for expenses, and the D stands for dividends. The RED accounts are closed at the end of each accounting period.

03/04/14 1:23 PM

S3-13. Preparing a post-closing trial balance (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min.

The April 30, 2014, adjusted trial balance of Steamed Sensation, Inc., is shown next.

After closing its accounts at July 31, 2014, Anderson Realty, Inc., had the following account balances:

Notes Payable .......................... Prepaid Rent ............................ Accounts Receivable ................ Prepaid Insurance .................... Accounts Payable..................... Equipment................................

$ 5,000 1,600 2,300 4,200 2,100 45,500

Cash......................................... Service Revenue ...................... Retained Earnings .................... Common Stock ........................ Salaries Expense ...................... Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment................................

Steamed Sensation, Inc. Adjusted Trial Balance April 30, 2014

$ 3,800 0 10,700 35,000 0

ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Prepaid Rent Supplies Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Unearned Service Revenue Salaries Payable Notes Payable Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Interest Revenue Salaries Expense Rent Expense Depreciation Expense, Equipment Utilities Expense Supplies Expense Total

4,600

Prepare Anderson Realty’s post-closing trial balance at July 31, 2014. List accounts in proper order.

0\$FFRXQWLQJ/DE

Exercises (Group A) E3-14A. Adjusting journal entries—unearned revenue and accrued revenue (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min.

DEBIT $ 4,200 7,000 2,700 250 36,000

CREDIT

$ 4,200 4,500 1,400 1,300 2,000 5,000 9,650 3,000 54,000

End of Chapter 50% of problems1,100 and exer22,700 cises (A and B sets) have been 5,200 revised.

Suppose you started up your own landscaping business. A customer paid you $170 in advance to mow his or her lawn while he or she was on vacation. You performed landscaping services for a local business, but the business hasn’t paid you the $440 fee yet. A customer pays you $215 cash for landscaping services. Answer the following questions about the correct way to account for your revenue under accrual-basis accounting: 1. Name the accounts used to record these events. 2. Prepare the journal entries to record the three transactions.

1,400 450 250 $83,150

$83,150

E3-15A. Adjusting journal entry—prepaid insurance (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Calculate the missing amounts for each of the following Prepaid Insurance situations. Quick solution: For situation A, journalize the adjusting entry. Consider each situation separately.

Situation Beginning Prepaid Insurance ................................... Payments for Prepaid Insurance during the year.......... Total amount to account for..................................... Ending Prepaid Insurance ........................................ Insurance Expense...................................................

A

B

C

$ 350 1,300 ? 300 $ ?

$ 800 ? ? 400 $1,300

? 2,200 3,600 ? $2,600

2. Calculate the ending balance in Retained Earnings. 3. Prepare a post-closing trial balance.

D

$ 700 ? 2,300 ? $1,400

Test Bank and Solutions Manual prepared byJournalize author, Jeffrey Waybright. the adjusting entries for the following adjustments at March 31, the end of the accounting period, omitting explanations. a. Employee salaries owed for Monday through Thursday of a five-day workweek, $4,300. c. Depreciation, $1,800.

1. Prepare the April closing entries for Steamed Sensation, Inc.

3. Trial balance totals = $50,150

E3-16A. Common adjusting journal entries (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min.

b. Unearned service revenue now earned, $840.

Requirements

2. Retained Earnings = $31,750

Problems (Group B) P3-48B. Common adjusting journal entries (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Journalize the adjusting entries needed at December 31, the end of the current accounting year, for each of the following independent cases affecting Mountain Mania, Inc. No other adjusting entries have been made for the year. a. Prior to making the adjusting entry on December 31, the balance in Prepaid Insurance is $1,200. Mountain Mania, Inc., pays liability insurance each year on April 30. b. Mountain Mania, Inc., pays employees each Friday. The amount of the weekly payroll is $12,500 for a five-day workweek. December 31, the fiscal year-end, is a Monday. c. Mountain Mania, Inc., received notes receivable from some customers for services provided. For the current year, accrued interest amounts to $640 and will be collected next year.

d. Prepaid rent expired, $950. e. Interest revenue accrued, $275.

NEW!

EXCEL® in MyAccountingLab • Now students can get real-world Excel practice in their classes. • Instructors have the option to assign students selected end-of-chapter questions that can be ­completed in an Excel-simulated environment. • Questions will be auto-graded and reported to and visible in the grade book. • Excel remediation will be available to students.

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 25

03/04/14 1:23 PM

26

Preface

Student and Instructor Resources MyAccountingLab

For Students myaccountinglab.com online Homework and Assessment Manager •  Pearson eText •  Data Files •  Videos •  Demo Docs •  Working Papers

• Audio and Student PowerPoint® Presentations •  Accounting Cycle Tutorial • MP3 Files with Chapter Objectives and Summaries •  Flash Cards

Student resource Web site: http://www.pearsonglobaleditions.com/kemp The book’s Web site contains the following: • Data Files: Select end-of-chapter problems have been set up in different software ­applications, including Excel, QuickBooks 2012, and General Ledger software. • Working Papers

MyAccountingLab

For Instructors myaccountinglab.com online Homework and Assessment Manager For the instructor’s convenience, the instructor resources can be downloaded from the textbook’s catalog page (http://www.pearsonglobaleditions.com/kemp) and MyAccountingLab. Available resources include the following: • Online Instructor’s Manual: Includes chapter summaries and the additional resources below: – Introduction to the Instructor’s Manual with a list of resources and a roadmap to help navigate what’s available in MyAccountingLab. – Instructor tips for teaching courses in multiple formats—traditional, hybrid, or online. – “First Day of Class” student handout that includes tips for success in the course, as well as an additional document that shows students how to register and log on to MyAccountingLab – Sample syllabi for 10- and 16-week courses. – Chapter overview and teaching outline that includes a brief synopsis and overview of each chapter. – Key topics that walk instructors through what material to cover and what examples to use when addressing certain items within the chapter. – Student chapter summary handout. – Assignment grid that outlines all end-of-chapter exercises and problems, the topic being covered in that particular exercise or problem, estimated completion time, level of difficulty, and availability in Excel templates. – Ten-minute quizzes that quickly assess students’ understanding of the chapter material. • Instructor’s Solutions Manual: Contains solutions to all end-of-chapter questions, including short exercises, exercises, and problems. • Test Bank: Includes more than 3,000 questions. Both objective-based questions and computational problems are available.

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 26

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Preface

27

• PowerPoint Presentations: These presentations help facilitate classroom discussion by demonstrating where the numbers come from and what they mean to the concept at hand. Includes NEW Demonstration Problem slides. – Instructor PowerPoint Presentations—complete with lecture notes – Student PowerPoint Presentations – Audio Narrated PowerPoint Presentations • Working Papers and Solutions in Excel and PDF Format. • Image Library. • Data and Solution Files: Select end-of-chapter problems have been set up in different software applications, including QuickBooks 2012 and General Ledger. Corresponding solution files are also provided.

http://www.pearsonglobaleditions.com/kemp

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 27

03/04/14 1:23 PM

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 28

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Acknowledgments Thank you to Mignon Tucker for all of her hard work and support, Jill Kolongowski for her dedication to the supplements, and Linda Hajek for her careful eye and in grateful appreciation to you, our colleagues and reviewers:

Reviewers The authors gratefully acknowledge the following reviewers of all editions of this text for their insightful comments and suggestions: Dawn Addington, Central New Mexico Community College Gary Adna, Ames Brigham Young University–Idaho Sheila Ammons, Austin Community College John Babich, Kankakee Community College Beverly Beatty, Anne Arundel Community College George Bernard, Seminole Community College Joseph Berry, Campbell University Swati Bhandarkar, University of Georgia Donald Bond, Texas Southern University Anna Boulware, St. Charles Community College Amy Bourne, Oregon State University Dr. Linda Bressler, University of Houston–Downtown Jerold Braun, Daytona State College Robert Braun, Southeastern Louisiana University Kathleen Brenan, Ashland University Molly Brown, James Madison University Nina Brown, Tarrant County College, Northwest Campus Ann K. Brooks, University of New Mexico Kelley Butler, Ivy Tech Community College Lafayette Marci L. Butterfield, University of Utah Ernest Carraway, North Carolina State University Sandra Cereola, James Madison University Dr. Joan A. Cezair, Fayetteville State University Yunhao Chen, Florida International University Bea Chiang, the College of New Jersey Leslie Cohen, University of Arizona Barry N. Cooper, Borough of Manhattan Community College (BMCC) Dori Danko, Grand Valley State University John Daugherty, Pitt Community College Vaun Day, Central Arizona College Patricia Doherty, Boston University School of Management Jimmy Dong, Sacramento City College Jap Efendi, University of Texas at Arlington Robert S Ellison, Texas State University–San Marcos

29

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 29

03/04/14 1:23 PM

30

Acknowledgments

Kim Everett, East Carolina University Janice Fergusson, University of South Carolina Patricia Feller, Nashville State Community College Richard Filler, Franklin University Calvin Fink, Bethune-Cookman University Philip Fink, University of Toledo Linda Flowers, Houston Community College Donald Foster, Tacoma Community College Brenda Fowler, Alamance Community College Donna Free, Oakland University Andy Garcia, Bowling Green State University Lisa Gillespie, Loyola University–Chicago Marina Grau, Houston Community College Ann Gregory, South Plains College Anthony Greig, Purdue University Michael Gurevitz, Montgomery College Patrick A. Haggerty, Lansing Community College Becky Hancock, El Paso Community College Bowe Hansen, University of New Hampshire Jerry W. Hanwell, Robert Morris University Rob Hochschild, Ivy Tech Community College Marsha Huber, Youngstown State University Carol Hutchinson, AB Tech Frank Ilett, Boise State University Janice Klimek, University of Central Missouri Jerry Kreuze, Western Michigan University Ron Lazer, University of Houston Patsy Lee, University of Texas at Arlington Patti Lopez, Valencia Community College Donald Lucy, Indian River State College Lois S. Mahoney, Eastern Michigan University Diane Marker, University of Toledo Jim Martin, Washburn University Michele Martinez, Hillsborough Community College Suzanne McCaffrey, University of Mississippi Bruce McClain, Cleveland State University Florence McGovern, Bergen Community College Heidi H. Meier, Cleveland State University Terri Meta, Seminole Community College Jeanine Metzler, Northampton Community College Melanie Middlemist, Colorado State University Susan Minke, Indiana Purdue University at Ft Wayne Birendra Mishra, University of California Riverside Earl Mitchell, Santa Ana College Carol A. Murphy, Quinsigamond Community College Khursheed Omer, University of Houston–Downtown Deborah Pauly, Loras College Sandra Pelfrey, Oakland University Stanley M. Quon, Sacramento City College Allan M Rabinowitz, Pace University Judy Ramage, Lawrence Christian Brothers University Rama Ramamurthy, College of William & Mary Nancy Rochman, University of Arizona Patrick Rogan, Cosumnes River College Miles Romney, University of San Diego

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 30

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Acknowledgments

31

Louis Rosamilia, Hudson Valley Community College Christine Schalow, University of Wisconsin–Stevens Point Tracy Schmeltzer, Wayne Community College Randy Serrett, University of Houston–Downtown Sheila Shain, Santa Ana College Carol Shaver, Louisiana Tech University Margaret L. Shelton, University of Houston–Downtown Lily Sieux, California State University East Bay Joanie Sompayrac, UT–Chattanooga Nancy Snow, University of Toledo Dennis Spector, Naugatuck Valley Community College Barbara Squires, Corning Community College Rick Street, Spokane Community College Joe Standridge, Sonoma State University Dennis Stovall, Grand Valley State University Gloria Stuart, Georgia Southern University Gracelyn Stuart-Tuggle, Palm Beach State College Karen Sturm, Loras College Ellen L. Sweatt, Georgia Perimeter College Jan Sweeney, Baruch College CUNY William Talbot, Montgomery College Pavani Tallapally, Slippery Rock University Samantha Ternes, Kirkwood Community College Peter Theuri, Northern Kentucky University Steven Thoede, Texas State University–San Marcos Robin E. Thomas, North Carolina State University Jack Topiol, Community College of Philadelphia Jinhee Trone, Santa Ana College John Trussel, University of West Florida Terri Walsh, Seminole State College of Florida Suzanne Ward, University of Louisiana at Lafayette Marvin Williams, University of Houston–Downtown Jan Workman, East Carolina University Christian Wurst Jr., Temple University James Yang, Montclair State University Laura Young, University of Central Arkansas Judith Zander, Grossmont College

Supplements Authors and Reviewers Courtney Baillie, Nebraska Wesleyan University Cheryl Bartlett, Central New Mexico Community College Michelle Berube, Corinthian Colleges Nabanita Bhattacharya, Northwest Florida State College Robert Braun, Southern Louisiana University Laurie Hays, Western Michigan University Dr. Anna Lusher, Slippery Rock University School of Business Michelle Maggio, Westfield State College Donna Mallery, Florida State College at Jacksonville, Kent Campus Sucharita Mandal, ansrsource Diane Marker, University of Toledo Jamie McCracken, Saint Mary-of-the-Woods College Allan Sheets, International Business College Ferdinand Siagian, Minnesota State University Rick Street, Spokane Community College

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 31

03/04/14 1:23 PM

32

Acknowledgments

Samantha Ternes, Kirkwood Community College Nagaraj VL, ansrsource Judith Zander, Grossmont College Bob Kemp and Jeffrey Waybright would especially like to thank the individuals below for their support and guidance throughout the project: Lacey Vitetta Alison Haskins Karen Kirincich Roberta Sherman Jeff Holcomb Anthony Gemmellaro Jill Kolongowski Michele Somody Mignon Tucker, Brava 360° Solutions Pearson would like to thank and acknowledge the following people for their work on the Global Edition:

Contributor Mohammad El Hajj, University Institute of Technology, Lebanese University

Reviewers Jeff Ng, The Chinese University of Hong Kong Travis Christensen, SolBridge International School of Business Prantik Ray, XLRI

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 32

03/04/14 1:23 PM

Financial Accounting

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 33

03/04/14 1:23 PM

A01_KEMP9543_03_GE_FM.indd 34

03/04/14 1:23 PM

1 Business, Accounting, and You Business, Accounting, and You You are about to study accounting. What is accounting, and why is it so important? Why does the study of business typically start with accounting? Accounting is the language of business. Can you think of living in a foreign country and not being able to read and speak the native language? It would be very hard. Accounting is the process business people use to communicate what they’ve been doing. To be successful in business, you need to be able to understand, speak, and use the language of business. In addition to being the language of business, accounting is the scorekeeping aspect of business. Think of the last sporting event you watched or played in. Can you imagine the end of the game without someone saying who scored, when they scored, and even how they scored? Accounting lets business managers know if they are winning or losing.

Learning Objectives 1 Understand the nature of business and the role of ­accounting in business

2 Know how a business operates

3 Know the different types and forms of businesses

4 Know the key accounting principles and concepts

5 Know how accounting functions in a business

6 Understand and be able to prepare basic financial statements

35

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 35

03/04/14 1:32 PM

36

Chapter 1

Accounting is at the heart of business. Whether you become an accountant or a business manager, understanding the foundation and process of accounting is critical to your success. If you are to be successful in business, your success starts with accounting. At the beginning of each chapter in the section Business, Accounting, and You, we will focus on how accounting keeps track of a business’s transactions and helps you, as a manager, make good business decisions.

Real World Accounting Video In the Real World Accounting Video, David Hitchner, owner and manager of ABC Wine, talks about what it means to own and operate a business. Look at the video. Think about what David is saying. And then realize how important accounting is to the success of a business.

What Is a Business, and Why Study Accounting? 1

Understand the nature of business and the role of accounting in business

Accounting  Accounting is the process of recognizing, measuring, recording, and reporting information about a business’s transactions.

You want to be successful in business. But why study accounting? The answer is what accounting reveals. Accounting is the process of recognizing, measuring, recording, and reporting information about a business’s transactions. Understanding accounting enables you to recognize and understand business transactions. Understanding business transactions enables you to manage them successfully. Think about going to a sporting event where you know nothing about the sport. You would probably have many questions. Your questions might include: • • • •

What is the objective of this sport? Who are the players, and what are they doing to compete? How do players win or lose the competition? Who keeps score, and how is the score kept?

Business is a competition. Businesses compete for customers, employees, profits, and much more. To successfully compete in business you need to understand the objective of business, the players and their roles in business, the rules of business, and who keeps score and how it is kept. If accounting is the scorekeeper of business, let’s first talk about the game of business. When you look at business, you see people and organizations creating, producing, and selling products. Businesses, both for-profit and not-for-profit businesses, are everywhere. But have you ever stopped and thought about business? Think about it. What is a business? Why does a business exist? How does a business operate? Business  A business is a legal organization that attempts to create value by exchanging products with customers for money.

The Definition of a Business

Product  A good or service ­purchased or produced by a business to be sold.

1. Businesses are legal entities. Businesses are empowered to operate by the law.

Goods  A good is a physical item that can be touched and felt. Goods are tangible.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 36

A business is a legal organization that attempts to create value by exchanging products with customers for money. An organization must have three elements to be called a business: 2. A business must exchange a product, often referred to as either a good or a ­service, for money or money substitutes. a. Goods are physical items that we can touch and feel. Goods are ­tangible. Examples include food, cars, and clothing.

03/04/14 1:32 PM

Business, Accounting, and You Services  A service is an activity that exists but cannot be touched and felt. Services are intangible.

Customer  A person or organization that purchases a product from a business. Sale  The exchange between a ­business and customer where the business provides a customer a ­product and the business receives money or money substitutes.

37

b. Services are activities that we know exist but we cannot touch and feel. Services are intangible. Examples include medical services, car repairs, and education. However, providing products is not sufficient criteria for a business to be called a business. Someone must buy these products for money or money substitutes (for example, a receivable or promise to pay later). So who buys the products for money or money substitutes? The answer is c ­ ustomers. To succeed, a business must create an exchange with a customer. The ­exchange is called a sale. 3. Businesses create value.  Customers get value from the benefits of a product. However, the other stakeholders in a business should also receive value. Owners get value from the profits a business earns. Employees get value from their wages. Lenders get value from the interest they charge. The purpose of any business is to create and increase value. In a for-profit business, this value is often measured as the market price of the business, or what you’d pay if you wanted to buy and own the business.1 All too often people assume that a business exists to create products, sales, profits, and jobs. All these things are important; however, the purpose of a business is to create value. So what is value? What determines value? How does value differ from profit?

The General Concept of Value Value  The price someone is willing to pay for an item.

The value of an item is what someone is willing to pay for it. As such, value depends on: 1. What the owner of an item expects to receive. 2. When the owner expects to receive it. 3. How certain the owner is about what he or she will receive and when it will be received.

Cost  The amount of money or money substitutes that a business pays to receive an item used in operating a business. Revenue  The amount of money or money substitutes that a business ­receives from the sale of a product. Profit  The revenue from a sale less the cost of the sale.

For example, imagine you plan to cook a very special dinner tonight with a very special person. You need groceries. Where do you go? You think of a grocery store such as Kroger. It’s late in the day, and you need food now. You are certain that Kroger will have the food you want and need. So what are you doing? You are entering into an exchange with Kroger. Kroger will provide you food and you will pay Kroger money. When we go to make an exchange, we seek an exchange where the value we receive exceeds the value that we give up. In other words, we want a “good deal.” In the Kroger example, you go to the store and ask the grocer how much you would pay for its food. If you believe the value of Kroger’s food is greater than the value of the money you must pay, you agree to the exchange. If you believe the value of Kroger’s food is less than the value of the money you must pay, you keep your money and do not agree to the exchange. You’re basically comparing the value of the food and the value of the money, seeking the greatest value for yourself. Businesses behave in the same way. A business attempts to create value by exchanging a product with a customer. Businesses buy or make products at one value (cost) and try to sell these products to their customers at a higher value (revenue). This exchange creates a profit (net benefit) to the business. An example of this is Kroger’s grocery business. If done well, Kroger makes a profit by paying less for the food (cost) than it charges you for the food (revenue). Making a profit is very important in a for-profit business and

1

For-profit businesses attempt to earn a profit. The concept of profit is discussed later. Examples of for-profit ­ usinesses are Target, Southwest Airlines, and many smaller businesses in your community. Not-for-profit b ­businesses attempt to break even, neither experiencing a profit or loss. Examples of not-for-profit businesses are charities, ­government, and religious organizations. This text will focus on for-profit businesses. However, many of the concepts discussed are applicable to not-for-profit businesses.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 37

03/04/14 1:32 PM

38

Chapter 1

drives the value of the business. Accountants are responsible for measuring revenue, costs, and profits.

Revenue Cost Profit

Risk  Risk is the uncertainty that could result in an outcome not desired.

Loss  A loss is a negative profit, which occurs when the cost of a sale is greater than the revenue from the sale.

In addition to the amount of profit, businesspeople also worry about when they make a profit and the risk they take to generate a profit. As we’ll see in later chapters, the old adage that “time is money” is true. Time does affect the value of an item. The quicker a business like Kroger earns a profit, the more valuable it is. The longer a business takes to earn a profit, the less valuable it is. Think about it. Would you pay extra to have Kroger prepare your special meal? The answer is probably yes, given that it is late in the day. As we’ll see throughout the book, accountants worry about when to recognize business transactions such as revenue, cost, and profit. Risk is also important. Risk is the uncertainty that an outcome we do not expect or desire could result. An example is Kroger’s success. Do the owners of Kroger know that their business will succeed? The answer is they hope and believe Kroger will s­ ucceed but are not certain of its success. Think about Kroger’s grocery business. What happens if you and others do not buy Kroger’s food? Kroger incurs a loss, where revenue is less than cost. If Kroger continues to lose money, it will fail. Risk hurts value. Businesspeople must recognize, understand, measure, and manage risk. To compensate for taking a risk, businesses expect higher profits. Accountants help managers and other decision makers understand risk with accounting information. An example of such accounting information is whether a business can pay its debts on time or at all. In every chapter, specifically in Chapter 12, Financial Statement Analysis, we’ll see how accounting information helps managers and other stakeholders understand risk.

Business Owners and Other Stakeholders Stakeholder  A stakeholder is a person or organization that is affected by a business.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 38

A business has many stakeholders, or people and organizations that are affected by a business. These stakeholders include customers, employees, suppliers, regulators, society, lenders, and owners. All stakeholders are important. All stakeholders should believe that they are receiving value from the business. In other words, each of the stakeholders in a business gives and receives value through an exchange. Ideally, each stakeholder believes that the value he or she receives exceeds the value he or she gives up. An employee gives a business his or her labor for a paycheck. A supplier sells products to a business, ideally at a profit. A customer buys a product from a business at a price. Society, and regulators appointed by society, benefit from a business through jobs, taxes, and hopefully a better quality of life. In a free-market economy, all stakeholders are free to enter into an exchange, are important, and should not be taken for granted. However, the providers of money are free to provide their money as they deem ­appropriate. Nobody forces a bank to make a loan to a business. Nobody forces an owner to put money in a business. There is an old saying that goes “It takes money to make money.” What that means is it takes money to form and operate a business. To attract that money, lenders and owners must believe they will receive value greater than they give.

03/04/14 1:32 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

39

The Goal of a Business The goal of a business is to create value for its owners. Owners expect a profit that compensates them for the use of their money over time and for the risk they assume. If the business does not create value, owners will not provide the money needed to operate the business. Without the business, customers, suppliers, employees, and society will not ­receive the value they seek. A business must create value for its owners. However, to do so, owners must appreciate that the other stakeholders must also receive value. So if the objective of the firm is to create value, and we need to focus on creating value for owners, how does a business create value for its owners? How does a business generate profits, over time, at risk?

How Does a Business Operate? 2

Know how a business operates

Operating a business is not simple or easy. It takes a lot of resources. It also takes the ability to use those resources wisely. So what are the resources a business needs, and how does a business use those resources to generate profits, over time and at risk?

Resources Needed to Start and Operate a Business To operate, businesses need to acquire money and use that money to make a profit. A firm acquires money by: Liabilities  A liability is an amount owed to a lender or other creditor. Stockholders’ equity  Money provided to the business by owners either through an initial investment or the retention of profits, also known as owners’ equity.

Asset  An economic resource that a business owns and can use to operate the business. Employees  People, hired by a business, for a period of time to ­operate the business. Expense  Money or other value surrendered due to the sale of goods or services or the operating of the business. Interest  The expense of using ­borrowed money for a period of time. Net income  Operating profit less interest expense, computed as ­revenue, less operating expenses, less interest expense.

1. Borrowing money from lenders (called liabilities). 2. Getting owners to put in their money (called owners’ or stockholders’ ­equity) in exchange for a percentage of ownership. A liability is a financial claim, or debt, that the business owes to a party that is not an owner of the business. Owners’ equity represents money provided to the business by owners, either through an initial investment or the retention of profits. Often people will say the owners invested their money in the business.

Operating the Business A business then uses the money to acquire assets and hire people. An asset is an economic resource that a business owns and can use to operate the business. Assets include cash, inventory, and buildings. The business also hires people, called employees, to operate the business for a period of time. With the assets and employees, the business operates in hope of generating a profit, where revenue is greater than expenses. Remember, revenue is money or other value ­received that a business earns from the sale of goods or services. Expenses, often ­referred to as costs, are money or other value surrendered from the operating of the business. Part of operating the business is making sure lenders are paid interest. Interest is the expense of using borrowed money for a period of time. After paying interest and other expenses, the owners of the business get what remains, referred to as profit or net income. Net income is revenue, less expenses (including interest expense).2

Net Income  Revenue  Expenses

2

A business must also pay taxes. Taxes are an expense that will be explored later in this book. Net income is what is left after a business recognizes its tax expense and other expenses.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 39

03/04/14 1:32 PM

40

Chapter 1

The question that owners must ask is whether the net income is worth the time and risk involved. Owners have many alternative uses for their money. They, like everyone else, seek the greatest value or return on their money. Let’s look at a simple example. You start a computer repair business. You invest $1,000 in your business, which will be used to start the business and is called owner’s equity. You ­expect net income of $100, or a 10% return on your money ($100/$1000). However, you need $2,000 to start your business. You need equipment and other assets that cost you $2,000. So you go to a bank and ask to borrow $1,000 for one year. The bank looks at your loan ­application and agrees to lend you $1,000. However, for the time and risk associated with your loan, the bank requires you to pay simple interest of 6%. Thus, in one year you are ­required to repay the $1,000 loan plus $60 (6%) interest, or a total of $1,060. You borrow the $1,000 from the bank, combine it with your $1,000 ­equity, and start your business. After one year, you close and liquidate the business. You are proud of your business ­because you have worked hard. You had revenue of $500, expenses such as supplies and rent of $400, and interest expense of $60 (6% × $1,000). You made net income of $40 ($500  –  $400  –  $60 = $40). The revenue from these sales exceeded the expenses by $40. How do you feel? Net income of $40 is good, but is it good enough? Would you have invested your $1,000 in the business if you thought you would only earn net income of $40?

The Cost of Money Creating value is more than just generating net income by selling a product. Money has a cost. Businesses get money by borrowing it or having owners provide it. If a business ­borrows money, it must pay the lender rent on the money, called interest. It must also ­return the borrowed money at an agreed-upon time in the future. However, owners’ money also has a cost. Owners are not going to provide their money without expecting to receive a benefit, or return, over time. Why should they? Why would an owner put money in a business for no return when they could deposit their money in a bank and earn interest? Never forget that money, whether borrowed or provided by owners, has a cost. The cost of the money is dependent on many things, but above all else is a function of the risk the lender or owner is taking. Remember, great risk must be compensated by great return. We just learned that a business first acquires money from lenders (liabilities) and owners (equity). Lenders require the business to pay interest plus return the money they borrow. Owners expect to receive a benefit or return. This benefit or return is based on net income. Then a business uses the money to hire employees and acquire assets. Next, the employees use the assets to generate net income. If successful, the net income is equal to or exceeds the net income expected by owners. When it does, value for the owners is created. When it does not, value for the owners is destroyed.

How Are Businesses Organized? 3

Know the different types and forms of businesses

There are many types and forms of business organizations. The type of business relates to what it does to create value or, in other words, make a profit. The form of business organization relates to how it is legally organized.

The Types of Businesses

For-profit business  A business that attempts to create an exchange, or sale, where revenue exceeds ­expenses, creating a profit.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 40

Businesses are typically divided into two broad categories, for-profit businesses and notfor-profit businesses. In this book, we’ll focus on for-profit businesses that operate as corporations. • For-profit businesses attempt to create an exchange or sale where revenue exceeds expenses, creating a profit. Examples of for-profit businesses are Kroger, Facebook, Ford, Walmart, and Apple.

03/04/14 1:32 PM

Business, Accounting, and You Not-for-profit business  A business that attempts to create an exchange or sale where revenue equals costs. Service business  A business that sells a service to its customers. Merchandise business  A ­business that sells physical goods or products to its customers. Manufacturing business  A business that produces the physical goods that it sells to its customers. Wholesale business  A business that sells products to other businesses for resale. Retail business  A business that sells products to the final consumer of the product.

41

• Not-for-profit businesses attempt to create an exchange or sale where revenue equals costs. Examples of not-for-profit businesses are charities like The Red Cross or Habitat for Humanity, religious organizations, and governments. Although ­not-for-profit businesses are not the focus of this book, many of the principles and techniques discussed in this book also apply to not-for-profit businesses. Within these two broad categories of business, there are three types of businesses: ­service businesses, merchandising businesses, and manufacturing businesses. • A service business sells services to its customers. In other words, what it sells is time. Common types of service businesses include law firms, accounting firms, physical therapy offices, painting companies, and automotive repair shops. • A merchandise business sells physical goods or products to its customers. Common types of merchandise businesses include grocery stores, automobile dealerships, and sporting goods stores. A merchandise business may be either a wholesale business or a retail business. A wholesale business is a business that sells products to other businesses for resale. The business that sells food products to a grocery store is an ­example of a wholesale business. A retail business is a business that sells products to the final consumer of the product. Target, Macy’s, and Kroger are examples of retail businesses. • A manufacturing business produces the physical goods that it sells to its customers. Common types of manufacturing businesses include automobile manufacturers, the makers of clothing, and soft drink manufacturers.

The Legal Forms of Businesses A business can be legally organized as a sole proprietorship, partnership, corporation, or limited liability company. Most businesses in the United States are sole proprietorships. However, most business transactions are conducted in and among corporations. Why? The answer is most large businesses like Kroger, Facebook, Ford, Apple, and Target are corporations. But how do you know what type of business organization is best for your business? Sole proprietorship  A business entity that has one owner, where, for legal and tax purposes, the business and the owner are considered the same. Partnership  A business that has more than one owner, where, for legal and tax purposes, the business and the owners are considered the same.

Corporation  A legal entity, ­chartered under state law, that is empowered to conduct business. The corporation and owners are ­considered as separate for legal and tax purposes.

Stockholder  An owner of part of a corporation. Dividend  The payment of past and current profits, less losses, previously retained in the business.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 41

• A sole proprietorship is a business entity that has one owner. For legal purposes and for tax purposes, the business and the owner are considered the same. The business owner is personally responsible or liable for all of the debts and obligations of the business. If somebody wants to sue the business, he or she would have to sue the owner. In addition, all of the income or loss generated by the business is reported on the owner’s personal tax return and taxed at individual rates. • A partnership is very similar to a sole proprietorship except that it has two or more owners. For legal purposes, the owners (partners) and the business are ­considered the same. If somebody sues the business, he or she would need to sue the b ­ usiness owners. For tax purposes, the partners divide all of the income or loss of the ­partnership and report it on their personal tax returns. Therefore, it is taxed at individual tax rates just like a sole proprietorship. • A corporation differs from a sole proprietorship or a partnership because it is a separate legal entity from the owners. The business is incorporated under the laws of a state. When you see the abbreviation “Corp.” for “Corporation” or “Inc.” for “Incorporated,” the business is a corporation. The owners of a corporation and the corporation itself are considered as separate under the law. This legal separation is very attractive to the business owners because it limits their personal liability to what they have invested in the corporation. The corporation’s debts and obligations are not the debts and obligations of the owners. For tax purposes, the corporation is taxed as a separate entity from the owners. Therefore, income tax is imposed on the income of the corporation at corporate tax rates. If the business chooses to pay owners, called stockholders, any of the current or past net income, the business will pay a dividend. Stockholders must pay a tax on the dividends they receive. In effect, the income is taxed twice, double taxing the business owners. Many business

03/04/14 1:32 PM

42

Chapter 1

S-corporation  A small ­corporation that has met the legal ­requirements to act as a corporation but elected to be taxed at individual rates. Limited liability company  A hybrid business entity having ­characteristics of both a corporation and a partnership.

owners desire to have the legal protection that the corporate form of organization offers. Owners can only lose what they have invested. They thus have limited liability. But they do not want to be subject to the “double taxation” that also occurs. Owners of small corporations are able to make an S-corporation election, which allows them to have limited liability and be taxed at individual rates, eliminating the double taxation. • A limited liability company is a relatively new form of business organization. When you see the letters “LLC,” the business is a limited liability company. The owners of a limited liability company enjoy the same legal separation that a ­corporation provides. For tax purposes, a limited liability company’s income is treated ­similar to a sole proprietorship or a partnership. All of the income of the limited liability company is divided among the owners and is taxed at their personal rates. In many ways, a limited liability company is similar to an S-corporation. However, unlike an S-corporation, a limited liability company can be very flexible in how it distributes earnings among the owners. Exhibit 1-1 summarizes the different types of business organizations.

Type of Business

Legal Status

Tax Status

Benefits

Drawbacks

Sole Proprietorship

Business and owner are considered to be the same entity

Business income is allocated to the owner and taxed at owner’s personal tax rate

• Ease of formation • No double taxation

• Unlimited liability of owner • Difficult to raise capital • Limited life

Partnership

Business and owners are considered to be the same entity

Business income is allocated to the owners and taxed at owners’ personal tax rates

• Ease of formation • No double taxation • Shared investment/knowledge

• Unlimited liability of owners • Disagreements between partners • Limited life

Corporation

Business and owners are considered to be separate entities

Business income is taxed at corporate tax rates. Any income distributed to the owners is also taxed at owners’ personal tax rates. Also referred to as a C-corporation.

• Limited liability of owners • Easier to raise capital • Unlimited life

• More difficult and costly to form • Double taxation • More paperwork • More regulations

S-corporation

Business and owners are considered to be separate entities

Business income is allocated to the owners and taxed at owners’ personal tax rates

• Limited liability of owners • No double taxation • Easier to raise capital • Unlimited life

• More difficult and costly to form • More paperwork • More regulations

Limited Liability Company

Business and owners are considered to be separate entities

Business income is allocated to the owners and taxed at owners’ personal tax rates

• Limited liability of owners • No double taxation • More flexibility than with S-corporation

• More difficult and costly to form • Limited life

Exhibit 1-1 Although the process of accounting for the different types of business organizations is similar, there are slight variations depending on the type of organization. In this book, we will focus our attention on accounting for corporations.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 42

03/04/14 1:32 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

43

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analyze

What form of business organization should be chosen?

There are many ways to organize a business including the following: a sole proprietorship, partnership, corporation or S-corporation, or limited liability company. Each type of business organization has different advantages and disadvantages.

Know the tax and legal treatments of each type of organization. Weigh the best treatment of taxes and legal liability of each type, and pick the format that is most advantageous for the business owners.

What Is Accounting, and What Are the Key Accounting Principles and Concepts? 4

Know the key accounting principles and concepts

Financial accounting  The process of recognizing, measuring, recording, and reporting information about a business’s transactions to stakeholders outside the business, including stockholders (owners) and lenders.

Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP)  The rules, principles, and concepts established by the accounting profession that govern financial accounting. Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB)  A seven-person group primarily ­responsible for the establishment of standards of financial accounting and reporting called GAAP.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 43

Have you noticed how many kids play little league sports these days and wondered why so many kids compete in these sports? Some kids play to get into better shape and some kids play just for the fun, but most kids play because they want to win. If you think about it, we live in a very competitive world. This competitiveness makes the job of the scorekeeper very important because, without the scorekeeper, nobody would know which team won the contest. In addition to keeping track of who wins, the scorekeeper in an athletic contest tracks many other statistics that help the coach and the players judge individual performances. The world of business is very much like little league sports. Businesses exist to win, which is usually defined as generating profits and creating value. Financial accounting is the process of recognizing, measuring, recording, and reporting information about a business’s transactions to stakeholders outside the business. Outside stakeholders include stockholders (owners) and lenders. So what does it take to make a business “win” and create value? It takes many hardworking people performing the functions of the business. It takes people developing great products (for example, the research and development group or department); making great products (for example, the production or operations group or department); promoting, selling, and distributing products (for example, the sales and marketing group or department); and acquiring money (for example, the finance department). But it also takes people providing information about the business’s financial condition and operations. Businesses run on information, and accounting is at the heart of providing useful information. In essence, accountants are the scorekeepers in the business world.

Generally Accepted Accounting Principles In sports there are established rules and principles that dictate how each game is to be played and how the score is to be kept. In the same way, the accounting profession has created a set of rules and principles that must be followed. This set of rules is codified and called Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP). In the United States, financial accounting must follow GAAP, which is the rules, principles, and concepts established by the accounting profession that govern financial accounting. GAAP helps existing and potential owners and creditors compare different companies. In the US, most GAAP is developed by the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB). The FASB is a seven-person group primarily responsible for the establishment of GAAP. The main objective of financial accounting is to provide

03/04/14 1:32 PM

44

Chapter 1

information useful for owners and lenders. To be useful, information must be understandable, relevant, and reliable; GAAP tries to ensure that accounting information ­follows these principles.

International Financial Reporting Standards

International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS)  Accounting standards developed by the International Accounting Standards Board for use throughout the world.

The globalization of business means that companies outside the US are not required to follow US GAAP. Therefore, what principles do companies based outside the United States follow to ensure the reliability of accounting information to investors and other stakeholders? International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) are accounting standards that are developed by the International Accounting Standards Board. IFRS were originally followed by businesses located in countries that did not have their own accounting standards. However, many countries that have their own accounting standards have started to allow the use of IFRS in addition to, or instead of, their own standards. The United States is currently considering a switch from US GAAP to IFRS. However, because the adoption of IFRS by the United States is not certain and in any event would be years away, this book will focus on US GAAP. Chapter 6 has a more ­in-depth discussion of IFRS.

The Business Entity Principle Business entity principle  The business entity principle dictates that the financial affairs of a business ­organization must be kept separate from the personal financial affairs of the business owners.

The most basic concept in accounting is that of the business entity principle. The business entity principle dictates that the financial affairs of a business organization must be kept separate from the personal financial affairs of the business owners. This separation is necessary because, if the owners of a business choose to place personal assets into the business, then those assets are now considered to belong to the business and no longer to the owners. For example, if a business owner invests a used car into his or her business, that car should no longer be used by the business owner for personal purposes.

The Reliability (Objectivity) Principle Reliability principle  Information should be verifiable, confirmable by any independent observer; also called objectivity principle.

The reliability (or objectivity) principle requires that the accounting information for a business be arrived at objectively so it may be relied upon by outside users. The information should be independently verifiable. For example, a company’s checking account is supported by a statement from the bank. This statement provides objective evidence that the account exists. Without the reliability principle, accounting information might be based on what people think or feel it should be, rather than what it really is. This would make it easier to manipulate the information for fraudulent purposes.

The Cost Principle Cost principle  The cost principle states that when a business acquires assets or services, they should be ­recorded at their actual cost, also called historical cost. Actual cost  Actual cost of assets and services acquired, also referred to as historical cost.

The cost principle states that when a business acquires assets or services, they should be recorded at their actual cost, also called historical cost. In other words, the amount paid for the asset or service is the amount recorded as its value. Other values, such as market value and appraised value, are not used even if they are known at the time of the purchase. The cost principle also requires that the accounting records keep the historical cost of an asset throughout its useful life because this cost is a reliable measure.

Accounting Ethics: A Matter of Trust Accountants are important. Accountants have considerable responsibility and, thus, power. They must worry about providing information that is understandable, relevant, and reliable. Stakeholders use the information provided by accountants to make very serious

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 44

03/04/14 1:32 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

45

business decisions. Accountants must be trustworthy and perform their a­ ccounting duties in accordance with high ethical standards. They must provide clear and ­complete information, not manipulate the financial information so as to mislead stakeholders, and make their best efforts to prevent fraud. Think about a sports event. Who do you ask to be the scorekeeper? First, you figure out who understands how the game is played. From that group, you ask the most trustworthy person available to keep score. Business is the same. Accountants must be knowledgeable, but they must also be trustworthy. In Chapter 6, we’ll explore the challenges faced by the accounting profession, including ethics.

Accounting in Your World How would you respond to the following situations?

•  The company CEO asks you to falsify the company’s a­ ccounting records. He or she says that the company cannot afford to report that it is performing poorly. If it does, some stores will likely have to be closed and people will lose their jobs. The CEO implies that if you are not a “team player” and fail to falsify the records, then it will be your fault these people are unemployed.

• At the end of the month, your supervisor asks you to create fictitious sales invoices. He or she tells you that your department is just a little bit shy of reaching the sales goal necessary for each member of the department to receive a quarterly bonus. Your supervisor says that you can just delete the fictitious sales at the beginning of the next month and that no one will ever know.

•  A coworker confides that he or she has stolen several MP3 players from the store at which you work. Your c­ oworker offers to give you one of the players. He or she says that you both deserve it for all of the long hours you have worked for the company lately. You may find yourself faced with an ethical dilemma at any time during your career. You only have one chance to make the right decision.

What Is the Role of Accounting in a Business? 5

Know how accounting functions in a business

Remember our sports analogy where accounting is the “scorekeeper” of business? Accountants must: • • • •

Recognize business transactions. Measure business transactions. Record business transactions. Report business transactions over a period of time.

Now, we will look more closely at what those scorekeeping activities are and how they are done.

Recognize

Measure

Record

Report

The Roles of Accounting in Business

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 45

03/04/14 1:32 PM

46

Chapter 1

How Do You Recognize a Business Transaction? Accountants must first recognize a business transaction. This may appear easy, but often it is not. Let’s look at an example. You own a computer repair store. A customer brings in a computer for repair. Is this a sale that generates revenue? The customer promises to pay you $100 when you complete the repair. However, you have not repaired the customer’s computer. There is no exchange. You have not earned the revenue yet. The customer’s order is an important event, but it is not a completed business transaction. Thus the accountant will wait to recognize this as revenue until you repair the customer’s computer and earn the revenue. Let’s look at another example using a computer repair store. You repair the customer’s computer. You have completed your part of the transaction. But you have an agreement with your customer that he or she does not have to pay you for 30 days. In other words, you exchanged your repair service for the customer’s promise to pay you $100 in 30 days. You have exchanged your repair service for a receivable. Is this $100 revenue when you repaired the customer’s computer? Do we wait until you receive the $100 cash before we recognize the revenue?

Cash Accounting Cash accounting  Accounting that only recognizes business transactions when cash is received or disbursed.

Cash accounting only recognizes a business transaction when cash is received or disbursed. If your computer repair store used cash accounting, you would not recognize the revenue until you received the cash. However, most businesses do not use cash accounting. Most businesses, in accordance with GAAP, use accrual accounting.

Accrual Accounting Accrual accounting  Accounting that recognizes a business transaction when it occurs, whether or not cash is received or disbursed.

Accrual accounting recognizes a business transaction when it occurs, whether or not cash is received or disbursed. Using accrual accounting, your computer repair store would recognize the revenue when you repaired the customer’s computer. You repaired the computer and were paid with a promise for the services performed. You now have money owed to you from the customer. You have completed a business transaction. When the customer pays you the $100, you would recognize another transaction where you now have $100 cash and no promise of future money. Understanding when a business receives and disburses cash is very important. A business must be able to manage its cash flow in order to pay its bills and survive. However, waiting to recognize a business transaction until cash is received or paid can deny stakeholders very important information. An example is a liability. Just because a business has not paid a bill does not mean it does not owe it. Stakeholders want to know what a business owes now and must pay in the future. For that reason, businesses typically use accrual accounting. However, as noted later, accountants also provide users information about where a business gets and uses its cash.

How Do You Measure a Business Transaction? After recognizing a business transaction, the accountant must then measure the transaction. This process presents several challenges. Let’s return to our example of your computer repair store. You repaired your ­customer’s computer, and he or she now owes you $100. Will you collect $100? You may not collect the $100. Based on prior experience, you may believe that you will only ­collect 90% of the money, or $90. You estimate that you will not collect, and thus lose, $10 of the sale. Do you disclose that you are owed $100 or expect to receive $90? Under

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 46

03/04/14 1:32 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

47

US GAAP, you would estimate that you will lose $10 and your claim on your customer is only worth $90. Measuring transactions using accrual accounting requires the accountant to make estimates. These estimates may need to be adjusted over time. Let’s look at another example. You bought a building to house your computer repair store. The building cost you $100,000 five years ago. You still own and use the building, but the building was recently appraised to have a value of $200,000. Your wealth has increased by $100,000 because your building appreciated from $100,000 to $200,000 in value. But do accountants recognize this increase in value? The GAAP used in the United States would not. Why? Because US GAAP is conservative, it requires a sale of the building to recognize that it is now worth more than when you bought it. US GAAP is based on historical cost and is designed not to overstate the value of assets. However, accounting rules in other countries may be different from US GAAP. They may recognize that your building’s value has increased even without a sale. Such rules are based on current or market values for assets. IFRS is a set of accounting rules that uses current or market values. In this book, we’ll focus on US GAAP. However, in other chapters, particularly Chapter 6, we’ll look at how different countries can have different accounting rules. This coverage in other chapters will be denoted by the icon at left.

How Do You Record Business Transactions Using the Accounting Equation?

Fundamental accounting equation  The equation that states that total assets equal the sum of total liabilities and total stockholders’ equity.

Accounting is the process of recognizing, measuring, recording, and reporting information about a business’s transactions. But what is the process or method used by accountants? After business transactions are recognized and measured, how do accountants record the business transactions? Remember, the accountant’s job is really the job of being the scorekeeper for the business. The accountant needs to keep track of information so he or she can tell people about the operations of the business. The accountant must keep track of two main things. First, the accountant must track the resources a business owns that have value. These are called assets. In addition, the accountant must track where the business obtained the money to finance its assets. Remember, money comes from liabilities or stockholders’ equity. The amount of assets that a business owns at a point in time must equal the amount of financing the business has at that point in time. In other words, assets must equal liabilities plus stockholders’ equity. This concept can be expressed as an equation, referred to as the fundamental accounting equation:

Assets (what the business owns)

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity

(who provides the money)

The parties who provide the money to finance a company’s assets have an ownership interest in the assets of the company. Therefore, the liabilities and stockholders’ equity also represent who has an ownership interest in, or claims to, a company’s assets.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 47

03/04/14 1:32 PM

48

Chapter 1

Transaction Analysis Accountants will record a business transaction with this fundamental accounting equation. When the accountant records a transaction that affects the business, he or she will record what effect the transaction has on the assets of the business and what effect it has on the financing of the business. This process is called transaction analysis.

Stockholders’ Equity Before we start looking at how transactions affect the accounting equation, let’s take a closer look at the stockholders’ equity section of the equation. Stockholders’ equity, sometimes called shareholders’ equity, is the phrase used to describe owners’ equity in a corporation. In order to provide more useful information to various people, the stockholders’ equity section of the equation can be broken down into smaller subcategories: Common stock  The stockholders’ equity that is the result of the owners of the business investing money (or other assets) into the business. Retained earnings  The stockholders’ equity that is the result of ­the business having net income, or earnings, that have been retained in the business.

• Common stock is used to reflect stockholders’ equity that is the result of the ­owners of the business investing money (or other assets) into the business. • Retained earnings is used to reflect stockholders’ equity that is the result of the business having net income, or earnings, that have been retained in the business. As we saw earlier (on page 39), net income is created when the business has revenue that exceeds expenses. A net loss is when a business has expenses that exceed revenue. An expanded version of the accounting equation would look like this:

Assets

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock

(what the business owns)

Retained Earnings

(who provides the money)

The retained earnings subcategory can now be further broken down into subcategories to help the accountant provide even better information. These are the subcategories and the information they reflect: • Revenue is used to reflect an increase in retained earnings that is the result of the business providing goods and services. • Expenses are used to reflect a decrease in retained earnings that is the result of the business incurring costs related to providing goods and services. • Dividends are used to reflect a decrease in retained earnings that is the result of the owners receiving assets (usually cash) from the business. An expanded version of the accounting equation would now look like this:

Assets

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock

Retained Earnings

Common Stock  Revenues  Expenses  Dividends Retained Earnings and, therefore, Stockholders’ Equity increases by adding amounts to Revenues. Retained Earnings and, therefore, Stockholders’ Equity decreases by adding amounts to expenses and dividends. These subcategories will make more sense as we see how they are used to record the effects of business transactions. To illustrate, let’s

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 48

03/04/14 1:32 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

49

analyze the effects of several transactions on the accounting equation for the month of January 2014 for Osborne Consulting, Inc., a new computer consulting business started by Cindy Osborne. 1. Sale of stock. Cindy Osborne invests $10,000 to start the business. Osborne Consulting, Inc., sells Cindy $10,000 of common stock in exchange for her cash investment. The effect of this transaction on the accounting equation is to i­ncrease Assets and increase Stockholders’ Equity as follows:

Assets

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock

Cash $10,000 $10,000

(1) Bal

Retained Earnings

Common Stock  Revenues  Expenses  Dividends $10,000 $10,000

 

Remember that, for each transaction, the amount on the left side of the equation must equal the amount on the right side. The amount of assets will be increased by $10,000 because the business now has $10,000 of cash that it did not have before. In order to keep track of what type of assets the business has, the accountant will create a subcategory under assets for each different type of asset that the business has, so a subcategory for Cash was created. Because the assets have increased, there is now a need to increase the ownership side of the equation. The business does not owe the $10,000 to a third party, so the $10,000 ownership interest must belong to Cindy and must be entered in the Stockholders’ Equity section of the equation. If we look at the Stockholders’ Equity side of the equation, we can see that there are two possible places the $10,000 can be entered in order to increase Stockholders’ Equity: Common Stock and Retained Earnings. Based on the definitions of when each of these would be used, as discussed previously, we see that the $10,000 should be entered in the Common Stock section of Stockholders’ Equity because this ­increase in Stockholders’ Equity was the result of Cindy investing assets into the business. 2. Purchase supplies on credit. Osborne Consulting purchases office supplies, agreeing to pay $350 within 30 days. The effect of this transaction on the accounting equation is to increase Assets and increase Liabilities as follows:

Assets

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock

Bal (2) Bal

Cash $10,000 $10,000

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 49



Supplies



$350 $350

  

Accounts Payable $350 $350

Retained Earnings

Common  Stock  Revenues  Expenses  Dividends $10,000  $10,000

03/04/14 1:32 PM

50

Chapter 1

Prepaid expenses  Amounts that are assets of a business because they represent items that have been ­purchased but will be used later. Accounts payable  A liability ­incurred by a business when purchasing goods and services.

The Supplies account is an asset because the supplies that were purchased have not been used yet. Supplies are an example of what we call prepaid expenses. A prepaid expense is an asset until it has been used up in the business operations. The agreement to pay for them later creates an accounts payable, a ­liability, because the business owes $350 to a third party. 3. Purchase equipment for cash. The business purchases equipment, paying cash of $4,000. The effect of this transaction on the accounting equation is to increase one asset and decrease another asset as follows:

Assets

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock

Bal (3) Bal

Cash $10,000 $4,000 $ 6,000

 

Supplies $350



$350

 Equipment   $4,000  $4,000 

Accounts Payable $350 $350

Retained Earnings

Common  Stock  Revenues  Expenses  Dividends  $10,000  $10,000

The cash purchase of equipment increases one asset, Equipment, and decreases ­another asset, Cash, by the same amount. After the transaction is completed, Osborne Consulting has total assets of $10,350, liabilities of $350, and stockholders’ equity of $10,000. This type of transaction is referred to as a shift in assets. Because there has been no change in the total amount of assets, there should be no change in ownership; therefore, there will be no change in the amount of Stockholders’ Equity or liabilities. 4. Borrow cash from the bank. Osborne Consulting borrows $12,000 cash from the bank and signs a two-year note payable to the bank. The effect of this transaction on the accounting equation is to increase Assets and increase Liabilities as follows:

Assets

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock

Bal (4) Bal

Cash $ 6,000 $12,000 $18,000

 

Supplies $350



$350

Note payable  A liability that is represented by a written promise that requires future payment.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 50

Retained Earnings

Accounts Notes Common  Equipment  Payable  Payable  Stock  Revenues  Expenses  Dividends $4,000   $350  $10,000 $12,000 $4,000   $350  $12,000  $10,000

A note payable is a written promise to pay a specified amount in the future. Often businesses will borrow money from the bank in order to purchase assets or to make sure enough cash is available to operate the business. Borrowing cash from the bank increases the asset Cash because the business has $12,000 that it did not have before. It also increases the liability Notes Payable by $12,000 because the business owes $12,000 to the bank. In other words, the bank has an ownership interest in $12,000 of Osborne Consulting’s assets. Note that total assets of $22,350 still equal the total liabilities of $12,350 plus the stockholders’ equity of $10,000.

03/04/14 1:32 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

51

5. Provide services for cash. Osborne Consulting earns service revenue by ­providing consulting services for clients. Osborne collects $1,200 cash for ­services provided. The effect of this transaction on the accounting equation is to increase Assets and increase Stockholders’ Equity as follows:

Assets

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock

Bal (5) Bal

Cash $18,000 $1,200 $19,200

 

Supplies $350



$350

Retained Earnings

Accounts Notes Common  Equipment  Payable  Payable  Stock  Revenues  Expenses  Dividends $4,000   $350  $12,000  $10,000 $1,200 $4,000   $350  $12,000  $10,000  $1,200

Providing services increases both Cash and Revenues by $1,200. Cash is increased because the business has $1,200 that it did not have before, and Revenues is increased because Stockholders’ Equity must be increased to reflect the fact that Cindy, the sole stockholder, has an ownership interest in the increased assets. As was previously discussed, the specific subcategory that is used to increase Retained Earnings (and, therefore, Stockholders’ Equity) due to providing goods and services is Revenues.

On account  Buying or selling on credit. Accounts receivable  An asset that represents amounts owed to the business by customers.

Assets

6. Provide services on credit. A business can also earn service revenue even if it has not yet received cash for these services. Osborne Consulting performs $1,900 of services and, in return, receives customers’ promises to pay this $1,900 within one month. In accounting, we say that Osborne performed this service on account. A client’s promise to pay is called an account ­receivable. It is an asset because the business has the right to collect the cash in the f­ uture. The effect on the accounting equation is to increase Assets and increase Stockholders’ Equity as follows:

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock

Bal (6) Bal

Accounts Accounts Cash  Receivable  Supplies  Equipment  Payable  $19,200  $350  $4,000  $350  $1,900 $19,200  $1,900  $350  $4,000  $350 

Retained Earnings

Common Notes Payable  Stock  Revenues  Expenses  Dividends $12,000  $10,000  $1,200 $1,900 $12,000  $10,000  $3,100

Notice that the Revenue account was increased just as it was in the previous transaction when Osborne Consulting performed services and received cash. The Revenue account was increased to reflect the fact that there has been an increase in the stockholders’ ownership interest in the assets of the business. In Transaction 5, the assets increased because the business received cash, and in Transaction 6, the assets increased because the business received an account receivable.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 51

03/04/14 1:32 PM

52

Chapter 1

7. Partial payment of accounts payable. Osborne Consulting pays $150 to the store where it purchased $350 worth of supplies in Transaction 2. In accounting, this is referred to as “paying on account.” The effect on the accounting equation is to decrease Assets and decrease Liabilities as follows:

Assets

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Retained Earnings

Common Stock

Bal (7) Bal

Accounts Accounts Cash  Receivable  Supplies  Equipment  Payable  $19,200  $1,900  $350  $4,000  $350  $150 $150 $19,050  $1,900  $350  $4,000  $200 

Common Notes Payable  Stock  Revenues  Expenses  Dividends $12,000  $10,000  $3,100 $12,000  $10,000  $3,100

The payment of cash on account has no effect on Supplies because the payment does not affect the amount of supplies that the business has. Likewise, the payment on account does not affect Expenses because the business is paying off an amount owed, not using those supplies. The Cash account decreases because the business has less cash and the Accounts Payable account decreases because the business owes less to a third party. 8. Payment of expenses. During the month, Osborne Consulting paid $1,700 cash for expenses incurred such as wages, building rent, and utilities. Later on we will see that each different type of expense will be shown separately in the accounting equation, but for now we will lump them all together under the heading “Expenses.” The effect on the accounting equation is to decrease Assets and decrease Stockholders’ Equity as follows:

Assets

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock

Bal (8) Bal

Accounts Accounts Cash  Receivable  Supplies  Equipment  Payable  $19,050  $1,900  $350  $4,000  $200  $1,700 $17,350  $1,900  $350  $4,000  $200 

Retained Earnings

Common Notes Payable  Stock  Revenues  Expenses  Dividends $12,000  $10,000  $3,100 $1,700 $12,000  $10,000  $3,100  $1,700

For this transaction, Cash decreases and Expenses increase. Because Expenses are subtracted from Retained Earnings, Retained Earnings (and, therefore, Stockholders’ Equity) will decrease. This decrease in Stockholders’ Equity r­ eflects that the assets for the business have decreased and, therefore, there has to be less ownership reported. Remember that Expenses are used to decrease Retained Earnings when needed as the result of the business incurring costs ­related to providing goods and services.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 52

03/04/14 1:32 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

53

9. Cash dividends. Osborne Consulting pays $500 of cash dividends to Cindy Osborne, the stockholder. The effect on the accounting equation is to decrease Assets and decrease Stockholders’ Equity as follows:

Assets

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock

Bal (9) Bal

Accounts Accounts Cash  Receivable  Supplies  Equipment  Payable  $17,350  $1,900  $350  $4,000  $200  $500 $16,850  $1,900  $350  $4,000  $200 

Retained Earnings

Common Notes Payable  Stock  Revenues  Expenses  Dividends $12,000  $10,000  $3,100  $1,700 $500 $12,000  $10,000  $3,100  $1,700  $500

The payment of dividends causes a decrease in Cash of $500 and an increase in Dividends of $500. Because Dividends are subtracted from Retained Earnings, Retained Earnings (and, therefore, Stockholders’ Equity) will decrease. This decrease in Stockholders’ Equity reflects that the assets for the business have decreased and, therefore, there has to be less ownership interest reported. Dividends are different from expenses because the cash is paid directly to the owners rather than being paid for costs that were related to providing goods or services. Once again we can see that the total assets of $23,100 still equal the total liabilities of $12,200 plus stockholders’ equity of $10,900, so the accounting equation continues to balance. Remember that total Stockholders’ Equity equals the Common Stock of $10,000 plus the Retained Earnings of $900. Retained Earnings was arrived at by calculating net earnings of $1,400 (subtracting the Expenses from the Revenues) and then subtracting the Dividends.

Try It… At the end of its first month of operations, Robinson Consulting, Inc., has assets totaling $57,000 and stockholders’ equity totaling $32,000. What is the amount of Robinson Consulting’s total liabilities at the end of the month?

Answer

We can use the fundamental accounting equation to figure out what Robinson Consulting’s total liabilities are. First, it helps to restate the equation in a different format by subtracting stockholders’ equity from both sides of the equation as follows:

Assets

Stockholders’ Equity

Liabilities

Next, insert the amount of Robinson Consulting’s total assets and the total stockholders’ equity into the restated formula.

$57,000  $32,000  Liabilities Finally, solve the equation to get the total liabilities of $25,000.

$57,000  $32,000  $25,000

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 53

03/04/14 1:32 PM

54

Chapter 1

How Do You Report Business Transactions Using Financial Statements? 6

Understand and be able to prepare basic financial statements

Financial statements  Historical, objective reports, prepared according to GAAP, that communicate financial information about a business.

Accounting is the process of recognizing, measuring, recording, and reporting information about a business’s economic transactions. But what is the process of reporting used by accountants? To report the results of a business’s transactions for a period, financial statements need to be prepared. These reports show the entity’s financial information to interested stakeholders both inside and outside the organization. Four basic financial statements are prepared by most organizations: • • • •

Income statement Statement of retained earnings Balance sheet Statement of cash flows

The Income Statement Income statement  A financial statement that reports the revenue and expenses of a business during a given period of time.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 54

An income statement answers the question, “Is the organization generating any net income?” Just as a scoreboard shows how many points a team earned for a specific ­period of time, a business prepares an income statement to show, for a specific time period, the revenue earned and the expenses incurred to produce that revenue. Like the scoreboard that shows whether the team is winning or losing, the income statement shows whether the business generated net income (total revenue was greater than total expenses, where total expenses are total operating expenses plus interest expense) or a net loss (total revenue is less than total expenses). To prepare an income statement, we set up a format that includes a heading and the body of the statement. The heading of all financial statements should show “who,” “what,” and “when.” The “who” is the name of the business, the “what” is the name of the financial statement, and the “when” is the time period covered by the statement. The body of the income statement lists the r­ evenue, then the expenses, and finally the net income or net loss. When revenue is greater than expenses, the business earns net income, or profit. When expenses are greater than revenue, the business has a net loss. We can prepare an income statement for Osborne Consulting for the month of January 2014 by referring to the ending balances in the accounting equation that we recently completed. If we look at Exhibit 1-2, we can see what the income statement for Osborne Consulting looks like. In the first month of operations, Osborne Consulting, Inc., earned $3,100 in revenue and had $1,700 in expenses that resulted in net income of $1,400. This amount can remain part of the stockholders’ equity in the business and can be used to “grow” or expand the business, or the business can distribute dividends to the stockholders. Notice the dollar signs on the first and last amounts and the double underline under the last amount presented on the statement (Net Income). It is common practice to place a dollar sign on the first number and the last number in each column on a financial statement and to double underline the final amount.

03/04/14 1:32 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

Exhibit 1-2

55

Osborne Consulting, Inc. Income Statement Month Ended January 31, 2014 $3,100 1,700 $1,400

Revenue Expenses Net Income Osborne Consulting, Inc. Statement of Retained Earnings Month Ended January 31, 2014

$

0 1,400 1,400 500 $ 900

Retained Earnings, January 1, 2014 Add: Net Income for the month Subtotal Less: Dividends Retained Earnings, January 31, 2014

Osborne Consulting, Inc. Balance Sheet January 31, 2014 ASSETS Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Equipment

Total Assets

$16,850 1,900 350 4,000

$23,100

LIABILITIES Accounts Payable Notes Payable Total Liabilities

$

200 12,000 12,200

STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities & Stockholders’ Equity

10,000 900 10,900 $23,100

Osborne Consulting, Inc. Statement of Cash Flows Month Ended January 31, 2014 Cash flows from operating activities: Net income Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities: Increase in current assets Increase in current liabilities Net cash used in operating activites Cash flows from investing activities: Purchase of equipment Net cash used in investing activities Cash flows from financing activities: Proceeds from issuance of commmon stock Proceeds from issuance of notes payable Payment of dividends Net cash provided by financing activities Net increase in cash Cash balance January 1, 2014 Cash balance January 31, 2014

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 55

$ 1,400

(2,250) 200

(2,050) (650)

(4,000) (4,000) 10,000 12,000 (500) 21,500 16,850 0 16,850

03/04/14 1:33 PM

56

Chapter 1

The Statement of Retained Earnings Statement of retained ­earnings  A financial statement that reports the amount of ­accumulated net profits that a business has ­retained and not paid in dividends since ­inception. The statement reports the beginning balance of retained ­earnings, plus net income or minus net loss in the given period, less the ­dividends during the given period, equalling ending retained earnings.

“How much net income has the corporation made and kept during the current accounting period?” The statement of retained earnings answers this question by presenting the amount of the retained earnings and the changes to it during a specific time period, such as a month or a year. Increases in retained earnings come from net income and decreases result from either a net loss or the payment of dividends. To prepare the statement of retained earnings, we set up a format that includes a heading and body similar to the income statement. The heading includes the name of the business, the name of the financial statement, and the time period covered by the statement. The body of the statement lists the beginning retained earnings balance, any net income earned or net loss incurred, any dividends paid, and the ending balance of Retained Earnings. Using the information from the income statement that we just ­prepared and the dividend information from our accounting equation, we can prepare a statement of retained earnings. Exhibit 1-2 shows what Osborne Consulting’s statement of retained earnings looks like. Because this is the first month that Osborne Consulting has been in business, there is a zero balance in beginning Retained Earnings. During the first month of operations, Osborne Consulting, Inc., paid dividends of $500, which, when combined with the $1,400 of net income for January, leaves an ending Retained Earnings balance at January 31 of $900. Of the $1,400 that Osborne Consulting earned during January, we can see that $900 was retained in the business.

The Balance Sheet Balance sheet  or statement of financial position A financial statement that reports the assets, ­liabilities, and stockholders’ equity of a business at a specific point in time.

“What assets does the company have, and who has ownership rights to those assets?” The balance sheet answers this question by listing all of an entity’s assets, liabilities, and stockholders’ equity as of a specific date, usually the end of a month or a year. Basically the balance sheet shows the accounting equation for a business and reflects the fact that assets equal liabilities plus stockholders’ equity. The balance sheet is also known as the statement of financial position. Using the information from the statement of ­retained earnings that we just prepared and the ending balances from our a­ ccounting equation, we can prepare a balance sheet for Osborne Consulting. Exhibit 1-2 shows what Osborne Consulting’s balance sheet will look like. Notice that total assets equal total liabilities and stockholders’ equity.

The Statement of Cash Flows

Statement of cash flows  A financial statement that reports the sources and uses of cash for a given period of time. Operating activities  Activities that create revenue and/or expense in the entity’s major line of business.

“Where did the business get the money it needed to operate, and where did it spend its money?” The statement of cash flows answers this question by showing stakeholders all of the sources and all of the uses of cash by a business for a specified period of time. On the statement of cash flows, the sources and uses of cash are reported for three different types of business activities: 1. Operating activities are activities in the entity’s major line of business to ­generate revenue and/or expenses such as providing goods or services. 2. Investing activities are the decisions made by management to buy and sell longterm assets such as buying equipment.

Investing activities  Decisions made by management to buy and sell long-term assets.

3. Financing activities are those actions that generate the receipt or payment of cash to pay long-term liabilities or raise capital such as selling common stock or borrowing money.

Financing activities  Actions that generate the receipt or payment of cash to pay long-term liabilities or to raise capital.

Exhibit 1-2 shows what Osborne Consulting’s statement of cash flows will look like. Notice that the cash balance reported on the balance sheet equals the ending cash balance reported on the statement of cash flows. The statement of cash flows will be covered in more detail in Chapter 11.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 56

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

57

Relationships Among the Financial Statements The financial statements are prepared in the following order: 1. Income statement 2. Statement of retained earnings 3. Balance sheet 4. Statement of cash flows The reason for this order is that the net income figure from the income statement is needed in order to prepare the statement of retained earnings. Likewise, the ending retained earnings balance from the statement of retained earnings is needed to prepare the balance sheet. Finally, information from both the income statement and the balance sheet is needed in order to prepare the statement of cash flows.

Focus on Decision Making “What Is the Business?”

Think of a business. It may be a big business such as Kroger or Facebook, or a small business such as your local doctor. Now think about the following questions: 1. Why does the business exist? 2. What type of business is it? 3. What does the business sell? 4. What expenses does the business incur as it operates? 5. What assets and people are needed to operate the business? 6. Where could the business get the money to finance the assets and pay the employees? Businesses all exist to create value for their stakeholders, especially for their owners. But each business tries to be different. Businesses compete. To be successful, they need to be special.

The Income Statement

The income statement of the business tells the owners and managers the revenues (or sales) and expenses a business has experienced during a period of time. Different businesses have different types of revenues and expenses. The revenues and expenses incurred by your doctor are different than the revenues and expenses incurred by Kroger or Facebook.

The Balance Sheet

Different businesses need different types of assets to be successful. Your doctor sells his or her services whereas Walmart sells clothing, tools, and other household products. Your doctor’s office is small compared to the big buildings used by Kroger or even Facebook. The balance sheet of a business reflects the different assets a business needs to operate. Given that businesses are different, it is reasonable to expect that different businesses use different ways to finance their assets. Different businesses have different amounts and types of liabilities and owners’ equity.

How They Do It: A Look at Business

Think about how different businesses operate. An example is a food store such as Kroger. Kroger sells food. It needs assets such as cash, food (called inventory), and buildings. Kroger finances these assets with liabilities and stockholders’ equity. For the year ended

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 57

03/04/14 1:33 PM

58

Chapter 1

February 2, 2013, Kroger had sales of $96.8 billion, expenses of $95.3 billion, and net income of $1.5 billion. At February 2, 2013, Kroger had assets of $24.6 billion, financed with $20.4 billion in liabilities and $4.2 billion in stockholders’ equity. Kroger’s biggest assets were food and buildings. Compare that to Facebook, the Internet social media company. Facebook sells advertising and other Internet services. It needs cash, computers, and software to run the computers. For the year ended December 31, 2012, Facebook reported sales of $5.1 billion, expenses of $5.05 billion, and net income of just over $50 million. At December 31, 2012, Facebook reported assets of $15.1 billion, financed with $3.3 billion in liabilities and $11.8 billion in stockholders’ equity. Facebook’s biggest assets were marketable securities, short-term investments that can be quickly converted to cash. Different businesses operate differently. Accountants must communicate these differences when they recognize, measure, record, and report business transactions using financial statements.

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analyze

How do I understand how a business operates?

The income statement reports the revenues and expenses of a business. Revenues represent what a business earns as a result of providing goods or services. Expenses represent the cost to the business of providing those goods or services.

If revenues exceed expenses, the business is profitable and has earned net income. However, if expenses exceed revenue, the business has incurred a net loss and is not profitable.

The statement of retained earnings shows whether the net income of a business was paid out as dividends or retained in the business.

If a business is planning on growth, it will often issue low or no dividends to shareholders. This way, it retains the income in the business.

The balance sheet reflects the assets, liabilities, and stockholders equity of the business.

The liabilities of a business reflect the claims of third ­parties to the assets of the business. Once those claims are settled, the remaining assets belong to the stockholders (the owners) of the business. This amount is reflected by the stockholders’ equity on the balance sheet.

The statement of cash flows reflects the sources and uses of cash over a period of time.

You can see whether a company’s operations generated cash for the business and how much cash the business invested in the purchase of assets such as buildings and equipment. If a company’s operations generated insufficient funds to finance its investments in assets, you can determine how the business financed these acquisitions.

Accounting, Business, and You—Putting It All Together So what is accounting? Accounting is the process of recognizing, measuring, recording, and reporting information about a business’s economic transactions. Accounting is the language of business.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 58

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

59

So what is a business? A business is an organization, recognized under law, that a­ ttempts to create value by exchanging products with customers for money. Why does a business exist? A business exists to create value. How does a business create value? A business acquires money (liabilities and owners’ equity) and uses money to hire people and acquire assets. The people (employees) then use the assets to generate revenue and expenses that hopefully result in enough net income to compensate owners for the use of their money. It’s not easy to create value. Managing a business is both challenging and rewarding. It’s a challenge to blend all the parts of a business into a cohesive organization that delivers value for all stakeholders, particularly owners. A business is a team composed of people, assets, liabilities, and owners’ equity. To compete successfully, a business must blend and manage all the parts or players in the business just right. To be successful a business needs good information. That’s the job of accounting. Accountants are the scorekeepers of business. Like all good scorekeepers, they have rules. The rules accountants use are called Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP). Accountants use GAAP to create financial statements. The four primary statements are the income statement, the statement of retained earnings, the balance sheet, and the statement of cash flows. So look around. What do you see? You see businesses. You see people and organizations creating, producing, and selling products. And in doing so, you see businesses creating value. However, a very important part of that value-creating process is keeping track of your revenues, expenses, assets, liabilities, and owners’ equity. In other words, as a business owner or manager, accounting is important to you.

Summary MyAccountingLab

1

Understand the nature of business and the role of accounting in business

Here is what you should know after reading this chapter. MyAccountingLab will help you identify what you know and where to go when you need practice.

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

A business is a legal organization that attempts to create value by exchanging products with ­customers for money. Accounting is the process of recognizing, measuring, recording, and reporting business transactions.

Accounting (p. 36) Business (p. 36) Cost (p. 37) Customer (p. 37) Goods (p. 36) Loss (p. 38) Product (p. 36) Profit (p. 37) Revenue (p. 37) Risk (p. 38) Sale (p. 37) Services (p. 37) Stakeholder (p. 38) Value (p. 37)

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 59

03/04/14 1:33 PM

60

2

Chapter 1

Know how a business operates

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

A business obtains money from owners and ­lenders. Owners and lenders expect a return that compensates them for time and risk. Owners expect a profit, the difference between revenue and costs. Lenders expect interest. A business uses the money provided by owners and lenders to hire employees and invest in assets. Employees then use the assets to generate revenue and incur costs.

Asset (p. 39) Employees (p. 39) Expense (p. 39) Interest (p. 39) Liabilities (p. 39) Net income (p. 39) Owners’ equity (p. 39) Stockholders’ equity (p. 39)

3

Know the different types and forms of businesses

There are many types of businesses. A business is organized under the law as a sole proprietorship, a partnership, a corporation, or a limited liability company.

Corporation (p. 41) Dividend (p. 41) For-profit business (p. 40) Limited liability company (LLC) (p. 42) Manufacturing business (p. 41) Merchandise business (p. 41) Not-for-profit business (p. 41) Partnership (p. 41) Retail business (p. 41) Service business (p. 41) Sole proprietorship (p. 41) Stockholder (p. 41) S-corporation (p. 42) Wholesale business (p. 41)

4

Know the key accounting principles and concepts

Accounting is governed by rules, called Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP).

Actual cost (p. 44) Business entity principle (p. 44) Cost principle (p. 44) Financial accounting (p. 43) Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) (p. 43) Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP) (p. 43) Historical cost (p. 44) International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) (p. 44) Objectivity principle (p. 44) Reliability principle (p. 44)

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 60

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

5

Know how accounting functions in a business

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Accounting is a critical part of a successful ­business. Accounting is the scorekeeping function of what the business is doing. Accounting must recognize, measure, record, and report the resources a business owns. These resources are called assets. Accounting must also account for the sources of the money to acquire the ­assets, money provided by owners or lenders. Last, ­accounting must account for how the business operates and whether it generates a profit, where revenue exceeds expenses, or a loss, where ­revenue is less than expenses.

Accounts payable (p. 50)

61

Accounts receivable (p. 51) Accrual accounting (p. 46) Cash accounting (p. 46) Common stock (p. 48) Fundamental accounting equation (p. 47) Note payable (p. 50) On account (p. 51) Prepaid expenses (p. 50) Retained earnings (p. 48)

6

Understand and be able to prepare basic financial statements

Accounting uses the accounting equation to ­produce four financial statements. These statements are the income statement, the balance sheet, the statement of retained earnings, and the statement of cash flows.

Balance sheet (p. 56) Financial statements (p. 54) Financing activities (p. 56) Income statement (p. 54) Investing activities (p. 56) Operating activities (p. 56) Statement of cash flows (p. 56) Statement of financial position (p. 56) Statement of retained earnings (p. 56)

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 61

03/04/14 1:33 PM

62

Chapter 1

Accounting Practice Discussion Questions 1. The text states that accounting is the “language of business.” What does this mean? Why is it important to know the language? 2. Would you describe accounting as primarily a technical discipline or primarily an ethical discipline? Why? 3. Financial statements are defined as “historical reports that communicate financial ­information about a business to people or organizations outside the company.” Why is the word historical used? 4. What are some reasons why accounting has adopted “historical” financial statements as the model? What are some disadvantages associated with presenting “historical” ­financial statements? 5. What are some of the uses of financial statements? 6. What is the primary way in which corporations differ from proprietorships and partnerships? What are some of the factors that might affect a person’s decision about the form of organization that would be best in a given situation? 7. What is the fundamental accounting equation? Define each of the components of this equation. 8. How is the accounting equation affected by each of these transactions? a. Owners contribute cash to start the business in exchange for common stock. b. The company borrows money from the bank. c. The company provides services for a client who promises to pay later. d. The company collects from the customer in transaction c. 9. In what order should the financial statements be prepared? Why? 10. Which financial statement would be most useful to answer each of the following questions? a. Does the corporation have enough resources to pay its short-term debts? b. What is the corporation’s policy toward “growing the company” versus distributing its wealth to owners? c. Did the corporation pay its operating costs with resources generated from operations, money borrowed from banks, or money generated from selling off its buildings and equipment? d. Did the corporation make a profit last year?

Self Check 1. Which type of business organization is owned by its stockholders? a. Proprietorship b. Partnership c. Corporation d. All the above are owned by stockholders. 2. The majority of Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP) are created by the a. Institute of Management Accountants (IMA). b. Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC). c. American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA). d. Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB).

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 62

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

63

3. Which accounting principle specifically states that we should record transactions at amounts that can be verified? a. Business entity principle b. Cost principle c. Reliability principle d. Going-concern principle 4. Wave Rider is famous for custom skateboards. At the end of a recent year, Wave Rider’s total assets added up to $884 million and stockholders’ equity was $187 million. How much did Wave Rider owe creditors? a. $1,071 million b. $884 million c. $697 million d. $187 million 5. Assume that Wave Rider sold skateboards to a department store for $28,000 cash. How would this transaction affect Wave Rider’s accounting equation? a. Increase both assets and stockholders’ equity by $28,000 b. It will not affect the accounting equation because the effects cancel out. c. Increase both assets and liabilities by $28,000 d. Increase both liabilities and stockholders’ equity by $28,000 6. Assume that Wave Rider sold skateboards to another department store for $18,000 on account. Which parts of the accounting equation does a sale on account affect? a. Accounts Payable and Cash b. Accounts Receivable and Retained Earnings c. Accounts Receivable and Accounts Payable d. Accounts Payable and Retained Earnings 7. Assume that Wave Rider paid expenses totaling $32,000. How does this transaction affect Wave Rider’s accounting equation? a. Increases assets and decreases liabilities b. Decreases both assets and stockholders’ equity c. Increases both assets and stockholders’ equity d. Decreases assets and increases liabilities 8. Consider the overall effects of the transactions in questions 5, 6, and 7 on Wave Rider. What is Wave Rider’s net income or net loss? a. Net loss of $4,000 b. Net income of $46,000 c. Net income of $14,000 d. It cannot be determined from the data given. 9. The balance sheet reports a. financial position on a specific date. b. results of operations on a specific date. c. results of operations for a specific period. d. financial position for a specific period. 10. The income statement reports a. financial position for a specific period. b. results of operations on a specific date. c. financial position on a specific date. d. results of operations for a specific period. 11. According to the Real World Accounting Video, the objective of business is to create value. True or False?

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 63

03/04/14 1:33 PM

64

Chapter 1 12. According to the Real World Accounting Video, ________ are important reports business managers use in managing their business. a. balance sheets b. income statements c. both balance sheets and income statements Answers are given after Written Communication.

MyAccountingLab

Short Exercises S1-1. Accounting principles (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. Place the corresponding letter of the definition next to the term. _____ 1. Cost principle _____ 2. Business entity principle _____ 3.  Generally Accepted Accounting Principles _____ 4. Reliability principle

a. An organization that stands as a separate ­economic unit must not have its financial ­affairs confused with that of other entities. b. Data must be verifiable. c. Standards developed by FASB. d. Acquired assets and services should be recorded at their actual cost.

S1-2. Accounting principles (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. Jack Sanders owns and operates Jack’s Java Coffee Shop. He proposes to account for the shop’s assets at their current market value in order to have current amounts on the balance sheet. Which accounting concept or principle does Jack violate? a. Business entity principle b. Going-concern principle c. Reliability principle d. Cost principle S1-3. Accounting terminology (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 10–15 min. Place the corresponding letter of the definition next to the term. _____ 1. Liabilities

a. Any event that affects a firm’s financial position.

_____ 2. Assets

b. Organization form with a single owner.

_____ 3. Corporation

c. Organization form with two or more owners.

_____ 4. Dividends

d. Organization form that can have an indefinite life.

_____ 5. Sole proprietorship

e. Debt owed to outsiders.

_____ 6. Partnership

f. Economic resources of the business.

_____ 7. Transaction

g. Payment of cash to the owners of a corporation.

S1-4. Basic accounting equation (Learning Objective 5 ) 5–10 min. Determine the missing amounts in the following accounting equations.

Assets a. b. c.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 64

$106,000 ? $94,000

Stockholders’ Equity

Liabilities = = =

$24,000 $63,000 ?

+ + +

? $28,000 $45,000

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

65

S1-5. Basic accounting equation (Learning Objective 5 ) 5–10 min. Ellen Beach owns Ellen’s Lawncare Service. The business has cash of $13,000 and equipment that costs $35,000. Debts of the business include accounts payable of $9,000 and a $5,000 note payable. Determine the amount of stockholders’ equity Ellen has in the business. Write the accounting equation for Ellen’s Lawncare Service. S1-6. Basic accounting equation (Learning Objective 5 ) 5–10 min. Boehms, Inc., has cash of $36,000, supplies costing $1,500, and stockholders’ equity of $28,000. Determine the liabilities of the business. Write the accounting equation for Boehms, Inc. S1-7. Basic accounting equation (Learning Objective 5 ) 5–10 min. Qwick Care Clinic, Inc., started a business when Dr. Hamm purchased $15,000 of common stock in the business for cash. Before starting operations, Qwick Care Clinic, Inc., borrowed $18,000 cash by signing a note payable to 1st National Bank. Account for these two transactions in the accounting equation. S1-8. Entering transactions in the accounting equation (Learning Objective 5 ) 5–10 min. Sanchez Towing Service, Inc., earns service revenue by towing vehicles for AAA. Sanchez Towing Service’s main expenses are the salaries paid to its employees. Account for the following transactions in the expanded accounting equation: a. Sanchez Towing Service, Inc., earned $62,000 of service revenue on account. b. Sanchez Towing Service, Inc., paid $33,000 in salaries expense. S1-9. Basic accounting equation (Learning Objective 5) 5–10 min. At the beginning of the year, Shanon Company had total assets of $550,000 and total liabilities of $210,000. Answer the following questions viewing each situation as being independent of the others.

1. If total assets increased by $200,000 during the year, and total liabilities decreased by $75,000, what is the amount of Stockholder’s equity at the end of the year?

2. During the year, total liabilities increased by $230,000 and stockholder’s equity ­decreased by $90,000. What is the amount of total assets at the end of the year?

3. If total assets decreased by $40,000 and stockholder’s equity increased by $130,000 during the year, what is the amount of total liabilities at the end of the year?

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 65

03/04/14 1:33 PM

66

Chapter 1 S1-10. Basic financial statements (Learning Objective 6 ) 5–10 min. Label each of the items listed with the abbreviation of the financial statement on which it appears. Items may appear on more than one statement. Income Statement (IS) Balance Sheet (BS) Statement of Retained Earnings (RE) _____ 1. Accounts Receivable _____ 2. Notes Payable _____ 3. Advertising Expense _____ 4. Service Revenue _____ 5. Retained Earnings _____ 6. Office Supplies S1-11. Transaction Analysis (Learning Objective 5 ) 5–10 min. The following transactions represent part of the activities of Samia Kaakour, Inc. for the first month of its existence. Indicate the effect of each transaction upon the total assets of the business by one of the following phrases: increased total assets; decreased total assets; or no change in total assets. a. Samia Kaakour bought shares of common stock to start the business by opening a bank account b. Purchased a computer for cash c. Purchased office equipment with money borrowed from the bank d. Paid the first month’s utility bill e. Collected an accounts receivable f. Borrowed some money from a bank to provide cash during the low season of the year g. Paid an accounts payable S1-12. Transaction analysis (Learning Objective 5 ) 5–10 min. Selected transactions for Moe Company are listed below. List the number of the ­transaction and then describe the effect of each transaction on assets, liabilities, and stockholder’s equity. Example: Bought shares of common stock in the business. The answer would be: Increase in assets and increase in stockholder’s equity. 1. Paid monthly utility bill. 2. Purchased new display case for cash. 3. Paid cash for repair work on security system. 4. Billed customers for services performed. 5. Received cash from customers billed in (4). 6. Incurred advertising expenses on account. 7. Paid monthly rent. 8. Received cash from customers when service was rendered.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 66

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

67

S1-13. Transaction analysis (Learning Objective 5 ) 5–10 min. Presented here are nine transactions and the analysis used to account for them. Evaluate each of the suggested accounting treatments, and indicate whether it is true or false. 1. Received cash of $41,000 from the stockholders, who bought stock in the business.

Answer: Increase asset, increase stockholders’ equity. _____ True _____ False 2. Paid $600 cash to purchase supplies.

Answer: Increase asset, increase stockholders’ equity. _____ True _____ False 3. Earned service revenue on account, $1,200.

Answer: Increase asset, increase retained earnings. _____ True _____ False 4. Purchased office furniture on account at a cost of $450.

Answer: Increase asset, increase liability. _____ True _____ False 5. Received cash on account, $1500.

Answer: Increase asset, decrease asset. _____ True _____ False 6. Paid cash on account, $175.

Answer: Increase asset, increase liability. _____ True _____ False 7. Sold land for $68,000 cash, which was the cost of the land.

Answer: Increase asset, decrease asset. _____ True _____ False 8. Performed services and received cash of $825.

Answer: Increase asset, increase revenue. _____ True _____ False 9. Paid monthly office rent of $1,500.

Answer: Decrease asset, increase stockholders’ equity. _____ True _____ False S1-14. Transaction analysis and calculating net income (Learning Objective 5) 5–10 min. The analysis of Cunnington, Inc.’s first seven transactions follows. The business only sold stock once and paid no dividends.

Assets

1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity

Accounts Accounts Notes Common Retained Cash  Receivable  Equipment  Payable  Payable  Stock  Earnings   $40,000  $40,000  $ 6,000   6,000  $15,000  15,000   1,200   $1,200  1,350  1,350   1,750  1,750  350  350   1. Label each of the transactions in the preceding analysis with the corresponding ­letter of the description that best fits it: a. Earned revenue for services provided, but customer will pay later. b. Customers paid cash for services completed earlier in the month. c. Received cash for revenue earned by providing services. d. Paid cash for expenses incurred to operate the business. e. Paid cash to purchase equipment. f. Sold stock to start the business. g. Purchased equipment with a bank loan. 2. If these transactions fully describe the operations of Cunnington, Inc., during the month, what was the amount of its net income or net loss?

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 67

03/04/14 1:33 PM

68

Chapter 1

MyAccountingLab

Exercises (Group A) E1-15A. Basic accounting equation (Learning Objective 5 ) 10–15 min.

Assets Appleway Corp. 1st Choice Inc. Hamilton Inc.

Quick solution: $12,000 decrease

? $ 82,000 $127,300

Stockholders’ Equity

Liabilities   

$48,700 ? $88,500

  

$13,400 $27,000 ?

E1-16A. Basic accounting equation (Learning Objective 5 ) 10–15 min. Mountain Drycleaners had $91,000 of total assets and $7,000 of total stockholders’ equity at December 31, 2014. At December 31, 2015, Mountain Drycleaners had ­assets totaling $145,000 and stockholders’ equity totaling $73,000. After analyzing the data, answer the following questions: 1. What was the amount of the increase or decrease in liabilities? 2. Identify a possible reason for the change in liabilities during the year. E1-17A. Basic accounting equation (Learning Objective 5 ) 10–15 min. Lynne’s Designs started business in 2014 with total assets of $37,000 and total liabilities of $16,000. At the end of 2014, Lynne’s Designs’ total assets were $82,000 and total liabilities were $28,000. After analyzing the data, answer the following questions: 1. What was the amount of the increase or decrease in stockholders’ equity? 2. Identify two possible reasons for the change in stockholders’ equity during the year. E1-18A. Using the accounting equation to determine net income (Learning Objectives 5 & 6) 15–20 min. The balance sheet data for Alan’s Lightworks, Corp., at August 31, 2014, and September 30, 2014, follow:

Total Assets .......................................................................... Total Liabilities...................................................................... Common Stock ..................................................................... Total Stockholders’ Equity ....................................................

Aug 31, 2014

Sep 30, 2014

$135,000 81,000 25,000 ?

$190,000 145,000 25,000 ?

Requirement 1. The following are three independent assumptions about the business during September. For each assumption, compute the amount of net income or net loss during September 2014. Find the solution by preparing the statement of retained earnings. First, use the amounts of total assets, total liabilities, and common stock given previously and the accounting equation to determine the beginning and ending retained earnings amounts. Then plug those and the other amount given in each assumption into the statement of retained earnings to determine the net income or net loss.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 68

a. The business paid no dividends. b. The business paid $14,000 of dividends. c. The business paid $6,000 of dividends.

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

69

E1-19A. Transaction analysis (Learning Objective 5) 15–20 min. Rabie Sadek decides to open a cleaning and laundry service titled Rabie Sadek, Inc. in Jnah Beirut. During January, the first month of operations, the following transactions occurred: 1. Rabie Sadek invests $30,000 cash in the business in exchange for the company’s common stock. 2. Purchased computer equipment for $6,000, paying $2,000 in cash and the ­remainder due in 30 days. 3. Purchased office supplies for $1,300 cash. 4. Received a bill for $300 for advertising in the newspaper. 5. Cash receipts from customers for cleaning and laundry amounted to $2,800. 6. Paid salaries of $600 to workers. 7. Billed customers $350 for cleaning and laundry services. 8. Paid $300 for advertising that was previously billed in Transaction 4. 9. Incurred utilities expense for month on account, $600. Requirement Analyze the effects of these transactions on the basic accounting equation. Use ­headings for Cash, Accounts Receivable, Office Supplies, Computer Equipment, Accounts Payable, Common Stock, Service Revenue, Advertising Expense, Salaries Expense, and Utilities Expense. E1-20A. Types of business organizations and balance sheet preparation (Learning Objectives 3 & 6) 10–15 min. The following are selected accounts of Inchirah Toys on December 31, 2014:

Common Stock .......................... $45,000 Accounts Payable....................... 7,000 Equipment.................................. 35,000 Service Revenue......................... 28,000 Supplies Expense....................... 4,500 Cash........................................... 6,000

Dividends ................................... Utilities Expense......................... Salaries Expense ........................ Accounts Receivable .................. Supplies ..................................... Rent Expense .............................

$4,000 700 9,000 14,000 4,800 2,000

Requirements 1. What type of business organization is Inchirah Toys? 2. Prepare an income statement, a statement of retained earnings, and a balance sheet for Inchirah, Inc. for the month ended December 31, 2014.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 69

03/04/14 1:33 PM

70

Chapter 1 E1-21A. Types of accounts and income statement preparation (Learning Objectives 5 & 6 ) 15–20 min. Selected accounts of Cole Consulting, Inc., a financial services business, have the following balances at December 31, 2014, the end of its first year of operations. During the year, James Cole, the only stockholder, bought $20,000 of stock in the business.

Office Furniture ...................... Utilities Expense..................... Accounts Payable................... Note Payable .......................... Service Revenue .................... Accounts Receivable .............. Supplies Expense...................

$ 26,500 6,300 4,100 10,000 116,600 7,000 2,700

Rent Expense ........................... Cash......................................... Office Supplies......................... Salaries Expense ...................... Salaries Payable....................... Property Tax Expense .............. Equipment................................

$28,000 4,200 500 36,700 1,500 1,600 48,000

Requirements 1. Identify each as an asset, liability, revenue, or expense. 2. Prepare the income statement of Cole Consulting, Inc., for the year ended December 31, 2014. What is the result of operations for 2014? 3. Assuming the balance in Retained Earnings on December 31, 2014, was $9,300, what was the amount of the dividends during the year? Answer by preparing a statement of retained earnings to solve for the dividends. Recall that the ­business has just completed its first year and has no beginning balance for retained earnings. E1-22A. Using the accounting equation to determine net income (Learning Objectives 5 & 6 ) 15–20 min. This information relates to Ghandour, Inc. for the year 2014.

Retained Earnings, December 31, 2014 ................................................................... Supplies Expense..................................................................................................... Dividends paid during 2014 ..................................................................................... Rent Expense ........................................................................................................... Commission Revenue .............................................................................................. Utilities Expense....................................................................................................... Salaries and Wages Expense....................................................................................

$62,400 1,800 9,000 10,400 52,000 2,400 25,000

Requirement After analyzing the data, prepare an income statement and calculate the balance of retained earnings for January 1, 2014.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 70

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

71

Exercises (Group B) E1-23B. Basic accounting equation (Learning Objective 5 ) 10–15 min. Determine the missing amounts in the following accounting equations.

Assets Corner Grocery, Corp. Sampson Hardware, Inc. Perfect Cleaners, Inc.

? $104,000 $108,800

Stockholders’ Equity

Liabilities   

$45,000 ? $92,600

  

$27,900 $44,000 ?

E1-24B. Basic accounting equation (Learning Objective 5 ) 10–15 min. Burnt Finger Restaurant had $84,000 of total assets and $56,000 of total stockholders’ equity at July 31, 2014. At July 31, 2015, Burnt Finger Restaurant had assets totaling $153,000 and stockholders’ equity totaling $91,000. After analyzing the data, answer the following questions: 1. What was the amount of the increase or decrease in liabilities? 2. Identify a possible reason for the change in liabilities during the year. E1-25B. Basic accounting equation (Learning Objective 5 ) 10–15 min. Candy’s Candies started a business in 2014 with total assets of $50,000 and total ­liabilities of $40,000. At the end of 2014, Candy’s Candies’ total assets were $57,000 and total liabilities were $8,000. After analyzing the data, answer the following questions: 1. What was the amount of the increase or decrease in stockholders’ equity? 2. Identify two possible reasons for the change in stockholders’ equity during the year. E1-26B. Using the accounting equation to determine net income (Learning Objectives 5 & 6 ) 15–20 min. The balance sheet data for Cindy’s Office Supplies, Co., at October 31, 2014, and November 30, 2014, follow:

Total Assets .......................................................................... Total Liabilities...................................................................... Common Stock ..................................................................... Total Stockholders’ Equity ....................................................

Oct 31, 2014

Nov 30, 2014

$127,000 92,000 15,000 ?

$165,000 119,000 15,000 ?

Requirement 1. The following are three independent assumptions about the business during November. For each assumption, compute the amount of net income or net loss during November 2014. Find the solution by preparing the statement of retained earnings. First, use the amounts of total assets, total liabilities, and common stock given previously and the accounting equation to determine the beginning and ending retained earnings amounts. Then plug those and the other amount given in each assumption into the statement of retained earnings to determine the net income or net loss.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 71

a. The business paid no dividends. b. The business paid $7,000 of dividends. c. The business paid $15,000 of dividends.

03/04/14 1:33 PM

72

Chapter 1 E1-27B. Transaction analysis (Learning Objective 5 ) 15–20 min. Samantha Luden opened a medical practice titled Samantha Luden M.D., Inc. During March, the first month of operations, the business experienced the following events:

Mar 2 6 11 15 17 19 22 30

Luden bought $45,000 of common stock in the business by opening a bank account in the name of Samantha Luden M.D., Inc. The business paid $20,000 cash for land with the intention of building an office building on the land. The business purchased medical supplies for $1,000 on account. The business officially opened for business. The business treated patients and earned service revenue of $11,000, receiving cash. The business paid office rent, $1,700. The business sold supplies to another doctor for $350 cash, the cost of those supplies. The business paid $700 on account related to the March 11 purchase. Requirement 1. Analyze the effects of these events on the accounting equation of the medical practice of Samantha Luden M.D., Inc. Use headings for Cash, Medical Supplies, Land, Accounts Payable, Common Stock, Service Revenue, and Rent Expense.

E1-28B. Types of business organizations and balance sheet preparation (Learning Objectives 5 & 6) 10–15 min. The following are the balances of the assets, liabilities, and equity of Julie’s Coffee Shop at October 31, 2014:

Cash......................................... Retained Earnings .................... Accounts Payable..................... Accounts Receivable ................

$19,000 12,550 800 1,400

Office Equipment........................ $14,200 Common Stock .......................... 18,000 Note Payable .............................. 4,000 Supplies ..................................... 750

Requirements 1. What type of business organization is Julie’s Coffee Shop? 2. Prepare the balance sheet of the business at October 31, 2014. 3. What does the balance sheet report?

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 72

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

73

E1-29B. Types of accounts and income statement preparation (Learning Objectives 5 & 6) 15–20 min. Selected accounts of Alden Consulting, Inc., a financial services business, have the following balances at December 31, 2014, the end of its first year of operations. During the year, Lorraine Alden, the only stockholder, bought $5,400 of stock in the business.

Office Furniture ...................... Utilities Expense..................... Accounts Payable................... Notes Payable ........................ Service Revenue .................... Accounts Receivable .............. Supplies Expense...................

$ 20,000 12,600 3,800 30,000 161,000 10,500 3,400

Rent Expense ........................... Cash......................................... Office Supplies......................... Salaries Expense ...................... Salaries Payable....................... Property Tax Expense .............. Equipment................................

$18,000 10,000 500 43,000 2,200 2,400 32,000

Requirements 1. Identify each as an asset, liability, revenue, or expense. 2. Prepare the income statement of Alden Consulting, Inc., for the year ended December 31, 2014. What is the result of operations for 2014? 3. Assuming the balance in Retained Earnings on December 31, 2014, was $21,600, what was the amount of the dividends during the year? Answer by preparing a statement of retained earnings to solve for the dividends. Recall that the business has just completed its first year and has no beginning balance for retained earnings. E1-30B. Using the accounting equation to determine net income (Learning Objectives 5 & 6) 15–20 min. Presented here is information for Hastings, Inc., for the year ended October 31, 2014.

Hastings, Inc. Beginning: Assets ............................................................................................................ Liabilities........................................................................................................ Ending: Assets ............................................................................................................ Liabilities........................................................................................................ Stockholders’ Equity: Sale of Stock .................................................................................................. Payment of Dividends ....................................................................................

$ 83,000 36,000 $162,000 31,000 $ 20,000 71,000

Requirements 1. What is the beginning stockholders’ equity of Hastings, Inc.? 2. What is the ending stockholders’ equity of Hastings, Inc.? 3. What is the net income or net loss for the year?

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 73

03/04/14 1:33 PM

74

Chapter 1

MyAccountingLab

Problems (Group A) P1-31A. Transaction analysis and the calculation of net income (Learning Objective 5) 20–25 min. Jill Stevens worked as an accountant at a local accounting firm for five years after graduating from college. Recently, she opened her own accounting practice, which she operates as a corporation. The name of the new entity is Stevens and Associates, Inc. Jill experienced the following events during the first month of operations. Some of the events were personal and did not affect the accounting practice. Others were business transactions and should be accounted for by the business.

Apr 3 5 7 9 10 14 20 27 30

Received $65,000 cash proceeds from refinancing her house. $50,000 of common stock in the business was sold to Jill Stevens. The cash proceeds were deposited in a new business bank account titled Stevens and Associates, Inc. Paid $600 cash for office supplies for the new accounting practice. Purchased $4,300 of office furniture for the accounting practice and agreed to pay the vendor within three months. Jill sold 1,200 shares of Ford stock, which she had owned for several years, receiving $15,600 cash. The cash from the sale of stock was deposited in her personal bank account. A representative of a large company telephoned Jill and told her of the company’s intention to hire Stevens and Associates, Inc., as its accountants. Finished accounting work for a client and sent the client a bill for $5,400. The client is expected to pay within two weeks. Paid office rent, $1,300. Paid $2,000 of dividends to shareholders of Stevens and Associates, Inc.

Requirements 1. Enter each transaction in the expanded accounting equation of Stevens and Associates, Inc., as needed, calculating new balances after each transaction. 2. Determine the following items: a. Total assets b. Total liabilities c. Total stockholders’ equity d. Net income or net loss for April

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 74

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

75

P1-32A. Income statement and balance sheet transactions; prepare the income statement and balance sheet (Learning Objectives 5 & 6) 25–30 min. Dennise Geary started an interior design company called Interiors by Dennise, Inc., on November 1, 2014. The following amounts summarize the financial position of her business on November 14, 2014, after the first two weeks of operations:

Assets

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock

Cash $1,660

Retained Earnings

Accounts Accounts Common Service Salaries  Receivable  Supplies  Equipment  Payable  Stock  Revenue  Expense  Dividends  $3,210  0  $26,000  $4,700  $21,640  $6,300  $1,770  0 During the remainder of November, the following events occurred: a. Geary received $20,000 as a gift and used it to buy common stock in the business. b. Paid off the beginning balance of Accounts Payable. c. Performed services for a client and received cash of $4,000. d. Collected cash from a customer on account, $1,100. e. Purchased supplies on account, $500. f. Consulted on the interior design of a major office building and billed the client for services performed, $3,500. g. Sold an additional $8,000 of common stock in the business. h. Incurred and paid salaries of $2,300. i. Sold supplies at cost to another interior designer for $180 cash. j. Paid dividends of $700 to Geary. Requirements 1. Enter the remaining transactions for the month of November into the expanded accounting equation, calculating new balances after each transaction. 2. Prepare the income statement of Interiors by Dennise, Inc., for the month ended November 30, 2014. 3. Prepare the statement of retained earnings of Interiors by Dennise, Inc., for the month ended November 30, 2014. 4. Prepare the balance sheet of Interiors by Dennise, Inc., at November 30, 2014.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 75

03/04/14 1:33 PM

76

Chapter 1 P1-33A. Prepare the income statement, statement of retained earnings, and balance sheet (Learning Objective 6) 20–25 min. The Classy Chassis, Inc., restores antique automobiles. The retained earnings balance of the corporation was $32,400 at December 31, 2013. During 2014, the corporation paid $25,000 in dividends to its stockholders. At December 31, 2014, the business’s ­accounting records show these balances:

Accounts Receivable ................ Note Payable ............................ Retained Earnings .................... Salaries Expense ...................... Equipment................................ Insurance Expense...................

$12,500 10,000 ? 38,000 82,400 4,600

Cash......................................... $ 14,800 Accounts Payable..................... 2,400 Advertising Expense................. 3,500 Service Revenue ...................... 106,000 Common Stock ........................ 30,000

Quick solution:

Requirement

a. Net income = $59,900

1. Prepare the following financial statements for The Classy Chassis, Inc.: a. Income statement for the year ended December 31, 2014 b. Statement of retained earnings for the year ended December 31, 2014 c. Balance sheet at December 31, 2014

b. Ending Retained earnings = $67,300 c.  Total assets = $109,700

P1-34A. Prepare the income statement and balance sheet; identify certain financial information (Learning Objective 6) 25–30 min. Presented here are the amounts of Assets, Liabilities, Stockholders’ Equity, Revenues, and Expenses of Fast and Fit, Inc., at March 31, 2014. The items are listed in alphabetical order.

Accounts Payable................... Accounts Receivable .............. Advertising Expense............... Building.................................. Cash....................................... Common Stock ...................... Dividends ............................... Equipment.............................. Insurance Expense.................

$ 16,000 22,000 15,000 125,000 16,000 35,000 28,000 45,000 2,300

Interest Expense .................... Land....................................... Note Payable .......................... Property Tax Expense ............ Rent Expense ......................... Salaries Expense .................... Salaries Payable..................... Service Revenue .................... Supplies .................................

$

6,000 35,000 62,000 3,500 23,000 92,000 3,000 166,000 1,900

The retained earnings balance of the business was $132,700 at March 31, 2013. Requirements 1. Identify each amount shown as an asset, liability, or stockholders’ equity. 2. Prepare the company’s income statement and statement of retained earnings for the year ended March 31, 2014. 3. Prepare the company’s balance sheet at March 31, 2014. 4. Answer these questions about the company: a. What was the profit or loss for the year? b. What was the increase or decrease of retained earnings for the year? c. What is the amount of economic resources on March 31, 2014? d. What is the amount owed on March 31, 2014?

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 76

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

77

P1-35A. Error analysis and preparation of balance sheet (Learning Objective 6) 20–25 min. The IT manager of Baldwin Realty, Inc., prepared the balance sheet of the company while the accountant was ill. The balance sheet contains numerous errors. In ­particular, the IT manager knew that the balance sheet should balance, so she plugged in the retained earnings amount to achieve this balance. The retained earnings amount, ­however, is not correct. All other amounts are accurate, but some are out of place.

Baldwin Realty, Inc. Balance Sheet Month Ended April 30, 2014 ASSETS Cash Rent Expense Supplies Expense Salaries Payable Equipment

Total Assets

$ 9,100 2,100 550 1,800 21,000

$34,550

LIABILITIES Accounts Payable Utilities Expense Accounts Receivable Notes Payable STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY Common Stock Supplies Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities & Stockholders’ Equity

$

650 850 2,300 6,000

15,000 700 9,050 24,750 $34,550

Requirement 1. Prepare a new, corrected balance sheet for Baldwin Realty, Inc.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 77

03/04/14 1:33 PM

78

Chapter 1

Problems (Group B) P1-36B. Transaction analysis and the calculation of net income (Learning Objective 5) 20–25 min. Davin Shore worked as an accountant at a local accounting firm for five years after graduating from college. Recently, he opened his own accounting practice, which he operates as a corporation. The name of the new entity is Shore and Associates, Inc. Davin experienced the following events during the first month of operations. Some of the events were personal and did not affect the accounting practice. Others were ­business transactions and should be accounted for by the business.

Jun 3 5 7 9 10 14 20 27 30

Received $60,000 cash proceeds from refinancing his house. $70,000 of common stock in the business was sold to Davin Shore. The cash proceeds were deposited in a new business bank account titled Shore and Associates, Inc. Paid $1,300 cash for office supplies for the new accounting practice. Purchased $3,500 of office furniture for the accounting practice and agreed to pay the vendor within three months. Davin sold 400 shares of Cooper stock, which he had owned for several years, receiving $40,000 cash. The cash from the sale of stock was deposited in his personal bank account. A representative of a large company telephoned Davin and told him of the company’s intention to hire Shore and Associates, Inc., as its accountants. Finished accounting work for a client and sent the client a bill for $3,800. The client is expected to pay within two weeks. Paid office rent, $2,400. Paid $700 of dividends to shareholders of Shore and Associates, Inc. Requirements 1. Enter each transaction in the expanded accounting equation of Shore and Associates, Inc., as needed, calculating new balances after each transaction. 2. Determine the following items: a. Total assets b. Total liabilities c. Total stockholders’ equity d. Net income or net loss for June

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 78

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

79

P1-37B. Income statement and balance sheet transactions; prepare the income statement and balance sheet (Learning Objectives 5 & 6) 25–30 min. Jill Schultz started an interior design company called Interiors by Jill, Inc., on June 1, 2014. The following amounts summarize the financial position of her business on June 14, 2014, after the first two weeks of operations:

Assets

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock

Cash $1,680

Retained Earnings

Accounts Accounts Common Service Salaries  Receivable  Supplies  Equipment  Payable  Stock  Revenue  Expense  Dividends 0 0  $4,130   $32,000  $3,100  $30,000  $9,170  $4,460  During the remainder of June, the following events occurred: a. Schultz received $10,000 as a gift and used it to buy common stock in the business. b. Paid off the beginning balance of Accounts Payable. c. Performed services for a client and received cash of $2,500. d. Collected cash from a customer on account, $2,130. e. Purchased supplies on account, $850. f. Consulted on the interior design of a major office building and billed the client for services performed, $6,200. g. Sold an additional $7,000 of common stock in the business. h. Incurred and paid salaries of $4,600. i. Sold supplies at cost to another interior designer for $250 cash. j. Paid dividends of $1,500 to Schultz. Requirements 1. Enter the remaining transactions for the month of June into the expanded ­accounting equation, calculating new balances after each transaction. 2. Prepare the income statement of Interiors by Jill, Inc., for the month ended June 30, 2014. 3. Prepare the statement of retained earnings of Interiors by Jill, Inc., for the month ended June 30, 2014. 4. Prepare the balance sheet of Interiors by Jill, Inc., at June 30, 2014.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 79

03/04/14 1:33 PM

80

Chapter 1 P1-38B. Prepare the income statement, statement of retained earnings, and balance sheet (Learning Objective 6) 20–25 min. McKnight, Inc., restores antique automobiles. The retained earnings balance of the corporation was $23,500 at December 31, 2013. During 2014, the corporation paid $40,000 in dividends to its stockholders. At December 31, 2014, the business’s ­accounting records show these balances:

Accounts Receivable ................ Note Payable ............................ Retained Earnings .................... Salaries Expense ...................... Equipment................................ Insurance Expense...................

$ 8,000 16,000 ? 13,000 65,000 8,000

Cash......................................... Accounts Payable..................... Advertising Expense................. Service Revenue ...................... Common Stock ........................

$17,000 9,000 5,500 88,000 20,000

Requirement 1. Prepare the following financial statements for McKnight, Inc.: a. Income statement for the year ended December 31, 2014 b. Statement of retained earnings for the year ended December 31, 2014 c. Balance sheet at December 31, 2014 P1-39B. Prepare the income statement and balance sheet; identify certain financial information (Learning Objective 6) 25–30 min. Presented here are the amounts of Assets, Liabilities, Stockholders’ Equity, Revenues, and Expenses of Alpha, Inc., at October 31, 2014. The items are listed in alphabetical order.

Accounts Payable................... Accounts Receivable .............. Advertising Expense............... Building.................................. Cash....................................... Common Stock ...................... Dividends ............................... Equipment.............................. Insurance Expense.................

$ 13,700 15,100 19,600 142,000 24,800 75,000 28,000 51,000 3,600

Interest Expense .................... Land....................................... Note Payable .......................... Property Tax Expense ............ Rent Expense ......................... Salaries Expense .................... Salaries Payable..................... Service Revenue .................... Supplies .................................

$

7,500 40,000 75,000 4,900 24,000 91,300 4,750 210,000 2,250

The retained earnings balance of the business was $75,600 at October 31, 2013. Requirements 1. Identify each amount shown as an asset, liability, or stockholders’ equity. 2. Prepare the company’s income statement and statement of retained earnings for the year ended October 31, 2014. 3. Prepare the company’s balance sheet at October 31, 2014. 4. Answer these questions about the company: a. What was the profit or loss for the year? b. What was the increase or decrease of retained earnings for the year? c. What is the amount of economic resources on October 31, 2014? d. What is the amount owed on October 31, 2014?

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 80

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

81

P1-40B. Error analysis and preparation of balance sheet (Learning Objective 6) 20–25 min. The IT manager of On Call Realty, Inc., prepared the balance sheet of the company while the accountant was ill. The balance sheet contains numerous errors. In ­particular, the IT manager knew that the balance sheet should balance, so she plugged in the retained earnings amount to achieve this balance. The retained earnings amount, ­however, is not correct. All other amounts are accurate, but some are out of place.

On Call Realty, Inc. Balance Sheet Month Ended November 30, 2014 ASSETS Cash Rent Expense Supplies Expense Salaries Payable Equipment

Total Assets

$31,000 1,800 500 1,100 8,100

$42,500

LIABILITIES Accounts Payable Utilities Expense Accounts Receivable Notes Payable STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY Common Stock Supplies Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities & Stockholders’ Equity

$ 2,500 900 3,200 7,000

10,000 580 18,320 28,900 $42,500

Requirement 1. Prepare a new, corrected balance sheet for On Call Realty, Inc.

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 81

03/04/14 1:33 PM

82

Chapter 1

Continuing Exercise This exercise is the first exercise in a sequence that begins an accounting cycle. The cycle is ­continued in Chapter 2 and completed in Chapter 3. Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., began operations and completed the following transactions during April:

Apr 1 3 5 6 8 17 30

Received $2,000 and issued 500 shares of common stock. Deposited this amount in a bank account in the name of Cole's Yard Care, Inc. Purchased on account a mower, $1,200, and weed whacker, $400. The equipment is expected to remain in service for four years. Purchased $90 of gas. Wrote check #1 from the new bank account. Performed lawn services for client on account, $225. Purchased $85 of fertilizer from the lawn store. Wrote check #2 from the new bank account. Completed landscaping job for client, received cash $850. Received $175 on account from services performed on April 6. Requirement 1. Analyze the effects of Cole’s Yard Care, Inc.’s transactions on the accounting equation. Include these headings: Cash, Accounts Receivable, Lawn Supplies, Equipment, Accounts Payable, Common Stock, Retained Earnings, Service Revenue, and Fuel Expense. Determine the ending balances in each account on April 30. In Chapter 2, we will account for these same transactions a different way—as the ­accounting is actually performed in practice.

Continuing Problem This problem is the first problem in a sequence that begins an accounting cycle. The cycle is continued in Chapter 2 and completed in Chapter 3. Greg Richards recently left his job at a local pool company to open his own pool and spa maintenance business. Greg Richards took all of the money he and his wife had in their personal savings account and used it to open Aqua Magic, Inc., on May 1, 2014. Presented next are the transactions for the first month of operations for Aqua Magic, Inc.:

May 1 3 7 12 15 16 18 21 27 30 31 31

Greg invested $35,000 cash and a used truck with a fair market value of $10,000 in the business in exchange for the company’s common stock. Paid $1,800 cash to purchase office equipment. Purchased $600 of supplies on account. Performed services for cash customers and received $1,350. Incurred and paid salaries of $625 to the office receptionist. Sold the company truck for $10,000. Signed a note payable for $36,200 to purchase a new truck. Performed $4,500 of services on account for a local hotel chain. Paid $300 of the amount owed from the purchase of supplies on May 7. Received $2,200 on account from credit customers. Received the utility bill for the month of May, $740. The bill is not due until June 15. Paid $2,500 dividends to the shareholder, Greg Richards. Requirements 1. Enter the transactions for Aqua Magic, Inc., for the month of May into the ­expanded accounting equation. Calculate the ending balances at May 31. 2. Prepare the income statement for Aqua Magic, Inc., for the first month of operations. 3. Prepare the statement of retained earnings for Aqua Magic, Inc., for the first month of operations. 4. Prepare the balance sheet for Aqua Magic, Inc., at May 31. 5. Did Greg make a wise decision leaving his job to start Aqua Magic, Inc.?

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 82

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

83

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem Let’s look at Target, one of the largest retailers found throughout the United States. Think about Target, all its stakeholders, what products it sells, and how and where it sells its products. Think about all the employees that work for Target and the assets that Target needs. Think about the business of Target. Now go to Target’s Web site at www.target.com. Next, scroll to the bottom of the page and look for the heading “about Target” and click on “company information.” There you’ll find ­information about Target’s business. Explore the menu options available in “Our Company” and in “Investors” in order to find the answers to these questions: 1. What is the mission statement of the business? What does it say about value? 2. What type of business is Target? Is it a service company, a merchandise company, or a manufacturing company? 3. What products does Target sell? Where does it get the products it sells? 4. Who are Target’s customers? 5. Now look at Target’s stock price. At the beginning of February 2013 you would pay approximately $62 to own one share of Target’s stock. When you add all the shares of stock together, Target is valued at approximately $40 billion. That’s a considerable amount of money. Do you think Target is worth $40 billion? What role do you think accounting plays in helping owners (stockholders) decide the value of Target?

Apply Your Knowledge Ethics in Action Case 1. Lisa Hill and her husband Mike were the owners of LM Enterprises, Inc. They applied for a small business loan, and the bank requested the most recent business financial statements. When Lisa compiled the balance sheet, she noticed that the business’s assets and related stockholders’ equity were small. Accordingly, she told Mike that they should contribute some of their personal assets to the business so the assets and equity would appear much larger and thus the bank would more likely agree to the business loan. Mike agreed that the balance sheet would appear stronger with more assets and equity, but his concern was with the income statement. The sales for the latest period were low, which resulted in a slight net loss because expenses were slightly higher than revenues. Mike reasoned that contributing assets would show a stronger ­balance sheet but felt something had to be done to also improve the income statement. He then told Lisa that their business could “sell” back some of the assets they had contributed and report higher sales on the income statement, which would result in net income rather than the actual net loss. Lisa did not feel comfortable buying back assets from their business just to increase ­reported sales. Discuss any ethical concerns you may have with Lisa’s proposal. Discuss any ethical concerns you may have with Mike’s proposal. Do you think it is ethical for a business to “dress up” its financial statements when applying for a loan? Case 2. Blackstone, Inc., was in the final phase of completing a land development project it started earlier in the year. Blackstone, Inc., had acquired 50 acres of raw land for $400,000 and then spent an additional $1,700,000 in land development costs to create a new subdivision with 100 residential lots. With a total cost of $2,100,000 and 100 lots, each lot had a cost of $21,000; however, the lots were listed for sale at $48,000 per lot. Blackstone, Inc., was applying for a business loan and needed to provide current financial statements to the bank. Amy Clark, the company president, wanted to report the total current value of the lots, $4,800,000 (100 lots x $48,000 per lot), rather than the total cost currently listed on the balance sheet, $2,100,000. Dan Sullivan, the company accountant, told Amy that the lots were inventory and that they should be reported on the balance sheet at the $2,100,000 rather than the fair market value. Should the balance sheet for Blackstone, Inc., list the lots at the total cost of $2,100,000 or the total selling price of $4,800,000? Could Blackstone, Inc., provide one balance sheet using historical cost and another balance sheet using market value?

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 83

03/04/14 1:33 PM

84

Chapter 1

Know Your Business Financial Analysis Purpose: To help familiarize you with the financial reporting of a real company in order to further your understanding of the chapter material you are learning. Each chapter will have a financial statement case that will focus on material contained in that chapter. You will be asked questions and will then refer to Appendix A at the end of the book where you will find the annual report for Columbia Sportswear Company. Use the annual report to answer these questions. As you progress through each chapter, you will gain a real ­understanding of actual corporate financial reporting in addition to the basic accounting concepts you are learning within each textbook chapter. This added learning experience will reinforce your understanding of accounting. Requirements 1. Look at all the financial statements starting on page 690 of Appendix A  and see whether you can identify the balance sheet, income statement, and statement of cash flows. (Note that the term Consolidated simply means “combined.”) 2. What was the total amount of assets Columbia Sportswear reported as of December 31, 2012? (Keep in mind that the numbers are in thousands.) Did the total assets increase or decrease from December 31, 2011? 3. Did you see that Columbia Sportswear titled its income statement “Statements of Operations”? Were you able to identify it? (Note that some companies use this title.) 4. What was the total amount of revenues (net sales) Columbia Sportswear ­reported for the year ended December 31, 2012? (Keep in mind that the numbers are in thousands.) Did the revenues increase or decrease from the previous years presented?

Industry Analysis Purpose: To help you understand and compare the performance of two companies in the same industry. Go to the Columbia Sportswear Company Annual Report located in Appendix A and find the Consolidated Balance Sheets on page 692. Now access the 2012 Annual Report for Under Armour, Inc. To do this from the Internet, go to the company’s Web page at http://www.underarmour.​ com. At the bottom of the page under Business Info, click on Investor Relations. Next, click on Financials on the left-hand side of the page and then click on Annual Report and Proxy. Now, on the right-hand side of the page, look for the link to download the 2012 annual report. The Consolidated Balance Sheet is located on page 48. Columbia Sportswear Company and Under Armour, Inc., are in the same industry, which is manufacturing and selling sportswear. It is helpful to compare a company’s financial data against other companies in their industry. Requirement 1. Look at the data from the Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2012, for each of the companies. Which company’s stockholders have a higher claim to their company’s assets? To find out, divide the total stockholders’ equity for each company by its total liabilities and stockholders’ equity.

Small Business Analysis Purpose: To help you understand the importance of cash flows in the operation of a small business. You have just received your year-end financial statements from your CPA and you notice one very disturbing item. The net income from your income statement shows $36,000! Your very first thought is “where is it?” Then you look at your cash balance and see that it decreased $8,000

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 84

03/04/14 1:33 PM

Business, Accounting, and You

85

from last year to this year. You’re thinking there has to be something wrong here. So you call up your CPA and ask for a meeting to discuss this obvious error. After all, how can you possibly have a positive net income and have your cash balance decrease? At the meeting, the CPA lays out the financial statements in front of you and begins to ­explain how this would have happened. Following are a condensed income statement, statement of retained earnings, and balance sheet:

BCS Consultants, Inc. Income Statement For the Year Ended December 31, 2014 $142,000 106,000 $ 36,000

Total Revenue Total Expenses Net Income

BCS Consultants, Inc. Statement of Retained Earnings For the Year Ended December 31, 2014 Beginning Retained Earnings Net Income Dividends Paid Ending Retained Earnings

$ 84,000 $ 36,000 (15,000)

21,000 $105,000

BCS Consultants, Inc. Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 & 2013 Assets: Cash Equipment Total Assets Liabilities: Notes Payable—Bank Stockholder’s Equity: Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

2014

2013

$ 30,000 158,000 $188,000

$ 38,000 146,000 $184,000

$ 58,000

$ 75,000

25,000 105,000 130,000 $188,000

25,000 84,000 109,000 $184,000

Requirement 1. By looking at the three financial statements, can you anticipate what the CPA is going to tell you about why the cash decreased even though you had net income for the year? What changed from 2013 to 2014? Are transactions that affect the income statement the only transactions that affect your cash balance?

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 85

03/04/14 1:33 PM

86

Chapter 1

Written Communication You just received an e-mail from a potential new client who contacted you from your Web site. This client has indicated to you that he or she is planning to start a new business. The client would like to find out from you what different types of business organizations are available. Also, the client is wondering exactly what role an accountant would have in the running of his or her business. Requirement 1. Prepare an e-mail to this potential client addressing his or her questions about the different types of business organizations and why he or she needs to have an ­accountant involved in the business. Self Check Answers 1. c 2. d 3. c 4. c 5. a 6. b 7. b 8. c 9. a 10. d 11. true 12. c

M01_KEMP9543_03_GE_C01.indd 86

03/04/14 1:33 PM

2 Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions Business, Accounting, and You Walk into your local Target and look around. What do you see? You see people browsing, making decisions to buy or not to buy, and taking their purchases to the checkout. You see Target employees helping customers. You see many business transactions occurring simultaneously. You see business in action. Now, think about it. How does Target keep up with the cause and effect of all those transactions? How does a business keep track of all its assets, liabilities, revenue, costs, and other activities? There must be a “scorekeeper” or systematic process that recognizes, measures, records, and reports these business transactions in an understandable, reliable, and relevant manner. That’s the role of accounting in business. To ensure accounting information is understandable, reliable, and relevant, accountants have rules. GAAP, as noted in Chapter 1, set the rules for recognizing

Learning Objectives 1 Define accounts and understand how they are used in accounting

2 Explain debits, credits, and the double-entry system of accounting

3 Demonstrate the use of the general journal and the general ledger to record business transactions

4 Use a trial balance to prepare financial statements

87

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 87

03/04/14 1:39 PM

88

Chapter 2

and measuring the business transactions. This part of the process will be explored throughout the book. However, the rules for recording and reporting business transactions are based on a set of proven techniques that have evolved over time. The result is a set of standard, universally accepted procedures that work. The key to using these techniques and procedures is understanding: (1) accounts and (2) doubleentry accounting. So why is this important to you? Whether you want to be an accountant or manager, you need to understand how business transactions are recorded. The final report card, good or bad, is a result of this recording process. Would you want to play a game where you do not understand how the score is recorded and ultimately reported? Probably not. Understanding how accountants record business transactions is very important.

Real World Accounting Video In the Real World Accounting Video, Julie Gaines, owner and manager of Fishs Eddy, talks about what it means to own and operate a business. Look at the video. Think about what Julie is saying. And then realize how important accounting is to the ­success of a business.

How Are Accounts Used to Keep Business Transactions Organized? 1

Define accounts and understand how they are used in accounting

Accounts  The basic summary ­device of accounting; the detailed record of all the changes in a specific asset, liability, or stockholders’ equity item as a result of transactions.

As we discussed in Chapter 1, accounting provides useful information to various users. In order for the information to be useful, it has to be detailed. Therefore, to convey the detail required, accountants will create many categories in which to track information. These categories are referred to as accounts. We have already seen accounts in use. When recording transactions in the accounting equation in Chapter 1, we created accounts such as Cash, Equipment, and Accounts Payable.

Organizing Accounts Numbering helps keep the accounts organized. Account numbers usually have two or more digits. The first digit indicates the type of account. Generally, if an account starts with: • • • • •

1, it is an asset account. 2, it is a liability account. 3, it is a stockholders’ equity account other than a revenue or expense account. 4, it is a revenue account. 5, it is an expense account.

Accounts that start with 6, 7, 8, or 9 are used by some businesses to record special types of accounts such as other revenues and expenses. After the first digit, the remaining digits in an account number are used to specify the exact account. For example, Cash may be numbered 101 and Accounts Receivable may be numbered 131. A gap in numbers is usually left between the different accounts to ­allow for additional accounts to be added later. A listing of all of the accounts is referred

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 88

03/04/14 1:39 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions Chart of accounts  A list of all the accounts of a business and the numbers assigned to those accounts.

89

to as a chart of accounts. The accounts are typically listed in the chart of accounts in the order that they appear in the accounting equation. Therefore, assets would be listed first, followed by the liabilities, and then the stockholders’ equity accounts. Typical types of accounts for many businesses are as follows:

Assets As described in Chapter 1, assets represent things of value that a business has. Most businesses use the following asset accounts:

Promissory note  A written pledge to pay a fixed amount of money at a later date.

• Cash. Cash typically includes the business’s bank account balance, paper currency, coins, and checks. • Accounts Receivable. A business may sell goods or services in exchange for a promise of a future cash receipt. Such sales are said to be made on credit or on ­account. The Accounts Receivable account reflects the amounts that customers owe the business for goods or services that have already been provided. In other words, it shows how much money the company can expect to receive from customers in the future. • Notes Receivable. A business may sell goods or services or loan money and ­receive a promissory note. A note receivable is a written promise that the customer or ­borrower will pay a fixed amount of money by a certain date. Notes Receivable reflects the amount of the promissory notes that the business expects to collect in cash at a later date. • Prepaid Expenses. A business often pays certain expenses, such as rent and insurance, in advance. A prepaid expense is an asset because the prepayment provides a f­ uture benefit for the business. A separate asset account is used for each prepaid e­ xpense. Prepaid Rent and Prepaid Insurance are examples of prepaid expense accounts. • Land. The Land account is used to keep track of the cost of land a business owns and uses in its operations. • Buildings. The cost of a business’s buildings, offices, warehouses, etc. is recorded in the Buildings account. • Equipment, Furniture, and Fixtures. A business typically has a separate asset account for each type of equipment. Examples include Computer Equipment, Office Equipment, Store Equipment, and Furniture and Fixtures.

Liabilities As defined in Chapter 1, liabilities are amounts owed to third parties. A business generally has fewer liability accounts than asset accounts because a business’s liabilities can be summarized in a few categories such as: • Accounts Payable. A business may purchase goods or services in exchange for a promise of future payment. Such purchases are said to be made on credit or on account. The Accounts Payable account reflects how much cash the business must pay to suppliers for goods or services that have already been received. • Notes Payable. Notes Payable represents amounts the business must pay because it signed promissory notes to borrow money or to purchase goods or services. • Accrued Liabilities. An accrued liability is a liability for an expense that has been incurred but has not yet been paid. Taxes Payable, Interest Payable, and Salaries Payable are examples of accrued liability accounts.

Stockholders’ Equity As we saw in Chapter 1, the owners’ claim to the assets of the business is called Stockholders’ Equity. We have already discussed the different types of stockholders’ ­equity accounts and what they’re used for, but they are listed here again for review.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 89

03/04/14 1:39 PM

90

Chapter 2

• Common Stock. The Common Stock account represents the investment of assets, usually cash, the stockholders have invested into a business in exchange for the company’s stock. • Retained Earnings. The Retained Earnings account tracks the cumulative earnings of the business since it began, less any dividends given to stockholders. • Revenues. Increases in Retained Earnings (and, therefore, Stockholders’ Equity) created by selling goods or services to customers are called revenues. This account represents amounts earned by the company even if the company has not yet been paid for the goods and services provided. A business may have several revenue accounts depending on how many ways it earns its revenue. • Expenses. Expenses are decreases in Retained Earnings (and, therefore, Stockholders’ Equity) from using resources to deliver goods and services to customers. A business needs a separate account for each type of expense, such as Insurance Expense, Rent Expense, Salaries Expense, and Utilities Expense. Businesses often have numerous expense accounts because many different types of costs are associated with providing goods and services to customers. • Dividends. This account reflects the amount of earnings that have been distributed to the stockholders. Dividends decrease Retained Earnings (and, therefore, Stockholders’ Equity).

What Is Double-Entry Accounting? 2 Explain debits, credits, and the double-entry system of accounting

Double-entry accounting  The rule of accounting that specifies ­every transaction involves at least two ­accounts and is recorded with equal amounts of debits and credits. Debit  The left side of any account; an entry made to the left side of an account. Credit  The right side of any account; an entry made to the right side of an account. T-account  An informal account form used to summarize transactions, where the top of the T holds the account title and the base divides the debit and credit sides of the account.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 90

In Chapter 1, we learned that every time we entered a transaction in the accounting equation, it affected at least two accounts. In accounting, the requirement that every transaction affect at least two accounts is called double-entry accounting. In order to simplify the process of accounting, each account is broken down into two sides. This can be visualized as a large T. For each account, one side of the T will represent an increase to the account, while the other side represents a decrease. Whether it is the left side of the T or the right side that increases the account depends on the type of account. Some accounts will increase on the left side and some will increase on the right side. In accounting terms, the left side of an account is referred to as the debit side. The right side of an account is referred to as the credit side. An example of a T-account is as follows:

Account Title Debit  left side Dr.

Credit  right side Cr.

Although T-accounts are not an official accounting tool, accounting professors use them to help students visualize the accounts. When first learning accounting, it can be very confusing trying to understand why some accounts are increased with debits (on the left side) while other accounts are increased with credits (on the right side). However confusing this might be, it was designed this way for a purpose. In addition to the rule that states that assets must always equal liabilities plus stockholders’ equity, another accounting rule states that in every transaction the dollar amount of debits must equal the dollar amount of credits. By requiring that the amount of debits always equals the amount of credits and having some accounts increase with debits and other accounts increase with credits, the accounting equation is automatically kept in balance. Exhibit 2-1 shows the accounting equation with T-accounts under each type of account along with which side of the account increases it or decreases it. When trying to learn which accounts are increased with debits and which accounts are increased with credits, it is helpful to think of the acronym ADE and the acronym LCR. In the acronym ADE, the A stands for Assets, the D for Dividends, and the E for Expenses. These accounts are increased on the debit side (think of the DE in ADE). In

03/04/14 1:39 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

91

the acronym LCR, the L stands for Liabilities, the C stands for Common Stock, and the R stands for both Revenues and Retained Earnings. These accounts are increased on the credit side (think of the CR in LCR).

Assets

Liabilities

Assets

Liabilities

Debit + Bal

Credit –

Debit –

Credit + Bal

Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock Debit –

Credit + Bal

Retained R i d Earnings Debit –

Credit + Bal

Dividends Debit + Bal

Credit –

Revenues Debit –

Credit + Bal

Expenses Debit + Bal

Credit –

Exhibit 2-1

Accounting in Your World Jill recently purchased something over the phone and used her debit card to pay for it. When she checked her bank account activity online, the bank “debited” her account when it took money out of her account to pay for the purchase. Jill read in the textbook that a debit would increase her cash account. Now Jill is really confused.

=

Debit

= ?

Many students feel this way when first introduced to debits and credits. It is really just a matter of perspective. You see, your bank account is an asset to you because it represents cash that is yours. However, your account is a liability to the bank because it represents money that the bank owes you. So, when the bank removes money from your account, it will debit the account to lower the liability because it no longer owes you the money. This is why it is called a debit card. You would actually need to credit your cash account, an asset, to show a decrease to your cash. Because you view your account as an asset and the bank views it as a liability, what you do (debit or credit) to the account to increase or decrease it will be exactly opposite of what the bank does.

Asset

You

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 91

Liability

Your Account

Bank

03/04/14 1:39 PM

92

Chapter 2

Normal Balance Normal balance  The balance that appears on the side of an account where increases are recorded; the expected balance of an account.

You would expect an account to have a positive balance; therefore, the normal balance of an account is on the increase side of an account: • Assets increase on the debit side, so the normal balance of an asset is on the debit side. • Liabilities increase on the credit side, so the normal balance of a liability is on the credit side. • Common Stock increases on the credit side, so the normal balance of this account is on the credit side. • Retained Earnings increases on the credit side, so the normal balance of this account is on the credit side. • Dividends increase on the debit side, so the normal balance of the Dividends account is on the debit side. • Revenues increase on the credit side, so the normal balance of a revenue is on the credit side. • Expenses increase on the debit side, so the normal balance of an expense is on the debit side.

How Are the General Journal and General Ledger Used to Keep Track of Business Transactions? 3 Demonstrate the use of the general journal and the general ledger to record business transactions

General journal  The chronological accounting record of the transactions of a business. Record  Entering a transaction in a journal; also called journalize. Transaction  An event that has a financial impact on a business entity.

Although it would be possible to enter transactions directly into the T-accounts, if we were to try to do this for a real company, it would become very cumbersome and inefficient. Accountants need to enter transactions efficiently and in a timely manner. In order to do this, the general journal was created. The general journal is a chronological, or date order, record of the transactions of a business. The general journal can be compared to an individual person’s diary. Like an individual person’s diary, the general journal is a place to record events that have affected the business. Recording a transaction in the general journal is referred to as journalizing the transaction. To record a journal entry: 1. Record the date. 2. Record the debit part of the entry by entering the account title and then entering the amount in the debit column. 3. Record the credit part of the entry on the next line by indenting the account title and then entering the amount in the credit column. 4. Write an explanation describing the entry. Exhibit 2-2, Panel A, describes a transaction, and Panel B shows how this transaction is

General ledger  The accounting record summarizing, in accounts, the transactions of a business and showing the resulting ending account balances. Posting  Copying information from the general journal to accounts in the general ledger.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 92

entered in the journal. The page number of the journal appears in its upper-right corner. Because the information in the general journal is organized by date and not by account, the information that it provides is not very useful. In order to be more useful, information must be organized by account. Therefore, the general ledger was created. The general ledger is a grouping of all the accounts of a business with their balances. It shows the amount of Assets, Liabilities, and the Stockholders’ Equity accounts on a given date. Once transactions have been entered in the general journal, the information is then transferred to the general ledger. The process of transferring information from the general journal to the general ledger is called posting. Posting simply means copying the amounts from the journal to the ledger. Debits in the journal are posted as debits in

03/04/14 1:39 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

93

PANEL A—Illustrative Transaction: DATE Jan 1, 2014

TRANSACTION Osborne Consulting, Inc., sold $10,000 of common stock to Cindy Osborne, who was investing cash in the business.

PANEL B—Journal: DATE Jan 1, 2014

PANEL C—Ledger:

ACCOUNTS Cash Common Stock Sold stock. 1

2

Cash DATE 2014 Jan 1

ITEM

3 POST REF. J.1

Common Stock DATE 2014 Jan 1

POST REF. 111 311

ITEM

POST REF. J.1

DEBIT

Page 1 CR. 10,000

4

CREDIT

10,000

DEBIT

DR. 10,000

Account No. 111 BALANCE DEBIT CREDIT 10,000

CREDIT 10,000

Account No. 311 BALANCE DEBIT CREDIT 10,000

Exhibit 2-2

the ledger, and credits in the journal are posted as credits in the ledger. Exhibit 2-2, Panel C, demonstrates how an entry is posted from the journal to the ledger. The posting process demonstrated in Exhibit 2-2 includes four steps. The four steps required to post the first part of the journal entry are as follows:

Posting reference  A notation in the journal and ledger that links these two accounting records together.

Arrow ❶ Copy the transaction date from the journal to the Cash account in the ledger. Arrow ❷ Copy the journal page number from the journal to the posting ­reference column in the Cash account in the ledger. “J.1” refers to Journal page 1. This provides a reference that links the entry in the ­ledger back to the journal. Arrow ❸ Copy the dollar amount of the debit, $10,000, from the journal as a debit into the Cash account in the ledger. Arrow ❹ Copy the account number, 111, from the Cash account in the ledger back to the posting reference column in the journal. This step indicates that the $10,000 debit to Cash was posted to the Cash account in the ledger. The journal entry is posted to Cash first because this is the first account listed in the entry. Once posting to Cash is complete, repeat the process to post the entry to Common Stock. The account format that is utilized in Panel C of Exhibit 2-2 is called a fourcolumn account. The first pair of debit and credit columns contains the individual transaction amounts that have been posted from journal entries, such as the $10,000 debit. The second pair of debit and credit columns is used to show the account’s balance after each entry. Posting used to be performed on a periodic basis, such as daily or weekly. However, most modern computerized accounting systems post transactions immediately after they have been entered.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 93

03/04/14 1:39 PM

94

Chapter 2

Transaction Analysis To properly record, or journalize, transactions in the general journal, it is helpful to complete a five-step process. Steps 1 through 4 analyze the transaction for the journal entry and Step 5 reflects the journalizing of the transaction and the posting from the journal into the accounts in the general ledger. The five-step process is as follows:

Step 1 What accounts are involved? Example: Cash, Accounts Payable, Salaries Expense, etc.



Step 2 For each account involved, what type of account is it? Is it an asset, a liability, or one of the stockholders’ equity accounts? Example: Cash is an asset.



Step 3 Is the account balance increasing or decreasing? Example: If you receive cash, then that account increases.



Step 4 Should the account be debited or credited? Example: Cash is an asset and it increases; increases in assets are recorded as debits.



Step 5 Record the entry and post to the accounts in the general ledger. The five-step analysis looks like the following in chart form: Step 1 Accounts Affected

Step 2

Step 3

Step 4

Step 5

Type

cT

Dr. or Cr.

Journalize entry and post to ledger

Applying Transaction Analysis Check out how the transactions for the first month of operations for Osborne Consulting, Inc., are analyzed and recorded. These transactions were examined in Chapter 1 for a new computer consulting business. For illustration purposes, journal entries are shown being posted to T-accounts within the accounting equation. In actual practice, the journal entries would be posted to four-column accounts in the general ledger. 1. Sale of stock. The business sold Cindy Osborne $10,000 of common stock for cash.

Analysis of Transaction (1)

Step 1 What accounts are involved? The business received cash in exchange for stock, so the accounts involved are Cash and Common Stock.



Step 2 What type of account is it? Cash is an asset. Common Stock is an account within stockholders’ equity.



Step 3 Does the account balance increase or decrease? Because cash was received, Cash is increased. Common Stock also increased because there has been more stock issued.



Step 4 Do you debit or credit the account in the journal entry? According to the rules of debits and credits, an increase in an asset is recorded with a debit. An increase in Common Stock is recorded with a credit.

The first four steps can be summarized as follows:

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 94

1 Accounts Affected

2 Type

3 cT

4 Dr. or Cr.

Cash Common Stock

Asset Stockholders’ Equity

c c

Dr. Cr.

03/04/14 1:39 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions



95

Step 5 Journalize and post the transaction as follows:

GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account 1

Debit

Cash

Creditt

10,000 Common Stock

GENERAL LEDGER

10,000 00

Balance Sheet Assets

Liabilities

Cash

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Retained Earnings

Dividends

Revenues

Expenses

Common Stock

10,000

10,000

Notice that the name of the account being credited is indented in the journal. This format is a standard way to differentiate the accounts that are credited from the accounts that are debited. Also, note again that every transaction affects at least two accounts and that the total amount added to the debit side equals the total amount added to the credit side. This demonstrates doubleentry accounting, which keeps the accounting equation in balance. 2. Purchase supplies on credit. Osborne Consulting purchases office supplies agreeing to pay $350 within 30 days.

Analysis of Transaction (2)

Step 1 The business received supplies in exchange for a promise to pay cash to the supplier next month. The accounts involved in the transaction are Supplies and Accounts Payable.



Step 2 Supplies is an asset; Accounts Payable is a liability.



Step 3 The asset Supplies is increased. The liability Accounts Payable is increased because the business owes more than it did before this transaction.



Step 4 An increase in the asset Supplies is a debit; an increase in the liability Accounts Payable is a credit.



1 Accounts Affected

2 Type

3 cT

4 Dr. or Cr.

Supplies Accounts Payable

Asset Liability

c c

Dr. Cr.

Step 5 Journalize and post the transaction as follows:

GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account 2

Supplies Accounts Payable

Debit

Credit

350 350 50

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Cash 10,000

Liabilities

Accounts Payable 350

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Reta Retained Earnings Earn

Dividends

Revenues

Expenses

Common Stock 10,000

Supplies 350

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 95

03/04/14 1:39 PM

Chapter 2

96

3. Purchase equipment for cash. The business purchases equipment, paying cash of $4,000.

Analysis of Transaction (3)

Step 1 The business received equipment in exchange for cash paid to the equipment manufacturing company. The accounts involved in the transaction are Equipment and Cash.



Step 2 Equipment and Cash are both assets.



Step 3 The asset Equipment is increased. The asset Cash is decreased because a check was written to pay for the equipment.



Step 4 An increase in the asset Equipment is a debit; a decrease in the asset Cash is a credit.



1 Accounts Affected

2 Type

3 cT

4 Dr. or Cr.

Equipment Cash

Asset Asset

c

Dr. Cr.

T

Step 5 Journalize and post the transaction:

GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account 3

Equipment

Debit

Credit

4,000

Cash

4,000 00

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Cash 10,000 4,000

Liabilities

Accounts Payable

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Retained Reta Earnings Earn

Dividends

Revenues

Expenses

Common Stock

350

10,000

Supplies 350

Equipment 4,000

4. Borrow cash from the bank. Osborne Consulting borrows $12,000 cash from the bank and signs a two-year note payable to the bank.

Analysis of Transaction (4)

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 96



Step 1 Osborne Consulting received cash from the bank in exchange for a signed note agreeing to pay the cash back in two years. The accounts involved in the transaction are Cash and Notes Payable.



Step 2 Cash is an asset; Notes Payable is a liability.



Step 3 The asset Cash is increased. The liability Notes Payable is also increased because it represents an obligation owed to the bank.



Step 4 An increase in the asset Cash is a debit; an increase in the liability Notes Payable is a credit. 1 Accounts Affected

2 Type

3 cT

4 Dr. or Cr.

Cash Notes Payable

Asset Liability

c c

Dr. Cr.

03/04/14 1:39 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions



97

Step 5 Journalize and post the transaction as follows:

GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account 4

Debit

Cash

Credit

12,000 Notes Payable

12,000 00

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Cash

Accounts Payable

10,000 4,000 12,000

Supplies

Liabilities

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Retained Reta Earnings Earn

Dividends

Revenues

Expenses

Common Stock

350

10,000

Notes Payable

350

12,000

Equipment 4,000

5. Provide services for cash. Osborne collects $1,200 of cash for services provided.

Analysis of Transaction (5)

Step 1 The business received cash in exchange for computer consulting services. The accounts involved in the transaction are Cash and Service Revenue.



Step 2 Cash is an asset; Service Revenue is a revenue.



Step 3 The asset Cash is increased. The revenue Service Revenue is increased also because the business has earned revenue by providing services.



Step 4 An increase in the asset Cash is a debit; an increase in the revenue Service Revenue is a credit.



1 Accounts Affected

2 Type

3 cT

4 Dr. or Cr.

Cash Service Revenue

Asset Revenue

c c

Dr. Cr.

Step 5 Journalize and post the transaction as follows:

GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account 5

Cash

Debit

Credit

1,200 Service Revenue

1,200 00

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Cash 10,000 4,000 12,000 1,200

Supplies 350

Liabilities

Accounts Payable 350

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Common Stock 10,000

Retained Reta Earnings Earn

Dividends

Revenues

Expenses

Service Revenue 1,200

Notes Payable 12,000

Equipment 4,000

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 97

03/04/14 1:39 PM

98

Chapter 2

6. Provide services on credit. Osborne Consulting performs $1,900 of services on account.

Analysis of Transaction (6)

Step 1 Osborne Consulting received promises from customers to send cash next month in exchange for consulting services provided. Again, the business earned this money, although it has not received it yet. The accounts involved in the transaction are Accounts Receivable and Service Revenue.



Step 2 Accounts Receivable is an asset; Service Revenue is a revenue.



Step 3 The asset Accounts Receivable and the revenue Service Revenue are both increased.



Step 4 An increase in the asset Accounts Receivable is a debit; an increase in the revenue Service Revenue is a credit. 1 Accounts Affected

2 Type

3 cT

4 Dr. or Cr.

Accounts Receivable Service Revenue

Asset Revenue

c c

Dr. Cr.



Step 5 Journalize and post the transaction as follows:

GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account 6

Accounts Receivable

Debit

Credit

1,900

Service Revenue

1,900 00

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Cash 10,000 4,000 12,000 1,200

Supplies 350

Liabilities

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Accounts Payable 350

Reta Retained Earnings Earn

Dividends

Common Stock 10,000

Revenues

Expenses

Service Revenue 1,200 1,900

Notes Payable 12,000

Equipment 4,000

Accounts Receivable 1,900

7. Partial payment of accounts payable. Osborne Consulting pays $150 to the store where it purchased $350 worth of supplies in Transaction (2).

Analysis of Transaction (7)

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 98



Step 1 Osborne Consulting paid $150 of the $350 that it owed to a supplier. The accounts involved in the transaction are Accounts Payable and Cash.



Step 2 Accounts Payable is a liability; Cash is an asset.



Step 3 The liability Accounts Payable is decreased. The asset Cash is also decreased.

03/04/14 1:39 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions



99

Step 4 A decrease in the liability Accounts Payable is a debit; a decrease in the asset Cash is a credit.



1 Accounts Affected

2 Type

3 cT

4 Dr. or Cr.

Accounts Payable Cash

Liability Asset

T T

Dr. Cr.

Step 5 Journalize and post the transaction as follows:

GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account 7

Accounts Payable

Debit

Credit

150

Cash

150 50

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Cash

Accounts Payable

10,000 4,000 12,000 150 1,200

Supplies

Liabilities

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Retained Reta Earnings Earn

Dividends

Common Stock

150 350

Revenues

Expenses

Service Revenue

10,000

1,200 1,900

Notes Payable

350

12,000

Equipment 4,000

Accounts Receivable 1,900

8. Payment of expenses. During the month, Osborne Consulting paid cash of $1,700 for expenses incurred such as salaries ($600), building rent ($900), and utilities ($200).

Analysis of Transaction (8)

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 99



Step 1 The business paid $1,700 in exchange for employee services, the use of the building, and for utilities consumed as part of operating the business. The accounts involved in the transaction are Salaries Expense, Rent Expense, Utilities Expense, and Cash.



Step 2 Salaries Expense, Rent Expense, and Utilities Expense are expenses; Cash is an asset.



Step 3 The expense accounts are increased. The asset Cash is decreased.



Step 4 An increase in an expense is a debit; a decrease in the asset Cash is a credit. 1 Accounts Affected

2 Type

3 cT

4 Dr. or Cr.

Salaries Expense Rent Expense Utilities Expense Cash

Expense Expense Expense Asset

c c c T

Dr. Dr. Dr. Cr.

03/04/14 1:39 PM

Chapter 2

100



Step 5 Journalize and post the transaction:

GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account 8

Debit

Credit

Salaries Expense

600

Rent Expense

900

Utilities Expense

200

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet

Income Statement

1,700 00

Cash

Assets

Cash

Accounts Payable

10,000 4,000 12,000 150 1,200 1,700

Supplies

Liabilities

Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock

Reta Retained Earnings Earn

Dividends

Revenues ues

Common Stock

150 350

Service Revenue

10,000

1,200 1,900

Notes Payable

350

Expenses

Salaries Expense 600

Rent Expense

12,000

900

Equipment

Utilities Expense

4,000

200

Accounts Receivable 1,900

Compound journal entry  A journal entry that affects more than two accounts.

As we can see by this entry, it is possible to have more than two accounts utilized in an entry. This is referred to as a compound journal entry. Note that the total amount of debits must still equal the total amount of credits. 9. Cash dividends. Osborne Consulting pays $500 of cash dividends to Cindy Osborne, the stockholder.

Analysis of Transaction (9)

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 100



Step 1 The stockholder received cash dividends. The business reduced the stockholders’ equity interest because of dividends paid to the stockholder. The accounts involved in the transaction are Dividends and Cash.



Step 2 Dividends is an account within stockholders’ equity and Cash is an asset.



Step 3 The Dividends account is increased because dividends have been paid. The asset Cash is decreased.



Step 4 An increase in Dividends is a debit; a decrease in the asset Cash is a credit.

1 Accounts Affected

2 Type

3 cT

4 Dr. or Cr.

Dividends Cash

Stockholders’ Equity Asset

c T

Dr. Cr.

03/04/14 1:39 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions



101

Step 5 Journalize and post the transaction:

GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account 9

Debit

Dividends

Credit

500

Cash

500 00

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Cash 10,000 4,000 12,000 150 1,200 1,700 500

Liabilities

Accounts Payable

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Reta Retained Earnings Earn ings

Common Stock

150 350

Dividends

Dividends

Service Revenue

500

10,000

1,200 1,900

Notes Payable

Supplies

Revenues ues

Expenses

Salaries Expense 600

Rent Expense

12,000

900

350

Utilities Expense

Equipment 4,000

200

Accounts Receivable 1,900

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analyze

When does a business recognize and record a transaction?

Examine the transaction to determine its impact, if any, on the company’s accounting equation.

If the transaction immediately ­increases or decreases assets, liabilities, or ­stockholders’ equity, then the transaction should be recorded in the ­company’s accounting records.

Balancing the T-Accounts Balance  The difference between an account’s total debit and total credit amounts; the ending value of an account.

After the transactions are recorded and posted to the T-accounts, you will calculate each account’s balance. The ending balance is the difference between the account’s total debits and its total credits. Every account has a beginning and ending balance as shown as “Bal” in the following T-account: Cash (1) Bal (2) (4) Bal

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 101

0 (3) 1,000

101 300

700

03/04/14 1:39 PM

102

Chapter 2

The numbers (1) through (4) for different entries in the Cash T-account above are explained below. (1) The beginning balance for the current accounting period is the ending balance brought forward from the previous period. In this example, the business is new, so its beginning balance is $0. (2) If, for example, the business receives $1,000 from the sale of stock during the first ­accounting period, this transaction will show up as a debit to the Cash account. (3) If the company then pays $300 cash for supplies purchased, the amount will be ­entered on the credit side of the Cash account. (4) Because the company just started, this account had a beginning debit balance of $0. Add increases of $1,000 that appear on the debit side, and subtract decreases of $300 that appear on the credit side. The resulting ending balance of Cash is $700. The Cash account normally has a debit balance because debits increase this account. A horizontal line separates the transaction amounts from the account balance at the end of an accounting period. The “Bal 700” under the horizontal line shows that the balance in Cash at the end of the accounting period was $700. In the next accounting period, this balance will be the new beginning balance and will change as the business receives more cash and pays out more cash. If an account’s total debits are more than its total credits, then that account has a debit ending balance. If an account’s total credits are more than its total debits, then that account has a credit ending balance. The ending balance of any T-account can be found in the same way that we just did for the Cash account. The ending balances for Osborne Consulting are seen below. Please note that the ending balances for the T-accounts are indicated by double underlines.

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Cash 10,000 4,000 12,000 150 1,200 1,700 500 16,850

Supplies 350

Liabilities ties

Accounts Payable 150 350 200

Notes Payable 12,000

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Common Stock 10,000

Reta Retained Earnings Earnings

Dividends 500

Dividends

Revenues

Service Revenue 1,200 1,900 3,100

Expenses

Salaries Expense 600

Rent Expense 900

Equipment

Utilities Expense

4,000

200

Accounts Receivable 1,900

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 102

03/04/14 1:39 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

103

Try it… During the month of September, Powers, Inc. had transactions that resulted in the following amounts being recorded in its Cash account; $1,200 debit, $250 credit, $875 debit, $2,125 credit, $350 credit, and a $400 debit. Powers, Inc.’s cash balance at the beginning of September was $2,450. Enter the amounts from above in a T-account to determine Power’s, Inc.’s cash balance at the end of September.

Answer: Cash Bal

Bal

2,450 1,200 875 400 2,200

250 2,125 350

How Is a Trial Balance Prepared, and What Is It Used For? 4 Use a trial balance

to prepare financial statements

Trial balance  A list of all the accounts of a business and their ­balances; its purpose is to verify that total debits equal total credits.

Accounting period  Generally, the time period reflected by a set of financial statements.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 103

Once transactions have been recorded in the journal and posted to accounts in the ledger, a trial balance is prepared. The first step in preparing a trial balance is to complete the heading. Similar to the financial statements that were prepared in Chapter 1, the heading should show the company name, the statement name, and the date of the trial balance. Next, the name of each account is entered into the first column of the trial balance in the order that the account appears in the general ledger. Now, two columns are created labeled “debit” and “credit,” and the balance of each account is entered into the correct column. Finally, the debit and credit columns are totaled. As was done when preparing the financial statements in Chapter 1, the first and last amount in each column have a dollar sign placed before them, and the last amounts in both columns are double underlined. It should be noted that the trial balance is not an “official” financial statement. Its purpose is to summarize all account balances to be certain that total debits equal total credits after the entries have been journalized and posted. A trial balance can be prepared at any time, but is most commonly done at the end of the accounting period. An accounting period is usually defined as a month, a quarter, or a year. Exhibit 2-3 shows the trial balance for Osborne Consulting, Inc., after all transactions have been journalized and posted for January 2014.

03/04/14 1:39 PM

104

Chapter 2

Osborne Consulting, Inc. Trial Balance January 31, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Equipment Accounts Payable Notes Payable Common Stock Dividends Service Revenue Rent Expense Salaries Expense Utilities Expense Total

DEBIT $16,850 1,900 350 4,000

CREDIT

$

200 12,000 10,000

500 3,100 900 600 200 $25,300

$25,300

Exhibit 2-3

Stop and Think… Jill just completed a problem that was assigned in her accounting class. She told Alan, one of her classmates, that she was confident that she did the problem correctly because the debits equal the credits on the trial balance. According to Alan, just because the debits equal the credits on the trial balance, it does not mean that everything was done correctly. Who is right, Jill or Alan?

Answer

Alan is correct. The following are some of the errors that can occur and yet the trial ­ balance will still be in balance:

• A transaction can be recorded for the wrong amount in a journal entry. • An entire journal entry can be recorded twice or not recorded at all. • The wrong accounts can be debited or credited in a journal entry. For example, when recording a payment on an account payable, it is possible to debit Accounts Receivable instead of Accounts Payable.

Correcting Errors If an error has occurred, the steps required to correct it depend on the type of error that was made. If a journal entry has been made to the wrong accounts or for the wrong amount, it is easiest to reverse, or undo, the incorrect entry. A new entry should then be prepared that contains the correct accounts or amount. To correct an entry that has been made twice, one of the entries should be reversed. If an entry was erroneously omitted, it simply needs to be entered.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 104

03/04/14 1:39 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

105

Preparation of Financial Statements After completing the trial balance, you can use it to prepare the financial statements because it shows all of the accounts with their balances. First, set up the financial statements as we did in Chapter 1. Now, using the account balances from the trial balance, insert the account names and their balances into the financial statements, starting with the income statement, then the statement of retained earnings, and finishing with the balance sheet. Make sure the balance sheet is in balance! That is, total Assets equal total Liabilities plus Stockholders’ Equity. Exhibit 2-4 on the following page shows the income statement and statement of ­retained earnings for the month ended January 31, 2014, and the balance sheet at January 31, 2014, for Osborne Consulting, Inc. You can see once again how the information flows from one statement to another.

Osborne Consulting, Inc. Income Statement Month Ended January 31, 2014 Revenue: Service Revenue Expenses: Rent Expense Salaries Expense Utilities Expense Total Expenses Net Income

$3,100 $900 600 200 1,700 $1,400

Osborne Consulting, Inc. Statement of Retained Earnings Month Ended January 31, 2014 $

0 1,400 1,400 500 $ 900

Retained Earnings, January 1, 2014 Add: Net Income for the month Subtotal Less: Dividends Retained Earnings, January 31, 2014

Osborne Consulting, Inc. Balance Sheet January 31, 2014 ASSETS Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Equipment

Total Assets

$16,850 1,900 350 4,000

$23,100

LIABILITIES Accounts Payable Notes Payable Total Liabilities STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities & Stockholders’ Equity

$

200 12,000 12,200

10,000 900 10,900 $23,100

Exhibit 2-4

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 105

03/04/14 1:39 PM

106

Chapter 2

Accounting cycle  The sequence of steps used to record and report business transactions.

These statements look the same as they did in Chapter 1, except now on the income statement we see detailed information for revenues and expenses. Also, notice that the income statement now has two columns. Many students assume, erroneously, that these columns represent debits and credits as they did on the trial balance. On financial statements, columns are used in order to make the statement more organized and easier to read; they are not used to signify debits and credits. The process of analyzing transactions, entering them into the journal, posting them to the ledger, preparing a trial balance, and preparing financial statements is only a part of what is called the accounting cycle. This accounting cycle is completed by a business for every accounting period, and then it is repeated for the next accounting period, and the next, and the next, and so on. The following is a visual representation of the accounting cycle: Step One

Step Eight

Recognize, measure and journalize transactions

Prepare a post-closing trial balance

Step Two Post transactions to the general ledger

Step Seven

Step Three

Journalize and post closing entries

Prepare an unadjusted trial balance

Step Six

Step Four

Prepare financial statements

Journalize and post adjusting entries

Step Five Prepare an adjusted trial balance

In the next chapter, you will learn the remaining steps in the accounting cycle, which include preparing adjusting and closing entries.

Focus On Decision Making How Does Accounting Report Business Transactions?

Think of the school you are attending. What are some of the transactions that are conducted every day at your school? How would the following transactions be recorded? Make sure you think through each of these transactions and understand that you need to acknowledge the total transaction. 1. You enroll in class and pay the school your tuition. 2. Your school hires your teacher, who teaches your class. 3. Your school pays the utilities that make your classroom comfortable. 4. You buy a ticket to an athletic event, concert, or other special activity. 5. Your school pays for advertising to promote the athletic event, concert, or other special activity.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 106

03/04/14 1:39 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

107

Managers need good information about all the aspects of a business transaction. They need accounting systems to recognize, measure, record, and report the entire transaction. Financial statements must report the total transaction and how everything in a business works together.

How They Do It: A Look at Business

Businesses produce income by using assets financed with money. Think about Target, the large discount retailer. Target buys and sells goods such as clothing, groceries, electronics, and toys. Target sells these goods in large buildings. To earn more net income, Target tries to sell more goods. However, as sales increase, Target needs more assets. The more assets Target has, the more financing it needs. It needs money to finance the growing amount of clothing, groceries, electronics, and toys it sells. It also needs money to finance new and bigger buildings. Target gets this money from either borrowing the money (which increases Target’s liabilities) or from its owners (stockholders’ equity). For the year ended February 2, 2013, Target had revenues of $73.3 billion, expenses of $70.3 billion, and net income of $3 billion. As of February 2, 2013, Target had assets of $48.2 billion. These assets were financed with liabilities of $31.6 billion and stockholders’ equity of $16.6 billion. As can be seen by comparing its 2012 and 2013 financial statements, Target grew its assets. For the year ended January 28, 2012, Target had revenues of $69.9 billion, expenses of $66.9 billion, and net income of $3 billion. As of January 28, 2012, Target had assets of $46.6 billion, liabilities of $30.8 billion, and stockholders equity of $15.8 billion. Target increased its assets, and thus its financing, in hopes of seeing net income increase in the future. Now think about IBM. IBM, the large technology firm, helps its customers implement solutions to technological challenges and opportunities. IBM sells physical goods such as computers. However, more than goods, IBM sells the services of its people. As IBM sells more goods, it needs more assets and thus financing. However, if IBM sells more services, it may not need more assets like Target does. Today, IBM is shifting its focus to selling more services than goods. We can see that in its financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2012, IBM had revenues of $104.5 billion, expenses of $87.9 billion, and net income of $16.6 billion. At December 31, 2012, IBM had assets of $119.2 billion, liabilities of $100.2 billion, and stockholders’ equity of $19 billion. For the year ended December 31, 2011, IBM had revenues of $106.9 billion, expenses of $91.0, and net income of $15.9 billion. At December 31, 2011, IBM had assets of $116.4 billion, liabilities of $96.2 billion, and stockholders’ equity of $20.2 billion. Now think about it. IBM’s total revenue decreased, but net income increased. IBM is changing how it does business by selling more services and fewer computers. IBM services have lower costs. This change is making IBM more competitive and valuable. IBM increased net income in 2012 by 4.4% by changing what it does and the ­resources it needs. As you can see from the comparison of IBM and Target, each transaction affects the business in many ways. Accountants must communicate all these effects when they recognize, measure, record, and report business transactions using financial statements. Financial statements report how the transactions all come together.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 107

03/04/14 1:39 PM

108

Chapter 2

Summary MyAccountingLab

1 Define accounts and

understand how they are used in accounting

Here is what you should know after reading this chapter. MyAccountingLab will help you identify what you know and where to go when you need practice.

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Numbered accounts are used to keep things organized. Account numbers starting with:

Accounts (p. 88)

• 1, assets

Chart of accounts (p. 89) Promissory note (p. 89)

• 2, liabilities • 3, stockholder’s equity other than revenues and expenses • 4, revenues • 5, expenses • 6 through 9, other

2 Explain debits, credits, and the double-entry system of accounting

Debits and credits are used to record changes in an account’s balance. • Debits increase assets, expenses, and dividends. • Credits increase liabilities, common stock, retained earnings, and revenues. • Debits decrease liabilities, common stock, retained earnings, and revenues.

Credit (p. 90) Debit (p. 90) Double-entry accounting (p. 90) Normal balance (p. 92) T-account (p. 90)

• Credits decrease assets, expenses, and dividends.

3 Demonstrate the use of the general journal and the general ledger to record business transactions

Business transactions are:

Compound journal entry (p. 100)

• Entered into the general journal.

Balance (p. 101)

• Posted from the general journal to the general ledger.

General journal (p. 92) General ledger (p. 92) Journalize (p. 92) Posting (p. 92) Posting reference (p. 93) Record (p. 92) Transaction (p. 92)

4

Use a trial balance to prepare financial statements

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 108

A trial balance:

Accounting cycle (p. 106)

• Ensures that debits equal credits.

Accounting period (p. 103)

• Is used to prepare the Income Statement, Statement of Retained Earnings, and Balance Sheet.

Trial balance (p. 103)

03/04/14 1:39 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

109

Accounting Practice Discussion Questions 1. The order in which assets were listed and described in the text is the order in which you will see them listed on the balance sheet. What is the organizing principle behind the order in which assets are listed? 2. What type of transaction would result in the recording of a prepaid asset? What do you think will happen to that prepaid asset eventually? 3. How is revenue related to retained earnings? 4. Distinguish between an event and a transaction. Are all transactions events? Are all events transactions? Why or why not? What are the implications of your answers with respect to journal entries? 5. What is a “normal balance”? What are normal balances for the following accounts? a. Accounts Receivable b. Prepaid Expenses c. Notes Payable d. Retained Earnings e. Salaries Expense 6. You learned in this chapter that Cash is increased with a debit. When you deposit your paycheck in your account, however, the teller might say that he or she is going to credit your account. Why? 7. What would be the implications of a credit balance in the Cash account? 8. Distinguish between journalizing and posting. 9. True or false: If the trial balance is in balance, the financial statements will be accurate. Why or why not? 10. When it is time to prepare the financial statements, from where do the financial statement numbers come?

Self Check 1. Which sequence of actions correctly summarizes the accounting process? a. Prepare a trial balance, journalize transactions, post to the accounts b. Journalize transactions, post to the accounts, prepare a trial balance c. Post to the accounts, journalize transactions, prepare a trial balance d. Journalize transactions, prepare a trial balance, post to the accounts 2. The left side of an account is used to record a. debits. b. increases. c. credits. d. debits or credits, depending on the type of account. 3. Suppose Green Products, Inc., has cash of $41,000, receivables of $37,000, and furniture and fixtures totaling $174,000. Green Products, Inc., owes $64,000 on account and has a $125,000 note payable. How much is the stockholders’ equity? a. $127,000 b. $189,000 c. $63,000 d. $252,000

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 109

03/04/14 1:39 PM

110

Chapter 2 4. Cathy’s Catering, Inc., purchased $200 of supplies on account. The journal entry to record this transaction is denoted by which of the following? DATE a.

b.

c.

d.

ACCOUNTS Supplies Accounts Receivable

POST REF.

DR. 200

CR. 200

Supplies Accounts Payable

200

Inventory Accounts Payable

200

Accounts Payable Supplies

200

200

200

200

5. Posting a $500 purchase of supplies on account appears as which of the following?

a.

Supplies

Accounts Payable

500

b.

cc..

Cash

500

Supplies

500

Accounts Payable

500

Supplies

dd..

Supplies

500

Accounts Receivable

500

500

500

6. Which journal entry records obtaining a bank loan of $10,000? DATE a.

b.

ACCOUNTS Notes Payable Cash Cash

POST REF.

DR. 10,000

10,000 10,000

Notes Payable c.

d.

CR.

10,000

Notes Payable Accounts Receivable

10,000

Cash

10,000 Accounts Payable

10,000

10,000

7. RV Wholesale, Inc., paid $1,200 for supplies and purchased additional supplies on account for $1,000. RV Wholesale, Inc., also paid $200 of the accounts payable. What is the balance in the Supplies account? a. $1,200 b. $1,000 c. $2,400 d. $2,200

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 110

03/04/14 1:40 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

111

8. The Blue Ox Restaurant recorded a cash collection on account by debiting Cash and crediting Accounts Payable. What will the trial balance show for this error? a. Too much for liabilities b. Too much for assets c. The trial balance will not balance. d. Both a and b 9. Christopher Foley, an attorney, has a law corporation, Christopher Foley, Attorney, Inc., that began the year with total assets of $145,000, total liabilities of $70,000, and stockholders’ equity of $75,000. During the year, Christopher Foley, Attorney, Inc., earned revenue of $125,000 and paid expenses of $35,000. Christopher Foley, Attorney, Inc., also sold an additional $24,000 of stock and paid $10,000 in dividends. How much is the stockholders’ equity in Christopher Foley, Attorney, Inc., at year-end? a. $235,000 b. $155,000 c. $179,000 d. $199,000 10. The entry to record the payment of $1,500 rent expense would be which of the following?

DATE a.

b.

ACCOUNTS Rent Expense Cash Cash

POST REF.

DR. 1,500

1,500 1,500

Rent Expense c.

d.

CR.

1,500

Rent Expense Accounts Payable

1,500

Accounts Payable Rent Expense

1,500

1,500

1,500

11. According to the Real World Accounting Video, businesses take risks to earn a profit. True or False? 12. According to the Real World Accounting Video, ________ is a profitability measure that shows how much net income is earned on every dollar of sales. a. sales ratio b. expense ratio c. asset financing ratio d. profit margin ratio Answers are given after Written Communication.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 111

03/04/14 1:40 PM

112

Chapter 2

MyAccountingLab

Short Exercises S2-1. Accounting terms (Learning Objective 1) 5–10 min. Match the accounting terms at the left with the corresponding definitions at the right. 1. Account

a. Any economic event that has a financial impact on the business.

2. Assets

b. The detailed record of the changes in a particular asset, liability, or stockholders’ equity.

3. Stockholders’ c. Economic resources that provide a future benefit for Equity a business. 4. Expenses

d. Debts or obligations of a business.

5. Liabilities

e. Stockholders’ claim to the assets of a corporation.

6. Revenues

f. Increases in stockholders’ equity from selling goods or services to customers.

7. Transactions

g. Decreases in stockholders’ equity from using resources to sell goods or services.

S2-2. Account types (Learning Objective 1) 5–10 min. For each of the following accounts, place the corresponding letter(s) of its account type in the space provided. Use the most detailed account type appropriate. (A) Asset  (L) Liability  (SE) Stockholders’ Equity  (R) Revenue  (E) Expense SE

Dividends 1. Accounts Payable 2. Cash 3. Service Revenue 4. Prepaid Rent 5. Rent Expense 6. Common Stock

S2-3. Accounting cycle steps (Learning Objectives 2, 3, & 4) 5–10 min. The following list names the activities involved in the accounting process of recording and summarizing business transactions. Place the number corresponding with the order the activity occurs next to the activity, starting with 1.   1    Transaction occurs.        Prepare the financial statements.        Prepare the trial balance.         Post the transactions from the journal to the ledger.        Record the transactions in the journal.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 112

03/04/14 1:40 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

113

S2-4. Account types (Learning Objective 1) 5–10 min. For each of the following accounts, indicate the account type by labeling it as an asset (A), liability (L), stockholders’ equity (SE), revenue (R), or expense (E). Also give the digit each account number would begin with in the chart of accounts. Use the most detailed account type appropriate.   A,1    Land       1. Service Revenue       2. Dividends   

   3. Accounts Receivable

  

   4. Salaries Expense

  

   5. Notes Payable

  

   6. Common Stock

  

   7. Rent Expense

S2-5. Accounting terminology (Learning Objectives 2, 3, & 4) 5–10 min. Demonstrate your knowledge of accounting terminology by filling in the blanks to ­review some key definitions. Dillon Baker is describing the accounting process for a friend who is a psychology ­major. Dillon states, “The basic summary device in accounting is the _______. The left side of an account is called the _______ side, and the right side is called the _______ side. We record transactions first in a _______. Then we post, or copy, the data to the _______. It is helpful to list all the accounts with their balances on a _______ _______.” S2-6. Effects of debits and credits on accounts (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. For each of the following accounts, indicate if the account’s normal balance is a debit balance (DR) or a credit balance (CR). DR

Cash 1. Rent Expense 2. Accounts Payable 3. Service Revenue 4. Office Furniture 5. Common Stock 6. Land 7. Dividends

S2-7. Balancing accounts and normal balances (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Calculate each account balance.

3/8 3/17

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 113

Supplies

1322

250 3/27 800

400

Note Payable 3/20 3/31

1,250 3/5 4,500

221 9,500

03/04/14 1:40 PM

114

Chapter 2 S2-8. Types of accounts and effects of debits and credits (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. For each item below, indicate whether a debit or credit applies. 1. Decrease in Prepaid Insurance ________ 2. Increase in Commission Revenue ________ 3. Decrease in Unearned Revenue ________ 4. Increase in Dividends ________ 5. Decrease in Interest Receivable ________ 6. Increase in Depreciation Expense ________ 7. Decrease in Notes Payable ________ 8. Increase in Supplies ________ S2-9. Recreating journal entries from T-account postings (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Eight transactions are recorded in the following T-accounts:

Cash (1) (7)

45,000 (2) 22,500 (3) (4) (6) ((8))

Accounts Receivable 3,500 0 0 1,700 5 3,225 8,000 0 7,500 , 0

(5)

((2))

13,500 ,

Service Revenue ((5))

1,700 ,

(1)

45,000 0

(8)

Accounts Payable 8,000 (2)

27,000

Dividends

Common Stock

(6)

22,500

Office Equipment

Prepaid Insurance ((3))

27,000 (7)

7,500

Gasoline Expense 10,000 0

(4)

3,225

Indicate for each debit and each credit: (a) whether an asset, liability, common stock, dividends, revenue, or expense account was affected and (b) whether the account was increased (+) or decreased (–). Answers should be presented in the following chart form:

Transaction No.

Account Debited Type Effect

(1)

Asset

(Example)

+

Account Credited Type Effect Common Stock

+

(2) S2-10. Journalizing transactions (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Cindy Anderson opened a dental practice in Spokane, Washington as a corporation. The following transactions took place in August:

Aug 1 5 7 10

Sold $50,000 of common stock to Anderson to start the business. Purchased dental supplies on account, $6,300. Paid monthly office rent of $1,000. Provided $3,800 of dental services to patients. Received cash of $1,200 for these services and sent bills to patients for the remainder.

Using the steps outlined in the five-step transaction analysis, record the transactions in the journal.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 114

03/04/14 1:40 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

115

S2-11. Journalizing transactions (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. After operating for a month, Rosa Anderson’s dental practice completed the following transactions during September:

Sep 3 9 16 22 30 30

The business borrowed $35,000 from the bank, signing a note payable. Performed service for patients on account, $1,250. Received cash on account from patients, $500. Received a utility bill, $380, which will be paid during October. Paid the monthly salary to its dental assistant, $2,250. Paid interest expense of $170 on the bank loan.

Using the steps outlined in the five-step transaction analysis, record the transactions in the journal. S2-12. Prepare trial balance (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. The accounting records for Audio Masters, Corp., contain the following amounts on April 30, 2014. The accounts appear in no particular order.

Service Revenue ...................... Prepaid Rent ............................ Accounts Payable..................... Equipment................................ Dividends .................................

$63,000 750 1,700 21,000 22,600

Utilities Expense....................... Note Payable ............................ Cash......................................... Rent Expense ........................... Common Stock ........................

$18,400 11,500 18,300 10,150 15,000

Prepare the trial balance for Audio Masters at April 30, 2014. List the accounts in proper order. S2-13. Preparation of financial statements from a trial balance (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 5–10 min. Selected transactions from the journal of Wael, Inc. during its first month of operations are presented here. Date Aug. 1 10 12

25 31

ACCOUNT TITLES Cash Common Stock Cash Service Revenue Equipment Cash Notes Payable Accounts Receivable Service Revenue Cash Accounts Receivable

DEBIT $ 20,000

CREDIT $ 20,000

3,200 3,200 12,000 1,000 11,000 3,500 3,500 900 900

Requirements 1. Post the transactions to T-accounts. 2. Prepare a trial balance at August 31, 2014.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 115

03/04/14 1:40 PM

116

Chapter 2 S2-14. Accounting terminology (Learning Objectives 1, 2, 3, & 4) 5–10 min. Accounting has its own vocabulary and basic relationships. Match the accounting terms at the left with the corresponding phrase at the right. 1. Posting

a. Chronological record of transactions.

2. Normal balance

b. An asset.

3. Payable

c. Left side of an account.

4. Journal

d. Side of an account where increases are recorded.

5. Receivable

e. Copying data from the journal to the ledger.

6. Chart of accounts

f. List of all accounts with their balances.

7. Debit

g. A liability.

8. Trial balance

h. List of all of the accounts of a business.

9. Credit

MyAccountingLab

i. Right side of an account.

Exercises (Group A) E2-15A. Journalizing transactions (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 10–15 min. The following are six transactions for Wissam Printing, Inc., during the month of May. 1. Stockholders invest $190,000 cash to start the business. 2. Purchased three photocopy machines for $600,000, paying $200,000 cash and signing a 5-year, 4% note for the remainder. 3. Purchased $6,000 paper supplies on credit. 4. Cash received for photocopy services amounted to $9,000. 5. Paid $800 cash for TV advertising. 6. Paid $600 on account for paper supplies purchased in transaction 3. Requirement 1. Complete the following table. For each transaction shown, determine the accounts affected, the type of account, whether the account increased or decreased, and whether it would be recorded in the journal on the debit or credit side.

Transaction Number 1

Accounts Affected

Account Type

Dr. or Cr.

Cash Common Stock

Assets Stockholder’s equity

Dr. Cr.

E2-16A. Journalizing transactions (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. These transactions relate to Auberge Agency.

Oct. 1 2 3 6 10 27 30

Stockholders invested $45,000 in exchange for common stock of the corporation. Hires an assistant at an annual salary of $24,000. Buys office equipment for $2,500 on account. Sells a house on account for M Houssam; $15,000 commission due from him. Receives cash of $180 as commission. Pays $500 on account for equipment purchased on October 3. Pays the assistant $2,000 in salary for October. Requirements a. Journalize the transactions. Do not provide explanations. b. Post the transactions to T-accounts.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 116

03/04/14 1:40 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

117

E2-17A. Journalizing transactions (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. Journalize the following business transactions in general journal form. 1. Stockholders invest $80,000 in exchange for common stock of the corporation. 2. Purchased office supplies worth $1,500 on credit. 3. Purchased furniture for $25,000, paying $3,500 in cash and signed a 30-day, $21,500 note payable. 4. Commissions billed to clients amount to $8,000. 5. Paid $500 in cash for the current month’s rent. 6. Paid $500 cash on account for office supplies purchased in transaction 2. 7. Received a bill for $600 for utilities for the current month. 8. Paid $3,000 cash for office salaries. 9. Paid $1,400 cash dividends to stockholders. 10. Received a check of $2,500 from a client in payment on account of commissions billed in transaction 4. E2-18A. Balance accounts and prepare trial balance (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 10–15 min. The transactions for Tiny Tykes Daycare, Inc., for the month of October 2014 are posted in the following T-accounts.

Cash Oct 1 6 23 Bal

25,000 Oct 4 6,700 9 1,400 29

111 1 13,500 0 0 300 0 1,600

Accounts Receivable 112 2 Oct 17 Bal

Oct 2 Bal

2,300 Oct 23

1,400

Supplies

113 3

Equipment Oct 4 Bal

Oct 9

Service Revenue

13,500

Accounts Payable

211 11

300 Oct 2 Bal

0 450

Common Stock

311 11

Oct 1 Bal

450

115 15

Oct 6 17 Bal

411 6,700 2,300

Salaries Expense Oct 29 Bal

501

1,600

25,000 0

Quick solution:

Requirements

1. Cash balance = $17,700

1. Calculate account balances at October 31, 2014.

2. Trial balance totals = $34,150

2. Prepare the trial balance for Tiny Tykes Daycare, Inc., at October 31, 2014. E2-19A. Record transactions and prepare a trial balance (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 15–20 min. Baily Realty, Inc., had the following transactions for the month of March 2014.

Mar 2 4 8 11 15 19 27 31

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 117

Paid Rent Expense, $1,000. Performed service for a customer and received cash, $1,100. Purchased supplies on account, $100. Received cash from credit customers on account, $2,600. Sold an additional $45,000 of Common Stock. Paid $450 on account. Performed service for customers on account, $3,300. Made a payment on the Notes Payable, $6,000.

03/04/14 1:40 PM

118

Chapter 2 The following T-accounts have been set up for Baily Realty, Inc., with their beginning balances as of March 1, 2014.

Cash Mar 1

1111

212

Mar 1

9,000

2,800

Mar 1

Common Stock

113 3

311

Mar 1

30,750

550

Office Furniture

Service Revenue

114 14

Mar 1

411 2,600

2,900

Building Mar 1

400

Notes Payable

112 2

Supplies

Mar 1

211

Mar 1

5,000

Accounts Receivable Mar 1

Accounts Payable

116 16

Rent Expense Mar 1

511

1,500

30,000

Requirements 1. Journalize the transactions for the month of March. Explanations are not required. 2. Post the journal entries to the appropriate T-accounts. Identify all items by date. 3. Calculate the balance of each account at March 31, 2014. 4. Prove that the total of all the debit balances equals the total of all of the credit balances by preparing a trial balance at March 31, 2014. E2-20A. Journalize transactions, prepare a trial balance and balance sheet (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 20–25 min. The transactions for Rawlins Equipment, Inc., for the month of September 2014 have been posted to the accounts as follows:

Cash (1)

53,000 (4) (5) (6)

Supplies 7,5000 5,5000 5000

(2)

750

500 (2)

Notes Payable 7500

(5)

5,500 (3)

Building

7,500

(4)

Accounts Payable (6)

Equipment

140,000

(3)

Common Stock

140,0000

(1)

53,000

Requirements 1. Prepare the journal entries that served as the sources for the six transactions. 2. Calculate the ending balance in each account. 3. Prepare the trial balance for Rawlins Equipment, Inc., at September 30, 2014. 4. Prepare a balance sheet for Rawlins Equipment, Inc., as of September 30, 2014.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 118

03/04/14 1:40 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

119

E2-21A. Journalizing, posting, trial balance, income statement, and balance sheet (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 25–30 min. Munro Consulting, Inc., completed the following transactions during November 2014, its first month of operations:

Nov 2 3 6 8 11 19 20 28

Sold $80,000 of common stock to Darryl Munro to start the consulting practice. Paid monthly office rent, $1,700. Paid cash for a new computer, $1,800. Purchased office furniture on account, $1,200. Purchased supplies on account, $400. Performed consulting service for a client on account, $2,600. Paid utility expenses, $500. Performed service for a client and received cash for the full amount of $1,600.

Requirements 1. Open, or set up, T-accounts in the ledger for the following accounts: Cash, Accounts Receivable, Supplies, Equipment, Furniture, Accounts Payable, Common Stock, Service Revenue, Rent Expense, and Utilities Expense. 2. Record transactions in the journal. Explanations are not required. 3. Post the journal entries to the T-accounts, identify all items by date. Calculate the ending balance in each account. 4. Prepare a trial balance at November 30, 2014. 5. Prepare the income statement, statement of retained earnings, and balance sheet. E2-22A. Error correction (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. Allie Murphy has trouble keeping her debits and credits equal. During a recent month, Allie made the following errors: a. Allie recorded a $450 payment of rent by debiting rent expense for $45 and crediting Cash for $45. b. In recording an $800 payment on account, Allie debited Accounts Receivable and credited Cash. c. Allie recorded the receipt of cash for service revenue by debiting Cash for $640 ­instead of the correct amount of $460. Allie also credited Service Revenue for $640, the incorrect amount. d. Allie recorded a $275 purchase of supplies on account by debiting Accounts Payable and crediting Supplies. e. In preparing the trial balance, Allie omitted a $30,000 note payable. Requirements 1. For each of these errors, state whether Allie’s mistake would cause the total debits and total credits on the trial balance to be unequal. 2. Identify each account with an incorrect balance, and indicate the amount and ­direction of the error. Use the following format:

Effect on Trial Balance Total debits  Total credits

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 119

Account(s) Misstated Cash $405 too high Rent Expense $405 too low

03/04/14 1:40 PM

120

Chapter 2

Exercises (Group B) E2-23B. Journalizing transactions (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 10–15 min. The following are six journal entries KLP Engineering, Inc., made during the month of April.

Apr 1 3 5 9 12 17

Paid advertising expense, $340. Paid $7,800 cash to purchase a new piece of equipment. Issued common stock in exchange for $18,000 cash. Borrowed $12,000 on a note payable from the bank. Paid monthly telephone bill, $280. Purchased supplies for $165, paid cash.

Requirement 1. For each transaction shown, determine the accounts affected, the type of account, whether the account increases or decreases, and whether it would be recorded in the journal on the debit or credit side. The first transaction has been analyzed for you.

Transaction Date

Accounts Affected

Type

April 1

Advertising Expense Cash

Stockholders’ Equity Asset

Increase/Decrease Dr. or Cr. Increase Decrease

Dr. Cr.

E2-24B. Journalizing transactions (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. Using the steps outlined in the five-step transaction analysis, record the following transactions in the general journal for Washup Plumbing, Inc. Explanations are not required.

Apr 1 5 10 12 19 21 27

Paid interest expense, $1,000. Purchased office furniture on account, $3,000. Performed service on account for a customer, $2,400. Borrowed $20,000 cash, signing a note payable. Sold for $75,000 land that had cost the company $75,000. Purchased building for $300,000; signed a note payable. Paid $1,500 on account.

E2-25B. Journalizing transactions (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. Flores & Associates, Inc., completed the following transactions during December 2014, its first month of operations:

Dec 1 3 5 6 11 18 24 31

Sold $80,000 of common stock to Angela Flores to start the business. Purchased supplies on account, $160. Paid cash for a building to use for storage, $45,000. Performed service for customers and received cash, $3,700. Paid on accounts payable, $120. Performed service for customers on account, $2,650. Received cash from a customer on account, $2,100. Paid the following expenses: salaries, $1,100; and rent, $1,450.

Requirement 1. Using the steps outlined in the five-step transaction analysis, journalize the transactions of Flores & Associates, Inc. List transactions by date. Explanations are not required.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 120

03/04/14 1:40 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

121

E2-26B. Balancing accounts and prepare trial balance (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 10–15 min. The transactions for Fun Time Daycare, Inc., for the month of May 2014 are posted in the following T-accounts.

Cash May 1 6 23 Bal

May 17 Bal

35,000 May 4 3,000 9 750 29

12,700 0 0 600 0 1,500

Equipment May 4 Bal

1122

5,100 May 23

750

115 15

Service Revenue

12,700

Accounts Payable May 9

Accounts Receivable

Supplies May 2 Bal

1111

600 May 2 Bal

Common Stock May 1 Bal

1133

May 6 17 Bal

211 11 0 900

311 11

411 3,000 5,100

Salaries Expense May 29 Bal

501

1,500

35,000 0

900

Requirements 1. Calculate account balances at May 31, 2014. 2. Prepare the trial balance for Fun Time Daycare, Inc., at May 31, 2014. E2-27B. Record transactions and prepare a trial balance (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 15–20 min. Going Green, Inc., had the following transactions for the month of December 2014.

Dec 2 4 8 11 15 19 27 28

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 121

Paid Rent Expense, $1,600. Performed service for a customer and received cash, $900. Purchased supplies on account, $225. Received cash from credit customers on account, $1,500. Sold an additional $5,000 of Common Stock. Paid $375 on account. Performed service for customers on account, $1,640. Made a payment on the Notes Payable, $2,500.

03/04/14 1:40 PM

122

Chapter 2 The following T-accounts have been set up for Going Green, Inc., with their beginning balances as of December 1, 2014.

Cash Dec 1

1111

Dec 1

Notes Payable

1122

212

Dec 1

17,500

Common Stock

1133

311

Dec 1

30,000

450

Office Furniture

Service Revenue

114 14

Dec 1

411 5,300

3,100

Building Dec 1

875

2,200

Supplies

Dec 1

211

Dec 1

4,325

Accounts Receivable Dec 1

Accounts Payable

116 16

Rent Expense Dec 1

511

1,600

42,000

Requirements 1. Journalize the transactions for the month of December. Explanations are not required. 2. Post the journal entries to the appropriate T-accounts. Identify all items by date. 3. Calculate the balance of each account at December 31, 2014. 4. Prove that the total of all the debit balances equals the total of all of the credit balances by preparing a trial balance at December 31, 2014. E2-28B. Journalize transactions, prepare a trial balance and balance sheet (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 20–25 min. The transactions for Grinko, Inc., for the month of June 2014 have been posted to the accounts as follows:

Cash (1)

28,000 (4) (5) (6)

Supplies 9,0000 2,5000 5000

1,100

(2)

(4)

Accounts Payable (6)

500 (2)

Equipment 9,000

Notes Payable

1,1000

(5)

2,500 (3)

Building 50,000

(3)

Common Stock 50,0000

(1)

28,000

Requirements 1. Prepare the journal entries that served as the sources for the six transactions. 2. Calculate the ending balance in each account. 3. Prepare the trial balance for Grinko, Inc., at June 30, 2014. 4. Prepare a balance sheet for Grinko, Inc., as of June 30, 2014.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 122

03/04/14 1:40 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

123

E2-29B. Journalizing, posting, trial balance, income statement, and balance sheet (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 25–30 min. Nolan Consulting, Inc., completed the following transactions during September 2014, its first month of operations:

Sep 2 3 6 8 11 19 20 28

Sold $50,000 of common stock to James Nolan to start the consulting practice. Paid monthly office rent, $1,750. Paid cash for a new computer, $1,400. Purchased office furniture on account, $2,700. Purchased supplies on account, $225. Performed consulting service for a client on account, $1,835. Paid utility expenses, $285. Performed service for a client and received cash for the full amount of $975.

Requirements 1. Open, or set up, T-accounts in the ledger for the following accounts: Cash, Accounts Receivable, Supplies, Equipment, Furniture, Accounts Payable, Common Stock, Service Revenue, Rent Expense, and Utilities Expense. 2. Record transactions in the journal. Explanations are not required. 3. Post journal entries to the T-accounts. Identify all items by date. Calculate the ­ending balance in each account. 4. Prepare a trial balance at September 30, 2014. 5. Prepare the income statement, statement of retained earnings, and balance sheet. E2-30B. Error correction (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. Allison Meehan has trouble keeping her debits and credits equal. During a recent month, Allison made the following errors: a. Allison recorded a $900 payment of rent by debiting Rent Expense for $90 and crediting Cash for $90. b. In recording a $700 payment on account, Allison debited Accounts Receivable and credited Cash. c. Allison recorded the receipt of cash for service revenue by debiting Cash for $230 instead of the correct amount of $320. Allison also credited Service Revenue for the $230, the incorrect amount. d. Allison posted a $190 purchase of supplies on account by debiting Accounts Payable and crediting Supplies. e. In preparing the trial balance, Allison omitted a $95,000 note payable. Requirements 1. For each of these errors, state whether Allison’s mistake would cause the total debits and total credits on the trial balance to be unequal. 2. Identify each account with an incorrect balance, and indicate the amount and ­direction of the error.

Effect on Trial Balance Total debits  Total credits

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 123

Account(s) Misstated Cash $810 too high Rent Expense $810 too low

03/04/14 1:40 PM

124

Chapter 2

MyAccountingLab

Problems (Group A) P2-31A. Journalizing transactions (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. Annabel Marshall practices law under the business title Annabel Marshall, Attorney at Law, Inc. During April, her law practice engaged in the following transactions:

Apr 1 3 8 12 17 26 30 30 30

Sold $40,000 of common stock to Marshall to start the business. Paid $600 for the purchase of office supplies. Paid $28,000 cash to purchase land for an office site. Purchased office equipment on account, $1,800. Borrowed $5,000 from the bank. Marshall signed a note payable to the bank in the name of the business. Paid $2,600 on account. Revenues earned during the month included $15,000 cash and $27,000 on account. Paid employees’ salaries, $2,900; office rent, $1,400; and utilities, $700. Paid $9,000 of dividends to stockholder, Marshall. Marshall’s business uses the following accounts: Cash, Accounts Receivable, Supplies, Land, Office Equipment, Accounts Payable, Notes Payable, Common Stock, Dividends, Service Revenue, Salaries Expense, Rent Expense, and Utilities Expense. Requirement 1. Journalize each transaction. Omit explanations.

P2-32A. Journalizing transactions (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. Opportunity Advertising, Inc., engaged in the following business transactions during July 2014:

Jul 1 3 6 9 13 15 17 18 22 26 31

Borrowed $450,000 from Horizon Bank. The company president signed a note payable to the bank in the name of Opportunity Advertising, Inc. Paid $275,000 cash to purchase an office building. Provided services to customers on account, $21,400. Purchased $875 of office supplies on account. Provided services to cash customers, $8,200. Paid $3,500 of dividends to company stockholders. Received payment on account from credit customers, $5,900. Paid property tax expense on office building, $1,140. Paid employee salaries, $4,300. Paid cash to purchase supplies, $550. Paid $4,700 on account.

Opportunity Advertising, Inc., uses the following accounts: Cash, Accounts Receivable, Supplies, Building, Accounts Payable, Notes Payable, Common Stock, Dividends, Service Revenue, Salaries Expense, and Property Tax Expense. Requirement 1. Journalize each transaction. Omit explanations.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 124

03/04/14 1:40 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

125

P2-33A. Journalizing, posting, and trial balance preparation (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 20–25 min. Tucker Stevens opened an accounting firm on October 1, 2014. During the month of October, the business completed the following transactions:

Oct 1 3 5 8 11 14 16 19 23 28 31 31 31

The business sold $50,000 of common stock to open the firm, Stevens & Associates, Inc. Purchased supplies, $300, and furniture, $1,300, on account. Performed accounting service for a client and received cash, $1,800. Paid cash to acquire land for a future office site, $25,000. Prepared tax returns for a client on account, $2,500. Paid assistant’s salary, $600. Paid for the furniture purchased October 3 on account. Received $300 cash for accounting services performed. Billed a client for $1,700 of accounting services. Received $400 from client on account. Paid secretary’s salary, $600. Paid rent expense, $1,500. Paid $1,800 of dividends.

Requirements 1. Open, or set up, the following T-accounts: Cash, Accounts Receivable, Supplies, Furniture, Land, Accounts Payable, Common Stock, Dividends, Service Revenue, Salaries Expense, and Rent Expense. 2. Journalize transactions. Explanations are not required. 3. Post the transactions to the T-accounts, using transaction dates as posting references. 4. Calculate the balance in each account at October 31, 2014. 5. Prepare the trial balance for Stevens & Associates, Inc., at October 31, 2014. P2-34A. Journalizing, posting, and trial balance preparation (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 25–30 min. The trial balance for Safe Systems, Inc., at September 15, 2014, follows:

Safe Systems, Inc. Trial Balance September 15, 2014 ACCT # 110 112 115 140 210 311 315 411 511 515

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 125

ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Equipment Accounts Payable Common Stock Dividends Service Revenue Salaries Expense Rent Expense Total

DEBIT $ 6,530 7,200 310 14,300

CREDIT

$ 5,100 23,000 2,500 6,940 2,800 1,400 $35,040

$35,040

03/04/14 1:40 PM

126

Chapter 2 During the remainder of September, Safe Systems, Inc., completed the following transactions:

Sep 16 18 21 23 25 27 29 30 30

Collected $3,200 cash from a client on account. Performed services on account, $2,650. Received $1,150 cash for services performed. Purchased supplies on account, $215. Paid $1,500 in dividends. Paid $1,800 on account. Received $3,200 cash for services performed. Paid rent, $1,950. Paid employees’ salaries, $1,400.

Requirements Quick solution: 1. Cash balance = $7,430 2. Trial balance totals = $40,455

1. Journalize the transactions that occurred September 16 to September 30 on page 6 of the journal. 2. Open the ledger accounts listed in the trial balance together with their beginning balances at September 15. Use the four-column account format illustrated in the chapter. Enter “Bal” for the September 15 balance in the Item column. Post the transactions to the ledger using dates, account numbers, and posting references. Calculate the new account balances at September 30, 2014. 3. Prepare the trial balance for Safe Systems, Inc., at September 30, 2014. P2-35A. Prepare a trial balance, income statement, statement of retained earnings, and balance sheet (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. The accounts of Apex Consulting, Inc., follow with their normal balances at January 31, 2014. The accounts are listed in no particular order.

Account

Balance

Common Stock ............................................... Insurance Expense.......................................... Accounts Payable............................................ Service Revenue ............................................. Land................................................................ Supplies Expense............................................ Cash................................................................ Salaries Expense ............................................. Building........................................................... Rent Expense .................................................. Dividends ........................................................ Utilities Expense.............................................. Retained Earnings ........................................... Accounts Receivable ....................................... Notes Payable ................................................. Supplies ..........................................................

$34,300 2,000 4,500 126,500 54,000 3,500 7,600 62,000 99,000 7,500 14,000 5,400 10,400 5,500 85,000 200

Requirements 1. Prepare the company’s trial balance at January 31, 2014, listing accounts in the proper order. List the largest expense first, the second-largest expense next, and so on. 2. Prepare the year-end financial statements: income statement, statement of ­retained earnings, and balance sheet. The retained earnings balance of $10,400 is the beginning balance for the year; it has not been updated for the current year’s income or loss. 3. Was it a profitable year for Apex Consulting, Inc.? Why or why not?

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 126

03/04/14 1:40 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

127

P2-36A. Error correction (Learning Objective 4) 15–20 min. The following errors occurred in the accounting records of Allied Security, Inc.: a. The company accountant recorded the receipt of cash for service revenue by ­debiting Cash for $240 instead of the correct amount of $420. Service Revenue was also credited for $240, the incorrect amount. b. A $375 purchase of supplies on account was recorded by debiting Accounts Payable and crediting Supplies. c. The company accountant recorded a $1,375 payment of rent by debiting rent ­expense for $13,750 and crediting Cash for $13,750. d. In recording a $1,100 payment on account, Accounts Receivable was debited and Cash was credited. Requirements 1. Prepare the necessary journal entries to correct each of these errors. 2. For each of the errors, determine if the error would cause net income to be ­overstated, understated, or unchanged.

Problems (Group B) P2-37B. Journalizing transactions (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. Tina Dalton practices law under the business title Tina Dalton, Attorney at Law, Inc. During September, her law practice engaged in the following transactions:

Sep 1 3 8 12 17 26 30 30 30

Sold $60,000 of common stock to Dalton to start the business. Paid $450 for the purchase of office supplies. Paid $43,000 cash to purchase land for an office site. Purchased office equipment on account, $4,300. Borrowed $65,000 from the bank. Dalton signed a note payable to the bank in the name of the business. Paid $2,800 on account. Revenues earned during the month included $12,000 cash and $16,500 on account. Paid employees’ salaries, $3,240; office rent, $1,800; and utilities, $675. Paid $4,300 of dividends to stockholder, Dalton. Dalton’s business uses the following accounts: Cash, Accounts Receivable, Supplies, Land, Office Equipment, Accounts Payable, Notes Payable, Common Stock, Dividends, Service Revenue, Salaries Expense, Rent Expense, and Utilities Expense. Requirement 1. Journalize each transaction. Omit explanations.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 127

03/04/14 1:40 PM

128

Chapter 2 P2-38B. Journalizing transactions (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. Action Advertising, Inc., engaged in the following business transactions during May 2014:

May 1 3 6 9 13 15 17 18 22 26 31

Borrowed $150,000 from Northern Bank. The company president signed a note payable to the bank in the name of Action Advertising, Inc. Paid $135,000 cash to purchase an office building. Provided services to customers on account, $11,800. Purchased $1,100 of office supplies on account. Provided services to cash customers, $8,100. Paid $5,000 of dividends to company stockholders. Received payment on account from credit customers, $7,500. Paid property tax expense on office building, $1,250. Paid employee salaries, $3,350. Paid cash to purchase supplies, $1,300. Paid $5,000 on account.

Action Advertising, Inc., uses the following accounts: Cash, Accounts Receivable, Supplies, Building, Accounts Payable, Notes Payable, Common Stock, Dividends, Service Revenue, Salaries Expense, and Property Tax Expense. Requirement 1. Journalize each transaction. Omit explanations. P2-39B. Journalizing, posting, and trial balance preparation (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 20–25 min. Tom Slater opened an accounting firm on July 1, 2014. During the month of July, the business completed the following transactions:

Jul 1 3 5 8 11 14 16 19 23 28 31 31 31

The business sold $100,000 of common stock to open the firm, Slater & Associates, Inc. Purchased supplies, $575, and furniture, $2,300, on account. Performed accounting service for a client and received cash, $1,600. Paid cash to acquire land for a future office site, $28,000. Prepared tax returns for a client on account, $1,850. Paid assistant’s salary, $575. Paid for the furniture purchased July 3 on account. Received $2,450 cash for accounting services performed. Billed a client for $3,300 of accounting services. Received $1,450 from client on account. Paid secretary’s salary, $575. Paid rent expense, $1,720. Paid $2,500 of dividends.

Requirements 1. Open, or set up, the following T-accounts: Cash, Accounts Receivable, Supplies, Furniture, Land, Accounts Payable, Common Stock, Dividends, Service Revenue, Salaries Expense, and Rent Expense. 2. Journalize transactions. Explanations are not required. 3. Post the transactions to the T-accounts that have been set up for you, using ­transaction dates as posting references. 4. Calculate the balance in each account. 5. Prepare the trial balance for Slater & Associates, Inc., at July 31, 2014.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 128

03/04/14 1:40 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

129

P2-40B. Journalizing, posting, and trial balance preparation (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 25–30 min. The trial balance for XYZ Systems, Inc., at January 15, 2014, follows:

XYZ Systems, Inc. Trial Balance January 15, 2014 ACCT # 110 112 115 140 210 311 315 411 511 515

ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Equipment Accounts Payable Common Stock Dividends Service Revenue Salaries Expense Rent Expense Total

DEBIT $ 2,700 8,000 1,000 14,600

CREDIT

$ 4,500 21,600 2,800 6,600 2,300 1,300 $32,700

$32,700

During the remainder of January, XYZ Systems, Inc., completed the following transactions:

Jan 16 18 21 23 25 27 29 30 30

Collected $3,400 cash from a client on account. Performed services on account, $1,200. Received $2,700 cash for services performed. Purchased supplies on account, $400. Paid $1,400 in dividends. Paid $2,100 on account. Received $3,800 cash for services performed. Paid rent, $1,000. Paid employees’ salaries, $2,400.

Requirements 1. Journalize the transactions that occurred January 16 to January 30 on page 6 of the journal. 2. Open T-accounts for the ledger accounts listed in the trial balance and enter their beginning balances at January 15. Use the four-column account format illustrated in the chapter. Enter “Bal” for the January 15 balance in the item column. Post the transactions to the ledger, using dates, account numbers, and posting references. Calculate the new account balances at January 31, 2014. 3. Prepare the trial balance for XYZ Systems, Inc., at January 31, 2014.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 129

03/04/14 1:40 PM

130

Chapter 2 P2-41B. Prepare a trial balance, income statement, statement of retained earnings, and balance sheet (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. The accounts of Baker Consulting, Inc., follow with their normal balances at December 31, 2014. The accounts are listed in no particular order.

Account

Balance

Common Stock ............................................... Insurance Expense.......................................... Accounts Payable............................................ Service Revenue ............................................. Land................................................................ Supplies Expense............................................ Cash................................................................ Salaries Expense ............................................. Building........................................................... Rent Expense .................................................. Dividends ........................................................ Utilities Expense.............................................. Retained Earnings ........................................... Accounts Receivable ....................................... Notes Payable ................................................. Supplies ..........................................................

$120,000 5,300 4,100 101,700 82,000 1,840 9,120 48,750 135,000 11,340 15,000 6,750 12,320 7,370 85,000 650

Requirements 1. Prepare the company’s trial balance at December 31, 2014, listing accounts in the proper order. List the largest expense first, the second-largest expense next, and so on. 2. Prepare the year-end financial statements: income statement, statement of ­retained earnings, and balance sheet. The retained earnings balance of $12,320 is the beginning balance for the year; it has not been updated for the current year’s net income or loss. 3. Was it a profitable year for Baker Consulting, Inc.? Why or why not? P2-42B. Error correction (Learning Objective 4) 15–20 min. The following errors occurred in the accounting records of Coral Cove, Inc.: a. The company accountant recorded the receipt of cash for service revenue by debiting Cash for $470 instead of the correct amount of $740. Service Revenue was also credited for $470, the incorrect amount. b. A $225 purchase of supplies on account was recorded by debiting Accounts Payable and crediting Supplies. c. The company accountant recorded a $1,200 payment of rent by debiting Rent Expense for $12,000 and crediting Cash for $12,000. d. In recording an $825 payment on account, Accounts Receivable was debited and Cash was credited. Requirements 1. Prepare the necessary journal entries to correct each of these errors. 2. For each of the errors, determine if the error would cause net income to be ­overstated, understated, or unchanged.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 130

03/04/14 1:40 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

131

Continuing Exercise This exercise continues with the business of Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., begun in the continuing ­exercise in Chapter 1. Instead of using T accounts as you did in Chapter 1, now you will account for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc.’s transactions in the general journal. Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., completed the following transactions during April:

Apr 1 3 5 6 8 17 30

Received $2,000 and issued 500 shares of common stock. Deposited this amount in a bank account in the name of Cole's Yard Care, Inc. Purchased on account a mower, $1,200, and weed whacker, $400. The equipment is expected to remain in service for four years. Purchased $90 of gas. Wrote check #1 from the new bank account. Performed lawn services for client on account, $225. Purchased $85 of fertilizer from the lawn store. Wrote check #2 from the new bank account. Completed landscaping job for client, received cash $850. Received $175 on account from services performed on April 6. Requirements 1. Open T-accounts in the ledger: Cash, Accounts Receivable, Lawn Supplies, Equipment, Accounts Payable, Common Stock, Retained Earnings, Service Revenue, and Fuel Expense. 2. Journalize the transactions. Explanations are not required. 3. Post journal entries to the T-accounts. Key all items by date and denote an account balance as Bal. Formal posting references are not required. Determine ending balances in T-accounts on April 30, 2014. 4. Prepare a trial balance at April 30, 2014.

Continuing Problem This problem continues with the business of Aqua Magic, Inc., begun in the continuing problem in Chapter 1. Here you will account for Aqua Magic, Inc.’s transactions using formal accounting practices. The trial balance for Aqua Magic, Inc., as of May 31, 2014, is presented below.

Aqua Magic, Inc. Trial Balance May 31, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Equipment Vehicles Accounts Payable Notes Payable Common Stock Dividends Service Revenue Salaries Expense Utilities Expense Total

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 131

DEBIT $43,325 2,300 600 1,800 36,200

CREDIT

$

1,040 36,200 45,000

2,500 5,850 625 740 $88,090

$88,090

03/04/14 1:40 PM

132

Chapter 2 During June the following transactions occurred:

Jun 1 2 3 4 5 8 11 13 16 17 18 19 21 22 24 26 28 30 30 30

Paid receptionist’s salary, $625. Paid cash to acquire land for a future office site, $25,000. Moved into a new location for the business and paid the first month’s rent, $2,300. Performed service for a customer and received cash, $1,750. Received $450 on account. Purchased $725 of supplies on account. Billed customers for services performed, $3,250. Sold an additional $10,000 of common stock to Greg Richards. Paid receptionist’s salary, $625. Received $1,500 cash for services performed. Received $1,025 from customers on account. Paid $450 to be listed in the Yellow Pages telephone directory. Paid $875 on account. Purchased office furniture on account, $4,000. Paid miscellaneous expenses, $275. Billed customers for services provided, $1,450. Received $1,800 from customers on account. Paid utility bill, $640. Paid receptionist’s salary, $625. Paid $3,500 of dividends. Requirements 1. Journalize the transactions that occurred in June, omit explanations. 2. Open the ledger accounts listed in the trial balance together with their beginning balances at May 31. Use the four-column account format illustrated in the chapter. Enter “Bal” for the May 31 balance in the Item column. Post the journal entries to the ledger creating new ledger accounts as necessary, omit posting references. Calculate the new account balances at June 30, 2014. 3. Prepare the trial balance for Aqua Magic, Inc., at June 30, 2014.

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem Let’s look at Target some more. Think about Target. Think about accountants reporting what Target has, where it gets or receives its money, and what it has been doing to create value. Is Target earning net income or loss? What resources does Target need to operate? Think about the business of Target. Return to Target’s Web site at www.target.com. Next, scroll to the bottom of the page and look for the heading “about Target” and click on “company information.” Now click on “Investors” and click on “Annual Reports.” Finally, look for the link to the 2012 annual report and click on it. A lot of information is contained in Target’s financial statements, which are ­located in the annual report. Look through the pages of the annual report. On page 33 of the annual report, you’ll find Target’s income statement for the year ending February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Operations). On page 35, you’ll find Target’s balance sheet as of February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position). After the income statement and balance sheet are other reports and explanations of the numbers on the reports. Now answer the following questions: Look at the 2013 income statement and balance sheet of Target. How would the following transactions affect the financial statements? a. What would happen to Target’s balance sheet if it borrowed $50 million of cash from a bank? b. What would happen to Target’s balance sheet if it built a new store costing $50 ­million in cash?

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 132

03/04/14 1:40 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

133

c. What would happen to Target’s income statement and balance sheet if it had a big sale, increasing net income by $10 billion which all ended up as cash? d. What would happen to Target’s income statement and balance sheet if it hired more employees? The salaries of these employees cost Target $1 billion paid in cash. The extra employees did not create any extra net income.

Apply Your Knowledge Ethics in Action Case 1. Lynne Jamison was recording the daily transactions of Liberty Physical Therapy, Inc., into the accounting records so she could prepare financial statements and apply for a bank loan. Some of the business expenses were higher than she had expected, and Lynne was worried about the effect of these expenses on net income. Lynne was recording a $3,800 payment for legal fees incurred by the business by debiting Legal Expense and crediting Cash to properly record the ­journal entry. She then thought that, rather than debiting the expense account for the $3,800 payment, she could debit the Dividends account, which also had a normal debit balance. Lynne knew that debits had to equal credits, so debiting the Dividends account instead of the Legal Expense account would not affect the trial balance. Further, the net income would be $3,800 higher because now no legal expense would be recorded. She thought that either way the ­retained earnings would be lower, and besides, it really didn’t matter how the $3,800 payment was shown as long as she showed it somewhere. Should Lynne debit the Dividends account rather than the Legal Expense account? Do you agree with her thought that it really doesn’t matter how the $3,800 payment is shown as long as it is shown somewhere? Considering that Lynne owns all of the Liberty Physical Therapy, Inc., common stock, does she have any ethical responsibilities to properly record each business transaction? Case 2. Joe Reese is the accountant for Lawn Boyz Lawnservice, Inc. During the month, ­numerous payments were made for wages for which he was properly debiting the Wage Expense account and crediting Cash. Joe became concerned that if he kept debiting the Wage Expense account it would end up with a balance much higher than any of the other expense accounts. Accordingly, he began debiting other expense accounts for some of the wage payments and, thus, “spread the expenses around” to other expense accounts. When he was done posting all the journal entries to the ledger accounts, he printed a trial balance. He saw that the Wage Expense balance was $42,000 and the total of all the other expense accounts was $26,000. Had he properly posted all the wage expense transactions, Wage Expense would have totaled $54,000 and the other expense accounts would have totaled $14,000. Joe reasoned that his ­actions provided for “more balanced” expense account totals and, regardless of his postings, the total expenses were still $68,000, so the overall net income would be the same. Were Joe’s actions justified? Do they cause any ethical concerns? If you were the owner of Lawn Boyz Lawnservice, Inc., would you have a problem with what Joe did?

Know Your Business Financial Analysis Purpose: To help familiarize you with the financial reporting of a real company in order to further your understanding of the chapter material you are learning. Although we do not have access to the journals used by Columbia Sportswear, we can still understand various business transactions on the financial statements in Columbia Sportswear’s annual report. Refer to the Columbia Sportswear income statements, “Statements

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 133

03/04/14 1:40 PM

134

Chapter 2 of Operations,” and the Columbia Sportswear balance sheets in Appendix A. Assume Columbia Sportswear completed the following transactions during January 2012:

Jan 3 7 10 15 29

Purchased $583,000 of equipment for cash. Had cash sales of $27,480,000. Purchased $31,364,000 of inventory on account. Made $703,000 of sales on account. Paid $14,625,000 on account from the January 10 purchase.

Requirements 1. Prepare journal entries to record the transactions listed. Use the account titles found in the Columbia Sportswear financial statements: Cash; Accounts Receivable; Inventory; Property, Plant, and Equipment; Accounts Payable; and Net Sales. 2. Look at the financial statements and locate the accounts that you included in your journal entries. Note that the balances Columbia Sportswear reported include ­millions of dollars in transactions for the year. Imagine how much activity and how many transactions Columbia Sportswear has every day!

Industry Analysis Purpose: To help you understand and compare the performance of two companies in the same industry. Go to the Columbia Sportswear Company Annual Report located in Appendix A. Now a­ ccess the 2012 Annual Report for Under Armour, Inc. For instructions on how to access the report ­online, see the Industry Analysis in Chapter 1. Requirements Answer these questions about the two companies:

1. In terms of net sales or net revenue, which is the larger company for the year ending December 31, 2012? Which financial statement did you look at to find that information? 2. In terms of total assets at December 31, 2012, which is the larger company? Which financial statement did you look at to find that information? 3. Which company has more total debt at December 31, 2012? Which financial statement did you look at to find that information? 4. Which company has the higher gross profit percentage for the year ending December 31, 2012? Don’t know that one? On the Consolidated Statements of Operations/Income, divide Gross Profit by Net Sales (or Net Revenues). What ­exactly does this mean? 5. Which company paid more cash dividends to its stockholders in 2012? Which ­financial statement did you look at to find that information? 6. Which company’s stock would you rather own? Why?

Small Business Analysis Purpose: To help you understand the importance of cash flows in the operation of a small business. You’re sitting in your CPA office late on a Friday afternoon when you get an e-mail from a ­client. You know that she has been working on setting up a new accounting system in her ­office for a new business that she just started. You figured that this would eventually generate some communication between the two of you because you know that she has relatively limited ­accounting knowledge. Here’s her e-mail to you: “Brian, I’m pretty frustrated right now! As you know, I’ve been installing this new accounting system here in the office and I’ve run into a problem. I don’t understand this Cash account.

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 134

03/04/14 1:40 PM

Analyzing and Recording Business Transactions

135

I have purchased some items on my debit card, and I’ve purchased some items on my credit card. So, logically, when I purchased the items on my debit card, I debited the Cash account. But when I used my credit card, it made sense to credit my Cash account. And to make things even worse, my Cash account ends up with a credit balance, and I’m pretty sure that’s not right. This is too confusing and it’s Friday afternoon; I’m going home!” The following journal entries were attached to your client’s e-mail:

DATE May 5

DATE May 6

ACCOUNTS Cash Supplies Purchased supplies using debit card.

POST REF.

ACCOUNTS Utilities Expense Cash Paid utilities bill using credit card.

POST REF.

DR. 320

CR. 320

DR. 275

CR. 275

Requirement 1. Because Cash is the lifeblood of any business, having a correct balance in the Cash account is of utmost importance. Correctly entering cash transactions is equally important. Suggest to your client the corrections that need to be made to the ­journal entries she made.

Written Communication Consider the situation that was presented in the Small Business Analysis. Your client had two concerns that she asked you about. The first one is that she was concerned that her Cash balance had a credit balance instead of a debit balance. And even after the corrections were made, the Cash balance was still a credit. The second concern she had was how to record transactions when she uses her debit card as opposed to transactions when she uses her credit card. Write a short memo or letter to your client addressing these two situations and what you would consider to be the proper accounting treatment for each of the two. More specifically, if the Cash account was showing as a credit balance, how would that have happened? Is it possible for that to happen? And regarding the use of the debit card versus the credit card, from the information contained in the chapter, explain the difference between the two types of cards and how each transaction should be recorded from an accounting point of view. Self Check Answers 1. b 2. a 3. c 4. b 5. a 6. b 7. d 8. d 9. c 10. a 11. true 12. d

M02_KEMP9543_03_GE_C02.indd 135

03/04/14 1:40 PM

3 Adjusting and Closing Entries Business, Accounting, and You Learning Objectives 1 Understand the revenue recognition and matching principles

2 Understand the four types of adjustments, and prepare ­adjusting entries

3 Prepare financial statements from an adjusted trial balance

4 Prepare closing entries and a post-closing trial balance

It’s December 31st and closing time at Disney. Everyone has worked hard. The year has come to a close. Millions of transactions have occurred and been recorded by the accountants. It’s time to wrap up the year and tabulate the score for Disney. How does Disney conclude a year’s activities and prepare for a new year? There has to be an end for a new beginning. Think of a sporting event. There must be an end to the game. At the end of the game, the scorekeeper must make sure the score accurately reflects what ­happened. Accountants are the scorekeepers of the business. They have activities to complete at the end of each accounting period. They may need to go back and make sure they have recognized, measured, and reported all the business’s transactions. Given the rules of Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP), they may need to adjust the scorecard to better reflect what happened. They then need to summarize the transactions and prepare the final reports.

136

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 136

03/04/14 1:44 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

137

Whether you are an accountant or a manager who uses accounting information, you need to understand the process used by accountants to adjust and c­ onclude (close) a business’s financial records. Why? Because they affect the reports used to manage the business. They affect the final score used to judge a business’s success. In Chapter 2, we learned about journalizing and posting transactions for a business, as well as how to prepare a trial balance and financial statements. These were steps one, two, three, and six of the accounting cycle. Once again the accounting cycle looks like this: Step One

Step Eight

Recognize, measure and journalize transactions

Prepare a post-closing trial balance

Step Two Post transactions to the general ledger

Step Seven

Step Three

Journalize and post closing entries

Prepare an unadjusted trial balance

Step Six

Step Four

Prepare financial statements

Journalize and post adjusting entries

Step Five Prepare an adjusted trial balance

Fiscal year  Any consecutive, 12-month period that a business adopts as its accounting year.

Here in Chapter 3, we will learn how to prepare steps four, five, seven, and eight. The accounting cycle is repeated for every accounting period. The accounting period can be defined as a month, a quarter, or a year. The annual accounting period for most large companies runs the calendar year from January 1 through December 31, a­ lthough some companies use a fiscal year that does not coincide with the calendar year. A fiscal year is any consecutive 12-month period that a business chooses. It may begin on any day of the year and end 12 months later. Usually, the fiscal year-end date is the low point in business activity for the year. Although we will focus primarily on an annual time period, usually financial statements are prepared monthly, ­quarterly, or semiannually so that businesses have an idea of how they are doing before the year ends.

Real World Accounting Video In the Real World Accounting Video, Jeanette Cebollero, the chief financial officer (CFO) of Rosa Mexicano Restaurants, talks about the accounting function. Look at the video.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 137

03/04/14 1:44 PM

138

Chapter 3

Think about what Jeanette is saying. Think about how important accounting is to the success of a business.

How Does a Company Accurately Report Its Income? Revenue Recognition and Matching Principles 1 Understand the revenue

r­ ecognition and matching principles

Accrual accounting  Accounting method that records revenues when earned and expenses when incurred without regard to when cash is exchanged. Revenue recognition ­principle  Recording revenues when they are earned by providing goods or services to customers. Matching principle  Recording expenses in the time period they were incurred to produce revenues, thus matching them against the revenues earned during that same period. Cash-basis accounting Accounting method that records revenues when cash is received and expenses when cash is paid. Accruals  Revenues earned or ­expenses incurred before cash has been exchanged.

Deferrals  Cash received or paid before revenues have been earned or expenses have been incurred.

In Chapter 1, we learned that financial statements are prepared in order to provide useful information to various users. However, for financial statements to be useful, they must be accurate and up to date. To ensure that financial statements are up to date, GAAP requires the use of accrual accounting. To practice accrual accounting, a business must follow the next two accounting principles: • The revenue recognition principle states that revenues should be recognized, or ­recorded, when they are earned regardless of when cash is received. • The matching principle states that expenses should be matched with the revenues they helped generate. In other words, expenses should be recorded when they are ­incurred regardless of when they are paid for.

Accruals and Deferrals It is possible for a business to record revenues only when cash is received and record ­expenses only when cash is paid. As discussed in Chapter 1, this is referred to as ­ ash-basis accounting. In many instances, when a company uses cash-basis accountc ing, its financial statements do not present an accurate picture of how the company is ­performing. This is because a business may provide goods and services to customers “on account.” In this case, the business has earned revenue prior to receiving cash from the customer. A business may also purchase goods and services from suppliers on account. In this case, expenses are incurred before cash is paid. When revenues are earned before cash is received or expenses are incurred before cash is paid, it is called an accrual. We have already seen accruals in Chapters 1 and 2 when we recorded transactions in Accounts Receivable and Accounts Payable. Businesses may also receive cash from customers prior to the delivery of goods or services to the customer. In this case, cash is received before revenue is earned. In addition, businesses may pay for goods or services prior to receiving those goods or services from the supplier. In this case, cash is paid before an expense is incurred. When cash is received for goods or services prior to the recognition of a revenue or cash is paid for goods or services prior to the recognition of the expense, it is called a deferral. We have also seen deferrals in Chapters 1 and 2 when we purchased supplies and equipment. Accruals and deferrals can be summarized as follows:

Accrued Revenue Accrued Expense Deferred Revenue Deferred Expense Adjusting entries  Journal entries made at the end of the accounting period to measure the period’s income accurately and bring the related asset and liability accounts to correct balances before the financial statements are prepared.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 138

Now Revenue is recognized Expense is recognized Cash is received Cash is paid

Later Cash is received Cash is paid Revenue is recognized Expense is recognized

As we saw in Chapter 2, a business records transactions throughout the accounting period as the transactions occur. At the end of the period, the accountant prepares a trial balance and uses it to prepare financial statements. However, before most businesses can prepare accurate, up-to-date financial statements, the accountant will have to prepare adjusting entries.

03/04/14 1:44 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

139

Stop and Think… If cash is so important to the well-being of a business, why does US GAAP require the use of accrual accounting instead of cash-basis accounting?

Answer

The goal of US GAAP is for financial statements to reflect accurate information regarding the performance of a business. The fact that a business has received cash from customers does not necessarily mean that the business is performing well. For example, let’s assume that during the year a business received $20,000 from customers for services that it had provided during the same year. The business also received another $10,000 from customers for services that will not be provided until the following year. Under cash-basis accounting, the business would report $30,000 of revenues in the first year. Now, suppose during the second year the customers asked for (and received) a refund of the $10,000 before the services were provided. The $30,000 in revenues that were originally reported under cash-basis accounting during the first year now seems to be inaccurate because the business only ended up with revenues of $20,000. Under ­accrual accounting, the business would have only reported $20,000 of revenues in the first year, which would have reflected a more accurate picture of the business’s performance. This is because, under accrual accounting, revenues are recorded when they are earned i­nstead of when cash is received.

What Is the Role of Adjusting Entries, and When Are They Prepared? 2 Understand the four

types of adjustments, and prepare adjusting entries

Adjusting entries are journal entries used to ensure that the revenue recognition principle and the matching principle are followed. Adjustments may be needed for accruals when revenues have been earned, or expenses have been incurred, before cash is exchanged. Because cash has not been exchanged, it is possible that the revenue or expense has not been recorded, so an adjusting entry is needed to record the revenue or expense. • Two types of adjustments are made for accruals:

1. Accrue, or record, unrecorded revenues. Revenues are recorded in the ­current period by debiting a receivable and crediting revenue.



2. Accrue, or record, unrecorded expenses. Record the expenses in the current period by debiting an expense and crediting a liability.

A deferral is created when cash is exchanged before the related revenue or expense is recognized. Examples include receiving cash from customers prior to providing services or purchasing supplies that are not used immediately. • Two types of adjustments are made for deferrals: Unearned revenue  A liability ­created when a business collects cash from customers in advance of providing goods or services; also called deferred revenue.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 139



1. Divide unearned revenues between periods. When payment is received in advance from a customer for goods or services, cash is debited. The ­liability account, Unearned Revenue, is credited because the customer is owed the goods or services. Once the customer receives the goods or services, an ­adjusting entry is prepared in which the Unearned Revenue account is ­debited to reduce it and a Revenue account is credited.

03/04/14 1:44 PM

140

Chapter 3

Prepaid expenses  Amounts that are assets of a business because they represent items that have been paid for but will be used later; also called deferred expenses.

Unadjusted trial balance  A trial balance that is prepared at the end of the accounting period prior to the adjusting entries being made.



2. Divide prepaid expenses, supplies, buildings, equipment, and other assets between periods. These items are recorded as assets when they are purchased because the item that was paid for has not yet been used up. Therefore, an asset account is debited and cash is credited to record the purchase. Once part, or all, of the item is used up, an adjusting entry is prepared in which an expense account is debited and the related asset is credited to reduce it.

At the end of the accounting period, the accountant prepares a trial balance from the account information contained in the general ledger. This trial balance lists most of the revenues and expenses of the business, but these amounts are incomplete because the ­adjusting entries have not yet been prepared. Therefore, this trial balance is called an unadjusted trial balance (step three in the accounting cycle). Remember Osborne Consulting, Inc., from Chapter 2? Exhibit 3-1 shows the unadjusted trial balance for Osborne Consulting, Inc., at the end of its first quarter of operations, at March 31, 2014. Now, we need to prepare adjusting entries at March 31, 2014.

Osborne Consulting, Inc. (Unadjusted) Trial Balance March 31, 2014 ACCOUNT TITLE Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Prepaid Rent Equipment Accounts Payable Unearned Service Revenue Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Salaries Expense Utilities Expense Total

BALANCE DEBIT CREDIT $26,300 3,100 900 3,000 12,600 $13,100 450 20,000 9,500 3,200 7,000 550 400 $50,050 $50,050

Exhibit 3-1 Remember from Chapter 2 that transactions are recorded in the journal and posted to accounts in the general ledger. This process is still used when adjusting the accounts. In this chapter, we will show how to record adjusting entries and how to post them to ­accounts. However, instead of using the real ledger account form, we will post adjustments to T-accounts. We use this method because it is easier to see how these entries affect the specific accounts as well as the accounting equation.

Accruing Revenues Accounts Receivable  Businesses sometimes earn revenue by providing goods or services before they receive cash. Assume that a local car dealership hires Osborne Consulting, Inc., on March 15 as a computer consultant. Osborne Consulting agrees to a monthly fee of $500, which the car dealership pays on the 15th of each month, beginning on April 15. During March, Osborne earns half a month’s fee, $250 ($500 × 1/2 month), for consulting work performed March 15 through March 31. On March 31, Osborne makes the following

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 140

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

141

adjusting entry to reflect the accrual of the revenue earned during March (the beginning balance of each account is found on the unadjusted trial balance presented in Exhibit 3-1): GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account

Debit

Mar 31 Accounts Receivable

Credit

250

Service Revenue

250 50

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Liabilities

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Retained Earnings

Dividends

Accounts Receivable

Revenues

Expenses

Service Revenue Bal 7,000 250 Bal 7,250

Bal 3,100 250 Bal 3,350

Without the adjustment, Osborne Consulting’s financial statements are inaccurate because they would understate both Accounts Receivable and Service Revenue.

Accruing Expenses Salaries Payable  Suppose Osborne Consulting pays the office assistant a monthly salary of $550. Osborne pays the assistant on the 15th of each month for the past month’s work. On March 31, the following adjustment must be made to record the salaries expense for the month of March: GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account Mar 31 Salaries Expense Salaries Payable

Debit

Credit

550 550 50

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Accounts Receivable

Liabilities

Common Stock

Salaries Payable 550

Bal 3,100 250 Bal 3,350

Accrued expenses  Expenses that have been incurred prior to being paid for.

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity Retained Earnings

Dividends

Revenues ues

Expenses

Service Revenue Bal 7,000 00 0 50 0 250 Bal 7,250 50 0

Salaries Expense Bal

550 550 Bal 1,100

This is referred to as accruing the expense. Accrued expenses, such as the accrual for salaries expense, are expenses that the business has incurred but not paid. The adjusting entry to accrue the expense always creates a liability, such as Salaries Payable, Taxes Payable, or Interest Payable.

Adjusting Deferred Revenues Deferred revenue  A liability ­created when a business collects cash from customers in advance of providing goods or services; also called unearned revenue.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 141

Unearned Revenues  It is possible for a business to collect cash from customers prior to providing goods or services. Receiving cash from a customer before earning it ­creates a liability called unearned revenue, or deferred revenue. It is classified as a ­liability ­because the company owes a product or service to the customer. Even though the ­account has the word revenue in its title, it is not a revenue account because the amount in the account represents what has not yet been earned.

03/04/14 1:45 PM

142

Chapter 3

Suppose a local real estate agency hires Osborne Consulting to provide consulting ser­­ vices, agreeing to pay $450 monthly, beginning immediately. Osborne Consulting collects the first amount from the real estate agency on March 21. Osborne Consulting records the cash receipt and a liability as follows:

DATE Mar 21

ACCOUNTS Cash Unearned Service Revenue Collected revenue in advance.

POST REF.

DR. 450

CR. 450

The liability account Unearned Service Revenue now shows that Osborne Consulting owes $450 of services because of its obligation to provide consulting services to the real estate agency. During the last ten days of March, Osborne Consulting earned one-third of the $450, or $150 ($450 × 1/3). Therefore, Osborne Consulting makes the following adjustment to record earning $150 of the revenue:

GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account Mar 31 Unearned Service Revenue Service Revenue

Debit

Credit

150 150 50

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Accounts Receivable Bal 3,100 250 Bal 3,350

Liabilities

Common Stock

Salaries Payable 550

Unearned Service Revenue 150 Bal Bal

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

450 300

Retained Earnings

Dividends

Revenues ues

Expenses

Service Revenue

Salaries Expense

Bal 7,000 00 0 50 0 250 Bal 7,250 50 0 150 50 00 Bal 7,400

Bal

550 550 Bal 1,100

Service Revenue increases by $150, and Unearned Service Revenue decreases by $150. Now both accounts are up to date at March 31.

Adjusting Deferred Expenses Prepaid Rent  Prepaid rent and prepaid insurance are examples of prepaid expenses, Deferred expenses  Amounts that are assets of a business because they represent items which have been paid for but will be used later. Also called prepaid expenses.

also called deferred expenses. Prepaid expenses represent items that are paid for ­ efore they are used. Often, renters are required to pay rent in advance. This prepayment b ­creates an asset for the renter. Suppose Osborne Consulting, Inc., moves to a new office and prepays three months’ office rent on March 1, 2014. If the lease specifies a monthly rental of $1,000, the amount of cash paid is $3,000 ($1,000 × 3 months). The entry to record the payment is as follows:

DATE Mar 1

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 142

ACCOUNTS Prepaid Rent Cash Paid three months’ rent in advance.

POST REF.

DR. 3,000

CR. 3,000

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

143

After posting, Prepaid Rent has a $3,000 debit balance. During March, Osborne Consulting uses the rented space for one month; therefore, the balance in Prepaid Rent is reduced by $1,000 (one month’s rent). The required adjusting entry is as follows: GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account Mar 31 Rent Expense Prepaid Rent

Debit

Credit

1,000 1,000 00

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Accounts Receivable Bal 3,100 250 Bal 3,350

Common Stock

Retained Earnings

Dividends

Salaries Payable 550

Unearned Service Revenue

Prepaid Rent Bal 3,000 Bal 2,000

Liabilities

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

1,000 00

150 Bal Bal

450 300

Revenues ues

Expenses

Service Revenue Bal 7,000 00 0 50 0 250 Bal 7,250 50 0 150 50 0 00 0 Bal 7,400

Salaries Expense Bal

550 550 Bal 1,100

Rent Expense 1,000

The Rent Expense account is increased with a debit, which reduces Retained Earnings and, therefore, Stockholders’ Equity. The asset account Prepaid Rent is decreased with a credit for the same amount. After posting, Prepaid Rent and Rent Expense show the correct ending balances. If Osborne Consulting, Inc., had prepaid insurance, the same analysis would also apply to this asset account. The difference in the adjusting entry would be in the account titles, which would be Prepaid Insurance instead of Prepaid Rent and Insurance Expense instead of Rent Expense. The amount of the entry would also be different.

Accounting in Your World In order to better understand the difference between a prepaid expense and an unearned revenue, consider this example: At the start of this quarter or semester in school, you paid your school the tuition that was due for the upcoming term. Your tuition will ultimately be an expense to you. However, before the term began, the amount you paid was not yet an expense to you because the school had not yet provided any classes. In other words, you had not yet received anything for your payment. Instead, the amount you paid represented an asset known as a prepaid expense. It was an asset because the school owes you either the classes or a refund. Once classes started, you began to incur an expense. Technically, the amount of your asset, prepaid expense, would have decreased and the amount of your expense would have increased every day. By the end of the quarter or semester, none of the tuition you paid would be considered to be a prepaid expense. Instead, it becomes an expense. Now, let’s look at the same example from the perspective of your school. When your school received the tuition payment from you, it did not have the right to record it as a revenue because it had not provided you with any classes. Instead, the school

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 143

03/04/14 1:45 PM

144

Chapter 3

would ­record your tuition as a liability called unearned revenue. Unearned revenue represents a liability to the school because the school owes you either the classes or your money back. Once classes started, your school began to earn revenue. The amount of its unearned revenue would have decreased and the amount of its revenue would have increased every day. By the end of the quarter or semester, the entire amount of tuition you paid  would be considered to be revenue to your school. As you can see, one entity’s ­prepaid expense is another entity’s unearned revenue and vice versa.

Supplies  Supplies receive the same treatment as prepaid expenses. On March 5, Osborne Consulting pays $900 for office supplies. The asset accounts, Supplies and Cash, are both affected. Supplies increased by $900, while Cash decreased by $900, as shown here:

DATE Mar 5

ACCOUNTS Supplies Cash Purchased office supplies.

POST REF.

DR. 900

CR. 900

The March 31 trial balance, as shown in Exhibit 3-1 on page 140, shows Supplies with a $900 debit balance. During March, Osborne Consulting uses some of these supplies to conduct business. Therefore, Osborne Consulting’s March 31 Balance Sheet should not report supplies of $900. To figure out the amount of supplies used, Osborne Consulting counts the supplies on hand at the end of March. The supplies on hand are still an asset to the business. Assume that Osborne Consulting has supplies costing $600 at March 31. The supplies purchased ($900) minus the supplies on hand at the end of March ($600) equals the value of the supplies used during the month ($300). The amount of supplies used during the month will become supplies expense. The March 31 adjusting entry updates the Supplies account and records Supplies Expense for the month:

GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account Mar 31 Supplies Expense

Debit

Credit

300

Supplies

300 00

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Accounts Receivable

Salaries Payable 550

Bal 3,100 250 Bal 3,350

Unearned Service Revenue

Prepaid Rent Bal 3,000 Bal 2,000

1,000 000

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 144

900 600

150 Bal Bal

450 300

Common Stock

Retained Earnings

Dividends

Revenues ues

Expenses

Service Revenue Bal 7,000 00 0 50 0 250 Bal 7,250 50 0 150 50 0 00 0 Bal 7,400

Salaries Expense Bal

550 550 Bal 1,100

Rent Expense 1,000

Supplies Expense

Supplies Bal Bal

Liabilities

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

300

300

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

145

After the entry is posted to the general ledger, the correct account balances for Supplies and Supplies Expense will be reflected. Long-term assets  Long-lived, tangible assets such as land, buildings, equipment, and furniture used in the operation of a business lasting for more than a year. Depreciation  Allocation of the cost of a long-term asset to expense over its useful life.

Depreciation of long-term assets  Long-term assets, or fixed assets, are assets that last for more than one year. Examples include land, buildings, equipment, and furniture. All of these assets, except land, are used up over time. As a long-term asset is used up, part of the asset’s cost becomes an expense, just as supplies become supplies expense when they are used up. The expensing of a long-term asset’s cost over its useful life is called ­depreciation. No depreciation is recorded for land because it is never really used up. We account for long-term assets in the same way as prepaid expenses and supplies because they are all assets. The major difference is the length of time it takes for the asset to be used up. Prepaid expenses and supplies are typically used within a year, while most long-term assets remain functional for several years. Suppose that, on March 1, Osborne Consulting purchases equipment on account for $12,600 and makes this journal entry:

DATE Mar 1

Straight-line depreciation  A method of estimating depreciation (Cost of the Asset – Salvage Value)/ Useful Life of the Asset. Salvage value  The estimated value of a long-term asset at the end of its useful life.

ACCOUNTS Equipment Accounts Payable Purchased equipment on account.

POST REF.

DR. 12,600

CR. 12,600

After posting the entry, the Equipment account has a $12,600 balance. It is ­difficult to measure the amount of a long-term asset that has been used up over time, so the amount must be estimated. Several methods can be used to estimate the amount of ­depreciation. The most common method, which Osborne Consulting utilizes, is called the straight-line depreciation method. Osborne Consulting believes the equipment will be useful for three years and will be worthless and have no salvage value at the end of its life. Depreciation of this equipment is calculated using the straight-line method as follows:

Depreciation Expense per Year 

Cost of Asset  Salvage Value of Asset $12,600   $4,200 Useful Life of Asset 3

Osborne Consulting purchased the equipment on March 1, so the accountant needs to calculate one month’s Depreciation Expense. To calculate one month’s depreciation, ­divide the yearly depreciation by twelve ($4,200/12 months = $350). Accumulated Depreciation  A contra-asset account that reflects all of the depreciation recorded for an asset to date.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 145

The Accumulated Depreciation Account  Depreciation expense for March is recorded by debiting Depreciation Expense. However, instead of crediting the asset account (as was done with supplies and prepaid expenses) to reduce it, an account called Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment will be credited.

03/04/14 1:45 PM

146

Chapter 3

The journal entry to record depreciation expense for the month of March is as follows:

GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account

Debit

Mar 31 Depreciation Expense, Equipment

Credit

350

Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment

350 50

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Accounts Receivable

Salaries Payable 550

Bal 3,100 250 Bal 3,350

Unearned Service Revenue

Prepaid Rent Bal 3,000 Bal 2,000

Liabilities

1,000

150 Bal Bal

450 300

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Retained Earnings

Dividends

Revenues ues

Expenses

Service Revenue Bal 7,000 00 0 50 0 250 Bal 7,250 50 0 150 50 0 00 0 Bal 7,400

Salaries Expense Bal

550 550 Bal 1,100

Rent Expense

Supplies Expense

Supplies Bal Bal

900 600

1,000

300

300

Depreciation Expense, Equipment

Equipment Bal 12,600

350

Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment 350

Contra-account  An account that is linked to another account. A contraaccount will have a normal balance opposite of the account it is linked to.

Net value  The amount found by subtracting the balance of a ­contra-account from the balance of the account it is linked to.

Book value  The asset’s cost minus its accumulated depreciation; also called carrying value.

Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment is a contra-asset account. A contra-­account has three main characteristics: • A contra-account is linked to another account and will always appear with this ­account in the financial statements. • A contra-account’s normal balance is always opposite of the account it is linked to. • The balance in a contra-account is subtracted from the balance of the account it is linked to in order to find the net value of the two accounts. Because it is linked to Equipment, an asset account, Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment will appear on the balance sheet. Being an asset, the Equipment account has a debit balance, so the Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment account will have a credit balance because it is a contra-asset. Since it’s a contra-account, the balance of Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment is subtracted from Equipment. The net amount of a long-term asset is called its book value, or carrying value, and is calculated as follows:

Cost  Accumulated Depreciation  Book (or Carrying) Value

Book Value of a Long-Term Asset Equipment................................................................... Less: Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment .............. Book Value ..................................................................

$12,600 350 $12,250

Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment increases over the life of the asset as the ­asset is used up, which reduces the book value of the equipment. By keeping the cost of the equipment separate from its accumulated depreciation, financial statement users can look at the Equipment account to see how much the asset originally cost and also look

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 146

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

147

at the Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment account to see how much of the original cost has been used up. A business usually keeps an accumulated depreciation account for each type of depreciable long-term asset. If Osborne Consulting, Inc., had both buildings and equipment, it would use two accumulated depreciation accounts, Accumulated Depreciation, Buildings and Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment. Depreciation will be covered more in depth in Chapter 8.

Try It! Jim Oliver is the accountant for Crazy Critters, Inc., a local veterinary clinic. After Jim ­finished preparing the financial statements for the year, he realized that he failed to make an adjusting entry to record $1,800 of depreciation expense. What effect did this error have on Crazy Critters’ financial statements?

Answer

In order to determine the effects of omitting an adjusting entry, we must examine what the adjusting entry should have been. The adjusting entry Jim should have made is:

DATE

ACCOUNTS Depreciation Expense Accumulated Depreciation

POST REF.

DR. 1,800

CR. 1,800

As we can see from the journal entry, Depreciation Expense should have been debited (increased), which would have increased total expenses for the year. An increase in ­total expenses causes a decrease in Net Income. So, the omission of the adjusting entry for depreciation expense causes Net Income, and therefore Retained Earnings, to be overstated. We also see that the Accumulated Depreciation account should have been credited (increased), which would cause total assets to decrease because Accumulated Depreciation is a contra-asset account. So, the omission of the adjusting entry for depreciation expense also causes the total assets to be overstated.

How Are Financial Statements Prepared from an Adjusted Trial Balance? The Adjusted Trial Balance 3 Prepare financial

s­ tatements from an adjusted trial balance

Adjusted trial balance  A list of all the accounts of a business with their adjusted balances.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 147

Earlier in the chapter, the unadjusted trial balance in Exhibit 3-1 on page 140 showed the ­account balances for Osborne Consulting, Inc., before the adjustments had been made. After adjustment, Osborne Consulting’s accounts would appear as presented in Exhibit 3-2. Prior to preparing the financial statements, an adjusted trial balance is prepared to make sure total debits still equal total credits after adjusting entries have been recorded and posted. The adjusted trial balance for Osborne Consulting is presented in Exhibit 3-3.

03/04/14 1:45 PM

148

Chapter 3

Assets Cashh C 26,300

Accounts Receivable e 3,100 250 3,350

Supplies 900 300 600

Stockholders’ olders’ Equity

Liabilities Prepaid Rent 3,000 1,000 2,000

Equipment 12,600

Accum. Depreciation,, Equipment 350

Accounts Payable

Common Stock C St k

13,100

20,000

Salaries Payable

Retained Earnings

550 550

9,500

Unearned Service Revenue 150 450 300

Dividends 3,200

Salaries Expense 550 550 1,100

Rent Expense 1,000

Supplies Expense 300

Service Revenue 7,000 250 150 7,400

Depreciation Expense, Equipment 350

Utilities Expense 400

Exhibit 3-2

Osborne Consulting, Inc. Adjusted Trial Balance March 31, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Prepaid Rent Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Unearned Service Revenue Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Salaries Expense Rent Expense Utilities Expense Depreciation Expense, Equipment Supplies Expense Total

DEBIT $26,300 3,350 600 2,000 12,600

CREDIT

$

350 13,100 550 300 20,000 9,500

3,200 7,400 1,100 1,000 400 350 300 $51,200

$51,200

Exhibit 3-3

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 148

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

149

Preparing the Financial Statements The March financial statements of Osborne Consulting, Inc., are prepared from the adjusted trial balance in Exhibit 3-3. The financial statements should be prepared in the same order that we used in previous chapters: 1. The income statement (Exhibit 3-4) reports the revenues and the expenses to determine net income or net loss for a period of time. 2. The statement of retained earnings (Exhibit 3-5) shows the changes in ­retained earnings during the period and computes the ending balance of retained ­earnings. Notice that the Retained Earnings balance of $9,500 on the adjusted trial balance does not represent the ending Retained Earnings balance because the account has not yet been updated for the current period’s earnings or dividends. 3. The balance sheet (Exhibit 3-6) reports the assets, liabilities, and stockholders’ equity to see the financial position of the business at a specific point in time. As we first discussed in Chapter 1, all financial statements include these elements: • Heading

1. Name of the entity, such as Osborne Consulting, Inc.



2. Title of the statement: Income Statement, Statement of Retained Earnings, or Balance Sheet



3. Date, or period, covered by the statement: Quarter ended March 31, 2014, or March 31, 2014

• Body of the statement On the income statement, expenses may be listed in descending order from the largest amount to the smallest amount, as Osborne Consulting did, or they may be listed in some other order, such as alphabetical order.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 149

03/04/14 1:45 PM

150

Chapter 3

Osborne Consulting, Inc. Income Statement Quarter Ended March 31, 2014 Revenue: Service Revenue Expenses: Salaries Expense Rent Expense Utilities Expense Depreciation Expense, Equipment Supplies Expense Total Expenses Net Income

$7,400 $1,100 1,000 400 350 300 3,150 $4,250

Exhibit 3-4 Osborne Consulting, Inc. Statement of Retained Earnings Quarter Ended March 31, 2014 $ 9,500 4,250 13,750 3,200 $10,550

Retained Earnings, March 1, 2014 Add: Net Income Subtotal Less: Dividends Retained Earnings, March 31, 2014

Exhibit 3-5 Osborne Consulting, Inc. Balance Sheet March 31, 2014 ASSETS Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Prepaid Rent Equipment Less: Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment

Total Assets

$26,300 3,350 600 2,000

LIABILITIES Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Unearned Service Revenue Total Liabilities

$13,100 550 300 13,950

$12,600

350

12,250

$44,500

STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities & Stockholders’ Equity

20,000 10,550 30,550 $44,500

Exhibit 3-6

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 150

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

151

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analyze

How can I tell how well a business is performing?

A company’s financial statements will provide information regarding the performance of the company.

The income statement reflects how profitable a business has been for a specified period of time. The statement of retained earnings shows how much of a company’s earnings have been distributed to the stockholders during the period. And the balance sheet reflects the business’s financial position on a given date. In other words, it shows what assets the business has and who has rights to those assets.

How Does a Company Prepare for a New Accounting Period? Completing the Accounting Cycle 4 Prepare closing entries and a post-closing trial balance

Closing entries  Journal entries that are prepared at the end of the accounting period. Closing entries zero out the revenue, expense, and dividend accounts so accounting can begin for the next period.

We have now seen steps one through six in the accounting cycle completed for Osborne Consulting. The entire accounting cycle can be completed by finishing steps seven and eight. Step seven of the accounting cycle is the journalizing and posting of the closing entries, and step eight is the preparation of a post-closing trial balance. In order to complete the accounting cycle, closing entries must be journalized and posted. Earlier in the chapter, we processed the transactions for Osborne Consulting and prepared the financial statements at the end of March. If we continue recording information in the revenue, expense, and dividend accounts, we will lose track of what activity happened prior to April compared to what happens in April and beyond, making it i­mpossible to prepare accurate financial statements for the next accounting period. In order to not confuse the transactions from the two different periods, the revenue, expense, and dividend accounts must be reset to zero before we start recording transactions for April. It is similar to resetting the scoreboard at the end of a game before you start a new game. Because we must keep the accounting equation in balance, we cannot just erase the balances in the revenue, expense, and dividend accounts because it would cause the equation to become unbalanced. To keep the accounting equation in balance and still be able to zero out these accounts, we will use closing entries. Closing entries are utilized to accomplish two things: • The revenue, expense, and dividend account balances from the current accounting period are set back to zero so accounting for the next period can begin. • The revenue, expense, and dividend account balances from the current accounting period are transferred into Retained Earnings so the accounting equation stays in balance. Transferring the revenue and expense account balances into Retained Earnings actually transfers the Net Income, or Net Loss, for the current period into Retained Earnings. Transferring the dividend account balance into Retained Earnings decreases Retained Earnings by the amount of dividends for the period.

Temporary accounts  The revenue, expense, and dividend accounts; these accounts are closed at the end of the accounting period.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 151

The revenue, expense, and dividend accounts are known as temporary accounts. They are called temporary because they are used temporarily to record activity for a specific period, the accounting period, and then they are closed into Retained Earnings. It is easy to remember the temporary accounts if you think of the color RED. The R in RED stands for revenues, the E stands for expenses, and the D stands for dividends. The RED accounts are closed at the end of each accounting period.

03/04/14 1:45 PM

152

Chapter 3

Before closing the temporary accounts, the accounting equation for a corporation would be as follows:

Stockholders’ Equity Liabilities

Assets

Common Stock

Retained Earnings

Dividends

Revenues

Expenses

After closing the temporary accounts, the accounting equation would be as follows:

Stockholders’ Equity Assets

Permanent accounts  The asset, liability, common stock and retained earnings accounts; these accounts are not closed at the end of the ­accounting period.

Liabilities

Common Stock

Retained Earnings

The accounts that remain in the accounting equation after closing are called ­ ermanent accounts. Assets, liabilities, common stock, and retained earnings are not p closed at the end of the period because they are not used to measure activity for only one specific period. Consider Cash, Accounts Receivable, Accounts Payable, and Common Stock. These accounts do not represent business activity for a single period, so they are not closed at the end of the period. Their balances carry over to the next period. For example, the ending Cash balance at March 31, 2014, becomes the beginning balance on April 1, 2014.

The Three Closing Entries: Revenues, Expenses, and Dividends To journalize closing entries, complete the following steps:

Step 1 Close the revenue accounts and move their balances into the Retained Earnings account. To close revenues, debit each revenue account for the amount of its credit balance. Transfer the revenue balances to Retained Earnings by crediting the Retained Earnings account for the total amount of the revenues. This closing entry transfers total revenues to the credit side of Retained Earnings.



Step 2 Close the expense accounts and move their balances into the Retained Earnings account. To close expenses, credit each expense account for the amount of its debit balance. Transfer the expense balances to Retained Earnings by debiting the Retained Earnings account for the total amount of the expenses. This closing entry transfers total expenses to the debit side of Retained Earnings.



Step 3 Close the Dividends account and move its balance into the Retained Earnings account. To close the Dividends account, credit it for the amount of its debit balance and debit the Retained Earnings account. This entry transfers the dividends to the debit side of Retained Earnings.

Remember that Net Income is equal to Revenues minus Expenses. So, closing the Revenues and Expenses into Retained Earnings (Steps 1 and 2) has the effect of adding Net Income for the period to, or deducting a Net Loss for the period from, Retained Earnings. Once the Dividends account has been subtracted from Retained Earnings, Step 3, the balance in the Retained Earnings account should match ending retained earnings on the statement of retained earnings. The process for making closing entries is the same as it is for making any entry; ­record the entries in the journal and post them to the proper accounts in the ledger.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 152

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

153

Now, let’s apply this process to Osborne Consulting, Inc., at the end of March:

Step 1

GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account

Debit

Mar 31 Service Revenue

Credit

7,400

Retained Earnings

7,400 00

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Liabilities ties

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Retained Earnings

Retained Earnings

Dividends

Dividends

Revenues

Expenses

Service Revenue

Bal 3,200

Bal 9,500 000 00 7,400

Salaries Expense

Bal 7,000 00 0 50 0 250 150 50 0 7,400 Bal 7,400 00 0 Bal -0--

Bal

550 550 Bal 1,100

Rent Expense Bal 1,000

Supplies Expense 300

Bal

Depreciation Expense, Equipment Bal

350

Utilities Expense Bal

400

  Step 2 GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account Mar 31 Retained Earnings

Debit

Credit

3,150

Salaries Expense

1,100 00

Rent Expense

1,000 00

Supplies Expense

300 00

Depreciation Expense, Equipment

350 50

Utilities Expense

400 00

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Liabilities ties

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Retained Earnings 3,150

Bal 9,500 000 00 7,400

Retained Earnings

Dividends Bal 3,200

Dividends

Revenues

Expenses

Service Revenue Bal 7,000 00 0 50 0 250 150 500 7,400 Bal 7,400 00 0 Bal -0--

Salaries Expense Bal

550 550 Bal 1,100 Bal -0-

1,100

Rent Expense Bal 1,000 -0Bal

1,000

Supplies Expense Bal Bal

300 -0-

300

Depreciation Expense, Equipment Bal Bal

350 -0-

350

Utilities Expense Bal Bal

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 153

400 -0-

400

03/04/14 1:45 PM

154

Chapter 3

  Step 3   GENERAL JOURNAL Date Account Mar 31 Retained Earnings Dividends

Debit

Credit

3,200 3,200 00

GENERAL LEDGER Balance Sheet Assets

Liabilities ties

Income Statement Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Retained Earnings 3,150 3,200

Bal 9,500 000 000 7,400 Bal 10,550 50

Retained Earnings

Dividends

Revenues

Dividends Bal 3,200 Bal -0-

Expenses

Service Revenue

3,200 00

Bal 7,000 00 0 50 0 250 150 50 0 7,400 Bal 7,400 00 0 Bal -0--

Salaries Expense Bal

550 550 Bal 1,100 Bal -0-

1,100

Rent Expense Bal 1,000 -0Bal

1,000

Supplies Expense Bal Bal

300 -0-

300

Depreciation Expense, Equipment Bal Bal

350 -0-

350

Utilities Expense Bal Bal

400 -0-

400

At this point, the Retained Earnings account balance reflects all the net income earned, net loss incurred, and dividends paid during the life of Osborne Consulting, Inc., to date. After the closing entries, Retained Earnings ends with a balance of $10,550. This balance should, and does, match the balance on the statement of retained earnings and the balance sheet presented in Exhibits 3-5 and 3-6 on page 150.

Post-Closing Trial Balance Post-closing trial balance  A list of the accounts and their balances at the end of the accounting period after closing entries have been journalized and posted.

The accounting cycle ends with the preparation of a post-closing trial balance, as seen in Exhibit 3-7 on the following page. This trial balance lists the accounts and their ­adjusted balances after closing. Only assets, liabilities, common stock, and retained earnings appear on the post-closing trial balance. No temporary accounts—revenues, expenses, or dividends—are included because they have been closed. The accounts in the ledger are now up to date and ready for the next period’s transactions.

Summary of the Adjusting and Closing Processes Businesses record adjusting entries at the end of the accounting period to accomplish two purposes: 1. Report net income or net loss accurately on the income statement. 2. Reflect the correct account balances on the balance sheet. Each adjusting entry will always affect one income statement account, a revenue or an expense, and one balance sheet account, an asset or a liability. Cash is never included in an adjusting entry because cash is always recorded accurately at the time it is received or paid.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 154

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

155

Osborne Consulting, Inc. Post-Closing Trial Balance March 31, 2014 BALANCE DEBIT CREDIT $26,300 3,350 600 2,000 12,600 $ 350 13,100 550 300 20,000 10,550 $44,850 $44,850

ACCOUNT TITLE Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Prepaid Rent Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Unearned Service Revenue Common Stock Retained Earnings Total

Exhibit 3-7 Accruals and deferrals can be summarized as follows: 1. With an accrued revenue or expense, a revenue or expense is recorded first when the revenue is earned or the expense is incurred and cash is received or paid later. 2. With a deferred revenue or expense, cash is received or paid first. The revenue or expense is recorded later as the revenue is earned or the expense is incurred. Exhibit 3-8 summarizes the accrual and deferral adjustments.

First Accrued Expenses

Accrued Revenues

Accruals: Cash transaction comes later Dr. Cr.

Accrue an expense and the related liability: Salaries Expense Salaries Payable Accrue a revenue and the related asset: Accounts Receivable Service Revenue First

Later

Dr.

Cr.

Pay cash and decrease the liability: XXX

XXX

XXX

Salaries Payable Cash

XXX

Receive cash and decrease the asset: XXX

XXX

Cash Accounts Receivable

Deferrals: Cash transaction comes first Dr. Cr.

Prepaid Expenses, Depreciable Assets

Pay cash and record an asset: Prepaid Rent Cash

XXX

Unearned Revenues

Receive cash and record a liability: Cash Unearned Service Revenue

XXX

XXX

Later

Dr.

XXX

Record an expense and decrease the asset: Rent Expense Prepaid Rent

XXX

XXX

Record a revenue and decrease the liability: Unearned Service Revenue Service Revenue

XXX

XXX Cr.

XXX

XXX

Exhibit 3-8

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 155

03/04/14 1:45 PM

156

Chapter 3

Businesses record closing entries at the end of the accounting period to accomplish two purposes: • Zero out the revenue, expense, and dividend accounts. • Transfer the balances of the revenue, expense, and dividend accounts into Retained Earnings. Closing entries are the end-of-period journal entries that get the temporary accounts— revenues, expenses, and dividends—ready for the next accounting period by zeroing them out. Closing entries also transfer the balances from the temporary accounts into the Retained Earnings account. The post-closing trial balance is the final step in the accounting cycle. The post-closing trial balance is prepared to ensure that total debits still equal total credits before a new accounting period is started.

Focus on Decision Making “Who Owns Net Income and Where Does Income Go?”

What is net income? You can’t touch it. You can’t see it. You can’t spend it. There’s not even an account in the general ledger that is called Net Income. You can touch, see, and spend cash. But using accrual accounting, net income is not cash. So what is net ­income? Net income is the net of revenues less expenses. But who gets the net income? Who owns net income? The answer is owners own net income. Think of revenues as something that benefits owners. Think of expenses as something that takes away some of that benefit that revenues provide. The net, whether net income or loss, belongs to the owners. At the end of each accounting period, we want to close out the old measure and start a new measure of revenues, expenses, and net income. We have closing entries that zero out all the revenue and expense accounts so they start with a zero balance. However, we do not zero out the impact that revenues and expenses had on balance sheet accounts such as cash, accounts receivable, and accounts payable. To get this to work, we take the net income and recognize that it belongs to the business’s owners. It’s a part of the owners’ equity. If the business does not distribute it to the owners, the net income is retained in the business. Earnings over time can be retained in the business or distributed to owners.

How They Do It: A Look At Business

Let’s look at the Walt Disney Company. Disney operates amusement parks, makes movies, sells clothing, and a lot of other things related to the entertainment business. Some years are very good. Some years are not as good. At the end of 2011 and the beginning of 2012, Disney had retained earnings of $38.375 billion. This figure represents all of the net income and net losses earned by Disney, less any dividends to its stockholders, since the company was founded in 1923. In 2012, Disney had net income of $5.682 billion. However, it paid its stockholders $1.092 billion in dividends. So, at the end of 2012, Disney had retained earnings of $42.965 billion. Disney started out 2012 with retained earnings of $38.375 billion, added net income of $5.682 billion, and paid dividends of $1.092 b ­ illion, thus creating an ending retained earnings of $42.965 billion. During 2012, Disney had sales of $42.278 billion and expenses of $36.596 billion, creating net income of $5.682 billion. This net income belongs to Disney’s owners and was reflected in the increase in retained earnings, which is a part of stockholders’ equity. Now what did Disney do with the net income it did not pay to its stockholders? Disney used the earnings to invest in new assets such as movies and attractions at its amusement parks. Disney also used some of the money to pay its liabilities. Disney paid its stockholders a dividend, but retained some of its earnings to help grow the business for the future. Next, let’s think about Under Armour, Inc. Under Armour manufactures and sells sporting apparel. From the year that it was founded, 1996, until the end of 2012, Under Armour had good and bad years. Under Armour had never paid dividends to its owners, its stockholders. At the end of 2011 and the beginning of 2012, the net of all of Under

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 156

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

157

Armour’s income and losses throughout its life summed to $366.164 million. In 2012, Under Armour had net income of $128.778 million. Under Armour decided it needed to retain all its 2012 earnings to grow the business. It once again decided not to pay dividends to its stockholders. So at the end of 2012, Under Armour had retained earnings of $493.181 million. Under Armour started out 2012 with retained earnings of $366.164 million, had a special tax adjustment of $1.761 million, added net income of $128.778 million, thus creating an ending retained earnings of $493.181 million. During 2012, Under Armour had sales of $1,834,921,000 and expenses of $1,706,143,000, creating net income of $128,778,000. This net income belongs to Under Armour’s owners and was reflected in the increase in retained earnings, which is a part of stockholders’ equity. Now what did Under Armour do with the net income? Under Armour used the money to invest in new assets such as cash, accounts receivable, and property and equipment. Under Armour did not pay its stockholders a dividend. Under Armour ­retained the earnings to help finance the business’ growth.

Summary MyAccountingLab

1

Understand the revenue recognition and matching principles

Here is what you should know after reading this chapter. MyAccountingLab will help you identify what you know and where to go when you need practice.

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Accrual versus cash accounting

Accrual accounting (p. 138)

• Revenue recognition principle recognizes revenues when they are earned

Accruals (p. 138)

• Matching principle recognizes expenses when they are incurred

Adjusting entries (p. 138) Cash-basis accounting (p. 138) Deferrals (p. 138) Fiscal year (p. 137) Matching principle (p. 138) Revenue recognition principle (p. 138)

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 157

03/04/14 1:45 PM

158

2

Chapter 3

Understand the four types of adjustments, and prepare adjusting entries

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Adjusting entries

Accrued expenses (p. 141)

• Are recorded at the end of the accounting period

Accumulated Depreciation (p. 145)

• Always include one revenue or expense ­account and one asset or liability account • Ensure that net income is reported properly • Ensure that the proper balance is reflected in asset and liability accounts

Book value (p. 146) Carrying value (p. 146) Contra-account (p. 146) Deferred expenses (p. 142) Deferred revenue (p. 141) Depreciation (p. 145) Long-term assets (p. 145) Net value (p. 146) Prepaid expenses (p. 140) Salvage value (p. 145) Straight-line depreciation (p. 145) Unadjusted trial balance (p. 140) Unearned revenue (p. 139)

3

Prepare financial statements from an adjusted trial balance

The adjusted trial balance

Adjusted trial balance (p. 147)

• Is prepared after all adjusting entries have been entered in the general journal and posted to the general ledger • Is used to prepare the period-end financial statements

4

Prepare closing entries and a post-closing trial balance

Closing entries

Closing entries (p. 151)

• Are made at the end of an ­accounting ­period in order to prepare for a new ­accounting period

Permanent accounts (p. 152)

• Transfer the balances in all revenue ­accounts, all expense accounts, and the dividends ­account into the retained earnings account

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 158

Post-closing trial balance (p. 154) Temporary accounts (p. 151)

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

159

Accounting Practice Discussion Questions 1. If XYZ Consulting performs a consulting service and bills the customer on June 28 and receives payment from the customer on July 19, on what date would revenue be recorded if a. XYZ uses the cash basis of accounting? b. XYZ uses the accrual basis of accounting? 2. What does the matching principle require companies to match? 3. Why does the time period in which revenue is recognized matter? 4. What is a deferral? Under which basis of accounting, cash or accrual, would deferrals come into play? Under what circumstances would a company record a deferral? 5. Why do companies prepare adjusting entries? 6. What are some similarities and differences between assets and expenses? 7. What type of account (asset, liability, revenue, or expense) would Joe’s Towing Company debit when it pays (credits) cash for each of the following transactions? a. Pays $100 to fill tow truck with gas b. Pays $1,000 to have a gas company deliver gas for its on-site refueling station Did you choose the same type of account or different ones? Why? 8. Describe the type of transaction that gives rise to a deferred revenue journal entry during the year. Why might deferred revenues require adjustment? 9. What kind of account is accumulated depreciation? How is it reported on the financial statements? 10. What are the objectives of the closing process? Which kind of accounts get closed? What is the only account that is affected by the closing process but not closed?

Self Check 1. The revenue recognition principle says a. divide time into equal periods to measure net income or net loss properly. b. record revenue only after you have earned it. c. match revenues and expenses in order to compute net income. d. record revenue only when you receive cash. 2. Adjusting the accounts is the process of a. subtracting expenses from revenues to measure net income. b. recording transactions as they occur during the accounting period. c. updating the accounts at the end of the accounting period. d. zeroing out account balances to prepare for the next accounting period. 3. Which of the following terms describe the types of adjusting entries? a. Expenses and revenues b. Prepaid expenses and prepaid revenues c. Deferrals and accruals d. Deferrals and depreciation

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 159

03/04/14 1:45 PM

160

Chapter 3 4. Assume that the weekly payroll of ASR, Inc., is $4,500. Employees work five days per week, Monday through Friday. December 31, the end of the year, falls on Wednesday, but the company won’t pay employees for the full week until its usual payday, Friday. What adjusting entry will ASR, Inc., make on Wednesday, December 31? DATE a.

b.

c.

d.

ACCOUNTS Salaries Payable Salaries Expense

POST REF.

DR. 2,700

CR. 2,700

Salaries Expense Accumulated Salaries

2,700

Salaries Expense Cash

2,700

Salaries Expense Salaries Payable

2,700

2,700

2,700

2,700

5. Unearned Revenue is always a. revenue. b. stockholders’ equity. c. a liability. d. an asset. 6. The adjusted trial balance shows a. assets, liabilities, and common stock only. b. revenues and expenses only. c. amounts that may be out of balance. d. amounts that are ready for the financial statements. 7. Which of the following accounts is not closed? a. Salaries Expense b. Dividends c. Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment d. Service Revenue 8. What do closing entries accomplish? a. Bring the Retained Earnings account to its correct ending balance b. Transfer revenues, expenses, and dividends to retained earnings c. Zero out the revenues, expenses, and dividends to prepare them for the next accounting period d. All of the above 9. Which of the following is not a closing entry? DATE a.

b.

c.

d.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 160

ACCOUNTS Salaries Payable Retained Earnings

POST REF.

DR. 1,000

1,000

Service Revenue Retained Earnings

1,200

Retained Earnings Dividends

1,500

Retained Earnings Rent Expense

CR.

1,200

1,500 800 800

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

161

10. Which correctly represents the flow of information from one financial statement to another? a. Statement of retained earnings to the balance sheet b. Income statement to the statement of retained earnings c. Both a and b are correct. d. None of the above is correct. 11. According to the Real World Accounting Video, the excess of sales revenue over cost of goods sold is called _______________. a. the sales margin or net sales b. the gross margin or gross profit c. net income or earnings after taxes 12. According to the Real World Accounting Video, GAAP is the term used for _______________. a. Government Accredited Accounting Positions b. Generally Accepted Accounting Principles c. General and Accounting Procedures Answers are given after Written Communication.

MyAccountingLab

Short Exercises S3-1. Accounting principles (Learning Objectives 1 & 2) 5–10 min. Match the accounting term with the corresponding definition. ____ 1. Accrual-basis accounting

a. Any consecutive 12-month period.

____ 2. Matching principle

b. Records the impact of a business event as it occurs regardless of whether the transaction affected cash.

____ 3. R  evenue recognition principle ____ 4. Fiscal period

c. Records expenses when incurred to sell goods or provide services. d. Records revenue when it is earned.

S3-2. Accounting terminology (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 5–10 min. Match the accounting term with the corresponding definition. ____ 1. Accumulated depreciation ____ 2. Adjusted trial balance ____ 3. Adjusting entry ____ 4. Book value ____ 5. Contra-account ____ 6. Depreciation ____ 7. Long-term asset

a. An account whose normal balance is ­opposite that of its companion account. b. Entry made to assign revenues to the period in which they are earned and ­expenses to the period incurred. c. A list of accounts with their adjusted balances. d. The cumulative sum of all depreciation ­recorded for an asset. e. The allocation of a long-term asset’s cost to expense over its useful life. f. The asset’s cost less its accumulated depreciation. g. Long-lived asset used to operate the business.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 161

03/04/14 1:45 PM

162

Chapter 3 S3-3. Types of adjusting entries (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. The trial balance of Allen & Associates includes the following balance sheet accounts. For each account, identify the type of adjusting entry that is typically made for the ­account (deferred expense, deferred revenue, accrued expense, or accrued revenue), and give the related income statement account used in that adjustment. Example: Prepaid Insurance: deferred expense; Insurance Expense a. Interest Payable

d. Supplies

b. Unearned Service Revenue

e. Accumulated Depreciation

c. Accounts Receivable S3-4. Adjusting journal entry—prepaid rent (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Julie’s Flower Shop’s Prepaid Rent balance is $4,500 on July 1. This prepaid rent ­represents six months’ rent. Journalize and post the adjusting entry on July 31 to record one month’s rent. Compute the balances of the two accounts involved on July 31. S3-5. Adjusting journal entry—supplies (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. On September 1, during its first month of operations, Dagher Company purchased ­supplies worth $3,500 and debited the supplies account for that amount. On December 31, an inventory of supplies showed $1,000 of supplies on hand. What ­adjusting journal entry should be made for December 31? S3-6. Adjusting journal entry—interest expense (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. In order to purchase equipment and supplies, Sinclair Bike Shop, Inc., borrowed $28,000 on August 1 by signing a note payable to Community One Bank. Interest expense for Sinclair Bike Shop, Inc., is $140 per month. Journalize an adjusting entry to accrue interest expense at December 31, assuming no other adjusting entries have been made for the year. Post to the two accounts affected by the adjustment. S3-7. Adjusting journal entry—magazine subscriptions (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Backcountry, Inc., an outdoor magazine, collected $2,700 on June 1 for one-year subscriptions from subscribers in advance. Journalize and post the adjusting entry on December 31 to record the revenue that Backcountry, Inc., has earned, assuming no other adjusting entries have been made for the year. Compute the balances of the two accounts involved. S3-8. Adjusting journal entry—salaries, accrued revenue, interest expense (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Journalize the following adjusting entries at August 31:

1. Services provided but not recorded, $2,700. 2. Salaries earned by employees but not recorded, $3,200. 3. Accrued interest on a note payable, $260. S3-9. Adjusting journal entry—depreciation expense, interest expense (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Byblos Company purchased furniture on June 1 for $60,000, paying $20,000 cash and signing a 6%, 2-month note for the remaining balance. The furniture is expected to depreciate by $12,000 each year. Byblos Company prepares monthly financial ­statements. Make any adjusting journal entries that should be made on June 30th.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 162

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

163

S3-10. Closing entries (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. From the following list of accounts from the adjusted trial balance, identify each as an asset, liability, stockholders’ equity, revenue, or expense. Use the most detailed account type appropriate. Also, state whether each account is a permanent or temporary account and whether it is an account that gets closed at the end of the accounting period. Following the accounts is a sample of the format to use.

1. 2. 3. 4.

5. Unearned Service Revenue 6. Prepaid Rent 7. Dividends

Depreciation Expense Sales Revenue Building Cash

Account

Type of Account

Permanent/Temporary

Closed

Supplies

Asset

Permanent

No

S3-11. Financial statements and closing entries (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 10–15 min. The following selected accounts and balances appear on the adjusted trial balance for Waverly, Inc., on July 31, 2014:

Service Revenue ........................................ Rent Expense ............................................. Salaries Expense ........................................ Dividends ................................................... Common Stock .......................................... Retained Earnings ......................................

$ 1,800 650 575 300 25,000 4,100

1. What is the net income or net loss? 2. What is the change in Retained Earnings? 3. Journalize the closing entries required. S3-12. Adjusting and closing entries (Learning Objectives 2 & 4) 5–10 min. For the following series of journal entries, indicate whether each is an adjusting entry (ADJ) or a closing entry (CL).

TYPE OF ENTRY (ADJ OR CL) ACCOUNTS Salaries Expense Salaries Payable

DR. 725

CR. 725

Service Revenue Retained Earnings

4,200

Retained Earnings Dividends

1,500

Unearned Revenue Service Revenue

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 163

POST REF.

4,200

1,500 940 940

03/04/14 1:45 PM

164

Chapter 3 S3-13. Preparing a post-closing trial balance (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. After closing its accounts at July 31, 2014, Anderson Realty, Inc., had the following ­account balances:

Notes Payable .......................... Prepaid Rent ............................ Accounts Receivable ................ Prepaid Insurance .................... Accounts Payable..................... Equipment................................

$ 5,000 1,600 2,300 4,200 2,100 45,500

Cash......................................... Service Revenue ...................... Retained Earnings .................... Common Stock ........................ Salaries Expense ...................... Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment................................

$ 3,800 0 10,700 35,000 0 4,600

Prepare Anderson Realty’s post-closing trial balance at July 31, 2014. List accounts in proper order.

MyAccountingLab

Exercises (Group A) E3-14A. Adjusting journal entries—unearned revenue and accrued revenue (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Suppose you started up your own landscaping business. A customer paid you $170 in advance to mow his or her lawn while he or she was on vacation. You performed landscaping services for a local business, but the business hasn’t paid you the $440 fee yet. A customer pays you $215 cash for landscaping services. Answer the following questions about the correct way to account for your revenue under accrual-basis accounting:

1. Name the accounts used to record these events. 2. Prepare the journal entries to record the three transactions. E3-15A. Adjusting journal entry—prepaid insurance (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Calculate the missing amounts for each of the following Prepaid Insurance situations. For situation A, journalize the adjusting entry. Consider each situation separately.

Situation Beginning Prepaid Insurance ................................... Payments for Prepaid Insurance during the year.......... Total amount to account for..................................... Ending Prepaid Insurance ........................................ Insurance Expense...................................................

A

B

C

D

$ 350 1,300 ? 300 $ ?

$ 800 ? ? 400 $1,300

? 2,200 3,600 ? $2,600

$ 700 ? 2,300 ? $1,400

E3-16A. Common adjusting journal entries (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Prepare the adjusting entries for December 31, 2014 for Rabih & Moe Co. using the following data: a. Salaries and Wages Payable $0: Salaries are paid every Friday for the current week. Five employees receive a weekly salary of $900 each, and three earn a weekly ­salary of $500 each. December 31 is a Wednesday. Employees do not work weekends. All employees worked the last 3 days of December. b. Notes Receivable $90,000: This is a 6-month note, dated October 1, 2014, with a 6% interest rate.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 164

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

165

E3-17A. Error analysis (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. The adjusting entries for the following adjustments were omitted at period-end: a. Prepaid rent expired, $3,000. b. Depreciation, $1,300. c. Employee salaries owed for Monday through Wednesday of a five-day workweek, $4,000. d. Supplies used during the period, $800. e. Unearned service revenue now earned, $4,200. Requirement Compute the amount that net income for the year is overstated or understated for each omitted entry. Use the following format to help analyze the transactions.

Transaction

Overstated/Understated

Amount

Sample a., b., etc.

Overstated

$5,000

E3-18A. Common adjusting journal entries (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Prepare year-end adjustments for the following transactions. a. Accrued interest on notes receivable is $120. b. $1,500 of unearned service revenue has been recognized. c. Three years’ rent, totaling $30,000, was paid in advance at the beginning of the year. d. Services totaling $2,000 had been performed but not yet billed at the end of the year. e. Depreciation on equipment totaled $6,000 for the year. f. Supplies purchased totaled $1,000. By year end, only $250 of supplies remained. g. Salaries owed to employees at the end of the year total $1,700. E3-19A. Common adjusting journal entries (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. The accounting records of Media Unlimited include the following unadjusted balances at September 30: Accounts Receivable, $1,800; Supplies, $900; Salaries Payable, $0; Unearned Service Revenue, $900; Service Revenue, $4,300; Salaries Expense, $2,500; and Supplies Expense, $0. The following data pertain to the September 30 adjusting entries: a. Service revenue accrued, $1,600. b. Unearned service revenue that has been earned, $300. c. Supplies on hand, $50. d. Salaries owed to employees, $1,400. Requirement Record the adjustments, then post them to T-accounts, labeling each adjustment by ­letter. Calculate each account’s adjusted balance.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 165

03/04/14 1:45 PM

166

Chapter 3 E3-20A. Income statement preparation (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. The accountant for Halco, Inc., posted adjusting entries (a) through (e) to the accounts at December 31, 2014. Selected balance sheet accounts and all the revenues and ­expenses of the entity follow in T-account form.

Accounts Receivable (e)

Supplies

7,000 1,100

2,500 (a)

800

Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment (b)

Accumulated Depreciation, Building

3,600 0 1,400 0

(c)

Salaries Payable (d)

Service Revenue 2,300

(e)

Salaries Expense (d)

10,500 2,300

50,000 3,600

Supplies Expense (a)

800

Depreciation Expense, Equipment (b)

1,400

15,700 1,100

Depreciation Expense, Building (c)

3,600

Requirements Quick solution: Net Loss = $1,800

1. Explain the purpose for each adjusting entry. 2. Calculate ending balances in the accounts and use the appropriate accounts to prepare the income statement of Halco, Inc., for the year ended December 31, 2014. List expenses in order from largest to smallest.

3. Were the 2014 operations successful? Give the reason for your answer. E3-21A. Statement of retained earnings preparation (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Delta Alarm, Inc., began the year with $20,000 of common stock and $32,000 of retained earnings. On May 5, investors bought $12,000 of additional stock in the ­business. On August 22, the business purchased land valued at $80,000. The income statement for the year ended December 31, 2014, reported a net loss of $9,000. During this fiscal year, the business paid $300 each month for dividends. Requirements

1. Prepare Delta Alarm’s statement of retained earnings for the year ended December 31, 2014.

2. Did the retained earnings of the business increase or decrease during the year? What caused this change?

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 166

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

167

E3-22A. Recreating adjusting journal entries (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. The adjusted trial balances of Rimrock, Inc., at March 31, 2014, and March 31, 2015, include these amounts:

Supplies ................................................................................................ Salaries Payable.................................................................................... Unearned Service Revenue ...................................................................

2014

2015

$ 1,600 2,700 14,500

$4,100 1,800 8,200

Analysis of the accounts at March 31, 2015, reveals these transactions for the past twelve months:

Purchase of supplies........................................................................................... Cash payments for salaries ................................................................................. Cash receipts in advance for service revenue......................................................

$ 7,300 51,400 74,000

Requirement Compute the amount of supplies expense, salaries expense, and service revenue Rimrock, Inc., will report for the year ended March 31, 2015. Solve by making T-accounts and posting the information to solve for the unknown amounts. E3-23A. Financial statement preparation (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. The adjusted trial balance of Credit Financier Co. appears below. Using the information from the adjusted trial balance, you are to prepare an income statement, a retained earnings statement, and a balance sheet for the month ending December 31.

Credit Financier Co. Adjusted Trial Balance December 31, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Equipment Accumulated Depreciation—Equipment Accounts Payable Unearned Service Revenue Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Supplies Expense Depreciation Expense Rent Expense Total

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 167

DEBIT $18,400 5,200 4,800 18,500

CREDIT

$ 7,000 6,000 8,000 18,000 10,400 6,500 19,500 4,100 6,500 4,900 $68,900

$68,900

03/04/14 1:45 PM

168

Chapter 3 E3-24A. Prepare closing entries (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Requirements

1. Using the following selected accounts of Allied Electrical, Inc., at November 30, 2014, prepare the entity’s closing entries:

Common Stock ........................ Service Revenue ...................... Unearned Revenues ................. Salaries Expense ...................... Accumulated Depreciation ....... Supplies Expense..................... Interest Revenue ...................... Interest Expense ......................

$25,000 90,000 2,500 24,400 33,600 2,800 750 3,650

Accounts Receivable .................. $ 4,400 Retained Earnings ...................... 16,800 Salaries Payable......................... 2,375 Depreciation Expense................. 5,100 Rent Expense ............................. 8,300 Dividends ................................... 20,000 Supplies ..................................... 825

2. What is Allied Electrical’s ending Retained Earnings balance at November 30, 2014? E3-25A. Statement of retained earnings preparation (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. From the following accounts of Waves Salon, Inc., prepare the business’s statement of retained earnings for the year ended July 31, 2014:

Retained Earnings Clo Clo

150,000 Aug 1 77,000 Clo Bal

92,000 0 0 299,000 0 164,000

Dividends Oct 31 Jan 31 Apr 30 Jul 31 Bal

24,000 10,000 25,000 18,000 77,000 Clo

77,000

E3-26A. Prepare a post-closing trial balance (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. The following post-closing trial balance was prepared for Perfect Portraits, Inc., but some balances were entered in the wrong column. Prepare a corrected post-closing trial balance. Assume all accounts have normal balances and the amounts are correct.

Perfect Portraits, Inc. Post-Closing Trial Balance May 31, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Unearned Service Revenue Common Stock Retained Earnings Total

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 168

DEBIT $ 8,100 4,300

CREDIT

$

800 70,000

11,500 5,600 1,700 3,200 35,000 26,200 $58,900

$107,500

03/04/14 1:45 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

169

E3-27A. Prepare closing entries (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. The adjusted trial balance shown below is for Brava Company at the end of its fiscal year. Requirement

1. Prepare the closing entries for the temporary accounts on June 30. 2. What is Brava’s ending Retained Earning balance on June 30, 2014?

Brava Company Adjusted Trial Balance June 30, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Prepaid Insurance Equipment Accumulated Depreciation—Equipment Accounts Payable Salaries and Wages Payable Unearned Rent Revenue Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Rent Revenue Salaries and Wages Expense Supplies Expense Rent Expense Insurance Expense Depreciation Expense Total

DEBIT $ 15,000 8,200 800 2,700 16,400

CREDIT

$ 4,500 5,500 1,900 800 18,000 6,000 5,900 35,000 14,100 19,500 1,500 12,500 1,800 1,500 $85,800

$85,800

Exercises (Group B) E3-28B. Adjusting journal entries—unearned revenue and accrued revenue (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Suppose you started up your own landscaping business. A customer paid you $170 in advance to mow his or her lawn while he or she was on vacation. You performed landscaping services for a local business, but the business hasn’t paid you the $375 fee yet. A customer pays you $80 cash for landscaping services. Answer the following questions about the correct way to account for your revenue under accrual-basis accounting:

1. Name the accounts used to record these events. 2. Prepare the journal entries to record the three transactions.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 169

03/04/14 1:46 PM

170

Chapter 3 E3-29B. Adjusting journal entry—prepaid insurance (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Calculate the missing amounts for each of the Prepaid Insurance situations. For situation A, journalize the adjusting entry. Consider each situation separately.

Situation Beginning Prepaid Insurance ................................... Payments for Prepaid Insurance during the year.......... Total amount to account for..................................... Ending Prepaid Insurance ........................................ Insurance Expense...................................................

A

B

C

D

$ 400 1,500 ? 700 ?

$ 600 ? ? 400 $1,200

? 2,200 3,300 ? $3,000

$ 800 ? 1,700 ? $ 500

E3-30B. Common adjusting journal entries (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Journalize the adjusting entries at July 31, the end of the accounting period. Omit explanations. a. Employee salaries owed for Monday through Thursday of a five-day workweek, $4,500. b. Unearned service revenue now earned, $1,250. c. Depreciation, $1,900. d. Prepaid rent expired, $350. e. Interest revenue accrued, $980. E3-31B. Error analysis (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. The adjusting entries for the following adjustments were omitted at period-end: a. Prepaid rent expired, $1,400. b. Depreciation, $2,600. c. Employee salaries owed for Monday through Wednesday of a five-day workweek, $3,750. d. Supplies used during the period, $450. e. Unearned service revenue now earned, $2,200. Requirement Compute the amount that net income for the year is overstated or understated for each omitted entry. Use the following format to help analyze the transactions.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 170

Transaction

Overstated/Understated

Amount

Sample a., b., etc.

Overstated

$5,000

03/04/14 1:46 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

171

E3-32B. Common adjusting journal entries (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Journalize the adjusting entry needed at March 31, the fiscal year-end, for each of the following independent situations. No other adjusting entries have been made for the year. a. On February 1, we collected $6,600 rent in advance. We debited Cash and credited Unearned Rent Revenue. The tenant was paying six months’ rent in advance. b. The business holds a $5,000 note receivable. Interest revenue of $520 has been earned on the note but not yet received. c. Salaries expense is $3,100 per day, Monday through Friday, and the business pays employees each Friday. This year, March 31 falls on a Thursday. d. The unadjusted balance of the Supplies account is $1,000. Supplies on hand total $700. e. Equipment was purchased two years ago at a cost of $4,000. The equipment’s useful life is five years. f. On November 1, when $936 was paid for a one-year insurance policy, Prepaid Insurance was debited and Cash was credited. E3-33B. Common adjusting journal entries (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. The accounting records of Activities Unlimited, Inc. include the following ­unadjusted balances at September 30: Accounts Receivable, $2,100; Supplies, $900; Salaries Payable, $0; Unearned Service Revenue, $750; Service Revenue, $4,100; Salaries Expense, $1,850; and Supplies Expense, $0. The following data pertains to September 30 adjusting entries: a. Service revenue accrued, $1,650. b. Unearned service revenue that has been earned, $350. c. Supplies on hand, $240. d. Salaries owed to employees, $980. Requirement Record the adjustments, then post them to T-accounts, labeling each adjustment by letter. Calculate each account’s adjusted balance. E3-34B. Income statement preparation (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. The accountant for Cyclone Construction, Inc., posted adjusting entries (a) through (e) to the accounts at July 31, 2014. Selected balance sheet accounts and all the revenues and expenses of the entity follow in T-account form.

Accounts Receivable (e)

Supplies

29,300 1,200

3,000 (a)

600

Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment (b)

Accumulated Depreciation, Building

5,200 0 1,800 0

(c)

Salaries Payable (d)

Service Revenue 1,700

(e)

Salaries Expense (d)

14,000 1,700

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 171

46,000 6,000

Supplies Expense (a)

600

Depreciation Expense, Equipment (b)

1,800

38,000 1,200

Depreciation Expense, Building (c)

6,000

03/04/14 1:46 PM

172

Chapter 3 Requirements 1. Explain the purpose for each adjusting entry. 2. Calculate ending balances in the accounts and use the appropriate accounts to prepare the income statement of Cyclone Construction, Inc., for the year ended July 31, 2014. List expenses in order from largest to smallest. 3. Were the 2014 operations successful? Give the reason for your answer. E3-35B. Statement of retained earnings preparation (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Williams Industrial, Inc., began the year with $25,000 of common stock and $19,600 of retained earnings. On September 5, investors bought $4,000 of additional stock in the business. On November 22, the business purchased land valued at $37,000. The income statement for the year ended December 31, 2014, reported a net loss of $2,700. During this fiscal year, the business paid $800 each month for dividends. Requirements

1. Prepare Williams Industrial’s statement of retained earnings for the year ended December 31, 2014. 2. Did the retained earnings of the business increase or decrease during the year? What caused this change? E3-36B. Recreating adjusting journal entries (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. The adjusted trial balances of XYZ, Inc., at August 31, 2014, and August 31, 2015, include these amounts:

Supplies ............................................................................................... Salaries Payable................................................................................... Unearned Service Revenue ..................................................................

2014

2015

$ 4,000 1,700 17,000

$1,500 4,400 9,900

Analysis of the accounts at August 31, 2015, reveals these transactions for the past twelve months:

Purchases of supplies........................................................................................... Cash payments for salaries ................................................................................... Cash receipts in advance for service revenue........................................................

$ 6,500 59,800 66,400

Requirement Compute the amount of supplies expense, salaries expense, and service revenue XYZ, Inc., will report for the year ended August 31, 2015. Solve by making T-accounts and posting the information to solve for the unknown amounts.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 172

03/04/14 1:46 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

173

E3-37B. Financial statement preparation (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. The adjusted trial balance for Five Star Catering, Inc., is presented next. Prepare the ­income statement and statement of retained earnings for Five Star Catering, Inc., for the month ended October 31, 2014. Also prepare the balance sheet at October 31, 2014.

Five Star Catering, Inc. Adjusted Trial Balance October 31, 2014 DEBIT $ 9,100 3,800 600 32,000

ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Unearned Service Revenue Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Salaries Expense Rent Expense Depreciation Expense, Equipment Supplies Expense Total

CREDIT

$ 8,400 2,100 1,350 1,900 5,000 15,925 2,500 20,400 4,750 1,200 675 450 $55,075

$55,075

E3-38B. Prepare closing entries (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Requirements

1. Using the following selected accounts of Jona and Son Electrical, Inc., at April 30, 2014, prepare the entity’s closing entries:

Common Stock ........................ Service Revenue ...................... Unearned Revenues ................. Salaries Expense ...................... Accumulated Depreciation.......... Supplies Expense..................... Interest Revenue ...................... Interest Expense ......................

$22,000 54,000 2,100 20,800 30,000 1,800 500 2,400

Accounts Receivable ................ Retained Earnings .................... Salaries Payable....................... Depreciation Expense............... Rent Expense ........................... Dividends ................................. Supplies ...................................

$ 7,000 4,200 1,300 2,600 5,900 16,000 1,700

2. What is Jona and Son Electrical’s ending Retained Earnings balance at April 30, 2014?

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 173

03/04/14 1:46 PM

174

Chapter 3 E3-39B. Statement of retained earnings preparation (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. From the following accounts of Christianson & Associates, Inc., prepare the business’s statement of retained earnings for the year ended July 31, 2014:

Retained Earnings Clo Clo

132,000 Aug 1 46,000 Clo Bal

84,000 0 0 210,000 0 116,000

Dividends Oct 31 Jan 31 Apr 30 Jul 31 Bal

12,000 8,000 16,000 10,000 46,000 Clo

46,000

E3-40B. Prepare a post-closing trial balance (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. The following post-closing trial balance was prepared for Photo Finish, Inc., but some balances were entered in the wrong column. Prepare a corrected post-closing trial ­balance. Assume all accounts have normal balances and the amounts are correct.

Photo Finish, Inc. Post-Closing Trial Balance July 31, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Unearned Service Revenue Common Stock Retained Earnings Total

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 174

DEBIT $10,250 13,200

CREDIT

$ 1,700 23,000 5,000 5,200 4,700 3,000 15,000 15,250 $51,900

$44,400

03/04/14 1:46 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

175

E3-41B. Prepare closing entries (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. The following is the adjusted trial balance of Best Way, Inc., for January 31, 2014. Requirement

1. Journalize the closing entries at January 31.

Best Way, Inc. Adjusted Trial Balance January 31, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Furniture Accumulated Depreciation, Furniture Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Unearned Service Revenue Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Salaries Expense Rent Expense Depreciation Expense, Equipment Depreciation Expense, Furniture Supplies Expense Total

MyAccountingLab

DEBIT $ 3,300 8,100 420 4,700

CREDIT

$

3,160

43,400 4,700 2,640 1,375 1,700 15,000 5,105 20,000 96,400 32,600 14,800 1,550 730 480 $130,080

$130,080

Problems (Group A) P3-42A. Common adjusting journal entries (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Journalize the adjusting entry needed at December 31, the end of the current accounting year, for each of the following independent cases affecting Pro Powersports, Inc. No other adjusting entries have been made for the year. a. Prior to making the adjusting entry on December 31, the balance in Prepaid Insurance is $10,200. Pro Powersports, Inc., pays liability insurance each year on September 1. b. Pro Powersports, Inc., pays employees each Friday. The amount of the weekly payroll is $12,250 for a five-day workweek. December 31, the fiscal year-end, is a Wednesday. c. Pro Powersports, Inc., received notes receivable from some customers for services provided. For the current year, accrued interest amounts to $475 and will be ­collected next year.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 175

03/04/14 1:46 PM

176

Chapter 3 d. The beginning balance of Supplies was $825. During the year, $3,650 of supplies were purchased. At December 31, the supplies on hand total $1,100. e. During the year, Pro Powersports, Inc., received $9,300 in advance for services to be provided at a later date. As of December 31, Pro Powersports, Inc., earned $7,700 of the total fees received in advance during the current year. f. Depreciation for the current year includes Vehicles, $2,750, and Equipment, $1,400. P3-43A. Recreating adjusting journal entries from trial balance (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Assume the unadjusted and adjusted trial balances for Amusement Theater, Inc., at September 30, 2014, show the following data:

Amusement Theater, Inc. Trial Balance September 30, 2014

ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Prepaid Rent Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Interest Payable Unearned Service Revenue Notes Payable Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Salaries Expense Rent Expense Depreciation Expense, Equipment Interest Expense Supplies Expense Total

UNADJUSTED TRIAL BALANCE DR. CR. $ 8,300 6,000 4,100 2,800 11,000 $ 6,200 1,500

4,200 8,000 3,000 8,450 15,300 44,700 22,500 4,500 1,000 550 $76,050

$76,050

ADJUSTED TRIAL BALANCE DR. CR. $ 8,300 6,000 900 2,100 11,000 $ 6,950 1,500 1,500 190 3,300 8,000 3,000 8,450 15,300 45,600 24,000 5,200 1,750 740 3,200 $78,490 $78,490

Requirement

1. Journalize the adjusting entries that account for the differences between the two trial balances.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 176

03/04/14 1:46 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

177

P3-44A. Prepare adjusting journal entries and an adjusted trial balance (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 25–30 min. The trial balance of Advantage Advertising, Inc., at November 30, 2014, and the data needed for the month-end adjustments follow:

Advantage Advertising, Inc. Trial Balance November 30, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Prepaid Insurance Supplies Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Unearned Service Revenue Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Salaries Expense Insurance Expense Depreciation Expense, Equipment Utilities Expense Supplies Expense Total

DEBIT $ 6,420 8,650 2,800 1,150 48,000

CREDIT

$11,200 1,920 3,100 30,000 9,960 1,500 18,710 6,370

$74,890

$74,890

a. Insurance coverage still remaining at November 30, $900. b. Supplies used during the month, $845. c. Depreciation for the month, $2,700. d. Accrued utilities expense at November 30, $630. (Use Accounts Payable as the ­liability account needed.) e. Accrued salaries at November 30, $1,495. f. Service revenue still unearned at November 30, $1,165. Requirements

1. Open T-accounts for the accounts listed in the trial balance and insert their November 30 unadjusted balances.

2. Journalize the adjusting entries and post them to the T-accounts. Reference the posted amounts by letters (a) through (f). Calculate the adjusted balance in each account.

3. Prepare the adjusted trial balance at November 30, 2014. 4. How will the company use the adjusted trial balance?

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 177

03/04/14 1:46 PM

178

Chapter 3 P3-45A. Effects of adjusting journal entries on income statement accounts (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 20–25 min. Troy, Corp., completed the following selected transactions and prepared these ­adjusting entries during August:

Aug 1 3 6 8 12 18 23 26 30 31 31

Prepaid insurance for August through October, $3,000. Performed service on account, $3,500. Purchased office furniture on account, $350. Paid property tax expense, $900. Purchased office equipment for cash, $1,400. Performed services and received cash, $2,400. Collected $300 on account. Paid the account payable from the August 6 transaction. Paid salaries expense, $1,300. Recorded an adjusting entry for August insurance expense related to the August 1 transaction. Recorded an adjusting entry for unearned revenue now earned, $800.

Requirements

1. State whether the transaction would increase revenues, decrease revenues, i­ncrease expenses, decrease expenses, or have no effect on revenues or expenses. If revenues or expenses are affected, give the amount of the impact on revenues or expenses for August. Use the following format for your answer.

Revenues and Expenses for August Date

Impact on Revenues or Expenses

$ Effect on Revenues or Expenses

Aug XX

Increase Revenues

$500

2. Compute August net income or net loss under the accrual basis of accounting. 3. State why the accrual basis of accounting results in an accurate measurement of income.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 178

03/04/14 1:46 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

179

P3-46A. Prepare financial statements (Learning Objective 3) 20–25 min. The adjusted trial balance of Titan Realty, Inc., at December 31, 2014, follows:

Titan Realty, Inc. Adjusted Trial Balance December 31, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Prepaid Rent Supplies Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Unearned Service Revenue Interest Payable Salaries Payable Notes Payable Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Interest Revenue Salaries Expense Rent Expense Depreciation Expense, Equipment Utilities Expense Interest Expense Supplies Expense Total

DEBIT $ 5,370 12,100 1,800 830 54,000

CREDIT

$ 14,200 2,890 2,300 470 2,125 7,500 10,000 4,045 18,750 108,000 1,400 36,500 15,600 3,200 2,640 1,380 760 $152,930

$152,930

Requirements

1. Prepare Titan Realty’s income statement and statement of retained earnings for the year ending December 31, 2014, and year-end balance sheet. List expenses in decreasing order on the income statement.

2. a. Which financial statement reports Titan Realty’s results of operations? Were op-



M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 179

erations successful during 2014? Cite specifics from the financial statements to support your evaluation. b. Which statement reports the company’s financial position?

03/04/14 1:46 PM

180

Chapter 3 P3-47A. Prepare closing entries and a post-closing trial balance (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. The April 30, 2014, adjusted trial balance of Steamed Sensation, Inc., is shown next.

Steamed Sensation, Inc. Adjusted Trial Balance April 30, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Prepaid Rent Supplies Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Unearned Service Revenue Salaries Payable Notes Payable Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Interest Revenue Salaries Expense Rent Expense Depreciation Expense, Equipment Utilities Expense Supplies Expense Total

DEBIT $ 4,200 7,000 2,700 250 36,000

CREDIT

$ 4,200 4,500 1,400 1,300 2,000 5,000 9,650 3,000 54,000 1,100 22,700 5,200 1,400 450 250 $83,150

$83,150

Requirements Quick solution: 2. Retained Earnings = $31,750 3. Trial balance totals = $50,150

1. Prepare the April closing entries for Steamed Sensation, Inc. 2. Calculate the ending balance in Retained Earnings. 3. Prepare a post-closing trial balance.

Problems (Group B) P3-48B. Common adjusting journal entries (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Journalize the adjusting entries needed at December 31, the end of the current ­accounting year, for each of the following independent cases affecting Mountain Mania, Inc. No other adjusting entries have been made for the year. a. Prior to making the adjusting entry on December 31, the balance in Prepaid Insurance is $1,200. Mountain Mania, Inc., pays liability insurance each year on April 30. b. Mountain Mania, Inc., pays employees each Friday. The amount of the weekly payroll is $12,500 for a five-day workweek. December 31, the fiscal year-end, is a Monday. c. Mountain Mania, Inc., received notes receivable from some customers for services provided. For the current year, accrued interest amounts to $640 and will be ­collected next year.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 180

03/04/14 1:46 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

181

d. The beginning balance of Supplies was $1,025. During the year, $4,300 of ­supplies were purchased. At December 31, the supplies on hand total $2,500. e. During the year, Mountain Mania, Inc., received $17,200 in advance for services to be provided at a later date. As of December 31, Mountain Mania, Inc., earned $4,700 of the total fees received in advance during the current year. f. Depreciation for the current year includes Vehicles, $2,550, and Equipment, $1,300. P3-49B. Recreating adjusting journal entries from trial balance (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Assume the unadjusted and adjusted trial balances for Fox Theater, Inc., at November 30, 2014, show the following data:

Fox Theater, Inc. Trial Balance November 30, 2014

ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Prepaid Rent Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Interest Payable Unearned Service Revenue Notes Payable Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Salaries Expense Rent Expense Depreciation Expense, Equipment Interest Expense Supplies Expense Total

UNADJUSTED TRIAL BALANCE DR. CR. $ 7,200 4,700 1,950 3,800 26,800 $ 5,100 2,300

2,900 7,000 10,000 7,055 8,500 46,150 22,600 2,200 2,480 275 $80,505

$80,505

ADJUSTED TRIAL BALANCE DR. CR. $ 7,200 4,700 825 2,800 26,800 $ 6,750 2,300 1,175 145 1,300 7,000 10,000 7,055 8,500 47,750 23,775 3,200 4,130 420 1,125 $83,475 $83,475

Requirement

1. Journalize the adjusting entries that account for the differences between the two trial balances.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 181

03/04/14 1:46 PM

182

Chapter 3 P3-50B. Prepare adjusting journal entries and an adjusted trial balance (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 25–30 min. The trial balance of Novelty Nook, Inc., at June 30, 2014, and the data needed for the month-end adjustments follow:

Novelty Nook, Inc. Trial Balance June 30, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Prepaid Insurance Supplies Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Unearned Service Revenue Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Salaries Expense Insurance Expense Depreciation Expense Utilities Expense Supplies Expense Total

DEBIT $ 22,800 19,700 2,300 1,700 85,000

CREDIT

$ 24,000 2,000 2,500 70,000 33,500 8,100 11,000 3,400

$143,000

$143,000

a. Insurance coverage still remaining at June 30, $400. b. Supplies used during the month, $800. c. Depreciation for the month, $2,500. d. Accrued utilities expense at June 30, $900. (Use Accounts Payable as the liability account needed.) e. Accrued salaries at June 30, $800. f. Service revenue still unearned at June 30, $1,200. Requirements

1. Open T-accounts for the accounts listed in the trial balance and insert their June 30 unadjusted balances.

2. Journalize the adjusting entries and post them to the T-accounts. Reference the posted amounts by letters (a) through (f). Calculate the adjusted balance in each account.

3. Prepare the adjusted trial balance at June 30, 2014. 4. How will the company use the adjusted trial balance?

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 182

03/04/14 1:46 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

183

P3-51B. Effects of adjusting journal entries on income statement accounts (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 20–25 min. Sky Way, Corp., completed the following selected transactions and prepared these adjusting entries during January:

Jan 1 3 6 8 12 18 23 26 30 31 31

Prepaid insurance for January through March, $3,600. Performed service on account, $4,150. Purchased office furniture on account, $2,200. Paid property tax expense, $1,160. Purchased office equipment for cash, $4,300. Performed services and received cash, $1,600. Collected $3,400 on account. Paid the account payable from the January 6 transaction. Paid salaries expense, $1,615. Recorded an adjusting entry for January insurance expense related to the January 1 transaction. Recorded an adjusting entry for unearned revenue now earned, $875.

Requirements

1. State whether the transaction would increase revenues, decrease revenues, i­ncrease expenses, decrease expenses, or have no effect on revenues or expenses. If revenues or expenses are affected, give the amount of the impact on revenues or expenses for January. Use the following format for your answer.

Revenues and Expenses for January Date

Impact on Revenues or Expenses

$ Effect on Revenues or Expenses

Jan XX

Increase Revenues

$XXX

2. Compute January net income or net loss under the accrual basis of accounting. 3. State why the accrual basis of accounting results in an accurate measurement of income.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 183

03/04/14 1:46 PM

184

Chapter 3 P3-52B. Prepare financial statements (Learning Objective 3) 20–25 min. The adjusted trial balance for Ocean Realty, Inc., at March 31, 2014, follows:

Ocean Realty, Inc. Adjusted Trial Balance March 31, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Prepaid Rent Supplies Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Unearned Service Revenue Interest Payable Salaries Payable Notes Payable Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Interest Revenue Salaries Expense Rent Expense Depreciation Expense, Equipment Utilities Expense Interest Expense Supplies Expense Total

DEBIT $ 10,200 11,600 1,000 1,300 46,000

CREDIT

$ 12,000 3,300 1,800 540 1,500 9,000 26,000 10,900 19,000 88,000 960 43,000 14,000 4,200 2,800 600 300 $154,000

$154,000

Requirements

1. Prepare Ocean Realty’s income statement and statement of retained earnings for the year ended March 31, 2014, and year-end balance sheet. List expenses in decreasing order on the income statement.

2. a. Which financial statement reports Ocean Realty’s results of operations? Were



M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 184

operations successful during 2014? Cite specifics from the financial statements to support your evaluation. b. Which statement reports the company’s financial position?

03/04/14 1:46 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

185

P3-53B. Prepare closing entries and a post-closing trial balance (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. The June 30, 2014, adjusted trial balance of KLR, Inc., is shown next.

KLR, Inc. Adjusted Trial Balance June 30, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Prepaid Rent Supplies Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Unearned Service Revenue Salaries Payable Notes Payable Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Service Revenue Interest Revenue Salaries Expense Rent Expense Depreciation Expense, Equipment Utilities Expense Supplies Expense Total

DEBIT $ 6,200 12,700 2,650 420 31,000

CREDIT

$ 4,750 5,900 1,240 2,125 10,000 7,500 10,525 4,000 41,400 650 18,100 6,350 1,325 960 385 $84,090

$84,090

Requirements

1. Prepare the June closing entries for KLR, Inc. 2. Calculate the ending balance in Retained Earnings. 3. Prepare a post-closing trial balance.

Continuing Exercise This exercise continues the accounting process for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., from the c­ ontinuing exercise in Chapter 2. Refer to the T-accounts and the trial balance that you prepared for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., at April 30, 2014. Requirements

1. Open these additional T-accounts: Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment, Depreciation Expense, Equipment, Supplies Expense.

2. A physical count shows $25 of lawn supplies on hand at April 30, 2014. Depreciation on equipment for the month totals $33. Journalize any required ­adjusting journal entries and post to the T-accounts, identifying all items by date.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 185

03/04/14 1:46 PM

186

Chapter 3

3. Prepare the adjusted trial balance at April 30, 2014. 4. Journalize and post the closing entries at April 30. Denote each closing amount as Clo and an account balance as Bal.

5. Prepare a post-closing trial balance at April 30, 2014.

Continuing Problem This problem continues the accounting process for Aqua Magic, Inc., from the continuing p ­ roblem in Chapter 2. The trial balance for Aqua Magic, Inc., at June 30, 2014, should look like this:

Aqua Magic, Inc. Trial Balance June 30, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Land Furniture Equipment Vehicles Accounts Payable Notes Payable Common Stock Dividends Service Revenue Salaries Expense Rent Expense Utilities Expense Advertising Expense Miscellaneous Expense Total

DEBIT $ 24,935 3,725 1,325 25,000 4,000 1,800 36,200

CREDIT

$

4,890 36,200 55,000

6,000 13,800 2,500 2,300 1,380 450 275 $109,890

$109,890

During July, the following transactions occurred:

Jul 1 4 9 12 15 16 22 25 28 30

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 186

Paid four months’ rent, $9,200. Performed service for a customer and received cash, $2,700. Received $2,300 from customers for services to be performed later. Purchased $800 of supplies on account. Billed customers for services performed, $2,800. Paid receptionist’s salary, $625. Received $2,950 on account. Paid $2,100 on account. Received $1,725 cash for services performed. Paid $1,400 of dividends.

03/04/14 1:46 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

187

Requirements

1. Journalize the transactions that occurred in July. Omit explanations. 2. Using the four-column accounts from the continuing problem in Chapter 2, post the transactions to the ledger creating new ledger accounts as necessary. Omit posting references. Calculate the new account balances at July 31.

3. Prepare the unadjusted trial balance for Aqua Magic, Inc., at July 31. 4. Journalize and post the adjusting entries for July based on the following adjust

ment information. a. Record the expired rent. b. Supplies on hand, $250. c. Depreciation; $180 equipment, $50 furniture, $420 vehicles. d. Services performed but unbilled, $2,200. e. Accrued salaries, $625. f. Unearned service revenue earned as of July 31, $1,100.

5. Prepare an adjusted trial balance for Aqua Magic, Inc., at the end of July. 6. Prepare the income statement and statement of retained earnings for the threemonth period May 1 through July 31, 2014. Also prepare a balance sheet at July 31, 2014.

7. Prepare and post closing entries. 8. Prepare a post-closing trial balance at July 31, 2014.

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem Let’s look at Target again. Think about the business of Target. Now return to that place on Target’s website called “investor relations.” Look at Target’s 2012 financial statements contained in its 2012 annual report. Go to: http://investors.target.com/phoenix.zhtml?c=65828&p=irol-reportsAnnual. On page 33 of the financial statements, you’ll find Target’s income statement for the year ending February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidate Statement of Operations). On page 35, you’ll find Target’s balance sheet as of February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position). On page 37, you’ll find Target’s statement of retained earnings for the year ending February 2, 2013. It’s a part of Target’s statement titled Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Investment. Now answer the following questions:

1. Look at Target’s income statement. Is Target profitable? Does it have a positive net income or a negative net income (loss) for the year ending February 2, 2013? How does that compare with the year ending February 2, 2013?

2. Look at Target’s statement of shareholders’ investment. How does Target’s net ­income flow into its balance sheet?

3. Look at Target’s balance sheet. What assets does Target own? How much has Target invested in each type of assets and in total assets?

4. Look at Target’s balance sheet. How does Target finance its assets? How much ­liabilities and shareholders’ equity does Target have?

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 187

03/04/14 1:46 PM

188

Chapter 3

Apply Your Knowledge Ethics in Action Case 1. Jilian Carter was preparing the adjusting journal entries for Jilian’s Java, a business that uses the accrual basis of accounting, in order to prepare the adjusted trial balance and financial statements. She knew that $610 of salaries related to the current accounting period had ­accrued but wouldn’t be paid until the next period. Jilian thought that simply not including the adjustment for these salaries would mean that salaries expense would be lower and reported net income would be higher than it would have been if she had made the adjustment. Further, she knew that the Salaries Payable account would be zero, so the liabilities reported on the balance sheet would be less and her business would look even better. Besides, she reasoned that these salaries would be reported eventually, so it was merely a matter of showing them in one period instead of another. Dismissing the reporting as just a timing issue, she ignored the adjustment for the additional salaries expense. Is Jilian acting unethically by failing to record the adjustment for accrued salaries? Does it matter that, shortly into the new accounting period, the salaries will ultimately be paid? Is it really simply a matter of timing? What are the potential problems of failing to include all the adjusting journal entries? Case 2. Brent Robertson and his banker were reviewing the quarterly income statements for his consulting business, Robertson and Associates, Inc. The banker was impressed with the growth of sales revenue and net income for the second quarter of this year as compared to the second quarter of last year. Brent knew it had been a good quarter, but didn’t think it had been spectacular. Suddenly, Brent realized that he failed to close out the revenue and expense accounts for the prior quarter, which ended in March. Because those temporary accounts were not closed out, their balances were included in the second quarter amounts for the current year. Brent then realized that the banker had the financial statements but not the general ledger or any trial balances. Thus, the banker would not be able to see that the accounting cycle from the first quarter was not properly closed and that this failure was creating a misstated income statement for the second quarter of the current year. The banker then commented that the business appeared to be performing so well that he would approve a line of credit for the business. Brent decided to not say anything because he did not want to lose the line of credit. Besides, he thought, it really did not matter that the income statement was misstated because his business would be sure to repay any amounts borrowed. Should Brent have informed the banker of the mistake made, and should he have redone the second quarter’s income statement? Was Brent’s failure to close the prior quarter’s revenue and expense accounts unethical? Does the fact that the business will repay the loan matter?

Know Your Business Financial Analysis Purpose: To help familiarize you with the financial reporting of a real company in order to further your understanding of the chapter material. This case will help you to better understand the effect of adjusting journal entries on the financial statements. You know that adjusting journal entries are entered in the journal and then posted to the ledger accounts. We do not have access to the journals and ledgers used by Columbia Sportswear, but we can see some of the adjusted accounts on the company’s financial statements. Refer to the Columbia Sportswear income statements, “Statements of Operations,” and the Columbia Sportswear balance sheets, in Appendix A. Also find footnote 6 titled “Property, Plant, and Equipment, Net” and footnote 9 titled “Accrued Liabilities,” which are two of the many footnotes included after the financial statements.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 188

03/04/14 1:46 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

189

Requirements

1. Open T-accounts for the following accounts and their balances as of December 31, 2011. (Note that amounts from the Columbia Sportswear financial statements are in thousands.)

Accumulated Depreciation ................................................................................. Accrued Salaries, Bonus, Vacation, and Other Benefits...................................... Accrued Import Duties ....................................................................................... Accrued Product Warranties .............................................................................. Other Accrued Liabilities ....................................................................................

$275,886 $ 55,958 $ 11,258 $ 10,452 $ 26,828

2. Using the following information for Columbia Sportswear’s 2012 operations, make

the appropriate journal entries. a. Full payment of the December 31, 2011, balances in the accrued liability accounts. b. Depreciation expense, $27,157. c. Accrued salaries and benefits expense, $55,728. d. Accrued import duty expense, $15,023. e. Accrued product warranty expense, $10,209. f. Accrued other (miscellaneous) expenses, $24,230.

3. Post the journal entries to the T-accounts you set up. Check the updated ending balances in each account against the balances reported by Columbia Sportswear as of December 31, 2012.

Industry Analysis Purpose: To help you understand and compare the performance of two companies in the same industry. Go to the Columbia Sportswear Company Annual Report located in Appendix A . Now a­ ccess the 2012 Annual Report for Under Armour, Inc. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Industry Analysis in Chapter 1. Requirement

1. By reviewing the financial statements of both companies, can you determine which method of accounting, cash or accrual basis, each of the companies used? How did you determine this? If one of the companies used the cash basis and the other used the accrual basis, would it affect your ability to compare the two ­companies? Explain your answer.

Small Business Analysis Purpose: To help you understand the importance of cash flows in the operation of a small business. It’s the end of the month, and cash flow has been a little slow, as it usually is during this time of the accounting period. It just seems to be a little slower this month. You know that Wednesday the 31st is payday, which always requires a large cash outlay. However, you also know that your bank is looking for a set of financial statements as of the end of the month because the loan on your building is coming up for renewal soon. Based on some of the previous meetings with your bankers, they are always concerned with the cash balance, so you want to have your cash balance as high as possible. You come up with a tentative plan you believe will not only preserve some of your cash ­balance at the end of the month but also will help your bottom line, your net income. That’s the other thing that the bankers are always concerned about. You don’t want to make any mistakes

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 189

03/04/14 1:46 PM

190

Chapter 3 with your financial statements at this crucial point, so you decide to contact your CPA to run the idea by her. The conversation goes something like this: “Good morning, Sherry. This is Bill Conan from Conan Consultants, Inc. Our financial statements have to look really good this month because the bank is going to be scrutinizing them pretty closely for our pending loan renewal. I know that the two things they concentrate on are the cash balance and the net income. So, I’ve got a plan to help in both of those areas. I’m going to hold off paying my employees until after the first of the month. Plus, last month, I made a big insurance payment to cover me for the next six months, so I won’t need to show any insurance expense this month. Both of those will help my net income because I won’t be showing those expenses on my income statement. Plus, by not writing the paychecks until the first of the month, I’ll be helping to show a higher cash balance. It’s really only one day, but the bank won’t know that my cash balance should be lower. These certainly sound like some good ideas that would help with my situation, but just in case, I wanted to check with you to see what you thought. Any comments?” The first words out of the CPA’s mouth are “Bill, you know that your financial statements are prepared using the accrual basis of accounting.” Requirement

1. Complete the thought process of the CPA concerning Bill’s plan. What does she mean by the accrual basis of accounting? What effect will that have on the net income? Is Bill correct in his assessment of the big insurance payment he made last month covering the next six months? What effect will that have on the net income? And in regard to the last item, what about Bill’s plan to keep the cash balance as high as possible and his statement “the bank won’t know that my cash balance should be lower”?

Written Communication You have received a letter from a disgruntled client concerning this year’s tax return that your firm recently completed for his or her company. The client’s business is in the second year of operations, and you remembered that it seemed to be much more profitable this year than during the first year of operations. You also recall that this particular client’s year-end work was assigned to one of your relatively new staff accountants, which might be part of the problem. The gist of the letter is that last year’s taxable net income was about $32,000, and according to the company’s calculations, the net income from this year should have been about $55,000. The client is wondering why the company is showing taxable net income of $87,130 on this year’s return and paying income tax on that amount. You retrieve the file to review it and immediately see the problem. Your staff accountant failed to make the closing entries at the end of the first year of operations! Requirement

1. Prepare a letter to this client explaining the situation and, most importantly, e­ xplaining the importance of preparing closing entries at the end of each and ­every year. Also, suggest a solution to this problem for the client, knowing that just explaining the accounting issue might not be enough to retain this client in the future. Self Check Answers 1. b 2. c 3. c 4. d 5. c 6. d 7. c 8. d 9. a 10. c 11. b 12. b

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 190

03/04/14 1:46 PM

Adjusting and Closing Entries

191

Comprehensive Problem Journalizing, Posting, Adjusting, Preparing, and Closing Financial Statements Brava Landscaping, Inc., completed the following transactions during its first month of operations for January 2014: a. Gabrielle Brava invested $8,500 cash and a truck valued at $16,000 to start Brava Landscaping, Inc. The business issued common stock in exchange for these assets. b. Purchased $450 of supplies on account. c. Paid $1,800 for a six-month insurance policy. d. Performed landscape services for a customer and received $925 cash. e. Completed a $5,300 landscaping job on account. f. Paid employee salary, $820. g. Received $1,560 cash for performing landscaping services. h. Collected $1,350 in advance for landscaping service to be performed later. i. Collected $2,800 cash from a customer on account. j. Purchased fuel for the truck, paying $110 with a company credit card. Credit Accounts Payable. k. Performed landscaping services on account, $2,130. l. Paid the current month’s office rent, $1,150. m. Paid $400 on account. n. Paid cash dividends of $1,000. Requirements

1. Record each transaction in the general journal. Use the letter corresponding to each transaction as the transaction date. Explanations are not required.

2. Post the transactions that you recorded in Requirement 1 in the following T-accounts.

Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Prepaid Insurance Truck Accumulated Depreciation Accounts Payable

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 191

Salaries Payable Unearned Service Revenue Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends

Service Revenue Salaries Expense Depreciation Expense Insurance Expense Fuel Expense Rent Expense Supplies Expense

03/04/14 1:46 PM

192

Chapter 3

3. Prepare an unadjusted trial balance as of January 31, 2014. 4. Journalize and post the adjusting journal entries on January 31, 2014, based on

the following information: a. Accrued salaries expense, $470. b. Depreciation expense, $330. c. Record the expiration of one month’s insurance. d. Supplies on hand, $85. e. Earned 2/3 of the Unearned Service Revenue during January.

5. Prepare an adjusted trial balance as of January 31, 2014. Use the adjusted trial ­ alance to prepare Brava Landscaping’s income statement and statement of b ­retained earnings for the month ending January 31, 2014, and balance sheet at January 31, 2014. On the income statement list expenses in decreasing order by amount—that is, the largest expense first, the smallest expense last.

6. Journalize and post the closing entries. 7. Prepare a post-closing trial balance at January 31, 2014.

M03_KEMP9543_03_GE_C03.indd 192

03/04/14 1:46 PM

4 Accounting for a Merchandising Business Business, Accounting, and You Walk into a Toys R Us. Look around. What do you see? You see employees, products, and customers. You see employees unloading products, called inventory, from trucks of suppliers. You see other employees placing the products on display shelves. You see employees demonstrating products and helping customers make informed ­decisions. You see customers taking products from the shelves, going to check-out stations, and purchasing products. You see thousands of business transactions. So how does a business like Toys R Us account for operating its business? How does Toys R Us recognize, measure, record, and report the purchase and sale of i­nventory? How does Toys R Us account for employee wages, advertising, and

Learning Objectives 1 Describe the relationships among manufacturers, wholesalers, retailers, and customers

2 Define periodic and perpetual inventory systems

3 Journalize transactions for the purchase of inventory

4 Journalize transactions for the sale of inventory

5 Understand shipping terms and journalize transactions for freight charges and other selling expenses

6 Prepare a multi-step income statement and a classified balance sheet

7 Compute earnings per share, the gross profit ­percentage, and the net ­income percentage

193

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 193

03/04/14 1:52 PM

194

Chapter 4

other operating expenses such as utilities? How does Toys R Us account for customers buying inventory and giving Toys R Us, in exchange for the inventory, cash or promises to pay cash? How does Toys R Us account for the merchandising of products? Business is about operating and earning net income. Net income starts with buying and selling products. As an accountant or manager, you need to understand how products flow from suppliers to customers. You need to understand how ­accountants keep score and determine whether the sale of a product results in net income or net loss.

Real World Accounting Video In the Real World Accounting Video, Noah Lenovitz, a partner and chief operating officer of Fishs Eddy, talks about what it means to operate a business. Look at the video. Think about what Noah is saying. Now realize how important accounting is to the success of a business.

What Are the Relationships Among Manufacturers, Wholesalers, Retailers, and Customers? 1

Describe the relationships among manufacturers, wholesalers, retailers, and customers

Merchandise inventory  Goods purchased for resale to customers in the normal course of merchandising operations; also called inventory. Wholesalers  Businesses that buy goods from manufacturers and resell them to retailers. Retailers  Businesses that buy goods from manufacturers or wholesalers and resell them to the general public.

In Chapters 1–3, you learned how to account for a service business. In this chapter, you will learn how to account for a merchandising business. A merchandising business buys and sells products, called merchandise inventory, instead of services. Throughout the remainder of the book, we will refer to merchandise inventory simply as inventory. Inventory is a very important asset to a merchandising business because it reflects the amount of goods the business has available to sell to its customers. A merchandising business can be either a wholesaler or a retailer. Wholesalers generally purchase large lots of products from manufacturers and resell them to retailers. Retailers buy goods from wholesalers and resell them to the final consumers, the general public. It is also possible for a retailer to purchase products directly from a manufacturer. Exhibit 4-1 shows the relationships among manufacturers, wholesalers, retailers, and customers. The discount chain Walmart and the Internet merchandiser Amazon.com are wellknown examples of retailers. In this chapter, a fictitious merchandiser named Cellular

Merchandising Businesses Manufacturer A

Manufacturer B

Customers

Wholesaler

Retailer

Exhibit 4-1

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 194

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

195

Connect, Inc., is used to illustrate merchandising operations. Cellular Connect is a mall retailer that sells cell phones and accessories. We will learn how Cellular Connect records entries related to purchases of inventory from its suppliers. In addition, we will learn the entries Cellular uses to record sales of merchandise to its customers. We will also learn how the type of inventory tracking system chosen by Cellular will affect the journal ­entries that it must make.

How Do Periodic and Perpetual Inventory Systems Differ? 2

Define periodic and perpetual inventory systems

Periodic inventory system  An ­inventory system in which the ­business does not keep a ­continuous record of inventory on hand. At the end of the accounting period, a ­physical count of inventory is taken and is used to determine the cost of ending inventory and the cost of the goods sold.

Merchandisers use one of two inventory tracking systems: • The periodic inventory system is a system of accounting for inventory that does not keep a continuous, running record of inventory as it is bought and sold. Instead, the business physically counts the goods in inventory at the end of the accounting period. It then multiplies the quantity of each item by its cost to get the total value of the ending inventory. Once the cost of ending inventory has been determined, a business will calculate the cost of the inventory it has sold during the period using the following formula:

Beginning Inventory  Purchases  Cost of Goods Available for Sale  Ending Inventory  Cost of Goods Sold

Historically, businesses that sold large quantities of relatively inexpensive goods used the periodic inventory system because it was too costly and time consuming to track the inventory items that were sold. Currently, thanks to innovations in inventory tracking technology, most businesses utilize a perpetual inventory system. Perpetual inventory system An inventory system in which the ­business keeps a continuous record of inventory on hand and the cost of the goods sold.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 195

• The perpetual inventory system is a system of accounting for inventory that keeps a running record of inventory as it is bought and sold. Every time the ­business engages in a transaction involving inventory, the balance in the inventory ­account is immediately updated. By doing this, the inventory balance is perpetually up to date. However, the business must still physically count inventory at least once a year to see whether any goods have been lost, damaged, or stolen. Just because the accounting records indicate that a certain amount of inventory exists, it doesn’t mean that this amount is actually on hand. If the actual inventory count is different than the perpetual records indicate, the perpetual records are adjusted to reflect the physical count. The general ledger is also updated by debiting or crediting the ­inventory ­account as needed. The offsetting debit or credit is to the Cost of Goods Sold ­account. Technology makes it easier for almost any business to use the ­perpetual system. Usually, a cash register used in a perpetual system is connected to a bar code scanner. When an inventory item is scanned, not only is the sale recorded, but the ­inventory records are simultaneously updated. Because the perpetual inventory ­system is more commonly used, we will use it to illustrate the transactions for Cellular Connect.

03/04/14 1:52 PM

196

Chapter 4

How Do You Account for the Purchase of Inventory? 3

Journalize transactions for the purchase of inventory

Throughout the year, merchandisers engage in a number of inventory transactions with suppliers including cash purchases, credit purchases, purchase returns and allowances, and purchase discounts. Let’s examine how Cellular Connect, Inc., accounts for these types of transactions.

Cash and Credit Purchases Cellular Connect purchases 300 cell phone cases from Accessories Unlimited on ­account at a cost of $25 each. Therefore, the total value of Cellular’s purchase is $7,500 (300 cases × $25). Cellular Connect receives the goods on February 1 and records this ­purchase as follows: DATE Feb 1

Subsidiary ledger  An accounting record that contains details, such as a list of customers and the accounts receivable due from each or a list of suppliers and the accounts payable due to each.

ACCOUNTS Inventory Accounts Payable—Accessories Unlimited Record purchase of inventory on account.

POST REF.

DR. 7,500

CR. 7,500

The purchase of inventory on account increases both Cellular Connect’s assets and liabilities. The Inventory account reflects the cost of goods purchased for resale. The ­balance increases every time inventory is purchased. Inventory is an asset until it is sold because, as discussed in Chapter 1, assets represent things of value that the business owns. Notice that the name of the supplier is listed in the journal entry following Accounts Payable. The supplier’s name is used because the amount owed to each individual ­supplier will be posted to a subsidiary ledger in addition to the Accounts Payable account in the general ledger. The subsidiary ledger contains a record for each separate supplier. If everything has been posted correctly, the total of the account balances in the accounts payable subsidiary ledger will equal the Accounts Payable account balance in the general ledger. This way, a merchandiser can keep track of the amount of accounts payable owed to each individual supplier. Some suppliers may require cash to be paid at the time of shipment. If Accessories Unlimited required cash payment for the 300 cell phone cases at the time of sale, Cellular Connect would record the cash purchase as follows: DATE Feb 1

ACCOUNTS Inventory Cash Record purchase of inventory for cash.

POST REF.

DR. 7,500

CR. 7,500

Purchase Returns and Allowances Purchase returns and ­allowances  A reduction in the amount owed for a purchase due to returning merchandise or accepting unsatisfactory goods.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 196

Occasionally, merchandisers buy goods that are not satisfactory. In these cases, most suppliers allow the goods to be returned. They may also allow the merchandiser to keep the unsuitable goods and receive a deduction, or allowance, from the amount they owe for the merchandise. Both purchase returns and allowances decrease the merchandiser’s cost of the inventory. Suppose Cellular Connect buys 20 hands-free headsets for $20 each from Mega Mobile. Upon receipt of the headsets, Cellular Connect determines that Mega Mobile

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

197

shipped the wrong headsets and, after notifying Mega Mobile, returns the headsets. Because Cellular Connect no longer owes Mega Mobile for the headsets, it will reduce Accounts Payable by debiting the account. Cellular Connect also no longer has the ­inventory, so it will reduce the Inventory account by crediting it. Cellular records the purchase return on April 5 as follows: DATE Apr 5

Sales invoice  A bill that documents the sale of goods to a customer. Credit terms  The payment terms for customers who buy on account. n/30  Credit term specifying that ­payment for a purchase is due within 30 days after the date of the invoice. n/eom  Credit term specifying that payment for a purchase is due by the end of the month; also referred to as eom. Purchase discount  Discount ­received on purchases by paying early within a discount period.

ACCOUNTS Accounts Payable—Mega Mobile Inventory Record inventory returned to manufacturer.

POST REF.

DR. 400

CR. 400

Now, assume that instead of returning the headsets, Cellular Connect had been granted a $50 reduction in the total purchase price (an allowance) as an incentive to keep the headsets. In this case, Cellular Connect would make the same entry that was made to record the return but the amount of the entry would be for $50.

Purchase Discounts Exhibit 4-2 illustrates Accessories Unlimited’s sales invoice for Cellular’s $7,500 ­ urchase of inventory. A sales invoice is a bill that documents the sale of goods to p a customer. The invoice includes credit terms, or the payment terms, for customers who buy on a­ ccount. A customer may pay cash when it receives the goods or it may pay within a ­period of time following the receipt of those goods. Credit terms are used on sales ­invoices to communicate to the customer when payment is due. Often, merchandisers will use the term n/30, which means that the sales price for the goods must be paid within 30 days after the date of the invoice. If the amount is due at the end of the month, the invoice will include the phrase n/eom or just eom. All businesses want to have enough cash to pay their bills on time. Therefore, businesses often offer customers purchase discounts for early payment in order to improve

Accessories Unlimited P.O. Box 873 Redding, CA Shipped to:

Cellular Connect 1471 E. Union St. Seattle, WA

Quantity

Item

300 each

Cell phone cases

Invoice Date Number 2/1/14 644

Terms: 3/15, n/30 Unit Price

Total

$ 25

$ 7,500

Subtotal Shipping Charge Tax Total

$ 7,500 – – $ 7,500

Exhibit 4-2

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 197

03/04/14 1:52 PM

198

Chapter 4

Discount period  Period in which the customer can make early payment for a purchase and receive a discount on that purchase.

their cash inflow. By rewarding the customer for paying amounts before the due date, these companies get cash sooner. The time period in which the customer may pay and receive the discount is called the discount period. If the customer takes advantage of this offer and pays early, then these discounts represent a reduction in the cost of the merchandise purchased. Review Accessories Unlimited’s sales invoice in Exhibit 4-2. Accessories Unlimited’s credit terms of “3/15, n/30” mean that Cellular Connect may deduct 3% of the total amount due to Accessories Unlimited if it pays within 15 days of the invoice date. Otherwise, the full amount is due in 30 days. In this case, the discount period covers 15  days. However, if Accessories Unlimited listed terms of “n/30” instead of “3/15, n/30,” it would mean that it was not offering a discount at all and payment is due 30 days after the invoice date. If Cellular Connect pays within the discount period, it will pay $7,275, or 97% of the invoice amount of $7,500:

Invoice Total $7,500 (100% of invoice amount)  Purchase Discount (225) (3% of invoice amount, or 0.03  $7,500)  Cash Paid $7,275 (97% of invoice amount, or 0.97  $7,500) Cellular records its payment on February 13, which is within the discount period: DATE Feb 13

ACCOUNTS Accounts Payable—Accessories Unlimited Cash Inventory Record payment of inventory purchases within the discount period.

POST REF.

DR. 7,500

CR. 7,275 225

Note that the discount is credited to the Inventory account. This is because the discount decreases the cost of the cell phone cases that Cellular Connect bought from Accessories Unlimited. However, if Cellular Connect pays this invoice after the discount period, it pays the full amount of $7,500. In this case, it records the payment as: DATE Feb 24

ACCOUNTS Accounts Payable—Accessories Unlimited Cash Record payment of inventory purchases after the discount period.

POST REF.

DR. 7,500

CR. 7,500

It is important to note that discounts are not granted on any purchase returns or allowances.

How Do You Account for the Sale of Inventory? 4

Journalize transactions for the sale of inventory

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 198

Merchandisers engage in several different types of business transactions with customers: • Cash sales: Goods are sold for cash. • Credit sales: Goods are sold on account.

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

199

• Sales returns and allowances: Damaged goods are returned by a customer for a ­refund. However, sometimes the customer keeps the damaged goods and accepts an allowance (price reduction) on the goods. • Sales discounts: Suppliers grant customers a reduction in the amount owed as an incentive for paying within a discount period. Let’s examine how Cellular Connect accounts for these types of transactions.

Cash Sales Sales Revenue  The amount that a business earns from selling its inventory.

Cost of Goods Sold  The cost of the inventory that the business has sold to customers.

Merchandisers, such as Cellular Connect, often receive cash at the time they sell merchandise. The journal entry to record a cash sale increases the asset, Cash, and also increases the revenue account, Sales Revenue. Sales Revenue is the account used by merchandisers to track the value of merchandise sold to customers at the price that the merchandiser charges those customers. Remember that Cellular Connect uses the perpetual inventory system to account for its inventory. At the time of a sale, in addition to recording the sales revenue, Cellular also reduces the Inventory balance for the cost of the merchandise sold. By doing this, the Inventory account is updated so that it always, or perpetually, reflects the current balance. The cost of the merchandise sold is accounted for in the Cost of Goods Sold account. This income statement account reflects the cost of merchandise sold during the period. The Cost of Goods Sold is deducted from Sales Revenue as a step in determining the amount of net income or loss for the period. Assume that on June 9, Cellular Connect sells $3,000 of merchandise to customers for cash. The goods that Cellular sold its customers cost Cellular $1,900. The journal entry to record the sale is as follows: DATE Jun 9

ACCOUNTS Cash Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold Inventory Record sale of inventory for cash.

POST REF.

DR. 3,000

CR. 3,000

1,900 1,900

Remember that when a product is sold, a merchandiser recognizes the following: 1. Sales revenue for the selling price of the product to the customer 2. Cost of goods sold for the merchandiser’s cost of the product Compound journal entry  A journal entry affecting more than two accounts; an entry that has more than one debit and/or more than one credit.

A journal entry that involves more than two accounts is called a compound journal entry. A compound entry may include more than one debit amount or more than one credit amount. Some merchandisers allow customers to use credit cards and debit cards rather than currency. These transactions are treated as cash sales because the merchandiser receives cash from the credit/debit card company. The credit/debit card company then collects the amount due from the customer. The merchandiser, however, usually must pay a service charge to the credit/debit card company in exchange for its processing of the transactions. Accounting for debit and credit card sales is discussed in Chapter 7 in more detail.

Credit Sales Many merchandisers establish charge accounts for their customers. Assume that Cellular Connect sold a cell phone and accessories to Jim Kahl on account, n/30 on June 11 for $500. The goods cost Cellular $290. The entry to record this transaction is similar

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 199

03/04/14 1:52 PM

200

Chapter 4

to accounting for a cash sale except Accounts Receivable is debited instead of Cash. Cellular records this sale on account and the cost of goods sold as follows: DATE Jun 11

ACCOUNTS Accounts Receivable—Jim Kahl Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold Inventory Record sale of inventory on account, invoice no. 322.

POST REF.

DR. 500

CR. 500

290 290

When Jim sends Cellular his payment for this merchandise, Cellular records the cash receipt on account as follows: DATE Jun 19

ACCOUNTS Cash Accounts Receivable—Jim Kahl Record payment received on invoice no. 322.

POST REF.

DR. 500

CR. 500

Notice that the name of the customer is listed in the journal entry following Accounts Receivable. This is similar to what is done for Accounts Payable. A separate account is kept in an accounts receivable subsidiary ledger for each charge customer. Each entry affecting accounts receivable is posted to the customer’s account in the subsidiary ledger as well as to the Accounts Receivable account in the general ledger. After all entries are posted, the total of the account balances in the accounts receivable subsidiary ledger will equal the Accounts Receivable account balance in the general ledger. This way, the ­merchandiser can keep track of the amount of accounts receivable owed by each individual customer.

Sales Returns and Allowances

Sales Returns and Allowances  A reduction in the amount of sales due to customers returning merchandise or accepting unsatisfactory goods; a contra-account to Sales Revenue. Credit memorandum  A ­document that supports the return ­ of goods from the customer or an ­allowance for ­unsatisfactory goods and the ­adjustment to the customer’s account balance.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 200

Merchandisers may allow customers to return unwanted merchandise, or they may let customers keep the goods and request an allowance. A business tracks these returns and allowances so it can analyze and manage the causes behind the returns and allowances and measure the related costs to the business. To track returns and allowances accurately, the amount of returns and allowances is recorded in a contra-account called Sales Returns and Allowances. Remember from Chapter 3 that a contra-account is an account with a balance opposite of the account to which it is linked. Sales Returns and Allowances is linked to Sales Revenue, which has a credit balance. Therefore, Sales Returns and Allowances will have a debit balance. As we will see later, Sales Returns and Allowances appears on the income statement and is deducted from Sales Revenue to ­arrive at Net Sales. Exhibit 4-3 illustrates a credit memorandum, a document that acknowledges the return of goods from a customer or the granting of an allowance. The credit memo gets its name from the effect that it has on the balance of the customer’s account. Because the credit memo decreases the amount due from the customer, the merchandiser credits the accounts receivable balance for that customer. The merchandiser sends a credit memorandum to the customer as notification that an adjustment has been made to the amount the customer owes the merchandiser.

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

201

1471 E. Union St. Seattle, WA CREDIT MEMORANDUM #14 To:

Jill Harris 2194 S.E. 31st Ave. Olympia, WA

Date: August 15, 2014

We credit your account balance for the following: $75

3 car chargers @ $25 each

Exhibit 4-3

Sales Returns When a customer returns goods, the merchandiser will: • Decrease net sales revenue by increasing Sales Returns and Allowances, and decrease the customer’s Accounts Receivable account balance for the sales price of those goods. • Decrease Cost of Goods Sold and increase Inventory for the cost of the returned goods. Let’s see how Cellular records the return illustrated in the credit memo in Exhibit 4-3. The credit memo reflects the return of three car chargers, originally purchased for $75, by Jill Harris, a customer. The returned car chargers cost Cellular $30. Cellular Connect records the sales return as follows: DATE Aug 15

ACCOUNTS Sales Returns and Allowances Accounts Receivable—Jill Harris Inventory Cost of Goods Sold Record receipt of returned goods, credit memo no. 14.

POST REF.

DR.

CR. 75 75 30 30

Accounts Receivable decreases because the customer no longer owes Cellular for the returned goods. Cellular also updates its inventory because its perpetual inventory system needs to reflect the increase to Inventory because of the return of the goods. Cellular also decreases the Cost of Goods Sold because the goods are no longer sold.

Sales Allowances Rather than return goods to the merchandiser, some customers may be willing to keep unwanted goods and accept an allowance. Assume Cellular Connect grants credit customer Bill Logan a $100 sales allowance for damaged goods. Cellular records the sales allowance as follows: DATE Aug 29

ACCOUNTS Sales Returns and Allowances Accounts Receivable—Bill Logan Record sales allowance for damaged goods, credit memo no. 15.

POST REF.

DR. 100

CR. 100

Notice that the journal entry for a sales allowance does not affect Inventory or Cost of Goods Sold because the customer did not return any goods to the merchandiser.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 201

03/04/14 1:52 PM

202

Chapter 4

Sales Discounts

Sales Discount  Discount granted on sales for the customer’s early payment within a discount period; a contra-account to Sales Revenue.

Do you recall the discount that Cellular Connect received from Accessories Unlimited for early payment? It is possible for Cellular to offer discounts to its credit customers for early payment. Let’s assume that Cellular sells merchandise to Kelly Harding for $450. The sale is made on account with credit terms of 2/15, n/30. If Kelly chooses to pay the invoice within the 15-day discount period, she will get a 2%, or $9, discount on her $450 purchase ($450 × 0.02). Kelly will pay $441, or 98% of the invoice amount of $450. This discount represents a reduction in the value of sales to Cellular. Businesses track the amount of these sales discounts so they can measure the ­impact on their sales revenue. To do so, businesses record these discounts in a contra-account called Sales Discounts. Because Sales Discounts is linked to Sales Revenue, it will ­normally have a debit balance. The Sales Discounts account tracks decreases in sales revenue, which result from a discount to customers. Similar to the treatment of Sales Returns and Allowances, Sales Discounts appears on the income statement and is deducted from Sales Revenue to arrive at Net Sales. Because the Sales Returns and Allowances and the Sales Discount accounts have debit balances, they will be closed along with the expense accounts at the end of the period. Assume that Cellular receives payment of $441 from Kelly on February 13 within the discount period. The journal entry to record the receipt of cash and the sales discount is as follows: DATE Feb 13

ACCOUNTS Cash Sales Discounts Accounts Receivable—Kelly Harding

POST REF.

DR. 441 9

CR.

450

If Kelly fails to pay within the 15-day discount period, she will have to pay the full invoice price of $450. If Cellular receives payment from Kelly on February 24, it records the payment as follows: DATE Feb 24

ACCOUNTS Cash Accounts Receivable—Kelly Harding

POST REF.

DR. 450

CR. 450

Try It… If a customer returned $2,500 of merchandise and the transaction was recorded by debiting Sales and crediting Accounts Receivable, instead of debiting Sales Returns and Allowances and crediting Accounts Receivable, would the net income on the income statement be incorrect?

Answer

No. Let’s assume that the company has $20,000 of total sales at the time the return is made and that this is the first time merchandise is returned during the period. If the transaction is recorded by debiting Sales, the Sales balance will be reduced to $17,500. As there have been no other sales returns, the balance in the Sales Returns and Allowances will be zero. Therefore, the amount of Net Sales will be $17,500. If instead of debiting Sales, the Sales Returns and Allowances account is debited, the Sales account will have a balance of $20,000 and the Sales Returns and Allowances account will have a balance of $2,500. Therefore, the amount of Net Sales will still be $17,500 ($20,000 – $2,500). If the amount of Net Sales is $17,500 regardless of which way the transaction is recorded, the net income will be the same. The reason for using the Sales Returns and Allowances account is simply to keep track of the amount of merchandise returned during the period. Managers often use this information to determine if there are quality issues with their products.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 202

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

203

How Do You Account for Freight Charges and Other Selling Expenses? 5

Understand shipping terms and journalize transactions for freight charges and other selling expenses

Freight charges  The cost of ­shipping merchandise from the seller to the buyer. Title  Legally recognized rights to the possession and ownership of property. Free on board (FOB) shipping point  A shipping term specifying that title to goods passes to the buyer when the goods are shipped at the seller’s place of business; thus, the buyer pays the cost of shipping the goods to its location. Free on board (FOB) ­destination  A shipping term specifying that title to goods passes to the buyer when the goods are received at the buyer’s destination; thus, the seller pays the cost of shipping the goods to this destination.

In addition to purchases and sales transactions, a merchandiser also accounts for shipping costs and other selling expenses. Merchandisers often pay costs related to: • Receiving goods from suppliers. • Delivering goods to customers. • Advertising and other selling costs. When merchandisers order items, they often pay the cost of shipping the items to their place of business. These shipping costs are often referred to as freight charges. Buyers and sellers specify who pays shipping costs by agreeing to shipping terms. In addition to dictating who is responsible for paying shipping costs, shipping terms also specify the point at which ownership of the goods, or title, transfers from seller to buyer. Shipping terms may be free on board (FOB) shipping point or free on board (FOB) destination. • Under free on board (FOB) shipping point, ownership transfers from the seller to the buyer at the point when the goods leave the seller’s place of business. Also, this term means that the buyer pays the shipping charges to have the merchandise ­delivered to its place of business. The buyer adds the shipping costs to inventory by debiting Inventory because these amounts increase the cost of the goods purchased. • Free on board (FOB) destination denotes the opposite arrangement. Ownership transfers from the seller to the buyer when the goods reach their destination. This means that the seller must pay to ship goods to that point. The seller records the shipping costs with a debit to Delivery Expense. Exhibit 4-4 summarizes FOB terms.

FOB Shipping Point Seller

FOB Destination Buyer

Seller

Tit le

Title passes to buyer.

Buyer

Title

Buyer pays shipping costs.

Seller pays shipping costs.

Title passes to buyer.

Exhibit 4-4

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 203

03/04/14 1:52 PM

204

Chapter 4

Accounting in Your World

Have you ever purchased something online or from a catalog and thought you received a really great deal until you received the bill and realized that the company charged you a significant amount for “shipping”? The reason that you were required to pay these shipping charges is because the merchandise was sold with shipping terms of “FOB Shipping Point.” Next time, you should purchase items from a company that offers “FOB Destination” shipping terms.

Costs Related to the Receipt of Goods from Suppliers Let us see how Cellular Connect records shipping costs when it purchases goods. When it buys products under FOB shipping point, Cellular either pays the shipping company directly or reimburses the seller for the freight charges if they have been prepaid by the seller. When Cellular buys products under FOB destination, the supplier pays the freight charges.

FOB Shipping Point, Pay the Shipping Company Suppose Cellular Connect incurs shipping costs related to the purchase of merchandise (FOB shipping point) from Accessories Unlimited. Cellular pays $60 to the carrier for the February 1 shipment seen earlier. Cellular Connect’s entry to record payment of the shipping charge is as follows: DATE Feb 1

ACCOUNTS POST REF. Inventory Cash Record payment of shipping bill for the February 1 purchase.

DR.

CR. 60 60

Cellular debits Inventory to increase the cost of the merchandise bought and credits Cash for the shipping costs.

FOB Shipping Point, Repay the Seller for Prepaid Shipping Costs Under FOB shipping point, the seller sometimes prepays the shipping costs as a convenience to the buyer. These costs are added to the invoice for the merchandise. Let’s see how Cellular records the following purchase transactions. On July 15, Cellular buys $1,000 of goods on account from CellTel, Inc. The terms of the purchase are 2/10, n/30, FOB shipping point. CellTel prepaid $80 of shipping costs and added the charges to the invoice for an invoice total of $1,080. Cellular then returns $100 of these

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 204

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

205

goods for credit on July 20. On July 25, Cellular makes payment in full for the purchase. First, Cellular records the purchase of goods: DATE Jul 15

ACCOUNTS Inventory Accounts Payable—CellTel, Inc. Record purchase of inventory on account.

POST REF.

DR. 1,080

CR. 1,080

Next, Cellular records the return of inventory, as follows: DATE Jul 20

ACCOUNTS Accounts Payable—CellTel, Inc. Inventory Record inventory returned to the manufacturer.

POST REF.

DR. 100

CR. 100

Finally, it records the payment for the purchase by calculating the purchase discount and the balance due. Cellular pays on July 25, which is within the 10-day discount ­period, so it receives a discount of $18: 2% of the $1,000 original cost of the goods m ­ inus $100 of returned goods, or 0.02 × $900. Although shipping costs increase the invoice amount of the merchandise purchased, they are not included in the calculation of any purchase discount. The purchase discount is computed only on the amount due to the supplier for the goods purchased. The calculation of the payment amount is as follows:

Purchase Amount $1,000  Shipping Costs 80  Purchase Return (100)  Purchase Discount (18) ($1,000  $100  $900; $900  0.02  $18)  Cash Paid $ 962 The journal entry to record the cash payment is as follows: DATE Jul 25

ACCOUNTS Accounts Payable—CellTel, Inc. ($1,000  $80  $100) Inventory [($1,000  $100)  0.02] Cash ($1,000  $80  $100  $18) Record payment of inventory puchases within the discount period.

POST REF.

DR. 980

CR. 18 962

FOB Destination Under FOB destination, the seller pays to ship the goods to the destination requested by the customer. If Cellular Connect purchased goods under these terms, it has no shipping costs to record because the supplier pays the freight.

Costs Related to Delivering Goods to Customers The cost of shipping goods to customers is recorded in an expense account titled Delivery Expense. This cost occurs when the seller agrees to shipping terms of FOB destination. Delivery Expense is an expense on the income statement and, as an expense account, normally has a debit balance.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 205

03/04/14 1:52 PM

206

Chapter 4

Let’s see how the sale of goods and payment of shipping costs affect Cellular Connect in different situations. Rob Macklin, a frequent customer at Cellular Connect, has an account with the store. Rob buys a bluetooth headset as a Christmas gift for his sister who lives in Las Vegas. Cellular purchases the headset for $45 and sells it to Rob for $100. Shipping costs to Las Vegas total $15.

FOB Destination Let’s assume that Cellular advertises that shipping costs are free with any purchase of $100 or more. Assume Rob buys the headset on November 30 and charges it to his ­account. He asks Cellular to ship it to Las Vegas. Cellular records the sale and payment of shipping costs as follows: DATE Nov 30

DATE Nov 30

ACCOUNTS Accounts Receivable—Rob Macklin Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold Inventory Record sale of inventory on account.

POST REF.

ACCOUNTS Delivery Expense Cash Record shipping costs on sale.

POST REF.

DR. 100

CR. 100

45 45

DR.

CR. 15 15

In this case, income from the sale is $40 ($100 – $45 – $15).

FOB Shipping Point Now, let’s assume that Cellular does not offer free shipping. Because Cellular sold the goods FOB shipping point, Rob pays for the shipping costs. Rob purchases the headset on November 30 and takes it home to wrap and send with another gift. Cellular would record the sale as follows: DATE Nov 30

ACCOUNTS Accounts Receivable—Rob Macklin Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold Inventory Record sale of inventory on account.

POST REF.

DR. 100

CR. 100

45 45

In this situation, income from sale would be $55 ($100 – $45).

FOB Shipping Point, Seller Agrees to Prepay the Shipping Costs Now assume that Rob buys the headset on November 30 and asks Cellular to ship it to Las Vegas for him. Again, because the goods are sold FOB shipping point, Rob is responsible for the shipping charges. In this case, Cellular pays for shipping the goods

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 206

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

207

and adds the cost to Rob’s invoice. Cellular records the sale, including the payment of shipping costs, as follows: DATE Nov 30

DATE Nov 30

ACCOUNTS Accounts Receivable—Rob Macklin Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold Inventory Record sale of inventory on account.

POST REF.

ACCOUNTS Accounts Receivable—Rob Macklin Cash Record prepayment of shipping costs.

POST REF.

DR. 100

CR. 100

45 45

DR.

CR. 15 15

Income from the sale is again $55 ($100 – $45). The $15 Cellular paid to ship the headset to Las Vegas is not an expense as it will be reimbursed by Rob. A comparison r­eveals that the income from the sale under FOB shipping point remains the same whether or not Cellular prepays the shipping charges:

Sales Revenue ...............  Cost of Goods Sold........  Delivery Expense ...........  Income from Sale ..........

FOB destination $100 (45) (15) $ 40

FOB Shipping Point $100 (45) — $ 55

FOB Shipping Point, Seller Prepays $100 (45) — $ 55

Other Selling Costs Selling expenses  Expenses ­related to advertising and selling products including sales salaries, sales ­commissions, advertising, ­depreciation on items used in sales, and delivery expense.

Selling expenses represent the costs associated with advertising and selling inventory.

Examples of selling expenses usually found on a merchandiser’s income statement include the following: • Sales salaries, wages, and commissions • Advertising and promotion • Depreciation on stores, parking lots, counters, displays, shelves, vehicles of ­salespeople, and storage space (such as warehouses and refrigerators) • Delivery costs of merchandise to customers As we will see in the next section, selling expenses are a deduction when arriving at the net income of a merchandiser.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 207

03/04/14 1:52 PM

208

Chapter 4

Stop and Think… If freight charges paid by a merchandiser to ship merchandise to a customer are expensed as a delivery expense, why are freight charges paid by the merchandiser to have goods it purchased delivered added to the Inventory account?

Answer

It has to do with the matching principle that was discussed in Chapter 3. By expensing the freight charges of delivering merchandise to a customer, the freight costs are being matched with the revenue that was earned when the merchandise was sold. The freight charges associated with the receipt of purchased goods are added to the cost of inventory so that they are not expensed until the inventory is sold. Because the freight costs become part of the cost of the inventory, they will be expensed through cost of goods sold once the inventory is sold and therefore the matching principle is better observed.

How Do You Prepare a Merchandiser’s Financial Statements? The Income Statement 6

Prepare a multi-step income statement and a classified balance sheet

Single-step income ­statement  Income statement format that groups all revenues together and lists all expenses together, subtracting total expenses from total revenues and calculating net income or net loss without computing any subtotals.

In earlier chapters, you learned how to complete the financial statements for a service business. Many service businesses use a single-step income statement. The single-step income statement groups all revenues together and all expenses together. Then the total expenses are subtracted from total revenues in a single step without calculating any subtotals. The advantage of the single-step format is that it clearly distinguishes revenues from expenses. Although Cellular Connect is a merchandiser, Exhibit 4-5 illustrates its income statement for the year ended December 31, 2014, prepared using the single-step format.

Cellular Connect, Inc. Income Statement Year Ended December 31, 2014 Revenues: Net Sales Revenue Expenses: Cost of Goods Sold Selling Expenses General and Administrative Expenses Interest Expense Total Expenses Net Income

$167,900 $90,300 1,200 19,650 1,100 112,250 $ 55,650

Exhibit 4-5 Multi-step income statement  Income statement format that calculates net income or net loss by listing important subtotals, such as gross profit and operating income. Net Sales Revenue  Sales revenue less sales discounts and sales returns and allowances.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 208

Most merchandisers use a multi-step income statement. The multi-step income statement is prepared in steps. Important subtotals are computed as part of the calculation of net income or net loss. Investors prefer this format because it provides step-by-step information about the profitability of the business. This format makes it more useful for managers within the business as well as investors outside of the business. The multi-step income statement for most merchandisers will contain most, but not necessarily all, of the following items: • Net Sales Revenue is presented first and is calculated by subtracting both Sales Returns and Allowances and Sales Discounts from Sales Revenue. Keep in mind

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

Gross Profit  Net sales revenue minus cost of goods sold; also called Gross Margin. Operating Expenses  Expenses of operating a business other than cost of goods sold. Examples include depreciation, rent, salaries, utilities, advertising, delivery expense, property taxes, and supplies expense. General and Administrative Expenses  Office expenses, such as the salaries of the company president and office employees, depreciation of items used in administration, rent, ­utilities, and property taxes on the ­office building. Operating Income  Gross profit minus operating expenses. Also called Income from Operations. Other Revenues and Expenses  Revenues and expenses that fall outside the main operations of a business, such as interest expense and a loss on the sale of long-term assets.

209

that a company may not offer its customers any sales discounts. Also, even if sales discounts are offered, customers may not take advantage of them. Therefore, it is possible that no sales discounts will appear on a company’s income statement. • The cost of the merchandise that is sold appears next as Cost of Goods Sold. • Gross Profit, also called Gross Margin, is a subtotal computed next. The gross profit equals Net Sales Revenue minus Cost of Goods Sold. • Operating Expenses are the expenses, other than cost of goods sold, of ­operating the business. Operating Expenses are listed after Gross Profit. Many companies ­report operating expenses in two categories:

1. Selling Expenses include sales salaries, commissions, advertising, promotion, depreciation for items used in sales, and delivery costs to customers.



2. General and Administrative Expenses include office expenses, such as the salaries of the company president and office employees, depreciation of items used in administration, rent, utilities, and property taxes on the office building.

• On the multi-step income statement, Gross Profit minus Operating Expenses equals Operating Income, or Income from Operations. Operating income measures the results of the entity’s primary, ongoing business activities. • The last section of a multi-step income statement is Other Revenues and Expenses. This category reports revenues and expenses that fall outside of a business’s main operations. Examples include interest revenue, interest expense, dividend revenue, and gains and losses on the sale of long-term assets. As not every business has revenues and expenses outside its main operations, not all income statements will include this section. • The last line of the multi-step income statement is Net Income or Net Loss. To calculate, add Other Revenues and subtract Other Expenses from Operating Income. The final results of operations, net income or net loss, is a company’s bottom line, a commonly used business term. Cellular Connect’s multi-step income statement for the year ended December 31, 2014, appears in Exhibit 4-6 on page 210 along with the Statement of Retained Earnings and the Balance Sheet. After you review Cellular Connect’s multi-step income statement in Exhibit 4-6, look again at its single-step version in Exhibit 4-5. Notice that in both formats net income is exactly the same. The format of the income statement does not change the net income or net loss of a business. It simply changes how the calculation of net income or net loss is presented.

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analyze

When should a financial statement user expect to see a single versus multi-step format for the income statement?

It depends on how the information will be used by the user.

The single-step format shows the calculation of net income or net loss by subtracting all expenses from all revenues in a single step. The single-step format typically shows summary information and is intended for users who do not need much detail. This format would not be a good format for creditors or investors to use, but it would be great to use in a press release or newspaper article. The multi-step format shows the calculation of net income or net loss in a series of steps with subtotals for gross profit and operating income. This format shows detailed information and is best suited for creditors and investors.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 209

03/04/14 1:52 PM

210

Chapter 4

Cellular Connect, Inc. Income Statement Year Ended December 31, 2014 Sales Revenue Less: Sales Returns and Allowances Net Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses: Selling Expenses: Advertising Expense Delivery Expense General and Administrative Expenses: Salaries Expense Rent Expense Insurance Expense Depreciation Expense, Office Equipment Supplies Expense Operating Income Other Revenues and (Expenses): Interest Expense Net Income

$171,300 3,400 $167,900 90,300 77,600

$ 1,000 200

1,200

10,200 7,300 1,000 600 550

19,650

20,850 56,750 (1,100) $ 55,650

Cellular Connect, Inc. Statement of Retained Earnings Year Ended December 31, 2014 $20,900 55,650 76,550 55,900 $20,650

Retained Earnings, December 31, 2013 Add: Net Income Subtotal Less: Dividends Retained Earnings, December 31, 2014

Cellular Connect, Inc. Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 ASSETS Current Assets: Cash Accounts Receivable Inventory Supplies Prepaid Insurance Total Current Assets Long-term Assets: Office Equipment Less: Accumulated Depreciation, Office Equipment

Total Assets

$ 7,150 4,600 15,700 100 200

LIABILITIES Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable $30,000 Salaries Payable 400 Unearned Sales Revenue 700 Total Current Liabilities $31,100 Long-Term Liabilities: $27,750 Mortgage Payable 10,000 Total Liabilities 41,100

52,000 STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY 3,000 49,000 Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities & $76,750 Stockholders’ Equity

15,000 20,650 35,650 $76,750

Exhibit 4-6

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 210

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

211

The Statement of Retained Earnings A merchandiser’s statement of retained earnings looks exactly like that of a service business. Cellular’s statement of retained earnings is presented in Exhibit 4-6.

The Balance Sheet Classified balance sheet  A balance sheet that separates assets and liabilities into current and long-term classes. Liquidity  The ability to convert an asset to cash quickly.

In order to provide more useful information, merchandisers, as well as most service businesses, usually prepare a classified balance sheet. A classified balance sheet lists assets in classes in the order of their liquidity. Liquidity refers to how close an asset is to becoming cash or being used up. Similar to the assets, the liabilities are listed in classes based on how soon the obligation will be paid or fulfilled. By listing the assets and liabilities in these classes, financial statement users can better analyze the business’s ability to pay its bills on time.

Assets Current Assets  Assets that are ­expected to be converted to cash, sold, or consumed within one year or the business’s operating cycle if the cycle is longer than a year.

The most liquid assets are presented on a classified balance sheet in a class called Current Assets. Current Assets are assets that will be converted to cash, sold, or used up during the next twelve months or within a business’s normal operating cycle if longer than one year.

Operating cycle  The time span during which the business obtains ­resources, uses them to sell goods and services to customers, and ­collects cash from these customers.

Business uses cash to purchase resources such as equipment, supplies, and inventory

Business collects cash from the sale of goods and services

Resources are used to provide goods and services to customers

Long-term assets  Assets other than those that are current. Fixed assets  The long-lived assets of a business including land, buildings, furniture, fixtures, and equipment; also called plant assets and commonly shown on the balance sheet as property, plant, and equipment. Property, plant, and equipment  A heading often seen on the balance sheet used to describe fixed, or plant, assets.

Current liabilities  Debts due to be paid with cash or fulfilled with goods and services within one year or the entity’s operating cycle if the cycle is longer than a year.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 211

The Operating Cycle

For most businesses, the operating cycle is a few months. Cash, Accounts Receivable, Notes Receivable due within one year, and Prepaid Expenses are all current assets. If the business is a merchandiser, then the major difference between its balance sheet and that of a service business is that it also shows Inventory as a current asset. All assets other than current assets are reported in a class called long-term assets. One category of long-term assets is called fixed assets or plant assets. This category is often labeled on the balance sheet as property, plant, and equipment. Land, buildings, furniture, fixtures, and equipment are examples of these assets.

Liabilities The debts or obligations of a business that must be paid for or fulfilled within one year (or within the entity’s operating cycle if the cycle is longer than a year) are reported in a class called current liabilities. Accounts Payable, Notes Payable due within one year, Salaries Payable, Interest Payable, and Unearned Revenue are current liabilities.

03/04/14 1:52 PM

212

Chapter 4

Long-term liabilities  Liabilities other than those that are current. Account form  A balance sheet ­format that lists assets on the left ­ of the report and liabilities and stockholders’ equity on the right, just as those accounts appear in the ­accounting equation. Report form  A balance sheet format that reports assets at the top of the report, followed by liabilities, and ending with stockholders’ equity at the end of the report.

Obligations that extend beyond one year are reported as long-term liabilities. Often, a business owner signs a contract to repay a note or mortgage over several years. The portion of the note or mortgage that must be paid within one year is classified as a current liability. However, the remaining balance is a long-term liability. The balance sheet for Cellular Connect is presented in Exhibit 4-6. Cellular’s balance sheet is presented in account form. The account form lists the assets on the left and the liabilities and stockholders’ equity on the right, just as these accounts appear in the accounting equation. It is also acceptable to present the balance sheet in report form, which lists the assets at the top and the liabilities and stockholders’ equity on the bottom.

Focus On Decision Making “Is the Business Profitable?”

Think about being the manager of Cellular Connect, Inc. Look at Exhibit 4-6. Are you doing a good job or bad job? Is your business profitable? How profitable is your business? Three measures often used to evaluate profitability are the earnings per share, gross profit percentage, and net income percentage.

7

Compute earnings per share, the gross profit percentage, and the net income percentage

Earnings per share (EPS)   The portion of a company’s earnings ­allocated to each outstanding share of common stock. Earnings per share serves as an indicator of a company’s profitability.

Earnings per Share

Earnings per share (EPS) is a measure of the profitability or loss of each unit of ownership. In a corporation, each unit of ownership is called a share of stock. As noted in Chapter 1, the owners of a corporation are called stockholders. Stockholders own shares of a corporation’s stock. Earnings per share is computed by dividing the corporation’s net income or net loss by the average number of shares outstanding during a year. Assume Cellular Connect has 1,875 average shares of stock outstanding during the year. Based on information provided from the income statement in Exhibit 4-6, Cellular Connect’s earnings per share is $29.68, calculated as follows:

Earnings Per Share  $55,650/1,875  $29.68 A $29.68 earnings per share means that Cellular Connect earned $29.68 for each share of stock outstanding during the year.1, 2

1

Earnings per share is computed by dividing net income or loss by the average number of shares outstanding during the year. All corporations have common stock. Sometimes a corporation has common stock and preferred stock. Owners of preferred stock have priority in receiving a stated amount of dividends. What remains belongs to the owners of the corporation’s common stock. Stockholders that own common stock control the business by voting for management and other major decisions. If a company has preferred stock, earnings per share is computed by subtracting preferred dividends from net income, resulting in net income available for common stockholders. This net income available to common stockholders is then divided by the average number of common shares outstanding during the year. 2 Earnings per share is computed by dividing net income or loss by the average number of shares outstanding during the year. This earnings per share number is called basic earnings per share. If a corporation has certain contingencies that have a high probability of occurring in the future, accountants will compute a diluted earnings per share. An example of such a contingency is when a company gives its senior executives the option to buy its stock at a very attractive price. Diluted earnings per share is computed by re-computing the net income and average number of shares outstanding, assuming the contingency occurred. The recomputed net income is then divided by the recomputed average number of shares outstanding during the year. The result is diluted earnings per share.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 212

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

213

The Gross Profit Percentage

Gross profit percentage  A measure of profitability equal to gross profit divided by net sales ­revenue; also called gross margin percentage.

Gross profit, also called gross margin, is a key tool in evaluating merchandising operations. Remember that gross profit is net sales revenue minus the cost of goods sold. Thus, gross profit is the amount left over from sales after deducting the cost of the merchandise sold. Merchandisers strive to maximize gross profit in order to help maximize net income. The gross profit percentage, also called the gross margin percentage, shows how well a merchandising business meets this goal. The gross profit percentage measures the relationship between gross profit and sales. The gross profit percentage is one of the most carefully watched measures of profitability by investors and business managers. This information is used to compare changes in gross profit from year to year for the business. Also, it is used to compare the company to other businesses in the same industry. For most businesses, the gross profit percentage changes little from year to year. To investors, a significant change in the gross profit percentage signals a significant change in the business’s operations, meriting further investigation. To compute the gross profit percentage, divide gross profit by net sales revenue. Based on information provided in the income statement in Exhibit 4-6, the gross profit percentage for Cellular Connect is 46.2%, calculated as follows:

Gross Profit Percentage 

Gross Profit $77,600   0.462  46.2% Net Sales Revenue $167,900

A 46.2% gross margin percentage means that each dollar of net sales generates $0.462 of gross profit. Every time Cellular Connect sells $1 of merchandise, it produces $0.462 of gross profit that hopefully covers operating expenses, interest expense, and generates net income.

The Net Income Percentage

Net income percentage  A ­measure of profitability equal to net income divided by net sales revenue.

Net income is the difference between sales (plus other revenues) and all the expenses the business incurs during a certain period. These expenses include the cost of inventory sold, but also include operating expenses such as salaries, rent, advertising, and utilities, as well as other expenses such as interest. Another way to look at it is that net income is gross profit (sales less the cost of merchandise sold) less operating expenses (which equals operating income) plus or minus other revenues and expenses a business experiences in a set accounting period. Net income is very important because it is the return that stockholders earn. Now ask yourself, “How much of every dollar of sales ends up as net income?” The net income percentage answers that question. The net income percentage is the ­percent of every dollar of net sales that ends up as net income. To compute the net income percentage, divide net income by net sales revenue. The formula for calculating the net income percentage is:

Net Income Percentage  Net Income/Net Sales Revenue Based on the information provided from the income statement in Exhibit 4-6, the net income percentage for Cellular Connect is 33.1%, calculated as follows:

Net Income Percentage 

$55,650  33.1% $167,900

Cellular Connect makes a little over $0.33 on every dollar of sales. That’s pretty good. The stockholders should be pleased with the management of Cellular Connect. Cellular Connect appears to be doing a very good job of keeping expenses low relative to sales.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 213

03/04/14 1:52 PM

214

Chapter 4

How They Do It: A Look at Business

Think about how different businesses operate and make a profit. Some businesses sell a lot of products and make a modest profit on each sale. An example is a toy store such as Toys R Us. Think of all the customers that come into a toy store. Think of all the toys each customer buys. Toys R Us only makes a few cents on each item sold, but it sells a lot of items. For the year ending February 2, 2013, Toys R Us’ gross profit margin percentage was 37%, but its net income percentage was less than 1%. This resulted in Toys R Us earning net income of only $39 million and earnings per share of $0.39 for the year ending February 2, 2013. Other businesses sell only a few items but make a lot of profit on each sale. An example is the very expensive jewelry store Tiffany & Co. Although Tiffany does not have a lot of customers and sales, it makes a large profit on each sale. This also results in a large net income. As of January 31, 2013, Tiffany’s gross profit margin percentage was 57% and net income percentage was 11%. This resulted in Tiffany & Co. earning net income of $416 million and earnings per share of $3.28 for the year ending January 31, 2013. Now, think; all businesses want to earn a profit or net income. However, different businesses earn that profit in different ways. Toys R Us made its profit by selling a lot of toys, making a small profit on each toy sale. Tiffany’s made its profit by selling a few items, making a large profit on each sale.

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analyze

Am I charging enough for my product?

Consider the gross profit on the income statement.

A business must have sufficient gross profit after paying for the cost of the goods that it sold in order to pay its operating expenses and other expenses and provide sufficient net income to satisfy its stockholders.

Am I earning a profit for my owners (stockholders)?

Consider the business’ net income and its earnings per share (EPS)

A business needs to reward its owners for providing money. This reward is net income. To measure the net income for each share of stock outstanding we compute the earnings per share (EPS). EPS is computed by dividing net income by the average number of shares outstanding during the period.

Summary MyAccountingLab

1

Describe the relationships among manufacturers, wholesalers, retailers, and customers

Here is what you should know after reading this chapter. MyAccountingLab will help you identify what you know and where to go when you need practice.

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

How do customers get their goods?

Inventory (p. 194)

• Manufacturers usually sell inventory to wholesalers or sometimes directly to retailers.

Merchandise inventory (p. 194)

• Wholesalers sell to retailers.

Retailers (p. 194) Wholesalers (p. 194)

• Customers usually buy from retailers.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 214

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

2

Define periodic and perpetual inventory systems

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Types of inventory systems:

Periodic inventory system (p. 195)

• Perpetual inventory system keeps a running record of inventory as it is bought and sold.

Perpetual inventory system (p. 195)

215

• Periodic inventory system only updates the inventory balance at the end of each period based on a physical count.

3

Journalize transactions for the purchase of inventory

Accounting for merchandise inventory purchases:

Credit terms (p. 197) Discount period (p. 198)

• Cash and credit purchases are recorded as increases to the Inventory account.

eom (p. 197)

• Purchase returns and allowances are recorded as decreases to the Inventory account.

Purchase returns and allowances (p. 196)

• Purchase discounts are recorded as decreases to the Inventory account.

Purchase discount (p. 197) n/30 (p. 197) n/eom (p. 197) Sales invoice (p. 197) Subsidiary ledger (p. 196)

4

Journalize transactions for the sale of inventory

Accounting for merchandise sales:

Compound journal entry (p. 199)

• Merchandise sales require a compound entry that increases Cash or Accounts Receivable, increases Sales, increases Cost of Goods Sold, and decreases Inventory.

Cost of Goods Sold (p. 199)

• The returns of merchandise (or sales allowances) are recorded in a contra-account titled Sales Returns and Allowances.

Sales Returns and Allowances (p. 200)

Credit memorandum (p. 200) Sales Discount (p. 202) Sales Revenue (p. 199)

• Sales discounts received for the prompt payment of an invoice are recorded in a contraaccount titled Sales Discounts.

5

Understand shipping terms and journalize transactions for freight charges and other selling expenses

Accounting for freight and other charges:

Free on board (FOB) destination (p. 203)

• Freight charges incurred on the delivery of goods from a vendor are recorded in the Inventory account.

Free on board (FOB) shipping point (p. 203)

• Freight charges incurred on the delivery of goods to a customer are recorded in an expense account such as Delivery Expense.

Freight charges (p. 203) Selling expenses (p. 207) Title (p. 203)

• The shipping terms dictate when title to goods (ownership) transfers.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 215

03/04/14 1:52 PM

216

6

Chapter 4

Prepare a multi-step income statement and a classified balance sheet

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Financial statements for a merchandiser:

Account form (p. 212)

• Multi-step income statements are usually detailed and show important subtotals such as Gross Profit and Operating Income.

Classified balance sheet (p. 211)

• Classified balance sheets show more useful information because assets and liabilities are classified as either current or long-term. The time frame used by most businesses to define current is one year or less.

Current Assets (p. 211) Current liabilities (p. 211) Fixed assets (p. 211) General and Administrative Expenses (p. 209) Gross Margin (p. 209) Gross Profit (p. 209) Income from Operations (p. 209) Liquidity (p. 211) Long-term assets (p. 211) Long-term liabilities (p. 212) Multi-step income statement (p. 208) Net Sales Revenue (p. 208) Operating cycle (p. 211) Operating Expenses (p. 209) Operating Income (p. 209) Other Revenues and Expenses (p. 209) Plant assets (p. 211) Property, plant, and equipment (p. 211) Report form (p. 212) Single-step income statement (p. 208)

7

Compute earnings per share, the gross profit percentage, and the net income percentage

Ratios often used to help make decisions:

Earnings per share (p. 212)

• Earnings per share (EPS) is a measure of the profitability or loss of each unit of ownership. In a corporation, each unit of ownership is called a share of stock.

Gross margin percentage (p. 213) Gross profit percentage (p. 213) Net income percentage (p. 213)

• Gross profit percentage measures the percentage of each dollar of sales that a business has left to pay its operating and other expenses and provide net income. • Net income percentage measures the percentage of net sales that results in net income.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 216

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

217

Accounting Practice Discussion Questions 1. What accounts will appear on the financial statements of a merchandiser that will not appear on those of a service-oriented company? 2. What are some reasons why a merchandiser might prefer to use a perpetual inventory system over a periodic inventory system? 3. Why do businesses use subsidiary ledgers? 4. What do the terms 2/10, n/30 mean? If you were advising a company that bought goods under these terms, what would you advise it to do with respect to payment? Why? 5. How many accounts are involved in recording the sale of merchandise on credit? 6. What kind of account is Sales Returns and Allowances? Where would it appear on the financial statements? 7. What is a credit memorandum? Give an example of the type of transaction in which it would be used. 8. What does the term “free on board” mean? Why is this an important term to understand if you are involved in making decisions about the purchasing of inventory or the setting of prices for your products? 9. What is the difference between a single-step and multi-step income statement? For what type of business is a multi-step income statement most appropriate? 10. What situation might explain why a company’s gross profit percentage went down from 60% to 40% from one year to the next?

Self Check 1. Which account does a merchandiser use that a service company does not use? a. Cost of goods sold b. Inventory c. Sales revenue d. All of the above 2. The two main inventory accounting systems are the a. perpetual and periodic. b. cash and accrual. c. returns and allowances. d. purchase and sale. 3. Which of the following represents the journal entry to record the purchase of $1,500 of inventory on account? DATE a.

b.

c.

d.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 217

ACCOUNTS Cost of Goods Sold Accounts Payable

POST REF.

DR. 1,500

CR. 1,500

Inventory Cash

1,500

Accounts Payable Inventory

1,500

Inventory Accounts Payable

1,500

1,500

1,500

1,500

03/04/14 1:52 PM

218

Chapter 4 4. Water Works Pool Supply, Inc., purchased inventory for $2,700 and also paid $70 freight to have the inventory delivered. Water Works Pool Supply, Inc., returned $125 of the goods to the seller and later took a 3% purchase discount. What is the final cost of the inventory that Water Works Pool Supply, Inc., kept? (Round your answer up to the next whole number.) a. $2,645 b. $2,566 c. $2,498 d. $2,568 5. Suppose Riley Electronics, Inc., had sales of $280,000 and sales returns of $26,000. Cost of goods sold was $112,000. How much gross profit did Riley Electronics, Inc., report? a. $168,000 b. $142,000 c. $194,000 d. $254,000 6. Suppose Perfect Picture Photography Supply’s Inventory account showed a balance of $44,700. A physical count showed $43,300 of goods on hand. To adjust the inventory account, Picture Perfect Photography Supply, Inc., would make which of the following entries? DATE a.

b.

c.

d.

ACCOUNTS Cost of Goods Sold Inventory

POST REF.

DR. 1,400

CR. 1,400

Inventory Accounts Payable

1,400

Accounts Payable Inventory

1,400

Inventory Cost of Goods Sold

1,400

1,400

1,400

1,400

7. If Holiboards, Inc., returned $2,750 of snowboards to a supplier, which of the following entries would be used to record the transaction? DATE a.

b.

c.

d.

ACCOUNTS Accounts Payable Inventory

POST REF.

DR. 2,750

CR. 2,750

Accounts Payable Sales Returns and Allowances

2,750

Inventory Accounts Payable

2,750

Cost of Goods Sold Inventory

2,750

2,750

2,750

2,750

8. An asset is classified as current if it a. will last longer than one year. b. will become cash, be sold, or be used up within twelve months. c. was purchased within the last six months. d. was purchased with cash.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 218

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

219

9. The income statement format that shows important subtotals is referred to as a. a subtotaled income statement. b. a single-step income statement. c. a multi-step income statement. d. a classified income statement. 10. Suppose Acme Electronics, Inc., had sales of $195,000 and sales returns of $15,000. Cost of goods sold was $108,000. What was Neilson Electronics’ gross profit percentage (rounded) for this period? a. 37% b. 40% c. 45% d. 34% 11. According to the Real World Accounting Video, the cost of merchandise inventory that the business has sold to customers is called _______________. a. inventory shrinkage b. cost of business c. cost of goods sold d. cost of inventory 12. According to the Real World Accounting Video, vendors generally sell merchandise expecting to be paid in ________ days. a. 0 b. 30 c. 90 d. 180 Answers are given after Written Communication.

MyAccountingLab

Short Exercises S4-1. Inventory methods (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. The following characteristics are related to either periodic inventory or perpetual inventory systems. 1. A physical count of goods on hand at year-end is required. 2. Inventory records are continuously updated. 3. Purchases of inventory are recorded in an asset account at the time of purchase. 4. Bar code scanners are often utilized when using this inventory system. 5. It is necessary to calculate the cost of goods sold at the end of the year with this inventory system. Match each characteristic with one of the following:

a. b. c. d.

Periodic inventory Perpetual inventory Both periodic and perpetual inventory Neither periodic nor perpetual inventory

S4-2. Adjusting inventory based on a physical count (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Cole’s Furniture uses the perpetual inventory method. At the end of the year, Cole’s Furniture’s Inventory account had a ledger balance of $163,000. A physical inventory count revealed that the actual inventory on hand totaled $161,800. Journalize the transaction necessary to adjust the Inventory account at the end of the year.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 219

03/04/14 1:52 PM

220

Chapter 4 S4-3. Journalizing inventory purchases (Learning Objective 3) 5–10 min. Suppose A-1 Sports purchases $83,000 of sportswear on account from Outdoor Wear, Inc., on December 1, 2014. Credit terms are 2/10, net 45. A-1 Sports pays Outdoor Wear, Inc., on December 8, 2014. 1. Journalize the transactions for A-1 Sports on December 1, 2014, and December 8, 2014. 2. What was the final cost of this inventory for A-1 Sports? S4-4. Inventory purchases and returns (Learning Objective 3) 5–10 min. Regal Spas, Inc., purchased $17,400 worth of inventory from the Pool Palace on account, terms of 1/10, n/30. Some of the goods are damaged in shipment, so Regal Spas, Inc., returns $1,600 of the merchandise to the Pool Palace. How much must Regal Spas, Inc., pay the Pool Palace a. after the discount period? b. within the discount period? S4-5. Journalizing inventory purchases and returns (Learning Objective 3) 5–10 min. Samia Corp. bought merchandise worth $5,000, terms n/30, from Zone Corp. on June 4. The cost of the merchandise to Zone was $3,600. On June 10, Samia Corp. returned $700 worth of goods to Zone Corp. for full credit. The goods had a cost of $450 to Zone. On June 12, the account was paid in full. Samia Corporation uses the perpetual inventory system. Prepare journal entries without explanations to record these transactions in Samia’s records. S4-6. Journalizing inventory purchases and freight charges (Learning Objectives 3 & 5) 5–10 min. Journalize the following transactions for Jammin’ Joe’s music store. a. Purchased $4,200 of merchandise on account, terms 3/15, n/30, FOB shipping point. b. Paid $140 to the freight company for the delivery of the merchandise purchased. c. Paid for the inventory purchased in part a. within the discount period. S4-7. Journalizing sales transactions (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. Journalize the following transactions for the Pool Palace. Explanations are not required. a. The Pool Palace sold $81,000 of merchandise to Regal Spas, Inc., on account, terms 4/15, n/60. The merchandise cost the Pool Palace $44,500. b. Received payment for the goods from Regal Spas, Inc., within the discount period. S4-8. Journalizing sales and return transactions (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. On December 3, Kamal Co. sold $500,000 of merchandise to Tara Co., terms 1/10, n/10. The cost of the merchandise sold was $320,000. On December 8, Tara Co. was granted an allowance of $20,000 for merchandise purchased on December 3. On December 13, Kamal Co. received the balance due from Tara Co. Prepare the journal entries to record these transactions on the books of Kamal Co. It uses a perpetual ­inventory system.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 220

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

221

S4-9. Calculate income statement items (Learning Objective 6) 5–10 min. Suppose Paul’s Hardware sells merchandise on account, terms 1/10, n/45, for $920 (cost of the inventory is $550) on March 17, 2014. Peter’s Hardware later received $290 of goods (cost, $175) as sales returns on March 21, 2014. The customer paid the balance due on March 26, 2014. 1. Calculate net sales revenue for March 2014. 2. Calculate gross profit for March 2014. S4-10. Calculate classified balance sheet amounts (Learning Objective 6) 5–10 min. Selected account balances for Maria’s Mocha at the end of the month are listed below in random order:

Accounts Payable.................................................................................................... $14,800 Unearned Revenue.................................................................................................. 7,300 Equipment............................................................................................................... 43,000 Inventory ................................................................................................................ 27,000 Accounts Receivable ............................................................................................... 5,700 Salaries Payable...................................................................................................... 2,150 Note Payable, Long-Term ....................................................................................... 46,000 Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment ................................................................... 4,200 Common Stock ....................................................................................................... 28,000 Supplies .................................................................................................................. 1,950 Building................................................................................................................... 121,000 Cash........................................................................................................................ 6,400 Accumulated Depreciation, Building ....................................................................... 53,000 Prepaid Rent ........................................................................................................... 2,400 Retained Earnings ................................................................................................... 11,800 Identify or compute the following amounts for Maria’s Mocha: a. Total current assets b. Total current liabilities c. Book value of plant assets d. Total long-term liabilities S4-11. Prepare a multi-step income statement (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. The accounting records for The Skate Shed, Inc., reflected the following amounts at the end of January 2014:

Cash........................................... Total Operating Expense ............ Accounts Payable....................... Total Stockholders’ Equity ......... Long-Term Notes Payable.......... Inventory.................................... Salaries Payable.........................

$2,750 6,475 4,800 6,025 23,000 4,700 1,150

Cost of Goods Sold .................. Equipment, Net ........................ Accrued Liabilities.................... Net Sales Revenue ................... Accounts Receivable ................ Prepaid Rent ............................ Interest Expense ......................

$21,000 25,700 2,475 41,500 3,100 1,200 375

Prepare The Skate Shed’s multi-step income statement for the fiscal year ended January 31, 2014. S4-12. Prepare a classified balance sheet (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Use the data from S4-11 to prepare the classified balance sheet for The Skate Shed, Inc., at January 31, 2014. Use the report format.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 221

03/04/14 1:52 PM

222

Chapter 4 S4-13. Calculate gross profit percentage and net income percentage (Learning Objective 7) 10–15 min. Use the data from S4-11 to calculate the gross profit percentage and the net income percentage for The Skate Shed, Inc., for 2014.

MyAccountingLab

Exercises (Group A) E4-14A. Adjusting inventory based on a physical count (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. The Inventory account for RV Repair Service Company had a balance of $126,800 at the end of its fiscal year. A physical count taken at year-end revealed that the value of inventory on hand amounted to $124,700. Requirements 1. Journalize the adjustment for inventory shrinkage. 2. What could cause the inventory balance according to the physical count to be different from the ledger balance? E4-15A. Journalizing inventory purchases, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 3 & 5) 10–15 min. On September 15, 2014, Simpson’s Department Store purchased $5,300 of inventory on account from one of its suppliers. The terms were 2/15, n/45, FOB shipping point. On September 18, Simpson’s Department Store paid freight charges of $410 related to the delivery of the goods purchased on September 15. Upon receiving the goods, Simpson’s Department Store checked the order and found $600 of unsuitable merchandise, which was returned to the supplier on September 20. Then, on September 28, Simpson’s Department Store paid the invoice. Requirement 1. Journalize all necessary transactions for Simpson’s Department Store. Omit explanations. E4-16A. Journalizing inventory purchases, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objective 3 & 5) 10–15 min. Abdo uses a perpetual inventory system. Journalize all necessary transactions for Abdo Company. Omit explanations. On January 1, 2014, Abdo Company purchased merchandise on account from Oklu Company for $70,000, with terms of 1/10, n/30, FOB shipping point. On January 2, Abdo paid freight charges of $500 related to the delivery of the goods purchased on January 1. On January 6, Abdo returned some merchandise and paid $53,955 as ­payment in full. E4-17A. Journalizing inventory sales, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 10–15 min. On January 1, 2014, Wael Company sold merchandise to Moe Company on account for $84,000 with credit terms of ?/10, n/30, FOB destination. The cost of the merchandise sold was $63,000. On January 3, Wael paid freight charges of $2,300 related to the delivery of goods sold on January 1. On January 7, Moe Company returned $4,000 of merchandise and paid its account in full (minus the discount) by remitting $78,400 in cash. Wael uses a perpetual inventory system. Requirement 1. Journalize all necessary transactions for Wael Company. Omit explanations.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 222

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

223

E4-18A. Journalizing inventory sales, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 10–15 min. Journalize the following transactions for Alpine Audio, Inc., that occurred during the month of April. Alpine Audio’s cost of inventory is 65% of the sales price.

Apr 3 7 16

Sold $2,200 of merchandise on account, terms 5/15, n/45, FOB shipping point. Alpine Audio, Inc., prepaid $65 of shipping costs and added the amount to the customer’s invoice. Issued a credit memo to the customer acknowledging the return of $225 (sales price) of unwanted goods. Received payment in full from the customer for the April 3 invoice.

E4-19A. Journalizing inventory purchases, sales, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 3, 4, & 5) 15–20 min. On October 1, the Kadmous Watch Store had an inventory of 20 watches at a cost of $150 each. During the month of October the following transactions occurred. Assume Kadmous uses a perpetual inventory system.

Oct

4 Purchased 180 watches at a cost of $145 each from the C&F Company, terms 2/10, n/30. 5 Paid freight of $1,000 on the October 4 purchase. 6 Sold 10 watches from the October 1 inventory to Darin for $250 each, terms 2/10, n/30. 7 Received credit from the C&F Company for the return of 8 defective watches. 13 Issued a credit memo to Darin for the return of a defective watch. 14 Paid C&F Company in full, less discount.

Requirement 1. Prepare the journal entries to record the transactions assuming the company uses a perpetual inventory system. E4-20A. Calculate multi-step income statement items (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. The following information is available for Khouloud Company. Use it to prepare a ­multiple-step income statement for the year ending December 31, 2014.

Sales Revenue.............................................. Sales Returns and Allowances ..................... Cost of Goods Sold ...................................... Operating Expenses ..................................... Interest Expense .......................................... Interest Revenue ..........................................

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 223

$730,000 15,000 340,000 100,000 5,000 7,000

03/04/14 1:52 PM

224

Chapter 4 E4-21A. Prepare a single-step income statement (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. The account balances for Sparky’s Electrical Supply, Inc., for the year ended August 31, 2014, are presented next in random order:

Cash....................................... Equipment.............................. Accounts Payable................... Common Stock ...................... Long-Term Notes Payable...... General Expenses................... Salaries Payable..................... Supplies ................................. Building.................................. Sales Returns and Allowances ........................ Prepaid Rent .......................... Interest Expense .................... Retained Earnings ..................

$

3,850 12,400 7,100 55,000 15,000 18,300 2,850 925 140,000 2,100 3,200 1,725 39,950

Cost of Goods Sold .................. $127,400 Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment........................... 9,500 Unearned Revenues ................. 2,700 Sales Revenue.......................... 253,000 Accounts Receivable ................ 6,425 Accumulated Depreciation, Building............................... 19,200 Mortgage Payable (Long-Term) ....................... 44,200 Dividends ................................. 80,000 Sales Discounts ....................... 3,375 Selling Expenses ...................... 36,500 Inventory.................................. 12,300

Requirements Quick solution:

1. Prepare Sparky’s Electrical Supply’s single-step income statement.

1. Net Income = $63,600.

2. Would you recommend the use of the single-step income statement format by a merchandiser? Why? E4-22A. Prepare a multi-step income statement; calculate gross profit percentage (Learning Objectives 6 & 7) 15–20 min. Use the data for Sparky’s Electrical Supply, Inc., from E4-21A. Requirements 1. Prepare Sparky’s Electrical Supply’s multi-step income statement. 2. Calculate the gross profit percentage. 3. The gross profit percentage for 2013 was 53.1%. Did the gross profit percentage improve or deteriorate during 2014? E4-23A. Prepare a classified balance sheet (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. Use the data for Sparky’s Electrical Supply, Inc., from E4-21A. Requirement 1. Prepare Sparky’s Electrical Supply’s classified balance sheet. Use the account ­format. The balance shown for retained earnings represents the balance prior to closing the temporary accounts for the year. E4-24A. Calculate earnings per share, gross profit percentage, and net income percentage (Learning Objective 7) 10–15 min. LanWan Software, Inc., had Sales Revenue of $52 million, Sales Returns and Allowances of $1.5 million, and Sales Discounts of $0.5 million in 2014. Cost of goods sold was $23 million, and net income was $10 million for the year. The average number of shares of common stock outstanding during the year was 500,000 shares. Requirement 1. Compute LanWan Software’s earnings per share, gross profit percentage, and net income percentage for 2014.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 224

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

225

Exercises (Group B) E4-25B. Adjusting inventory based on a physical count (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. The Inventory account for Sullivan Industrial, Inc., had a balance of $157,300 at the end of its fiscal year. A physical count taken at year-end revealed that the value of inventory on hand amounted to $154,900. Requirements 1. Journalize the adjustment for inventory shrinkage. 2. What could cause the inventory balance according to the physical count to be different from the ledger balance? E4-26B. Journalizing inventory purchases, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 3 & 5) 10–15 min. On November 15, 2014, Lavery’s Department Store purchased $4,300 of inventory on account from one of its suppliers. The terms were 3/15, n/45, FOB shipping point. On November 18, Lavery’s Department Store paid freight charges of $350 related to the delivery of the goods purchased on November 15. Upon receiving the goods, Lavery’s Department Store checked the order and found $300 of unsuitable merchandise, which was returned to the supplier on November 20. Then, on November 28, Lavery’s Department Store paid the invoice. Requirement 1. Journalize all necessary transactions for Lavery’s Department Store. Omit explanations. E4-27B. Journalizing inventory purchases, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 3 & 5) 10–15 min. Journalize the following transactions for The Hobby House, Inc., that occurred during the month of December.

Dec 3 6 12

Purchased $7,300 of merchandise on account, terms 2/10, n/30, FOB shipping point. The supplier prepaid freight charges of $475 and added the amount to the invoice. Returned damaged goods to the supplier and received a credit memorandum in the amount of $1,250. Paid for the goods purchased on December 3.

E4-28B. Journalizing inventory sales, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 10–15 min. On November 14, 2014, Salem Food Wholesale, Inc., sold $2,700 of inventory (cost is $1,050) on account to one of its customers. The terms were 3/10, n/30, FOB destination. On November 16, Salem Food Wholesale, Inc., paid freight charges of $195 related to the delivery of the goods sold on November 14. On November 20, $300 of goods (cost is $115) were returned by the customer. On November 23, Salem Food Wholesale, Inc., received payment in full from the customer. Requirement 1. Journalize all necessary transactions for Salem Food Wholesale, Inc. Omit explanations.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 225

03/04/14 1:52 PM

226

Chapter 4 E4-29B. Journalizing inventory sales, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 10–15 min. Journalize the following transactions for Wolfe Wholesale, Inc., that occurred during the month of November. Wolfe Wholesale’s cost of inventory is 55% of the sales price.

Nov 3 7 16

Sold $1,800 of merchandise on account, terms 2/15, n/45, FOB shipping point. Wolfe Wholesale, Inc., prepaid $75 of shipping costs and added the amount to the customer's invoice. Issued a credit memo to the customer acknowledging the return of $150 of unwanted goods. Received payment in full from the customer for the November 3 invoice.

E4-30B. Journalizing inventory purchases, sales, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 3, 4, & 5) 15–20 min. The following transactions occurred during June 2014 for Valley Gift and Collectables, Inc.:

Jun 3 6 8 11 12 18 25

Purchased $3,900 of goods on account. Terms, 2/10, n/30. FOB shipping point. Returned $400 of defective merchandise purchased on June 3. Paid freight charges of $70 for delivery of goods purchased on June 3. Sold $1,900 of inventory to a customer on account. Terms, 3/15, n/45, FOB shipping point. The cost of the goods was $800. Paid amount owed on the June 3 purchase. Granted a $200 sales allowance on the June 11 sale because the goods were the wrong color. Received payment in full from customer for the June 11 sale.

Requirement 1. Journalize the June transactions for Valley Gift and Collectables, Inc. Omit explanations. E4-31B. Calculate multi-step income statement items (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Consider the following incomplete table of a merchandiser’s profit data:

Sales

Sales Discounts

Net Sales

Cost of Goods Sold

Gross Profit

(a) 71,000 112,000 (g)

3,100 2,600 (e) 1,200

(b) (c) 98,400 106,500

72,500 43,900 (f) 37,600

27,200 (d) 43,600 (h)

Requirement 1. Complete the table by computing the missing amounts.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 226

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

227

E4-32B. Prepare a single-step income statement (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. The account balances for Borden’s Furniture, Inc., for the year ended August 31, 2014, are presented next in random order:

Cash....................................... Equipment.............................. Accounts Payable................... Common Stock ...................... Long-Term Notes Payable...... General Expenses................... Salaries Payable..................... Supplies ................................. Building.................................. Sales Returns and Allowances ........................ Prepaid Rent .......................... Retained Earnings ..................

$ 11,600 32,000 5,100 15,000 60,000 13,800 2,600 2,400 155,000 2,500 1,900 56,000

Cost of Goods Sold ................ Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment......................... Unearned Revenues ............... Sales Revenue........................ Accounts Receivable .............. Accumulated Depreciation, Building............................. Mortgage Payable (Long-Term) ..................... Dividends ............................... Sales Discounts ..................... Selling Expenses .................... Inventory................................ Interest Expense ....................

$128,700 12,700 3,100 249,000 6,300 38,700 21,500 65,200 1,900 32,400 8,300 1,700

Requirements 1. Prepare Borden’s Furniture’s single-step income statement. 2. Would you recommend the use of the single-step income statement format by a merchandiser? Why? E4-33B. Prepare a multi-step income statement; calculate gross profit percentage (Learning Objectives 6 & 7) 15–20 min. Use the data for Borden’s Furniture, Inc., from E4-32B. Requirements 1. Prepare Borden’s Furniture Inc.’s multi-step income statement. 2. Calculate the gross profit percentage. 3. The gross profit percentage for 2013 was 41.3%. Did the gross profit percentage improve or deteriorate during 2014? E4-34B. Prepare a classified balance sheet (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. Use the data for Borden’s Furniture, Inc., from E4-32B. Requirement 1. Prepare Borden’s Furniture’s classified balance sheet. Use the account format. The balance shown for retained earnings represents the balance prior to closing the temporary accounts for the year. E4-35B. Calculate earnings per share, gross profit percentage, and net income percentage (Learning Objective 7) 10–15 min. Alliance Software, Inc., had Sales Revenue of $67 million, Sales Returns and Allowances of $2.8 million, and Sales Discounts of $1.6 million in 2014. Cost of goods sold was $31 million, and net income was $9 million for the year. The average number of shares of common stock outstanding during the year was 600,000 shares. Requirement 1. Compute Alliance Software’s earnings per share, gross profit percentage, and net income percentage for 2014.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 227

03/04/14 1:52 PM

228

Chapter 4

MyAccountingLab

Problems (Group A) P4-36A. Journalizing inventory purchases, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 3 & 5) 15–20 min. The following purchase-related transactions for Bailey, Inc., occurred during the month of June.

Jun 3 9 16 22 28 28

Purchased $6,900 of merchandise, paid cash. Purchased $550 of supplies on account from Slater Unlimited. Terms, n/30, FOB destination. Purchased $7,100 of merchandise on account from Tire, Inc. Terms, 2/15, n/30, FOB shipping point. Received a credit memo in the amount of $1,400 from Tire, Inc., for damaged goods from the June 16 purchase that were returned. Paid for the supplies purchased on June 9. Paid Tire, Inc., in full for the June 16 purchase.

Requirement 1. Journalize the transactions for Bailey, Inc. Omit explanations. P4-37A. Journalizing inventory sales, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 15–20 min. The following sale-related transactions for Handyman Hardware, Inc., occurred during the month of April.

Apr 3 4 10 17 22 26 30

Sold $4,400 (cost $2,340) of merchandise on account to F. Adams. Terms, 1/15, n/45, FOB destination. Paid $115 to ship the goods sold on April 3 to F. Adams. Sold $2,350 (cost $1,410) of merchandise to cash customers. Received payment in full from F. Adams for the April 3 sale. Sold $5,900 (cost $3,540) of merchandise on account to B. Osborne. Terms, 2/10, n/30, FOB shipping point. Granted B. Osborne a $850 allowance on the April 22 sale due to minor defects in the goods shipped. Received payment in full from B. Osborne for the April 22 sale.

Requirement 1. Journalize the transactions for Handyman Hardware, Inc. Omit explanations.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 228

03/04/14 1:52 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

229

P4-38A. Journalizing inventory purchases, sales, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 3, 4, & 5) 20–25 min. The following transactions occurred between Tucker’s Fine Furnishings and K & B Furniture Warehouse during August of the current year:

Aug 4 7 10 18 31

Tucker’s Fine Furnishings purchased $12,000 of merchandise from K & B Furniture Warehouse on account. Terms, 3/15, n/30, FOB shipping point. The goods cost K & B Furniture Warehouse $7,200. Tucker’s Fine Furnishings paid a $150 freight bill for delivery of the goods purchased on August 4. Tucker’s Fine Furnishings returned $1,300 of the merchandise purchased on August 4. The goods cost K & B Furniture Warehouse $750. Tucker’s Fine Furnishings paid $2,000 of the August 4 invoice less the discount. Tucker’s Fine Furnishings paid the remaining amount owed on the August 4 invoice.

Requirements 1. Journalize these transactions on the books of Tucker’s Fine Furnishings. 2. Journalize these transactions on the books of K & B Furniture Warehouse. P4-39A. Journalizing inventory purchases, sales, returns, and freight transactions; calculate gross profit (Learning Objectives 3, 4, 5, & 6) 25–30 min. The following transactions for Tireboyz Tire, Inc., occurred during June:

Jun 4 7 9 11 13 15 16 18 20 22 23

Purchased $6,500 of merchandise on account from Westcoast Tire. Terms, 3/15, n/45, FOB shipping point. Westcoast Tire prepaid the $450 shipping cost and added the amount to the invoice. Purchased $350 of supplies on account from Office Express. Terms, 2/10, n/30, FOB destination. Sold $1,350 (cost, $760) of merchandise on account to P. Haskins. Terms, 2/15, n/45, FOB destination. Paid $60 freight charges to deliver goods to P. Haskins. Returned $1,200 of the merchandise purchased on June 4 and received a credit. Sold $840 (cost, $505) of merchandise to cash customers. Paid for the supplies purchased on June 7. Paid Westcoast Tire the amount due from the June 4 purchase in full. P. Haskins returned $650 (cost, $390) of merchandise from the June 9 sale. Purchased $4,800 of inventory. Paid cash. Received payment in full from P. Haskins for the June 9 sale.

Requirements Quick solution:

1. Journalize the transactions on the books of Tireboyz Tire, Inc.

2. Gross Profit for the month of June = $651

2. What was Tireboyz Tire, Inc.’s gross profit for the month of June?

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 229

03/04/14 1:52 PM

230

Chapter 4 P4-40A. Prepare a multi-step income statement; calculate gross profit percentage (Learning Objectives 6 & 7) 20–25 min. The adjusted trial balance for Great Gadget, Inc., as of April 30, 2014, is presented next:

Great Gadget, Inc. Trial Balance April 30, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Inventory Supplies Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Unearned Sales Revenue Note Payable, Long-Term Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Sales Revenue Sales Returns and Allowances Sales Discounts Cost of Goods Sold Selling Expense General Expense Interest Expense Total

DEBIT $ 10,100 31,900 20,100 2,400 75,000

CREDIT

$

6,100 6,300 2,400 15,000 40,000 43,700

41,000 221,600 3,500 3,100 98,900 32,600 16,100 400 $335,100

$335,100

Requirements 1. Prepare the multi-step income statement for April for Great Gadget, Inc. 2. Calculate the gross profit percentage for April for Great Gadget, Inc. 3. What does Great Gadget, Inc.’s gross profit percentage mean?

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 230

03/04/14 1:53 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

231

P4-41A. Prepare a multi-step income statement, a statement of retained earnings, and a classified balance sheet (Learning Objective 6) 25–30 min. The account balances for the year ended July 31, 2014, for Wilson Industries, Inc., are listed next:

Sales Revenue........................ Equipment.............................. Accounts Payable................... Sales Discounts ..................... Advertising Expense............... Interest Expense .................... Salaries Payable..................... Accounts Receivable .............. Building.................................. Sales Returns and Allowances ........................ Common Stock ...................... Depreciation Expense (General) ........................... Inventory................................ Commission Expense.............

$315,000 142,000 12,700 3,500 13,700 1,200 1,750 7,600 180,000 7,200 125,000 18,000 31,500 43,000

Cost of Goods Sold .......................... Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment................................... Unearned Sales Revenue ................. Prepaid Rent .................................... Office Salaries Expense.................... Accumulated Depreciation, Building....................................... Utilities Expense............................... Dividends ......................................... Cash................................................. Retained Earnings, 7/31/2013.......... Delivery Expense.............................. Insurance Expense........................... Mortgage Payable (Long-Term) ............................... Supplies ...........................................

$121,700 27,300 6,200 2,850 53,000 39,700 4,200 12,000 14,200 97,550 1,800 4,400 37,500 850

Requirements 1. Prepare Wilson Industries, Inc.’s multi-step income statement. 2. Prepare Wilson Industries, Inc.’s statement of retained earnings. 3. Prepare Wilson Industries, Inc.’s classified balance sheet in report form. P4-42A. Calculate earnings per share, gross profit percentage, and net income percentage (Learning Objective 7) 20–25 min. Use the data for Wilson Industries, Inc., from P4-41A. Requirements 1. Calculate the earnings per share for Wilson Industries for the year. Assume that the average number of common shares outstanding during the year was 7,500 shares. 2. The earnings per share for 2013 was $8.04. Did the earnings per share improve or deteriorate during 2014? 3. Calculate the gross profit percentage for Wilson Industries, Inc., for the year. 4. The gross profit percentage for 2013 was 58.6%. Did the gross profit percentage improve or deteriorate during 2014? 5. Calculate the net income percentage for Wilson Industries, Inc. 6. The net income percentage for 2013 was 21.3%. Did the net income percentage improve or deteriorate during 2014?

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 231

03/04/14 1:53 PM

232

Chapter 4

Problems (Group B) P4-43B. Journalizing inventory purchases, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 3 & 5) 15–20 min. The following purchase-related transactions for Penestrie, Inc., occurred during the month of June.

Jun 3 9 16 22 30 30

Purchased $7,700 of merchandise, paid cash. Purchased $650 of supplies on account from Supplies Unlimited. Terms, n/30, FOB destination. Purchased $5,600 of merchandise on account from Brown International, Inc. Terms, 2/15, n/30, FOB shipping point. Received a credit memo in the amount of $450 from Brown International, Inc., for damaged goods from the June 16 purchase that were returned. Paid for the supplies purchased on June 9. Paid Brown International, Inc., in full for the June 16 purchase.

Requirement 1. Journalize the transactions for Penestrie, Inc. Omit explanations. P4-44B. Journalizing inventory sales, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 15–20 min. The following sale-related transactions for Budget Decor, Inc., occurred during the month of April.

Apr 3 4 10 17 22 26 30

Sold $3,200 (cost $1,400) of merchandise on account to B. Levin. Terms, 1/15, n/45, FOB destination. Paid $85 to ship the goods sold on April 3 to B. Levin. Sold $2,300 (cost $1,025) of merchandise to cash customers. Received payment in full from B. Levin for the April 3 sale. Sold $4,800 (cost $2,800) of merchandise on account to A. Klecans. Terms, 2/10, n/30, FOB shipping point. Granted A. Klecans a $900 allowance on the April 22 sale due to minor defects in the goods shipped. Received payment in full from A. Klecans for the April 22 sale.

Requirement 1. Journalize the transactions for Budget Decor, Inc. Omit explanations.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 232

03/04/14 1:53 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

233

P4-45B. Journalizing inventory purchases, sales, returns, and freight transactions (Learning Objectives 3, 4, & 5) 20–25 min. The following transactions occurred between Tanaka’s Antique Furniture and R. S. Furniture Warehouse during August of the current year:

Aug 4 7 10 18 31

Tanaka's Antique Furniture purchased $7,100 of merchandise from R.S. Furniture Warehouse on account. Terms, 2/15, n/30, FOB shipping point. The goods cost R.S. Furniture Warehouse $3,900. Tanaka's Antique Furniture paid a $275 freight bill for delivery of the goods purchased on August 4. Tanaka's Antique Furniture returned $1,300 of the merchandise purchased on August 4. The goods cost R.S. Furniture Warehouse $700. Tanaka's Antique Furniture paid $1,800 of the August 4 invoice less the discount. Tanaka's Antique Furniture paid the remaining amount owed on the August 4 invoice.

Requirements 1. Journalize these transactions on the books of Tanaka’s Antique Furniture. 2. Journalize these transactions on the books of R. S. Furniture Warehouse. P4-46B. Journalizing inventory purchases, sales, returns, and freight transactions; calculate gross profit (Learning Objectives 3, 4, 5, & 6) 25–30 min. The following transactions for Bestbuy Tire, Co., occurred during November:

Nov 4 7 9 11 13 15 16 18 20 22 23

Purchased $5,100 of merchandise on account from Salem Tire. Terms, 2/15, n/45, FOB shipping point. Salem Tire prepaid the $75 shipping cost and added the amount to the invoice. Purchased $600 of supplies on account from Office Maxx. Terms, 3/10, n/30, FOB destination. Sold $1,250 (cost, $750) of merchandise on account to T. Thompson. Terms, 1/15, n/45, FOB destination. Paid $50 freight charges to deliver goods to T. Thompson. Returned $700 of the merchandise purchased on November 4 and received a credit. Sold $1,300 (cost, $780) of merchandise to cash customers. Paid for the supplies purchased on November 7. Paid Salem Tire the amount due from the November 4 purchase in full. T. Thompson returned $250 (cost, $170) of merchandise from the November 9 sale. Purchased $3,500 of inventory. Paid cash. Received payment in full from T. Thompson for the November 9 sale.

Requirements 1. Journalize the transactions on the books of Bestbuy Tire, Co. 2. What was Bestbuy Tire’s gross profit for the month of November?

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 233

03/04/14 1:53 PM

234

Chapter 4 P4-47B. Prepare a multi-step income statement; calculate gross profit percentage (Learning Objectives 6 & 7) 20–25 min. The adjusted trial balance Fresh Foods, Inc., as of November 30, 2014, is presented next:

Fresh Foods, Inc. Trial Balance November 30, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Inventory Supplies Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Accounts Payable Unearned Sales Revenue Note Payable, Long-term Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Sales Revenues Sales Returns and Allowances Sales Discounts Cost of Goods Sold Selling Expense General Expense Interest Expense Total

DEBIT $ 14,200 16,500 27,600 2,800 74,000

CREDIT

$ 13,800 6,100 4,900 35,700 35,000 28,250 45,000 214,700 3,800 4,300 102,600 25,400 20,900 1,350 $338,450

$338,450

Requirements 1. Prepare the multi-step income statement for November for Fresh Foods, Inc. 2. Calculate the gross profit percentage for November for Fresh Foods, Inc. 3. What does Fresh Foods, Inc.’s gross profit percentage mean?

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 234

03/04/14 1:53 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

235

P4-48B. Prepare a multi-step income statement, a statement of retained earnings, and a classified balance sheet (Learning Objective 6) 25–30 min. The accounts for the year ended October 31, 2014, for Ramirez Industries, Inc., are listed next:

Sales Revenue........................ Equipment.............................. Accounts Payable................... Sales Discounts ..................... Advertising Expense............... Interest Expense .................... Salaries Payable..................... Accounts Receivable .............. Building.................................. Sales Returns and Allowances ........................ Common Stock ...................... Depreciation Expense (General) ........................... Inventory................................ Commission Expense.............

$325,800 97,000 17,700 4,600 14,600 1,300 1,700 8,800 125,000 6,800 45,000 13,500 16,400 25,700

Cost of Goods Sold .......................... Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment................................... Unearned Sales Revenue ................. Prepaid Rent .................................... Office Salaries Expense.................... Accumulated Depreciation, Building....................................... Utilities Expense............................... Dividends ......................................... Cash................................................. Retained Earnings, 10/31/2013........ Delivery Expense.............................. Insurance Expense........................... Mortgage Payable (Long-Term) ............................... Supplies ...........................................

$171,600 13,000 4,100 3,500 53,200 41,300 5,300 10,000 12,200 88,250 1,400 10,200 45,000 750

Requirements 1. Prepare Ramirez Industries, Inc.’s multi-step income statement. 2. Prepare Ramirez Industries, Inc.’s statement of retained earnings. 3. Prepare Ramirez Industries, Inc.’s classified balance sheet in report form. P4-49B. Calculate earnings per share, gross profit percentage, and net income percentage (Learning Objective 7) 20–25 min. Use the data for Ramirez Industries, Inc., from P4-48B. Requirements 1. Calculate the earnings per share for Ramirez Industries for the year. Assume that the average number of common shares outstanding during the year was 5,000. 2. The earnings per share for 2013 was $3.27. Did the earnings per share improve or deteriorate during 2014? 3. Calculate the gross profit percentage for Ramirez Industries for the year. 4. The gross profit percentage for 2013 was 42.6%. Did the gross profit percentage improve or deteriorate during 2014? 5. Calculate the net income percentage for Ramirez Industries for the year. 6. The net income percentage for 2013 was 4.9%. Did the net income percentage improve or deteriorate during 2014?

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 235

03/04/14 1:53 PM

236

Chapter 4

Continuing Exercise Let’s continue our accounting for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., from Chapter 3. Starting in May, Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., has begun selling plants that it purchases from a wholesaler. During May, Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., completed the following transactions:

May 2 5 15 17 20 21 25 31

Completed lawn service and received cash of $450. Purchased 120 plants on account for inventory, $345, plus freight-in of $15. Freight-in was added to the invoice by the seller. Credit terms were n/30. Sold 30 plants on account, $215 (cost $90). Consulted with a client on landscaping design for a fee of $165 on account. Purchased 110 plants on account for inventory, $352. Paid on account, $1,900. Sold 120 plants for cash, $840 (cost $366). Recorded the following adjusting entries: Accrued salaries for the month of May equal $225 Depreciation on equipment $33 Lawn supplies used during May were $8 Physical count of plant inventory, 75 plants (cost $240)

Refer to the T-accounts for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., from the Continuing Exercise in Chapter 3. Use the ending balances on April 30 to set up T-accounts for the month of May. Requirements 1. Journalize and post the May transactions to the T-accounts. Omit explanations. Compute each account balance, and denote the balance as Bal. Open additional accounts as necessary. 2. Prepare the May income statement of Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., using the single-step format.

Continuing Problem In this problem, we continue the accounting for Aqua Magic, Inc. from Chapter 3. On August 1, Aqua Magic, Inc., expanded its business and began selling and installing ­swimming pools and spas. The post-closing trial balance for Aqua Magic, Inc., as of July 31, 2014, is presented next.

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 236

03/04/14 1:53 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

237

Aqua Magic, Inc. Trial Balance July 31, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Prepaid Rent Land Furniture Accumulated Depreciation, Furniture Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment Vehicles Accumulated Depreciation, Vehicles Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Unearned Service Revenue Notes Payable (long-term) Common Stock Retained Earnings Total

DEBIT $ 21,285 5,775 250 6,900 25,000 4,000

CREDIT

$

50

1,800 180 36,200

$101,210

420 3,590 625 1,200 36,200 55,000 3,945 $101,210

The following transactions occurred during the month of August:

Aug

2 3 5 6 8 10 11 12 13 15 16 17 19 21 22 24 25 27 28 30 31

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 237

Paid the receptionist’s salary, which was accrued on July 31. Purchased $21,500 of merchandise on account from the Tranquil Spa. Terms, 3/15, n/45, FOB shipping point. Purchased $950 of supplies. Paid cash. Paid freight charges of $475 related to the August 3 purchase. Sold a spa for $6,000 (cost, $3,500) on account to J. Nelson. Terms, 1/15, n/30, FOB shipping point. Purchased office furniture for $1,800. Paid cash. Paid advertising expense, $550. Returned a defective spa, which was purchased on August 3. Received a $3,000 credit from the Tranquil Spa. Sold a spa for $7,000 (cost, $3,450) to a cash customer. Granted J. Nelson a $400 allowance because of imperfections she detected upon receiving her spa. Paid receptionist’s salary, $625. Paid the Tranquil Spa the amount due from the August 3 purchase in full. Purchased $12,500 of inventory on account from Apex Pools. Terms, 2/10, n/30, FOB destination. Sold an above ground pool for $14,500 (cost, $9,250) on account to R. Jimenez. Terms, 2/10, n/30, FOB destination. Received payment in full from J. Nelson for the August 8 sale. Paid freight charges of $575 to have the pool sold to R. Jimenez on August 21 delivered. Purchased equipment on account from Sonic City, Inc., for $6,000. Terms, n/30, FOB destination. Received payment in full from R. Jimenez for the August 21 sale. Paid in full the invoice from the August 19 purchase from Apex Pools. Paid monthly utilities, $650. Paid sales commissions of $2,800 to the sales staff.

03/04/14 1:53 PM

238

Chapter 4 Requirements 1. Journalize the transactions that occurred in August. 2. Using the four-column accounts from the Continuing Problem in Chapter 3, post the transactions to the ledger, creating new ledger accounts as necessary; omit posting references. Calculate the new account balances. 3. Prepare the unadjusted trial balance for Aqua Magic, Inc., at August 31. 4. Journalize and post the adjusting entries for August based on the following adjustment information.   a. Record the expired rent. b. Supplies on hand, $640.   c. Depreciation; $60 equipment, $80 furniture, $475 vehicles. d. A physical count of inventory revealed $14,280 of inventory on hand. 5. Prepare an adjusted trial balance for Aqua Magic, Inc., at August 31. 6. Prepare the multi-step income statement and statement of retained earnings for the month ended August 31. Also, prepare a classified balance sheet at August 31. 7. Prepare and post closing entries. 8. Prepare a post-closing trial balance at August 31.

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem Let’s look at Target again. Think about the business of Target. Return to Target’s 2012 annual report. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem in Chapter 2. On page 33 of the annual report, you’ll find Target’s income statement for the year ending February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Operations). Now answer the following questions: 1. Look at Target’s income statement. What are Target’s sales for the past three years? Are sales increasing or decreasing compared with the previous year? 2. Look at Target’s income statement. Target had 1778 stores in 2012 and 1763 stores in 2011. What are Target’s sales per store in 2012 and 2011? (Divide total sales by the number of stores Target operated in each year.) Are sales per store ­increasing or decreasing? 3. Look at Target’s income statement. What is Target’s gross profit margin for the years ending January 28, 2012, and February 2, 2013? Is Target’s gross profit ­margin increasing or decreasing? 4. Look at footnotes 2 and 3 of the financial statements (pages 38 and 39 of the financial statements found in the 2012 annual report). How is Target accounting for sales (revenue) and costs? 5. What is Target’s net income percentage for the years ending January 28, 2012, and February 2, 2013? Is Target’s net income percentage increasing or decreasing? 6. Looking back over your answers to questions 1 through 5, how do you think Target is performing? What do you think is causing the changes in Target’s sales, costs, and margins?

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 238

03/04/14 1:53 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

239

Apply Your Knowledge Ethics in Action Case 1. Rob Peterson works as a salesperson at Consolidated Systems, Inc. In addition to a base monthly salary, Rob receives a commission that is based on the amount of sales that he makes during the month. Rob was hoping to have enough money for a down payment on a new car, but sales have been low due to a downturn in the economy. Rob was aware that Consolidated Systems, Inc., granted credit terms of 2/10, n/30 to its credit customers. In addition, Rob knew that Consolidated Systems, Inc., had a “no questions asked” return policy. Based on this knowledge, Rob had an idea. Rob contacted a regular customer and convinced the customer to make a substantial purchase of merchandise so that he could earn the commission on the sale. Rob explained to the customer that he would not have to pay for the goods for 30 days and that he could return part, or all, of the goods prior to paying for them. However, Rob asked the customer not to return any of the goods until the following month to ensure that he would earn the full commission. Requirements 1. Do you feel Rob acted unethically? Why or why not? 2. How can Consolidated Systems, Inc., deter actions like Rob’s? Case 2. Dolly Harding owns and operates Dolly Jo’s Café. Dolly has requested a credit application from LRM, Inc., a major food supplier from which she hopes to begin purchasing inventory. LRM, Inc., has requested that Dolly submit a full set of financial statements for Dolly Jo’s Café with the credit application. Dolly is concerned because the most recent balance sheet for Dolly Jo’s Café reflects a current ratio of 1.24. Dolly has heard that most creditors like to see a current ratio that is 1.5 or higher. In order to increase Dolly Jo’s Café’s current ratio, Dolly has convinced her parents to loan the business $25,000 on an 18-month long-term note payable. Dolly’s parents are apprehensive about having their money “tied up” for over a year. Dolly reassured them that even though the note is an 18-month note, Dolly Jo’s Café can, and probably will, repay the $25,000 sooner. Requirements 1. Discuss the ethical issues related to the loan from Dolly’s parents? 2. Why do you think creditors like to see current ratios of 1.5 or higher?

Know Your Business Financial Analysis Purpose: To help familiarize you with the financial reporting of a real company in order to further your understanding of the chapter material. This case uses both the income statement (statement of operations) and the balance sheet of Columbia Sportswear in Appendix A at the end of the book. Requirements 1. What income statement format does Columbia Sportswear use? How can you tell? 2. Calculate the gross profit percentage for Columbia Sportswear for 2010, 2011, and 2012. Has the gross profit percentage been improving or deteriorating? 3. Calculate the net income percentage for Columbia Sportswear for 2010, 2011, and 2012. Has the net income percentage improved or deteriorated? 4. Does Columbia Sportswear report a classified balance sheet? How can you tell?

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 239

03/04/14 1:53 PM

240

Chapter 4

Industry Analysis Purpose: To help you understand and compare the performance of two companies in the same industry. Find the Columbia Sportswear Company Annual Report located in Appendix A, and go to the financial statements starting on page 690. Now access the 2012 Annual Report for Under Armour, Inc., from the Internet. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Industry Analysis in Chapter 1. The company’s financial statements start on page 48. Which of these companies would be considered to be merchandising businesses? If your answer was “both companies are merchandising businesses,” you would be correct. But how did you know that? If you didn’t know anything about either of these two companies (maybe you’re already familiar with them through their advertising campaigns), how would you know that they are merchandising businesses? Can you tell that by looking at the consolidated balance sheets for both companies? What about the consolidated statements of income (or operations)? Which accounts on these two financial statements tell you that these companies are merchandising businesses?

Small Business Analysis Purpose: To help you understand the importance of cash flows in the operation of a small business. The end of the year is approaching. You’re going to meet with your CPA next week to do some end-of-the-year tax planning, so in preparation for that meeting, you look at your last month’s income statement. You know that you’ve had a pretty good year, which means that you’re going to have to pay some income taxes. But you know if you can get your taxable income down, you won’t have to pay as much in income taxes. You remember that one of your suppliers was offering a pretty good discount if you purchased from the company in bulk. The only problem is you have to pay for the purchases at the time of purchase. Knowing that you want to decrease your taxable income, you call up the supplier, place a large order, and write the supplier a check. At your meeting with the CPA, you tell her of the large inventory purchase for cash that you just made and how much income tax that will save you on this year’s income tax return. The CPA has a rather troubled look on her face; that look usually means you’ve made some kind of an error. So you pose this question to her: “Trish, you got that look on your face right after I told you about the big inventory purchase that I made. Even though I used up a lot of my available cash, the reason I did it was to save money on my tax return. A big purchase like that has to knock down my taxable income pretty good, huh? And besides, I got these products for a really good price, which means I’ll make more profit when I sell them. So why do you have that look? Did I mess up?” Requirement 1. If you were the CPA, how would you respond to this client? Is the large inventory purchase going to have any effect on his income statement? What about the fact that he paid for this large purchase in cash? Was it a good idea to use a large portion of available cash for a purchase like this? Keeping in mind that inventory can have a significant amount of carrying cost (storage, personnel, opportunity cost of the money, etc.), would you tell your client that he acted wisely or not?

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 240

03/04/14 1:53 PM

Accounting for a Merchandising Business

241

Written Communication You just received a letter from one of your good customers complaining about the shipment of your product that she just received. Football season is approaching, and the customer had ordered a large shipment of regulation-size footballs. Instead, she received youth-size footballs for half of the order. The customer is asking you what can be done about this mistake. Knowing that this client is located halfway across the country, it’s not feasible to just have her drop by your facility and trade out the footballs. The customer also had a question about a line item on her invoice under shipping terms. It said “FOB Destination” and the customer noticed that she was charged freight, which the customer normally doesn’t have to pay. The customer wants to know if that is correct. Requirement 1. Write a letter to your customer explaining how you intend to handle this purchase return or this purchase allowance (you choose which one you’re going to do). Explain the accounting forms that will need to be prepared to document this transaction. Also address the customer’s concern about the shipping terms. Self Check Answers 1. d 2. a 3. d 4. d 5. b 6. a 7. a 8. b 9. c 10. b 11. c 12. b

M04_KEMP9543_03_GE_C04.indd 241

03/04/14 1:53 PM

5 Inventory Business, Accounting, and You Learning Objectives 1 Describe the four different inventory costing methods

2 Compute inventory costs u­ sing first-in, first-out (FIFO), last-in, first-out (LIFO), and average cost methods and journalize inventory transactions

3 Compare the effects of the different costing methods on the financial statements

Walk down the aisles of a Toys R Us®. Look at all the products. There are dolls, bicycles, video games, crafts, and much more. There are thousands of items of inventory. Now blink. What happened? The inventory changed. Customers are constantly buying and removing inventory from Toys R Us. Employees are constantly restocking inventory with new items. Inventory is at the heart of operating a merchandise business. Businesses like Toys R Us purchase inventory hoping that customers will buy it at a price above the cost to the business. If this occurs, the business earns net income, if it can cover operating expenses. If this does not occur, the business incurs a net loss. Inventory is important and is at the center of creating a return by taking risks. Now ask yourself: How does Toys R Us keep up with its inventory? Who counts the inventory? How does Toys R Us figure out the cost of all the items sold? How does Toys R Us determine the cost of the items that it owns and hopes to sell in the

4 Value inventory using the lower-of-cost-or-market (LCM) rule

5 Illustrate the reporting of inventory in the financial statements

6 Determine the effect of inventory errors on the financial statements

7 Use the gross profit method to estimate ending inventory

8 Compute the ­inventory turnover and days-sales-in-inventory 242

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 242

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

243

future? These concerns are complicated when prices constantly change. Toys R Us must have a method to account for the quantity and cost of the thousands of items it buys, owns, and sells. Business is about earning net income. Net income is revenues less costs. How a business accounts for the cost of the items it buys and sells is very important. As an accountant or manager, you need to understand how merchandising businesses recognize, measure, record, and report the cost of inventory. It’s all about the scorecard of business and figuring out whether the merchandise business is winning or losing; that is, if the business is making a profit or loss.

Real World Accounting Video In the Real World Accounting Video, Keith Beavers, owner and operator of ABC Wines, talks about what it means to operate a business. Look at the video. Think about what Keith is saying. Now realize how important accounting is to the success of a business.

What Inventory Costing Methods Are Allowed? 1

Describe the four different inventory costing methods

Finished goods  Inventory of goods ready to sell. Raw materials  Inventory items used in the production of goods. Work in process  Inventory of partially completed goods.

Specific-identification Inventory costing method in which a business uses the specific cost of each unit of inventory; also called the specific-unit-cost method.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 243

As discussed in Chapter 4, merchandise inventory represents the goods that a merchandiser has available to sell to its customers. A manufacturer also has goods it holds for sale to its customers. These goods are called finished goods inventory. In addition, a manufacturer maintains two other types of inventory: raw materials inventory, which it uses to produce the goods it sells, and work in process inventory, which represents partially completed goods. In other words, work in process inventory represents goods that are in the process of becoming finished goods. A more detailed discussion of the inventory accounts of a manufacturer will be left to a managerial or cost accounting course. In this chapter, we focus on managing and accounting for inventory in merchandise businesses. Inventory represents a key asset for a merchandiser and is probably the business’s largest current asset. Recall from Chapter 4 that most companies utilize a perpetual inventory system. Under a perpetual system, the cost of goods purchased is added to the Inventory a­ ccount in the general ledger when goods are purchased. When the goods are sold, the cost of the goods is removed from the Inventory account and added to the Cost of Goods Sold ­account. Most merchandisers purchase large quantities of identical items. Due to inflation and other market forces, the cost the merchandiser pays for the items often differs from one purchase to the next. This raises an important accounting dilemma. If the goods are identical, but have different costs, how does the business know which costs to remove from the Inventory account and transfer to Cost of Goods Sold when the ­merchandise is sold? According to Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP), a business can assign costs using one of four different inventory costing methods. The four costing methods allowed by GAAP are: 1. Specific-identification method—Assumes that the cost assigned to an inventory item when it is sold is the actual cost paid for that item. Therefore, the Cost of Goods Sold represents the actual cost of the items that were sold. Also, the Ending Inventory represents the actual cost of the goods remaining in inventory. Under

03/04/14 1:55 PM

244

Chapter 5

First-in, first-out (FIFO) Inventory costing method in which the first inventory costs incurred are the first costs to be assigned to cost of goods sold. FIFO leaves in ending inventory the last, most recent costs incurred.

Last-in, first-out (LIFO) Inventory costing method in which the last inventory costs incurred are the first costs to be assigned to cost of goods sold. LIFO leaves in ending ­inventory the first, oldest costs incurred. Average cost  Inventory costing method where, after each purchase of inventory, a new weighted average cost per unit is computed and is used to value ending inventory and cost of goods sold.

specific-identification, the cost flow of the goods through the accounting records will exactly match the physical flow of the goods through the business. This method is also called the specific-unit-cost method. 2. First-in, first-out (FIFO) method—Assumes that the earliest inventory costs are assigned to items as they are sold. The Cost of Goods Sold represents the oldest costs incurred to purchase inventory items. The Ending Inventory represents the most recent costs incurred to purchase inventory items. Under FIFO, the cost flow of the goods through the accounting records will closely match the physical flow of the goods through the business. 3. Last-in, first-out (LIFO) method—Assumes that the most recent inventory costs are assigned to items as they are sold. The Cost of Goods Sold represents the ­latest costs incurred to purchase inventory items. The Ending Inventory represents the earliest costs incurred to purchase inventory. Under LIFO, the cost flow of the goods through the accounting records will be nearly opposite of the physical flow of the goods through the business. 4. Average cost method—Assumes that a weighted-average cost per item of the entire inventory purchased is assigned to items as they are sold. Both the Cost of Goods Sold and the Ending Inventory represent an average of the cost incurred to purchase inventory items. Under the average cost method, the Cost of Goods Sold and the Ending Inventory will fall between the amounts arrived at using FIFO and LIFO assuming that costs are steadily rising or falling.

Accounting in Your World

Does this taste funny to you?

Jill was at the grocery store the other day picking up a gallon of milk when she started thinking about LIFO, which she had been learning about in her accounting class. It did not make sense to her that any company would want to use LIFO. After all, she reasoned, if the grocery store used LIFO, it would be selling milk that it just purchased first, which would leave older milk on the shelves. Jill wonders how she can be sure that the gallon of milk she took off the shelf is fresh and not one that has been on the shelf for weeks or even months. Jill is confusing the flow of costs through the accounting records with the physical flow of inventory through a store. LIFO refers to the flow of costs through the accounting records and not to the physical flow of goods. The flow of costs through the accounting records can match, or be exactly opposite of, the physical flow of goods through a store. Jill can rest assured that even if the store uses LIFO, her milk is likely to be fresh.

Cost Flow Versus Physical Flow of Inventory The inventory costing method (FIFO, LIFO, etc.) refers to the flow of costs through a merchandiser’s accounting records rather than to the physical flow of the goods through the business. The physical flow of the goods through the business will

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 244

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

Inventory layer  A record of the quantity of and the cost of inventory items made in a single purchase.

245

depend on how the goods are stocked and in what order customers, or employees, remove the goods from the shelves when they are sold. The flow of the costs through the accounting records will depend upon which inventory costing method the business chooses. Imagine that every inventory item that is purchased has a “yellow sticky note” attached to it with the price that was paid for the item written on the “sticky note.” Next, assume that when the business receives a shipment of inventory items, the “sticky notes” reflecting the cost of the items are removed from each item and given to the Accounting Department. The Accounting Department will keep track of the “sticky notes” for each separate purchase in what is referred to as an inventory layer. The quantity purchased of each item along with the purchase price is tracked as an inventory layer for every separate purchase. The physical inventory will most likely be managed in a manner that causes the oldest inventory to be sold first followed by more recent purchases and so on. The physical flow of the inventory is maintained in this manner to prevent inventory items from spoiling if they are perishable or to prevent having items that look outdated should the manufacturer choose to change the packaging. The Accounting Department calculates the cost flow of the inventory without any consideration of the actual physical flow of the merchandise (unless the specific-identification inventory method is used). The Accounting Department only needs to know how many units were sold, not which units were sold. The Accounting Department then applies the cost flow method (FIFO, LIFO, etc.) to the inventory layers that it has recorded. In other words, the inventory costs are assigned based on the layers of “sticky notes.” Exhibit 5-1 demonstrates the difference between cost flow and physical flow.

Gallons of milk are placed in dairy case

Purchase #1 Six Gallons at $1.75 each

1.75

1.75

1.75

ed

1.75

1.75

c pla

1.75

ns

Purchase #2 Four Gallons at $2.00 each

o all

G

of

m

ilk

in

y air

se

ca

d

Dairy Department sells the are A Sti oldest milk first to ensure fresh cco ck un y no product for customers. tin te gD sg o ep art to me Accounting Department nt Layer One 1.75 1.75 1.75

2.00

2.00

2.00

2.00

Sticky notes go to Accounting Department

1.75 1.75 1.75

Layer Two 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00

Accounting Department uses the inventory layers to assign costs to the gallons sold based on the inventory costing method chosen.

Exhibit 5-1

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 245

03/04/14 1:55 PM

246

Chapter 5

Stop and Think… James Washington has decided to open a produce business named Prime Produce, Inc. Because produce spoils quickly, James wants to sell the oldest produce first so that it doesn’t spoil while sitting on the shelves. Does Prime Produce, Inc., have to use FIFO as its inventory costing method?

Answer

No. Remember that the inventory costing method refers to the flow of the inventory costs through the company’s accounting records, not to the physical flow of the inventory items through the business. The flow of costs through the accounting records may be the same as, closely follow, or be totally opposite of the physical flow of the inventory items through the business.

How Are the Four Inventory Costing Methods Applied? Inventory Cost Flows 2

Compute inventory costs using first-in, first-out (FIFO), last-in, first-out (LIFO), and average cost methods and journalize inventory transactions

Recall from Chapter 4 that, in a perpetual inventory system, purchases of goods for resale increase the balance of the Inventory account, while sales of goods to customers decrease the account. The Inventory account also reflects purchase discounts, purchase returns and allowances, and shipping costs related to the purchase of goods

Inventory Bal Purchases Shipping Costs Bal

Cost of goods available for sale  The cost of inventory on hand at the beginning of the period plus the net cost of inventory purchased during the period.

XX XX Purchase Discounts XX Purchase Returns and Allowances Sales XX

XX XX XX

The cost of the inventory flows through the Inventory account as items are purchased and sold. The cost of the units on hand in inventory at the beginning of the period is added to the net cost of units purchased for the period to determine the cost of goods available for sale. The objective of tracking the inventory cost is to allocate the cost of the goods available for sale between the following: • Units sold, which is recorded as Cost of Goods Sold and is subtracted from net sales revenue on the income statement to arrive at gross profit • Units on hand, or unsold, which is reflected as Ending Inventory, a current asset on the balance sheet Let’s follow the September inventory activity for ski parkas sold by Northwest Outfitters, Inc., assuming the following: Sep 1 5 15 26 30 30

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 246

One parka costing $40 is on hand, unsold from the previous month. Purchased six parkas for $45 each. Sold four parkas for $80 each. Purchased seven parkas for $50 each. Sold eight parkas for $80 each. Two parkas are on hand, unsold.

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

247

During September, Northwest Outfitters had 14 parkas available for sale: 1 unit on hand in beginning inventory, plus 13 units purchased during the month. The cost of goods available for sale for Northwest Outfitters would be calculated as follows:

Beginning Inventory  Purchases

(1 @ $40)  $ 40 (6 @ $45) $270 620 (7 @ $50) 350  Cost of Goods Available for Sale $660 Of the 14 parkas available for sale, Northwest sold 12 parkas and still had 2 parkas on hand in ending inventory at the end of the month. What would be the cost of the goods sold for the month and the ending inventory balance for that month? The answer depends on which inventory costing method Northwest Outfitters elects to use. Exhibit 5-2 illustrates the objective of calculating inventory costs for Northwest Outfitters. Beginning Inventory 1  $40 Cost of Goods Sold 12  ?  ? Purchases 6  $45 7  $50

Assign Costs

Sum of Cost of Goods Sold and Ending Inventory must equal Cost of Goods Available for Sale.

Ending Inventory 2?? Cost of Goods Available for Sale  $660

Exhibit 5-2 As we shall see, the various inventory costing methods produce different values for ending inventory and cost of goods sold.

Specific-Identification Method The specific-identification method is also called the specific-unit-cost method. This method values inventory according to the specific cost of each item of inventory. This method is used predominately by businesses that sell unique items with very different costs. Some examples are businesses that sell automobiles, houses, and artwork. For ­instance, an automobile dealer may have two vehicles on its car lot, a “basic” model that costs $22,000 and a “fully equipped” model that costs $29,000. Accordingly, the sales price of the basic model would be less than the sales price for the fully equipped model. It would not make sense for the dealer to assign the cost of the fully equipped model to the basic model when the basic model is sold. This would cause gross profit to be inaccurately stated because the higher cost of the fully equipped model would be subtracted from the lower selling price of the basic model. The dealer would want to specifically identify which model it sold and assign the actual cost of that model to the cost of goods sold. In order to utilize the specific-identification method, each inventory item must be able to be distinguished from other items with some identifying mark such as a serial number. Because the specific-identification method of inventory valuation is not widely used, we will focus on the more popular inventory costing methods. Let’s see how to compute inventory amounts using the FIFO, LIFO, and average cost methods for Northwest Outfitters.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 247

03/04/14 1:55 PM

248

Chapter 5

First-In, First-Out (FIFO) Method

Perpetual inventory record  A record that tracks the quantity of, and cost assigned to, inventory items as they are purchased and sold.

Assume that Northwest Outfitters uses the FIFO method to account for its inventory. Under FIFO, the first inventory costs incurred by Northwest each period are the first costs to be assigned to cost of goods sold. Simply put, FIFO assumes that the first inventory items Northwest purchased are the first inventory items it sold. In order to track inventory costs efficiently, a perpetual inventory record is often utilized. The perpetual inventory record maintains the detail supporting the quantity of, and costs assigned to, the inventory items as they are purchased and sold. It also maintains a running balance of the inventory on hand. When preparing the perpetual inventory record, it is critical that the inventory “layers” are kept in the proper order. An inventory layer consists of the quantity of inventory and its purchase cost. Exhibit 5-3 illustrates the FIFO perpetual inventory record for Northwest Outfitters, while Exhibit 5-4 illustrates the flow of costs using FIFO.

Parkas

Date Sep 1

Purchases Unit Total Quantity Cost Cost

6

5

$45

$270

1 3

15

7

26

$50

$620

13

$40 $45

$ 40 $135

$350

30 30

Cost of Goods Sold Unit Total Quantity Cost Cost

3 5 12

$45 $50

$135 $250 $560

Inventory on Hand Unit Total Quantity Cost Cost 1 $40 $ 40 1 6

$40 $45

$ 40 $270

3

$45

$135

3 7

$45 $50

$135 $350

2 2

$50

$100 $100

Exhibit 5-3

$40 $45

$45

$45

$45

$45

$45

$50

$50

$50

$50

$50

$50

Sep 15 Sales 1  $40  $ 40 3  $45  135 $175

To Cost of Goods Sold $50

Sep 30 Sales 3  $45  $135 5  $50  250 385 Total $560

Ending Inventory  $100

Exhibit 5-4

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 248

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

249

Northwest began September with one parka that cost $40. After the September 5 purchase, the inventory on hand consists of seven units: one at $40 plus six at $45. On September 15, Northwest sold four units. Under FIFO, the cost of the first unit sold is the oldest cost, $40 per unit. The next three units sold come from the layer that cost $45 per unit. That leaves three units in inventory on hand, and these units cost $45 each. The remainder of the perpetual inventory record is completed in the same manner. The FIFO monthly summary on September 30 is as follows: • Cost of Goods Sold: 12 units that cost a total of $560 • Ending Inventory: 2 units that cost a total of $100 Look for these amounts in the last row of the perpetual inventory record in Exhibit 5-3 as well as in Exhibit 5-4. If Northwest uses the FIFO method, it will use these amounts for the cost of goods sold and ending inventory in its financial statements. Notice that the sum of the cost of goods sold plus ending inventory equals the cost of goods available for sale, $660 ($560 + $100).

Last-In, First-Out (LIFO) Method Now, imagine that Northwest uses the LIFO method instead of FIFO. Under the LIFO method, the last, most recent costs incurred are the first costs assigned to the cost of goods sold. Accordingly, LIFO assumes that the last inventory items purchased are the first inventory items sold. The ending inventory’s cost comes from the oldest, earliest purchases of the inventory. Remember, LIFO costing does not follow the actual physical flow of goods for most companies. LIFO is simply a method of assigning costs to the physical units that were sold. The LIFO method perpetual inventory record for Northwest Outfitters is presented in Exhibit 5-5. Exhibit 5-6 illustrates the assignment of costs using LIFO.

Parkas

Date Sep 1

Purchases Unit Total Quantity Cost Cost

5

6

$45

$270

4

15

26

7

$50

7 1 13

$45

$180

$350

30

30

Cost of Goods Sold Unit Total Quantity Cost Cost

$620

12

$50 $45

$350 $ 45 $575

Inventory on Hand Unit Total Quantity Cost Cost $ 40 1 $40 1 6

$40 $45

$ 40 $270

1 2

$40 $45

$ 40 $ 90

1 2 7

$40 $45 $50

$ 40 $ 90 $350

1 1 2

$40 $45

$ 40 $ 45 $ 85

Exhibit 5-5

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 249

03/04/14 1:55 PM

250

Chapter 5

$40 $45

$45

$45

$45

$45

$45

$50

$50

$50

$50

$50

$50

To Cost of Goods Sold $50

Sep 15 Sales 4  $45 

$180

Sep 30 Sales 7  $50  $350 1  $45  45 Total

$395 $575

Note: The seven parkas @ $50 were not available for sale until after the September 26 purchase. Ending Inventory  $85

Exhibit 5-6

Again, Northwest had one parka at the beginning of September. After the purchase on September 5, Northwest holds seven units of inventory: one at $40 plus six at $45. Northwest then sells four units on September 15. Under LIFO, the cost of goods sold always comes from the latest purchase. That leaves three parkas in inventory on September 15: one at $40 plus two at $45. The purchase of seven units on September 26 adds a new $50 layer to inventory. Then the sale of eight units on September 30 removes units from inventory in LIFO order. The LIFO monthly summary on September 30 is as follows: • Cost of Goods Sold: 12 units that cost a total of $575 • Ending Inventory: 2 units that cost a total of $85 These amounts can be seen in the last row of the perpetual inventory record in Exhibit 5-5 as well as in Exhibit 5-6. If Northwest uses the LIFO method, it will use these amounts for the cost of goods sold and ending inventory in its financial statements. Notice that the sum of cost of goods sold and ending inventory still equals the cost of goods available for sale, $660 ($575 + $85).

Average Cost Method Suppose Northwest Outfitters uses the average cost method to account for its inventory of parkas. With this method, the business computes a new, weighted-average cost per unit after each purchase based on the number of items purchased at each price. Ending inventory and cost of goods sold are then based on the average cost per unit. Exhibit 5-7 shows a perpetual inventory record for the average cost method. We round average unit cost to the nearest cent and total cost to the nearest dollar.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 250

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

251

Parkas

Date Sep 1 5 15 26 30 30

Purchases Unit Total Quantity Cost Cost 6

$45

$270

7

$50

$350

13

$620

Cost of Goods Sold Unit Total Quantity Cost Cost

4

$44.29 $177

8 12

$48.30 $386 $563

Inventory on Hand Unit Total Quantity Cost Cost 1 $40.00 $ 40 7 $44.29 $310 3 $44.29 $133 10 $48.30 $483 2 $48.30 $ 97 $ 97 2

Exhibit 5-7

The average unit cost on September 5 is based on the cost of the unit on hand at the beginning of September plus the cost of the six units purchased on September 5:

Sep 1 5 Total

Beginning Inventory Purchase

Number of Units

Unit Cost

Total Cost

1 6 7

$40 $45

$ 40 $270 $310

Total Cost of Inventory on Hand  Number of Units on Hand  Average Cost per Unit $310

7 Units

$44.29

The four items sold on September 15 are assigned a cost of $44.29 per unit, and the remaining three units are carried forward at a cost of $44.29 each. Northwest then computes a new average cost after the September 26 purchase in the same manner. The average cost monthly summary on September 30 is as follows: • Cost of Goods Sold: 12 units that cost a total of $563 • Ending Inventory: 2 units that cost a total of $97 Once again, these amounts can be seen in the last row of the perpetual inventory record presented in Exhibit 5-7. If Northwest uses the average cost method, it will use these amounts to prepare its financial statements. Yet again, the sum of the cost of goods sold and ending inventory equals the cost of goods available for sale, $660 ($563 + $97).

Journalizing Inventory Transactions The journal entries to record the inventory transactions for Northwest Outfitters for the month of September are presented in Exhibit 5-8 using the following information: • All purchases and sales in September were made on account. • The sales price of a parka charged to a customer was $80.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 251

03/04/14 1:55 PM

252

Chapter 5

FIFO DATE Sep 5

Purchase inventory on account (six parkas @ $45 each)

15

Sold four parkas for $80 each

Purchased inventory on account (seven parkas @ $50 each)

26

30

Sold eight parkas for $80 each

ACCOUNTS Inventory Accounts Payable

DR. 270

Accounts Receivable Sales Revenue

320

Cost of Goods Sold Inventory

175

Inventory Accounts Payable

350

Accounts Receivable Sales Revenue

640

Cost of Goods Sold Inventory

385

LIFO CR.

DR. 270

270

CR. 270

320 320

320 320

180 175

320 177

180 350

350

177 350

350 640

640

350 640

640 395

385

AVERAGE COST DR. CR. 270 270

640 386

395

386

Exhibit 5-8 Notice that the journal entries to record the purchases of inventory on account are the same, regardless of the costing method chosen. The differences occur in the second part of the sales entries that removes the cost of the parkas sold from the inventory account and transfers it to cost of goods sold.

What Effect Do the Different Costing Methods Have on Net Income? 3

Compare the effects of the different costing methods on the financial statements

The choice of inventory costing method often has an effect on the amount of net income a company reports on its income statement. Exhibit 5-9 compares the FIFO, LIFO, and average cost methods of costing inventory assuming that, over time, inventory costs are increasing. As you can see, different

Inventory Costing Method

Description

Benefit

First-In, First-Out (FIFO)

Cost of goods sold has older, lower costs. Ending inventory has the newer, higher costs.

Most closely matches actual flow of goods in most cases. Maximizes net income. Use method to attract investors or borrow money.

Last-In, First-Out (LIFO)

Cost of goods sold has newer, higher costs. Ending inventory has the older, lower costs.

Minimizes net income and income taxes and minimizes ending inventory. Use method to reduce income taxes and cash needed to pay taxes.

Average Cost

Averages costs in ending inventory and cost of goods sold.

A “middle-ground solution” for reporting net income and ending inventory and paying income taxes.

Exhibit 5-9

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 252

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

253

methods have different benefits. FIFO is the most popular inventory costing method, followed by LIFO, and then by average cost. Exhibit 5-10 summarizes the results of the three inventory methods as used for Northwest Outfitters. It shows Sales Revenue, Cost of Goods Sold, and Gross Profit for FIFO, LIFO, and average cost. The Cost of Goods Sold data comes from Exhibits 5-3, 5-5, and 5-7.

Sales Revenue [(4  8)  $80] Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit

FIFO $960 560 $400

LIFO $960 575 $385

Average Cost $960 563 $397

Exhibit 5-10

Consistency principle  Accounting principle that states that a business should use the same ­accounting methods and procedures from period to period.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 253

Exhibit 5-10 shows that FIFO produces the lowest cost of goods sold and the highest gross profit. Net income is also the highest under FIFO when inventory costs are rising. Many companies choose this method when they want to report high income in order to attract investors and borrow on attractive terms. LIFO results in the highest cost of goods sold and, therefore, the lowest gross profit when inventory costs are increasing. Lower gross profit results in lower net income and lower income taxes. A drawback to using LIFO when inventory costs are rising is that the company reports lower net income. The average cost method generates gross profit, net income, and income tax amounts that fall between the extremes of FIFO and LIFO. Therefore, companies that seek a “middle-ground” solution choose the average cost method for valuing inventory. Based upon the previous information, it appears that a business could “manage its income” by switching back and forth between costing methods depending upon the circumstances. This is not the case due to the consistency principle mandated by GAAP. The consistency principle states that businesses should use the same accounting methods and procedures from period to period. The consistency principle does not mean that a company can never change its accounting methods, for instance changing from the LIFO to FIFO inventory valuation method, but that it can only do so if it can justify the change. Also, any changes in accounting methods must be disclosed to the financial statement users. Suppose you are analyzing a company’s net income pattern over a two-year period and costs are rising. If the company switched from LIFO to FIFO during that time, its net income likely increased significantly. The problem is that much, if not all, of the increase in income could be the result of the change in inventory method. If you were unaware of the change, you might believe that the company’s income increased because of improved operations. Therefore, companies must report any changes in the accounting methods they use and they generally must retrospectively apply the impact of the change as an adjustment to beginning retained earnings, unless it is impractical to do so. Consistency helps investors compare a company’s financial statements from one period to the next and make better decisions.

03/04/14 1:55 PM

254

Chapter 5

Try It… Anderson’s Outdoor Equipment, Inc., has recently opened for business. The owners are trying to determine which inventory costing method to choose. They would like to pay the least amount of income taxes possible. Which inventory method will allow Anderson’s Outdoor Equipment, Inc., to pay the least amount of taxes?

Answer

It depends on whether the cost of inventory is expected to increase or decrease during the period. If inventory costs are expected to increase, Anderson’s Outdoor Equipment, Inc., should choose LIFO. However, if inventory costs are expected to decrease, Anderson’s Outdoor Equipment, Inc., should choose FIFO. If inventory costs are expected to remain constant, the choice of inventory costing method will have no effect on the net income for the period.

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analyze

Which inventory costing method should a company choose?

The physical and cost flow of the inventory can differ. The choice of inventory method depends on the type of inventory being sold, whether inventory costs are rising or declining, and whether you want to report higher or lower net income.

A company should choose: Specific-identification method when it sells unique items with varying costs. FIFO if inventory costs are rising and the company wants to report higher net income. FIFO if inventory costs are declining and the company wants to report the lowest net income. LIFO if inventory costs are rising and the company wants to report the lowest net income. LIFO if inventory costs are declining and the company wants to report the highest net income. Average cost method if costs are continually fluctuating and the company wants to stabilize net income.

What Else Determines How Inventory Is Valued? 4

Value inventory using the lower-of-cost-or-market (LCM) rule

Conservatism  Accounting principle that states that a business must report all items in the financial statements at amounts that lead to the most cautious immediate results.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 254

Another important accounting principle is the principle of conservatism. Conservatism in accounting means reporting items in the financial statements at amounts that lead to the most cautious immediate results. A conservative approach will mean that, when there are two reasonable options present, the option should be chosen that causes assets and income to be understated, rather than overstated. A conservative approach will also mean that liabilities and expenses are overstated, rather than understated. The goal is for financial statements to report figures that minimize the risk of overstating the company’s assets and understating liabilities.

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

Lower-of-cost-or-market (LCM) rule  The rule that a business must report inventory in the financial statements at whichever is lower, the historical cost or the market value, of each inventory item.

255

Merchandisers are often faced with a situation where the cost of replacing an inventory item is lower than what was originally paid for the item. In order to take a conservative approach when these situations arise, businesses will apply the lower-ofcost-or-market (LCM) rule. The LCM rule requires businesses to report inventory in the financial statements at whichever is lower, the amount originally paid (the historical cost) or the replacement cost (the current market value) of each inventory item. If the replacement cost of inventory is less than its historical cost, a company writes down the inventory value by decreasing inventory and increasing cost of goods sold. In this way, net income is decreased in the period in which the decrease in the market value of the inventory occurred. Let’s look at the process of valuing inventory according to the lower-of-cost-ormarket rule for the inventory in Exhibit 5-11. • Prepare a table listing each inventory item, its quantity, unit cost, and unit market value. • Calculate the total cost and total market value for each item. Inventory Item 122A, for example, has a total cost of $2,000 (40 units × $50 cost per unit) and a total market value of $2,080 (40 units × $52 market value per unit). • Place the lower of the cost or market value for each item in the “Lower of Cost or Market” column. Item 122A would have a value of $2,000. • Add the amounts in each column to obtain the total cost, total market value, and total lower-of-cost-or-market amounts. • Adjust the inventory balance to reflect the lower-of-cost-or-market amount. The total cost is $14,800 and the total LCM amount is $14,425, so a journal entry is made to reduce the inventory amount by the difference of $375 ($14,800 – $14,425).

Total Inventory Item 122A 1587L 394CZ

Inventory Quantity 40 75 68

Unit Cost $ 50 $ 80 $100

Unit Market Value Cost $ 52 $ 2,000 $ 75 6,000 $101 6,800 $14,800

Market $ 2,080 5,625 6,868 $14,573

Lower of Cost or Market $ 2,000 5,625 6,800 $14,425

Exhibit 5-11

Materiality  Accounting principle that states that a company must perform strictly proper accounting only for items that are significant for the business’s financial statements. Information is significant, or material, when its presentation in the financial statements would cause someone to change a decision.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 255

The application of LCM is actually more complex than is demonstrated in Exhibit 5-11; however, more in-depth coverage will be left to a more advanced accounting course. The LCM rule may be applied to inventory on an item-by-item basis as in Exhibit 5-11, to broad categories of items, or to the entire inventory taken as a whole. Application of the LCM rule is a continuation of the process of valuing inventory. Businesses will record inventory transactions, assigning a cost to each inventory item sold using the specificidentification, FIFO, LIFO, or average cost method. Then, at the end of the accounting period, they will apply the LCM rule to the ending inventory. In this way, businesses report conservative values for inventory and net income. Most businesses will report inventory on the balance sheet at the lower-of-cost-ormarket value; however, others will use the concept of materiality to decide whether inventory needs to be written down to its current replacement cost. The materiality concept states that a company must perform strictly proper accounting only for items that have a material effect on the company’s financial statements. An item is considered to have a material effect when it would cause someone to change a decision; stated differently, a material amount is one large enough to make a difference to a user of the financial statements. For example, if the lower-of-cost-or-market comparison in Exhibit 5-11 resulted in a

03/04/14 1:55 PM

256

Chapter 5

difference between total cost and total LCM of $3, the company would have been appropriate in ignoring any adjustment to inventory for the $3. So, the materiality concept frees ­accountants from having to report every account in strict accordance with GAAP, while still reporting items properly.

How Is Inventory Reported on the Balance Sheet? 5

Illustrate the reporting of inventory in the financial statements

Full-disclosure principle Accounting principle that states that a company’s financial statements should report enough information for users to make knowledgeable decisions about the company. Footnotes  Disclosures that accompany the financial statements.

Inventory is reported as a current asset and is often listed after receivables on the balance sheet. In addition to showing the inventory amount, a business must disclose the costing method used to value inventory (specific-identification, FIFO, LIFO, or average cost) and the application of LCM. This disclosure helps a business adhere to the full-disclosure principle. The full-disclosure principle requires that a company’s financial statements report enough information for outsiders to make knowledgeable decisions about the company. To provide this information, accountants typically include a set of footnotes that accompany the financial statements. Footnote disclosures help ensure that companies report relevant, reliable, and comparable financial information. A common footnote related to inventory would look like this: NOTE 2: Statement of Significant Accounting Policies: Inventory. Inventory is carried at the lower of cost or market. Cost is determined using the first-in, first-out method.

Suppose a banker is comparing two companies, one using LIFO and the other FIFO. When inventory costs are rising, the company using the FIFO inventory costing method reports higher net income, but only because it uses FIFO. Without knowledge of the accounting methods the companies are using, the banker could lend money to the wrong business or lend the wrong amount of money to each.

Inventory Shrinkage

Inventory shrinkage  The loss of inventory.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 256

The perpetual inventory method keeps a continuous record of the inventory on hand at all times. However, the actual amount of inventory on hand may differ from the amount on hand according to the accounting records due to errors in recording inventory-related transactions or due to inventory shrinkage. Inventory shrinkage represents a loss of inventory. Inventory shrinkage is most often the result of employee theft, customer theft, and the damage, spillage, or spoilage of inventory items. A physical inventory count is used to determine the amount of inventory actually on hand at the end of the accounting period. A number of commonly used procedures help ensure the accuracy of the count. A count usually occurs when the store is closed. Individuals assigned to the count can use maps of inventory locations, pre-numbered count sheets, and ink pens and may count in pairs. The count may also involve prewritten inventory instructions and tags to identify merchandise to be counted and is typically supervised. To save time and increase objectivity for the count, an outside inventory-taking firm may be used to take counts instead of, or in addition to, employees. If the entity has its financial statements audited, a representative of the audit firm will usually be present at the count to take test counts and determine whether inventory instructions are being adequately followed. This allows the auditor to evaluate whether inventory and cost of goods sold are fairly presented in the statements. The inventory value derived from the physical inventory count is used as the inventory account balance on the balance sheet. The accounting records are adjusted for any difference between the inventory value determined by the count and the value according to the perpetual records. The Inventory account is debited or credited as necessary with a corresponding credit or debit to the Cost of Goods Sold account.

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

257

How Do Inventory Errors Affect the Financial Statements? 6

Determine the effect of inventory errors on the financial statements

A correct count of the inventory items on hand is necessary to ensure the accurate reporting of the inventory’s value. However, errors in the inventory count can and do occur, such as: • Counting inventory inaccurately. • Double counting inventory; for example, counting it in one location and then moving it to another location where it is counted again. • Not counting one section of the storeroom or excluding incoming goods shipped FOB shipping point. • Failure to recognize obsolete or damaged goods, resulting in failure to write down their value accordingly. What is the impact of a counting error? Remember that in a perpetual inventory system, the inventory account balance is adjusted to reflect the value arrived at by the physical count. A wrong count, a count that disagrees with the accounting records of inventory, will result in making a journal entry that causes both the Inventory balance and the Cost of Goods Sold to be incorrect. To demonstrate, let’s look at the income statements for a company for two consecutive years. In order to keep the example simple, we will assume that the company has a $20,000 balance in both beginning inventory and ending inventory for the first year. We will also assume that it has a $20,000 balance in ending inventory in the second year (remember that the beginning balance in the inventory account in year 2 is the ending inventory balance from year 1). In addition, assume that the company made purchases of $75,000 and that it had sales of $160,000 and operating expenses of $40,000 in both years. In other words, the activity for both years is exactly the same. Exhibit 5-12, Panel A, illustrates the income statements for both years assuming that inventory was properly counted. Panel A—Ending Inventory correctly stated Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold: Beginning Inventory Purchases Cost of Goods Available for Sale Ending Inventory Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Net Income Panel B—Ending Inventory overstated by $5,000 Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold: Beginning Inventory Purchases Cost of Goods Available for Sale Ending Inventory Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Net Income

Year 1 $160,000

Year 2 $160,000 $ 20,000 75,000 95,000 20,000

$20,000 75,000 95,000 20,000 75,000 85,000 40,000 $45,000

75,000 85,000 40,000 $45,000

Year 1 $160,000

Year 2 $160,000 $ 25,000 75,000 100,000 20,000

$20,000 75,000 95,000 25,000 70,000 90,000 40,000 $ 50,000

80,000 80,000 40,000 $ 40,000

Exhibit 5-12

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 257

03/04/14 1:55 PM

258

Chapter 5

Now, let’s assume that the ending inventory in year 1 was incorrectly valued at $25,000 (instead of the correct amount of $20,000) due to an error in the physical count. Exhibit 5-12, Panel B, illustrates the income statements for both years assuming that ending inventory in year 1 was overstated by $5,000. A comparison of the statements in Panel A and Panel B of Exhibit 5-12 reveals the following for year 1: • • • •

Cost of Goods Sold is understated by $5,000. Gross Profit is overstated by $5,000. Net Income is overstated by $5,000. Retained Earnings will be overstated because Net Income is closed into Retained Earnings.

Recall from Chapter 3 that Inventory, as an asset, is a permanent account that carries its balance over to the next period. So, one period’s ending inventory becomes the next period’s beginning inventory. Thus, the error in ending inventory in year 1 carries over as an error in the beginning inventory in year 2. A comparison of the statements in Panel A and Panel B of Exhibit 5-12 reveals the following for year 2: • • • • •

Cost of Goods Available for Sale is overstated by $5,000. Cost of Goods Sold is overstated by $5,000. Gross Profit is understated by $5,000. Net Income is understated by $5,000. Retained Earnings will now be correctly stated because the understatement in Net Income in year 2 will offset the overstatement from year 1 when the Net Income from year 2 is closed into Retained Earnings.

As you can see, the error cancels out after two periods. The total net income, $90,000, from Panel B for the two periods combined when there is an error is the same as it is in Panel A for the two periods when there are no errors. The effects of inventory errors are summarized in Exhibit 5-13.

Inventory Error Period 1 Ending Inventory Overstated Period 1 Ending Inventory Understated

Period 1 Gross Profit Cost of and Net Income Goods Sold Understated Overstated Overstated Understated

Period 2 Cost of Gross Profit Goods Sold and Net Income Overstated Understated Understated Overstated

Exhibit 5-13

Is It Possible to Estimate the Value of Inventory If the Inventory Is Accidentally Destroyed? 7

Use the gross profit method to estimate ending inventory

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 258

Often a business must estimate the value of its inventory. Suppose the company suffers a fire loss. To collect insurance, it must estimate the cost of the inventory destroyed, that is, it must estimate the ending inventory.

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory Gross profit method  A way to estimate ending inventory by using the gross profit percentage.

259

The gross profit method estimates ending inventory by using the format for the Cost of Goods Sold:

Beginning Inventory  Purchases (Net of Discounts and Returns and Allowances, Plus Shipping Costs)  Cost of Goods Available for Sale  Ending Inventory  Cost of Goods Sold

Rearranging ending inventory and cost of goods sold helps to estimate ending inventory. Let’s look at an example. We can estimate ending inventory through the following steps and amounts, as shown in Exhibits 5-14 and 5-15:

Step 1 Calculate the cost of goods available for sale. Add the beginning balance of inventory and the net cost of purchases for the accounting period ($14,000 + $66,000 = $80,000).



Step 2 Estimate the cost of goods sold. Do you remember calculating the gross profit percentage in Chapter 4? The historical gross profit percentage of a business can be used to estimate the current period’s gross profit. Calculate the estimated gross profit by multiplying the net sales revenue by the historical gross profit percentage ($100,000 × 40% = $40,000). Subtract the estimated gross profit from the net sales revenue to get the estimated cost of goods sold ($100,000 – $40,000 = $60,000).



Step 3 Estimate the ending inventory. Subtract estimated cost of goods sold from the cost of goods available for sale ($80,000 – $60,000 = $20,000).

Step 1

Step 2

Step 3

Beginning Inventory  Purchases (net)  Cost of Goods Available for Sale Estimated Cost of Goods Sold: Net Sales Revenue  Estimated Gross Profit of 40% ($100,000  40%)  Estimated Cost of Goods Sold Estimated Ending Inventory

$ 14,000 66,000 80,000 $100,000 (40,000) (60,000) $ 20,000

Exhibit 5-14

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 259

03/04/14 1:55 PM

260

Chapter 5 Step 2. Estimate the cost of goods sold. Net Sales Revenue – Estimated Gross Profit of 40% Estimated Cost of Goods Sold

$100,000 (40,000) $ 60,000

Beginning Inventory $14,000

Purchases $66,000

Estimated Cost of Goods Sold $60,000

Assigning Costs

Estimated Ending Inventory $20,000 Cost of Goods Available for Sale  $80,000 Step 1. Calculate cost of goods available for sale.

Step 3. Estimate the ending inventory. Cost of Goods Available for Sale Estimated Cost of Goods Sold Estimated Ending Inventory

$80,000 (60,000) $20,000

Exhibit 5-15

Focus On Decision Making “How Much Inventory Does a Business Need?”

8

Compute the inventory turnover and days-sales-in-inventory

What do you think about when you think of a merchandise business like Toys R Us? Most likely, it’s the things you buy; in other words, inventory. Inventory is the most important asset in a merchandise business. But how much inventory does a business need? A business does not want too little or too much inventory. If it has too little, the business will lose sales and profit. But having too much inventory is also a problem. Inventory is expensive to maintain. It takes up space and it ties up money. Remember that the money used to finance assets (liabilities or shareholders’ equity) comes at a cost. Likewise, inventory may become obsolete and lose value. The bottom line is merchandise businesses want enough inventory to meet future sales, but not too much inventory that it incurs excessive costs to maintain it.

The Rate of Inventory Turnover and Days-Sales-in-Inventory Inventory turnover  The ratio of cost of goods sold to average inventory.

So how do managers determine the right amount of inventory? Often they look at inventory turnover and days-sales-in-inventory. Inventory turnover is the ratio of cost of goods sold to the average inventory. Inventory turnover tells the manager how many times in a year the average inventory sold. Inventory turnover is computed as:

Inventory Turnover 

Cost of Goods Sold Cost of Goods Sold  (Beginning Inventory  Ending Inventory)/2 Average Inventory

Inventory turnover is usually computed for an annual period, so the cost of goods sold figure is the amount for the entire year. Average inventory is computed by adding the beginning inventory balance to the ending inventory balance and dividing the total by

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 260

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

Days-sales-in-inventory  The average number of days that it took to sell the average inventory held during the year.

261

two. Remember that balance sheet accounts, such as Inventory, carry their balances from one period to the next. The ending inventory for one year becomes the beginning inventory for the next year. Days-sales-in-inventory looks at the same issue with a slightly different measure. Days-sales-in-inventory measures how much inventory a business sells in a day and compares that amount with how much inventory a business owned on average during the year. Days-sales-in-inventory is computed as:

Days-Sales-In-Inventory  Average Inventory/ (Cost of Goods Sold/365 Days)

To demonstrate inventory turnover and days-sales-in-inventory, we will use the financial statements for Cellular Connect, Inc., from Exhibit 4-6 in Chapter 4. Cellular Connect’s rate of inventory turnover is calculated:

Inventory Turnover 

90,300  6.10 Times Per Year (rounded) (13,900*  15,700)/2

*The $13,900 beginning inventory balance is the ending inventory balance for the prior period and is not shown in Exhibit 4-6.

Cellular Connect’s days-sales-in-inventory is calculated as:

Days-Sales-in-Inventory 

(13,900  15,700)/2  60 days (rounded) (90,300/365)

Cellular Connect’s inventory turnover shows that it is selling its merchandise inventory a little more than six times a year. Cellular Connect’s days-sales-in-inventory shows it had enough inventory, during 2014, for 60 days of sales. Cellular Connect could operate for 60 days without buying any more inventory. A high turnover rate and low days-sales-in-inventory is desirable because it indicates that the inventory is turning over, or being sold, quickly. An increase in the turnover rate usually means increasing profits will result from increasing sales. Regardless of the turnover rate, merchandisers need to keep sufficient levels of inventory on hand to meet sales demand. However, they also need to avoid purchasing too much inventory. Inventory management is about meeting customer demand with the least amount of inventory.

How They Do It: A Look at Business

Go back to Chapter 4 and look at Focus on Decision Making. Remember how some businesses have small net income percentages and some businesses have large net income percentages? If a business has a small net income percentage, it needs to sell a lot of items to earn a large net income. To do this, the business must have a high inventory turnover and low days-sales-in-inventory. If a business has a large net income percentage, it does not need to sell a lot of items to earn a large net income. It can have a low inventory turnover and a high days-sales-in-inventory. Now once again think about Toys R Us and Tiffany & Co. In Chapter 4, we saw that Toys R Us had a low net income percentage and Tiffany had a high net income percentage. However, both businesses earned net income. How did they do it? For the year ending February 2, 2013, Toys R Us had an inventory turnover of 3.85 times a year and an average of 95 days-sales-in-inventory. For the year ending January 31, 2013, Tiffany had an inventory turnover of only 0.76 times a year and an average of 482 days-sales-in-inventory.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 261

03/04/14 1:55 PM

262

Chapter 5

Toys R Us, compared with Tiffany, operates with a lower net income percentage but a higher inventory turnover. Toys R Us makes a little profit on each sale, but has a lot of sales. Tiffany, compared with Toys R Us, operates with a higher net income percentage and a lower inventory turnover. Tiffany has few sales, but makes a lot of profit on each sale. Although they operate differently, both Toys R Us and Tiffany are successful businesses.

Summary MyAccountingLab

1

2

Here is what you should know after reading this chapter. MyAccountingLab will help you identify what you know and where to go when you need practice.

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Describe the four different inventory costing methods

Inventory costing methods:

Average cost (p. 244)

• Determine the flow of costs through the accounting records.

Cost of goods available for sale (p. 246)

Compute inventory costs using first-in, first-out (FIFO), last-in, first-out (LIFO), and average cost methods and journalize inventory transactions

• Specific-identification assigns the actual cost of each item to the units sold.

Finished goods (p. 243)

• FIFO assigns the oldest costs to the units sold.

Last-in, first-out (LIFO) (p. 244)

First-in, first-out (FIFO) (p. 244) Inventory layer (p. 245)

• LIFO assigns the most recent costs to the units sold.

Perpetual inventory record (p. 248)

• Average cost assigns a weighted average cost of the inventory on hand to the units sold.

Specific-identification (p. 243)

Raw materials (p. 243) Specific-unit-cost (p. 244) Work in process (p. 243)

3

Compare the effects of the different costing methods on the financial statements

The choice of inventory costing method can ­affect net income:

Consistency principle (p. 253)

• In times of rising prices, FIFO will result in the highest net income and LIFO will result in the lowest net income. • In times of declining prices, FIFO will result in the lowest net income and LIFO will result in the highest net income.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 262

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

4

5

6

7

Value inventory using the lower-of-cost-or-market (LCM) rule Illustrate the reporting of inventory in the financial statements Determine the effect of inventory errors on the financial statements Use the gross profit method to estimate ending inventory

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Reporting inventory in the financial statements

Conservatism (p. 254)

• The lower-of-cost-or-market (LCM) rule is used in inventory valuation. LCM requires that inventory be valued at current market value if lower than historical cost.

Footnotes (p. 256)

• The ending inventory balance is always adjusted to equal the value according to a physical count taken at year-end.

Inventory shrinkage (p. 256)

• The full-disclosure principle requires that the methods used to value inventory be disclosed in the financial statements. This is usually done in footnotes added to the financial statements.

263

Full-disclosure principle (p. 256) Gross profit method (p. 259) Lower-of-cost-or-market (LCM) rule (p. 255) Materiality (p. 255)

• A misstatement in ending inventory will cause net income on the income statement to be incorrect in the year of the misstatement as well as in the following year. The assets and retained earnings on the balance sheet will be incorrect in the year of the misstatement but will be correctly reported in the year following the misstatement. • The value of ending inventory can be ­estimated using the gross profit method in cases where the inventory has been lost or destroyed.

8

Compute the inventory turnover and days-sales-in-inventory

Ratios often used to help make decisions:

Days-sales-in-inventory (p. 261)

• Inventory turnover measures how quickly a business sells its inventory.

Inventory turnover (p. 260)

• Days-sales-in-inventory measures how many days worth of sales is held in inventory.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 263

03/04/14 1:55 PM

264

Chapter 5

Accounting Practice Discussion Questions 1. The introduction to this chapter suggests that the chapter will explore the answers to some questions about inventory. Did you get the answers to those questions? Specifically, a. why does inventory need to be counted? b. what would happen if the count was done incorrectly? c. what do the terms FIFO and LIFO have to do with inventory? 2. How are the financial statements of a manufacturer different from those of a merchandiser with respect to inventory? 3. What is a cost-flow assumption? Why is a cost-flow assumption necessary in accounting for inventory? 4. If a company had two units that cost $1 each in its beginning inventory and purchased two more units for $2 each, what would be the cost of goods sold associated with a sale of three units under each of the following assumptions? a. FIFO b. LIFO c. Average cost 5. If a company had two units that cost $1 each in its beginning inventory and purchased two more units for $2 each, what would be the gross profit reported on the income statement under each of the following assumptions if three units were sold for $3 each? a. FIFO b. LIFO c. Average cost 6. In a period of rising inventory costs, which cost-flow assumption would produce the highest net income? Why? 7. Let’s say that two companies, identical in every way except that one used FIFO and one used LIFO, went into a bank on the same day to get a loan to deal with the rising cost of acquiring inventory. Despite the fact that they both engaged in the same transactions at the same dollar values, one company reported higher net income and higher total assets on the financial statements. Which one was it? If the banker made the decision based on the company that would have higher cash flow associated with the inventory costing method choice, which company would have received the loan? 8. Describe some business and economic conditions that might make the lower-of-cost-ormarket rule more likely to result in a write-down of inventory. 9. Under which of the inventory methods, periodic or perpetual, would a company be better equipped to detect inventory shrinkage? Why? 10. If a company is having a harder time selling its products, even at discounted prices ­compared to last year, would this year’s inventory turnover rate be higher or lower than last year’s rate? What about the gross profit rate?

Self Check 1. During April, Bargain Hardware made sales of $42,300 and ended the month with inventories totaling $5,400. Cost of Goods Sold was $21,900. Total operating expenses were $10,800. How much net income did Bargain Hardware earn for the month? a. $4,200 b. $20,400 c. $9,600 d. $15,000

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 264

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

265

2. Which inventory costing method assigns the newest, most recent costs incurred during the period to ending inventory? a. Last-in, first-out (LIFO) b. Specific-unit cost c. Average cost d. First-in, first-out (FIFO) 3. Which inventory costing method results in the lowest net income during a period of declining inventory costs? a. Last-in, first-out (LIFO) b. Specific-unit cost c. Average cost d. First-in, first-out (FIFO) 4. Assume BAL, Inc., began March with 95 units of inventory that cost a total of $1,710. During March, BAL, Inc., purchased and sold goods as follows:

Mar 6 15 22 30

Purchased 120 units @ $16 each Sold 135 units @ $30 each Purchased 135 units @ $14 Sold 95 units @ $29 each

BAL, Inc., uses perpetual inventory. Under the FIFO inventory method, how much is BAL’s cost of goods sold for the sale on March 15? a. $2,190 b. $2,430 c. $2,350 d. $1,280 5. Assume BAL, Inc., began March with 95 units of inventory that cost a total of $1,710. During March, BAL, Inc., purchased and sold goods as follows:

Mar 6 15 22 30

Purchased 120 units @ $16 each Sold 135 units @ $30 each Purchased 135 units @ $14 each Sold 95 units @ $29 each

BAL, Inc., uses perpetual inventory. Under the LIFO inventory method, how much is BAL’s cost of inventory on hand after the sale on March 30? a. $1,920 b. $2,160 c. $1,680 d. $2,000 6. Assume BAL, Inc., began March with 95 units of inventory that cost a total of $1,710. During March, BAL, Inc., purchased and sold goods as follows:

Mar 6 15 22 30

Purchased 120 units @ $16 each Sold 135 units @ $30 each Purchased 135 units @ $14 each Sold 95 units @ $29 each

BAL, Inc., uses perpetual inventory. Under the average cost inventory method, how much is BAL’s cost of goods sold for the sale on March 15? Round unit cost to the nearest cent. a. $1,800.90 b. $2,278.80 c. $2,000.00 d. $2,295.00

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 265

03/04/14 1:55 PM

266

Chapter 5 7. Which of the following prevents a company from switching its inventory costing method to a different method each year? a. Consistency principle b. Materiality concept c. Matching principle d. Disclosure principle 8. Which of the following is most closely linked to the accounting principle of conservatism? a. Consistency principle b. Disclosure principle c. Lower-of-cost-or-market rule d. Materiality concept 9. At December 31, 2012, Island Equipment understated ending inventory by $2,500. How does this error affect cost of goods sold and net income for 2012? a. Understates costs of goods sold and overstates net income b. Leaves both cost of goods sold and net income correct because the errors cancel each other c. Overstates cost of goods sold and understates net income d. Overstates both cost of goods sold and net income 10. Suppose Rocky Mountain, Inc., lost its entire inventory in a hurricane. Beginning inventory was $49,000, net purchases totaled $530,000, and sales came to $880,000. Rocky Mountain’s normal gross profit percentage is 42%. Use the gross profit method to estimate the cost of the inventory lost in the hurricane. a. $301,000 b. $19,600 c. $68,600 d. $209,400 11. According to the Real World Accounting Video, a ____________ is a profitability measure that is computed as net income/net sales. a. gross profit margin ratio b. profit margin ratio c. net income ratio d. net sales ratio 12. According to the Real World Accounting Video, ABC Wines has a supply chain that is composed of its ______________. a. landlords b. importers and distributors c. customers d. employees Answers are given after Written Communication.

MyAccountingLab

Short Exercises S5-1. Inventory methods (Learning Objective 1) 5 min. Hasse Landscaping would like to assign the oldest costs of inventory items to its ending inventory. Which inventory costing method should Hasse Landscaping choose? S5-2. Inventory methods (Learning Objective 1) 5–10 min. Cunnington Furniture doesn’t expect prices to change dramatically and wants to use a method that averages price changes. 1. Which inventory method would best meet Cunnington Furniture’s goal? 2. What if Cunnington Furniture wanted to expense out the newer purchases of goods instead? Which inventory would best meet that need?

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 266

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

267

S5-3. FIFO (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Nazira Company sells many products. Frutti is one of its popular items. Below is an analysis of the inventory purchases and sales of Frutti for the month of April. Nazira Company uses the perpetual inventory system. Using the FIFO method, calculate the amount charged to the cost of goods sold for April. Purchases Date Apr 1 3 4 10 16 19 25 30

Units Beginning inventory Purchase Sales Purchase Sales Sales Sales Purchase

Sales

Unit Cost

100 60

$55 $60

200

$65

40

$75

Units

Selling Price/ Unit

60

$120

90 70 50

$130 $130 $130

S5-4. FIFO (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Refer to the data for S5-3. Using the FIFO method, calculate the value of ending inventory for April. S5-5. Average cost (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Refer to the data for S5-3. Using the average cost method, calculate the value of ­ending inventory on April 31. S5-6. LIFO (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Refer to the data for S5-3. Using the LIFO method, calculate the value of ending inventory on April 31. S5-7. LIFO (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Refer to the data for S5-3. Using the LIFO method, calculate the amount charged to cost of goods sold for April. S5-8. Inventory terms (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 5–10 min. Match the terms with the definitions. _____ 1. A company must perform strictly proper accounting only for items that are significant to the business’s financial statements. _____ 2. Reporting the least favorable figures in the financial statements.

a. Full-disclosure b. Materiality c. Consistency d. Conservatism

_____ 3.  A business’s financial statements must report enough information for users to make knowledgeable decisions about the company. _____ 4. A business should use the same accounting methods and procedures from period to period.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 267

03/04/14 1:55 PM

268

Chapter 5 S5-9. Lower-of-cost-or-market (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. Thomson Company accumulates the following cost and market data at December 31. What is the amount of inventory Thomson Company reports on December 31 using the lower-of-cost-or-market rule? Inventory

Cost

Market

Categories

Data

Data

Product A Product B Product C

$11,000 8,000 14,000

$10,200 8,500 12,600

S5-10. Reporting inventory on the balance sheet (Learning Objective 5) 5–10 min. At the end of the current year, Cottage Cafe’s inventory account balance was $13,550. A physical count of the inventory revealed that inventory on hand totaled $13,480. What amount should Cottage Cafe report on its balance sheet for inventory? S5-11. Inventory principles and terminology (Learning Objectives 1, 4, & 5) 5–10 min. Match the accounting terms on the left with the corresponding definitions on the right. _____1. Assigns the most recent inventory costs to ending inventory. _____2. Results in cost of goods sold that falls between what FIFO and LIFO produce assuming rising prices. _____3. This principle is the basis for using the lower-of-cost-or-market rule. _____4. Principle that prevents a company from using a different inventory costing method each year.

a. Conservatism b. Full-disclosure c. LIFO d. Average cost e. FIFO f. Consistency g. Materiality h. Specific-Identification

_____5. Identifies exactly which inventory item was sold. Usually used for unique inventory items. _____6. Requires that a company report enough information for outsiders to make decisions. _____7. Treats the most recent/newest purchases as the first units sold. _____8. Principle that states significant items must conform to GAAP.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 268

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

269

S5-12. Inventory errors (Learning Objective 6) 5–10 min. Inland Industrial Supply’s income statement data for the year ended October 31, 2014, follow.

Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit

$253,700 136,400 $117,300

Assume that the ending inventory was accidentally overstated by $2,800. What are the correct amounts for cost of goods sold and gross profit? S5-13. Inventory errors (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Inland Industrial Supply’s income statement data for the year ended December 31, 2014, follow.

Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit

$253,700 136,400 $117,300

Assume that the ending inventory was accidentally overstated by $3,200. How would the inventory error affect Inland Industrial Supply’s cost of goods sold and gross profit for the year ended December 31, 2015, if the error is not corrected in 2014? S5-14. Estimating ending inventory (Learning Objective 7) 10–15 min. Haskin’s Wholesale began the year with inventory of $51,600 and made purchases of $326,800 during the year. Sales for the year are $505,300, and Haskin’s Wholesale’s gross profit percentage is 38% of sales. Compute Haskin’s Wholesale’s estimated cost of ending inventory using the gross profit method. S5-15. Inventory turnover (Learning Objective 8) 5–10 min. Swanson, Incorporated’s sales for the year ended March 31, 2014, were $1,275,000, and cost of goods sold amounted to $728,000. Beginning inventory was $55,000, and ending inventory was $68,000. Compute Swanson, Incorporated’s rate of inventory turnover for the year ended March 31, 2014. Round answer to the nearest tenth.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 269

03/04/14 1:55 PM

270

Chapter 5

MyAccountingLab

Exercises (Group A) E5-16A. FIFO (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Riley’s Sports Shop carries a line of waterproof cameras. Riley’s Sports Shop uses the FIFO method and a perpetual inventory system. The sales price of each camera is $380. Company records indicate the following activity for waterproof cameras for the month of August:

Date Aug 1 7 11 19 28

Item Balance Purchase Sale Purchase Sale

Quantity 10 14 16 12 9

Unit Cost $240 $252 $256

Requirements 1. Prepare a perpetual inventory record for the waterproof cameras to determine the amount Riley’s Sports Shop should report for ending inventory and cost of goods sold using the FIFO method. 2. Journalize Riley’s Sports Shop’s inventory transactions using the FIFO method. Assume that all purchases and sales are on account. E5-17A. LIFO (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Refer to the data for E5-16A. However, instead of the FIFO method, assume Riley’s Sports Shop uses the LIFO method. Requirements 1. Prepare a perpetual inventory record for the cameras on the LIFO basis to determine the cost of ending inventory and cost of goods sold for the month. 2. Journalize Riley’s Sports Shop’s inventory transactions using the perpetual LIFO method. Assume that all purchases and sales are on account. E5-18A. Average cost (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Refer to the data for E5-16A. However, instead of the FIFO method, assume Riley’s Sports Shop uses the average cost method. Requirements 1. Prepare a perpetual inventory record for the cameras on the average cost basis to determine the cost of ending inventory and cost of goods sold for the month. Round average cost per unit to the nearest cent and all other amounts to the nearest dollar. 2. Journalize Riley’s Sports Shop’s inventory transactions using the perpetual average cost method. Assume that all purchases and sales are on account.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 270

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

271

E5-19A. FIFO versus LIFO (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Assume that Brazington Bikes bought and sold a line of mountain bikes during May as follows:

Date May 1 5 12 21 30

Item Balance Sale Purchase Sale Sale

Quantity 12 8 18 6 7

Unit Cost $480 $460

Brazington Bikes uses the perpetual inventory system. Requirements 1. Compute the cost of ending inventory under FIFO. 2. Compute the cost of ending inventory under LIFO. 3. Which method results in higher cost of ending inventory? E5-20A. FIFO versus LIFO (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Refer to the data for Brazington Bikes in E5-19A. Quick solution:

Requirements

1. FIFO cost of goods sold = $9,900; 2. LIFO cost of goods sold = $9,820

1. Compute the cost of goods sold under FIFO. 2. Compute the cost of goods sold under LIFO. 3. Which method results in the higher cost of goods sold? E5-21A. FIFO versus LIFO versus average cost (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 15–20 min. Assume that McCormack Tire completed the following perpetual inventory transactions for a line of tires.

Beginning Inventory................................................................................. Purchase.................................................................................................. Sale..........................................................................................................

28 tires @ $193 35 tires @ $185 42 tires @ $284

Requirements 1. Compute cost of goods sold and gross profit under FIFO. 2. Compute cost of goods sold and gross profit using LIFO. 3. Compute cost of goods sold and gross profit using average cost. Round average cost per unit to the nearest cent and all other amounts to the nearest dollar. 4. Which method results in the largest gross profit and why?

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 271

03/04/14 1:55 PM

272

Chapter 5 E5-22A. Lower of cost or market (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Vermont Resources has the following account balances at March 31, 2014. The inventory balance was determined using FIFO.

Inventory Beg Bal End Bal

Cost of Goods Sold

10,000 21,000

Bal

Sales Revenue

101,000

Bal

186,000

Vermont Resources has determined that the replacement cost (current market value) of the March 31, 2014, ending inventory is $20,200. Requirements 1. What value would Vermont Resources report on the balance sheet at March 31, 2014, for inventory assuming the company uses the lower-of-cost–or-market rule? 2. Prepare any adjusting journal entry required from the information given. E5-23A. Reporting inventory on the balance sheet (Learning Objective 5) 5–10 min. Sundaze Sunglasses had the following FIFO perpetual inventory record at November 30, the end of the fiscal year.

Date Nov 1 Nov 3

Quantity 140

Purchases Unit Cost $6.05

Total Cost

Cost of Goods Sold Unit Total Quantity Cost Cost

$847.00

Nov 7 Nov 13

90

$6.15

Nov 25 230

$6.00

$ 780.00

20 85 55 60 350

$6.00 $6.05 $6.05 $6.15

$ 120.00 $ 514.25 $ 332.75 $ 369.00 $2,116.00

$ 553.50

Nov 18

Nov 30

130

$1,400.50

Inventory on Hand Unit Quantity Cost 150 $6.00 150 $6.00 140 $6.05 20 $6.00 140 $6.05 20 $6.00 140 $6.05 90 $6.15 55 $6.05 90 $6.15 30 30

$6.15

Total Cost $900.00 $900.00 $847.00 $120.00 $847.00 $120.00 $847.00 $553.50 $332.75 $553.50 $184.50 $184.50

A physical count of the inventory performed at year-end revealed $178.35 of inventory on hand. Requirements 1. Journalize the adjusting entry for inventory, if any is required. 2. What could have caused the value of the ending inventory based on the physical count to be lower than the amount based on the perpetual inventory record?

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 272

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

273

E5-24A Inventory errors (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Old Time Bakery reported sales revenue of $134,000 and cost of goods sold of $89,000. Requirements 1. Compute Old Time Bakery’s correct gross profit assuming the company’s ending inventory is overstated by $1,100. Show your work. 2. Compute Old Time Bakery’s correct gross profit assuming the company’s ending inventory is understated by $2,200. Show your work. E5-25A. Inventory errors (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Apex Auto Parts, Inc., reported the following comparative income statement for the years ended September 30, 2014 and 2013.

Apex Auto Parts, Inc. Comparative Income Statements For the Years Ended September 30, 2014 and 2013 Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold: Beginning Inventory Net Purchases Cost of Goods Available Ending Inventory Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Net Income

2014 $157,000

2013 $148,300 $11,800 71,300 83,100 18,400

$18,400 72,000 90,400 17,900 72,500 84,500 25,300 $ 59,200

64,700 83,600 25,800 $ 57,800

During 2014, Apex Auto Parts, Inc., discovered that the 2013 ending inventory, as previously reported, was understated by $3,200. Requirements 1. Prepare the corrected comparative income statement for the two-year period, complete with a heading for the statement. 2. What was the effect of the error on net income for the two years combined? Explain your answer. E5-26A. Estimating ending inventory (Learning Objective 7) 5–10 min. Sounds on Wheels sells and installs audio equipment. During a recent fire that occurred at its warehouse, Sounds on Wheels’ entire inventory was destroyed. Sounds on Wheels’ accounting records reflect the following information.

Beginning Inventory............................................................................................. Net Purchases...................................................................................................... Net Sales.............................................................................................................. Gross Profit Rate .................................................................................................

$ 54,000 280,400 425,000 35%

Requirement 1. Use the gross profit method to estimate the amount of Sounds on Wheels’ inventory loss.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 273

03/04/14 1:55 PM

274

Chapter 5 E5-27A. Inventory turnover (Learning Objective 8) 10–15 min. Outdoor Adventure, Inc., has the following information as of December 31, 2014:

Sales Revenue.............................................................................. Cost of Goods Sold: Beginning Inventory ................................................................ Net Purchases ......................................................................... Cost of Goods Available .......................................................... Ending Inventory ..................................................................... Cost of Goods Sold ................................................................. Gross Profit.................................................................................. Operating Expenses ..................................................................... Net Income ..................................................................................

$1,675,400 $ 36,200 760,400 796,600 48,400

748,200 927,200 67,300 $ 859,900

Requirements 1. Compute the rate of inventory turnover for Outdoor Adventure, Inc., for the year ended December 31, 2014. Round the result to two decimal places. 2. The rate of inventory turnover for Outdoor Adventure, Inc., was 17.42 in 2013. Has the rate improved or deteriorated?

Exercises (Group B) E5-28B. FIFO (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Underwater World carries a line of waterproof watches. Underwater World uses the FIFO method and a perpetual inventory system. The sales price of each watch is $185. Company records indicate the following activity for waterproof watches for the month of March: Date Mar 1 7 11 19 28

Item Balance Purchase Sale Purchase Sale

Quantity 6 8 10 13 9

Unit Cost $100 $108 $112

Requirements 1. Prepare a perpetual inventory record for the waterproof watches to determine the amount Underwater World should report for ending inventory and cost of goods sold using the FIFO method. 2. Journalize Underwater World’s inventory transactions using the FIFO method. Assume that all purchases and sales are on account. E5-29B. LIFO (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Refer to the data for E5-28B. However, instead of the FIFO method, assume Underwater World uses the LIFO method. Requirements 1. Prepare a perpetual inventory record for the watches on the LIFO basis to determine the cost of ending inventory and cost of goods sold for the month. 2. Journalize Underwater World’s inventory transactions using the perpetual LIFO method. Assume that all purchases and sales are on account.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 274

03/04/14 1:55 PM

Inventory

275

E5-30B. Average cost (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Refer to the data for E5-28B. However, instead of the FIFO method, assume that Underwater World uses the average cost method. Requirements 1. Prepare a perpetual inventory record for the watches on the average cost basis to determine the cost of ending inventory and cost of goods sold for the month. Round average cost per unit to the nearest cent and all other amounts to the nearest dollar. 2. Journalize Underwater World’s inventory transactions using the perpetual average cost method. Assume that all purchases and sales are on account. E5-31B. FIFO versus LIFO (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Assume that North Country Bike World bought and sold a line of mountain bikes during August as follows: Date Aug 1 5 12 21 30

Item Balance Sale Purchase Sale Sale

Quantity 17 11 16 10 7

Unit Cost $267 $271

North Country Bike World uses the perpetual inventory system. Requirements 1. Compute the cost of ending inventory under FIFO. 2. Compute the cost of ending inventory under LIFO. 3. Which method results in a higher cost of ending inventory? E5-32B. FIFO versus LIFO (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Refer to the data for North Country Bike World in E5-31B. Requirements 1. Compute the cost of goods sold under FIFO. 2. Compute the cost of goods sold under LIFO. 3. Which method results in a higher cost of goods sold? E5-33B. FIFO versus LIFO versus average cost (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 15–20 min. Assume that Performance Tire, Inc., completed the following perpetual inventory transactions for a line of tires.

Beginning Inventory................................................................................. Purchase.................................................................................................. Sale..........................................................................................................

34 tires @ $ 88 29 tires @ $ 90 38 tires @ $160

Requirements 1. Compute cost of goods sold and gross profit under FIFO. 2. Compute cost of goods sold and gross profit using LIFO. 3. Compute cost of goods sold and gross profit using average cost. Round average cost per unit to the nearest cent and all other amounts to the nearest dollar. 4. Which method results in the largest gross profit and why?

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 275

03/04/14 1:56 PM

276

Chapter 5 E5-34B. Lower of cost or market (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Ridgeview Resources has the following account balances at January 31, 2014. The inventory balance was determined using FIFO.

Inventory Beg Bal End Bal

Cost of Goods Sold

18,300 29,700

Bal

Sales Revenue

132,600

Bal

297,800

Ridgeview Resources has determined that the replacement cost (current market value) of the January 31, 2014, ending inventory is $30,600. Requirements 1. What value would Ridgeview Resources report on the balance sheet at January 31, 2014, for inventory assuming the company uses the lower-of-cost-or-market rule? 2. Prepare any adjusting journal entry required from the information given. E5-35B. Reporting inventory on the balance sheet (Learning Objective 5) 5–10 min. Sunglass Bungalow had the following FIFO perpetual inventory record at April 30, the end of the fiscal year.

Date Apr 1 Apr 3

Quantity 110

Purchases Unit Cost $9.10

Total Cost

Cost of Goods Sold Unit Total Quantity Cost Cost

$1,001.00

Apr 7 Apr 13

80

$9.25

Apr 25 190

$9.00

$1,440.00

20 90 20 70 360

$9.00 $9.10 $9.10 $9.25

$ 180.00 $ 819.00 $ 182.00 $ 647.50 $3,268.50

$ 740.00

Apr 18

Apr 30

160

$1,741.00

Inventory on Hand Unit Total Quantity Cost Cost 180 $9.00 $1,620.00 180 $9.00 $1,620.00 110 $9.10 $1,001.00 20 $9.00 $ 180.00 110 $9.10 $1,001.00 20 $9.00 $ 180.00 110 $9.10 $1,001.00 80 $9.25 $ 740.00 20 $9.10 $ 182.00 80 $9.25 $ 740.00 10 10

$9.25

$ $

92.50 92.50

A physical count of the inventory performed at year-end revealed $64.75 of inventory on hand. Requirements 1. Journalize the adjusting entry for inventory, if any is required. 2. What could have caused the value of the ending inventory based on the physical count to be lower than the amount based on the perpetual inventory record?

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 276

03/04/14 1:56 PM

Inventory

277

E5-36B. Inventory errors (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Titan Trucks reported sales revenue of $343,000 and cost of goods sold of $246,000. Requirements 1. Compute Titan Trucks’ correct gross profit assuming the company’s ending inventory is overstated by $3,600. Show your work. 2. Compute Titan Trucks’ correct gross profit assuming the company’s ending inventory is understated by $1,800. Show your work. E5-37B. Inventory errors (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Gomez Auto Parts, Inc., reported the following comparative income statement for the years ended April 30, 2014 and 2013.

Gomez Auto Parts, Inc. Comparative Income Statements For the Years Ended April 30, 2014 and 2013 2014 Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold: Beginning Inventory Net Purchases Cost of Goods Available Ending Inventory Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Net Income

2013 $119,000

$143,000

$12,500 71,000 83,500 12,000

$12,000 79,000 91,000 18,000 73,000 70,000 29,000 $ 41,000

71,500 47,500 23,000 $ 24,500

During 2014, Gomez Auto Parts, Inc., discovered that the 2013 ending inventory, as previously reported, was overstated by $3,000. Requirements 1. Prepare the corrected comparative income statement for the two-year period, complete with a heading for the statement. 2. What was the effect of the error on net income for the two years combined? Explain your answer. E5-38B. Estimating ending inventory (Learning Objective 7) 5–10 min. Mobile Audio sells and installs audio equipment. During a recent fire that occurred at its warehouse, Mobile Audio’s entire inventory was destroyed. Mobile Audio’s accounting records reflect the following information.

Beginning Inventory........................ Net Purchases................................. Net Sales......................................... Gross Profit Rate ............................

$ 58,000 287,000 486,000 43%

Requirement 1. Use the gross profit method to estimate the amount of Mobile Audio’s inventory loss.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 277

03/04/14 1:56 PM

278

Chapter 5 E5-39B. Inventory turnover (Learning Objective 8) 10–15 min. Pete’s Plants has the following information as of July 31, 2014:

Sales Revenue.............................................................................. Cost of Goods Sold: Beginning Inventory ................................................................ Net Purchases ......................................................................... Cost of Goods Available .......................................................... Ending Inventory ..................................................................... Cost of Goods Sold ................................................................. Gross Profit.................................................................................. Operating Expenses ..................................................................... Net Income ..................................................................................

$980,000 $ 44,300 257,000 301,300 21,200

280,100 699,900 70,000 $629,900

Requirements 1. Compute the rate of inventory turnover for Pete’s Plants for the year ended July 31, 2014. Round the result to two decimal places. 2. The rate of inventory turnover for Pete’s Plants was 10.24 in 2013. Has the rate improved or deteriorated?

MyAccountingLab

Problems (Group A) P5-40A. Computing LIFO and journalizing inventory transactions (Learning Objectives 1 & 2) 15–20 min. Watkins Equipment sells hand-held engine analyzers to automotive service shops. Watkins Equipment started April with an inventory of 140 units that cost a total of $22,120. During the month, Watkins Equipment purchased and sold merchandise on account as follows:

Apr 6 13 19 25 29

Purchased 60 units @ $160 Sold 50 units @ $310 Purchased 80 units @ $162 Sold 60 units @ $310 Sold 110 units @ $310

Watkins Equipment uses the LIFO method. Cash payments on account totaled $18,400. Operating expenses for the month were $16,200, with two-thirds paid in cash and the rest accrued as Accounts Payable. Requirements 1. Which inventory method (excluding specific-unit) most likely mimics the physical flow of Watkins Equipment’s inventory? 2. Prepare a perpetual inventory record, using LIFO cost, for this merchandise. 3. Journalize all transactions using LIFO. Record the payments on account and the operating expenses on April 30.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 278

03/04/14 1:56 PM

Inventory

279

P5-41A. Computing average cost and preparing a multi-step income statement (Learning Objectives 2 & 5) 15–20 min. Refer to the data for Watkins Equipment in P5-40A. However, assume Watkins Equipment uses the average cost method. Requirements 1. Prepare a perpetual inventory record using average cost. Round the average unit cost to the nearest cent and all other amounts to the nearest dollar. 2. Prepare a multi-step income statement for Watkins Equipment for the month of April. P5-42A. FIFO, LIFO, and average cost (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 15–20 min. Horizon Furnishings, Inc., completed the following inventory transactions during the month of March: Date Mar 1 4 12 22 31

Item Balance Purchase Sale Purchase Sale

Quantity 15 45 53 60 32

Unit Cost $110 $107 $104

Requirements 1. Without resorting to calculations, determine which inventory method will result in Horizon Furnishings, Inc., paying the lowest income taxes. 2. Prepare a perpetual inventory record using FIFO. 3. Prepare a perpetual inventory record using LIFO. 4. Prepare a perpetual inventory record using average cost. Round average cost per unit to the nearest cent and all other amounts to the nearest dollar. P5-43A. Lower of cost or market (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Raleigh Golf Pros uses the LIFO inventory method and values its inventory using the lower-of-cost-or-market (LCM) rule. Raleigh Golf Pros has the following account balances at December 31, 2014, prior to releasing the financial statements for the year:

Inventory Beg Bal End Bal

39,000 63,300

Cost of Goods Sold Bal

231,000

Sales Revenue Bal

325,000

The accountant for Raleigh Golf Pros has determined that the replacement cost (current market value) of the ending inventory as of December 31, 2014, is $61,700. Requirements 1. Which accounting principle or concept is most relevant to Raleigh Golf Pros’ decision to utilize LCM? 2. What value would Raleigh Golf Pros report on the balance sheet at December 31, 2014, for inventory? 3. Prepare any adjusting journal entry required from the information given.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 279

03/04/14 1:56 PM

280

Chapter 5 P5-44A. Lower of cost or market (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Due to a nationwide recession, Liquidation World’s merchandise inventory is gathering dust. It is now October 31, 2014, and the $189,400 that Liquidation World paid for its ending inventory is $13,200 higher than current replacement cost. Before any adjustments at the end of the period, Liquidation World’s Cost of Goods Sold account has a balance of $728,600. Liquidation World uses lower of cost or market to value its ending inventory. Requirements 1. What amount should Liquidation World report for inventory on the balance sheet? 2. What amount should Liquidation World report for cost of goods sold? 3. Journalize any required entries. P5-45A. Inventory errors (Learning Objective 6) 20–25 min. Evergreen Supply, Co., shows the following financial statement data for 2012, 2013, and 2014. Prior to issuing the 2014 statements, auditors found that the ending inventory for 2012 was understated by $5,000 and that the ending inventory for 2014 was overstated by $8,000. The ending inventory at December 31, 2013, was correct. (In thousands) Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold: Beginning Inventory Net Purchases Cost of Goods Available Ending Inventory Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Net Income

2014

2013 $206

$ 25 120 145 23

$ 23 129 152 32

$ 32 125 157 20 137 69 37 $ 32

2012 $182

$193

120 73 35 $ 38

122 60 36 $ 24

Requirements 1. State whether each year’s net income before corrections is understated or overstated and indicate the amount of the understatement or overstatement. 2. Prepare corrected income statements for the three years. 3. What is the impact on the 2014 income statement if the 2012 inventory error is left uncorrected? P5-46A. Estimating ending inventory (Learning Objective 7) 15–20 min. Quick solution: 1. October 31 estimated inventory = $69,288; 2. Gross Profit = $286,188.

Pugliese Enterprises lost its entire inventory in a hurricane that occurred on October 31, 2014. Over the past five years, gross profit has averaged 42% of net sales. The company’s records reveal the following data for the month of October:

Beginning Inventory............................................................................................ Net Purchases..................................................................................................... Sales ................................................................................................................... Sales Returns and Allowances ............................................................................ Sales Discounts ..................................................................................................

$ 43,600 420,900 743,200 58,300 3,500

Requirements 1. Estimate the October 31 inventory, using the gross profit method. 2. Prepare the October income statement through gross profit for Pugliese Enterprises.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 280

03/04/14 1:56 PM

Inventory

281

P5-47A. Inventory turnover and days-sales-in-inventory (Learning Objective 8) 10–15 min. Sanchez Wholesale, Inc., has the following information for the years ending May 31, 2014 and 2013: (In thousands) Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold: Beginning Inventory Net Purchases Cost of Goods Available Ending Inventory Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Net Income

2014

2013 $228

$226 $ 35 140 175 32

$ 32 139 171 25 146 82 39 $ 43

143 83 41 $ 42

Requirements 1. Compute the rate of inventory turnover for Sanchez Wholesale, Inc., for the years ended May 31, 2014 and 2013. Round the result to two decimal places. 2. Compute the days-sales-in-inventory for Sanchez Wholesale, Inc., for the years ended May 31, 2014 and 2013. 3. What is a likely cause for the change in the rate of inventory turnover from 2013 to 2014?

Problems (Group B) P5-48B. Computing LIFO and journalizing inventory transactions (Learning Objectives 1 & 2) 15–20 min. Top Line Equipment sells hand-held engine analyzers to automotive service shops. Top Line Equipment started November with an inventory of 95 units that cost a total of $11,400. During the month, Top Line Equipment purchased and sold merchandise on account as follows:

Nov 6 13 19 25 29

Purchased 105 units @ $134 Sold 100 units @ $280 Purchased 150 units @ $136 Sold 110 units @ $280 Sold 105 units @ $280

Top Line Equipment uses the LIFO method. Cash payments on account totaled $16,300. Operating expenses for the month were $9,000, with two-thirds paid in cash and the rest accrued as Accounts Payable. Requirements 1. Which inventory method (excluding specific-unit) most likely mimics the physical flow of Top Line Equipment’s inventory? 2. Prepare a perpetual inventory record, using LIFO cost, for this merchandise. 3. Journalize all transactions using LIFO. Record the payments on account and the operating expenses on November 30.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 281

03/04/14 1:56 PM

282

Chapter 5 P5-49B. Computing average cost and preparing a multi-step income statement (Learning Objectives 2 & 5) 15–20 min. Refer to the data for Top Line Equipment in P5-48B. However, assume Top Line Equipment uses the average cost method. Requirements 1. Prepare a perpetual inventory record using average cost. Round the average unit cost to the nearest cent and all other amounts to the nearest dollar. 2. Prepare a multi-step income statement for Top Line Equipment for the month of November. P5-50B. FIFO, LIFO, and average cost (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 15–20 min. Lakeside Industries completed the following inventory transactions during the month of August:

Date Aug 1 4 12 22 31

Item Balance Purchase Sale Purchase Sale

Quantity 35 70 81 56 44

Unit Cost $90 $92 $95

Requirements 1. Without resorting to calculations, determine which inventory method will result in Lakeside Industries paying the lowest income taxes. 2. Prepare a perpetual inventory record using FIFO. 3. Prepare a perpetual inventory record using LIFO. 4. Prepare a perpetual inventory record using average cost. Round average cost per unit to the nearest cent and all other amounts to the nearest dollar. P5-51B. Lower of cost or market (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. SoCal Sporting Goods uses the LIFO inventory method and values its inventory using the lower-of-cost-or-market (LCM) rule. SoCal Sporting Goods has the following account balances at December 31, 2014, prior to releasing the financial statements for the year:

Inventory Beg Bal End Bal

43,200 75,230

Cost of Goods Sold Bal

360,450

Sales Revenue Bal

514,340

The accountant for SoCal Sporting Goods has determined that the replacement cost (current market value) of the ending inventory as of December 31, 2014, is $73,850. Requirements 1. Which accounting principle or concept is most relevant to SoCalSporting Goods’ decision to utilize LCM? 2. What value would SoCal Sporting Goods report on the balance sheet at December 31, 2014, for inventory? 3. Prepare any adjusting journal entry required from the information given.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 282

03/04/14 1:56 PM

Inventory

283

P5-52B. Lower of cost or market (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Due to a nationwide recession, Freeze It Corp.’s merchandise inventory is gathering dust. It is now July 31, 2014, and the $160,500 that Freeze It Corp., paid for its ending inventory is $11,200 higher than current replacement cost. Before any adjustments at the end of the period, Freeze It Corp.’s Cost of Goods Sold account has a balance of $671,000. Freeze It Corp. uses lower of cost or market to value its ending inventory. Requirements 1. What amount should Freeze It Corp. report for inventory on the balance sheet? 2. What amount should Freeze It Corp. report for cost of goods sold? 3. Journalize any required entries. P5-53B. Inventory errors (Learning Objective 6) 20–25 min. Ling Supply, Co., shows the following financial statement data for 2012, 2013, and 2014. (In thousands) Net Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold: Beginning Inventory Net Purchases Cost of Goods Available Ending Inventory Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Net Income

2014

2013 $198

$

6 132 138 19

$ 19 112 131 16

$ 16 145 161 23 138 60 42 $ 18

2012 $179

$177

115 62 41 $ 21

119 60 43 $ 17

Prior to issuing the 2014 statements, auditors found that the ending inventory for 2012 was understated by $5,000 and that the ending inventory for 2014 was overstated by $8,000. The ending inventory at December 31, 2013, was correct. Requirements 1. State whether each year’s net income before corrections is understated or overstated, and indicate the amount of the understatement or overstatement. 2. Prepare corrected income statements for the three years. 3. What is the impact on the 2014 income statement if the 2012 inventory error is left uncorrected? P5-54B. Estimating ending inventory (Learning Objective 7) 15–20 min. Inland Empire Supply, Inc., lost its entire inventory in a hurricane that occurred on July 31, 2014. Over the past five years, gross profit has averaged 39% of net sales. The company’s records reveal the following data for the month of July:

Beginning Inventory............................................................................................ Net Purchases..................................................................................................... Sales ................................................................................................................... Sales Returns and Allowances ............................................................................ Sales Discounts ..................................................................................................

$ 43,400 287,300 488,400 81,500 5,900

Requirements 1. Estimate the July 31 inventory using the gross profit method. 2. Prepare the July income statement through gross profit for Inland Empire Supply, Inc.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 283

03/04/14 1:56 PM

284

Chapter 5 P5-55B. Inventory turnover and days-sales-in-inventory (Learning Objective 8) 10–15 min Keystone Electronics, Inc., has the following information for the years ending January 31, 2014 and 2013: (In thousands) Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold: Beginning Inventory Net Purchases Cost of Goods Available Ending Inventory Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Net Income

2014

2013 $226

$218 $ 28 147 175 24

$ 24 147 171 18 153 73 47 $ 26

151 67 43 $ 24

Requirements 1. Compute the rate of inventory turnover for Keystone Electronics, Inc., for the years ended January 31, 2014 and 2013. Round the result to two decimal places. 2. Compute the days-sales-in-inventory for Keystone Electronics, Inc., for the years ended January 31, 2014 and 2013. 3. What is a likely cause for the change in the rate of inventory turnover from 2013 to 2014?

Continuing Exercise This exercise continues the Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., exercise begun in Chapter 1. Consider the May transactions for Cole’s Yard Care that were presented in Chapter 4. (Cost data has been removed from the sale transactions.)

May 2 5 15 17 20 21 25 31

Completed lawn service and received cash of $450. Purchased 120 plants on account for inventory, $345, plus freight-in of $15. Freight-in was added to invoice by seller. Credit terms were n/30. Sold 30 plants on account, $215. Consulted with a client on landscaping design for a fee of $165 on account. Purchased 110 plants on account for inventory, $352. Paid on account, $1,900. Sold 120 plants for cash, $840. Recorded the following adjusting entries: Accrued salaries for the month of May equal $225. Depreciation on equipment $33. Lawn supplies used during May were $8. Physical count of plant inventory, 75 plants

Refer to the T-accounts for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., from the Continuing Exercise in Chapter 3. Use the ending balances in T-accounts at April 30.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 284

03/04/14 1:56 PM

Inventory

285

Requirements 1. Prepare perpetual inventory records for Plant Inventory for May for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., using the FIFO method. 2. Journalize and post the May transactions using the perpetual inventory record created in Requirement 1. Omit explanations. Key all items by date. Compute each account balance, and denote the balance as Bal. 3. Journalize and post the adjusting entries. Denote each adjusting amount as Adj. Compute each account’s ending balance and denote the balance as Bal. 4. Journalize and post closing entries. Denote each closing amount as Clo. Compute each account’s ending balance and denote the balance as Bal. Prove the equality of debits and credits by preparing a post closing trial balance.

Continuing Problem This continues our accounting for Aqua Magic, Inc. As stated in the Continuing Problem in Chapter 4, Aqua Magic, Inc., began selling pools and spas in August. For this problem, we will focus on the purchase and sales of spas during the month of September. The purchases and sales of spa inventory for the month of September are as follows:

Spa Inventory August 31 balance September 5 purchase September 11 sale September 17 purchase September 21 sale September 25 purchase September 29 sale

Unit @ Cost 5 units @ $2,750 each 4 units @ $2,600 each 6 units 7 units @ $2,500 each 5 units 4 units @ $2,350 each 3 units

Total Cost $13,750 $10,400 $17,500 $ 9,400

Requirements 1. Assuming that Aqua Magic, Inc., uses the FIFO inventory cost flow assumption, what is the September 30 ending spa inventory balance and September cost of goods sold for spas? 2. Assuming that Aqua Magic, Inc., uses the LIFO inventory cost flow assumption, what is the September 30 ending spa inventory balance and September cost of goods sold for spas? 3. Assuming that Aqua Magic, Inc., uses the average cost inventory cost flow assumption, what is the September 30 ending spa inventory balance and September cost of goods sold for spas? Round average cost per unit to the nearest cent and all other amounts to the nearest dollar.

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem Look again at Target’s financial statements contained in its 2012 annual report. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem in Chapter 2. On page 33 of the annual report, you’ll find Target’s income statement for the year ending February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Operations). On page 35, you’ll find Target’s balance sheet as of February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position). Now answer these questions: 1. What makes up Target’s inventory? Look at footnote 12 of the financial statements (footnote 12 on page 45 of the financial statements found in Target’s 2012 ­annual report). What inventory method (such as FIFO and LIFO) does Target use? 2. Look at Target’s balance sheet. How much has Target invested in inventory as of February 2, 2013, and January 28, 2012?

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 285

03/04/14 1:56 PM

286

Chapter 5 3. Look at Target’s balance sheet. How much inventory does Target have per store as of February 2, 2013, and January 28, 2012? (Divide total inventory by the number of stores Target operated in each of these years [1778 stores at February 2, 2013, and 1763 stores at January 28, 2012].) Is inventory per store increasing or decreasing? 4. Look at Target’s balance sheet and income statement. What is Target’s inventory turnover rate for the year ending February 2, 2013? What does this tell you? 5. Look at Target’s balance sheet and income statement. What is Target’s days-salesin-inventory ratio for the year ending February 2, 2013? What does this tell you? 6. Looking back over your answers to questions 1 through 5, how do you think Target is performing?

Apply Your Knowledge Ethics in Action Case 1. Susan Hopkins recently went to work for RJ Enterprises as the accounting manager. At the end of the year, Bill Harrison, the CEO, called Susan into his office for a meeting. Mr. Harrison explained to Susan that RJ Enterprises was in the midst of obtaining a substantial investment of cash by a major investor. Mr. Harrison explained that he was concerned that the investor would decide not to invest in RJ Enterprises when it saw the current year’s results of operations. Mr. Harrison then asked Susan to revise the current year’s financial statements by increasing the value of the ending inventory in order to decrease cost of goods sold and increase net income. Mr. Harrison tried to reassure Susan by explaining that the company is undertaking a new advertising campaign that will result in a significant improvement in the company’s income in the following year. Susan is concerned about the future of her job, as well as others within the company, if the company does not receive the investment of cash. Requirements 1. What would you do if you were in Susan’s position? 2. If Susan increases the value of the current year’s ending inventory, what will be the effect on the following year’s net income? Case 2. Pacific Equipment, which sells industrial handling equipment, values its inventory using LIFO. During the recent year, Pacific Equipment has experienced a significant increase in the cost of its inventory items. Although the net income for the current year has been fairly good, Lynne Jamison, the company president, wishes it was higher because the company has been considering borrowing money to purchase a new building. Mrs. Jamison has heard that a company’s choice of inventory valuation method can affect the net income of the company. Mrs. Jamison has asked the controller, Lisa Adams, to explore the possibility of changing the company’s inventory valuation method. Requirement 1. If you were in Lisa’s position how would you respond to Mrs. Jamison? Address potential ethical implications and applicable accounting principles in your answer.

Know Your Business Financial Analysis Purpose: To help familiarize you with the financial reporting of a real company in order to further your understanding of the chapter material you are learning. This case continues our examination of the financial statements of Columbia Sportswear. In addition to the income statement (statement of operations) and the balance sheet of Columbia Sportswear in Appendix A, you will also be investigating the notes to the financial statements.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 286

03/04/14 1:56 PM

Inventory

287

Requirements 1. Which footnote discusses the inventory costing method used by Columbia Sportswear? 2. What inventory method does Columbia Sportswear use to value its inventory? 3. Calculate the rate of inventory turnover for Columbia Sportswear for 2012 and 2011 (the 2010 ending balance in inventory was $314,298,000). Has the rate of inventory turnover improved or deteriorated?

Industry Analysis Purpose: To help you understand and compare the performance of two companies in the same industry. Find the Columbia Sportswear Company annual report located in Appendix A, and go to the financial statements starting on page 690. Now access the 2012 annual report for Under Armour, Inc., from the Internet. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Industry Analysis in Chapter 1. The company’s financial statements start on page 48. Requirement 1. Calculate the inventory turnover for both companies for 2012. Who has the highest inventory turnover? Is that good or bad? Is it better to have a high inventory turnover or a low inventory turnover?

Small Business Analysis Purpose: To help you understand the importance of cash flows in the operation of a small business. It’s the end of the year, and your warehouse manager just finished taking a physical count of the inventory on hand. Because you are utilizing the perpetual inventory method with a relatively sophisticated inventory software program, you expect that the ending inventory balance will be fairly close to the balance on your general ledger. In the past, you’ve had to make some pretty large adjustments for inventory shrinkage, but with the new security measures you’ve installed to safeguard your inventory, you’re hoping that any shrinkage adjustment this year will be minimal. At least you hope that’s the case because your net income can’t take many more adjustments. This year’s financial statements are very important to your banker because of the loan renewal coming up early next year. You look at the amount from the final inventory count and it reads $465,375. You go to the general ledger Merchandise Inventory account and it reads $493,240. You look at the preliminary income statement, which doesn’t reflect any of these adjustments yet, and the net income is $176,600. You remember that the banker said that he really wanted to see a net income of at least $150,000 this year. Requirements 1. Calculate the effect that the required inventory adjustments will have on the net income for the year. Would your banker be happy or not so happy when you presented the financial statements to him after these adjustments? 2. If the adjustment you made for inventory shrinkage last year was only about $10,000, should that cause you any concern for the amount of adjustment you have to make this year? 3. In addition to the impact that the inventory adjustment might have on your loan renewal, what effect did it have on your cash flow during the year?

Written Communication You just finished a telephone conversation with one of your clients, who has decided to expand her business by beginning to offer some merchandise for sale. Previously the company had only been a consulting business, but now it has an opportunity to sell some product from a new line offered by one of its clients.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 287

03/04/14 1:56 PM

288

Chapter 5 The client’s question to you seems rather simple, at least in her eyes. Which inventory costing method should the client use that will give the highest amount of net income? Because the consulting part of the business has not been doing very well lately, the company wants to have a lot of net income from this new side of the business so that the income statement will look good at the end of the year. The company has heard that either the LIFO or FIFO inventory method will result in higher net income, but it is not certain which one it is. Plus, the company definitely plans to always sell the oldest merchandise first, so will this have any impact on which method it chooses? The question does seem simple, but is the answer simple? Requirement 1. Respond to your client either with a memo, a letter, or an e-mail. Self Check Answers 1. c 2. d 3. d 4. c 5. d 6. b 7. a 8. c 9. c 10. c 11. b 12. b

Comprehensive Problem The Accounting Cycle for a Merchandiser, Including Inventory Valuation Bike World, Inc., wholesales a line of custom road bikes. Bike World’s inventory, as of November 30, 2014, consisted of 22 mountain bikes costing $1,650 each. Bike World’s trial balance as of November 30 appears as follows:

Bike World, Inc. Trial Balance November 30, 2014 ACCOUNT Cash Accounts Receivable Inventory Supplies Office Equipment Accumulated Depreciation, Office Equipment Accounts Payable Note Payable, Long-Term Common Stock Retained Earnings Dividends Sales Revenue Sales Returns and Allowances Sales Discounts Cost of Goods Sold Sales Commissions Expense Office Salaries Expense Office Rent Expense Shipping Expense Total

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 288

DEBIT $ 9,150 12,300 36,300 900 18,000

CREDIT

3,000 1,325 5,000 8,500 21,425 4,250 150,950 1,700 1,275 78,900 11,300 7,425 5,500 3,200 $190,200

$190,200

03/04/14 1:56 PM

Inventory

289

During the month of December 2014 Bike World, Inc., had the following transactions:

Dec 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 19 20 22 30

Purchased 10 bikes for $1,575 each from Truspoke Bicycle, Co., on account. Terms, 2/15, n/45, FOB destination. Sold 14 bikes for $2,100 each on account to Allsport, Inc. Terms, 3/10, n/30, FOB destination. Paid $375 freight charges to deliver goods to Allsport, Inc. Received $7,200 from Cyclemart as payment on a November 17 sale. Terms were n/30. Purchased $450 of supplies on account from Office Express. Terms, 2/10, n/30, FOB destination. Received payment in full from Allsport, Inc., for the Dec 6 sale. Purchased 15 bikes for $1,600 each from Truspoke Bicycle, Co., on account. Terms, 2/15, n/45, FOB destination. Paid Truspoke Bicycle, Co., the amount due from the December 4 purchase in full. Sold 18 bikes for $2,125 each on account to Columbia Cycle, Inc. Terms, 2/15, n/45, FOB shipping point. Paid for the supplies purchased on December 12. Paid sales commissions, $1,850. Paid current month’s rent, $500.

Requirements 1. Using the transactions previously listed, prepare a perpetual inventory record for Bike World, Inc., for the month of December. Bike World, Inc., uses the FIFO ­inventory costing method. (Bike World records inventory in the perpetual ­inventory record net of any discounts as it is company policy to take advantage of all ­purchase discounts.) 2. Open four-column general ledger accounts and enter the balances from the November 30 trial balance. 3. Record each transaction in the general journal. Explanations are not required. Post the journal entries to the general ledger, creating new ledger accounts as necessary. Omit posting references. Calculate the new account balances. 4. Prepare an unadjusted trial balance as of December 31, 2014. 5. Journalize and post the adjusting journal entries based on the following information, creating new ledger accounts as necessary: a. Depreciation expense on office equipment, $1,875. b. Supplies on hand, $245. c. Accrued salary expense for the office receptionist, $845. 6. Prepare an adjusted trial balance as of December 31, 2014. Use the adjusted trial balance to prepare Bike World, Inc.’s multi-step income statement and statement of retained earnings for the year ending December 31, 2014. Also, prepare the balance sheet at December 31, 2014. 7. Journalize and post the closing entries. 8. Prepare a post-closing trial balance at December 31, 2014.

M05_KEMP9543_03_GE_C05.indd 289

03/04/14 1:56 PM

6 The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics Business, Accounting, and You Learning Objectives 1 Understand the importance of US GAAP and how it differs from accounting standards in other countries (IFRS)

Think of your favorite sports team. Your team is about to play a very important game. How is the game played? How is the score kept to determine which team won or lost the game? What happens if someone cheats? It takes rules to make sports fair. It also takes someone to make, monitor, and enforce the rules of the game.

2 Understand the importance and role of internal control

3 Define fraud and describe the different types of fraud in business

4 Know what a Certified Public Accountant (CPA) is and does

5 Know the legal and ­ethical responsibilities of an ­accountant, including the ­requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (SOX)

6 Know the difference between book value and market value of stockholders’ equity

290

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 290

03/04/14 1:57 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

291

Business has rules. Businesses like Google and McDonalds have rules on what they can and cannot do. Businesses compete to win the game of creating value. However, a business cannot just do anything it wants. It’s illegal for a business to knowingly make or sell a product that hurts a customer. A business must provide a safe place for employees to work. A business cannot falsely advertise what a product can or cannot do. Businesses compete, but operate using rules designed to create fairness for all stakeholders. Businesses also have rules about financial information. A business cannot provide stockholders and lenders false information. It’s fraudulent and against the law. But what is false information? It depends on the rules. So who sets the rules for businesses regarding financial information? How does a business create a system to ensure the rules are fairly applied? Who makes sure a business is following the rules? What happens if a business does not follow the rules? We’ll look at these questions and issues in this chapter.

Real World Accounting Video In the Real World Accounting Video, Vince Molinari, CEO and founder of Gate Technologies, talks about what he looks for in a business. Gate Technologies is an investment firm that invests in new businesses. Look at the video. Think about what Vince is saying. Now realize how important accounting is to the success of a business.

What Are the Rules that Govern Accounting? 1

Understand the importance of US GAAP and how it differs from accounting standards in other countries (IFRS)

Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP)  The rules, ­principles, and concepts established by the accounting profession that ­govern financial accounting.

In Chapter 1, we saw that accountants need rules. Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP) are the set of rules used by accountants. GAAP is intended to make accounting information useful and help decision makers make good decisions. For ­accounting information to be useful, it must be: • Understandable • Relevant • Reliable

Understandable First, accounting information should be understandable. Accountants do not want users to make bad decisions. They work hard so a company’s financial information is clear and comprehensible. They know business is complex. Understanding financial information is challenging. For that reason, accountants try to explain what they have done in notes to the financial statements. Look at Appendix A and the financial statements of Columbia Sportswear. The balance sheet, income statement, and other statements are shown. Now look at the pages immediately following these statements. You will find pages of notes that explain the numbers found in the financial statements.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 291

03/04/14 1:57 PM

292

Chapter 6

Relevant Second, accounting information should be relevant. Think of the thousands of transactions a business conducts. Think about trying to give every detail of every business transaction to a business’s stakeholders. The user of the information would be overloaded with information. For that reason, accountants must summarize the information and determine what ­information is important to the user. Accountants try to provide only the information that is important. Accountants will often say the information they provide is material, which is another way of saying the information they provide is important. In deciding what is ­relevant, GAAP focuses on the information that is important to the providers of a company’s financing, both lenders and stockholders. A part of relevance is making sure the information is computed and disclosed consistently. How would you feel if you were participating in a sporting event and the other team decided to change the rules of the game? Accountants would feel the same if different accounting rules were used each time. Accountants try to provide information that is comparable over time and among companies. As we’ll see in Chapter 12, Financial Statement Analysis, stakeholders need consistent information to understand how a company performs over time and how it compares with competing companies. Accountants use GAAP to provide consistency. If GAAP changes, accountants will explain how the change affects the financial statements.

Reliable

Audit  An examination of the ­validity and reliability of accounting information.

Third, accounting information should be reliable. Users of accounting information should be able to trust that the business transactions are recognized, measured, recorded, and reported using a set of accepted rules or standards. To provide reliability, accountants use accounting systems, CPAs, and audits. Companies create accounting systems that apply GAAP to the company’s business transactions. The people that validate and certify that the information is in accordance with GAAP are called Certified Public Accountants (CPAs). The process CPAs use to confirm the financial reports conform to GAAP is called an audit.

Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP) in the United States Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB)  The organization that has been designated by the US government to establish Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP) in the United States. Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC)  The ­government agency in the United States that is responsible for regulating U.S financial markets that sell stocks. Accounting Standards Codification (ASC)  A system used by the Financial Accounting Standards Board to organize and code all ­accounting pronouncements.

Rules are important in any game. However, all the players must accept the rules and promise to play by those rules. So who sets the rules regarding for-profit businesses? In the United States, it is the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB). Look at the FASB’s Web site and see how the FASB operates and sets standards (www.fasb.org). When the FASB issues a new standard, it must be approved by the US government. The US government agency that approves GAAP is the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC), which regulates US financial markets. There are thousands of documents explaining the standards and how to apply the standards. The documents show the standards used to account for revenue, costs, assets, liabilities, and stockholders’ equity in a wide range of situations and businesses. The FASB has created a system called Accounting Standards Codification (ASC) to organize and code all of these documents. The challenge the FASB faces is that the business world is constantly changing. To provide useful information, the FASB must constantly update accounting standards. For example, when you were born, there was no Google. Google created a whole new way of doing business. The FASB had to create new accounting standards dealing with the ­issues faced by businesses such as Google. The FASB must constantly review and update GAAP so GAAP produces useful information.

The Nature of US GAAP GAAP in the United States is very conservative. What does it mean to be conservative? It means that US GAAP tries to not overstate value. US GAAP does not want to

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 292

03/04/14 1:57 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

293

overstate the value of an asset or understate the value of a liability. Now remember that the accounting equation states that assets equal liabilities plus stockholders’ equity. Not overstating the value of assets or understating the value of liabilities means accountants do not overstate the value of stockholders’ equity. Being conservative, accountants use historical cost to report assets, liabilities, and stockholders’ equity. When the market value of an item permanently drops below the historical cost, US accountants will adjust the value to reflect the lower market value. As an example, consider a piece of land that changes in market value over time. If you bought a parcel of land 10 years ago for $100,000, accountants would record that your cash had decreased by $100,000 and you have land valued at $100,000. If the market value of the land permanently dropped to $70,000, accountants would decrease the value of the land to $70,000 and recognize a loss of $30,000. This loss would decrease stockholders’ equity by $30,000. However, when the value of an item increases, generally US accountants will not increase the value of the item. That increase in value would only be recognized if the item was sold. Let’s go back to your land. Let’s assume the land increased in value from $100,000 to $150,000. US accountants would not record a transaction until you sold the land for $150,000. Until you sell the land, the land is reported at $100,000. When you sell the land, your cash would increase by $150,000, your land would decrease by $100,000, and you would recognize a $50,000 profit ($150,000 sale price less $100,000 land cost). Because of your $50,000 profit, your stockholders’ equity would increase by $50,000. Why is US GAAP conservative? There are many reasons. However, US accountants realize that people do not like risk. Accountants want to provide information on which users can rely. Market values often fluctuate temporarily, creating ever-changing financial statements. The issue is whether US GAAP, using historical cost, provides the most useful and reliable information to users. Would decision makers prefer current or market values versus historical values?

Generally Accepted Accounting Principles Around the World: IFRS

International Accounting Standards Board (IASB)  The international organization developing and promoting accounting standards to be used throughout the world. International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS)  Accounting standards ­developed by the International Accounting Standards Board for use throughout the world.

The generally accepted accounting principles used in a country reflect the country’s culture and laws. Different people look at things differently. Accountants must use the principles set by a country’s government. This creates confusion for businesses that operate in more than one country. To address this confusion, a private organization was formed in 2001 to help countries agree on a set of accounting standards. This organization is called the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB). Look at the IASB’s Web site and see how the IASB operates and sets standards (www.ifrs.org). The standards issued by the IASB are called International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS). These standards are more like principles than rules. The IASB desires countries to take these principles and create their own set of generally accepted accounting principles. Some countries have adopted IFRS and some have not. The United States has not adopted IFRS. Countries that have adopted some or all IFRS include most European countries, Canada, Mexico, China, and Russia.

Differences Between FASB and IFRS The major difference between international accounting standards (IFRS) and US accounting standards (GAAP) is the use of current or market values versus historical values for assets and liabilities. Many users of financial statements, particularly a balance sheet, ask “What is something worth today?” They are asking for financial statements that reflect current or market values, not historical values. Let’s look back at your land. Most users want to know your land is now worth $150,000. They want to know that you could sell it for $150,000 and receive $150,000 cash. They want to know the current or

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 293

03/04/14 1:57 PM

294

Chapter 6

market value of your land, not what it cost you 10 years ago. IFRS would recognize your land has increased in value, even though you have not sold the land. Under IFRS, the land could increase in value from $100,000 to $150,000. You would recognize a $50,000 profit, and stockholders’ equity would increase by $50,000. As we discussed earlier, ­under US GAAP, the increase in value would not be recognized. In the United States, the FASB is currently working with countries throughout the world and the IASB to converge the US standards (GAAP) with international standards (IFRS). Exhibit 6-1 summarizes some of the more significant items that will differ ­between US GAAP and IFRS. Because countries have different cultures and laws, agreement will take compromise and time. When and how the US accounting standards will change is still to be determined. The focus of this book is current US GAAP.1

Related Chapter

Topic

US GAAP Treatment

IFRS Treatment

Inventory costing

The use of LIFO is allowed.

The use of LIFO is prohibited.

5

Inventory valuation using lower-of-cost-or-market

Market is typically defined as the current replacement cost.

Market is defined as the net realizable value (selling price) of the inventory.

5

Goodwill and other intangible assets

Generally valued at cost and only recognized as assets if purchased.

Generally recognized as assets if the future benefit of 8 the intangible is probable and can be reliably measured. Intangible assets may be purchased or internally generated.

Research and development costs

Both research and development costs are expensed as incurred.

Research costs are expensed as incurred.

Contingent liabilities

Contingent liabilities are recorded only if they are probable and can be reasonably estimated. If they are reasonably possible, they are only disclosed in the footnotes.

Contingent liabilities are recorded if they are either probable or possible.

9

Cash flow statement

Interest and dividend income and interest expense are reported in the operating section of an indirect method cash flow statement as part of net income.

Interest and dividend income and interest expense can be removed from net income in the operating section of an indirect method cash flow statement (using adjustments similar to those used for depreciation expense or gains and losses on long-term assets).

11

8

Development costs are capitalized and amortized over time.

Interest and dividend income can be reported in the investing section of the cash flow statement. Interest expense can be reported in the financing section of the cash flow statement. Extraordinary items

Extraordinary items are excluded from income from continuing operations and reported separately as a component of net income.

Extraordinary items are reported as part of income from continuing operations.

12

Exhibit 6-1

1

At appropriate points throughout the text, the discussion will highlight the major differences between US GAAP and IFRS. More detailed explanations are beyond the scope of an introductory financial accounting course.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 294

03/04/14 1:57 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

295

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analysis

Do I need to keep up with accounting standards?

Accounting standards must respond to the ­ever-changing business environment. Keep current by reading prominent business periodicals, which will reference these changes. In addition, regularly visit FASB’s Web site (www.fasb.org) for a list of new standards and pending standards.

It is hard to win the game of business if you do not know the rules. The rules are the ­accounting standards. For example, what if the United States adopted IFRS and you were ­unaware of this change? Failure to keep ­current could adversely affect a company’s ability to accurately represent its financial information to creditors, investors, and other stakeholders.

What Is Internal Control? 2

Understand the importance and role of internal control

Internal control  A system ­implemented within an organization to help it safeguard assets, ­operate ­efficiently and effectively, report ­financial information properly, and comply with ­applicable laws and regulations.

Think about what you learned in Chapters 1, 2, and 3. You learned about recognizing, measuring, recording, and finally, reporting business transactions. You needed a system, or set of procedures that captured all the business transactions correctly. Accounting information systems perform this accounting function. Today, most accounting information systems are computerized. However, some smaller businesses still use manual systems. All accounting information systems, whether computerized or manual, are composed of journals, temporary and permanent accounts, and ledgers. Accounting systems accurately and consistently recognize, measure, record, and report business transactions in accordance with rules such as GAAP. In addition, accounting systems attempt to prevent fraud, promote efficiencies, and help the business succeed. A critical function of any accounting information system is internal control. In the next section, we explore the elements, reasons for, and limitations of an effective internal control system. Internal control is a comprehensive system that helps an organization do the following: • • • •

Safeguard assets. Operate efficiently and effectively. Ensure proper reporting of financial information. Ensure compliance with applicable laws and regulations.

An organization’s management is responsible for the design and implementation of the internal control system. Internal control systems vary from one company to another. Usually, large companies have better developed, more complex internal control systems than small companies. Despite being less formal and less structured, the internal control systems of small companies can still be effective.

Elements of an Internal Control System There are five key elements that affect an organization’s internal control system. The complexity and effectiveness of the internal control system depend upon these elements. These elements are: • • • • •

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 295

The control environment Risk assessment Control activities Information and communication Monitoring

03/04/14 1:57 PM

296

Chapter 6

Control Environment Control environment  The ­overall attitude, awareness, and ­actions of management and staff regarding the internal control system and its importance to the business.

The control environment is the foundation for all other components of internal control. The control environment reflects management and staff attitudes regarding internal control and sets the tone for the entire organization. Control environment factors include the following: • Leadership philosophy and operating style (an effective control environment cannot exist if management has a “do as I say, not as I do” attitude). • The competency of the employees within an organization. • The integrity and ethical values of the company personnel. • The organizational structure of the company, namely the delegation of authority and responsibility.

Risk Assessment Risk assessment  The process of identifying risks and taking steps to mitigate them.

Risk is a fact of life. Every day a company will face a variety of risks from both internal and external sources. Risk assessment is an ongoing process that identifies and analyzes risks and takes steps to reduce them. For example, a fast food restaurant like McDonald’s that hires predominately younger workers would be at a higher risk of violating child labor laws. Also, a company that has a large amount of cash on hand will have a higher risk of having cash stolen from it.

Control Activities Control activities  The policies and procedures implemented in an internal control system.

There are two elements related to control activities: • Policies establishing what should be done. • The procedures that should be followed to implement the policies. The control activities of an organization vary from company to company. Control activities occur at all levels and in all functions throughout the entire organization. Generally, the controls chosen for an organization are based on its control environment, its assessment of risk, the size and structure of the organization, and the nature of its operations. Examples of common control activities include the following: • Proper training and supervision: Employees should have written job descriptions and be properly trained and adequately supervised. • Separation of duties: Responsibility for more than one of the following functions should not be given to any one employee:

1. Authorizing transactions



2. Maintaining custody of assets



3. Keeping accounting records

Assigning an individual responsibility for more than one of these duties creates an ­opportunity for fraud. For example, if an employee has access to cash or other assets and he or she can record transactions, then he or she can steal from the company and falsify financial information to hide the theft. • Mandatory vacations: Employees should be required to take annual vacations. If an employee knows that another person will be performing his or her duties while he or she is on vacation, there is less perceived opportunity to commit fraud. The ­vacationing employee will be concerned that any improper activities will be detected. • Restricted access: Limit the number of employees who have access to company ­assets, such as cash, inventory, and supplies. For instance, use cash registers, vaults, and locked storage units to control access to assets. Also, access to computerized accounting records should be restricted to authorized personnel through the use of passwords. Allowing too many people access to assets and records creates an ­opportunity for fraud to occur. It also makes it more difficult to find the perpetrator should fraud occur.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 296

03/04/14 1:57 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

Audit trail  A trail of business ­documents and records that provides evidence of transactions.

297

• Security measures: Proper security measures should be implemented to deter theft. These measures can include the use of security cameras and alarm systems. Cash registers that print a receipt should also be utilized with a requirement that all ­customers receive a receipt. • Proper authorization: Requiring proper authorization for certain activities. For ­example, requiring proper authorization for all sales returns can help prevent ­improper refunds from being issued. • Maintain adequate documents and records: A trail of business documents and ­records, called an audit trail, should be maintained. The audit trail provides ­evidence of, and the details supporting, business transactions. Documents should be pre-numbered so gaps in the numbered sequence draw attention. Creating an ­effective audit trail lowers the chance that inappropriate activity will go unnoticed.

Accounting in Your World

Have you ever eaten at a food court in a mall and seen a sign that says, “If you do not get a receipt your meal is free”? Why would the business care if you get a receipt? This is actually part of the business’s internal control activities. You see, the company doesn’t really care if you get a receipt; it just cares that a receipt is printed. This practice prevents an employee from taking your money and pocketing it because once the receipt is printed, the sale is recorded. If the employee pockets your payment, the daily cash count will not match the daily record of sales and the theft will be detected. This example is just one of many control activities that businesses utilize as part of their internal control systems.

Information and Communication To maximize the effectiveness of an internal control system, information about the control environment, the risk assessment, and the control activities must be communicated at all levels of the organization. This information should be communicated up, down, and across the organizational structure of the company. It is also critical that management communicates to all personnel that internal control must be taken seriously.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 297

03/04/14 1:57 PM

298

Chapter 6

Monitoring The internal control system must be continually monitored to locate weaknesses in the system. Monitoring can be accomplished through ongoing activities or through separate evaluations. Ongoing monitoring activities include regular management and supervisory activities. It also includes the assessment of the performance of the internal control system by employees as they perform their required duties. The need for separate evaluations depends on the effectiveness of the ongoing monitoring procedures.

Internal Control Limitations A good internal control system reduces the risk of undetected errors and irregularities. However, an internal control system cannot provide absolute assurance that no errors will occur. It also does not guarantee that fraud will be prevented or detected. The effectiveness of an internal control system is limited because:

Collusion  Two or more individuals working together to commit fraud.

• Employees can become tired, careless, or distracted and make mistakes. They may also use poor judgment or misunderstand policies and procedures. • Controls can be poorly designed. • Staff size limitations may hinder efforts to properly segregate duties. • Two or more people can work together to circumvent controls. This is known as collusion. • Management can override controls. • The cost of implementing some internal controls may exceed the benefits of these controls. Some examples of these limitations are: • An employee may forget to check authorization for the extension of credit to a ­customer when the phone rings in the middle of the transaction. • A disgruntled employee may convince another employee to help steal from the company. • Management may override controls and direct the accounting staff to record ­revenue for services that have not yet been performed. • In small businesses, the cost of employing enough people for a separation of duties may exceed the benefits of the segregation.

Stop and Think… Goodguys Tire Company is a small retail tire outlet located in Portland, Oregon. Bill Hanson, the president of Goodguys Tire Company, has assigned the bookkeeper the responsibility of processing all cash receipts as well as all cash disbursements. The bookkeeper also prepares the daily cash deposits and takes them to the bank. Bill knows that he has not achieved a very good separation of duties, but the limited number of employees (due to the size of the company) did not allow it. Is there anything Bill can do, in light of the fact that there is not a good separation of duties, to help prevent fraud from occurring?

Answer

Yes, although there is no substitute for proper separation of duties, some of the steps Bill could take to help detect and deter fraud include, but are not limited to:

• Ensure that someone other than the bookkeeper receives the unopened bank statement and prepares a bank reconciliation on a monthly basis.

• Require that all adjustments to customer accounts be authorized by someone other than the bookkeeper. A periodic review of the customer account detail should also be performed by someone other than the bookkeeper. Any unauthorized adjustments to the accounts should be noted and investigated.

• Require that someone other than the bookkeeper authorize all cash disbursements. The cash disbursement detail should also be reviewed for unusual disbursements periodically by someone other than the bookkeeper.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 298

03/04/14 1:57 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

299

What Is Fraud, and Who Commits It? 3

Define fraud and describe the different types of fraud in business

Fraud  Deceit or trickery involving ­intentional actions that cause harm to a business, its stakeholders, or both.

Errors occur. Errors hurt a business. But were the errors unintentional, or were they intended to deceive and defraud? What exactly is fraud? Although there are many definitions, in its broadest sense, fraud can be defined as the use of deception or trickery for personal gain. In the United States, fraud is one of the fastest-growing crimes. It ­accounts for more losses than robbery. In the business world, fraud is either committed by a business organization or against a business organization.

Management Fraud Management fraud  Management’s intentional ­misstatement of the financial ­statements, driven by greed or the pressure to show that a business is more ­profitable than it really is.

An organization’s top management is usually responsible for fraud that is committed by a business organization. This management fraud typically involves fraudulent financial reporting. Fraudulent financial reporting most often makes a company’s earnings look better than they are. The goal of overstating earnings is to help increase a company’s stock price or to ensure larger year-end bonuses for upper management. Fraudulent financial reporting is achieved when management does the following: • Overstates revenues by:

1. Overstating receivables related to revenue that has not yet been earned.



2. Understating unearned revenue (recording revenue when cash is received even though goods or services have not yet been provided).

• Understates expenses by:

Employee embezzlement  Fraud where employees steal from ­employers by taking assets or engaging in disbursement schemes to steal cash. Disbursement schemes  A form of employee embezzlement in which an employee tricks a company into giving up cash for an invalid reason. Examples include check tampering, cash register schemes, and expense schemes. Check tampering  A fraud scheme in which an employee writes a fraudulent check and makes the check payable to himself or herself, or obtains a check intended for an outside party, endorses the check, and then cashes it. Cash register schemes  A fraud scheme in which an employee steals cash by processing false refunds. Expense schemes  A fraud scheme in which an employee overcharges the company for travel and other business-related expenses, such as lunches, hotels, parking fees, and cab fares.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 299



1. Overstating the value of assets such as inventory, equipment, and buildings or recording assets that do not exist.



2. Understating amounts owed to suppliers, employees, or creditors.

Employee Embezzlement The primary form of fraud committed against a business organization is employee embezzlement. Employee embezzlement usually involves the misappropriation of business assets by an employee. Employees can: • Steal cash, inventory, tools, supplies, or other assets from the employer. • Establish fake companies, have the employer pay these phony companies for goods or services that are never delivered, and then intercept and fraudulently cash the checks. • Engage in disbursement schemes. Employee embezzlement involving ­disbursement schemes takes place when an employee tricks a company into ­giving up cash for an invalid reason. Examples of disbursement schemes include the following:

1. Check tampering: The employee writes a fraudulent check and makes the check payable to himself or herself. Alternatively, the employee obtains a check intended for an outside party, endorses the check, and then cashes it.



2. Cash register schemes: The employee gives a false refund for returned merchandise by filling out a refund form and putting it in the cash register. The employee then pockets the cash. Another related scheme happens when the employee accepts cash from a customer for a purchase but does not ­record the transaction in the cash register. The employee then keeps the cash for personal use.



3. Expense schemes: The employee overbills the company for travel or other business-related expenses, such as lunches, hotels, parking fees, and cab fares.

03/04/14 1:57 PM

300

Chapter 6

Bribe  The payment of money in order to influence the conduct of a person; also referred to as a kickback.

Employee dishonesty also occurs when an employee takes bribes or kickbacks from: • Suppliers in exchange for the employee turning a blind eye to a supplier charging the employer higher purchase prices. • Suppliers in exchange for the employee turning a blind eye to the delivery of inferior goods. • Suppliers in exchange for the employee authorizing payments to the supplier for goods not delivered to the employer. • Customers in exchange for granting the customer a lower sales price. • Customers in exchange for giving the customer goods or services for which the employer is never paid.

The Factors Usually Present When Fraud Is Committed Fraud triangle  The combination of perceived pressure, rationalization, and perceived opportunity necessary to commit fraud.

Anyone who has done much camping knows that it takes three things to build a fire: fuel, oxygen, and ignition. For fraud to occur, three factors must also exist: perceived pressure, rationalization, and perceived opportunity. Exhibit 6-2 presents the fraud ­triangle, which shows the connection of the three factors necessary to commit fraud.

Perceived Opportunity

Financial pressure: • Greed • Addictions • Poor credit rating or cash management Work pressure: • Dissatisfaction with pay • Overlooked for promotion

Fraud Triangle

Perceived Pressure

• Weak internal controls • Ineffective monitoring of controls • Assets susceptible to fraud

• “I’ll pay it back.” • “I deserve a pay raise.” • “It’s for a good purpose.”

Rationalization

Exhibit 6-2 Let us take a closer look at the three elements of the fraud triangle.

Perceived Pressure Perceived pressure  An element of the fraud triangle in which the employee feels a need to obtain cash or other assets.

Numerous reasons exist that could cause an individual to feel pressured to commit fraud. However, the most likely source of perceived pressure is usually financial pressure or work-related pressure. Financial pressure can be caused by, but is not limited to, the following: • • • • • •

Unexpected financial needs, such as medical bills A drug or alcohol habit Living beyond one’s means A gambling addiction Unanticipated financial losses Excessive bills or personal debt

Work-related pressure also has several possible causes. An employee might feel dissatisfied with his or her job because of a sense of being underpaid or underappreciated.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 300

03/04/14 1:57 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

301

Or an employee might have recently been overlooked for a promotion. Either of these things can motivate an employee to “get even” with the company by committing fraud. Also, if a company is performing poorly, it is possible for people within management to feel they are personally responsible. The perceived pressure caused by this feeling of personal responsibility can lead them to commit management fraud by falsifying the financial statements.

Rationalization Rationalization  An element of the fraud triangle in which the employee justifies his or her actions and convinces himself or herself that fraud is not wrong.

The next element of the fraud triangle that must be present in order for fraud to occur is rationalization. Rationalization is simply finding good reasons for doing things that we really know are wrong. Rationalization is human nature and very few people, if any, do not rationalize their behavior at some time or another. For example, you may have rationalized going out to a movie with your friends last night when you knew that you really needed to study for an important quiz. Employees who commit fraud attempt to justify their actions and convince themselves that fraud is not wrong by rationalizing their behavior. Common rationalizations used by individuals involved in fraud include the following: • • • •

“I didn’t steal the money; I only borrowed it, and I will pay it back.” “I deserve a pay raise. The company owes this to me.” “It won’t hurt anyone.” “Once the company gets over its financial difficulties, I will correct the books.”

Perceived Opportunity Perceived opportunity  An ­element of the fraud triangle in which the employee believes a chance exists to commit fraud, conceal it, and avoid punishment.

The third and final element of the fraud triangle is perceived opportunity. An i­ ndividual who commits fraud must perceive that an opportunity exists to commit the fraud, conceal it, and avoid punishment. An opportunity to commit fraud is often ­perceived when there is easy access to assets or when assets are poorly accounted for by an organization. Removing any one of the three elements of the fraud triangle makes it much less likely that fraud will occur. Consider the following examples: • No perceived pressure: An employee may see an opportunity to steal a company computer. He or she may even be able to justify taking the computer by telling himself or herself that the computer is an older one the company no longer uses. However, if he or she can afford to purchase a new computer, the employee will have a low incentive to commit fraud. • No rationalization: An employee may desperately need cash to pay overdue bills and may see a way to steal money without detection. However, the employee’s moral ­beliefs may make it impossible for him or her to justify taking the money. • No perceived opportunity: An employee may feel pressured to steal money to cover a gambling debt. He or she may rationalize the theft by convincing himself or h ­ erself that he or she will repay the company next month. However, if it is not p ­ ossible for the employee to steal money without detection, it is unlikely that he or she will commit fraud. This situation arises because the employee sees no opportunity to e­ ngage in fraudulent activity without discovery. Out of the three elements of the fraud triangle, a business can have the most influence over the element of perceived opportunity. A business generally has limited control over perceived pressure felt by an employee or an employee’s ability to rationalize unethical behavior. So, the most effective way for a business to prevent fraud is to reduce, or eliminate, the perceived opportunity for an employee to misappropriate company assets or for a manager to falsify financial information. Perceived opportunity can be reduced through a good system of internal control.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 301

03/04/14 1:57 PM

302

Chapter 6

What Is a Certified Public Accountant (CPA)? 4

Know what a Certified Public Accountant (CPA) is and does

Certified Public Accountant (CPA)  An accountant, licensed by a state, who serves the general public by auditing businesses and reporting whether the business’s financial statements are in accordance with Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP). American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA)  The professional organization that supports and improves the practice of public accounting in the United States. Internal audit (managerial ­audit)  An audit and assessment of a company’s compliance with laws and regulations, operating controls, and policies and procedures. An internal audit is performed by employees of the company. External audit  An audit of a company’s financial statements performed by independent Certified Public Accountants (CPAs).

Accountants in a company recognize, measure, record, and report business transactions in accordance with GAAP. But who validates that the accountants have done a good job and the information provided in financial reports is in accordance with GAAP? The answer is Certified Public Accountants (CPAs). A CPA is a person who has had extensive education and experience in the area of business and accounting. CPAs have passed a series of rigorous exams and must continuously update their education. CPAs are licensed to practice by states. To discover how to become a CPA, visit the Web sites of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants, referred to as the AICPA (www.aicpa.org) and the National Association of State Boards of Accountancy, referred to as NASBA (www.nasba.org).

Audits An audit is an examination of the validity and reliability of accounting information. Testing a business’s internal controls is a big part of an audit. Often, businesses use ­employees to conduct internal or managerial audits. However, businesses also hire external accountants to conduct audits. This external accountant must be a CPA and independent of the business. The purpose of an external audit is to assure users that a business’s financial statements conform to GAAP. The US Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) ­requires that all companies that sell stocks and bonds to the general public in the United States be audited by independent CPAs. Exhibit 6-3 illustrates a typical organizational chart of a large business and how the external auditor relates to management. CPAs who conduct external audits must use Generally Accepted Auditing Standards (GAAS). These standards were developed by the AICPA to ensure that ­auditors use good procedures and judgment.

Generally Accepted Auditing Standards (GAAS)  The procedures used by CPAs to audit companies. Board of Directors

External Auditing

Audit Committee

President

Vice President Production

Vice President Marketing

Treasurer: Custody of assets

Vice President Accounting and Finance

Other Vice Presidents

Controller: Accounting for assets

Internal Auditing

Exhibit 6-3

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 302

03/04/14 1:57 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

303

Audit Opinions Audit opinion  The opinion, issued by the CPA auditing a business, which indicates whether the financial ­statements are prepared in accordance with Generally Accepted Accounting Principles.

The outcome of an external audit is the issuance of an opinion by the independent CPA. Exhibit 6-4 describes the four different types of audit opinions. The CPA can issue one of four types of opinions. The CPA may issue: • • • •

An unqualified or “clean” opinion. A qualified or “except for” opinion. An adverse opinion. A disclaimer.

Type of Opinion

Reason Supporting the Opinion

Impact as a Result of the Opinion

Unqualified (also called a “clean” opinion)

An unqualified opinion means that, in the auditors’ opinion, the financial statements are fairly presented. In addition, they are free of material misstatements and have been prepared in accordance with Generally Accepted Accounting Principles, unless otherwise noted.

This is the best type of opinion. It gives the financial statement users assurance that the financial statements can be relied upon.

Qualified (also called an “except for” opinion)

A qualified opinion is issued when one of the following occurs: • The auditors have taken exception to an accounting application or treatment the company being audited used. • The auditors were unable to gather the information they felt was necessary in order to issue an unqualified opinion. • The auditors were unable to determine the outcome of an uncertainty, which could have an effect on the financial statements.

A qualified opinion includes a separate paragraph outlining the reason for the qualification. A qualified opinion is used to help financial statement users make more informed decisions about the company. It allows the auditor to bring to the attention of the users circumstances or situations that may affect the user’s reliance on the financial statements.

Adverse

By issuing an adverse opinion, the auditors are stating that in their opinion one of the following situations exists: • The financial statements are not fairly presented in accordance with GAAP. • There are material misstatements in the financial statements.

An adverse opinion will be accompanied by a paragraph explaining the reason for the negative opinion. An adverse opinion is very detrimental to a company as it basically informs users that the financial statements should not be relied upon.

Disclaimer

A disclaimer indicates that the auditors are unable to express an opinion based on their audit. A disclaimer of opinion may be issued because of the following: • A lack of independence on the auditors’ part. • The inability to obtain the evidence needed to support a different type of opinion. • The existence of substantial doubts regarding the business’s ability to continue as a “going concern.” • Material uncertainties for which the auditors are unable to determine the outcome.

Because the auditors are unable, or unwilling, to express an opinion on the financial statements, investors will give considerable thought before investing in a company that has been issued a disclaimer of opinion.

Exhibit 6-4 Decision makers, such as lenders and stockholders, use the audit opinion to decide whether they can rely on the financial statements. When an unqualified opinion is ­issued, users can have confidence that the financial statements report what the business has been doing. Look at Appendix A containing the Columbia Sportswear Annual Report. Look at the audit opinion which is located right before the financial statements. It looks complicated, but read it slowly. Notice how it talks about the audit. See how it concludes in an

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 303

03/04/14 1:57 PM

304

Chapter 6

unqualified or clean opinion. The CPA firm that audits Columbia Sportswear, Deloitte and Touche, certifies that the financial statements fairly present the financial position and results of operations in conformity with GAAP. If a CPA issues an incorrect opinion and users suffer losses, the users have the right to sue the CPA for damages. A CPA has a lot of responsibility.

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analysis

How do I know that I can rely on a ­business’s financial statements?

Look to see if a business’s financial statements have been audited by independent Certified Public Accountants.

Although unaudited financial statements are not ­necessarily unreliable, there is no third-party assurance that the information contained in the financial statements is accurate. Audited financial statements provide reasonable assurances that the information contained in the statements conforms to GAAP, is accurate, and can be relied upon.

What Are the Legal and Ethical Responsibilities of Accountants? 5

Know the legal and ethical responsibilities of an accountant, including the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (SOX)

Whistleblower  A person who ­reports illegal or unethical behavior.

Accountants are very important. Accountants have a lot of responsibility. The success or failure of a business depends on the decisions of its stakeholders. Those decisions are based on accounting information. Because of their importance, accountants have legal and ethical responsibilities. The law specifies the responsibilities of accountants and CPAs. Society also expects accountants to act ethically. Ethical behavior is conduct that requires adherence to higher standards than is required by law. The law states how we require people to act. Ethics state how we expect people to act. An example is an accountant who commits fraud. The law says this is illegal and specifies the penalties for committing the fraud. However, what happens if the accountant does not participate in the fraud, but suspects the fraud? We’d expect the accountant to inform the business’s stakeholders that fraud could be occurring. The accountant has not committed a crime. However, the accountant has committed an unethical act if he or she does not inform the stakeholders that they could lose money. A person who reports illegal or unethical behavior is often called a whistleblower. Doing the right thing is often hard. People sometimes feel pressure not to report illegal or unethical acts. What would you do if you saw a boss steal, knowing your boss had the ability to fire you? There are laws that protect whistleblowers. Look at the US Department of Labor’s Web site regarding the protection of whistleblowers (www.dol.gov/compliance/laws/comp-whistleblower.htm).

The Legal Responsibilities of Accountants Information is power. Accountants have information that others do not. Accountants must be very careful in what they do and say. How powerful are accountants? Think about it. What would you do if you, as the ­accountant, knew that a company was about to announce an unexpected increase in profit?

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 304

03/04/14 1:57 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

305

After announcing the profit, the price of the company’s stock would increase. You could make a lot of money by buying the stock before the information was announced and ­became public. That’s power. If you acted on information the general public did not have, you would be participating in insider trading, a form of fraud, which is against the law. Accountants that participate in fraud are subject to the same penalties as everyone else. They can be convicted. If convicted, accountants could be required to pay substantial amounts of money and, in some situations, go to jail. If the accountant is a CPA, he or she could lose his or her license to practice as a CPA.

Sarbanes-Oxley (SOX): Accountability of Accountants and Management Sarbanes-Oxley Act (SOX)  A law passed in 2002 by the US Congress requiring a business’s management to accept responsibility for providing the information needed by stakeholders outside the business. Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (PCAOB)  A private sector, nonprofit corporation that oversees the auditors of publicly traded companies. The PCAOB reports to the US Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC).

In response to a rash of accounting fraud cases, the United States enacted a special law in 2002 called the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (SOX). SOX requires a company’s management to take responsibility for a company’s financial statements. The Sarbanes-Oxley Act: • Applies to publicly traded companies. • Established the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (PCAOB). The PCAOB is a private sector, nonprofit corporation that oversees the auditors of publicly traded companies. The PCAOB protects the interests of investors by helping ensure that fair, independent audit reports are issued. The PCAOB reports to the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC). • Requires that external auditors report to an audit committee, rather than to an organization’s management. Prior to Sarbanes-Oxley, the external auditors often ­reported to a company’s upper management. • Requires that a company’s Chief Executive Officer (CEO) and Chief Financial Officer (CFO) certify all annual, or quarterly, reports filed by an organization. By signing the reports, the executives certify the following:

1. They have reviewed the report.



2. The report does not contain any materially untrue statements.



3. The financial statements and related information contained in the report fairly present the financial condition and the results of operations in all ­material respects of the organization.



4. The signing officers are responsible for internal controls, have evaluated these internal controls within the previous 90 days, and have reported on their findings.



5. They have disclosed: a. A list of all deficiencies in the internal controls and information on any fraud that involves employees who are involved with internal activities. b. Any significant changes in internal controls or related factors that could have a negative impact on the internal controls.



While SOX has been costly to implement for many companies, it has had a definite ­impact on improving internal controls in corporate America. As is true in any relationship, once trust has been broken, it takes time to rebuild. The implementation of SOX, along with the business community’s heightened awareness of the need for proper ethical behavior, has started to restore the public’s trust in corporate America.

Ethical Responsibilities of Accountants Ethics  The set of moral values an individual or society holds that specify how people and organizations should act.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 305

Ethics are the set of moral values an individual or society holds that specify how people

and organizations should act or behave. The law specifies the minimum level of behavior. An example is that you cannot steal. However, many decisions people face are not directly addressed by the law. The law cannot specify how people and organizations act in every situation. However, we expect people and organizations to act ethically, be fair, and do the right thing for all stakeholders.

03/04/14 1:57 PM

306

Chapter 6

Accountants are expected to have very high ethical standards. We expect accountants to be competent, objective, responsible, and concerned for the welfare of all stakeholders. We expect accountants to have integrity. The American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA) addresses these issues in its Code of Professional Conduct (www. aicpa.org/Research/Standards/CodeofConduct/Pages/default.aspx). Likewise, many states require CPAs to pass exams and participate in continuing education programs dealing with ethics. Accountants must make a lot of judgments. We must trust accountants to make good judgments and be responsible for their decisions. Accountants have considerable power. Accountants must know the law, abide by the law, and act ethically in all matters. Accountants must be trustworthy.

Focus on Decision Making “How Much Is the Business Worth?”

6

Know the difference between book value and market value of stockholders’ equity

How much is a business worth to its owners? Is it worth what the owners paid for the business? Is the business worth what the owners could receive if they sold the business? How should the accountant report the worth of the business? A balance sheet reports the value of what a business owns (assets) and how it ­finances those assets (liabilities and stockholders’ equity). Remember, the accounting equation states that assets equal liabilities plus stockholders’ equity. If we use algebra to rearrange the terms, we see that stockholders’ equity is equal to assets less liabilities. The value reported as stockholders’ equity is based on the values reported for assets and liabilities.

Stockholders’ Equity  Assets  Liabilities Book Value and Market Value of Stockholders’ Equity

Book value of stockholders’ ­equity  The book value of assets minus the book value of liabilities. The value reported on a company’s balance sheet for stockholders’ equity. Market value or market ­capitalization  The current market price per share times the number of shares outstanding.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 306

Using GAAP, accountants report most assets and liabilities at historical cost. The value of most assets is what the business paid for them. The value of most liabilities is the amount the business owed when the liabilities were incurred less any payments that have been made. The difference between assets and liabilities is stockholders’ equity. Stockholders’ equity reflects what the stockholders paid the business for the stock plus the profits retained in the business. This is called the book value of a company or the book value of stockholders’ equity. Book value is the value of stockholders’ equity reported on a balance sheet created using GAAP. Book value is the result of recording past transactions at historical costs. But how much would the stockholders receive if they sold the business in the current market? It’s probably not what the stockholders paid in the past. The amount stockholders expect to receive for their stock is based on the expected profits to be earned in the future. This amount is called the business’s market value or market capitalization. The market value of a business is what future owners will pay present owners for the business. That amount is based on the profits prospective owners believe the business will earn in the future. The market value of stockholders’ equity is equal to the market value of the assets less the market value of the liabilities. Now look back at the accounting standards provided by the IASB. Remember that these accounting standards use current or market values for assets and liabilities. This results in a reported value for stockholders’ equity that more closely reflects market value. Using US GAAP, the book value of stockholders’ equity is typically lower than the market value of stockholders’ equity. It’s because US GAAP is conservative and uses the cost principle. International accounting standards are less conservative and report stockholders’ equity at a value that is closer to market value.

03/04/14 1:58 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

307

How They Do It: A Look at Business

So is the difference between book and market values of stockholders’ equity big or small? The difference between book and market values can be very large. Let’s look at two examples, Google and McDonald’s. On December 31, 2012, Google’s reported book value of stockholders’ equity using US GAAP was $71.7 billion. Based on what you’d pay to buy a share of Google at the same time, the market value of Google’s stock was $239 billion. The market believes Google is worth almost twice what the balance sheet reports. The reason is that US GAAP is conservative and focuses on past transactions. The market is valuing Google based on the net income it believes Google will earn in the future. Now think about McDonald’s, the fast food restaurant company. On December 31, 2012, its reported book value of stockholders’ equity using US GAAP was $15.3 billion. Based on what you’d pay to buy a share of McDonald’s at the same time, the market value of its stock was $89.2 billion. The market believes McDonalds is worth almost four times what the balance sheet reports. Once again, the reason is book value reports the past while market value focuses on the future.

Summary MyAccountingLab

1

2

Understand the importance of US GAAP and how it differs from accounting standards in other countries (IFRS)

Understand the importance and role of internal control

Here is what you should know after reading this chapter. The Study Plan in MyAccountingLab will help you identify what you know and where to go when you need practice.

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

US accounting standards are designed to produce financial information that is understandable, relevant, and reliable. The Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) determines the standards used in the United States. US accounting standards are conservative, reporting most ­information using historical cost. Accounting standards differ around the world due to differences in culture and law. Many countries use accounting standards issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB). These standards are referred to as International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) and use current or market prices instead of historical costs.

Accounting Standards Codification (ASC) (p. 292)

Internal control is a comprehensive system that helps an organization safeguard assets, operate efficiently and effectively, ensure proper reporting of financial information, and ensure compliance with applicable laws and regulations.

Audit trail (p. 297)

Audit (p. 292) Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) (p. 292) Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP) (p. 291) International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) (p. 293) International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) (p. 293) Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) (p. 292)

Collusion (p. 298) Control activities (p. 296) Control environment (p. 296) Internal control (p. 295) Risk assessment (p. 296)

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 307

03/04/14 1:58 PM

308

3

Chapter 6

Define fraud and describe the different types of fraud in business

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Fraud is deception or trickery for personal gain. There are many types of fraud, but in the business world it is committed by a business or against a business. For fraud to occur there must be perceived pressure, rationalization, and perceived opportunity.

Bribe (p. 300) Cash register schemes (p. 299) Check tampering (p. 299) Disbursement schemes (p. 299) Employee embezzlement (p. 299) Expense schemes (p. 299) Fraud (p. 299) Fraud triangle (p. 300) Kickback (p. 300) Management fraud (p. 299) Perceived opportunity (p. 301) Perceived pressure (p. 300) Rationalization (p. 301)

4

Know what a Certified Public Accountant (CPA) is and does

In the United States, a CPA is a highly educated accounting professional who has the ability to audit a business and attest to whether the business’s financial statements fairly present the financial condition and results of operations of the business. A CPA is licensed by the state and must be independent of the business.

American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA) (p. 302) Audit opinion (p. 303) Certified Public Accountant (CPA) (p. 302) External audit (p. 302) Generally Accepted Auditing Standards (GAAS) (p. 302) Internal or managerial audit (p. 302)

5

6

Know the legal and ethical responsibilities of an accountant, including the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (SOX)

Know the difference between book value and market value of stockholders’ equity

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 308

Because accountants are very important, they must act legally and ethically. Accountants control information, and information is power. The Sarbanes-Oxley Act is a very important law that specifies the legal responsibilities of accountants and the penalties they face if they do not meet their obligations.

Ethics (p. 305)

The book value of a business’s stockholders’ equity is often different than the market value of the business’s stockholders’ equity. The reason is US GAAP is conservative and is designed not to overstate the value of a business.

Book value of stockholders’ equity (p. 306)

Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (PCAOB) (p. 305) Sarbanes-Oxley Act (SOX) (p. 305) Whistleblower (p. 304)

Market capitalization (p. 306) Market value (p. 306)

03/04/14 1:58 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

309

Accounting Practice Discussion Questions 1. Can ethics be taught in the college classroom? Why or why not? 2. What motivates people to commit fraud? 3. What is management fraud? What is employee fraud? Give some examples of each. 4. What is a fraud triangle, and why is it important? 5. Do you think the risk factors for management fraud are the same as the risk factors for employee fraud? Why or why not? 6. What is the control environment? Discuss how the control environment had a strong influence over a situation with which you are personally familiar (e.g., a place where you work, your family, your living group in college, a classroom, etc.). 7. What part of the fraud triangle is most closely associated with the control activities ­component of internal control? That is, if control activities are improved, which corner of the fraud triangle is most affected? Why? 8. What are the implications of the fact that every internal control structure has inherent limitations? That is, how does the knowledge that no internal control structure is perfect help management run the organization more effectively? 9. What effect does the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 have on the role and influence of the CEO in a corporation? 10. What is the difference between a rules-based system and a principles-based system of accounting rules? Under what circumstances would each be preferable? How does the distinction apply to the comparison of US GAAP to IFRS?

Self Check 1. Which of the following is not one of the key elements common to most frauds? a. Perceived pressure b. Perceived inequality c. Perceived opportunity d. Rationalization 2. The fraud triangle includes all of the following except for ______________. a. validation b. perceived opportunity c. rationalization d. perceived pressure 3. Internal control is a. the act of stealing a business’s assets. b. the process that helps a business achieve its objectives, such as operating efficiently and effectively. c. the reconciliation of the bank’s cash balance to the book’s cash balance. d. the preparation of fraudulent financial statements. 4. Which of the following is not an element of an internal control system? a. Monitoring b. Information and communication c. The control environment d. Auditing

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 309

03/04/14 1:58 PM

310

Chapter 6 5. Which of the following factors creates an opportunity for fraud? a. Greed b. Living beyond one’s means c. Lack of an audit trail d. The organization owes it to me 6. Which of the following is not a control activity? a. Proper authorization b. Security measures c. Risk assessment d. Mandatory vacations 7. Darice Goodrich receives cash from customers as part of her job duties. Her other duty is to post the receipts to customer accounts receivable. Based on these duties, her company has (a) weak a. disbursement schemes. b. fraud triangle. c. ethics. d. separation of duties. 8. Which of the following is not a limitation of internal control? a. Rationalization b. Tired employees c. Poorly designed controls d. Collusion 9. Internal auditors focus on _____; external auditors are more concerned with _____. (Fill in the blanks.) a. financial statements; laws and regulations b. company policies and procedures; financial statements c. e-commerce; fraud d. financial statements; risk assessment 10. Which of the following is false regarding the Sarbanes-Oxley act? a. It requires that external auditors report to the company president. b. It established the PCAOB. c. It applies to publicly traded companies. d. It requires that the company CEO certify annual reports. 11. According to the Real World Accounting Video, Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP) provide all of the following except ______________. a. standardization b. investor confidence c. comparability d. confusion 12. According to the Real World Accounting Video, CPAs are very special people in the accounting world. The initials CPA stand for ______________. a. Chartered Public Auditor b. Certified Public Accountant c. Certified Pubic Auditor d. Commerce Practicing Accountant Answers are given after Written Communication.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 310

03/04/14 1:58 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

MyAccountingLab

311

Short Exercises S6-1. Match the following five items (a-e) with the definitions provided below (1-5) a. Risk assessment b. Monitoring c. Information and communication d. Control environment e. Control activities

_____ 1. The actions, policies, and procedures that reflect the overall attitudes of top management, directors, and owners of an entity regarding internal control and its importance to the entity.

_____ 2. Policies and procedures that help ensure that necessary actions are taken to address risks in the achievement of the entity’s objectives.

_____ 3. Management’s ongoing and periodic assessment of the quality of internal control performance to determine that controls are operating as intended and are modified when needed.

_____ 4. Management’s identification and analysis of risks relevant to the preparation of financial statements in accordance with an applicable accounting framework.

_____ 5. The purpose of the entity’s system is to initiate, record, process, and report the entity’s transactions and to maintain accountability for the related assets. S6-2. Fraud triangle (Learning Objective 3) 5–10 min. Identify each of the following as an example of a perceived pressure (P), perceived ­opportunity (O), or rationalization (R) in the fraud triangle:

_____ 1. Job dissatisfaction _____ 2. Greed _____ 3. “It’s for a good purpose.” _____ 4. Weak internal control _____ 5. Gambling addiction S6-3. Internal controls (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Internal controls are designed to safeguard assets, encourage employees to follow company policies, promote operational efficiency, and ensure accurate records. Which objective is most important? What must the internal controls accomplish for the business to survive? Give your reason.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 311

03/04/14 1:58 PM

312

Chapter 6 S6-4. Internal controls (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Indicate by letters which of the following control activities match with the following descriptions: Separation of duties (SD) Restricted access (RA) Proper authorization (PA) Adequate documents and records (ADR)

_____ 1. Pre-numbered invoices _____ 2. Locking inventory in a warehouse _____ 3. Manager approval of sales returns _____ 4. Password protection of accounting software _____ 5. Not allowing the accounts payable clerk to sign checks S6-5. Internal controls (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Explain in your own words why separation of duties is often described as the cornerstone of internal control for safeguarding assets. Describe what can happen if the same person has custody of an asset and also accounts for the asset. S6-6. Fraud triangle (Learning Objective 3) 5–10 min. Look at each of the following employees of Anthony’s Restaurant. Which of the ­elements of the fraud triangle apply? Perceived pressure (P) Perceived opportunity (O) Rationalization (R)

_____ 1. As the bartender puts $20 in tips in her pocket, she thinks, “Nobody will get hurt.”

_____ 2. Jim uses money stolen from the company to pay for his m ­ other’s high ­medical bills.

_____ 3. Kirk knows he will be fired if he doesn’t record some fictitious sales. _____ 4. Trish, the night shift manager, knows that upper management does not monitor internal control.

_____ 5. Alan, a waiter, drove to work in a BMW and bragged about his recent ­vacation to Hawaii.

_____ 6. Brian, a cashier for the past five years, was caught stealing cash. When ­ uestioned about the theft, he said that he had not received a promotion q and deserved more pay.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 312

03/04/14 1:58 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

313

S6-7. Internal controls (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Identify each of the following as an internal control objective (O), an internal control activity (A), or a limitation of internal control (L).

_____   1. Separation of duties _____   2. Collusion _____   3. Proper authorization _____   4. Report financial information properly _____  5. Mandatory vacations _____  6. Management override _____  7. Complies with laws and regulations _____  8. Adequate documents and records _____  9. Poorly designed controls _____ 10. Operates efficiently and effectively S6-8. Internal controls (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Peter’s Hardware maintains the following policies/procedures with regard to internal control. Indicate by letter which of the following control activities applies to each of the following policies/procedures: _____ 1. E very day, all checks written are recorded in the accounting records using the ­information on the check stubs.

a. Proper authorization

_____ 2. T he store utilizes electronic theft detection systems.

c. Restricted access

_____ 3. P urchases of new equipment must be ­approved by the store manager.

e. Separation of duties

b. A  dequate documents and records d. Security measures

_____ 4. D  aily sales are recorded in the accounting records by someone other than the sales associates. _____ 5. T he company maintains passwords that limit access to its computerized accounting records. S6-9. Internal controls (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. The following situations suggest a strength or a weakness in internal control. Identify each as a strength or weakness, and give the reason for your answer. a. All employees must take at least five consecutive days off each year. b. The accounting department orders merchandise and approves invoices for payment. c. Cash received over the counter is controlled by the sales clerk, who rings up the sale and places the cash in the register. The daily sales are recorded in the accounting records by the accounting department. d. The officer who signs the checks need not examine the payment packet because he is confident the amounts are correct.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 313

03/04/14 1:58 PM

314

Chapter 6 S6-10. Internal controls (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Identify the missing internal control in the following situations. Select from these activities:

• Proper authorization • Separation of duties • Adequate documents and records a. While reviewing the records of Discount Drug, you find that the same employee ­orders merchandise and approves invoices for payment. b. Business is slow at Play Time Amusement Park on Tuesday, Wednesday, and Thursday nights. To reduce expenses, the owner decides not to use a ticket taker on those nights. The ticket seller is told to keep the tickets as a record of the number sold. c. When business is brisk, Shop Mart does not give customers a written receipt unless they ask for it. d. Lynne has worked for Watkins Electric Supply for more than 12 years. Due to her length of employment, she has been allowed to grant sales returns at her discretion. e. At a grocery store, the manager decides to reduce paperwork. He eliminates the ­requirement that the receiving department prepare a receiving report. S6-11. Fraud and internal controls (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 15–20 min. Each of the following situations has an internal control weakness. a. Crystal Lund has been your trusted employee for 25 years. She performs all ­cash-handling and accounting duties. Crystal just purchased a new Lexus and a new home in an expensive suburb. As owner of the company, you wonder how she can afford these luxuries because you pay her only $42,000 a year and she has no sources of outside income. b. Sanchez Hardwoods allows its sales staff to grant credit to any customer. As a result, it has had several large write-offs in Accounts Receivable recently. c. The office supply company where Power’s Sporting Goods purchases its business forms recently notified Power’s Sporting Goods that its documents were no longer going to be pre-numbered. Bill Powers, the owner, replied that he never uses the receipt numbers anyway. d. Discount stores, such as Target, make most of their sales in cash, with the remainder in credit card sales. To reduce expenses, one store manager allows the cashiers to record sales in the accounting records. Identify the missing internal control in each situation. Answers should include authorization, documentation, and separation of duties. Identify the possible problem caused by each control weakness. Answers should include theft and financial loss. Propose a solution to each internal control problem.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 314

03/04/14 1:58 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

315

S6-12. Accounting terminology (Learning Objectives 1 & 4) 5–10 min. Place the corresponding letter of the definition next to the term.

_____  1. Unqualified opinion _____  2. Audit _____  3. IFRS _____  4. GAAP _____  5. External audit _____  6. CPA _____  7. FASB _____  8. Qualified opinion _____  9. IASB _____10. GAAS a. An audit opinion that brings attention to special circumstances. b. Accounting standards issued by FASB and used in the United States. c. Auditing standards developed by the AICPA. d. Issues accounting standards that are used in the United States. e. An audit performed by an independent CPA. f. An examination of the financial statements. g. An accountant who is licensed to practice by one of the states. h. Issues accounting standards that are utilized internationally. i. An audit opinion that states that the financial statements are fairly presented. j. International accounting standards issued by the IASB. S6-13. Sarbanes-Oxley Act (Learning Objective 5) 20–25 min. What are the main provisions of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act? Be specific. S6-14. IFRS (Learning Objective 1) 20–25 min. Describe the major differences between US GAAP and International Financial Reporting Standards.

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem Return to Target’s 2012 annual report. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem in Chapter 2. Now, answer the following questions: 1. Look at Target’s latest audit opinion. It can be found on page 31 of Target’s 2012 annual report. Which CPA firm audits Target? Is its audit opinion unqualified, qualified, adverse, or a disclaimer? 2. What does the auditor’s opinion say about the accounting standards used by Target? What does the opinion say about how the audit was conducted? What does the audit opinion say about Target’s internal control? 3. Look at management’s statement on internal control found on page 32 of the ­financial statements, found in Target’s annual report. Look at the auditor’s statement on internal control found on that same page. What do these s­tatements tell you? 4. Look at Target’s balance sheet as of February 2, 2013. Do Target’s financial ­statements reflect current or historical values? What is the value of stockholders’ equity reported on the latest balance sheet? On the same date as the latest financial ­statements, Target’s stock sold for approximately $60 per share for a total market value of approximately $40 billion. Why is there a difference? 5. Look over Target’s financial statements and footnotes. Look at your answers to questions 1 through 4 above. Do you think Target’s financial statements are ­ understandable, relevant, and reliable?

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 315

03/04/14 1:58 PM

316

Chapter 6

Apply Your Knowledge Ethics in Action Case 1. Roberto needed a summer job and was lucky enough to land a position as a ticket ­collector at a local amusement park. On his first day, he was assigned to work alongside Suzanne who had worked at the park for the past two summers. Suzanne explained to Roberto that tickets are purchased from the box office outside the gate and that park-goers present their tickets at the gate when they are ready to enter. Each ticket has a stub that is torn off and given back to the park-goer so they can leave and return the same day. Roberto decided this was not going to be a bad summer job considering that one of the “perks” of working at the park was that on his days off he could enter the park free. However, he had remembered from reading the employee handbook that only employees were admitted free. Any friends or family accompanying the employee must pay full price. Suzanne showed Roberto the gate that employees used on their days off. She said, “Just swipe your employee ID card through the card reader on the outside of the gate, and you are in the park.” Soon after Roberto started working at the park, he began to notice that many of the ­employees would hold the employee gate open while their friends and family entered without purchasing a ticket. One day, Roberto asked Suzanne about what he had seen. Suzanne replied, “Oh, nobody around here follows that policy. Last week I even saw the park superintendent come in with his entire family without paying.” A few weeks later on one of his days off, Roberto was hanging out with his friends when one of them said, “Hey Roberto, since you are working at the amusement park, can’t you get us all in free today?” Roberto thought about how much more fun it would be to go to the park with his friends and he began to reason, “Why should I follow the rules if no one else does, not even the park superintendent? Anyway, it’s not like I would really be stealing anything.” Requirement 1. What are the ethical considerations in this case? Case 2. Ali Jamison is the controller at Williams Supply Company, a publicly traded distributor of automotive supplies. It is the end of the third quarter, and Ali is working under a deadline to get the quarterly financial statements prepared before the board of directors meeting at 2 p.m. The board of directors approves the quarterly financial statements before they are sent to the Securities and Exchange Commission. Unfortunately, Ali has a bit of a problem. The debit and credit columns of the general ledger trial balance do not balance. She is certain that this is a simple mistake that someone made in recording a journal entry, but she just doesn’t have time to look for the mistake. In order to make the deadline, Ali decides to force the trial balance into balance by adding the $85,000 that she is out of balance to the Inventory account. Because inventory is the company’s largest asset, Ali justified her actions by thinking that this wouldn’t make a difference to anyone looking at the ­financial statements. She wished she had more time to look for the mistake, but the clock is ­ticking away. Requirement 1. Is there any evidence of unethical behavior in this case? Explain your answer. Case 3. Sam Olson is the manager of a Stop and Go convenience store. He has been employed by the company for 14 years, the last 4 years as a store manager. Sam applied for a promotion to regional manager, who oversees all 30 store locations, but was once again denied promotion. Had he been promoted, the regional manager salary would have given Sam $18,000 more per year. Sam was upset and decided that if the company would not give him the additional compensation he deserved, then he would give himself a raise at the expense of the company. He knew that whenever he hired a new employee, the required paperwork sent to the corporate headquarters was simply filed without being reviewed. Thus, Sam completed all the company employment forms for a fictitious new employee he named “Jim Simpson.” He figured that, when the

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 316

03/04/14 1:58 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

317

company was notified by the Social Security Administration that the Social Security number for “Jim Simpson” was fraudulent, Sam would simply report that the employee had just quit and that he had no way to contact him. Sam’s scheme involved the following actions:

• He put “Jim” on the schedule. • Every week, he submitted a signed timecard for “Jim” along with all the other l­egitimate employee timecards.

• Every two weeks when Sam received the employee paychecks, he pulled “Jim’s” paycheck and hid it in his briefcase.

• He then cashed the paycheck for “Jim” and enjoyed the extra money. Requirement 1. While Sam’s actions are clearly unethical, were they justified, given that he was again denied a promotion and therefore undercompensated? Will Sam be caught? Does the company bear some responsibility, too? If the company required direct deposit of its employee paychecks, could this type of fraud be prevented? Can you recommend any other procedures the company could adopt that would help to prevent Sam’s fraud? Case 4. PDQ, Inc., is a supplier of residence alarm systems to building contractors. Charlie Roberts, the company’s new CEO, is out to make a name for himself and makes it known to his management team that he plans for the company to meet, if not exceed, its sales target each quarter. Charlie begins to realize that the company is falling short of its goal, and he quickly calls a management meeting to announce his new plan. He says he has arranged sweet deals with several of the company’s largest customers. PDQ will pay the contractors a 2% fee to buy a large quantity of alarm systems just before the end of each quarter, with the understanding that PDQ will buy the alarm systems back shortly after the beginning of the next quarter. Charlie uses the term “buy” loosely because there is no plan for an exchange of cash. PDQ will record the sales transactions by debiting Accounts Receivable, crediting Sales Revenue, debiting Cost of Goods Sold, and crediting Inventory. When the alarm systems are bought back, PDQ will debit Inventory and credit Accounts Receivable, which, of course, will have no impact on the income statement. Beth Dawson, the company’s accountant, tells Charlie that there is a problem with his plan. She explains that under Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP), PDQ has not earned revenue until inventory is delivered to customers. Charlie quickly responds that he has everything under control. He explains to Beth that the contractors have agreed to accept automatic shipments of the alarm systems and carry them in the company’s inventory as of quarter-end. Charlie says this is a “win-win” situation for everyone. The plan did exactly what Charlie hoped it would do. The company reported sales that consistently exceeded expectations. These inflated sales figures helped to boost the company’s stock price to an all-time high. Charlie considered himself a true winner. His compensation package included a lucrative stock bonus plan tied to the company’s sales growth. As a result of the company’s reported sales revenue, Charlie received stock in the company that he was able to sell for thousands of dollars at the inflated stock price. Requirements 1. Is there any evidence of unethical behavior in this case? Explain your answer. 2. Other than Charlie and the contractors, who could be harmed by Charlie’s plan? Case 5. Jennifer Sims was hired as the new store manager for BargainHunter. The store used four cash registers, and 10 cashiers worked various shifts in the store. Store operations include the following procedures:

• At the start of each shift, a cashier counts the beginning cash balance in the drawer, which is supposed to be $600.

• At the end of each shift, the cashier does the following: 1.  Counts the ending cash balance in the drawer and adds to it any amounts dropped in the safe.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 317

03/04/14 1:58 PM

318

Chapter 6 2.  Completes the shift cash form that reconciles the cash received to the total register sales tape. 3.  Reports any difference between the cash on hand and the cash that should be on hand based on receipts. As a manager, Jennifer was responsible for preparing the cash drawers for each shift. She decided to test the honesty of the cashiers, so she added an additional $25 to the beginning balance of one cash drawer. Jennifer planned to look at the shift cash form to see whether the cashier reported the extra $25 that was part of the beginning balance or just reported the $600 expected balance, taking the $25 for personal use. Jennifer also tested her assistant manager. She gave him the bank deposit bag containing $5,246.24, but included a deposit ticket that was exactly $50 less, listing $5,196.24 as the ­deposit amount. Jennifer wanted to see whether the assistant manager would report the extra $50 in the deposit bag. Jennifer planned to never let her employees or even her assistant manager know that she had tested them; instead, she would just say that she made a simple mistake in counting the cash if they questioned her. Requirement 1. Should Jennifer distrust her employees? Is it ethical for a manager to test ­employees without their knowledge? Should Jennifer ever inform the employees that they had been tested? Was it ethical for Jennifer to test an assistant manager? Case 6. Assume that you were recently hired as a staff accountant for Advanced Energy Solutions, Inc. You report to Tina, the director of financial reporting, who in turn reports to the CFO. One of your first assignments is to prepare the adjusting entries for the end of the second quarter and to draft the income statement. Tina instructs you to let her know as soon as you have the estimated earnings for the quarter. She says she will need to review the adjusting entries and earnings calculation with the CFO. After reviewing your work with the CFO, Tina tells you to change the entry that you recorded for depreciation expense on the company’s fleet of trucks from $234,000 to $194,000. At first you thought that you must have made some mistake in calculating the amount of depreciation, so you recheck your calculations. Surprisingly, you come up with the same amount again. So, tactfully, you ask Tina for an explanation for the change. She tells you that depreciation is only an estimate and that the CFO will change his mind about estimates based on earnings. Requirements 1. What is the effect of the change in the amount of the depreciation expense on the company’s second-quarter earnings? 2. What is the ethical dilemma that you face? 3. What are the alternatives that you might consider, and what are the potential ­consequences of each alternative? 4. What are some of the common excuses used to rationalize unethical behavior? Case 7. Kelly Straton, a trusted employee of Simpson Supply Company, found himself in a difficult financial situation. His son’s college tuition had to be paid in full by the end of the month. The family had experienced some unexpected expenses, and the money was just not there to pay the tuition. Kelly knew his son could not register for classes until the tuition was paid and classes filled quickly, so this could cause his son not to get the classes that he needed to graduate on time. Kelly considered himself a “true company man” who never missed work and was always willing to work until the job was finished. Although he had been with the company for 12 years and was entitled to two weeks vacation per year, Kelly never found time to take vacation. Because of his loyalty to the company over the years, he knew that his boss would probably lend him the money that he needed for his son’s tuition, but he just couldn’t bring himself to ask his boss for a loan. As Kelly thought about the situation, he realized how simple it would be for him to

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 318

03/04/14 1:58 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

319

“borrow” some money from the company to help him through these rough times and pay it back before anyone noticed. Kelly was responsible for all of the bookkeeping functions, plus opening the mail, counting the cash in the registers at the end of the day, and making the daily bank deposit. With these combined duties, Kelly found it fairly simple to give himself a “loan.” He removed $3,500 in cash from the cash register and replaced it with a $3,500 check from the incoming mail that day. The check was from a customer who was paying his or her account in full. Kelly made a journal entry crediting Accounts Receivable to clear the customer’s account, but rather than debiting Cash, he debited Inventory. Kelly knew that inventory was not counted and reconciled until year-end. This would give Kelly plenty of time to get the “loan” repaid before anyone noticed. Requirements 1. What are the ethical considerations in this case? 2. Discuss the primary internal control weakness in this case that could have contributed to Kelly’s actions. Case 8. You are the controller for Pro Clean Services, a company that provides janitorial services to large commercial customers. The company has been very successful during its first two years of operations, but in order to expand its customer base, the company is in need of additional capital to be used for equipment purchases. The two brothers who started the business, Adam and Tim Olson, invested their life savings in the business, so they have contacted a local bank about securing a loan for $175,000. The bank has asked for a set of financial statements, and Adam, being the business­person that he is, knows that the bank is going to be looking for a growth in earnings each year. Although the company’s earnings have increased, Adam would like the past year to look better than it does now. Adam stops by your office late in the afternoon on December 31 to find out when the ­financial statements will be ready. You explain that you still have to close out the end of the year, but should have them ready by the end of the week. Adam tells you that he is aware of a major contract that Tim is working on that will be signed on January 3 and asks you to delay the closing process a few days so the new contract can be included in this year’s operating results. You attempt to explain to Adam that you cannot do that, but you can tell that he is not listening to you. Adam interrupts by saying, “I don’t know why you accountants get so worked up over a few days. Let me just say that it would be in your best interest to include this contract in the current year’s operating results.” Adam leaves your office in a hurry, and you hear him mutter under his breath as he turns the corner, “That accountant—who does he think he is trying to tell me how to run my business?” Requirements 1. What are the accounting issues related to Adam’s request? 2. What is the ethical issue involved in this case? 3. What would be the appropriate course of action for you to take?

Know Your Business Financial Analysis Purpose: To help familiarize you with the financial reporting of a real company in order to further your understanding of the chapter material you are learning. The annual report of Columbia Sportswear in Appendix A contains much more information than what is reported in the financial statements and related footnotes. In this case, you will ­ explore other information presented in the annual report in order to determine the responsibilities of both management and the independent auditors for the annual report content. In addition, you will investigate the respective roles of both management and the auditors in the company’s internal control system.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 319

03/04/14 1:58 PM

320

Chapter 6 Refer to the Columbia Sportswear Annual Report in Appendix A. You will need to find and then read the following reports:

• Management’s Report on the Consolidated Financial Statements (Item 8) • Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Consolidated Financial Statements (Item 8)

• Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting (Item 9A) • Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Internal Control over Financial Reporting (Item 9A) Requirements 1. Who is responsible for the information in the annual report? Who is responsible for recommending the independent accountants to the Board of Directors? 2. Who were the independent auditors? Under what standards did they conduct their audit? What was their opinion of the audited financial statements? 3. Who is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting? Is the effectiveness of the internal controls ever reviewed? Do you think that internal control procedures are necessary? Why? 4. Do the auditors have any responsibility with respect to the internal controls? What was the auditor’s opinion regarding the management assessment of internal control effectiveness?

Industry Analysis Purpose: To help you understand and compare the performance of two companies in the same industry. Find the Columbia Sportswear Company Annual Report located in Appendix A and go to the section titled “Design and Evaluation of Internal Control Over Financial Reporting” in Item 9A starting on page 720. Now access the 2012 Annual Report for Under Armour, Inc., from the Internet. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Industry Analysis in Chapter 1. In item 8 On page 46 of the annual report, you’ll find a section titled “Report of Management on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting” where the company’s controls and procedures are discussed. Requirement 1. Compare the two annual reports as they relate to their disclosure of internal ­control procedures and the system of internal control.

Small Business Analysis Purpose: To help you understand the importance of cash flows in the operation of a small business. You’re having a tough time figuring out why your actual cash is always coming up less than the amount that the general ledger says should be there. You would hate to think that any of your employees would be stealing from you because they have all been with you since you opened the business five years ago. But maybe it’s time to do a little investigative work. After all, cash is the lifeblood of the business, and if it’s being misappropriated, you need to find out fast! You start to think back over some of the observations you’ve made recently and some of the conversations you’ve overheard, and one startling conclusion is staring you in the face. Julie’s been a good employee, but lately she’s been bragging about her wild weekends and some of the gambling casinos she’s been going to. Julie never used to be like that. You overheard one of her fellow employees ask her where she’s getting all this money, and she said that her husband just got a really good raise at his job and they’re celebrating. Then just last week, Julie drove to work in a new sports car and again you overheard her tell someone about the great deal her brotherin-law got for her on this car.

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 320

03/04/14 1:58 PM

The Challenges of Accounting: Standards, Internal Control, Audits, Fraud, and Ethics

321

Julie is in charge of accounts payable, billing, and collecting. Because your office is so small, you always felt like these jobs could be done more efficiently by the same person. You also ­remember that Julie’s uncle is one of your vendors and there was that situation last year where you discovered a double billing from her uncle’s company. When you brought it to Julie’s ­attention, she immediately admitted her error and took care of it. Requirement 1. Respond to the following: You are wondering whether you should call Julie into your office and have a talk with her or just observe a little bit more to see if you can discover any irregularities in Julie’s area.

Written Communication You’ve been asked by your boss to write a brief description of what the control activities should be that are a part of the development of a strong internal control system in your office. You know that the office is small in terms of personnel, which does create some control problems. So, your boss has also asked you to make some recommendations on ways to strengthen any weaknesses that you discover in the internal control system. Self Check Answers 1. b 2. a 3. b 4. d 5. c 6. c 7. d 8. a 9. b 10. a 11. d 12. b

M06_KEMP9543_03_GE_C06.indd 321

03/04/14 1:58 PM

7 Cash and Receivables Business, Accounting, and You Learning Objectives 1 Discuss internal controls for cash and prepare a bank reconciliation

2 Report cash on the balance sheet

3 Identify the different types of receivables and discuss related internal controls for accounts receivable

Walk into a candy store. Look at customers buying candy such as Hershey chocolate bars or Hershey chocolate kisses. Stop at the front of the store and watch the employees operating cash registers. What are they doing? They are helping customers to pay for products. Now, look at how customers are paying for their purchases. They often pay with cash or credit cards. A credit card is a promise to pay cash in the future. It’s a receivable to the candy store. Hopefully, it’s a good receivable and the candy store will collect the entire amount when it is due. Now think about Hershey, the candy manufacturer. Hershey sold the candy to the candy store. The candy store bought the candy with a promise to pay Hershey in the future. Hershey has a receivable from the candy store. That receivable may or may not be good. The candy store may or may not pay Hershey.

4 Use the direct write-off and allowance methods to account for uncollectible accounts

5 Report accounts receivable on the balance sheet

6 Account for notes receivable

7 Calculate the current ratio, quick ratio, accounts receivable turnover, and receivable collection period

8 (Appendix 7A) Account for the petty cash fund 322

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 322

03/04/14 5:21 PM

Cash and Receivables

323

So what does the candy store do with its cash? The candy store uses its cash to pay its bills. The candy store must pay for the candy it purchased from Hershey, the wages it owes its employees, and the other liabilities that it incurs to operate. If it cannot pay its bills, it cannot stay in business. Being in business is about taking risks. Managing cash is a very important part of managing risk. Accountants use accrual accounting to recognize, measure, record, and report business transactions. But managing cash and the promise of future cash is very ­important in operating a successful business. Business is about earning net income, but to earn net income, you need to be able to pay the bills. As an accountant or manager, you need to understand how businesses account for cash transactions and receivables. In earlier chapters, we have seen that net income is the result of deducting all of a business’s expenses from its revenues. Therefore, it makes sense that in order to increase net income a business must either reduce its expenses or increase its revenues. The choice of what methods of payment a business is willing to accept from its customers can have a significant effect on the amount of revenue it is able to generate. The method of payment a business accepts is determined by the type of sales it makes.

Real World Accounting Video In the Real World Accounting Video, Zachary Mack, owner and founder of Alphabet City Beer Company, talks about operating a business. Look at the video. Think about what Zachary is saying. Now realize how important cash management is to the success of a business.

What Are the Different Types of Sales? Cash Sales Cash sales are the most desirable form of sales because the business receives cash ­immediately upon delivering goods or services. Cash sales are also the easiest type to track because customers hand over currency or a check at the time of sale. The business does not need to keep records of the individual customers. As demonstrated in earlier chapters, a cash sale is recorded as follows (assume the sale amount is $500 and ignore cost of goods sold):

DATE

ACCOUNTS Cash Sales

POST REF.

DR. 500

CR. 500

Although cash sales are easy to account for, businesses may limit their sales potential by not providing options for customers to buy now and pay later.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 323

03/04/14 5:21 PM

324

Chapter 7

Credit Card Sales Accepting credit cards as an alternative to cash helps businesses attract more customers. There are two main types of credit cards: • Credit cards issued by a financial institution such as a bank or a credit union. The most common types of these cards are Visa and MasterCard. • Credit cards issued by a credit card company. Discover and American Express are the most common credit card companies. One of the primary benefits of credit cards is that they allow customers to buy now and pay later. Retailers who accept credit card payments do not have to worry about collecting from the customer or keeping accounts receivable records because the entity that ­issued the card bears the responsibility of collecting the amounts due from the customers. Instead of collecting cash from the customer, the retailer will receive payment from the issuer of the card. Another benefit of credit card sales is that they facilitate purchases made via telephone or online due to the fact that no cash has to change hands at the time of sale. One drawback to accepting credit card payments is that retailers typically pay a service fee to cover the cost of processing the transactions.

Debit Card Sales Businesses can also attract customers by accepting debit card payments in addition to cash and credit card payments. From the retailer’s perspective, debit cards are nearly identical to credit cards and have the same benefits and drawbacks. The primary difference between a debit card and a credit card is how and when the cardholder must pay the card issuer.

Credit/Debit Card Processing Most businesses hire a third party to process credit and debit card transactions. As previously mentioned, there is a fee associated with credit and debit card transactions; the fees vary depending on the type of card processed and the specific agreement the business has with the card processor. The agreement also specifies when and how fees are paid. The most common methods of fee payment are: • The fees are deducted from the proceeds of each sale at the time the sale proceeds are deposited into the business’s bank account. • The fees for all transactions processed are deducted from the business’s bank account on a monthly basis. Proceeds from credit and debit card transactions are typically deposited into a business’s bank account within a one- to three-day period after the sale. Therefore, credit and debit card sales are journalized in a manner similar to cash sales. Assume a business has credit/debit card transactions that total $500 for the day and that $8 of ­processing fees are deducted from the proceeds. The journal entry to record the day’s card sales is: DATE

ACCOUNTS Cash Service Fee Expense Sales

POST REF.

DR. 492 8

CR.

500

The expense associated with processing the transactions is recorded at the same time the sale proceeds are recorded. Now, assume that instead of having the processing fees ­deducted from the sales proceeds, the business has the fees deducted from its bank

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 324

03/04/14 5:21 PM

Cash and Receivables

325

account at the end of each month. The journal entry to record the day’s card sales would now look like this: DATE

ACCOUNTS Cash Sales

POST REF.

DR. 500

CR. 500

Notice that this entry is exactly the same as the entry required for cash sales. The ­expense associated with processing the transactions will be recorded at the time a statement is received from the processor or at the time the monthly bank reconciliation is prepared.

Sales on Account Bad debt  An account receivable that is unable to be collected; also called an uncollectible account.

In Chapter 4, we discussed sales of merchandise on account. When businesses agree to sell on credit, sales increase, but so does the risk of not being able to collect what is owed as a result of these sales. Accordingly, companies bear the risk of bad debts, or uncollectible accounts, which occur when a customer does not pay for the goods or services it received. Regardless of its size, a business must manage its customer relationships to avoid bad debts. We will account for bad debts later in the chapter.

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analyze

Should a company accept forms of payment other than cash?

A business needs to weigh the costs of accepting alternative forms of payment against the income generated by increased sales.

When a company accepts alternative forms of payment, it incurs additional costs. If those costs exceed the additional income generated from increased sales, then it is not in the best interest of the company to accept alternative forms of payment.

What Internal Control Procedures Should Be Used for Cash? 1

Discuss internal controls for cash and prepare a bank reconciliation

Regardless of whether sales are cash sales, credit/debit card sales, or sales on account, ultimately a business will collect cash from the transactions. Cash is one of the most vulnerable assets a business has. Cash is easy to conceal and has no identifying marks that link it to its owner, making it relatively easy to steal. Transactions that affect the cash account also affect other accounts, so any misstatement of cash can result in the misstatement of other items. As a result, it is important to have good internal controls over cash.

Internal Controls over Cash Receipts Companies typically receive cash over the counter and through the mail. Good internal control dictates that all cash receipts be deposited in the bank quickly. Each source of cash needs its own security measures.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 325

03/04/14 5:21 PM

326

Chapter 7

Over-the-Counter Cash Receipts The cash register provides control over the cash receipts for a retail business. Consider a Target store. Target issues a receipt for each transaction to ensure that every sale is recorded; a customer cannot receive a receipt unless the register records the transaction. When the sales associate enters a transaction in the register, the machine records it and the cash drawer opens to receive cash. At the end of the day, the cash in the drawer is reconciled against the machine’s record of cash sales to ensure the proper amount of cash is on hand. The machine’s record of sales is then used as the source for the journal entry to record sales. At the end of the day, or several times daily if the company is making a lot of sales, cash should be deposited in the bank. Any cash not in a cash register should be kept in a locked location within the business, such as a safe, until it can be deposited in the bank. These measures, coupled with oversight by management, help discourage theft.

Cash Receipts by Mail Many companies receive cash by mail, especially if they sell products or services on credit. Exhibit 7-1 shows how companies can control cash received by mail. Generally, an employee who has no other involvement in the sales or collection process, often a mailroom employee, opens all incoming mail and prepares a control listing of amounts received. At this time, a remittance advice is prepared if one did not accompany the payment. The mailroom then sends all customer checks to the treasurer, who oversees having the money deposited in the bank. The remittance advices, often check stubs, go to the Accounting Department and serve as a basis for making journal entries to Cash and the customers’ accounts receivable. As a final step, the controller compares the bank deposit amount from the treasurer with the debit to Cash from the Accounting Department. The amount of cash received according to the mailroom should match the debit to Cash and equal the amount deposited in the bank. This procedure ensures that cash receipts are safe in the bank and that the company accounting records are up to date.

Checks

Treasurer

Deposit DEPOSIT:

Bank

$2,167.05

Mailroom

Remittance advices

Accounting Department

Total amount posted to Cash

Controller

Exhibit 7-1

Internal Control over Cash Payments A good separation of duties between operations and cash payments provides internal control over those payments. Also, making payments by check is another important control for several reasons: • The check provides a written record of the payment. • An authorized official studies the evidence supporting the payment. • The official approves the payment by signing the check.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 326

03/04/14 5:21 PM

Cash and Receivables

327

Purchase and Payment Process To illustrate the internal control over cash payments by check in a company large enough to separate duties, suppose Top Ten Sporting Goods buys snowboard inventory from Taylor Snowboards. This purchase and payment process will generally follow steps similar to those shown in Exhibit 7-2: Purchase order  A document ­showing details of merchandise being ordered from a supplier. Receiving report  A document evidencing the receipt of goods purchased.

1. Top Ten Sporting Goods sends a purchase order to Taylor Snowboards, its supplier. By preparing this document, Top Ten is placing an order to buy snowboards. 2. Taylor Snowboards ships the goods and sends an invoice back to Top Ten. 3. Top Ten receives the snowboards and prepares a receiving report as evidence that it received the goods. 4. After matching the information on these documents, Top Ten sends a check to Taylor Snowboards to pay for the goods. 1 Purchase Order 2 Merchandise Inventory 3

Company

Receiving Report

2

Supplier

Invoice 4 Check

Exhibit 7-2 Purchasing agent  The individual in an organization responsible for placing orders to purchase goods for that organization. Controller  The individual in an ­organization responsible for the accounting system and financial statements. Treasurer  The individual in an ­organization responsible for the ­custody of assets, such as cash.

For good internal control, the purchasing agent, the individual who places the order, should neither receive the goods nor approve the payment. Otherwise, the purchasing agent could buy goods and have them shipped to his or her home. Or he or she could receive kickbacks from suppliers by having the supplier bill his or her employer too much, approving the payment and splitting the excess with the supplier. The controller, as the person responsible for the accounting function, should not sign the checks for similar reasons. He or she could sign a check payable to himself or herself and then manipulate the accounting records to hide this improper payment. Before signing the check, the treasurer, who usually assumes responsibility for the custody of cash, should examine each set of documents including the purchase order, receiving report, purchase invoice, and check to prove that they agree. This helps the company ensure that: 1. The goods it received were the goods it ordered, as proved by the purchase order and receiving report. 2. It is paying only for the goods ordered and received, as proved by the purchase ­order, receiving report, invoice, and check. After payment, the check signer should deface the set of documents. This can be ­accomplished by punching a hole through the payment packet or stamping the documents “PAID.” This hole or stamp confirms the bill has been paid and prevents the documents from being used to generate a second payment.

Electronic data interchange (EDI)  Direct electronic communication between suppliers and retailers.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 327

Streamlined Payment Procedures For many companies, the purchase and payment process is made more efficient through the use of electronic data interchange (EDI). EDI is a streamlined process that

03/04/14 5:21 PM

328

Chapter 7

Electronic funds transfer (EFT)  System that transfers cash by electronic communication rather than by paper documents.

bypasses people and documents altogether. For example, in electronic data interchange, Costmart’s computers communicate directly with the computers of suppliers such as Energize Soft Drinks, Inc., and Husky Foods. When Costmart’s inventory of Husky chocolate candy reaches a low level, the computer sends a purchase order to Husky. Husky ships the candy and invoices Costmart electronically. Then an electronic funds transfer (EFT) sends Costmart’s payment to Husky via electronic communication.

The Bank Reconciliation Bank reconciliation  A document that identifies and explains the differences between a depositor’s record of a cash account and a bank’s record of the same cash account. Bank statement  A document the bank prepares to report the changes in the depositor’s cash account for a period of time. It shows the beginning bank account balance, lists the month’s cash transactions, and shows the ending bank account balance. Bank balance  The balance in the company’s bank account according to the bank. Book balance  The balance in a company’s bank account according to the company’s accounting records, or books.

Preparing a bank reconciliation is an important internal control that should be ­performed regularly. On a monthly basis a company will receive a bank statement from its bank that shows the bank balance, the cash balance in the company’s account according to the bank. This balance usually does not agree with the book balance, the cash balance according to the company’s records. Differences between the bank balance and the book balance arise because of: • Differences, called timing differences, between the time when the bank records a transaction and when the business records it. • Errors made by either the bank or the business. The bank reconciliation identifies and explains the differences between the bank balance and the book balance and is used to arrive at the actual “true” balance of cash. The bank reconciliation serves as an internal control because it allows the correct amount of cash to be arrived at according to both bank and book records.

Preparing the Bank Reconciliation The basic format, showing items that typically appear on a bank reconciliation, is illustrated in Exhibit 7-3. The bank reconciliation is divided into two sides, the bank side and • Bank collections • Electronic fund transfers (EFT) • Interest revenue Bank Reconciliation

The company has recorded these deposits, but the bank has not yet received them. Bank must correct bank errors. The company has recorded these checks, but the bank has not yet paid them.

Bank Month-end cash balance according to the bank statement Add: Deposits in transit Bank errors Less: Outstanding checks Bank errors Adjusted bank balance

Bank must correct bank errors. Company must correct book errors.

Books $ XX

XX XX

(XX) (XX) $ XX

Month-end cash balance according to the ledger account Add: Additions to bank account not recorded on the books Book errors Less: Deductions to bank account not recorded on the books Book errors Adjusted book balance

Company must correct book errors.

$ XX

XX XX (XX) (XX) $ XX

• Electronic fund transfers (EFT) • Nonsufficient funds checks • Cost of printed checks • Service charges

Exhibit 7-3

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 328

03/04/14 5:21 PM

Cash and Receivables

329

the book side. When establishing the procedures for a bank reconciliation, keep in mind our discussion of separation of duties; the person who prepares the bank reconciliation should have no other responsibilities related to cash. Otherwise, the bank reconciler could steal cash and manipulate the reconciliation to conceal the theft.

Bank Side of the Reconciliation When preparing a bank reconciliation, the following items are included on the bank side of the reconciliation: Deposits in transit  Deposits that have been recorded by a company but not yet by its bank. Outstanding checks  Checks that have been issued by a company and recorded in its books but have not yet been paid by its bank.

1. Deposits in transit are deposits that the business has recorded but the bank has not. Deposits in transit are added to the bank balance. 2. Outstanding checks are checks that the business has recorded but the bank has not yet paid. Outstanding checks are subtracted from the bank balance. 3. Bank errors include the bank recording a deposit or a check for the wrong amount. The bank may also record a deposit or check that belongs in another bank customer’s account. The bank must correct the errors that it has made. Adjust the bank balance for the amount of the error, adding or subtracting as necessary depending on the ­nature of the error.

Book Side of the Reconciliation When preparing a bank reconciliation, the following items are included on the book side of the reconciliation: Bank collection  Collection of money by the bank on behalf of a depositor. Lock-box system  A system in which customers send payments to a post office box of a business. The bank collects payments from the box and deposits them into the business’s account.

1. Bank collections are cash collections made by the bank on behalf of the business. Many businesses have their customers pay their bank directly. One way customers make payment is through a lock-box system in which they send their payments to a business’s post office box. The bank then collects payments from the box and deposits them in the business’s account, thus reducing the chance of theft. Another example is a bank collection of a depositor’s note receivable. Because the bank statement is often the first communication that cash was received, the business has not yet recorded the receipt. These collections are added to the book balance. 2. Electronic fund transfers occur when the bank receives or pays cash on the depositor’s behalf electronically. Because the bank statement is often the first communication of the transactions, the book balance may need to be adjusted accordingly for the cash receipt or cash payment. 3. Interest revenue may be earned on an account depending on the balance in that account. Interest revenue is added to the book balance.

Nonsufficient funds (NSF) check  A check drawn against a bank account that has insufficient money to pay the check.

4. Nonsufficient funds (NSF) checks represent customer checks that the business has previously deposited that have turned out to be worthless. In other words, there were not sufficient funds in the customers’ bank accounts to pay the checks. These amounts are subtracted from the book balance to reverse the deposit amount made earlier. 5. Service charges represent bank fees for processing transactions, printing checks, etc. These amounts are subtracted from the book balance. 6. Book errors include mistakes made in recording cash transactions. For example, an error might involve recording a check in the accounting records for a different amount than what the check was written for. Another mistake might be failing to record a deposit that was made. The book balance is adjusted for the amount of the error, adding or subtracting as necessary depending on the nature of the error.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 329

03/04/14 5:21 PM

330

Chapter 7

Accounting in Your World

I don’t need a check register; I use online banking. Chris got a job his senior year in high school and opened a bank account to put the money he earns in. Chris deposits his paychecks into the account and then uses a debit card to make purchases. Chris’s dad encouraged him to keep track of his finances ­using a check register and to reconcile his account balance each month when his bank statement arrives. Instead, Chris decided to just check his account activity every few days online to see that the deductions from his account agree with what he remembers purchasing. A few days after going out for pizza with friends, Chris was looking at his account activity online. Chris happened to have his receipt from the pizza parlor in his wallet, which was unusual as he normally throws them away, and decided to check it against his account activity. The receipt from the pizza parlor showed that the cost of the pizza was $18.53 and that Chris had added a $2 tip bringing the total amount to $20.53. However, the amount deducted from Chris’s account was $22.53. It appeared that the amount of the tip was, accidentally or purposefully, added into the total amount charged twice. Chris feels lucky that he caught this mistake but wonders how many mistakes like this have occurred in the past that he didn’t catch. Now, Chris understands why it is important to maintain a check register and to reconcile the account activity each month when he receives his bank statement.

Bank Reconciliation Illustrated The January bank statement of Acrofab, Inc., is presented in Exhibit 7-4. The summary at the top shows the beginning balance, total deposits, total withdrawals, service charges, and the resulting ending balance. Details of the transactions for the month appear on the statement following this summary. The statement shows that the January 31 bank balance of Acrofab, Inc., is $5,875. Acrofab’s Cash account has a balance of $3,147 at January 31, 2014 as shown in Exhibit 7-5. Notice that the cash payments appear as one deduction, or credit, to the Cash account in the general ledger to make the process more efficient because businesses often write and record many checks at once. The bank reconciliation in Exhibit 7-6 identifies and explains the differences between the balance according to the bank statement and the balance according to Acrofab’s records, thus determining the correct Cash balance at the end of January. Exhibit 7-6, Panel A, lists the reconciling items, and Panel B shows the completed reconciliation.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 330

03/04/14 5:21 PM

Cash and Receivables

331

INLAND NORTHWEST NATIONAL BANK. Acrofab, Inc. 721 Front Street Seattle, WA 98058

CHECKING ACCOUNT 136-213733 CHECKING ACCOUNT SUMMARY AS OF 1/31/2014

BEGINNING BALANCE 6,500

TOTAL DEPOSITS 4,362

TOTAL WITHDRAWALS 4,972

DEPOSITS Deposits Deposits Deposits EFT-Rent Bank collection Interest

SERVICE CHARGES 15

ENDING BALANCE 5,875

DATE 4-Jan 4-Jan 8-Jan 17-Jan 26-Jan 31-Jan

CHARGES Service charges

DATE 31-Jan

CHECKS Number 956 732 733 734 735 736

AMOUNT 1,000 112 200 905 2,115 30

AMOUNT 15 DAILY BALANCE Date 31-Dec 4-Jan 6-Jan 8-Jan 10-Jan 17-Jan

Amount 100 3,000 160 100 100 1,100

Balance 6,500 7,560 7,360 7,560 7,460 5,205

OTHER CHARGES NSF EFT-Insurance

Date 20-Jan 26-Jan 31-Jan

DATE 4-Jan 20-Jan

MONTHLY SUMMARY Withdrawals: 9

Minimum Balance: 4,845

Balance 4,845 6,960 5,875

AMOUNT 52 360

Average Balance: 6,085

Exhibit 7-4 General Ledger: Cash DATE 2014 Jan 1 2 7 31 31

ITEM

POST REF.

DEBIT

CREDIT

Balance J. 30 J. 30 J. 32 J. 32

1,112 200 6,265* 1,600

Cash Payments: *Supporting Detail for Jan 31 Credit to Cash CHECK NO. AMOUNT CHECK NO. 732 $3,000 738 733 610 739 734 100 740 735 100 741 736 1,100 737 285 Total

Account No. 111 BALANCE DEBIT CREDIT 6,500 7,612 7,812 1,547 3,147

AMOUNT $ 320 85 205 460 $6,265

Exhibit 7-5

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 331

03/04/14 5:21 PM

332

Chapter 7

PANEL A—Reconciling Items a. Deposit in transit: $1,600 b. Bank error: The bank mistakenly deducted $100 for a check written by another company. Add $100 to bank balance because this balance will be $100 higher once the bank fixes its error. c. Outstanding checks: Check No. Amount 737 $285 738 320 739 85 740 205 741 460 d. EFT receipt of rent revenue: $905 e. Bank collection of a note receivable: $2,115, which includes interest revenue of $115 f. Interest revenue earned on bank balance: $30 g. Book error: Check no. 733 for $160 paid to Brown Company on account was recorded as $610; add $450 to the book balance. h. Bank service charge: $15 i. NSF check from L. Ross: $52 j. EFT payment of insurance expense: $360 PANEL B—Completed Reconciliation Acrofab, Inc. Bank Reconciliation January 31, 2014 BANK Bal, Jan 31 Add: a. Deposit of January 31 in transit b. Correction of bank error

Less: c. Outstanding checks No. 737 No. 738 No. 739 No. 740 No. 741 Adjusted bank balance

$5,875 1,600 100 7,575

(285) (320) (85) (205) (460) $6,220

BOOKS Bal, Jan 31 $3,147 Add: d. EFT receipt of rent revenue 905 e. Bank collection of note receivable, $2,000 plus interest revenue of $115 2,115 f. Interest revenue earned on bank balance 30 g. Correction of book error—overstated our check no. 733 ($610 – $160) 450 6,647 Less: h. Service charge (15) i. NSF check (52) j. EFT payment of insurance expense (360) Adjusted book balance $6,220

These amounts must agree, or the reconciliation is not complete.

Here is a summary of how to treat the reconciling items encountered most often: Bank Balance—Always:

Book Balance—Always:

• Add deposits in transit. • Subtract outstanding checks. • Add or subtract corrections of bank errors.

• Add bank collections, interest revenue, and EFT receipts. • Subtract NSF checks, the cost of printed checks, service charges, and EFT payments. • Add or subtract corrections of book errors.

Exhibit 7-6

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 332

03/04/14 5:21 PM

Cash and Receivables

333

Journalizing Transactions from the Reconciliation Once the bank reconciliation has been prepared, the true balance of cash is known. However, the Cash account in the general ledger still reflects the original book balance. Journal entries must be made and posted to the general ledger so it reflects the updated cash balance. All items on the book side of the bank reconciliation require journal entries, whereas none of the items on the bank side require journal entries. The journal entries listed here bring the Cash account up to date as a result of completing the reconciliation. The letters of the entries correspond to the letters of the reconciling items listed in Exhibit 7-6, Panel A. Entry (i), the entry for the NSF check, needs explanation. When L. Ross’s check was first deposited, Inland Northwest National Bank added $52 to Acrofab’s account. When L. Ross’s check was returned to Inland Northwest National Bank due to insufficient funds, the bank deducted $52 from Acrofab’s account. Because the funds are still receivable from Ross, Accounts Receivable—L. Ross is debited to re-establish the amount due from Ross.

DATE d.

e.

ACCOUNTS Cash Rent Revenue Record receipt of monthly rent. Cash

POST REF.

DR. 905

905

2,115

Notes Receivable Interest Revenue Record note receivable and interest collected by bank. f.

Cash

2,000 115

30

Interest Revenue Record interest earned on bank balance. g.

Cash

30

450

Accounts Payable—Brown Co. Correct recording of check no. 733 h.

i.

j.

CR.

450

Miscellaneous Expense Cash Record bank service charge.

15

Accounts Receivable—L. Ross Cash Record NSF check returned by bank.

52

Insurance Expense Cash Record payment of monthly insurance premium.

360

15

52

360

Online Banking Online banking allows businesses to pay bills and view account activity electronically. The company doesn’t have to wait until the end of the month to get a bank statement. The account history is like a bank statement because it lists all transactions including deposits, checks, EFT receipts and payments, ATM withdrawals, and interest earned on the bank balance. Because of this, it can be used instead of a bank statement to reconcile the bank account at any time.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 333

03/04/14 5:21 PM

334

Chapter 7

Stop and Think… Jill and Ramon were working on their accounting homework together. Their instructor had given them a problem that required them to prepare a bank reconciliation. He then asked them, “What balance would the company report on its balance sheet for the period?” Jill thought it should be the book balance from the bank reconciliation because that is the amount of cash the company’s records reflected. Ramon disagreed. He thought it should be the bank balance from the reconciliation because that is the amount of cash reflected on the bank statement, which is a formal document received from the bank. Which student is correct?

Answer

Neither student is correct. This is because neither the book balance nor the bank balance reflects all of the transactions that have affected the company’s cash balance during the period. The balance that would be reported on the balance sheet would be the reconciled balance from the bank reconciliation, as this represents the true amount of cash the company has at the end of the period.

How Is Cash Reported on the Balance Sheet? 2

Report cash on the balance sheet

Petty cash  Fund containing a small amount of cash that is used to pay for minor expenditures. Cash equivalents  Highly liquid, highly safe investments that so closely resemble cash that they may be shown with cash on the balance sheet.

Remember from our discussion of the classified balance sheet in Chapter 4 that Cash is the first asset listed because it’s the most liquid. Businesses often have several bank accounts, but they customarily combine all cash amounts into a single total. On the balance sheet, this total may be called Cash, or it may be called Cash and Cash Equivalents. Cash on the balance sheet includes coin, currency, checks on hand, petty cash (discussed in Appendix 7A), checking accounts, money orders, and traveler’s checks. In short, cash consists of anything that a bank will take as a deposit. Cash equivalents include very liquid, very safe short-term investments. Generally, investments with original maturities of three months or less qualify as cash equivalents. They often include time deposits, money market funds, certificates of deposit, and U.S. Treasury bills. These items are liquid because they can readily be converted into cash, and they are safe because they have little risk of losing their value. Cash equivalents so closely resemble cash that they are included with cash on the balance sheet.

How Do You Account for Receivables? Types of Receivables 3

Identify the different types of receivables and discuss related internal controls for accounts receivable

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 334

As discussed earlier in the chapter, companies often make sales on account that create a receivable from the customer. The two major types of receivables are accounts receivable and notes receivable. Remember from Chapter 1 that a business’s accounts receivable are current assets that reflect the amounts due from customers for credit sales of goods or services. Also recall from Chapter 2 that notes receivable are written promises by customers to pay an amount of cash to the business in the future. Notes receivable are more formal and usually longer in term than accounts receivable. Notes also usually include a charge for interest. A detailed discussion of notes receivable will follow later in the chapter. A company may also have other receivables, such as loans to employees and interest receivable. These other receivables may be either current or long-term assets, depending on if they are due within one year or less.

03/04/14 5:21 PM

Cash and Receivables

335

Internal Control over Accounts Receivable

Write off  Removing a customer’s ­receivable from the accounting records because it is considered uncollectible.

Most companies have a Credit Department to evaluate customers’ credit applications. The extension of credit requires a balancing act. The company wants to avoid receivables that will never be collected while at the same time granting credit to as many customers as possible. Also, companies that sell on credit often receive the related payment by mail, so internal control over collections is important. Remember, a critical element of internal control is the separation of cash-handling and cashaccounting duties. Good internal control over Accounts Receivable dictates that the granting of credit, the receipt of cash, and the recording of Accounts Receivable transactions are done by different individuals, preferably from different departments. For ­example, if the employee who handles the daily cash receipts also records the Accounts Receivable transactions, the company would have no separation of duties. The employee could pocket money received from a customer. He or she could then label the customer’s account as uncollectible, and the company would write off the account receivable, as discussed in the next section. The company would stop billing that customer, and the employee would have covered his or her theft. For this reason, separation of duties is important.

Accounting for Uncollectible Accounts Receivable Unfortunately, when a business chooses to sell goods or services on account, there will likely be customers who fail to pay the amount owed. When this happens, the customer’s account is referred to as an uncollectible account or a bad debt. Uncollectible accounts reflect a cost associated with selling goods and services on account. Companies who make sales on account expect that the benefit of granting credit to customers outweighs the cost.

Bad debt expense  Selling expense caused by uncollectible ­accounts; also called uncollectible accounts expense.

• The benefit: Increased revenues and profits from making sales to a wider range of customers. • The cost: Some customers don’t pay, and that creates an expense called Bad Debt Expense. Bad Debt Expense is also called Uncollectible Accounts Expense. Both account names mean the same thing—a customer did not pay his or her ­account balance. There are two methods of accounting for uncollectible accounts receivable: • The direct write-off method • The allowance method We will examine the direct write-off method first.

Direct write-off method  The method of accounting for uncollectible accounts in which a customer’s account is written off as uncollectible when the business determines that the customer will not pay.

4

Use the direct write-off and allowance methods to account for uncollectible accounts

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 335

How Do You Account for Uncollectible Accounts? The Direct Write-Off Method The simplest way to account for uncollectible accounts is to use the direct write-off method. Under the direct write-off method, at the time it is determined the business will not collect from a specific customer, the business writes off that customer’s Account Receivable. The Account Receivable is written off by debiting Bad Debt Expense and crediting the customer’s Account Receivable. For example, on March 5, 2015, assume that Allied Enterprises determined that Bill Johnson’s $400 Account Receivable was

03/04/14 5:21 PM

336

Chapter 7

uncollectible. The entry to write off Bill Johnson’s account under the direct write-off method would be: DATE Mar 5

ACCOUNTS Bad Debt Expense Accounts Receivable—Bill Johnson Wrote off Bill Johnson’s account.

POST REF.

DR. 400

CR. 400

The direct write-off method is generally not allowed by GAAP because it does not ­always adhere to the matching principle that was discussed in Chapter 3. For example, let’s assume Bill Johnson’s $400 account, which was written off, originated from a credit sale that occurred in 2014. In this instance, Allied Enterprises would have recorded sales revenue in 2014. However, Allied Enterprises wrote off the bad debt by recording the bad debt expense in 2015, a different year. As a result, Allied Enterprises fails to correctly match expenses with related revenues. The materiality principle, discussed in Chapter 5, allows companies who experience low amounts of bad debt expense to utilize the direct write-off method.

Direct Write-Off Method: Recovery of Accounts Previously Written Off Occasionally after a company has written off a customer’s account, the customer will unexpectedly pay part, or all, of the amount owed. There is a two-step process used to record the receipt of cash from the customer when this happens. First, the customer’s Account Receivable is reinstated. This step is required as the customer’s account no longer exists within the company’s records. Next, the payment on the account is recorded. Let’s assume that on August 10, 2015, Bill Johnson unexpectedly sent Allied Enterprises a check for $250 as payment on his account, which had previously been written off. Allied Enterprises would first reinstate the Account Receivable as follows:

DATE Aug 10

ACCOUNTS Accounts Receivable—Bill Johnson Bad Debt Expense Reinstate Bill Johnson’s account.

POST REF.

DR. 250

CR. 250

Observe that only $250 of the account was reinstated. If Allied Enterprises believes Mr. Johnson will pay the remaining $150 owed on the account, the entire $400 could have been reinstated. Also, notice that the accounts debited and credited in this entry are exactly opposite of those used in the entry to write off the account. Now that the account has been reinstated, Allied Enterprises records the receipt of cash as follows:

DATE Aug 10

ACCOUNTS Cash Accounts Receivable—Bill Johnson Collected cash on account.

POST REF.

DR. 250

CR. 250

Another method of accounting for uncollectible accounts that does adhere to the matching rule is the allowance method.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 336

03/04/14 5:21 PM

Cash and Receivables

337

The Allowance Method Allowance method  A method of accounting for uncollectible accounts that utilizes estimates of the amount of Accounts Receivable that are not ­expected to be collected in the future. Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts  A contra-asset account that holds the estimated amount of ­uncollectible accounts receivable; also called Allowance for Doubtful Accounts. Net realizable value  The net amount that the business expects to collect; the net realizable value of ­receivables is calculated by subtracting Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts from Accounts Receivable.

Control account  An account in the general ledger that summarizes the details of an account balance.

The allowance method is a method of accounting for bad debts in which bad debt expense is recorded in the same period as sales revenue. For this reason, the allowance method adheres to the matching principle and is, therefore, required by GAAP. Under the allowance method, a business will use an adjusting entry at the end of the period to record the bad debt expense for the period. Because the business does not know which customers will eventually not pay it, it must estimate the amount of bad debt expense based on past experience. The debit side of the adjusting entry will be to the Bad Debt Expense account. This is the same account that was debited when an account was written off using the direct write-off method. However, instead of crediting Accounts Receivable, a contra-account called Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts or Allowance for Doubtful Accounts will be credited. The Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts is “tied” to the Accounts Receivable account and is subtracted from Accounts Receivable to arrive at the net realizable value of the Accounts Receivable. The adjusting entry will look like this:

DATE Dec 31

ACCOUNTS Bad Debt Expense Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts To record estimated bad debts.

POST REF.

DR. XXX

CR. XXX

The Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts is utilized because the specific customers who will ultimately not pay are unknown at the time the adjusting entry is made. Remember from Chapter 4 that, in addition to the Accounts Receivable control account in the general ledger, each customer also has an account in the Accounts Receivable subsidiary ledger. In order to reduce Accounts Receivable, the specific customer would have to be known so that his or her Account Receivable could be reduced in the subsidiary ledger. As we will demonstrate later in the chapter, once it is known that a specific customer’s account is uncollectible, his or her Account Receivable will be written off. The offset to this entry will be to reduce the Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts by an equal amount.

Estimating the Amount of Uncollectible Accounts

Percent of sales method  The method of estimating uncollectible accounts that focuses on net credit sales; also called the income statement approach. Net credit sales  The total credit sales less sales discounts and sales returns and allowances related to the credit sales.

In order to estimate the amount of bad debt expense, a company will use its past bad debt experience to make an educated guess of how much will be uncollectible. The state of the economy, the industry the business operates in, and other variables are also used in order to arrive at the best estimate possible. There are two basic ways to estimate the amount of uncollectible accounts: • Percent of sales method • Aging method Percent of Sales Method The percent of sales method computes the estimated amount of uncollectible accounts as a percentage of net credit sales. To demonstrate, let’s assume that Allied Enterprises has the following selected account balances as of December 31, 2014, prior to adjusting for bad debts:

Accounts Receivable

Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts

32,000 00

450

Bad Debt Expense 0

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 337

03/04/14 5:21 PM

338

Chapter 7

It is important to note that when using the allowance method, the Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts will almost always have a balance at the end of the period. The balance in the account may have a debit or a credit balance depending on the amount of the adjusting entry from the prior period and the amount of uncollectible accounts that have been written off during the current period. Also, note that the Bad Debt Expense account will always have a zero balance before the adjusting entry. This is because, as an expense account, it was closed at the end of the prior period. Now, let’s assume that Allied Enterprises estimates uncollectible accounts to be 1/2 of 1% of net credit sales, which totaled $300,000 during 2014. The estimated amount of uncollectible accounts is $1,500 ($300,000 × 0.005). Under the percent of sales method, once the estimated amount of uncollectible accounts has been determined, the adjusting entry is made for that amount. The required journal entry at December 31, 2014, would be as follows: DATE Dec 31

ACCOUNTS Bad Debt Expense Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts To record estimated bad debts.

POST REF.

DR. 1,500

CR. 1,500

After posting the adjusting entry, Allied Enterprises’ accounts would look like this: Accounts Receivable

Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts

32,000

450 1,500 1,950

Bad Debt Expense 0 1,500 1,500

Income statement approach  The method of estimating uncollectible accounts that focuses on net credit sales; also called the percent of sales method. Aging method  The method of estimating uncollectible accounts that focuses on accounts receivable; the accountant calculates the end-ofperiod allowance balance based on an aging of the Accounts Receivable; also called the balance sheet approach.

The net realizable value of Allied Enterprises’ Accounts Receivable is $30,050 at December 31, 2014 ($32,000 Accounts Receivable less $1,950 Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts). Notice that Bad Debt Expense reflects the calculated amount of uncollectible accounts ($1,500), whereas Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts reflects a different amount ($1,950). This reflects why this method is also called the income statement approach. This method focuses more on the income statement than on the balance sheet. After the adjusting entry has been posted, the income statement account (Bad Debt Expense) reflects the calculated amount of uncollectible accounts rather than the balance sheet account (Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts).

Aging Method  The other method for estimating uncollectible accounts is the aging method. Once again, let’s assume Allied Enterprises had the following account balances at December 31, 2014, prior to adjusting for bad debts.

Accounts Receivable

Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts

32,000 00

450

Bad Debt Expense 0

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 338

03/04/14 5:21 PM

Cash and Receivables

339

When using the aging method, a schedule is created that reflects all of the company’s individual credit customers with their account balances broken down based on how long they’ve been outstanding. This is known as an Accounts Receivable aging report. Exhibit 7-7 reflects the Accounts Receivable aging report for Allied Enterprises at December 31, 2014.

1 2 32 33 34

Customer B. Ashford L. Clark

Balance $ 450 875

Current

M. Reynolds R. Turlock K. Wilson Total

575 225 950 $32,000

575

1–30 150

Days Past Due 31–60 61–90 91–180 > 181 300

875

225 26,850

2,800

125 325

475

825 1,250

300

Exhibit 7-7 Once the aging report has been prepared, an estimated percentage of uncollectible ­accounts is determined for each age category. This percentage is then multiplied by the balance for each age category to determine the estimated uncollectible amount for that category. These amounts are then added together to arrive at the total estimated amount of uncollectible accounts for the period. The calculation for Allied Enterprises would look like this:

Account Age Current 1–30 31–60 61–90 91–180 > 181 Total

Balance $26,850 2,800 475 325 1,250 300 $32,000

Estimated Percent Uncollectible 2% 5% 20% 40% 50% 80%

Estimated Uncollectible Amount $ 537 140 95 130 625 240 $1,767

Now that we know the total estimated amount of uncollectible accounts, $1,767, we are ready to make the adjusting entry. Unlike when using the percent of sales method, we do not simply take the calculated amount of uncollectible accounts and use this as the amount of the journal entry (this is the biggest difference between the two methods). Instead, we must look at the existing balance in Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts and perform a calculation to determine the amount to use in the adjusting entry. When using the aging method, the goal is for Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts to reflect the calculated amount of uncollectible accounts after the adjusting entry has been recorded and posted. The easiest way to determine the correct amount of the required adjusting entry is to do a T-account analysis of Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts: Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts 450 ? 1,767

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 339

03/04/14 5:21 PM

340

Chapter 7

The first step in the analysis is to enter the Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts balance that existed prior to making the adjusting entry. Next, skip a line and enter the desired ending balance in the T-account. This balance will be the calculated amount of the uncollectible accounts, $1,767. The question mark represents the adjusting entry amount that is required. This amount is determined by calculating the credit needed to bring the ending balance up to the desired amount. It is very important to pay attention to whether the Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts balance that existed prior to making the adjusting entry was a debit or a credit. Also, remember that the ending balance in the account will always be a credit balance. By looking at the T-account analysis, we can see that the required adjusting entry amount is $1,317 ($1,767 – $450). The required journal entry at December 31, 2014, would be:

DATE Dec 31

ACCOUNTS Bad Debt Expense Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts To record estimated bad debts.

POST REF.

DR. 1,317

CR. 1,317

After posting the adjusting entry, Allied Enterprises’ accounts would look like this:

Accounts Receivable

Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts

32,000

450 1,317 1,767

Bad Debt Expense 0 1,317 1,317

Balance sheet approach  The method of estimating uncollectible accounts that focuses on accounts receivable. The accountant calculates the end-of-period allowance balance based on an aging of the Accounts Receivable; also called the aging method.

The net realizable value of Allied Enterprises’ Accounts Receivable is $30,233 at December 31, 2014 ($32,000 Accounts Receivable less $1,767 Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts). Notice that Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts reflects the calculated amount of uncollectible accounts ($1,767), whereas Bad Debt Expense reflects a different amount ($1,317). This reflects why this method is also called the balance sheet ­approach. This method focuses more on the balance sheet than on the income statement. After the adjusting entry has been posted, the balance sheet account (Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts) reflects the calculated amount of uncollectible accounts rather than the income statement account (Bad Debt Expense).

Writing Off Uncollectible Accounts Under the Allowance Method The entry to write off a customer’s account under the allowance method is similar to the entry used under the direct write-off method. At the time a company determines a customer’s account is uncollectible, the Accounts Receivable will be credited to remove it from the company’s books. However, the offsetting debit will not be made to Bad Debt Expense as it was under the direct write-off method. Instead, it will be made to Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts. Assume that on March 5, 2015, Allied Enterprises determined that Bill Johnson’s $400 Account Receivable was uncollectible.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 340

03/04/14 5:21 PM

Cash and Receivables

341

The entry to write off Bill Johnson’s account under the allowance method would be as follows: DATE Mar 5

ACCOUNTS Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts Accounts Receivable—Bill Johnson Wrote off Bill Johnson’s account.

POST REF.

DR. 400

CR. 400

Remember that the expense related to writing off Bill Johnson’s account was recognized in 2014 when Allied Enterprises made the adjusting entry to record the estimated bad debts.

Allowance Method: Recovery of Accounts Previously Written Off The entries required to record the receipt of cash from a customer whose account was previously written off are similar under the allowance method to those used under the direct write-off method. First, the customer’s Account Receivable is reinstated. Then the payment on the account is recorded. Let’s assume once again that on August 10, 2015, Bill Johnson unexpectedly sent Allied Enterprises a check for $250 as payment on his previously written-off account. Allied Enterprises would first reinstate the Account Receivable: DATE Aug 10

ACCOUNTS Accounts Receivable—Bill Johnson Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts Reinstated Bill Johnson’s account.

POST REF.

DR. 250

CR. 250

Notice again that the accounts debited and credited in this entry are exactly opposite of those used in the entry to write off the account. Allied Enterprises now records the receipt of cash in the same manner as was done under the direct write-off method as: DATE Aug 10

ACCOUNTS Cash Accounts Receivable—Bill Johnson Collected cash on account.

POST REF.

DR. 250

CR. 250

Exhibit 7-8 summarizes the differences between the entries required when using the ­direct write-off method and those required when using the allowance method.

Event

Direct Write-off Method

Allowance Method

Period-end adjusting entry

None required

Bad Debt Expense Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts

Entry to write off customer account

Bad Debt Expense XXXX Accounts Receivable—customer name XXXX

Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts XXXX Accounts Receivable—customer name XXXX

Entries to record receipt of payment on an account previously written off

Accounts Receivable—customer name XXXX Bad Debt Expense XXXX Cash XXXX Accounts Receivable—customer name XXXX

Accounts Receivable—customer name XXXX Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts XXXX Cash XXXX Accounts Receivable—customer name XXXX

XXXX

XXXX

Exhibit 7-8

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 341

03/04/14 5:22 PM

342

Chapter 7

Try It… Will writing off Bill Johnson’s $400 account reduce the net realizable value of Allied Enterprises’ Accounts Receivable?

Answer

No, under the allowance method, the write-off of uncollectible receivables has no impact on the net realizable value of Accounts Receivable. Remember that the net realizable value of Accounts Receivable equals the balance in the Accounts Receivable account less the balance in the related contra account, Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts. When Bill Johnson’s account was written off, the asset account, Accounts Receivable, was reduced by $400. However, the Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts was also r­educed by $400, so the total change in the net realizable value of the Accounts Receivable is zero.

How Are Accounts Receivable Reported on the Balance Sheet? 5

Report accounts receivable on the balance sheet

Accounts receivable are reported at “net realizable value” in the current assets section of the balance sheet. There are two ways to show Accounts Receivable at net realizable value. For example, assume that at December 31, 2014, Allied Enterprises’ Accounts Receivable balance is $32,000 and its Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts balance is $1,767. Allied Enterprises could report its accounts receivable in either of the two ways shown here:

Allied Enterprises Balance Sheet (partial): December 31, 2014 Accounts Receivable Less: Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts Accounts Receivable, Net

$32,000 1,767 $30,233

Allied Enterprises Balance Sheet (partial): December 31, 2014 Accounts Receivable, Net of Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts of $1,767

$30,233

Most companies use the second method, but either is acceptable. The key is to show Accounts Receivable at net realizable value.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 342

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

343

How Do You Account for Notes Receivable? 6

Account for notes receivable

Promissory note  A written promise to pay a specified amount of money at a particular future date. Maker of a note  The entity that promises future payment; also called the debtor. Payee of a note  The entity to whom the debtor promises future payment; also called the creditor. Principal  The amount loaned out by the payee and borrowed by the maker of the note. Interest  The fee for using money; revenue to the creditor for loaning money; expense to the debtor for borrowing money. Interest rate  The percentage rate of interest specified by the note; almost always stated for a period of one year. Maturity date  The date when final payment of a note is due; also called the due date. Maturity value  The sum of the principal of a note plus interest due at maturity. Note term  The time span of the note during which interest is computed; it extends from the original date of the note to the maturity date.

Principal

Notes receivable are more formal than accounts receivable. The debtor signs a promissory note as evidence of the transaction. Before launching into the accounting, let’s ­define the terms related to notes receivable. • Promissory note: A written promise to pay a specified amount of money on a particular future date. • Maker of a note: The entity that signs the note and promises to pay the required amount; the maker of the note is the debtor. • Payee of a note: The entity to whom the maker promises future payment; the payee of the note is the creditor. • Principal: The amount loaned out by the payee and borrowed by the maker of the note. • Interest: The amount charged for loaning money. Interest is expense to the debtor and revenue to the creditor. • Interest rate: The percentage rate of interest specified by the note. Interest rates are almost always stated for a period of one year. A 10% note means that the amount of interest for one year is 10% of the note’s principal. • Maturity date: This is the date when final payment of the note is due. Also called the due date. • Maturity value: The sum of the principal plus interest due at maturity. • Note term: The period of time during which interest is earned. It extends from the original date of the note to the maturity date. Exhibit 7-9 illustrates a promissory note. As you study the promissory note, look for the items mentioned previously.

Identifying the Maturity Date Some notes specify the maturity date. For example, March 31, 2015, is the maturity date of the note shown in Exhibit 7-9. Other notes state the period of the note in days or months. When the period is given in months, the note’s maturity date falls on the same

PROMISSORY NOTE

$1,000

March 31, 2014 Date

Amount

Interest period starts

For value received, I promise to pay to the order of Allied Enterprises Principal

One thousand and no/100 on March 31, 2015 plus interest at the annual rate of 10 percent

Payee

Dollars

Interest period ends on the maturity date Interest rate Maker

Exhibit 7-9

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 343

03/04/14 5:22 PM

344

Chapter 7

day of the month as the date the note was issued. For example, a three-month note dated March 1, 2014, would mature on June 1, 2014. When the period is given in days, the maturity date is determined by counting the actual days from the date of issue. A 180-day note dated March 16, 2014, matures on September 12, 2014. When counting the days for a note term, remember to: • Count the maturity date. • Omit the date the note was issued.

Origination of Notes Receivable Notes receivable typically originate from a company doing one of the following: • Lending money. • Providing goods or services in exchange for a promissory note. • Accepting a promissory note as payment on an account receivable. Assume that, on August 1, 2014, Allied Enterprises lent $800 to Kim Simmons on a sixmonth, 8% promissory note. The journal entry to record the note would be:

DATE Aug 1

ACCOUNTS Note Receivable—K. Simmons Cash

POST REF.

DR. 800

CR. 800

Next, assume that on September 5, Allied Enterprises sells goods for $2,500 to Don Hammond. Hammond signs a nine-month promissory note at 10% annual interest. Allied Enterprises’ entry to record the sale (ignore cost of goods sold) is:

DATE Sep 5

ACCOUNTS Note Receivable—D. Hammond Sales

POST REF.

DR. 2,500

CR. 2,500

A company may also accept a note receivable from a credit customer who is unable to pay his or her account receivable on time. The customer signs a promissory note and gives it to the creditor. Assume that on November 18, 2014, Sandra Fisher cannot pay her $1,200 account when it comes due and that Allied Enterprises accepts a 60-day, 12% note receivable in lieu of payment. Allied Enterprises would record this as follows:

DATE Nov 18

ACCOUNTS Note Receivable—S. Fisher Accounts Receivable—S. Fisher

POST REF.

DR. 1,200

CR. 1,200

Computing Interest on a Note The formula for computing the interest is:

Amount of interest  Principal  Interest rate  Time

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 344

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

345

In the formula, multiplying by “Time” adjusts for the fact that the interest rate represents a year’s worth of interest. The “Time,” or time period, represents the portion of a year for which interest has accrued on the note. It may be expressed as a fraction of a year in months (x/12) or a fraction of a year in days (x/360 or x/365). When the interest period is stated in days, interest may be computed based on either a 360-day year or a 365-day year. Using the data in Exhibit 7-9, Allied Enterprises computes interest revenue for one year:

Amount of interest  Principal  Interest rate  Time $100

 $1,000 

0.10

 12/12

The maturity value of the note is $1,100 ($1,000 principal + $100 interest). The time element is 12/12 or 1 because the note’s term is 1 year. Interest on a $2,000 note at 6% for nine months is computed as:

Amount of interest  Principal  Interest rate  Time $90

 $2,000 

0.06

 9/12

Interest on a $4,000 note at 8% for 90 days (assuming a 360 day year) is computed as:

Amount of interest  Principal  Interest rate  Time $80

 $4,000 

0.08

 90/360

Accruing Interest Revenue Notes receivable are often outstanding at the end of an accounting period. The interest revenue earned on the notes up to year-end should be recorded as part of that year’s earnings. Recall that interest revenue is earned over time, not just when cash is received. Because of the matching principle, we want to record the interest revenue from notes in the year in which it was earned. Let’s continue with the Allied Enterprises’ note receivable from Exhibit 7-9. Allied Enterprises’ accounting period ends December 31. • How much of the total interest revenue does Allied Enterprises earn in 2014 (from March 31 through December 31, 2014)?

Amount of interest  Principal  Interest rate  Time $75

 $1,000 

0.10

 9/12

Allied Enterprises makes the following adjusting entry at December 31, 2014:

DATE Dec 31

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 345

ACCOUNTS Interest Receivable Interest Revenue Accrue interest revenue.

POST REF.

DR.

CR. 75 75

03/04/14 5:22 PM

346

Chapter 7

• How much interest revenue does Allied Enterprises earn in 2015 (from January 1 through March 31, 2015)?

Amount of interest  Principal  Interest rate  Time $25

 $1,000 

0.10

 3/12

On the note’s maturity date, Allied Enterprises makes the following entry: DATE Mar 31

ACCOUNTS Cash (Maturity Value) Note Receivable—B. Anderson Interest Receivable Interest Revenue Record repayment of note at maturity.

POST REF.

DR. 1,100

CR. 1,000 75 25

Earlier we determined that total interest on the note was $100 ($1,000 × 0.10 × 12/12). These entries assign the correct amount of interest to each year.

2014  $ 75 2015  $ 25 Total Interest  $100

Focus on Decision Making “Can a Business Pay Its Bills?”

7 Calculate the current

ratio, quick ratio, accounts receivable turnover, and receivable collection period

Liquidity management  The management of cash, specifically the amount and timing of cash receipts and payments. Current ratio  The ratio of current assets to current liabilities. Current assets  Cash, short-term investments, accounts receivable, ­inventory, and prepaid expenses.

How much cash, and assets that can be quickly turned into cash, should a business have? A business needs enough cash to pay its bills in normal times. It also needs enough cash to face unexpected challenges and opportunities. Just because a business is profitable does not mean that it can pay its bills. Remember, accrual accounting does not wait to recognize revenue or expense until the cash is received or paid. Thus, net income is not the same as cash. Likewise, an unprofitable business may be able to pay its bills in the short term. Like any asset, a business can have too little or too much cash. A business wants enough cash to pay its bills. But unneeded cash does not help the business’s profitability. So how can you tell when a business has the right amount of cash and assets that quickly turn into cash? The term often used to describe this issue is “liquidity management.” Liquidity management examines how a business manages its cash so it can pay its bills.

Current Ratio and Quick Ratio

Two ratios often used to measure a business’s liquidity are the current ratio and the quick ratio. The current ratio is the ratio of current assets to current liabilities. Current assets are cash and assets that are expected to turn into cash or be sold or consumed within the next year. Current assets include cash, short-term investments, accounts receivable, inventory, and prepaid expenses. Current liabilities are liabilities that must be paid in one year. Current liabilities include accounts payable, accrued liabilities, and other debts due in the next year. The formula for the current ratio is:

Current Ratio 

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 346

Current Assets Current Liabilities

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

Quick ratio  Ratio that reveals how well the entity can pay its current ­liabilities; also called the acid-test ratio. Quick assets  Cash, short-term ­investments, and accounts receivable.

347

A more stringent measure of a company’s ability to pay current liabilities is the quick ratio. The quick ratio, also called the acid-test ratio, compares a company’s quick assets to its current liabilities. Quick assets include cash, short-term investments, and accounts receivable. The quick ratio reveals whether the entity could pay all of its current liabilities with quick assets if they were to become due in the near future. The formula for the quick ratio is:

Quick Ratio 

Quick Assets Current Liabilities

Let’s assume that Mackay Industries has the following current assets as of December 31, 2013: cash, $3,100; net current receivables, $2,500; inventory, $6,300; and shortterm investments, $1,600. Current liabilities are $4,300. The current ratio for Mackay Industries is calculated as:

Current Ratio =

$3,100 + $2,500 + $1,600 + $6,300 = 3.14 $4,300

The quick ratio for Mackay Industries is calculated as:

Quick Ratio 

($3,100  $2,500  $1,600) $7,200   1.67 $4,300 $4,300

Notice the $6,300 of inventory was not considered in the calculation of the quick ratio. This is because, although inventory is a current asset, it is not considered to be a “quick” asset. The higher the current and quick ratios, the more able the business is to pay its current liabilities. Mackay Industries has a very strong current ratio and quick ratio. Mackay Industries’ current ratio of 3.14 means that it has $3.14 of current assets to pay each $1.00 of current liabilities. Mackay Industries’ quick ratio of 1.67 means that it has $1.67 of quick assets to pay each $1.00 of current liabilities.

Accounts Receivable Turnover and Receivable Collection Period

Accounts receivable turnover  Net Credit Sales divided by average Net Accounts Receivable; it measures a company’s ability to collect cash from its credit customers.

Why would a business have accounts receivable? Every business would prefer to receive cash from a sale. The answer is competition. Businesses have accounts receivable to attract customers. Accounts receivable are a way customers finance their purchases. Would you shop at Best Buy if it did not accept credit cards? Credit cards are a form of accounts receivable. So how much accounts receivable should a business have? It’s a balancing act. A business wants enough accounts receivable to attract customers and have sales. However, businesses do not want unnecessary accounts receivable. The money to finance accounts receivable is expensive. The business must also work to collect the accounts receivable and worry about bad debts. To help manage accounts receivable, a business often looks at two measures, the accounts receivable turnover and the receivable collection period. The accounts receivable turnover measures the ability to collect cash from customers who buy on credit. The higher the turnover, the more successful the business is in collecting cash. However, an accounts receivable turnover that is too high may indicate that a company is not extending credit freely enough to make sales to all potentially good customers. The accounts receivable turnover is calculated as:

Accounts Receivable Turnover 

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 347

Net Credit Sales Net Credit Sales  Average Net Accounts Receivable (Beginning Net Accounts Receivable  Ending Net Accounts Receivable)/2

03/04/14 5:22 PM

348

Chapter 7

Receivable collection ­period  Average Net Accounts Receivable divided by daily credit sales. It measures how many days it takes to collect accounts receivable.

The accounts receivable turnover is usually computed for an annual period, so the sales figure is the amount for the entire year. Average accounts receivable is computed by adding the beginning balance and ending balance of net accounts receivable and dividing the total by two. Remember that balance sheet accounts, such as accounts receivable, carry their balances from one period to the next. The ending accounts receivable for one year becomes the beginning accounts receivable for the next year. The receivable collection period looks at the same issue with a slightly different measure. The receivable collection period measures how many days it takes to collect the average balance of accounts receivable. The receivable collection period is computed as follows:

Receivable Collection Period 

Average Net Accounts Receivable (Net Credit Sales/365 Days)

To demonstrate the accounts receivable turnover and receivable collection period, assume that Mackay Industries has net credit sales for the year of $486,000; beginning net accounts receivable of $64,000; and ending net accounts receivable of $52,000. Mackay Industries would calculate the accounts receivable turnover and receivable collection period for the year as:

Accounts Receivable Turnover 

Receivable Collection Period 

$486,000 $486,000   8.38 (($64,000  $52,000)/2) $58,000

($64,000  $52,000)/2 $58,000   44 Days ($486,000/365 Days) $1,331.51

The determination of whether a company’s accounts receivable turnover is good or bad depends on the company’s credit terms. If Mackay Industries grants 30-day credit terms, its 8.38 accounts receivable turnover and 44 day receivable collection period would be viewed as poor. With 30-day credit terms, you would expect a turnover of closer to 12 (365 days divided by 30 days). If Mackay Industries grants 45-day credit terms, its 8.38 accounts receivable turnover and 44 day receivable collection period would be viewed as good. With 45-day credit terms, you would expect an accounts receivable turnover of closer to 8 (365 days divided by 45 days).

How They Do It: A Look at Business

So, what are acceptable current and quick ratios? What are a good accounts receivable turnover and receivable collection period? It depends on the business. Let’s look at Hershey and Walmart. First, let’s look at Hershey. Hershey makes and sells candy to wholesalers and retailers. When the economy is doing well, customers buy a lot of Hershey’s products. When the economy is not doing well, customers do not buy as much Hershey candy. Making and selling these products is a volatile and thus risky business. To make sure it can pay its bills, Hershey has a considerable amount of cash. On December 31, 2012, Hershey’s had $728 million in cash and cash equivalents. But Hershey also had a current ratio of 1.4 and a quick ratio of 0.8.The management of Hershey has significant liquidity to make sure it can pay its bills in good and bad times. A part of Hershey’s liquidity is the management of accounts receivable. Hershey sells to wholesalers and retailers, allowing them to pay later. Hershey has accounts receivable. Hershey’s accounts receivable turnover for its 2012 fiscal year was 15.4 times a year. It takes Hershey an average of 23.6 days to collect its average level of accounts receivable. Now, let’s look at Walmart. Walmart buys and resells clothing and household products. Walmart is a discount retailer that sells the basic goods that people need to live in good and bad times. Its sales and costs are very predictable. Its business is risky, but

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 348

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

349

not as risky as Hershey’s. To make sure it can pay its bills, Hershey has a lot of cash. On January 31, 2013, Walmart had $7.8 billion in cash. But Walmart also had a current ratio of 0.8 and a quick ratio of 0.2 at the end of the 2012 fiscal year. Walmart is a business that has less risk than Hershey. Because of the higher certainty of Walmart’s sales and operations, the management of Walmart does not believe Walmart needs as much liquidity as Hershey. A part of Walmart’s liquidity is the management of accounts receivable, particularly its credit card receivables. Walmart doesn’t loan money to its customers directly. However, Walmart accepts credit cards issued by banks. When Walmart accepts a credit card for payment, it takes several days for the bank to pay Walmart. Until the bank pays Walmart, credit card transactions are receivables. Walmart’s accounts receivable turnover for the fiscal year ending January 31, 2013, was 73.4 times a year. In other words, it takes Walmart an average of 5 days to collect its credit card receivables. Now think about and compare Hershey and Walmart. Each have accounts receivables. Accounts receivable are important in how each does business. However, Hershey and Walmart use accounts receivables differently and thus have different accounts receivable turnovers and collect periods.

Summary MyAccountingLab

1

Discuss internal controls for cash and prepare a bank reconciliation

Here is what you should know after reading this chapter. The Study Plan in MyAccountingLab will help you identify what you know and where to go when you need practice.

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Maintaining internal controls over cash is critical:

Bank balance (p. 328) Bank collection (p. 329)

• Cash receipts should be deposited promptly.

Bank reconciliation (p. 328)

• A payment process that ensures ­separation of duties is very important.

Book balance (p. 328)

• Bank reconciliations should be prepared regularly.

Bank statement (p. 328) Controller (p. 327) Deposits in transit (p. 329) Electronic data interchange (EDI) (p. 327) Electronic funds transfer (EFT) (p. 328) Lock-box system (p. 329) Nonsufficient funds (NSF) check (p. 329) Outstanding checks (p. 329) Purchase order (p. 327) Purchasing agent (p. 327) Receiving report (p. 327) Treasurer (p. 327)

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 349

03/04/14 5:22 PM

350

2

Chapter 7

Report cash on the balance sheet

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Most companies report cash and cash equivalents together on the balance sheet:

Cash equivalents (p. 334) Petty cash (p. 334)

• Cash consists of most things a bank will take as a deposit. • Cash equivalents are very liquid, shortterm investments such as money market funds.

3

4

5

Identify the different types of receivables and discuss related internal controls for accounts receivable Use the direct write-off and allowance methods to account for uncollectible accounts Report accounts receivable on the balance sheet

Granting credit to customers can generate more sales, but it comes at a cost if customers don’t pay: • GAAP requires the use of the allowance method to account for uncollectible accounts.

Aging method (p. 338) Allowance for Doubtful Accounts (p. 337) Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts (p. 337) Allowance method (p. 337) Bad debt expense (p. 335)

• The direct write-off method is generally not allowed by GAAP because it violates the matching principle.

Balance sheet approach (p. 340)

• On the balance sheet, the allowance for uncollectible accounts is subtracted from the accounts receivable balance to report the “net realizable value” of Accounts Receivable.

Direct write-off method (p. 335)

Control account (p. 337) Income statement approach (p. 338) Net credit sales (p. 337) Net realizable value (p. 337) Percent of sales method (p. 337) Uncollectible Accounts Expense (p. 335) Write off (p. 335)

6

Account for notes receivable

Notes receivable are generally longer in term than accounts receivable and are supported by a promissory note • Notes are recorded in the accounting records at face value, which is the principal amount of the note. • The maturity value of a note equals the principal amount of the note plus the interest due on the note.

Creditor (p. 343) Debtor (p. 343) Due date (p. 343) Interest (p. 343) Interest rate (p. 343) Maker of a note (p. 343) Maturity date (p. 343) Maturity value (p. 343) Note term (p. 343) Payee of a note (p. 343) Principal (p. 343) Promissory note (p. 343)

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 350

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

7

Calculate the current ratio, quick ratio, accounts receivable turnover, and receivable collection period

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Ratios frequently used to help make decisions:

Accounts receivable turnover (p. 347)

• The current ratio and quick ratio help a company determine its ability to pay ­current liabilities. • The accounts receivable turnover and ­receivable collection period measure how quickly a business collects its ­accounts receivable.

351

Acid-test ratio (p. 347) Current assets (p. 346) Current ratio (p. 346) Liquidity management (p. 346) Quick assets (p. 347) Quick ratio (p. 347) Receivable collection period (p. 348)

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 351

03/04/14 5:22 PM

352

Chapter 7

Accounting Practice Discussion Questions 1. Which duties should be segregated in the purchasing process? Why? That is, what could go wrong if two or more of those duties are not segregated? 2. After preparing a bank reconciliation, which reconciling items will require journal entries? Why? 3. What would be the surest way to eliminate the possibility of having any bad debts? Why don’t companies operate this way if it could help them eliminate this costly expense? 4. Why does the allowance method of accounting for bad debts conform to GAAP while the direct write-off method does not? 5. How is Allowance for Doubtful Accounts reported on the financial statements? Why is it important for companies to report net realizable value of Accounts Receivable on the balance sheet? 6. Why is the percent of sales method called the “income statement approach” while the aging method is called the “balance sheet approach”? 7. Under which method, percent of sales or aging, would the balance in Allowance for Doubtful Accounts, just before the adjusting entry, affect the amount of the adjusting entry? Why? 8. How would the net realizable value of Accounts Receivable change when an account is written off under the allowance method? 9. If a company with a 12/31 year-end lends money in the form of a six-month note on 11/1, which accounts will be credited when the note is paid off on 4/30? 10. Recently the United States was in a recession. What would be the expected effect of a recession on accounts receivable turnover ratios?

Self Check 1. The document that identifies and explains all differences between the company’s record of cash and the bank’s record of that cash is the a. bank reconciliation. b. electronic fund transfer. c. bank collection. d. bank statement. 2. Which item(s) appears as a reconciling item(s) to the book balance in a bank reconciliation? a. Outstanding checks b. Deposits in transit c. Both a and b d. None of the above 3. Which item(s) appears as a reconciling item(s) to the bank balance in a bank reconciliation? a. Outstanding checks b. Deposits in transit c. Both a and b d. None of the above 4. On its books, Nile Valley Company’s Cash account shows an ending balance of $950. The bank statement for the current period shows a $22 service charge and an NSF check for $140. A $220 deposit is in transit, and outstanding checks total $380. What is Nile Valley’s adjusted book balance for Cash? a. $626 b. $788 c. $818 d. $1,168

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 352

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

353

5. After performing a bank reconciliation, journal entries are required for a. all items on the book side of the reconciliation. b. all items on the bank side of the reconciliation. c. all items on the reconciliation. d. no items from the reconciliation because the Cash account needs no adjustment. 6. Uncollectible accounts are the same as a. notes receivable. b. bad debts. c. both a and b. d. none of the above. 7. Which method of estimating uncollectible receivables focuses on net credit sales? a. Aging approach b. Net realizable value approach c. Percent-of-sales approach d. All of the above 8. Your business uses the allowance method to account for uncollectible receivables. At the beginning of the year, Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts had a credit balance of $1,800. During the year you wrote off bad receivables of $2,000 and recorded Bad Debt Expense of $2,900. What is your year-end balance in Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts? a. $2,700 b. $3,800 c. $4,700 d. $3,300 9. Which of the following is true regarding the direct write-off method of accounting for uncollectibles? a. The direct write-off method does not adhere to GAAP. b. The direct write-off method does not use an allowance for uncollectible accounts and, thus, overstates assets on the balance sheet. c. The direct write-off method does not match expenses against revenues very well. d. All of the above are true. 10. On December 31, you have a $15,000 note receivable from a customer. Interest of 5% has also accrued for eight months on the note. What will your financial statements report for this situation? a. The balance sheet will report the note receivable of $15,000 and interest receivable of $500. b. The balance sheet will report the note receivable of $15,000. c. Nothing will be reported because you haven’t received the cash yet. d. The income statement will report a note receivable of $15,000. 11. In the Real World Accounting Video, Zachery Mack talks about the challenges of cash management. He was able to survive a catastrophe due to Hurricane Sandy. He was able to pay his bills and keep his business operating. He attributed his survival to which trait: a. being organized b. being optimistic c. being patient d. being positive 12. According to the Real World Accounting Video, cash sales account for approximately _________ of all sales at Alphabet City Beer. a. half, or 50% b. a quarter, or 25% c. none, or 0% d. all, or 100% Answers are given after Written Communication.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 353

03/04/14 5:22 PM

354

Chapter 7

MyAccountingLab

Short Exercises S7-1. Bank reconciliation adjustments (Learning Objective 1) 5–10 min. For each of the following, indicate whether the item is an adjustment to the bank balance or the book balance: _____ 1. Bank service charge _____ 2. Deposit in transit _____ 3. Bank collection of amount due from customer _____ 4. Interest revenue on bank balance _____ 5. Outstanding check S7-2. Bank reconciliation adjustments (Learning Objective 1) 10–15 min. Classify each of the following items as one of the following: Addition to the book balance (+ Book) Subtraction from the book balance (− Book) Addition to the bank balance (+ Bank) Subtraction from the bank balance (– Bank) _____ 1. Outstanding checks _____ 2. Deposits in transit _____ 3. NSF check _____ 4. Bank collection of our note receivable _____ 5. Interest earned on bank balance _____ 6. Bank service charge _____ 7. Book error: We credited Cash for $200. The correct amount of the check was $2,000. _____ 8. Bank error: The bank decreased our account for a check written by another customer. S7-3. Prepare a bank reconciliation (Learning Objective 1) 5–10 min. The T-account for cash and the bank statement of Sinclair Food Services for the month of October 2014 follows:

Cash

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 354

Oct 1 Oct 10 deposit Oct 31 deposit

3,310 Check #704 925 Check #705 240 Check #706

Pre-adjusted Bal @ Oct 31

2,605

640 300 930

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

Bank Statement: Bal, Oct 1 Deposits: Deposits Bank collection Interest Checks:

355

$3,310 $925 630 5 No. 704 705

Amount 640 300

Other Charges: Service charge Bal, Oct 31

1,560

(940) $ 40

(40) $3,890

Prepare Sinclair Food Services’ bank reconciliation at October 31. S7-4. Prepare bank reconciliation journal entries (Learning Objective 1) 5–10 min. Make the necessary journal entries arising from Greenacres Auto Center’s bank reconciliation presented next. Date each entry May 31 and include an explanation with each entry.

Greenacres Auto Center Bank Reconciliation May 31 BOOKS

BANK Bal, May 31 Add: Deposit in transit

Less: Outstanding checks Adjusted bank balance

$ 678 300 978

(345) $ 633

Bal, May 31 Add: Interest revenue Less: Service charge NSF Checks Adjusted book balance

$ 785 5 790 (25) (132) $ 633

S7-5. Balance sheet presentation of cash (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Prepare the current assets section of the balance sheet as of May 31, 2014, for Spices and More, Inc., using the following information:

Accounts Receivable .............................................................................................. Petty Cash.............................................................................................................. Cash in Bank Accounts .......................................................................................... Inventory................................................................................................................

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 355

$54,200 300 21,400 85,800

03/04/14 5:22 PM

356

Chapter 7 S7-6. Receivable terms (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 5–10 min. Match the term with its definition by placing the corresponding letter in the space provided: a. Creditor  c   E xample: Amounts owed to a business b. Debtor by another business or individual c. Receivables _____ 1. A  contra-account, related to accounts d. Bad Debt Expense receivable, that holds the estimated e. Allowance method amount of uncollectible receivables. f.   Allowance for Uncollectible _____ 2. A  method of accounting for uncollectAccounts ible receivables in which the company g. Percent of sales method waits until a specific customer’s ach. Aging method count receivable is uncollectible before i.    Direct write-off method recording bad debt expense. _____ 3. A  method of recording receivable losses on the basis of estimates instead of waiting to see which customers the company will not collect from. _____ 4. T he party to a credit transaction who sells goods or a service and obtains a receivable. _____ 5. A  way to estimate uncollectible accounts by analyzing individual accounts receivable according to the length of time they have been receivable. _____ 6. T he party to a credit transaction who makes a purchase and has a payable. _____ 7. C  ost to the seller of credit sales; arises from the failure to collect from credit customers. _____ 8. A  method of estimating uncollectible receivables that calculates bad debt ­expense based on net credit sales. S7-7. Direct write-off method (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. Amy Macintosh, an attorney, uses the direct write-off method to account for uncollectible receivables. On September 30, Macintosh’s accounts receivable were $16,500. During October, she earned service revenue of $21,000 on account and collected $19,000 from clients on account. She also wrote off uncollectible receivables of $1,600. What is Macintosh’s balance of Accounts Receivable on October 31? Does she expect to collect this entire amount? Why or why not? S7-8. Percent of sales allowance method (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 5–10 min. During its first year of operations, World Wide Travel earned revenue of $620,000 on account. Industry experience suggests that World Wide Travel’s uncollectible accounts will amount to 3% of revenues. On December 31, 2014, accounts receivable totaled $177,400. The company uses the allowance method to account for uncollectibles. Journalize World Wide Travel’s Bad Debt Expense using the percent-of-sales method. Show how World Wide should report Accounts Receivable on its balance sheet on December 31, 2014.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 356

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

357

S7-9. Percent of sales allowance method (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. Wilson’s Auto Repair ended 2013 with Accounts Receivable of $85,000 and a credit balance in Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts balance of $11,000. During 2014, Wilson’s Auto Repair had the following activity: a. Service revenue earned on account, $545,000. b. Collections on account, $575,000. c. Write-offs of uncollectibles, $19,000. d. Bad debt expense, estimated as 3% of service revenue. Journalize Wilson’s Auto Repair’s activity for 2014. S7-10. Aging of accounts receivable allowance method (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. The following information relates to Hani Company’s 2014 operations. Hani Company uses the allowance method for estimating uncollectible accounts. Prepare journal ­entries to record Hani Company’s 2014 transactions. a. Sold merchandise to Nadim for $2,000, terms n/30. b. Received $500 from Nadim on account. c. Wrote off as uncollectible the balance of the Nadim account when he declared bankruptcy. d. Unexpectedly received a check for $600 from Nadim. S7-11. Aging of accounts receivable allowance method (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. Umbrella.com had the following balances on December 31, 2014, before the year-end adjustments:

Accounts Receivable Bal

Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts

105,600

Bal

2,000

The aging of receivables yields these data:

Age of Accounts 1–30 Days

31–60 Days

61–90 Over 90 Total Days Days Receivables

Accounts Receivable $66,000 $24,000 $12,000 $3,600 Estimate Percentage Uncollectible ......... × 1% × 6% × 53% × 2%

$105,600

Journalize Umbrella’s entry to adjust the allowance account to its correct balance on December 31, 2014.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 357

03/04/14 5:22 PM

358

Chapter 7 S7-12. Internal controls—credit sales (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Claire Billiot, the office manager of a local office supply company, is designing its internal control system. Billiot proposes the following procedures for credit checks on new customers, sales on account, cash collections, and write-offs of uncollectible receivables: a. The Credit Department runs a credit check on all customers who apply for credit. When an account proves uncollectible, the Credit Department authorizes the writeoff of the account receivable. b. Cash receipts come into the Credit Department, which separates the cash received from the customer remittance slips. The Credit Department lists all cash receipts by customer name and the amount of cash received. c. The cash goes to the treasurer for deposit in the bank. The remittance slips go to the Accounting Department for recording of the collections. d. The controller compares the daily deposit slip to the total amount of the collections recorded. Both amounts must agree. For each of the four procedures, indicate whether the procedure includes an internal control weakness. Explain how employee fraud could occur because of the weakness. What can Claire do to strengthen the internal control system? S7-13. Notes receivable terms (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Match the term with its definition by placing the corresponding letter in the space provided: a. Interest _____1. A  written promise to pay a specified b. Note term amount of money at a particular future c. Interest rate date. d. Maker of the note _____2. The date when final payment of the note is e. Maturity date due; also called the due date. f.   Maturity value _____3. T he percentage rate of interest specified g. Payee of the note by the note for one year. h. Principal _____4. T he entity to whom the maker promises i.    Promissory note future payment. _____5. T he period of time during which interest is earned. _____6. T he amount loaned out by the payee and borrowed by the maker of the note. _____7. T he sum of the principal plus interest due at maturity. _____8. T he entity that signs the note and promises to pay the required amount. _____9. T he revenue to the payee for loaning money; the expense to the debtor. S7-14. Accounting for notes receivable (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Compute the maturity value as indicated for each of the following notes receivable. 1. A $7,000, 5%, 6-month note dated June 22. Maturity value $____________. 2. A $23,000, 6%, 60-day note dated February 15. Maturity value $____________. 3. A $15,000, 4%, 30-day note dated October 17. Maturity value $____________. 4. A $9,000, 7%, 6-month note dated December 15. Maturity value $____________.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 358

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

359

S7-15. Accounting for notes receivable (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Nisrine, Inc. has the following transactions related to notes receivable during the last month of the year. Journalize the transactions for Nisrine, Inc.

Dec

1 Loaned $20,000 cash to Wael on a 1-year, 6% note. 16 Sold goods to Loubna, receiving a $4,800, 60-day, 7% note. 31 Accrued interest revenue on all notes receivable.

S7-16. Quick ratio (Learning Objective 7) 5–10 min. Calculate the quick assets and the quick ratio for each of the following companies:

Cash................................................................................................... Short-term Investments..................................................................... Net Receivables.................................................................................. Current Liabilities...............................................................................

Rhodes

Peters

$15,000 6,000 41,000 40,000

$ 23,000 13,000 51,000 108,750

S7-17. Accounts Receivable Turnover and Receivable Collection Period (Learning Objective 7) 5–10 min.

Company Name Marina Oceana Panacea

Net Credit Sales

Beginning Ending Net Receivables Net Receivables $30,000 $42,000 $ 5,800

$ 5,000 $52,000 $ 5,400

$180,000 $400,000 $ 75,000

Which company is doing the best job of managing its accounts receivable? Why? Be sure to support your answer with computations.

MyAccountingLab

Exercises (Group A) E7-18A. Bank reconciliation adjustments (Learning Objective 1) 10–15 min. Calculate the answers for the missing data: BOOKS

BANK Bal, Jan 31 Add: Deposit in transit

Less: Outstanding checks Adjusted bank balance

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 359

$1,045 620 (a)

(b) $1,310

Bal, Jan 31 Add: Bank collection Interest revenue Less: Service charge Adjusted book balance

(c) 635 15 (d) (45) $1,310

03/04/14 5:22 PM

360

Chapter 7 E7-19A. Prepare a bank reconciliation and journal entries (Learning Objective 1) 20–25 min. Chester’s Produce’s checkbook lists the following:

Date 6/1 5 10 14 15 19 27 28 29

Check No. 922 923 924 925 926 927

Item

Check

West St. Kitchen Dividends received Kingpin Products Fauna (payment on account) Cash Staples Miller Properties Monthly Sales

$

Deposit

Balance $1,420 1,405 1,745 1,697 1,629 1,530 1,386 719 4,939

15 $ 340 48 68 99 144 667 4,220

Chester’s Produce’s June bank statement shows the following:

$1,420 340

Bal, Jun 1 Deposits: Checks:

No. 922 923 924 925

Amount $ 15 48 78* 99

Other Charges: Printed checks Service charge Bal, Jun 30

(240) $12 22

(34) $1,486

*This amount is correct for check no. 924.

Requirements 1. Prepare Chester’s Produce’s bank reconciliation on June 30, 2014. How much cash does Chester’s Produce actually have on June 30? 2. Prepare all necessary journal entries for Chester’s Produce to update the Cash ­account as a result of the bank reconciliation. E7-20A. Prepare a bank reconciliation (Learning Objective 1) 20–25 min. Information from Pring’s Picture Frames’ Cash account as well as the July bank statement are presented next.

Cash Jul 1 Jul 30

Pre-adjusted Bal @ Jul 31

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 360

2,106 Check #210 1,430 Check #211 Check #212 Check #213 Check #214

28 500 63 270 145

2,530

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

Bank Statement: Bal, Jul 1 Deposits: EFT—rent Checks:

361

$2,106 850 No. 210 211 212

Amount 280 500 63

Other Charges: Service charge Check printing NSF check #201 Bal, Jul 31

(843) $ 35 28 75

(138) $1,975

Check #210 was written for $280 to pay salaries expense. Requirements Quick solution:

1. Prepare the bank reconciliation on July 31.

1. Adjusted cash balance = $2,990

2. Prepare all necessary journal entries for Pring’s Picture Frames to update the Cash account as a result of the bank reconciliation. E7-21A. Direct write-off method (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. Blue Mountain, Inc., uses the direct write-off method to account for bad debts. Record the following transactions that occurred during the year:

May 3 Nov 8 Dec 10

Provided $4,450 of services to Ken Reeve on account. Wrote off Ken Reeve’s $4,450 account as uncollectible. Unexpectedly collected $1,000 from Ken Reeve on the account that had been written off. Blue Mountain, Inc., does not expect to collect the remaining balance.

E7-22A. Percent of sales allowance method (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Charly’s Automotive ended December 2013 with Accounts Receivable of $72,000 and a credit balance in Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts of $2,800. During January 2014, Charly’s Automotive completed the following transactions:

a. Sales of $273,000, which included $141,000 in credit sales and $132,000 of cash sales. Ignore cost of goods sold. b. Cash collections on account, $128,000. c. Write-offs of uncollectible receivables, $2,300. d. Bad debt expense, estimated as 1% of credit sales. Requirements 1. Prepare journal entries to record sales (ignore cost of goods sold), collections, write-offs of uncollectibles, and bad debt expense by the percent-of-sales method. 2. Calculate the ending balances in Accounts Receivable, Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts, and net Accounts Receivable at January 31, 2014. How much does Charly’s Automotive expect to collect?

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 361

03/04/14 5:22 PM

362

Chapter 7 E7-23A. Aging of accounts receivable allowance method (Learning Objective 4) 15–20 min. Al Ahlia Company had a $600 credit balance in Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts at December 31, 2014, before the current year’s provision for uncollectible accounts. An aging of the accounts receivable revealed the following:

Estimated Percentage Uncollectible Current Accounts 1–30 days past due 31–60 days past due 61–90 days past due Over 90 days past due Total Accounts Receivable

$183,000 17,000 13,500 6,500 19,000 $239,000

1% 3% 6% 10% 20%

Requirements a. Prepare the adjusting entry on December 31, 2014, to recognize bad debts expense using the aging of receivables method. b. Assume the same facts as above except that the Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts had a $600 debit balance before the current year’s provision for ­uncollectible accounts. Prepare the adjusting entry for the current year’s provision for ­uncollectible accounts. E7-24A. Percent of sales and aging of accounts receivable allowance methods (Learning Objective 4) 15–20 min. EasternTextile uses the allowance method to account for uncollectible accounts. On December 31, 2014, Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts has a $1,475 credit ­balance. Journalize the year-end adjusting entry for uncollectible accounts assuming the following independent scenarios: 1. Eastern Textile estimates uncollectible accounts as 1/5 of 1% of net credit sales. Net credit sales for the year equal $1,475,000. 2. Based on an aging of Accounts Receivable, Eastern Textile estimates that uncollectible accounts will equal $4,250. E7-25A. Accounting for notes receivable (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. On September 30, 2014, Citibank loaned $800,000 to George Wells on a one-year, 9% note. Requirements 1. Compute the interest for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2015, on the Wells note. Round interest calculations to the nearest dollar. 2. Which party has a.  a note receivable? b.  a note payable? c.  interest revenue? d.  interest expense? 3. How much in total would Wells pay the bank if he pays off the note early on April 30, 2015?

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 362

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

363

E7-26A. Accounting for notes receivable (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. Journalize the following transactions for Antoine Co. based on the notes receivable during the last 2 months of the year.

Nov 1 Dec 11 16 31

Loaned $120,000 cash to Jad on a 1-year, 10% note. Sold goods to Rabie, Inc., receiving a $7,200, 90-day, 5% note. Received a $20,000, 6-month, 9% note to settle an open account from Moe. Accrued interest revenue on all notes receivable.

E7-27A. Accounting for notes receivable (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. Jonah Enterprises sells on account. When a customer account becomes four months old, Jonah converts the account to a note receivable. During 2014, Jonah completed these transactions:

Jan 29 Jun 1 Jul 31

Sold goods on account to Belmont, Inc., $24,000. Ignore cost of goods sold. Received a $24,000, 60-day, 12% note from Belmont, Inc., in satisfaction of its past-due account receivable. Collected the Belmont, Inc., note at maturity. Use a 360-day year for interest computation and round to the nearest dollar. Requirement 1. Record the transactions in Jonah Enterprises’ journal.

E7-28A. Quick ratio and current ratio (Learning Objective 7) 15–20 min. Consider the following data:

COMPANY Cash................................................ Short-term Investments.................. Net Receivables............................... Total current assets ........................ Current Liabilities............................

A

B

C

D

$ 60,000 58,000 160,000 320,000 180,000

$ 75,000 20,000 115,000 230,000 95,000

$25,000 14,000 26,000 80,000 45,000

$105,000 24,000 150,000 315,000 340,000

Requirements 1. Calculate the quick assets and the quick ratio for each company. 2. Calculate the current ratio for each company. 3. Which of the companies should be concerned about its liquidity? E7-29A. Quick ratio, current ratio, and accounts receivable turnover (Learning Objective 7) 15–20 min. Cherokee Equipment reported the following items on December 31, 2014 (amounts in thousands, with last year’s amounts also given as needed):

Accounts Payable........................ Cash............................................ Inventory: December 31, 2014................ December 31, 2013................ Net Credit Sales .......................... Long-term Assets ....................... Long-term Liabilities ...................

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 363

$ 450 220 200 140 1,911 400 10

Accounts Receivable, Net: December 31, 2014................ December 31, 2013................ Cost of Goods Sold ..................... Short-term Investments.............. Other Current Assets................... Other Current Liabilities ..............

$ 250 170 1,100 168 60 130

03/04/14 5:22 PM

364

Chapter 7 Requirements 1. Compute Cherokee Equipment’s (a) quick ratio, (b) current ratio, and (c) accounts receivable turnover for 2014. 2. Evaluate each ratio value as strong or weak. Assume Cherokee Equipment sells on terms of net 30.

MyAccountingLab

Exercises (Group B) E7-30B. Bank reconciliation adjustments (Learning Objective 1) 10–15 min. Calculate the answers for the missing data:

BOOKS

BANK Bal, Dec 31 Add: Deposit in transit

$ 1,060 680 (a)

Less: Outstanding checks Adjusted bank balance

(b) $1,340

Bal, Dec 31 Add: Bank collection Interest revenue

(c) 425 35 (d)

Less: Service charge Adjusted book balance

(45) $1,340

E7-31B. Prepare a bank reconciliation and journal entries (Learning Objective 1) 20–25 min. Cliff’s Construction’s checkbook lists the following:

Date 4/1 5 10 14 15 19 27 28 30

Check No. 922 923 924 925 926 927

Item

Check

Westin Kitchen Dividends received Best Products Fergus (payment on account) Cash Office Supply James Town Properties Monthly Sales

Deposit

$ 10 $ 325 41 67 163 186 527 2,890

Balance $1,385 1,375 1,700 1,659 1,592 1,429 1,243 716 3,606

Cliff’s Construction’s April bank statement shows the following:

Bal, Apr 1 Deposits: Checks:

$1,385 325 No. 922 923 924 925

Other Charges: Printed checks Service charge Bal, Apr 30

Amount $ 10 41 76* 163

(290) $32 25

(57) $1,363

*This amount is correct for check no. 924.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 364

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

365

Requirements 1. Prepare Cliff’s Construction’s bank reconciliation on April 30, 2014. How much cash does Cliff’s Construction actually have on April 30? 2. Prepare all necessary journal entries for Cliff’s Construction to update the Cash account as a result of the bank reconciliation. E7-32B. Prepare a bank reconciliation (Learning Objective 1) 20–25 min. Information from Addison Picture Frames’ Cash account as well as the November bank statement are presented next.

Cash Nov 1 Nov 30

Pre-adjusted Bal @ Nov 30

Bank Statement: Bal, Nov 1 Deposits: EFT—rent Checks:

1,600 Check #210 2,700 Check #211 Check #212 Check #213 Check #214

33 400 113 300 150

3,304

$ 1,600 410 No. 210 211 212

Amount 330 400 113

Other Charges: Service charge Check printing NSF check #201 Bal, Nov 30

(843) $ 23 14 100

(137) $ 1,030

Check #210 was written for $330 to pay salaries expense. Requirements 1. Prepare the bank reconciliation on November 30. 2. Prepare all necessary journal entries for Addison Picture Frames to update the Cash account as a result of the bank reconciliation. E7-33B. Direct write-off method (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. Fesler Industries uses the direct write-off method to account for bad debts. Record the following transactions that occurred during the year:

May 3 Nov 8 Dec 10

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 365

Provided $1,300 of services to Beth Wilson on account. Wrote off Beth Wilson’s $1,300 account as uncollectible. Unexpectedly collected $1,150 from Beth Wilson on the account that had been written off. Fesler Industries does not expect to collect the remaining balance.

03/04/14 5:22 PM

366

Chapter 7 E7-34B. Percent of sales allowance method (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Teck Automotive ended December 2013 with Accounts Receivable of $30,000 and a credit balance in Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts of $4,000. During January 2014, Teck Automotive completed the following transactions:

a. Sales of $158,000, which included $98,000 in credit sales and $60,000 of cash sales. Ignore cost of goods sold. b. Cash collections on account, $77,000. c. Write-offs of uncollectible receivables, $900. d. Bad debt expense, estimated as 1% of credit sales. Requirements 1. Prepare journal entries to record sales (ignore cost of goods sold), collections, write-offs of uncollectibles, and bad debt expense by the percent-of-sales method. 2. Calculate the ending balances in Accounts Receivable, Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts, and net Accounts Receivable at January 31, 2014. How much does Teck Automotive expect to collect? E7-35B. Aging of accounts receivable allowance method (Learning Objective 4) 15–20 min. On October 31, 2014, the Accounts Receivable balance of Richards Manufacturing is $307,000. The Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts has a $4,200 credit balance. Richards Manufacturing prepares the following aging schedule for its accounts receivable:

Age of Accounts

Accounts Receivable ............................... Estimated Percentage Uncollectible ........

1–30 Days

31–60 Days

61–90 Days

Over 90 Days

$125,000 0.3%

$80,000 4.0%

$61,000 6.0%

$7,000 55%

Requirements 1. Journalize the year-end adjusting entry for uncollectible accounts on the basis of the aging schedule. Calculate the resulting ending balance of the Allowance account based on the account aging. Show the T-account for the Allowance on October 31, 2014. 2. Assume that instead of a $4,200 credit balance, there is a $1,300 debit balance in the Allowance account prior to adjustment. Journalize the year-end adjusting entry for uncollectible accounts on the basis of the aging schedule. Calculate the resulting ending balance of the Allowance account based on the account aging. Show the T-account for the Allowance on October 31, 2014. E7-36B. Percent of sales and aging of accounts receivable allowance methods (Learning Objective 4) 15–20 min. Outerbanks, Inc., uses the allowance method to account for uncollectible accounts. On December 31, 2014, Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts has a $1,300 credit balance. Journalize the year-end adjusting entry for uncollectible accounts assuming the following independent scenarios: 1. Outerbanks, Inc., estimates uncollectible accounts as 3/4 of 1% of net credit sales. Net credit sales for the year equal $800,000. 2. Based on an aging of Accounts Receivable, Outerbanks, Inc. estimates that uncollectible accounts will equal $2,650.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 366

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

367

E7-37B. Accounting for notes receivable (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. On July 31, 2014, Texas State Bank loaned $475,000 to Gina Baldwin on a one-year, 6% note. Requirements 1. Compute the interest for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2015, on the Baldwin note. Round interest calculations to the nearest dollar. 2. Which party has a.  a note receivable? b.  a note payable? c.  interest revenue? d.  interest expense? 3. How much in total would Baldwin pay the bank if she pays off the note early on January 31, 2015? E7-38B. Accounting for notes receivable (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. Journalize the following transactions of Baltic, Inc., which ends its accounting year on September 30:

May 1 Sep 17 30

Loaned $16,000 cash to Steve Franklin on a one-year, 6% note. Sold goods to Findlay, Corp., receiving a 90-day, 10% note for $12,000. Ignore cost of goods sold. Made a single entry to accrue interest revenue on both notes. Use a 360-day year for interest computations and round to the nearest dollar. E7-39B. Accounting for notes receivable (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. Sanchez Enterprises sells on account. When a customer account becomes four months old, Sanchez converts the account to a note receivable. During 2014, Sanchez ­completed these transactions:

Jan 31 Jun 1 Jul 31

Sold goods on account to Jitterz Coffee, 12,000. Ignore cost of goods sold. Received a $12,000, 60-day, 7% note from Jitterz Coffee, in satisfaction of its past-due account receivable. Collected the Jitterz Coffee, note at maturity. Use a 360-day year for interest computation and round to the nearest dollar. Requirement 1. Record the transactions in Sanchez Enterprises’ journal.

E7-40B. Quick ratio and current ratio (Learning Objective 7) 15–20 min. Consider the following data:

COMPANY Cash................................................ Short-term Investments.................. Net Current Receivables.................. Total Current Assets........................ Current Liabilities............................

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 367

A

B

C

D

$ 95,000 85,000 120,000 325,000 200,000

$ 67,000 30,000 113,000 224,000 255,000

$20,000 14,000 50,000 96,000 60,000

$103,000 53,000 145,000 368,000 260,000

03/04/14 5:22 PM

368

Chapter 7 Requirements 1. Calculate the quick assets and the quick ratio for each company. 2. Calculate the current ratio for each company. 3. Which of the companies should be concerned about its liquidity? E7-41B. Quick ratio, current ratio, and accounts receivable turnover (Learning Objective 7) 15–20 min. Midwest Equipment reported the following items on July 31, 2014 (amounts in thousands, with last year’s amounts also given as needed):

Accounts Payable........................ Cash............................................ Inventory: July 31, 2014 ......................... July 31, 2013 ......................... Net Credit Sales .......................... Long-term Assets ....................... Long-term Liabilities ...................

$ 360 130 145 130 3,270 360 30

Accounts Receivable, Net: July 31, 2014 .............................. 280 July 31, 2013 .............................. 260 Cost of Goods Sold .......................... 1,160 Short-term Investments................... 95 Other Current Assets........................ 65 Other Current Liabilities ................... 25

Requirements 1. Compute Midwest Equipment’s (a) quick ratio, (b) current ratio, and (c) accounts receivable turnover for 2014. 2. Evaluate each ratio value as strong or weak. Assume Midwest Equipment sells on terms of net 30.

MyAccountingLab

Problems (Group A) P7-42A. Prepare a bank reconciliation (Learning Objective 1) 20–25 min. The April cash records of Petrov, Inc., follow:

Date Apr 4 9 14 17 30

Cash Receipts (CR) Cash Debit $3,120 580 910 325 1,980

Cash Payments (CP) Check No. Cash Credit $ 18 1416 670 1417 92 1418 116 1419 954 1420 237 1421 2,120 1422

Petrov’s Cash account shows the balance of $6,570 on April 30. On April 30, Petrov, Inc., received the following bank statement:

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 368

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables Bank Statement for April Beginning Balance Deposits and other additions Apr 1 5 10 15 18 30 Checks and other deductions Apr 8 15 (Check no. 1416) 19 22 (Check no. 1417) 29 (Check no. 1418) 30 (Check no. 1419) 30 Ending Balance

369

$ 3,862 $ 660 EFT 3,120 580 910 325 1,600 BC $ 317 NSF 18 335 EFT 670 92 161 35 SC

7,195

(1,628) $ 9,429

Explanations: BC—bank collection; EFT—electronic funds transfer; NSF—nonsufficient funds check; SC—service charge.

Additional data for the bank reconciliation: a. The EFT deposit was a receipt of rent revenue. The EFT debit was payment of ­insurance expense. b. The NSF check was received from a customer. c. The $1,600 bank collection was for a note receivable. d. The correct amount of check 1419 is $161. Petrov, Inc., mistakenly recorded the check for $116. Requirement 1. Prepare Petrov’s bank reconciliation at April 30. P7-43A. Prepare a bank reconciliation (Learning Objective 1) 20–25 min. The July bank statement of Brendan’s Hamburgers just arrived from Liberty Bank.

July Bank Statement: Bal, Jul 1 Deposits: EFT—rent EFT—deposit Interest Checks:

Other Charges: Service charge NSF check #998 NSF check #201 Bal, Jul 31

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 369

$13,264 $900 350 5 No. 807 808 1668

Amount 450 50 600

1,255

(1,100) $ 19 60 171

(250) $13,169

03/04/14 5:22 PM

370

Chapter 7 To prepare the bank reconciliation, you gather the following additional data: a. The following checks are outstanding at July 31:

Check No. 800 .......................................................................................................................... 802 .......................................................................................................................... 806 .......................................................................................................................... 809 .......................................................................................................................... 810 .......................................................................................................................... 811 ..........................................................................................................................

Amount $353 80 32 104 227 40

b. On July 31, Brendan’s Hamburgers’ treasurer deposited $372, but this deposit does not appear on the bank statement. c. The bank statement includes a $600 deduction for check #1668 written by Harriet’s Hair Salon rather than Brendan’s Hamburgers. Brendan’s Hamburgers notified the bank of this bank error. d. Brendan’s Hamburgers’ Cash account shows a balance of $12,300 on July 31. e. The EFT deposit for $900 was a collection of rent revenue and the EFT deposit for $350 was a collection on account. Requirements 1. Prepare the bank reconciliation for July 31. 2. Record the entries called for by the reconciliation. Include an explanation for each entry. P7-44A. Direct write-off method and percent of sales allowance method (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 20–25 min. On October 31, Ash Tennis Equipment had an $82,000 debit balance in Accounts Receivable. During November, Ash Tennis Equipment had the following transactions:

•  Sales of $627,000, all on credit. Ignore cost of goods sold. •  Collections on account, $613,000. •  Write-offs of uncollectible receivables, $4,800. Requirements 1. Assume that Ash Tennis Equipment uses the allowance method to account for uncollectible accounts and that there was a $2,700 credit balance in the allowance account on October 31. Prepare journal entries to record sales (ignore cost of goods sold), collections on account, and write-offs of uncollectible accounts for the month of November. Next, assuming that bad debt expense is estimated at 2% of credit sales, prepare the adjusting journal entry to record bad debts expense. Enter the beginning balances and post all November activity in T-accounts for Accounts Receivable, Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts, and Bad Debt Expense. 2. Suppose that instead of the allowance method, Ash Tennis Equipment uses the direct write-off method to account for uncollectible receivables. Prepare journal entries to record sales, collections on account, and write-offs of uncollectible accounts for the month of November. Enter the beginning balances and post all November activity in T-accounts for Accounts Receivable and Bad Debt Expense. 3. What amount of bad debt expense would Ash Tennis Equipment report on its November income statement under each of the two methods? Which amount better matches expenses with revenue? Give your reason. 4. What amount of net accounts receivable would Ash Tennis Equipment report on its November 30 balance sheet under each of the two methods? Which amount is more realistic? Give your reason.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 370

03/04/14 5:22 PM

Cash and Receivables

371

P7-45A. Aging of accounts receivable allowance method (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 15–20 min. Dialex Supply completed the following selected transactions during 2014:

Jan 17 Jun 29 Aug 6 Sep 4 Dec 31 Dec 31

Sold inventory to Van Vasque, $1,200, on account. Ignore cost of goods sold. Wrote off the Van Vasque account as uncollectible after repeated efforts to collect from him. Received $50 from Van Vasque, along with a letter stating his intention to pay within 30 days. Reinstated his account in full. Received the balance due from Van Vasque. Made a compound entry to write off the following accounts as uncollectible: Brent Christian, $150; May Milford, $800; and Susan Smith, $300. Based on an aging of accounts receivable, estimated uncollectible accounts as $1,100.

Requirements Quick solution: 2. Adjusting journal entry amount to record bad debts ­expense = $1,050; Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts ­ ending balance = $1,100; Bad Debt Expense ending balance = $1,050

1. Open T-accounts for Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts and Bad Debt Expense. These accounts have beginning balances of $1,300 (cr.) and 0, respectively. 2. Record the transactions in the journal and post to the two T-accounts; remember to update the account balances but ignore posting references. 3. The December 31 balance of Accounts Receivable is $147,000. Show how Accounts Receivable would be reported on the balance sheet at that date. P7-46A. Accounting for notes receivable (Learning Objective 6) 20–25 min. Buck Insurance Agency received the following notes during 2014:

Note

Date

Principal Amount

Interest Rate

Term

(1) (2) (3)

Dec 23 Nov 30 Dec 7

$21,000 15,000 9,000

6% 5% 8%

1 year 4 months 30 days

Requirements 1. Identifying each note by number, compute the total interest on each note over the note term using a 360-day year, and determine the due date and maturity value of each note. Round interest calculations to the nearest dollar. 2. Journalize a single adjusting entry on December 31, 2014, to record accrued interest revenue on all three notes. Round interest calculations to the nearest dollar. Explanations are not required. 3. For note (1), journalize the collection of principal and interest at maturity. Explanations are not required.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 371

03/04/14 5:22 PM

372

Chapter 7 P7-47A. Accounting for notes receivable (Learning Objective 6) 20–25 min. Record the following transactions in the journal of Jo Jo Music. Explanations are not ­required. Use a 360-day year for interest computations and round to the nearest dollar.

2013 Dec 19 31 31 2014 Mar 18 Jun 1 Oct 31 Dec 1

Received a $3,000, 90-day, 8% note on account from The Music Man. Made an adjusting entry to accrue interest on The Music Man note. Made a closing entry for interest revenue. Collected the maturity value of The Music Man note. Loaned $15,000 cash to Main Street Music, receiving a six-month, 7% note. Received a $4,500, 60-day, 10% note from Voice Publishing on its past-due account receivable. Collected the maturity value of the Main Street Music note.

P7-48A. Quick ratio, current ratio, accounts receivable turnover, and receivable collection period (Learning Objective 7) 20–25 min. The comparative financial statements of Blue Oyster Restaurants for 2014, 2013, and 2012 include the following selected data:

2014 Balance Sheet Current Assets: Cash Short-term Investments Receivables, Net of Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts of $5, $5, and $4 respectively Inventory Prepaid Expenses Total Current Assets Total Current Liabilities Income Statement Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold

$

48 114

(In Thousands) 2013

$

67 232

2012

$

41 218

259 422 22 865

241 397 29 966

219 313 44 835

$ 598

$ 626

$ 608

$5,141 2,728

$5,211 2,612

$4,253 2,476

Requirements 1. Compute these ratios for 2014 and 2013: a.  Quick ratio. b.  Current ratio. c.  Accounts receivable turnover. Assume all sales are credit sales. d.  Receivable collection period. Assume all sales are credit sales. Use 365 days. 2. Write a memo explaining to the company owner which ratios improved from 2013 to 2014, which ratios deteriorated, and which items in the financial statements changed and caused changes in some ratios. Discuss whether this change conveys a favorable or an unfavorable impression about the company.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 372

03/04/14 5:23 PM

Cash and Receivables

MyAccountingLab

373

Problems (Group B) P7-49B. Prepare a bank reconciliation (Learning Objective 1) 20–25 min. The July cash records of Fitzgerald, Inc., follow:

Cash Receipts (CR) Cash Debit Date $2,739 Jul 4 533 9 856 14 353 17 2,023 31

Cash Payments (CP) Check No. Cash Credit $ 12 1416 775 1417 91 1418 128 1419 985 1420 215 1421 2,265 1422

Fitzgerald’s Cash account shows the balance of $6,078 on July 31. On July 31, Fitzgerald received the following bank statement:

Bank Statement for July Beginning Balance Deposits and other additions: Jul 1 5 10 15 18 31 Checks and other deductions: Jul 8 15 (Check no. 1416) 19 22 (Check no. 1417) 29 (Check no. 1418) 31 (Check no. 1419) 31 Ending Balance

$ 4,045 $ 650 EFT 2,739 533 856 353 1,300 BC $ 452 NSF 12 350 EFT 775 91 218 20 SC

6,431

(1,918) $ 8,558

Explanations: BC—bank collection; EFT—electronic funds transfer; NSF—nonsufficient funds checks; SC—service charge.

Additional data for the bank reconciliation: a. The EFT deposit was a receipt of rent revenue. The EFT debit was payment of insurance expense. b. The NSF check was received from a customer. c. The $1,300 bank collection was for a note receivable. d. The correct amount of check number 1419 is $218. Fitzgerald, Inc., mistakenly ­recorded the check for $128. Requirement 1. Prepare Fitzgerald, Inc.’s bank reconciliation on July 31.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 373

03/04/14 5:23 PM

374

Chapter 7 P7-50B. Prepare a bank reconciliation (Learning Objective 1) 20–25 min. The October bank statement of Julio’s Hamburgers just arrived from Safety Bank.

Bank Statement for October Bal, Oct 1 Deposits: EFT—rent EFT—deposit Interest No. Checks: 807 808 812 Other Charges: Service charge NSF check #698 NSF check #701 Bal, Oct 31

$13,418 $850 225 8 Amount $775 160 718

1,083

(1,653) $ 35 72 186

(293) $12,555

To prepare the bank reconciliation, you gather the following additional data: a. The following checks are outstanding on October 31:

Check No. 800 .......................................................................................................................... 802 .......................................................................................................................... 806 .......................................................................................................................... 809 .......................................................................................................................... 810 .......................................................................................................................... 811 ..........................................................................................................................

Amount $323 81 27 147 215 46

b. On October 31, Julio’s Hamburgers’ treasurer deposited $400, but this deposit does not appear on the bank statement. c. The bank statement includes a $745 deduction for a check #1668 written by Harry’s Hotdogs rather than Julio’s Hamburgers. Julio’s Hamburgers notified the bank of this bank error. d. Julio’s Cash account shows a balance of $12,071 on October 31. e. The EFT for $700 was a collection of rent revenue and the EFT deposit for $225 was a collection on account. Requirements 1. Prepare the bank reconciliation for October 31. 2. Record the journal entries called for by the reconciliation. Include an explanation for each entry.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 374

03/04/14 5:23 PM

Cash and Receivables

375

P7-51B. Direct write-off method and percent of sales allowance method (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 20–25 min. On March 31, King’s Tennis Equipment had a $210,000 debit balance in Accounts Receivable. During April, King’s Tennis Equipment had the following transactions:

•  Sales of $510,000, all on credit. Ignore cost of goods sold. •  Collections on account, $525,000. •  Write-offs of uncollectible receivables, $5,000. Requirements 1. Assume that King’s Tennis Equipment uses the allowance method to account for uncollectible accounts and that there was a $6,300 credit balance in the allowance account on March 31. Prepare journal entries to record sales (ignore cost of goods sold), collections on account, and write-offs of uncollectible accounts for the month of April. Next, assuming that bad debt expense is estimated at 4% of credit sales, prepare the adjusting journal entry to record bad debts expense. Enter the beginning balances and post all April activity in T-accounts for Accounts Receivable, Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts, and Bad Debt Expense. 2. Suppose that instead of the allowance method, King’s Tennis Equipment uses the direct write-off method to account for uncollectible receivables. Prepare journal entries to record sales, collections on account, and write-offs of uncollectible ­accounts for the month of April. Enter the beginning balances and post all April activity in T-accounts for Accounts Receivable and Bad Debt Expense. 3. What amount of Bad Debt Expense would King’s Tennis Equipment report on its April income statement under each of the two methods? Which amount better matches expense with revenue? Give your reasoning. 4. What amount of net accounts receivable would King’s Tennis Equipment report on its April 30 balance sheet under each of the two methods? Which amount is more realistic? Give your reasoning.

P7-52B. Aging of accounts receivable allowance method (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 15–20 min. Simpson Supply completed the following selected transactions during 2014:

Jan 17 Jun 29 Aug 6 Sep 4 Dec 31 Dec 31

Sold inventory to Jon Nelson, $800 on account. Ignore cost of goods sold. Wrote off Jon Nelson’s account as uncollectible after repeated efforts to collect from him. Received $650 from Jon Nelso, along with a letter stating his intention to pay within 30 days. Reinstated Nelson’s account in full. Received the balance due from Jon Nelson. Made a compound entry to write off the following accounts as uncollectible: Bill Renz, $175; Nancy Carlson, $240; and Daria Putin, $137. Based on an aging of accounts receivable, estimated uncollectible accounts as $3,180. Requirements 1. Open T-accounts for Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts and Bad Debt Expense. These accounts have beginning balances of $1,400 (cr.) and 0, respectively. 2. Record the transactions in the journal and post to the two T-accounts; remember to update account balances but ignore posting references. 3. The December 31 balance of Accounts Receivable is $87,550. Show how Accounts Receivable would be reported on the balance sheet at that date.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 375

03/04/14 5:23 PM

376

Chapter 7 P7-53B. Accounting for notes receivable (Learning Objective 6) 20–25 min. The Oklahoma City Insurance Agency received the following notes during 2014:

Note

Date

Principal

Interest Rate

Term

(1) (2) (3)

Nov 5 Nov 30 Dec 7

$20,000 $ 6,000 $12,000

9% 13% 11%

1 year 9 months 60 days

Requirements 1. Identifying each note by number, compute the total interest on each note over the note term using a 360-day year, and determine the due date and maturity value of each note. Round interest calculations to the nearest dollar. 2. Journalize a single adjusting entry on December 31, 2014, to record accrued interest revenue on all three notes. Round interest calculations to the nearest dollar. Explanations are not required. 3. For note (1), journalize the collection of principal and interest at maturity. Explanations are not required. P7-54B. Accounting for notes receivable (Learning Objective 6) 20–25 min. Record the following transactions in the journal of Soothing Sounds Music. Explanations are not required. Use a 360-day year for interest computations and round to the nearest dollar.

2013 Dec 6 31 31 2014 Mar 5 Jun 1 Oct 31 Dec 1

Received a $6,000, 90-day, 8% note on account from LM Publishing. Made an adjusting entry to accrue interest on the LM Publishing note. Made a closing entry for interest revenue. Collected the maturity value of the LM Publishing note. Loaned $12,500 cash to London Sounds, receiving a six-month, 7% note. Received a $4,000, 60-day, 6% note from Union Music on its past-due account receivable. Collected the maturity value of the London Sounds note.

P7-55B. Quick ratio, current ratio, accounts receivable turnover, and receivable collection period (Learning Objective 7) 20–25 min. The comparative financial statements of Lakeland Restaurants for 2014, 2013, and 2012 include the following selected data: 2014 Balance Sheet Current Assets: Cash Short-term Investments Receivables, Net of Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts of $6, $6, and $5, respectively Inventory Prepaid Expenses Total Current Assets Total Current Liabilities Income Statement Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 376

(In Thousands) 2013

2012

$

55 210

$ 190 118

$ 106 120

250 440 25 1,023

290 450 40 1,006

310 300 35 910

$ 650

$ 675

$ 620

$5,184 2,760

$5,050 2,590

$4,860 2,480

03/04/14 5:23 PM

Cash and Receivables

377

Requirements 1. Compute these ratios for 2014 and 2013: a.  Quick ratio. b.  Current ratio. c.  Accounts receivable turnover. Assume all sales are credit sales. d.  Receivable collection period. Use 365 days. 2. Write a memo explaining to the company owner which ratios improved from 2013 to 2014, which ratios deteriorated, and which items in the financial statements changed and caused changes in some ratios. Discuss whether this change conveys a favorable or an unfavorable impression about the company.

Continuing Exercise In this exercise, we continue our accounting for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., from Chapter 5. Refer to the Continuing Exercise from Chapter 5. On May 15, Cole’s Yard Care, Inc. sold 30 plants to Jill Dawson for $215 on account. On June 18, Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., received $170 on account from Jill Dawson related to her May 15 purchase. On August 12, Jill notified Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., that she was filing bankruptcy and that she would not be able to pay the remaining amount owed. Requirement 1. Journalize the entry to record the payment from Jill and to record the write-off of Jill’s uncollectible account. Assume that Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., uses the direct write-off method to account for uncollectible accounts.

Continuing Problem In this problem, we continue our accounting for Aqua Magic, Inc., from Chapter 5. Refer to the Continuing Problem in Chapters 4 and 5. Assume that all 14 of the spas Aqua Magic, Inc., sold in September were sold on account for $5,250 each. Assume no collections on account were made in September. At September 30, Aqua Magic, Inc., estimates that 4% of the outstanding Accounts Receivable balance will not be collected. Aqua Magic uses the allowance method. On August 31, the balance in Accounts Receivable is $5,775 and the balance in Allowance for Doubtful Accounts is $0. Requirements 1. Calculate the ending balance in Accounts Receivable at September 30. 2. Journalize the entry to record Aqua Magic, Inc.’s bad debt expense for September. 3. How will Accounts Receivable be reflected on Aqua Magic, Inc.’s balance sheet at September 30?

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem Return to Target’s 2012 annual report. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem in Chapter 2. On page 33 of the annual report, you’ll find Target’s income statement for the year ending February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Operations). On page 35, you’ll find Target’s balance sheet as of February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position). Now answer the following questions: 1. Look at Target’s balance sheet. How much cash and cash equivalents does Target have as of February 2, 2013, and January 28, 2012? Did the cash and cash equivalents increase or decrease? 2. Look at footnote 10 of the financial statements. Footnote 10 can be found on page 43 in Target’s 2012 annual report. What does it tell you about Target’s cash equivalents?

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 377

03/04/14 5:23 PM

378

Chapter 7 3. Look at Target’s balance sheet. How much accounts receivable (credit card receivables), net of allowance for doubtful accounts (bad debt allowance), does Target have as of February 2, 2013, and January 28, 2012? 4. Look at footnote 11 of the financial statements. Footnote 11 can be found starting on page 43 of the financial statement in Target’s 2012 annual report. What does it tell you about the receivables? 5. Using Target’s balance sheet, compute Target’s current and quick ratios for the years ending February 2, 2013, and January 28, 2012. Have they changed? What do these ratios tell you about Target’s management of liquidity? 6. Use Target’s balance sheet and income statement to compute Target’s accounts receivable turnover and receivable collection period for 2012. What do these ratios tell you about Target’s management of receivables? (Assume all sales are on credit and ignore credit card revenues.) 7. Looking back over your answers to questions 1 through 6, how do you think Target is performing? What do you think about Target’s management of cash and receivables?

Apply Your Knowledge Ethics in Action Case 1. Susan Casey is the controller of Casey’s Collectibles. The business uses the accrual method of accounting and recognizes sales revenue in the period in which the sale is made. As a result, the Accounts Receivable balance at year-end was $86,370, which was net of the Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts of $1,310. Susan was completing the year-end financial statements for the business in order to apply for a much-needed business loan when she saw a letter from a district court. The letter was to inform her, as controller of Casey’s Collectibles, that Jerome Smith had declared bankruptcy. As it turned out, Jerome was Casey’s Collectibles’ largest customer and his account receivable balance was $22,375, which the bankruptcy notification letter stated was never going to be paid. When Susan looked over the account receivable aging schedule, she saw that Jerome’s account was more than 90 days past due, and even though Susan had been suspicious, she still hoped that Jerome would pay his account balance. Susan thought that if she wrote off Jerome’s account, the bank would become concerned. She then thought that had she not been so quick to open the mail, she would have not known that Jerome was bankrupt, and the balance sheet she was about to present to the bank would be fine. Knowing how potentially damaging this new information could be, Susan decided to ignore it for the moment and simply go ahead with the balance sheet she had originally planned to give to the bank. Should Susan provide the bank with a new balance sheet that reflects this new information? Would Susan have been fine with the original balance sheet had she simply waited to open the mail? Are any ethical issues involved with updating financial statement information for subsequent events? Did Susan not properly use the allowance method as she only had a balance for doubtful accounts of $1,310? Would Susan need to inform the bank had the bankruptcy letter been from a customer with an account receivable balance of $132? Case 2. Bob and Larry were finishing the financial statements for their business when they saw the net income for the year was not going to be as large as they had hoped. Concerned that the bank would question the lower reported net income, Bob suggested that they reduce the percentage used to estimate uncollectible accounts for the current year from 5% of credit sales to 1% of credit sales. Larry quickly pointed out that, for the past seven years, bad debts have always been approximately 5% of the total credit sales. Bob then said that the key was simply that an “estimate” was used to compute the bad debt expense, so why not simply change the percentage from the “5% estimate” to a “1% estimate”? Larry was concerned because the change was not due to new business information; rather, it was due to pressure to increase the current year’s profit by reducing the amount of bad debt expense currently included in the income statement. He told Bob that the current year credit sales were $6,587,000 and the Bad Debt Expense should

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 378

03/04/14 5:23 PM

Cash and Receivables

379

be 5% or $329,350, not 1% or $65,870, because they could expect that, over the next fiscal year, approximately $329,000 of Accounts Receivable would end up as uncollectible. Bob pointed out, however, that by only using a 1% estimate, the current year net income would be much larger because the amount of Bad Debt Expense would only be $65,870 instead of the larger $329,350. He noted that the allowance account would also be reduced so the net Accounts Receivable on the balance sheet would be larger as well. Besides, Bob told Larry that they could worry about it in the next fiscal year. Larry told Bob that the bank would find out what they had done, to which Bob said there would be no problem; they could just say they made a mistake in their estimate. Would it be unethical to change the percentage used to compute the current year’s bad debt expense? Would it be acceptable to change the percentage amount if the change was disclosed? Would it be acceptable if they compromised and used 3%? If they had used a new screening method to determine the creditworthiness of customers and, as a result, were certain that the bad debts would be drastically reduced, could they change the percentage amount used? What do you think would happen if they used the 1% of credit sales for the current year’s financial statements? What would you recommend?

Know Your Business Financial Analysis Purpose: To help familiarize you with the financial reporting of a real company in order to further your understanding of the chapter material you are learning. This case will address the accounts receivable reflected on Columbia Sportswear’s Balance sheet. We will once again refer to the annual report for Columbia Sportswear located in Appendix A in order to answer some questions related to Columbia Sportswear’s receivables. Requirements 1. What was the net Accounts Receivable balance as of December 31, 2012? What was the net Accounts Receivable balance as of December 31, 2011? Did the amount of accounts receivable increase or decrease during the year? 2. Based on Columbia Sportswear’s balance sheet, does it appear that the allowance method is used to account for uncollectible receivables? Why or why not? 3. Can you determine the total amount of Accounts Receivable Columbia Sportswear had as of December 31, 2012? 4. Did the amount of the allowance for doubtful accounts increase or decrease during 2012?

Industry Analysis Purpose: To help you understand and compare the performance of two companies in the same industry. Find the Columbia Sportswear Company Annual Report located in Appendix A and go to the Financial Statements starting on page 690. Now access the 2012 Annual Report for Under Armour, Inc., from the Internet. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Industry Analysis in Chapter 1. The company’s Financial Statements start on page 48. Requirement 1. Calculate the accounts receivable turnover for both companies for 2012. Who has the highest accounts receivable turnover? Is that good or bad? Is it better to have a high accounts receivable turnover or a low accounts receivable turnover? Explain your answer. Assume net sales are all credit sales.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 379

03/04/14 5:23 PM

380

Chapter 7

Small Business Analysis Purpose: To help you understand the importance of cash flows in the operation of a small business. You’re pretty excited about your cash balance at the end of the month because this was the month you were going to take the big bonus from the business and make a down payment on a new house. You were waiting on a big check to come in from a client who has owed you for several months. You had considered writing it off because you had heard through some business associates that the company had been experiencing some financial difficulties. However, after your telephone call to the company the first of the week, the check finally arrived. You rushed the check down to the bank and deposited it. A couple days later, you access your account online at the bank to figure out how much of a bonus check you can afford to write yourself. After depositing the $26,000 from your client, you expect to have a balance of about $35,000, and because you always like to keep a balance of at least $10,000 in your account as a buffer, you figure you can easily write a bonus check for $20,000 for your down payment. After reviewing your account, you’re really concerned when you see that your bank balance is only $8,500! What happened? You scroll down through the screen for an explanation and you see the following:

• NSF check—Hastings & Associates, Inc.—$26,000.00 • Return check charge $150.00 • Monthly service charge $50.00 Requirements 1. What happened? Explain why your bank balance is $26,200 lower than you had anticipated. When you prepare your bank reconciliation, what journal entries will you have to make as a result of these three items from your bank? 2. Assume you ultimately end up having to write off the amount owed by Hastings & Associates, Inc. What would the journal entry be for that transaction, assuming you use the allowance method to account for bad debts?

Written Communication Refer to the preceding Small Business Analysis case. Prepare an e-mail to the owner of Hastings & Associates, Inc., explaining the situation with the returned check and the charge that the bank applied to your account for processing the returned check. Also, request payment for the entire amount due, including the return check charge. Keep in mind that the tone of the e-mail might have some bearing on whether Hastings & Associates, Inc. continues to utilize your services. Self Check Answers 1. a 2. d 3. c 4. b 5. a 6. b 7. c 8. a 9. d 10. a 11. a 12. a

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 380

03/04/14 5:23 PM

Cash and Receivables

381

Appendix 7A What Is a Petty Cash Fund? 8 (Appendix 7A) Account for the petty cash fund

A business may choose to keep a petty cash fund, which is a fund containing a small amount of cash used to pay for minor expenditures, such as the purchase of postage stamps or a shipment of a small package. Cash is easy to steal, and the thief is often able to do so without leaving evidence. For this reason, petty cash funds need controls such as the following: • Designate a custodian for the petty cash fund. This assigns responsibility for the fund. • Establish the fund by keeping a specific, fixed amount of cash on hand so that any missing amount can be easily identified. • Keep the fund in a safe, locked location, and only allow the custodian to have access to the fund. • Support all payments from the fund with a written record documenting the purpose and amount of the payment.

Setting Up the Petty Cash Fund Businesses establish a petty cash fund by writing a check for the designated amount, usually between $200 and $500, depending on the size and the needs of the business. They typically make the check payable to Petty Cash, cash the check, and place the money in the fund. Every business may have its own form for documenting petty cash payments, but the form is usually signed by the recipient of the petty cash and the custodian to verify the transaction. The cash in the fund plus the total of the payment forms should equal the fund balance at all times. Suppose that Inland Equipment established a petty cash fund of $200 on June 1. The journal entry to record the creation of the fund is: DATE Jun 1

ACCOUNTS Petty Cash Cash Establish the petty cash fund.

POST REF.

DR. 200

CR. 200

Now, imagine that on June 21 Suzanne Kimmel, the fund custodian, approved a cash payment from the petty cash fund to Jim Dirks to reimburse Jim for $25 of envelopes he purchased for the business. Suzanne prepared a record of the disbursement, much like the petty cash ticket in Exhibit 7A-1, and both she and Jim signed it. Suzanne kept the form in the fund as a replacement for the cash taken.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 381

03/04/14 5:23 PM

382

Chapter 7

PETTY CASH TICKET Jun 21 Date________________ $25 Amount_______________________________________ Envelopes For __________________________________________ Office Supplies Debit_________________________________________ Received by________________ Fund Custodian______

Exhibit 7A-1

Replenishing the Petty Cash Fund Payments deplete the petty cash fund, so it must be replenished periodically. On July 31 the petty cash fund of Inland Equipment holds the following: • $108 cash on hand • $90 in petty cash tickets: office supplies, $53; delivery expense, $37 Notice that when the $108 of cash on hand is added to the $90 of petty cash tickets, the total comes to $198, which is $2 less than the fund balance of $200. The $2 difference signifies that $2 was misplaced from the fund. The petty cash fund can be reconciled as follows:

Cash on Hand ..................................  Petty Cash Tickets ...........................  .........................................................  Cash Shortage .................................  Fund Balance ...................................

$108 90 198 2 $200

To replenish the petty cash fund and make the cash on hand equal to $200 again, the company writes a check, payable to Petty Cash, for the $92 ($200 – $108) difference between the cash on hand and the fund balance. The fund custodian cashes this check and puts $92 back in the fund. Now the fund holds $200 cash as required. The following journal entry would be made to record the issuance of the check: DATE Jul 31

ACCOUNTS Office Supplies Expense Delivery Expense Cash Short and Over Cash Replenish the petty cash fund.

POST REF.

DR.

CR. 53 37 2 92

The accounts debited in the entry represent the expense accounts associated with the items that the petty cash funds were used to purchase. The cash shortage is debited to an account titled Cash Short and Over. Notice that the journal entry included a credit to Cash, not Petty Cash. This is because the money to replenish the petty cash fund was taken from the Cash account. The Petty Cash account is only affected when: • The petty cash fund is established. • The petty cash fund balance is increased or decreased.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 382

03/04/14 5:23 PM

Cash and Receivables

383

Changing the Petty Cash Fund Imagine that Inland Equipment wants to increase the size of its fund from $200 to $300 on August 1. The business writes a $100 check payable to Petty Cash, and the custodian cashes it and places the money in the fund. In this case, the journal entry to record this $100 increase will look like the following:

DATE Aug 1

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 383

ACCOUNTS Petty Cash Cash Increase petty cash fund balance.

POST REF.

DR. 100

CR. 100

03/04/14 5:23 PM

384

Chapter 7

Accounting Practice MyAccountingLab

Short Exercises S7A-1. Petty cash transactions (Learning Objective 8) 5–10 min. Record the following petty cash transactions of Wilson Supply in the journal; explanations are not required.

Nov 1 30

Established a petty cash fund with a $100 balance. The petty cash fund had $26 in cash and $74 in petty cash tickets that were issued to pay for postage. Replenished the fund with cash.

S7A-2. Petty cash transactions (Learning Objective 8) 5–10 min. Record the following petty cash transactions of Apex, Inc., in the journal; explanations are not required.

Sep 1 30

30

MyAccountingLab

Established a petty cash fund with a $250 balance. The petty cash fund had $56 in cash and $187 in petty cash tickets that were issued to pay for office supplies ($112) and entertainment expense ($75). Replenished the fund. Increased the petty cash fund balance to $300.

Exercises (Group A) E7A-3A. Petty cash transactions (Learning Objective 8) 10–15 min. Lori’s Music School created a $200 petty cash fund on May 1. During the month, the fund custodian authorized and signed petty cash tickets as follows:

Petty Cash Ticket No. 1 2 3 4 5

Item Delivery of programs to customers Mail package Newsletter Key to closet Computer diskettes

Account Debited Delivery Expense Postage Expense Supplies Expense Miscellaneous Expense Supplies Expense

Amount $10 50 22 40 25

Requirements 1. Record the journal entry to create the petty cash fund. 2. Assuming that the cash in the fund totals $52 on May 31, make the journal entry to replenish the petty cash fund.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 384

03/04/14 5:23 PM

Cash and Receivables

385

E7A-4A. Petty cash transactions (Learning Objective 8) 10–15 min. Janson, Corp., maintains a petty cash fund of $225. On July 31, the fund holds $14 cash and petty cash tickets for office supplies, $172, and delivery expense, $32. Requirements 1. Make the journal entry to replenish the petty cash fund. 2. Janson, Corp., decided to increase the petty cash fund by $25. Prepare the journal entry.

MyAccountingLab

Exercises (Group B) E7A-5B. Petty cash transactions (Learning Objective 8) 10–15 min. Lynn’s Music School created a $250 petty cash fund on August 1. During the month, the fund custodian authorized and signed petty cash tickets as follows: Petty Cash Ticket No. 1 2 3 4 5

Item Delivery of programs to customers Mail package Newsletter Key to closet Computer diskettes

Account Debited Delivery Expense Postage Expense Supplies Expense Miscellaneous Expense Supplies Expense

Amount $12 47 25 41 30

Requirements 1. Record the journal entry to create the petty cash fund. 2. Assuming that the cash in the fund totals $99 on August 31, make the journal entry to replenish the petty cash fund. E7A-6B. Petty cash transactions (Learning Objective 8) 10–15 min. Elm Street Motors maintains a petty cash fund of $200. On December 31, the fund holds $12 cash, and petty cash tickets for office supplies totalling $121 and delivery expense totalling $55. Requirements 1. Make the journal entry to replenish the petty cash fund. 2. Elm Street Motors decided to increase the petty cash fund by $80. Prepare the journal entry.

MyAccountingLab

Problems (Group A) P7A-7A. Petty cash transactions (Learning Objective 8) 10–15 min. On March 1, The Party Place creates a petty cash fund with a balance of $325. During March, Sue Bemis, the fund custodian, signs the following petty cash tickets:

Petty Cash Ticket Number 101 102 103 104

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 385

Item Office supplies Cab fare for executive Delivery of package across town Dinner money for president and a potential customer

Amount $102 42 21 106

03/04/14 5:23 PM

386

Chapter 7 On March 31, prior to replenishment, the fund contains these tickets plus cash of $23. The accounts affected by petty cash payments are Office Supplies Expense, Travel Expense, Delivery Expense, and Entertainment Expense. Requirements 1. Record the journal entry to create the petty cash fund. 2. Record the journal entry to replenish the petty cash fund on March 31. Do you have any concerns regarding the Cash Short and Over account? 3. Make the April 1 entry to increase the fund balance to $350. Include an explanation, and briefly describe what the custodian does when the balance is increased.

Problems (Group B) P7A-8B. Petty cash transactions (Learning Objectives 8) 10–15 min. On August 1, City Delivery creates a petty cash fund with a balance of $450. During August, Eva Unger, the fund custodian, signs the following petty cash tickets: Petty Cash Ticket Number 101 102 103 104

Item Office supplies Cab fare for executive Delivery of package across town Dinner money for president and a potential customer

Amount $92 29 15 70

On August 31, prior to replenishment, the fund contains these tickets plus cash of $209. The accounts affected by petty cash payments are Office Supplies Expense, Travel Expense, Delivery Expense, and Entertainment Expense. Requirements 1. Record the journal entry to create the petty cash fund. 2. Record the journal entry to replenish the petty cash fund on August 31. Do you have any concerns over the Cash Short and Over account? 3. Make the entry on September 1 to decrease the fund balance to $400. Include an explanation, and briefly describe what the custodian does when the balance is decreased.

M07_KEMP9543_03_GE_C07.indd 386

03/04/14 5:23 PM

8 Long-Term and Other Assets Business, Accounting, and You Drive or walk up to an AT&T store. You want to purchase a phone and arrange phone service. You look up and see a building with a big AT&T sign. Now think about AT&T’s business. What do you see? You see a lot of land, buildings, computers, satellites, and much more. AT&T needs a lot of assets that have a life longer than one year. These long-term assets are needed to attract customers and deliver the goods and services customers want. Without these assets, no sale will occur. These assets are at the heart of AT&T’s success. Businesses such as AT&T need long-term assets such as land, buildings, and equipment. But the assets are often very expensive. As the business uses these assets, the assets depreciate. If the business needs to sell these assets, it is sometimes difficult to find a buyer. As such, investing money in these assets is risky and must be done carefully.

Learning Objectives 1 Describe the differences b­ etween fixed assets, ­intangible assets, and natural resources

2 Calculate and record the cost of acquiring fixed assets

3 Calculate and record the ­depreciation of fixed assets

4 Account for repairs to fixed assets

5 Account for the disposal of fixed assets

6 Account for intangible assets 7 Account for natural resources 8 Account for other assets 9 Report long-term assets on the balance sheet

10 Calculate the return on assets and the fixed asset turnover

387

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 387

03/04/14 2:04 PM

388

Chapter 8

So how do accountants recognize, measure, record, and report long-term asset transactions? As an accountant or manager, you need to understand how a business accounts for long-term assets. It affects a business’s net income and value.

Real World Accounting Video In the Real World Accounting video, Jason Berry of Rosa Mexicano Restaurants talks about managing a successful business. Look at the video. Think about what Jason is saying. Now realize how important long-term assets are to a successful business like the one Jason manages.

What Are the Different Types of Long-Term Assets? 1

Describe the differences between fixed assets, intangible assets, and natural resources

Fixed assets  Tangible assets such as buildings and equipment; also called plant assets. Tangible assets  Assets that are physical in form. They can be seen, touched, or held. Intangible assets  Assets with no physical form. They are valuable because of the special rights they carry. Examples include patents and copyrights. Natural resources  Assets that come from the earth. Examples include minerals, gas, oil, and timber.

Most businesses will own at least one of the following types of long-term assets: • Fixed assets. Fixed assets, often called plant assets, are “physical assets”—­meaning they can be seen, touched, or held. This includes assets such as land, buildings, vehicles, desks, and equipment. Fixed assets are also sometimes referred to as t­ angible assets. • Intangible assets. Patents, trademarks, and goodwill are examples of intangible assets. Unlike fixed assets, intangible assets cannot be seen, touched, or held. For example, even though there may a piece of paper that provides written evidence of a patent, the paper is not the patent. The patent (the intangible asset) is actually the specific rights that are conveyed to the owner of the patent. • Natural resources. Assets that come from the earth and can ultimately be used up are called natural resources. Timber, oil, minerals, and coal are all examples of natural resources. As we learned in Chapter 3, the cost of a long-term asset must be allocated to an expense as the asset is used up. Although the process of cost allocation is similar for the different types of assets, the terminology used to describe the process is different for each type of asset. Exhibit 8-1 summarizes the different asset types and the cost allocation terminology used with each.

Type of Asset

Fixed Assets

Intangible Assets

Natural Resources

Cost Allocation Terminology

Depreciation

Amortization

Depletion

Exhibit 8-1

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 388

03/04/14 2:04 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

389

The cost allocation methods for each type of asset will be covered later in the chapter. Companies may also own assets that are classified as other assets. Other assets typically consist of investments made by a business. These will be discussed near the end of the chapter.

How Is the Cost of a Fixed Asset Calculated? 2

Calculate and record the cost of acquiring fixed assets

Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP) require that the cost principle, which we learned about in Chapter 1, be applied when determining the cost of a fixed asset. Therefore, the actual amount paid for an asset is to be used as the asset’s cost. The amount paid for an asset should include all amounts paid to acquire the asset and to prepare it for its intended purpose. These costs vary depending on the type of fixed asset being purchased, so let’s discuss each asset type individually.

Land and Land Improvements The cost of land includes, but is not limited to, the following amounts paid by the purchaser: • • • • • •

Purchase price Realtor commissions Survey and legal fees Unpaid property taxes owed on the land Fees associated with transferring the ownership (title) on the land Cost of clearing the land and removing unwanted buildings

The cost of land does not include the following costs: • • • • • Land improvements  Depreciable improvements to land, such as fencing, sprinkler systems, paving, signs, and lighting.

Fencing Paving Sprinkler systems Lighting Signs

These costs are recorded as separate fixed assets called land improvements. Suppose that Apex Industries purchases land for $75,000 by signing a note payable for the same amount. Apex Industries also pays cash as follows: $2,500 in realtor commission, $1,200 in transfer fees, a $1,700 survey fee, $4,500 to remove an old building, $2,200 to have the land graded and leveled, $6,300 to have the land fenced, $1,300 for a sprinkler system, and $2,700 for outdoor lighting. What amount would Apex Industries record as the cost of the land? How much would Apex record as land improvements? Apex Industries would assign the following costs to land and land improvements:

Cost Incurred Purchase price Realtor commission Transfer fees Survey fee Building removal Grading Fencing Sprinkler system Lighting Total cost

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 389

Land $75,000 2,500 1,200 1,700 4,500 2,200

$87,100

Land Improvements

$ 6,300 1,300 2,700 $10,300

03/04/14 2:04 PM

390

Chapter 8

The purchase of the land and the subsequent cash payments are recorded as: DATE

ACCOUNTS Land Note Payable Purchased land on a note payable. Land Land Improvements Cash Paid cash for land and land improvements.

Capitalized  The process of ­debiting (increasing) an asset account for the cost of an asset.

POST REF.

DR. 75,000

CR. 75,000

12,100 10,300 22,400

We would say that Apex Industries capitalized the cost of the land at $87,100 ($75,000 + $12,100) and the land improvements at $10,300. Capitalized means that an asset account is debited (increased) for the cost of an asset. Notice that Land and Land Improvements are two entirely separate assets. Land is a special fixed asset because it is never really used up. Therefore, land is not depreciated. However, the cost of land improvements is depreciated over the useful life of the improvements.

Buildings The cost of a building depends on whether the building is constructed or whether an existing building is purchased. If a building is constructed, the cost of the building ­includes the following: • • • •

Architectural fees Building permit fees Contractor charges Payments for material, labor, and overhead

The time to complete a building can be months, even years. If a company constructs its own assets, the cost of a building may also include interest charged during the time of construction on any borrowed money. If a company purchases an existing building, the cost of the building includes: • • • • • •

Purchase price Realtor commissions Appraisal and legal fees Unpaid property taxes owed on the building Fees associated with transferring the ownership (title) on the building Costs of repairing and renovating the building for its intended use

Machinery and Equipment The cost of machinery and equipment includes: • • • • • • •

Purchase price (less any discounts) Transportation (delivery) charges Insurance while in transit Sales and other taxes Purchase commission Installation costs Cost of testing the asset before it is used

After the asset is up and running, the company no longer debits insurance, taxes, and maintenance costs to the Equipment account. From that point on, insurance, taxes, ­repairs, and maintenance costs are recorded as expenses.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 390

03/04/14 2:04 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

391

Furniture and Fixtures Furniture and fixtures include desks, chairs, file cabinets, display racks, shelving, and so forth. The cost of furniture and fixtures includes the basic cost of each asset (less any discounts), plus all other costs to ready the asset for its intended use. For example, for a desk, this may include the costs to ship the desk to the business and the cost paid to someone to assemble the desk. Exhibit 8-2 summarizes the costs associated with the different types of fixed assets.

• • • • • •

Building If constructed: • Construction costs • Architectural fees • Building permits • Material, labor, and overhead

Land Purchase price Brokerage commission Survey and legal fees Unpaid taxes Costs to clear land Costs to remove buildings

Land Improvements • Purchase price • Examples: • Fencing • Paving • Sprinkler systems • Lighting • Signs

If purchased: • Purchase price • Brokerage commission • Legal fees • Unpaid taxes • Renovation and repair costs

• • • • • • •

Furniture/Fixtures • Purchase price, less discounts • Transportation costs • Sales tax

Equipment/Machinery Purchase price, less discounts Transportation costs Insurance while in transit Sales tax Purchase commission Installation costs Testing costs

Exhibit 8-2

Lump-Sum (Basket) Purchase of Assets Lump-sum purchase  Purchase of multiple assets for one price; also called a basket purchase.

When a company pays a single price for several assets as a group it is referred to as a ­lump-sum purchase, or “basket” purchase. For example, Apex Industries may pay one price ($625,000) for land, a building, and equipment. For accounting, the company must allocate a portion of the total cost to each individual asset, as shown in the following diagram: Total Purchase Price $625,000

Land ?

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 391

Building ?

Equipment ?

03/04/14 2:04 PM

392

Chapter 8

The total cost is allocated to the different assets based on their relative market values. Let’s assume that an appraisal revealed that the land’s market value is $75,000, the building’s market value is $480,000, and the equipment’s market value is $130,000. Apex Industries got a good deal, paying only $625,000 for assets with a combined market value of $685,000 ($75,000 + $480,000 + $130,000). In order to allocate the total purchase price to the different assets, Apex Industries must first determine the ratio of each asset’s market value to the total market value for all assets combined:

Asset Land Building Equipment Total

Market Value $ 75,000 480,000 130,000 $685,000

Percent of Total Market Value (Rounded) 11%  $685,000 70%  $685,000 19%  $685,000 100%

Next, the cost that is allocated to each asset is found by multiplying the total purchase price by the ratios determined previously.

Asset Land Building Equipment Total

Total Purchase Price $625,000 $625,000 $625,000

Percent of Total  Market Value Cost Allocated (Rounded) to Asset $ 68,750  11% 437,500  70% 118,750  19% $625,000 100%

If we assume that Apex Industries purchased the combined assets on a note payable, the purchase is recorded as: DATE

ACCOUNTS Land Building Equipment Note Payable Purchased land, building, and equipment on a note payable.

POST REF.

DR. 68,750 437,500 118,750

CR.

625,000

How Are Fixed Assets Depreciated? 3

Calculate and record the depreciation of fixed assets

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 392

As we saw in Exhibit 8-1, the process of allocating a fixed asset’s cost to expense over its useful life is referred to as depreciation. Depreciation matches the asset’s expense against the revenue generated from using the asset, thereby adhering to the matching principle. In accounting, the “using up” of a fixed asset is also referred to as depreciation. For example, a delivery truck can only go so many miles before it is worn out, or used up. As the truck is driven, it depreciates, or is used up. Physical factors, like age and weather, will also contribute to the depreciation of assets. So, depreciation refers to the “using up” of a fixed asset as well as to the process of allocating the asset’s cost to expense over the asset’s useful life.

03/04/14 2:04 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

393

Let’s contrast this with what depreciation is not. • Depreciation is not a process of valuation. Businesses do not record depreciation based on changes in the asset’s market (sales) value. • Depreciation does not mean that the business sets aside cash to replace an asset when it is used up. Depreciation has nothing to do with cash.

Accounting in Your World

Have you ever bought a new car or know someone who has? If so, then you have probably heard people comment on how much the car “depreciated” the minute it was driven off the car lot. These people were referring to the fact that the resale value of the car was most likely less than what had been paid for it. In everyday life, the term depreciation is commonly used to describe a decrease in the market value of an asset, such as a car. However, from an accounting point of view, the car had not depreciated merely because it was driven off the lot. In accounting, depreciation refers to the allocation of the cost of an asset to expense during the life of the asset rather than to a decline in the market value of the asset.

Measuring Depreciation Depreciation of a fixed asset is based on three factors: 1. Cost 2. Estimated useful life 3. Estimated residual value

Useful life  The expected life of an asset during which it is anticipated to generate revenues. May be expressed in years or units of output.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 393

Cost is known and, as mentioned earlier in this chapter, includes all amounts i­ncurred to prepare the asset for its intended purpose. The other two factors are estimates. Estimated useful life represents the expected life of an asset during which it is anticipated to generate revenues. Useful life may be measured in years or in units of output. For example, a building’s life is usually stated in years, a truck’s in the number of miles it can be driven, and a photocopier’s in the number of copies it can make. For each asset, the goal is to define the estimated useful life that best measures the “using up” of the asset.

03/04/14 2:04 PM

394

Chapter 8

Residual value  Expected cash value of an asset at the end of its useful life; also called salvage value.

Depreciable cost  The cost of a fixed asset minus its estimated ­residual value.

Some assets, such as computers and software, may become obsolete before they wear out. An asset is obsolete when a newer asset can perform the job more efficiently. As a result of obsolescence, an asset’s useful life may be determined to be shorter than its physical life. In all cases, an asset’s cost is depreciated over its useful life. Estimated residual value—also called salvage value—is the asset’s expected cash value at the end of its useful life. A delivery truck’s useful life may be 150,000 miles. When the truck has driven that distance, the company will sell or scrap it. The expected cash value at the end of the truck’s life is the truck’s estimated residual value. Because the estimated residual value represents a portion of the asset’s cost that will be recovered, it is not depreciated. The residual value is subtracted from the cost of the asset to arrive at the asset’s depreciable cost.

Cost  Residual value  Depreciable cost A business will use past experience as well as information obtained from other sources to make the best estimates it can of useful life and residual value.

Depreciation Methods The most commonly used depreciation methods are as follows: • Straight-line • Units-of-production • Double-declining-balance These methods work differently in how the yearly depreciation amount is calculated, but they all result in the same total depreciation over the useful life of the asset. To demonstrate the different depreciation methods, let’s assume that Apex Industries purchased and placed in service a new delivery truck on January 1. The data related to Apex Industries’ new delivery truck is presented next: Purchase price (cost)............................................................................................ Estimated residual (salvage) value........................................................................ Estimated useful life..............................................................................................

$43,000 $ 4,000 5 years

Straight-Line Method Straight-line (SL) depreciation method  Depreciation method in which an equal amount of depreciation expense is assigned to each year of asset use.

The straight-line (SL) depreciation method allocates an equal amount of depreciation to each year. Apex Industries might want to use this method for the truck if it thinks time is the best indicator of the truck’s depreciation. The equation to find yearly depreciation using straight-line depreciation is:

Straight-line depreciation 

Cost  Residual value Depreciation  expense per year Estimated useful life in years

The yearly depreciation expense for Apex Industries’ delivery truck is:

Cost  Residual value $43,000  $4,000   $7,800 per year Estimated useful life 5

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 394

03/04/14 2:04 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

395

Because Apex Industries purchased the delivery truck on January 1, an entire year’s worth of depreciation will be recorded for the first year on December 31:

DATE Dec 31

ACCOUNTS Depreciation Expense, Truck Accumulated Depreciation, Truck Record yearly depreciation.

POST REF.

DR. 7,800

CR. 7,800

Exhibit 8-3 demonstrates a straight-line depreciation schedule that has been prepared for

Apex Industries’ delivery truck.

Year 0 1 2 3 4 5

Asset Cost $43,000

Yearly Depreciation

Accumulated Depreciation

$7,800 7,800 7,800 7,800 7,800

$ 7,800 15,600 23,400 31,200 39,000

Book Value $43,000 35,200 27,400 19,600 11,800 4,000

Exhibit 8-3

Fully depreciated  An asset that has reached the end of its estimated useful life. No more depreciation is recorded for the asset.

The final column shows the asset’s book value, which is its cost less accumulated depreciation. Notice that as an asset is depreciated, its accumulated depreciation increases and its book value decreases. Observe the Accumulated Depreciation and Book Value columns in Exhibit 8-3. At the end of its useful life, the asset is said to be fully depreciated. Once an asset has been fully depreciated, its final book value should equal its residual value, $4,000 in this case.

Units-of-Production (UOP) Method Units-of-production (UOP) depreciation method  Depreciation method by which a fixed amount of depreciation is assigned to each unit of output ­produced by an asset.

The units-of-production (UOP) depreciation method allocates a fixed amount of depreciation to each unit of output:

Units-of-production depreciation 

Cost  Residual value Depreciation  expense per unit Estimated useful life in units

Assume that, instead of straight-line depreciation, Apex Industries depreciates its ­delivery truck using units-of-production depreciation. Apex Industries might want to use UOP depreciation for the truck if it thinks miles are the best measure of the truck’s depreciation. The delivery truck is estimated to be driven 35,000 miles the first year, 30,000 the second, 30,000 the third, 20,000 the fourth, and 15,000 during the fifth (for a total of 130,000 miles). The UOP depreciation each period varies with the number of units (miles, in the case of the truck) the asset produces. The depreciation per unit for Apex Industries’ delivery truck is calculated as:

Cost  Residual value $43,000  $4,000   $0.30 per mile Estimated useful life in units 130,000 miles

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 395

03/04/14 2:04 PM

396

Chapter 8

Apex Industries would record $10,500 (35,000 miles × $0.30) of depreciation at December 31 of the first year as: DATE Dec 31

ACCOUNTS Depreciation Expense, Truck Accumulated Depreciation, Truck Record yearly depreciation.

POST REF.

DR. 10,500

CR. 10,500

A depreciation schedule similar to the one prepared for straight-line depreciation is presented in Exhibit 8-4 for units-of-production depreciation. Notice once again that the ending book value of the delivery truck, $4,000, equals its residual value as it did with straight-line depreciation.

Year 0 1 2 3 4 5

Double-declining-balance (DDB) method  An accelerated depreciation method that computes annual depreciation by multiplying the asset’s decreasing book value by a constant percent that is two times the straight-line rate. Accelerated depreciation method  A depreciation method that writes off more of the asset’s cost near the start of its useful life than the straight-line method does.

Asset Cost $43,000

Number of Units 35,000 miles 30,000 miles 30,000 miles 20,000 miles 15,000 miles

Yearly Depreciation Depreciation Depreciation Per Unit Expense     

$0.30 $0.30 $0.30 $0.30 $0.30

    

$10,500 9,000 9,000 6,000 4,500

Accumulated Depreciation $10,500 19,500 28,500 34,500 39,000

Book Value $43,000 32,500 23,500 14,500 8,500 4,000

Exhibit 8-4

Double-Declining-Balance Method The double-declining-balance (DDB) method is known as an accelerated ­depreciation method. An accelerated depreciation method writes off more depreciation near the start of an asset’s life and less at the end. Although DDB depreciation is generally used for income tax purposes, it can be used for “book” purposes. The use of DDB by Apex Industries would be appropriate if Apex anticipates the delivery truck will be significantly more productive in its early years. The DDB method multiplies the ­asset’s decreasing book value by a constant rate that is twice the straight-line depreciation rate. DDB amounts can be computed using the following formula:

1 Double-decliningBook value at the  2  Depreciation expense per year balance depreciation Estimated useful life in years beginning of the year

Note that residual value is not included in the formula. Unlike with straight-line and unitsof-production, with double-declining-balance depreciation, residual value is ignored until the end of an asset’s life. For the first year of the delivery truck, the calculation would be:

1  2  2/5  $43,000  $17,200 5

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 396

03/04/14 2:04 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

397

Exhibit 8-5 reflects a depreciation schedule for the delivery truck using double-­decliningbalance depreciation. Under double-declining-balance, the depreciation schedule is altered in the final years to prevent the asset from being depreciated below the residual value. In the case of Apex Industries’ delivery truck, the residual value was given as $4,000. In the DDB schedule in Exhibit 8-5, notice that after year 4, the truck’s book value is $5,573. In  year 5, depreciation expense calculated using DDB would reduce the book value below the residual value. Therefore, in the final year, the depreciation expense is reduced to $1,573, which is the book value of $5,573 less the $4,000 residual value. If the residual value is high enough, it is possible that the second-to-last year’s depreciation expense could be reduced and there would be no depreciation in the final year.

Year 0 1 2 3 4 5

Asset Cost $43,000

DDB Rate* 2/5 2/5 2/5 2/5

Yearly Depreciation Book Depreciation Value Expense  $43,000   25,800   15,480  9,288  

$17,200 10,320 6,192 3,715** 1,573***

Accumulated Depreciation $17,200 27,520 33,712 37,427 39,000

Book Value $43,000 25,800 15,480 9,288 5,573 4,000

*1/5  2  2/5 **rounded ***5,573  4,000  1,573

Exhibit 8-5 Some companies change to the straight-line method during the last years of an a­ sset’s life to “level off ” the yearly depreciation expense in the final years. The yearly depreciation when switching to straight-line is calculated as:

Remaining book value  Residual value  Depreciation expense per year Remaining useful life

Exhibit 8-6 reflects a depreciation schedule for the delivery truck using double-­decliningbalance depreciation with a switch to straight-line after year 3.

Year 0 1 2 3 4 5

Asset Cost $43,000

DDB Rate 2/5 2/5 2/5

Yearly Depreciation Book Depreciation Value Expense  $43,000   25,800   15,480 

$17,200 10,320 6,192 2,644* 2,644*

Accumulated Depreciation $17,200 27,520 33,712 36,356 39,000

Book Value $43,000 25,800 15,480 9,288 6,644 4,000

*(9,288  4,000)  2  2,644

Exhibit 8-6

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 397

03/04/14 2:04 PM

398

Chapter 8

Comparing Depreciation Methods Let’s compare the depreciation methods. Annual amounts vary, but total accumulated depreciation equals $39,000 for all three methods.

Year 1 2 3 4 5 Total Depreciation

Depreciation per Year Units-ofStraight-Line Production $ 7,800 $10,500 7,800 9,000 7,800 9,000 7,800 6,000 7,800 4,500 $39,000 $39,000

DoubleDeclining-Balance $17,200 10,320 6,192 3,715 1,573 $39,000

Which method is best? That depends on the asset. A business should match an asset’s expense against the revenue that the asset produces. Here are some guidelines: • Straight-Line. For an asset that generates revenue evenly over time, the straight-line method follows the matching principle. Each period shows an equal amount of ­depreciation. For example, the straight-line method would be good for depreciating a building. • Units-of-Production. The UOP method works best for an asset whose use varies from year to year. More use causes greater depreciation. For example, UOP might be good for depreciating copy machines, vehicles, and machinery. • Double-Declining-Balance. The DDB method works best for assets that produce more revenue in their early years and less in their later years. Higher depreciation in the early years is matched against the greater revenue. For example, DDB might be good for depreciating computers. DDB is also often chosen for federal income tax purposes. The increased depreciation in the early years of an asset’s life lowers the income in those years and, therefore, lowers the income tax paid.

Partial Year Depreciation In the examples for Apex Industries’ delivery truck, it was assumed that the truck was purchased on January 1 and used for an entire year. However, most assets are not purchased on the first day of the year and used for the entire year. When an asset is not used for an entire year, the depreciation expense for that year must be prorated for the number of months the asset was actually used during the year. If an asset is in service for more than one half of the month, it is considered to be in service for the entire month. The formula for prorating the depreciation expense is:

Depreciation expense for the entire year 

# of months asset was used  Prorated yearly depreciation expense 12

Let’s return to our example using Apex Industries’ delivery truck. Assume that, instead of purchasing the delivery truck on January 1, Apex Industries purchased the delivery truck on May 1. Exhibits 8-7 and 8-8 reflect new depreciation schedules for Apex Industries’ delivery truck using straight-line and double-declining-balance depreciation, respectively.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 398

03/04/14 2:04 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

Year 0 1 2 3 4 5 6

Asset Cost $43,000

Yearly Depreciation $7,800  8/12*  $5,200 7,800 7,800 7,800 7,800 $7,800  4/12**  2,600

Accumulated Depreciation $ 5,200 13,000 20,800 28,600 36,400 39,000

399

Book Value $43,000 37,800 30,000 22,200 14,400 6,600 4,000

*Prorated for May through December **Prorated for January through April

Exhibit 8-7

Year 0 1 2 3 4 5 6

Asset Cost $43,000

Yearly Depreciation Book Value Depreciation Expense*

DDB Rate 2/5 2/5 2/5 2/5 2/5

    

$43,000 31,533 18,920 11,352 6,811

Accumulated Depreciation

 $17,2008/12**$11,467  12,613  7,568  4,541  2,724 (4,087  4,000)  87

$11,467 24,080 31,648 36,189 38,913 39,000

Book Value $43,000 31,533 18,920 11,352 6,811 4,087 4,000

*Rounded **Prorated for May through December

Exhibit 8-8 Notice that both schedules now reflect six years, even though the delivery truck has a five-year life. Because the truck was only depreciated for eight months in the first year instead of twelve, the sixth year is added to “pick up” the final four months of depreciation. With units-of-production depreciation, there is no need to prorate the depreciation for partial years. This is because UOP is based on the quantity of units produced by an asset, regardless of how many months the asset was in service during the year.

Changing the Useful Life of a Depreciable Asset Estimating the useful life and residual value of a fixed asset can be difficult. Sometimes, as the asset is used, a business may determine that it needs to revise the useful life and/ or the residual value of the asset. For example, at the end of year 3, Apex Industries may find that its delivery truck is expected to last seven years instead of five. Accounting changes like this are not uncommon because the original estimates are not based on perfect foresight. Assuming straight-line depreciation is used, the formula used to calculate the new yearly depreciation amount, if the useful life or residual value is changed, looks like this:

(Remaining book value  New residual value)  Revised annual depreciation (New estimated useful life  Number of years already depreciated) In effect, the asset’s remaining depreciable book value is spread over the asset’s remaining life. Let’s return to our Apex Industries’ example. If we look back at Exhibit 8-3, we see that the remaining book value for Apex Industries’ delivery truck after year 3 is $19,600. Now let’s suppose that, in addition to revising the estimated useful life from five to seven

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 399

03/04/14 2:04 PM

400

Chapter 8

years, the residual value is also revised from $4,000 to $3,000. Apex Industries would calculate the new yearly depreciation as:

($19,600  $3,000) $16,600   $4,150 (7 years  3 years) 4 A new straight-line depreciation schedule reflecting the changes in estimates appears in Exhibit 8-9.

Year 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

Yearly Depreciation

Accumulated Depreciation

$7,800 7,800 7,800 4,150 4,150 4,150 4,150

$ 7,800 15,600 23,400 27,550 31,700 35,850 40,000

Book Value $43,000 35,200 27,400 19,600 15,450 11,300 7,150 3,000

Exhibit 8-9

Using Fully Depreciated Assets As explained earlier in the chapter, a fully depreciated asset is one that has reached the end of its estimated useful life. No more depreciation is recorded for the asset. If the asset is no longer useful, it is disposed of. If the asset is still useful, the company may continue using it. The asset account and its accumulated depreciation remain on the books, but no additional depreciation is recorded. In short, the asset never goes below residual value.

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analyze

Which depreciation method should a business use?

The choice of depreciation method depends upon the ­specific asset being depreciated as well as what the intended use of that asset is. The best method is one that most closely matches the cost of an asset against the future revenues it generates.

Straight-line depreciation is best for assets that will be used evenly throughout their lives and that will incur repair and maintenance costs evenly.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 400

Units-of-production depreciation is best for assets that will be utilized on an irregular basis throughout their lives. Double-declining-balance depreciation is best for assets that will be utilized significantly more in the early years of their lives. It is also best for assets that will require significantly more repair and maintenance expenditures in the later years of the asset’s life.

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

401

Stop and Think… After reviewing the year-end balance sheet, the company president called the controller to her office for a meeting. In the meeting, the company president questioned why the book value of the company’s equipment was so high. “After all,” she explained, “there is no way that the company could sell the equipment for that much money.” How should the controller answer the president?

Answer

The controller should explain that the book value of the equipment is not meant to reflect the resale value of the equipment. The book value reflects the cost of the equipment less the depreciation expense that has been taken on the equipment during its life so far. He should explain that depreciation is the process of allocating the cost of an asset to the periods that the asset will be used to generate revenue. So, book value reflects the amount of the asset’s cost that has not been expensed.

How Are Costs of Repairing Fixed Assets Recorded? 4

Account for repairs to fixed assets

When a business has to repair an existing fixed asset, the method of accounting for the expenditure is determined by the type of repair that occurred. Repairs are generally broken down into three types: • Ordinary repairs • Extraordinary repairs • Betterments

Ordinary Repairs Ordinary repair  Repair work that is necessary to maintain an asset in normal operating condition.

Revenue expenditure  Expenditure that is debited to an ­expense account.

Expenditures incurred to maintain an asset in proper working order are called ordinary repairs. For example, the cost of repairing the radiator, changing the oil and filter, or r­eplacing the tires on a company vehicle would be considered to be ordinary repairs. Ordinary repairs do not extend the useful life of an asset beyond its original useful life, nor do they increase the productivity of the asset. They simply keep the asset running. Ordinary repairs are recorded as an expense (usually by debiting Repairs and Maintenance Expense) in the period in which they are incurred. Ordinary repairs are also called revenue ­expenditures because the repair expense is matched against the revenues for the period.

Extraordinary Repairs Extraordinary repair  Repair work that extends the useful life of an asset.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 401

When an expenditure extends the useful life of an asset, it is called an extraordinary repair. Replacing the engine on a four-year-old company vehicle is an example of an extraordinary repair. This extraordinary repair would extend the vehicle’s useful life past its original expected life. Extraordinary repairs are not expensed when they are incurred because they provide value beyond the current period. Instead, the expenditure is capitalized by debiting the cost of the repair to the account of the repaired asset. The asset is then depreciated over its remaining useful life.

03/04/14 2:05 PM

402

Chapter 8

Betterments Betterment  Expenditure that increases the capacity or productivity of an asset. Capital expenditure  Expenditure that increases the ­capacity or productivity of an asset or extends its useful life. Capital expenditures are debited to an asset account.

Expenditures that increase an asset’s capacity or productivity are called betterments. An addition to an existing building is an example of a betterment. As with extraordinary repairs, betterments provide value that extends beyond the current period. The cost of a betterment is capitalized (debited to an asset account) and depreciated over the life of the betterment. Both extraordinary repairs and betterments are referred to as capital expenditures. Treating a capital expenditure as an expense, or vice versa, creates an accounting error. Suppose Mackay Machine Works replaces the engine in a company vehicle. This would be an extraordinary repair because it increases the vehicle’s life. If Mackay Machine Works expenses the cost by debiting Repair and Maintenance Expense, rather than capitalizing it (debiting an asset), Mackay Machine Works makes an accounting error. This error would: • overstate Repair and Maintenance Expense. • understate Net Income and therefore, Retained Earnings. • understate Assets on the balance sheet. Incorrectly capitalizing an expense creates the opposite error. Assume a minor repair, such as replacing the alternator on a vehicle, was incorrectly debited to an asset account. The error would result in expenses being understated and Net Income (and therefore Retained Earnings) being overstated. Furthermore, the balance sheet would overstate assets by the amount of the repair bill. Knowingly capitalizing an ordinary repair or expensing a capital expenditure is a violation of proper ethical behavior!

What Happens When a Fixed Asset Is Disposed? 5

Account for the disposal of fixed assets

In addition to acquiring and depreciating fixed assets, businesses often dispose of fixed assets. This may happen before, or after, the asset has reached the end of its useful life. The following are the most common ways that fixed assets are disposed. 1. The asset is discarded (thrown out). 2. The asset is sold. 3. The asset is exchanged for another asset. This occurs most often when an asset is used as a trade-in toward the purchase of another asset. Regardless of the method of disposal, it is important to ensure that depreciation expense on the asset is up to date prior to recording the disposal. Therefore, for any asset that has not been fully depreciated, a business must record the current period’s depreciation ­expense before recording the disposal of the asset. In many cases, the depreciation needs to be prorated because the asset is not in service for the entire year in which it is disposed. Prorating depreciation was covered earlier in the chapter in the discussion of partial-years depreciation. Once depreciation is up to date, the disposal of an asset is recorded using the following steps.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 402



Step 1 Record “what you got.” In other words, if you received any cash as part of the disposal transaction, then you would debit Cash for the amount of cash received. If you received a piece of equipment, then you would debit the Equipment account for the fair value (cost) of the equipment you received.



Step 2 Record “what you gave up.” You need to remove the asset that was disposed of from your books by debiting Accumulated Depreciation and crediting the Asset account (i.e., Office Equipment) for the respective amounts associated

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

403

with the disposed-of asset. Then, if you paid out any cash, you would credit Cash. If you gave a note payable, you would credit Notes Payable.

Like-kind exchange  Exchanging one fixed asset for another fixed asset that has similar functionality.

Step 3 Record any gain or loss recognized on the transaction. You will recognize (debit) a loss if the value of “what you got” in the transaction is less than “what you gave up.” You will recognize (credit) a gain if the value of “what you got” is more than the value of “what you gave up” in the transaction. In effect, the debit or credit needed in this part of the entry will equal the amount necessary to make the entire entry balance.

Prior to 2005, GAAP required that a business determine if an exchange of fixed assets involved assets that were similar in their function, a like-kind exchange, or dissimilar in their function. Like-kind exchanges were accounted for differently than exchanges of dissimilar assets. Since 2005, the distinction of similar versus dissimilar has been abandoned by GAAP with regard to exchanges.1 GAAP now requires that exchanges be evaluated to determine whether the exchange has “commercial substance.” If an exchange lacks “commercial substance,” then no gain on the exchange is recognized. Due to the complex nature of how “commercial substance” is calculated, extended coverage of this topic will be deferred to more advanced accounting courses. All examples in this chapter will assume that fixed asset exchanges have “commercial substance.” As a result, new fixed assets received should be recorded at fair value (cost) with the appropriate recognition of gains and losses. Let’s demonstrate asset disposals by once again using the Apex Industries’ delivery truck as an example. At the end of its useful life, the delivery truck is represented in the books as: Truck

Accumulated Depreciation, Truck

43,000

39,000

Consider these three situations in which Apex Industries disposes of the delivery truck. All disposals are assumed to take place after the delivery truck has been fully depreciated. Situation A:

The truck is completely worthless and is scrapped for $0.

Situation B:

Apex Industries sells the truck for $5,000 cash.

Situation C:

Apex Industries trades the delivery truck in on a new truck that costs $48,000. Apex is granted a trade-in allowance of $5,500 and pays for the difference in cash.

Situation A: The truck is completely worthless and is scrapped for $0. Let’s apply the three steps for disposal outlined previously to demonstrate this:

Step 1 Record “what you got.” In this case, Apex Industries received nothing for the truck so there will be nothing to record.



Step 2 Record “what you gave up.” In this case, Apex Industries gave up the old delivery truck and should remove it from the books. To remove the asset, we must zero out both the Asset and Accumulated Depreciation accounts. To do this, we will need to debit the Accumulated Depreciation, Truck account for $39,000 and credit the Truck account for $43,000.



Step 3 Record any gain or loss on the transaction. This is a loss on disposal because Apex Industries received nothing for a truck that had a net book value (cost – accumulated depreciation) of $4,000. Apex Industries will debit Loss on disposal of Truck for $4,000.

1

For more information see pre-codification FASB 153 and FASB ASC 845.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 403

03/04/14 2:05 PM

404

Chapter 8

Apex Industries will record the disposal as: DATE

ACCOUNTS Accumulated Depreciation, Truck Loss on Disposal of Truck Truck Record discarding of truck.

POST REF.

DR. 39,000 4,000

CR.

43,000

Notice that the debit to the loss account equals the amount needed to bring the entire entry into balance. Situation B: Apex Industries sells the truck for $5,000 cash. The three steps for disposal outlined previously can be applied to this situation as follows:

Step 1 Record “what you got.” In this case Apex Industries received $5,000 for the truck, so Cash will be debited for $5,000.



Step 2 Record “what you gave up.” Once again, Apex Industries gave up the old delivery truck and should remove it from the books. Accumulated Depreciation, Truck is debited for $39,000 and the Truck account is credited for $43,000.



Step 3 Record any gain or loss on the transaction. This is a gain on sale because Apex Industries received $5,000 for a truck that had a net book value (cost – accumulated depreciation) of $4,000. Apex Industries will credit Gain on Sale of Truck for $1,000. Apex Industries will record the disposal as: DATE

ACCOUNTS Cash Accumulated Depreciation, Truck Truck Gain on Sale of Truck Record sale of truck.

POST REF.

DR. 5,000 39,000

CR.

43,000 1,000

Observe that the credit to the gain account equals the amount needed to bring the entire entry into balance. Situation C: Apex Industries trades the delivery truck in on a new truck that costs $48,000. Apex is granted a trade-in allowance of $5,500 and pays for the difference in cash. Here again we will apply the three-step process to record the disposal.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 404



Step 1 Record “what you got.” In this transaction, Apex Industries received a $48,000 new truck. So, Truck (new) will be debited for $48,000.



Step 2 Record “what you gave up.” As in the previous situations, Apex Industries gave up the old delivery truck and should remove it from the books. Accumulated Depreciation, Truck is debited for $39,000 and the Truck (old) account is credited for $43,000. In addition to giving up the truck, Apex Industries paid cash in the amount of $42,500, so Cash is also credited for $42,500. With a trade-in, the amount of cash paid is determined by subtracting the trade-in allowance from the purchase price of the new asset. So, the $48,000 cost of the new truck less the $5,500 trade-in allowance equals the $42,500 cash paid. This same process is used to determine the amount of a note payable if a note is given instead of cash.



Step 3 Record any gain or loss on the transaction. A gain on the exchange occurs because Apex Industries received a truck with a cost of $48,000 for assets worth $46,500 (a truck that had a net book value of $4,000 plus cash of $42,500). Apex Industries will credit Gain on Exchange for $1,500.

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

405

Apex Industries will record the disposal as: DATE

ACCOUNTS Truck (New) Accumulated Depreciation, Truck Truck (Old) Cash Gain on Exchange of Assets Record trade-in of old truck on a new truck.

POST REF.

DR. 48,000 39,000

CR.

43,000 42,500 1,500

Once again, the gain equals the amount necessary to bring the entry into balance.

Try It… A piece of equipment that was originally purchased for $42,000 and had accumulated depreciation of $35,000 was sold for $8,000. How much gain or loss would be recognized on the sale?

Answer

$8,000 was received for a piece of equipment with a book value of $7,000 ($42,000 − $35,000) so a gain of $1,000 should be recognized on the sale.

How Do You Account for Intangible Assets? 6

Account for intangible assets

Amortization  Systematic reduction of an intangible asset’s carrying value on the books. An expense that applies to intangible assets in the same way depreciation applies to fixed assets and depletion to natural resources.

As we saw earlier, intangible assets have no physical form. Instead, in most cases, these assets convey special rights to their owner. Intangible assets include patents, copyrights, trademarks, and other creative works. The process of allocating the cost of an intangible asset to expense is called amortization. Amortization applies to ­intangible assets exactly as depreciation applies to fixed assets and depletion to natural resources. Amortization is computed over the intangible asset’s estimated useful life—usually by the straight-line method. The residual value of most intangible assets is zero. Also, obsolescence can sometimes cause an intangible asset’s useful life to be shortened from its original expected length. Amortization expense for an intangible asset is usually credited directly to the asset account instead of using an accumulated amortization account.

Specific Intangibles Patents Patent  An intangible asset that is a federal government grant conveying an exclusive 20-year right to produce and sell a process, product, or technology.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 405

A patent is an intangible asset that is a federal government grant conveying an exclusive 20-year right to produce and sell an invention. The patent may cover a product, process, or technology. The useful life of a patent is often much less than 20 years because newer, better products and processes are invented, rendering the patent obsolete. When an intangible asset is acquired, the acquisition cost is debited to an asset account. Suppose Apex Industries pays $160,000 on January 1 to acquire a patent on a new manufacturing process. Apex Industries believes this patent’s useful life is only five years because it is likely that a new, more efficient process will be developed within that time.

03/04/14 2:05 PM

406

Chapter 8

Amortization expense is $32,000 per year ($160,000/5 years). The acquisition and yearend amortization entries for this patent are: DATE Jan 1

Dec 31

ACCOUNTS Patents Cash Purchase patent.

POST REF.

Amortization Expense Patents Record yearly amortization.

DR. 160,000

CR. 160,000

32,000 32,000

At the end of the first year, Apex Industries will report this patent at $128,000 ($160,000 minus first-year amortization of $32,000), the next year at $96,000, and so forth. Each year for five years the value of the patent will be reduced by $32,000 until the end of its five-year life, at which point its net book value will be $0.

Copyrights Copyright  Exclusive right to reproduce and sell a book, musical composition, film, other work of art, or computer program. Issued by the federal government, copyrights extend 70 years beyond the author’s life.

A copyright is the exclusive right to reproduce and sell a book, musical composition, film, or other work of art or intellectual property. Copyrights also protect computer software programs such as Microsoft Windows 7. Copyrights are issued by the federal government and extend 70 years beyond the author’s life, although the useful life of most copyrights is relatively short. A copyright is accounted for in the same manner as a patent.

Trademarks and Brand Names Trademarks  Rights to use distinctive identifications of a product or service. Brand names  Rights to use distinctive identifications of a product or service; also called trade names.

Trademarks and brand names (also known as trade names) convey the exclusive right to utilize a symbol, slogan, or name that represents a distinctive product or service such as Sony’s® Blu-ray DiscTM and Intel’s® CoreTM. One of the most widely recognized legally protected slogans is Verizon Wireless’s “Can you hear me now?”2 The cost of a trademark or trade name is amortized over its useful life.

Franchises and Licenses Franchises  Privileges granted by a private business or a government to sell a product or service under specified conditions. Licenses  Privileges granted by a private business or a government to sell a product or service under ­specified conditions. Goodwill  Excess of the cost of an acquired company over the market value of its net assets (assets minus liabilities).

Franchises and licenses are privileges granted by a private business or a government to sell goods or services under specified conditions. The Seattle Mariners baseball team is a franchise granted by Major League Baseball. Subway restaurants and Midas Muffler centers are well-known business franchises. The acquisition cost of a franchise or license is amortized over its useful life.

Goodwill Goodwill in accounting has a different meaning from the everyday phrase “goodwill among men.” In accounting, goodwill refers to the excess of the cost to purchase another company over the market value of its net assets (assets minus liabilities). Suppose Apex Industries acquires Mackay Machine Works for $1,350,000. At the time of the purchase, the market value of Mackay Machine Works’ assets is $1,750,000 and the market value of its liabilities total $500,000. In this case, Apex Industries pays $100,000 above the market value of Mackay Machine Works’ net assets of $1,250,000 ($1,750,000 – $500,000). The extra $100,000 is considered to be goodwill and is ­recorded as:

2

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 406

Verizon’s slogan “Can you hear me now?” Reprinted with permission of Verizon Wireless.

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets DATE

ACCOUNTS Assets (Cash, Accounts Receivable, Equipment, etc. recorded at market value) Goodwill Liabilities (Account Payable, Notes Payable, Accrued Liabilities, etc.) Cash To record purchase of Mackay Machine Works.

POST REF.

DR.

407

CR.

1,750,000 100,000 500,000 1,350,000

Goodwill has some unique features unlike other intangible assets. 1. Goodwill is recorded only by an acquiring company when it purchases another company. An outstanding reputation may create goodwill, but that company never records goodwill for its own business. 2. According to GAAP, goodwill is not amortized. Instead, the acquiring company measures the fair value of its goodwill each year. If the goodwill has increased in fair value, there is nothing to record. But if goodwill’s fair value has decreased, then the company records an impairment loss and writes the goodwill down. For example, suppose Apex Industries’ goodwill—which it acquired in the purchase of Mackay Machine Works—has a fair value of $80,000 a year after the purchase. In this case, Apex Industries would make the following entry: DATE

ACCOUNTS Loss on Impairment of Goodwill Goodwill ($100,000 − $80,000) To record decrease in fair value of goodwill.

POST REF.

DR. 20,000

CR. 20,000

Apex Industries would then report this goodwill at its reduced fair value of $80,000.

Accounting for Research and Development Costs Research and development (R&D) costs are the lifeblood of companies such as Sony, Johnson & Johnson, IBM, and Ford. In general, companies don’t report R&D costs as assets on their balance sheets because GAAP requires companies to expense R&D costs as they are incurred.

How Are Natural Resources Accounted For? 7

Account for natural resources

Natural resources are assets that come from the earth. Examples include minerals, oil, natural gas, precious metals, coal, and timber. As stated earlier in the chapter, the process of allocating the cost of a natural resource to an expense is called depletion. Depletion ­expense is that portion of the cost of a natural resource that is used up in a particular ­period. Depletion expense is computed in a manner almost identical to units-of-production depreciation. The formula used to calculate the depletion per unit of natural resource is:

Depletion per unit of natural resource 

Depletion  Systematic reduction of a natural resource’s carrying value on the books. Expense that applies to natural resources in the same way depreciation applies to fixed assets and amortization to intangible assets. It is computed in a similar fashion as unitsof-production depreciation.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 407

Cost  Depletion expense per unit Estimated total units of natural resource

Notice that, unlike UOP depreciation, there is no residual value in the calculation of depletion expense. This is because when a natural resource is used up, there is nothing left to sell. To illustrate, let’s assume that Pegusus Gold owns gold reserves that cost $8,500,000. A geological study estimates that the reserves hold 20,000 ounces of gold. Pegusus Gold would calculate the depletion per ounce of gold as:

$8,500,000  $425 per ounce 20,000 ounces

03/04/14 2:05 PM

408

Chapter 8

If 600 ounces of gold are removed and sold during the month, depletion is $255,000 (600 ounces × $425 per ounce) and would be recorded as: DATE

ACCOUNTS Depletion Expense Accumulated Depletion—Gold Reserves Record monthly depletion.

POST REF.

DR. 255,000

CR. 255,000

Accumulated Depletion is a contra-account similar to Accumulated Depreciation. It is deducted from the cost of the natural resource to determine the net book value of the natural resource.

What Are Other Assets? 8

Account for other assets

Marketable securities  Readily tradable equity or debt securities.

Other assets may consist of any assets a business owns that we have not already discussed. Two common assets that a business might own are real estate (land or buildings) that is being held for resale rather than for use and investments in marketable securities. Marketable securities are investments, such as stocks, also known as equity securities, and bonds, also called debt securities. Bonds will be discussed more in Chapter 9; basically, buying bonds is a way of loaning money to an entity. Marketable securities are classified as current assets if management intends to sell them, or they mature, within a year. However, if they are not intended to be sold, or they do not mature, within a year they are shown as other long-term assets. A company investing in marketable securities earns income when it receives dividends on stock or interest on bonds that it holds. Also, changes in the market value of a security can affect a company’s income in two ways: • Realized gains and losses occur when a security is sold for an amount different from its cost. • Unrealized gains and losses occur when a security’s market value changes while the company still owns it. These are considered “unrealized” because the company won’t actually gain or lose money until it sells the investment. The accounting procedures followed for marketable securities depend on the type of investment and on management’s intention for the investment. Marketable securities are classified as trading securities, held-to-maturity securities, or available-for-sale securities.

Trading securities  Equity or debt securities that are actively managed in order to maximize profit.

Held-to-maturity securities  Debt securities that a company intends and is able to hold until maturity. Available-for-sale securities  Equity or debt securities that cannot be classified as either trading securities or held-to-maturity securities.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 408

• Trading securities include equity or debt securities that are actively managed in order to maximize profit as a result of short-term changes in price. These are shown as current assets on the balance sheet at their market value as of the balance sheet date. Any increase or decrease in price during the period is shown as an unrealized gain or loss on the income statement. Any interest or dividends earned during the period are also reported as income on the income statement. • Held-to-maturity securities are debt securities that a company intends and is able to hold until they mature. These are reported at their cost on the balance sheet as either current or long-term assets based on their maturity date. Any interest income earned on these securities is reported on the income statement. • Available-for-sale securities include equity or debt securities that cannot be classified as trading or held-to-maturity securities. These are reported at their current market value on the balance sheet date. Any interest or dividends earned during the period are included in net income on the income statement. However, increases or decreases in market value during the period are not reported as part of net income on the income statement. Instead, they are shown as separate changes in stockholders’ equity for the period.

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

409

How Are Long-Term Assets Reported on the Balance Sheet? 9

Report long-term assets on the balance sheet

In Chapter 4, we learned that current assets appear first on a classified balance sheet. Following the current assets, a business will report its long-term assets. Fixed assets are usually the first long-term asset reported and are often shown as “Property, Plant, and Equipment.” Property, Plant, and Equipment includes the original cost, accumulated depreciation, and book value of assets such as land, buildings, and equipment. Natural resources are typically shown after the fixed assets and include the original cost, accumulated depletion, and book value of any natural resources the business owns. A business may choose to show only the net book value of fixed assets and natural resources on the balance sheet. In this case, the business will disclose the costs and accumulated depreciation or depletion for each asset group in the financial statement footnotes. When a business has intangible assets, the balance sheet will typically show the amount for intangible assets after the fixed assets and the natural resources. The footnotes to the financial statements will include a description of the intangible asset and its estimated useful life. Other long-term assets are typically shown last in the long-term assets section of a balance sheet. Exhibit 8-10 illustrates a typical long-term assets section of a balance sheet: Total Current Assets Long-Term Assets Property, Plant, and Equipment: Land Buildings Equipment Less: Accumulated Depreciation Net Property, Plant, and Equipment Gold Reserves, Net of Accumulated Depletion of $260,000 Patents Other Long-Term Assets Total Long-Term Assets Total Assets

$ 165,000

$ 175,000 680,000 240,000 1,095,000 385,000 $710,000 620,000 80,000 145,000 1,555,000 $1,720,000

Exhibit 8-10

Focus on Decision Making “How Does a Business Manage Assets?”

10 Calculate the return on assets and the fixed asset turnover

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 409

Investing in assets is a very important decision. Some assets like accounts receivable are easy to convert to cash. Some assets like buildings are not easy to convert into cash. There is a lot of risk in investing in long-term assets. So why invest in risky, long-term assets? The answer is that great risk typically means great profits. Without long-term assets, such as buildings and equipment, a business would have no place to operate. Think of AT&T trying to sell phones without a building. Think of John Deere trying to manufacture tractors and farm equipment without a factory. It can’t be done. Businesses need the right blend of long- and short-term assets for employees to use and earn a profit. So, how does a business decide whether to invest in assets? The business looks at the investment, estimates the future profits from the investment, and determines whether the profits create enough value to justify the investment. Think about AT&T opening a new store. Does the investment in inventory, buildings, and other assets earn enough profit to justify lenders and owners taking risk over time? A business can have too little or too much invested in assets. If a business has too few assets, it cannot meet the demand for its product and loses sales and profits. If a

03/04/14 2:05 PM

410

Chapter 8

business has too much invested in assets, it also loses profits and value. Assets, both short- and long- term, are expensive to maintain and finance. So how do managers and other decision makers determine if the business has the right amount of assets? Two measures often used are return on assets (ROA) and fixed asset turnover.

Return on Assets (ROA) and Fixed Asset Turnover

Return on assets (ROA)  The ratio of net income divided by average total assets, which indicates the profit earned on each dollar invested in total assets.

Fixed asset turnover  The ratio of sales to average fixed assets, which indicates the sales generated for ­every dollar invested in fixed assets.

Walk into an AT&T store. Look around and see the cash in the register, the inventory, the building, and the equipment. Think of all the assets that it takes to operate an AT&T store. Now ask yourself, how much profit do owners earn for each dollar invested in assets? One way to answer that question is to compute the return on assets. Return on assets (ROA) is the ratio of net income divided by average total assets. The formula for ROA is:

Return on Assets (ROA) 

Net Income Average Total Assets

Now walk into the office of the AT&T store manager. Ask the manager how his or her supervisor evaluates the store’s performance. You’ll likely hear numerous measures, ­including ROA. A measure often used to evaluate the productivity, or output, of tangible, physical assets is the fixed asset turnover. Fixed assets are land, buildings, and equipment. Fixed assets are tangible and can be seen and touched. The fixed asset turnover is the ratio of sales to average fixed assets. The formula for the fixed asset turnover is:

Fixed Asset Turnover 

Sales Average Fixed Assets

The ROA and fixed asset turnover are usually computed for an annual period, so the net income and sales figures are the amounts for the entire year. Average total assets and average fixed assets are computed by adding the beginning balance and ending balance of each and dividing the total by two. Remember that balance sheet items, such as fixed assets and total assets, carry their balances from one period to the next. For example, the ending fixed assets for one year become the beginning fixed assets for the next year. Let’s look at an example. Assume MacKay Industries has sales of $500,000, net income of $60,000, beginning fixed assets of $200,000, ending fixed assets of $300,000, beginning total assets of $500,000, and ending total assets of $700,000. The ROA of MacKay Industries is calculated as:

Return on Assets (ROA) 

$60,000  10% (($500,000 + $700,000)/2)

The fixed asset turnover for MacKay Industries is calculated as:

Fixed Asset Turnover 

$500,000  2.0 (($200,000 + $300,000)/2)

The higher the ROA and fixed asset turnover, the more efficiently the business is utilizing its assets. The assets are more productive in generating net income and sales. MacKay Industries is generating net income of $0.10 for every dollar invested in assets and $2.00 of sales for every dollar invested in fixed assets.

How They Do It: A Look at Business

Let’s look at two businesses, AT&T and John Deere (Deere & Co.). It takes a lot of fixed assets to operate AT&T. AT&T has made a large investment in assets such as computers, satellites, and buildings. At December 31, 2012, AT&T

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 410

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

411

had $272.3 billion invested in total assets and $109.8 billion invested in long-term, fixed ­assets. AT&T’s ROA for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2012, was 2.8%. Its fixed ­asset turnover for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2012, was 1.2 times a year. Next we’ll look at John Deere, the manufacturer of farm and lawn equipment. It takes a lot of fixed assets to manufacture a tractor. John Deere has made a large investment in assets, particularly land, factories, and equipment. At October 31, 2012, John Deere had $56.3 billion invested in total assets and $5 billion invested in long-term, fixed assets. John Deere’s ROA for the fiscal year ended October 31, 2012, was 5.9%. Its fixed asset turnover for the fiscal year ended October 31, 2012, was 7.2 times a year. Now think about and compare AT&T and John Deere. John Deere appears to generate more net income for every dollar invested in fixed assets. However, to fully understand this, we must look at what the fixed assets are and how the value of the assets are measured. Think about it. Are the fixed assets old or new? Does the conservative historical cost reported in the balance sheet reflect the market value and cost of replacing the assets? How is depreciation measured? Measuring and evaluating how a business manages its fixed assets is complicated.

MyAccountingLab

Summary Here is what you should know after reading this chapter. MyAccountingLab will help you identify what you know and where to go when you need practice.

1

2

Describe the differences between fixed assets, intangible assets, and natural resources Calculate and record the cost of acquiring fixed assets

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Long-term assets consist of:

Basket purchase (p. 391)

• Fixed, or plant, assets.

Capitalized (p. 390)

• Intangible assets.

Fixed assets (p. 388)

• Natural resources.

Intangible assets (p. 388) Land improvements (p. 389) Lump-sum purchase (p. 391) Natural resources (p. 388) Plant assets (p. 388) Tangible assets (p. 388)

3

Calculate and record the depreciation of fixed assets

Fixed assets are depreciated using these methods: • Straight-line.

Accelerated depreciation method (p. 396) Depreciable cost (p. 394)

• Units-of-production.

Double-declining-balance (DDB) method (p. 396)

• Double-declining-balance.

Fully depreciated (p. 395) Residual value (p. 394) Salvage value (p. 394) Straight-line (SL) depreciation method (p. 394) Units-of-production (UOP) depreciation method (p. 395) Useful life (p. 393)

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 411

03/04/14 2:05 PM

412

4

Chapter 8

Account for repairs to fixed assets

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Repairs to fixed assets are classified as:

Betterment (p. 402)

• Ordinary repairs, which are expensed when incurred.

Capital expenditure (p. 402)

• Extraordinary repairs, which are debited to an asset account and depreciated. • Betterments, which are debited to an asset account and depreciated.

5

Account for the disposal of fixed assets

The disposal of fixed assets is accounted for by recording:

Extraordinary repair (p. 401) Ordinary repair (p. 401) Revenue expenditure (p. 401)

Like-kind exchange (p. 403)

• “What you got.” • “What you gave up.” • Any gain or loss recognized on the transaction.

6

Account for intangible assets

Intangible assets include the following:

Amortization (p. 405)

• Patents

Brand names (p. 406)

• Copyrights

Copyright (p. 406)

• Trademarks

Franchises (p. 406)

• Franchises

Goodwill (p. 406)

• Goodwill

Licenses (p. 406)

• Are amortized using a method similar to straight-line depreciation (except goodwill).

Patent (p. 405) Trade names (p. 406) Trademarks (p. 406)

7

Account for natural resources

Natural resources include the following:

Depletion (p. 407)

• Minerals • Oil • Gas • Coal • Timber • Are depleted using a method similar to unitsof-production depreciation.

8

Account for other assets

Other assets include the following:

Available-for-sale securities (p. 408)

• Assets such as land or buildings being held for resale.

Held-to-maturity securities (p. 408)

• Investments in marketable securities.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 412

Marketable securities (p. 408) Trading securities (p. 408)

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

Key Points 9

Report long-term assets on the balance sheet

413

Key Accounting Terms

Long-term assets are reported on the balance sheet after current assets in the following order: • Fixed assets • Natural resources • Intangible assets • Other long-term assets

10 Calculate the return on

assets and the fixed asset turnover

Ratios are often used to help make decisions:

Fixed asset turnover (p. 410)

• The return on assets measures how much profit a company generates for each dollar of assets it has.

Return on assets (ROA) (p. 410)

• The fixed asset turnover measures how efficiently a company is using its fixed assets to generate sales.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 413

03/04/14 2:05 PM

414

Chapter 8

Accounting Practice Discussion Questions 1. When a company makes an expenditure, it can either capitalize or expense the cost, depending on the nature of the expenditure. What does it mean to capitalize an expenditure? What determines whether an expenditure can be capitalized? 2. If a company were to purchase a piece of land with a building on it that it demolishes to make room for its new building, in which account would the cost of demolition be recorded (Land, Building, Demolition Expense, or something else)? Why? 3. What is a lump-sum purchase of assets? How does a company determine how much to allocate to each asset purchased in a lump-sum purchase? 4. What is depreciation, and why is it used in accounting? 5. Are useful life and physical life the same thing relative to fixed assets? Provide some examples that illustrate your answer. 6. Which depreciation method would be most appropriate for each of the following assets? a. This machine is used as a backup to the other machines in the production process. As a result, there are some years where it sees a lot of action and others where it is ­seldom used. It is not a high-tech machine. It will not become obsolete in the ­foreseeable future. b. Typically this machine will work very effectively and with few repairs for the first three years, but will be down for maintenance quite a bit during its final four years of use. c.  This machine is expected to run constantly over the entire period it is used. It requires regular maintenance over its lifetime in order to maintain its expected steady level of production. 7. What makes a repair “extraordinary” (as opposed to ordinary)? Give an example of an extraordinary and an ordinary repair. What is the financial statement effect of recording a repair as an extraordinary repair instead of an ordinary repair? 8. What is the book value of an asset? How is gain or loss on disposal of assets calculated? 9. If a machine that cost $10,000 was estimated to have a salvage value of zero after a useful life of 10 years and was sold for $4,500 after it had been owned for 6 complete years, what would be the amount of gain or loss recognized on the sale? 10. Complete the following analogies. What are some similarities and differences between the two concepts involved in each? a. Depreciation is to fixed assets as __________________ is to intangible assets. b. Depreciation is to fixed assets as __________________ is to natural resources.

Self Check 1. Which cost is not recorded as part of the cost of a building? a. Construction materials, labor, and overhead b. Annual building maintenance c. Earthmoving for the building’s foundation d. Real estate commission paid to buy the building

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 414

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

415

2. Northwest Airways bought four used Boeing 737 airplanes. Each plane had a selling price of $40 million, but Northwest bought the combination for $144 million. How much is Northwest Airways’ cost of each plane? a. $144 million b. $36 million c. $160 million d. $40 million 3. How should a capital expenditure for a long-term asset be recorded? a. Debit a liability b. Debit an expense c. Debit capital d. Debit an asset 4. Which depreciation method usually produces the most depreciation expense in the first year? a. Straight-line b. Double-declining-balance c. Units-of-production d. All produce the same amount of depreciation for the first year. 5. An airplane costs $75 million and is expected to fly 750 million miles during its 12-year life. Residual value is expected to be zero because the plane was used when acquired. If the plane travels 45 million miles the first year, how much depreciation expense should be recorded under the units-of-production method? a. $6.25 million b. $10 million c. $4.5 million d. Cannot be determined from the data given 6. Which depreciation method is generally preferable for income tax purposes? Why? a. Double-declining-balance because it gives higher depreciation deductions in earlier years b. Straight-line because it is simplest c. Double-declining-balance because it gives the most total depreciation over the asset’s life d. Units-of-production because it best tracks the asset’s use 7. A copy machine cost $36,000 when new and has accumulated depreciation of $34,000. Suppose Sun Graphics and Designs Center junks this machine, receiving nothing in return. What is the result of the disposal transaction? a. Loss of $36,000 b. Gain of $34,000 c. Loss of $2,000 d. Gain of $2,000 8. Using information from the preceding question, suppose Sun Graphics and Designs Center sold the machine for $6,000. What is the result of this disposal transaction? a. Loss of $4,000 b. Gain of $4,000 c. Gain of $6,000 d. Gain of $2,000 9. Depletion is calculated in a manner similar to which depreciation method? a. Double-declining-balance method b. Units-of-production method c. Straight-line method d. Accelerated method

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 415

03/04/14 2:05 PM

416

Chapter 8 10. Which intangible asset is recorded only as part of the acquisition of another company? a. Franchise b. Patent c. Goodwill d. Copyright 11. According to the Real World Accounting Video, a quantitative expression of a plan is called a __________________. a. directive b. scheme c. budget d. dream 12. According to the Real World Accounting Video, the cost of a fixed asset minus its estimated residual value is called an asset’s __________________. a. cost b. depreciable cost c. liquidation value d. depreciation expense Answers are given after Written Communication.

MyAccountingLab

Short Exercises S8-1. Long-term asset terms (Learning Objective 1) 5–10 min. Identify each of the following assets as a fixed asset (F) or an intangible asset (I): _____ 1. Franchises _ ____ 2. Vehicles _ ____ 3. Buildings _ ____ 4. Furniture _ ____ 5. Patents _ ____ 6. Copyrights _ ____ 7. Trademarks _ ____ 8. Land improvements S8-2. Long-term asset terms (Learning Objective 1) 5–10 min. For each of the following long-term assets, identify the type of expense that will be incurred to allocate the asset’s cost as depreciation expense (DR), depletion expense (DL), amortization expense (A), or none of these (NA).

_____ 1. Franchises _____ 2. Land _____ 3. Buildings _____ 4. Furniture _____ 5. Patents _____ 6. Copyrights _____ 7. Trademarks _____ 8. Land improvements _____ 9. Gold ore deposits

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 416

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

417

S8-3. Land or Land Improvements (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Identify each of the following as land (L) or land improvements (LI):

_____ 1. Survey fees _____ 2. Fencing _____ 3. Lighting _____ 4. Clearing land _____ 5. Parking lot S8-4. Lump-sum purchase (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Kamaplast Company purchased factory equipment for $53,000. Other costs incurred were freight costs, $1,200; installation, $2,000; labor costs in testing equipment, $500; oil lubricants and supplies to be used with equipment, $600; fire insurance policy ­covering equipment, $1,300. Compute the acquisition cost of the equipment. S8-5. Errors in accounting for long-term assets (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. Noxon, Inc., repaired a piece of equipment at a cost of $3,000, which Noxon, Inc., paid in cash. Noxon, Inc., erroneously capitalized this cost as part of the cost of the equipment. Requirements 1. Journalize both the incorrect entry the accountant made to record this transaction and the correct entry that the accountant should have made. 2. How will this accounting error affect Noxon, Inc.’s net income? Ignore depreciation. S8-6. Concept of depreciation (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Jody Martin just slept through the class in which Professor Ibanez explained the concept of depreciation. Because the next test is scheduled for Wednesday, Jody Martin telephones Hanna Svensen to get her notes from the lecture. Hanna Svensen’s notes are concise: “Depreciation—Sounds like Greek to me.” Jody Martin next tries Tim Lake, who says he thinks depreciation is what happens when an asset wears out. David Coe is confident that depreciation is the process of building up a cash fund to replace an asset at the end of its useful life. Explain the concept of depreciation for Jody Martin. Evaluate the explanations of Tim Lake and David Coe. Be specific. S8-7. Depreciation methods (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. At the beginning of the year, Titan Trucking purchased a used Kenworth truck at a cost of $48,000. Titan Trucking expects the truck to remain useful for four years (800,000 miles) and to have a residual value of $8,000. Titan Trucking expects the truck to be driven 160,000 miles the first year and 280,000 miles the second year. Requirements 1. Compute Titan Trucking’s first-year depreciation expense on the truck using the following methods: a. Straight-line b. Units-of-production c. Double-declining-balance 2. Show the truck’s book value at the end of the first year under the straight-line method.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 417

03/04/14 2:05 PM

418

Chapter 8 S8-8. Depreciation methods (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Refer to the data for S8-7. Compute second-year depreciation expense on the truck ­using the following methods: a. Straight-line b. Units-of-production c. Double-declining-balance S8-9. Straight-line depreciation method (Learning Objective 3) 5–10 min. Equipment was bought for $66,000 on January 1, 2013. Freight charges were $4,800 and installation cost $6,000. It is estimated that the equipment will have a $14,000 ­residual value at the end of 5 years. What is the amount of accumulated depreciation on December 31, 2014, if the straight-line method of depreciation is used? S8-10. Straight-line depreciation method (Learning Objective 3) 5–10 min. On January 1, Harry’s Hot Dogs purchased a hot dog stand for $120,000 with an ­estimated useful life of 10 years and no residual value. Suppose that after using the hot dog stand for four years and straight-line depreciation, the company determines that the stand will remain useful for only four more years. Record Harry’s Hot Dogs’ ­depreciation expense on the hot dog stand for year 5 by the straight-line method. S8-11. Capitalized versus expensed costs for long-term assets (Learning Objectives 2 & 4) 10–15 min. Classify each of the following expenditures for machinery as a capital expenditure (CAP) or a revenue expenditure (REV): a. Purchase price b. Ordinary recurring repairs to keep the machinery in good working order c. Lubrication of the machinery before it is placed in service d. Periodic lubrication after the machinery is placed in service e. Major overhaul to extend useful life by three years f. Sales tax paid on the purchase price g. Transportation and insurance while machinery is in transit from seller to buyer h. Installation i. Training of personnel for initial operation of the machinery S8-12. Disposition of long-term assets (Learning Objective 5) 5–10 min. On September 30, 2014, Ahlia Company sold old equipment for $46,000. The equipment was purchased on January 1, 2012, for $96,000 and was estimated to have a $16,000 residual value at the end of its 5-year life. Depreciation on the equipment has been recorded through December 31, 2013. Make the journal entry to record Ahlia’s sale of equipment. S8-13. Goodwill (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. When one media company buys another, goodwill is often the most costly asset acquired. TXL Publishing paid $925,000 to acquire the Thrifty Nickel, a weekly advertising paper. At the time of the acquisition, the Thrifty Nickel’s balance sheet reported total assets of $1,150,000 and liabilities of $375,000. The fair market value of the Thrifty Nickel’s assets was $1,225,000. The fair market value of liabilities was $375,000. How much goodwill did TXL Publishing purchase as part of the acquisition of the Thrifty Nickel? Journalize TXL Publishing’s acquisition of the Thrifty Nickel.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 418

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

419

S8-14. Amortization (Learning Objective 6) 5–10 min. On April 1, Micro Apps paid $750,000 to acquire a patent on software. Micro Apps expects the patent to have a useful life of five years. Requirements 1. Journalize the entry to record the purchase of the patent on April 1. 2. Journalize the entry to record amortization on December 31. S8-15. Depletion (Learning Objective 7) 5–10 min. Bargain Oil, a small Texas oil company, holds huge reserves of oil. Assume that at the end of 2014, Bargain Oil’s cost of oil reserves totaled approximately $14.4 million, ­representing 1.2 million barrels of oil reserves in the ground. Requirements 1. Calculate Bargain Oil’s depletion expense per barrel of oil. 2. Suppose Bargain Oil removed 220,000 barrels of oil during 2015 and sold all of these barrels during the year. Record Bargain Oil’s depletion expense for 2015. S8-16. Other long-term assets (Learning Objective 8) 5–10 min. Classify each of the following as: Trading security (T) Available-for-sale security (A) Held-to-maturity security (H) None of the above (N)

_____ 1. A bond that management plans on owning until it is repaid. Management does not believe it will need to sell the bond to generate cash before the bond’s scheduled maturity date.

_____ 2. Land that management is holding as an investment. _____ 3. Intel stock that company management plans on selling quickly, as soon as its price is 10% more than what the company paid at the time it purchased the stock.

_____ 4. Ford Motor Company stock. Management does not actively manage this stock and intends to sell it only if it needs to generate cash.

_____ 5. A bond that management plans on owning until it is repaid. However, ­ anagement believes it may have to sell the bond within the year in order m to provide enough cash for operations.

_____ 6. Inventory that management intends to sell within the year.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 419

03/04/14 2:05 PM

420

Chapter 8 S8-17. Other long-term assets (Learning Objective 8) 5–10 min. Specify how each of the following items would be reported in the financial statements of Cunnington Enterprises for its current fiscal year. Also specify the amount that would appear on the statement. Some items may be reported on more than one financial statement. In these cases, specify the amount that would appear on each statement. Income Statement (IS) Balance Sheet (BS) Change in Stockholders’ Equity (SE) 1. Cunnington Enterprises received $143 of dividends during the year on stock it owned in Haskins, Inc. 2. At year-end, Cunnington Enterprises owned a $5,000 US Treasury Bond. 3. Cunnington Enterprises sold stock for $580 cash that had been held as an available-for-sale security. The stock had been purchased for $520 and hadn’t changed in value until the time of its sale. 4. Stock that Cunnington Enterprises purchased for $875 during the year as an available-for-sale security has a market value of $940 at the year-end balance sheet date. 5. Stock that Cunnington Enterprises purchased for $640 during the year as a trading security had a market value of $655 at the year-end balance sheet date. 6. $280 of interest earned on a bond that Cunnington Enterprises purchased from the State of Washington.

MyAccountingLab Quick solution: Land = $338,800; Land Improvements = $73,000; Building = $800,000

Exercises (Group A) E8-18A. Capitalized costs for long-term assets (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Pierce Systems purchased land, paying $65,000 cash as a down payment and signing a $260,000 note payable for the balance. In addition, Pierce Systems paid delinquent property tax of $3,500, title insurance costing $1,500, and an $8,800 charge for leveling the land and removing an unwanted building. The company constructed an office building on the land at a cost of $800,000. It also paid $55,000 for a fence around the property, $8,000 for the company sign near the entrance, and $10,000 for special lighting of the grounds. Requirements 1. Determine the cost of the company’s land, land improvements, and building. 2. Which of the assets will Pierce depreciate? E8-19A. Capitalized costs for long-term assets (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Ramirez Transfer manufactures conveyor belts. Early in August 2015, Ramirez Transfer constructed its own building at a materials, labor, and overhead cost of $1,250,000. Ramirez Transfer paid cash for the construction costs. Ramirez Transfer also paid for architect fees and building permits of $82,000. Requirements 1. How much should Ramirez Transfer record as the cost of the building in 2015? 2. Record Ramirez Transfer’s transactions related to the construction of the building.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 420

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

421

E8-20A. Capitalized costs for long-term assets (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Sunshine Tanning Salon bought three tanning beds in a $13,000 lump-sum purchase. An independent appraiser valued the tanning beds as follows:

Tanning Bed

Appraised Value

1 2 3

$2,000 6,000 8,000

Sunshine Tanning Salon paid $6,500 in cash and signed a note payable for $6,500. Record the purchase in the journal, identifying each tanning bed’s cost by number in a separate Tanning Bed account. Round decimals to three places. E8-21A. Errors in accounting for long-term assets (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 15–20 min. On January 1 of year 1, Ramsco, Inc., purchased equipment at a cost of $85,000. Management expects the equipment to remain in service for five years, with zero residual value. Ramsco, Inc., uses the straight-line depreciation method. Through an accounting error, Ramsco, Inc., accidentally expensed the entire cost of the equipment at the time of purchase. Requirement 1. Prepare a schedule to show the overstatement or understatement in the following items at the end of each year over the five-year life of the equipment. a. Equipment, net b. Net income E8-22A. Depreciation methods (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. Wellness Medical Center bought equipment on January 2, 2014, for $24,000. The equipment was expected to remain in service for four years and to perform 700 operations. At the end of the equipment’s useful life, Wellness estimates that its residual value will be $3,000. The equipment performed 70 operations the first year, 210 the second year, 280 the third year, and 140 the fourth year. Requirements 1. Prepare a schedule of depreciation expense per year for the equipment under the three depreciation methods. After two years under double-declining-balance depreciation, the company switched to the straight-line method. Show your computations. 2. Which method tracks the wear and tear on the equipment most closely? 3. Which method would Wellness prefer to use for income-tax purposes in the first years of the equipment’s life? Explain in detail why a taxpayer prefers this method. E8-23A. Straight-line depreciation (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Hanson Freight purchased a building for $3,200,000 and depreciated it on a straightline basis over a 30-year period. The estimated residual value was $380,000. After using the building for 15 years, Hanson realized that wear and tear on the building would force the company to replace it before 30 years. Starting with the sixteenth year, Hanson began depreciating the building over a revised total life of 25 years and increased the estimated residual value to $430,000. Record depreciation expense on the building for years 15 and 16.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 421

03/04/14 2:05 PM

422

Chapter 8 E8-24A. Straight-line depreciation and long-term asset disposal (Learning Objectives 3 & 5) 15–20 min. On January 2, 2014, Sparkle Lighting purchased showroom fixtures for $20,000 cash, expecting the fixtures to remain in service for 10 years. Sparkle Lighting has depreciated the fixtures on a straight-line basis, with zero residual value. On June 30, 2015, Sparkle Lighting sold the fixtures for $14,500 cash. Record both the depreciation expense on the fixtures for 2015 and the sale of the fixtures on June 30, 2015. Round intermediate calculations to the nearest cent and final answers to the nearest whole dollar. E8-25A. Disposition of long-term assets (Learning Objective 5) 10–15 min. Assume that Excell Corporation’s comparative balance sheet reported these amounts:

December 31 Plant and Equipment.................................................................. Less: Accumulated Depreciation ................................................ Net Plant and Equipment............................................................

2013

2012

$ 645,000 137,400 $ 507,600

$ 610,000 120,600 $ 489,400

Requirement 1. Assume that on January 2, 2014, Henry sold 1/6 of its plant and equipment for $122,000 in cash. Journalize this transaction for Excell. E8-26A. Trade-in on purchase of new asset (Learning Objectives 3 & 5) 15–20 min. Essex County Transport is a large trucking company. Essex County Transport uses the unitsof-production (UOP) method to depreciate its trucks. In 2013, Essex County Transport acquired a Mack truck costing $400,000 with a useful life of 10 years or 937,500 miles. Estimated residual value was $25,000. The truck was driven 76,000 miles in 2013, 126,000 miles in 2014, and 166,000 miles in 2015. After 60,000 miles in 2016, Essex County Transport traded in the Mack truck for a new Freightliner that cost $460,000. Essex County Transport received a $245,000 trade-in allowance for the old truck and paid the difference in cash. Journalize the entry to record the purchase of the new truck. E8-27A. Patents (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Part 1. Hamilton Printing manufactures high-speed printers. Hamilton Printing recently paid $380,000 for a patent on a new laser printer. Although it gives legal protection for 20 years, the patent is expected to provide a competitive advantage for only eight years. Using the straight-line method of amortization, make journal entries to record (a) the purchase of the patent and (b) amortization for year 1. Assume the patent is purchased on January 1 of year 1. Part 2. After using the patent for three years, Hamilton Printing learns at an industry trade show that another company is designing a more efficient printer. On the basis of this new information, Hamilton Printing decides, starting with year 4, to amortize the remaining cost of the patent over two remaining years, giving the patent a total useful life of five years. Record amortization for year 4. E8-28A. Goodwill (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Rauscher, Corp., aggressively acquires other companies. Assume that Rauscher, Corp., purchased Lancer, Inc., for $12 million cash. The market value of Lancer’s assets is $14 million, and it has liabilities with a market value of $3.5 million. Requirements 1. Compute the cost of goodwill purchased by Rauscher, Corp. 2. Record the purchase of Lancer, Inc., by Rauscher, Corp.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 422

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

423

E8-29A. Depletion (Learning Objective 7) 10–15 min. Brimhall Mining paid $1,276,000 for the right to extract mineral assets from an 800,000-ton mineral deposit. In addition to the purchase price, Brimhall Mining also paid a $1,500 filing fee, an $8,500 license fee to the state of Colorado, and $58,000 for a geological survey of the property. Because the company purchased the rights to the minerals only, the company expected the asset to have zero residual value when fully depleted. During the first year, Brimhall Mining removed and sold 83,000 tons of minerals. Using the Mineral Assets account, make journal entries to record the following: a. Purchase of the minerals b. Payment of fees and other costs c. Depletion expense for the first year. E8-30A. Balance sheet disclosure of long-term assets (Learning Objective 9) 10–15 min. At the end of 2014, Zorro, Corp., had total assets of $11 million and total liabilities of $8 million. Included in the assets were property, plant, and equipment with a cost of $9 million and accumulated depreciation of $3 million. Also included in the assets were $246,000 of patents, $1,200,000 of goodwill, and $345,000 of other long-term assets. During 2014, Zorro, Corp., earned total revenues of $23 million and had total expenses of $21 million. Requirements 1. Show how Zorro, Corp., reported long-term assets on its balance sheet on December 31, 2014. 2. What was the book value of property, plant, and equipment on that date? E8-31A. Return on assets (ROA) and fixed asset turnover ratio (Learning Objective 10) 5–10 min. The following is selected data for Edwards Equipment, Inc., for the current year:

Sales ...................................................................... $774,000 Net income............................................................. 66,000 Total current assets, beginning.............................. 121,000 Total current assets, ending................................... 115,000 Property, plant and equipment, beginning ............. 276,000 Property, plant and equipment, ending .................. 298,000 Total assets, beginning .......................................... 397,000 Total assets, ending ............................................... 413,000 Requirement 1. Calculate the return on assets (ROA) and the fixed asset turnover ratio for Edwards Equipment for the current year. Round your answers to two decimal places.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 423

03/04/14 2:05 PM

424

Chapter 8

Exercises (Group B) E8-32B. Capitalized costs for long-term assets (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Specialty Systems purchased land, paying $65,000 cash as a down payment and ­signing a $235,000 note payable for the balance. In addition, Specialty Systems paid delinquent property tax of $6,300, title insurance costing $2,800, and a $5,500 charge for leveling the land and removing an unwanted building. The company constructed an office building on the land at a cost of $840,000. It also paid $36,000 for a fence around the property, $16,700 for the company sign near the entrance, and $7,100 for special lighting of the grounds. Requirements 1. Determine the cost of the company’s land, land improvements, and building. 2. Which of the assets will Specialty depreciate? E8-33B. Capitalized costs for long-term assets (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Chance Brothers manufactures conveyor belts. Early in July 2015, Chance Brothers ­constructed its own building at a materials, labor, and overhead cost of $940,000. Chance Brothers paid cash for the construction costs. Chance Brothers also paid for architect fees and building permits of $78,000. Requirements 1. How much should Chance Brothers record as the cost of the building in 2015? 2. Record Chance Brothers’ transactions related to the construction of the building. E8-34B. Capitalized costs for long-term assets (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Desert Sun Tanning Salon bought three tanning beds in a $21,000 lump-sum purchase. An independent appraiser valued the tanning beds:

Tanning Bed

Appraised Value

1 2 3

$ 9,000 6,000 8,000

Desert Sun Tanning Salon paid $11,000 in cash and signed a note payable for $10,000. Record the purchase in the journal, identifying each tanning bed’s cost by number in a separate Tanning Bed account. Round decimals to three places. E8-35B. Errors in accounting for long-term assets (Learning Objectives 3 & 4) 15–20 min. Assume that on January 1 of year 1, Middleton Company purchased equipment at a cost of $470,000. Management expects the equipment to remain in service for five years, with zero residual value. Middleton Company uses the straight-line depreciation method. Through an accounting error, Middleton Company accidentally expensed the entire cost of the equipment at the time of purchase. Requirement 1. Prepare a schedule to show the overstatement or understatement in the following items at the end of each year over the five-year life of the equipment: a. Equipment, net b. Net income

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 424

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

425

E8-36B. Depreciation methods (Learning Objective 3) 15–20 min. Mercy Medical Center bought equipment on January 2, 2014, for $38,000. The equipment was expected to remain in service for four years and to perform 800 operations. At the end of the equipment’s useful life, Mercy estimates that its residual value will be $2,000. The equipment performed 90 operations the first year, 250 the second year, 240 the third year, and 220 the fourth year. Requirements 1. Prepare a schedule of depreciation expense per year for the equipment under the three depreciation methods. After two years under double-declining-balance depreciation, the company switched to the straight-line method. Show your computations. 2. Which method tracks the wear and tear on the equipment most closely? 3. Which method would Mercy prefer to use for income-tax purposes in the first years of the equipment’s life? Explain in detail why a taxpayer prefers this method. E8-37B. Straight-line depreciation (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Pembrook Freight purchased a building for $1,000,000 and depreciated it on a straight-line basis over a 30-year period. The estimated residual value was $130,000. After using the building for 15 years, Pembrook realized that wear and tear on the building would force the company to replace it before 30 years. Starting with the ­sixteenth year, Pembrook began depreciating the building over a revised total life of 20 years and increased the estimated residual value to $205,000. Record depreciation expense on the building for years 15 and 16. E8-38B. Straight-line depreciation and long-term asset disposal (Learning Objectives 3 & 5) 15–20 min. On January 2, 2014, Lithonia Lighting purchased showroom fixtures for $18,000 cash, expecting the fixtures to remain in service for eight years. Lithonia Lighting has depreciated the fixtures on a straight-line basis, with zero residual value. On August 31, 2015, Lithonia Lighting sold the fixtures for $13,200 cash. Record both the depreciation expense on the fixtures for 2015 and the sale of the fixtures on August 31, 2015. Round intermediate calculations to the nearest cent and final answers to the nearest whole dollar. E8-39B. Disposition of long-term assets (Learning Objective 5) 10–15 min. Assume that Hardigan Corporation’s comparative balance sheet reported these amounts:

December 31 Plant and Equipment.................................................................. Less: Accumulated Depreciation ................................................ Net Plant and Equipment............................................................

2013

2012

$ 645,000 175,000 $ 470,000

$ 638,000 155,000 $ 483,000

Requirement 1. Assume that on January 2, 2014, Hardigan sold 1/2 of its plant and equipment for $252,000 in cash. Journalize this transaction for Hardigan.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 425

03/04/14 2:05 PM

426

Chapter 8 E8-40B. Trade-in on purchase of new asset (Learning Objectives 3 & 5) 15–20 min. Maple Valley Transport is a large trucking company. Maple Valley Transport uses the units-of-production (UOP) method to depreciate its trucks. In 2013, Maple Valley Transport acquired a Mack truck costing $385,000 with a useful life of six years or 1,500,000 miles. Estimated residual value was $85,000. The truck was driven 182,000 miles in 2013, 263,000 miles in 2014, and 254,000 miles in 2015. After 62,000 miles in 2016, Maple Valley Transport traded in the Mack truck for a new Freightliner that costs $422,000. Maple Valley Transport received a $243,000 trade-in allowance for the old truck and paid the difference in cash. Journalize the entry to record the purchase of the new truck. E8-41B. Patents (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Part 1. Morris Printing manufactures high-speed printers. On January 1 of year 1, Morris Printing recently paid $700,000 for a patent on a new laser printer. Although it gives legal protection for 20 years, the patent is expected to provide a competitive advantage for only eight years. Using the straight-line method of amortization, make journal entries to record (a) the purchase of the patent and (b) amortization for year 1. Part 2. After using the patent for five years, Morris Printing learns at an industry trade show that another company is designing a more efficient printer. On the basis of this new information, Morris Printing decides, starting with year 6, to amortize the remaining cost of the patent over two remaining years, giving the patent a total useful life of seven years. Record amortization for year 6. E8-42B. Goodwill (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Dillon, Corp., aggressively acquired other companies. Assume that Dillon, Corp., purchased Simmons, Inc., for $16 million cash. The market value of Simmons’s assets is $22 million, and it has liabilities with a market value of $8 million. Requirements 1. Compute the cost of goodwill purchased by Dillon, Corp. 2. Record the purchase of Simmons, Inc., by Dillon, Corp. E8-43B. Depletion (Learning Objective 7) 10–15 min. Whalen Mining paid $615,000 for the right to extract mineral assets from a 500,000ton mineral deposit. In addition to the purchase price, Whalen Mining also paid a $1,400 filing fee, a $3,600 license fee to the state of Colorado, and $45,000 for a geological survey of the property. Because the company purchased the rights to the minerals only, the company expected the asset to have zero residual value when fully depleted. During the first year, Whalen Mining removed and sold 80,000 tons of minerals. Using the Mineral Assets account, make journal entries to record the following: a. Purchase of the minerals b. Payment of fees and other costs c. Depletion expense for the first year (assume all the minerals extracted were sold during the year) E8-44B. Balance sheet disclosure of long-term assets (Learning Objective 9) 10–15 min. At the end of 2014, Jamison, Corp., had total assets of $14 million and total liabilities of $9 million. Included in the assets were property, plant, and equipment with a cost of $12 million and accumulated depreciation of $3 million. Also included in the assets were $210,000 of patents, $1,400,000 of goodwill, and $318,000 of other long-term assets. During 2014, Jamison, Corp., earned total revenues of $9 million and had total expenses of $7 million.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 426

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

427

Requirements 1. Show how Jamison, Corp., reported long-term assets on its balance sheet on December 31, 2014. 2. What was the book value of property, plant, and equipment on that date? E8-45B. Return on assets (ROA) and fixed asset turnover ratio (Learning Objective 10) 5–10 min. The following is selected data for Richardson Equipment, Inc., for the current year:

Sales ...................................................................... $821,000 Net income............................................................. 63,000 Total current assets, beginning.............................. 103,000 Total current assets, ending................................... 122,000 Property, plant and equipment, beginning ............. 305,000 Property, plant and equipment, ending .................. 314,000 Total assets, beginning .......................................... 408,000 Total assets, ending ............................................... 436,000 Requirement 1. Calculate the return on assets (ROA) and the fixed asset turnover ratio for Richardson Equipment for the current year. Round your answers to two decimal places.

MyAccountingLab

Problems (Group A) P8-46A. Long-term asset costs and partial year depreciation (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 20–25 min. Tri-State Manufacturing incurred the following costs in acquiring land, making land ­improvements, and constructing and furnishing a new building.

a. Purchase price of four acres of land.............................................................. b. Additional dirt and earthmoving .................................................................... c. Fence around the boundary of the property................................................... d. Attorney fee for title search on the land......................................................... e. Unpaid property taxes on the land to be paid by Tri-state ............................. f. Company signs at the front of the property ................................................... g. Building permit for the building..................................................................... h. Architect’s fee for the design of the building ................................................. i. Labor to construct the building ..................................................................... j. Materials used to construct the building ....................................................... k. Landscaping .................................................................................................. l. Parking lot and concrete walks...................................................................... m. Lights for the parking lot and walkways ........................................................ n. Salary of construction supervisor (85% to building; 15% to parking lot and concrete walks) ........................................................ o. Furniture for the building............................................................................... p. Transportation and installation of furniture ...................................................

$193,000 9,400 17,500 1,100 5,900 4,700 2,100 20,900 498,000 401,000 6,700 29,100 10,500 60,000 106,000 1,900

Tri-State Manufacturing depreciates buildings over 30 years, land improvements over 20 years, and furniture over eight years, all on a straight-line basis with zero residual value.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 427

03/04/14 2:05 PM

428

Chapter 8 Requirements 1. Set up columns for Land, Land Improvements, Building, and Furniture. Show how to account for each cost by listing the cost under the correct account. Determine the total cost of each asset. 2. All construction was complete and assets were placed in service on September 1. Record partial-year depreciation for the year ended December 31. Round intermediate calculations to the nearest cent and final answers to the nearest whole dollar. P8-47A. Journalize long-term asset transactions (Learning Objectives 2, 3, & 5) 20–25 min. Fidelity Freightway provides freight service. The company’s balance sheet includes Land, Buildings, and Motor-Carrier Equipment. Fidelity Freightway uses a separate accumulated depreciation account for each depreciable asset. During 2014, Fidelity Freightway completed the following transactions:

Jan 1

Jul 1

Oct 31 Dec 31

Traded in motor-carrier equipment with accumulated depreciation of $112,000 (cost of $151,000) for new equipment with a cash cost of $187,000. Fidelity Freightway received a trade-in allowance of $46,000 on the old equipment and paid the remainder in cash. Sold a building that cost $740,000 and had accumulated depreciation of $360,000 through December 31 of the preceding year. Depreciation is computed on a straight-line basis. The building has a 40-year useful life and a residual value of $50,000. Fidelity Freightway received $100,000 cash and a $420,000 note receivable. Purchased land and a building for a cash payment of $700,000. An independent appraisal valued the land at $277,500 and the building at $472,500. Recorded depreciation as follows: New motor-carrier equipment has an expected useful life of 1 million miles and an estimated residual value of $27,000. Depreciation method is the units-of-production method. During the year, Fidelity Freightway drove the truck 295,000 miles. Depreciation on buildings is straight-line. The new building has a 40-year useful life and a residual value equal to $81,000. Requirement 1. Record the transactions in Fidelity Freightway’s journal.

P8-48A. Capitalize long-term asset costs and several depreciation methods (Learning Objectives 2, 3, & 9) 20–25 min. On January 3, 2015, Azul Enterprises, Inc., paid $281,000 for equipment used in manufacturing automotive supplies. In addition to the basic purchase price, the ­company paid $700 transportation charges, $300 insurance for the equipment while in transit, $11,000 sales tax, and $2,000 for a special platform on which to place the equipment in the plant. Azul Enterprises, Inc., management estimates that the equipment will remain in service for five years and have a residual value of $35,000. The equipment will produce 60,000 units the first year, with annual production decreasing by 5,000 units during each of the next four years (i.e., 55,000 units in year 2, 50,000 units in year 3, and so on for a total of 250,000 units). In trying to decide which ­depreciation method to use, Azul Enterprises, Inc., requested a depreciation schedule for each of the three depreciation methods (straight-line, units-of-production, and double-declining-balance).

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 428

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

429

Requirements 1. For each depreciation method, prepare a depreciation schedule showing asset cost, depreciation expense, accumulated depreciation, and asset book value for each year of the asset’s life. For the units-of-production method, round depreciation per unit to three decimal places. 2. Azul Enterprises, Inc., prepares financial statements using the depreciation method that reports the highest income in the early years of asset use. For income tax purposes, the company uses the depreciation method that minimizes income taxes in the early years. Consider the first year Azul Enterprises, Inc., uses the equipment. Identify the depreciation methods that meet Azul Enterprises’ objectives, assuming the income tax authorities permit the use of any method. 3. Show how Azul Enterprises, Inc., would report equipment on the December 31, 2015, balance sheet for each depreciation method. P8-49A. Disposing of an asset (Learning Objective 5) 15–20 min. Dandachli Corporation uses straight-line depreciation. Based on 2014 transactions listed below, journalize all entries required, including those to update depreciation on assets disposed of, where applicable.

Jan

1 Retired equipment purchased on January 1, 2004. It cost $53,000 and had a useful life of 10 years with no residual value. June 30 Sold equipment purchased on January 1, 2012. It cost $78,000 and had a useful life of 3 years with no residual value. It sold for $9,000 cash. Dec 31 Sold equipment for $12,500 cash. It cost $43,000 when purchased on January 1, 2011, and was depreciated based on a 5-year useful life with a $3,000 residual value. P8-50A. Goodwill (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. Carl’s Restaurants acquired Welcome Diners. The financial records of Welcome Diners included:

Book Value of Assets ...................................................................................... Market Value of Assets ................................................................................... Market Value of Liabilities ...............................................................................

$2.4 million 2.8 million 1.3 million

Requirements 1. Make the journal entry to record Carl’s Restaurants’ purchase of Welcome Diners for $2.6 million cash, including any goodwill. 2. How should Carl’s Restaurants account for this goodwill after acquiring Welcome Diners? Explain in detail. P8-51A. Depletion (Learning Objective 7) 20–25 min. Ewing Oil Company’s balance sheet includes three assets: Natural Gas, Oil, and Coal Reserves. Suppose Ewing Oil Company paid $4.8 million in cash for the right to work a mine with an estimated 400,000 tons of coal. Assume the company paid $40,000 to remove unwanted buildings from the land and $55,000 to prepare the surface for mining. Further, assume that Ewing Oil Company signed a $65,000 note payable to a company that will return the land surface to its original condition after the mining ends. During the first year, Ewing Oil Company removed 68,000 tons of coal, which it sold on account for $22 per ton. Operating expenses for the first year totaled $315,000, all paid in cash.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 429

03/04/14 2:05 PM

430

Chapter 8 Requirements 1. Record all of Ewing Oil Company’s transactions, including depletion, for the first year. 2. Prepare the company’s income statement for its coal operations for the first year. P8-52A. Return on assets (ROA) and fixed asset turnover ratio (Learning Objective 10) 10–15 min. The following information is provided for Nariman Corporation.

(in $ millions) Net income 2014............................................. Net sales 2014 ................................................ Total assets 2012............................................ Total assets 2013............................................ Total assets 2014............................................ Fixed assets 2012 ........................................... Fixed assets 2013 ........................................... Fixed assets 2014 ...........................................

Nariman Corporation $ 275 1,500 1,000 1,050 1,150 520 600 650

Requirement 1. Calculate the return on assets (ROA) and the fixed assets turnover ratio for Nariman Corporation for 2014.

MyAccountingLab

Problems (Group B) P8-53B. Long-term asset costs and partial year depreciation (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 20–25 min. Prescott Manufacturing incurred the following costs in acquiring land, making land improvements, and constructing and furnishing a new building.

a. Purchase price of four acres of land.............................................................. b. Additional dirt and earthmoving .................................................................... c. Fence around the boundary of the property................................................... d. Attorney fee for title search on the land......................................................... e. Unpaid property taxes on the land to be paid by Prescott ............................. f. Company signs at the front of the property ................................................... g. Building permit for the building..................................................................... h. Architect’s fee for the design of the building ................................................. i. Labor to construct the building ..................................................................... j. Materials used to construct the building ....................................................... k. Landscaping .................................................................................................. l. Parking lot and concrete walks...................................................................... m. Lights for the parking lot and walkways ........................................................ n. Salary of construction supervisor (85% to building; 15% to parking lot and concrete walks) ........................................................ o. Furniture for the building............................................................................... p. Transportation and installation of furniture ...................................................

$210,000 9,300 14,000 1,400 6,700 11,400 2,900 26,000 414,000 377,000 9,300 34,600 8,700 30,000 63,000 1,200

Prescott Manufacturing depreciates buildings over 40 years, land improvements over 15 years, and furniture over eight years, all on a straight-line basis with zero residual value. Requirements 1. Set up columns for Land, Land Improvements, Building, and Furniture. Show how to account for each cost by listing the cost under the correct account. Determine the total cost of each asset. 2. All construction was complete and the assets were placed in service on November 1. Record partial-year depreciation for the year ended December 31. Round intermediate calculations to the nearest cent and final answers to the nearest whole dollar.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 430

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

431

P8-54B. Journalize long-term asset transactions (Learning Objectives 2, 3, & 5) 20–25 min. Russell Freightway provides freight service. The company’s balance sheet includes Land, Buildings, and Motor-Carrier Equipment. Russell uses a separate accumulated depreciation account for each depreciable asset. During 2012, Russell Freightway completed the following transactions:

Jan 1

Jul 1

Oct 31 Dec 31

Traded in motor-carrier equipment with accumulated depreciation of $85,000 (cost of $132,000) for new equipment with a cash cost of $174,000. Russell received a trade-in allowance of $64,000 on the old equipment and paid the remainder in cash. Sold a building that cost $570,000 and had accumulated depreciation of $240,000 through December 31 of the preceding year. Depreciation is computed on a straight-line basis. The building has a 40-year useful life and a residual value of $80,000. Russell received $100,000 cash and a $590,000 note receivable. Purchased land and a building for a cash payment of $900,000. An independent appraisal valued the land at $331,200 and the building at $703,800. Recorded depreciation as follows: New motor-carrier equipment has an expected useful life of 800,000 miles and an estimated residual value of $22,000. Depreciation method is the units-of-production method. During the year, Russell drove the truck 100,000 miles. Depreciation on buildings is straight-line. The new building has a 40-year useful life and a residual value equal to $60,000.

Requirement 1. Record the transactions in Russell Freightway’s journal. Round your depreciation expense to the nearest whole dollar. P8-55B. Capitalize long-term asset costs and several depreciation methods (Learning Objectives 2, 3, & 9) 20–25 min. On January 4, 2015, Sunbelt Systems, Inc., paid $287,700 for equipment used in manufacturing automotive supplies. In addition to the basic purchase price, the company paid $2,800 transportation charges, $800 insurance for the equipment while in transit, $25,800 sales tax, and $2,900 for a special platform on which to place the equipment in the plant. Sunbelt Systems, Inc., management estimates that the equipment will remain in service for five years and have a residual value of $40,000. The equipment will produce 60,000 units the first year, with annual production decreasing by 5,000 units during each of the next four years (i.e., 55,000 units in year 2, 50,000 units in year 3, and so on for a total of 250,000 units). In trying to decide which depreciation method to use, Sunbelt Systems, Inc., requested a depreciation schedule for each of the three depreciation methods (straight-line, units-of-production, and double-declining-balance). Requirements 1. For each depreciation method, prepare a depreciation schedule showing asset cost, depreciation expense, accumulated depreciation, and asset book value for each year of the asset’s life. For the units-of-production method, round depreciation per unit to three decimal places. 2. Sunbelt Systems, Inc., prepares financial statements using the depreciation method that reports the highest income in the early years of asset use. For income tax purposes, the company uses the depreciation method that minimizes income taxes in the early years. Consider the first year Sunbelt Systems, Inc., uses the equipment. Identify the depreciation methods that meet Sunbelt Systems’ objectives, assuming the income tax authorities permit the use of any method. 3. Show how Sunbelt Systems, Inc., would report equipment on the December 31, 2015, balance sheet for each depreciation method.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 431

03/04/14 2:05 PM

432

Chapter 8 P8-56B. Disposing of an asset (Learning Objective 5) 15–20 min. Alvery Industries had a piece of equipment that cost $31,000 and had accumulated depreciation of $30,000. Requirement 1. Record the disposition of the equipment assuming the following independent situations: a. Alvery discarded the equipment receiving $0. b. Alvery sold the equipment for $6,000 cash. c. Alvery traded the equipment in on a new piece of equipment costing $35,000. Alvery was granted a $5,500 trade-in allowance for the old equipment and paid the difference in cash. d. Alvery traded the equipment in on a new piece of equipment costing $23,000. Alvery was granted a $500 trade-in allowance for the old equipment and signed a note payable for the difference. P8-57B. Goodwill (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. Cottage Cafe acquired Don’s Diners. The financial records of Don’s Diners included:

Book Value of Assets ....................................................................................... Market Value of Assets .................................................................................... Market Value of Liabilities ................................................................................

$2.6 million 2.7 million 1.3 million

Requirements 1. Make the journal entry to record Cottage Cafe’s purchase of Don’s Diners for $1.8 million cash, including any goodwill. 2. How should Cottage Cafe account for this goodwill after acquiring Don’s Diners? Explain in detail. P8-58B. Depletion (Learning Objective 7) 20–25 min. O’Brien Oil Company’s balance sheet includes three assets: Natural Gas, Oil, and Coal Reserves. Suppose O’Brien Oil Company paid $1.8 million cash for the right to work a mine with an estimated 150,000 tons of coal. Assume the company paid $66,000 to remove unwanted buildings from the land and $46,000 to prepare the surface for mining. Further, assume that O’Brien Oil Company signed a $32,000 note payable to a company that will return the land surface to its original condition after the mining ends. During the first year, O’Brien Oil Company removed 38,000 tons of coal, which it sold on account for $28 per ton. Operating expenses for the first year totaled $250,000, all paid in cash. Requirements 1. Record all of O’Brien Oil Company’s transactions, including depletion, for the first year. 2. Prepare the company’s income statement for its coal operations for the first year.

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 432

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

433

P8-59B. Return on assets (ROA) and fixed asset turnover ratio (Learning Objective 10) 10–15 min. The following is selected data for Ibanez Industries:

2014 Sales ............................................................... $1,468,000 142,000 Net income...................................................... 158,000 Total, current assets, ending........................... 768,000 Property, plant and equipment, ending ........... 926,000 Total assets, ending ........................................

2013

2012

$1,582,000 151,000 153,000 764,000 917,000

$1,427,000 129,000 165,000 736,000 901,000

Requirements 1. Calculate the return on assets (ROA) and the fixed asset turnover ratio for Ibanez Industries for 2013 and 2014. Round your answers to two decimal places. 2. Have the ratios improved or deteriorated? Comment on the trend in both ratios.

Continuing Exercise This exercise continues our accounting for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., from previous chapters. In this exercise, we will account for the annual depreciation expense for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc. In the Continuing Exercise in Chapter 2, we learned that Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., had purchased a lawn mower and a weed whacker on April 3 and that they were expected to last four years. Requirements 1. Calculate the annual depreciation expense amount for each asset assuming both assets are depreciated using straight-line depreciation. 2. Record the entry for the partial year’s depreciation for 2014. Date it December 31, 2014. Assume that no depreciation has been recorded yet in 2014.

Continuing Problem This problem continues our accounting for Aqua Magic, Inc., from Chapter 7. During 2014, Aqua Magic made the following purchases:

• On May 3, Aqua Magic, Inc., purchased a copy machine for $1,800 cash. The copy •

• • • •

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 433

machine has an estimated useful life of five years and no salvage value. Aqua Magic uses double-declining-balance depreciation for the copy machine. On May 18, Aqua Magic, Inc., purchased a $36,200 truck financed by a note payable bearing 6% annual interest. The truck has an estimated useful life of 250,000 miles and a residual value of $3,700. The truck was driven 26,000 miles in 2014 and is depreciated using the units-of-production method. On June 2, Aqua Magic, Inc., paid $25,000 for land. On June 22, $4,000 of furniture was purchased on account. The furniture has a six-year life and a residual value of $400. Furniture is depreciated using straight-line depreciation. On August 10, $1,800 of furniture was purchased. The furniture has a five-year life and no residual value and is depreciated using straight-line depreciation. On August 25, $6,000 of equipment was purchased. The equipment has a four-year life and a $1,500 residual value and is depreciated using the straight-line method.

03/04/14 2:05 PM

434

Chapter 8

• On September 1, Aqua Magic, Inc., purchased a building for $150,000 financed by a mortgage bearing 4% annual interest. The building has an estimated salvage value of $30,000 and is being depreciated over 40 years using the straight-line method. Requirements 1. Calculate the depreciation expense as of December 31, 2014, for all assets purchased in 2014. 2. Assuming these are Aqua Magic’s only assets, how will fixed assets be reflected on the balance sheet at December 31, 2014?

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem Return to Target’s 2012 annual report. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem in Chapter 2. On page 33 of the annual report, you’ll find Target’s income statement for the year e­ nding February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Operations). On page 35, you’ll find Target’s balance sheet as of February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position). Now answer the following questions: 1. Look at Target’s balance sheet. What long-term assets does Target own? How much has Target invested in each type of long-term asset as of February 2, 2013, and January 28, 2012? 2. Look over footnotes 14, 15, and 16 of the financial statements. These footnotes start on page 45 of the financial statements, found in Target’s 2012 annual report. Why does Target have tangible and intangible assets? 3. Look over footnotes 14 and 16 of the financial statements. These footnotes start on page 45 of the financial statements, found in Target’s 2012 annual report. How is Target depreciating its property and equipment and amortizing its intangible assets? 4. Look at Target’s balance sheet and income statement. What is Target’s return on assets (ROA) and fixed asset turnover for the year ending February 2, 2013? What do these ratios tell you? 5. Looking back over your answers to question 1 through 4, how do you think Target is performing? What do you think of Target’s management of assets?

Apply Your Knowledge Ethics in Action Case 1. Luca Hanson owns Luca’s Limousine, which operates a fleet of limousines and shuttle buses. Upon reviewing the most recent financial statements, he became confused over the recent decline in net income. He called his accountant and asked for an explanation. The a­ ccountant told Luca that the numerous repairs and maintenance expenses, such as oil changes, cleaning, and minor engine repairs, had totaled up to a large amount. Further, because several drivers were involved in accidents, the fleet insurance premiums had also risen sharply. Luca told his accountant to simply capitalize all the expenses related to the vehicles rather than expensing them. These capitalized repair costs could then be depreciated over the next 10 to 20 years. By capitalizing those expenses, the net income would be higher, as would property and equipment assets; therefore, both the income statement and balance sheet would look better. His accountant, however, disagreed because the costs were clearly routine maintenance and because they did not extend the fleet’s useful life. Luca then told his accountant that the estimated useful life of the vehicles needed to be changed from 5 years to 15 years to lower the amount of depreciation expense. His accountant responded that capitalizing costs that should be expensed and extending the estimated lives of assets just to increase the reported net income was unethical and wrong. Luca said that it was his business and, therefore, demanded that the financial statements be changed to

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 434

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

435

show more net income. As a result, the accountant told Luca to pick up his files and find another accountant. What ethical concerns did the accountant have? If the total amount of repairs and maintenance was so large, couldn’t a case be made that the amount should be capitalized? Is it unethical to change the estimated life of an asset? Was it unethical for the accountant to sever the business relationship? Do you have any suggestions? Case 2. Panco Corporation purchased Apex Unlimited for $12 million. The fair market value of Apex Unlimited’s net assets at the time was $9 million, so Panco Corporation recorded $3 ­million of goodwill. Included in the purchase was a patent valued at $1.5 million with an estimated ­remaining life of eight years. To comply with GAAP, the goodwill was not amortized, but the patent was amortized over the remaining eight-year life. However, the Apex Unlimited business was not as profitable as anticipated, and as a result, the accountant for Panco Corporation stated that the goodwill needed to be written off. Further, the accountant discovered that the remaining life of the patent was only six years and that it should be amortized over the remaining six-year life rather than the eight-year life originally estimated. The CEO became concerned because these adjustments would cause net income to be extremely low for the year. As a result, he told the accountant to wait before writing off the goodwill because of the possibility that the purchase could be profitable in the future. Also, he argued, the life of the patent should be left alone because it was originally based upon what was thought to be an eight-year life. After much debate, the CEO then agreed with the accountant as long as the amount of goodwill was not completely written off in the current year. What ethical concerns are involved? Should the accountant change the amortizable life of an intangible asset? Should the accountant completely write off the goodwill account in the current year? Does the CEO’s concern for higher net income create any ethical problems when the accountant agrees to not completely write off the goodwill? Do you have any other thoughts?

Know Your Business Financial Analysis Purpose: To help familiarize you with the financial reporting of a real company in order to further your understanding of the chapter material you are learning. This case addresses the long-term assets of Columbia Sportswear. The majority of these assets consist of property and equipment and intangible assets. In the text, you learned how most long-term tangible assets used in business are capitalized and depreciated over their estimated useful lives. Further, you learned that certain intangible assets are amortized over time while others are not. In this case, you will not only see and understand the classification and presentation of these assets, but also explore the methods used by Columbia Sportswear to depreciate and amortize them. Refer to Columbia Sportswear’s financial statements in Appendix A. Also, consider the information presented in footnote 2, under the headings Property, plant, and equipment and Intangible assets and goodwill, footnote 6 titled Property, Plant, and Equipment, Net, and footnote 7 titled Intangible Assets, Net and Goodwill. Requirements 1. What was the balance of net property, plant, and equipment on December 31, 2012? What was the balance of net property, plant, and equipment on December 31, 2011? Did the amount of ending net property, plant, and equipment increase or decrease? Assume Columbia Sportswear removed $492,000 of fully depreciated assets from fixed assets in 2012. What effect did this have on the value of the net property, plant, and equipment balance? Explain your answer. 2. What methods of depreciation were used by Columbia Sportswear? What were the estimated useful lives? What kinds of intangible assets does Columbia Sportswear have? Which intangible assets are amortized by Columbia Sportswear, and which are not? Why?

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 435

03/04/14 2:05 PM

436

Chapter 8 3. What was the percentage of net property, plant, and equipment compared to the total assets on December 31, 2012? What was the percentage of net property, plant, and equipment compared to the total assets on December 31, 2011? Did the percentage increase or decrease during the year? 4. Columbia Sportswear lists “Leasehold improvements” and “Construction in progress” as part of Property, Plant, and Equipment. Although these assets are not discussed in the textbook, can you describe what these assets represent?

Industry Analysis Purpose: To help you understand and compare the performance of two companies in the same industry. Find the Columbia Sportswear Company Annual Report located in Appendix A and go to the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements starting on page 693. Now access the 2012 Annual Report for Under Armour, Inc., from the Internet. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Industry Analysis in Chapter 1. The Notes to Audited Consolidated Financial Statements start on page 53. Requirement 1. Find the section in the notes for each company where the company discusses its Property and Equipment or its Property, Plant, and Equipment. Also find the section where the company discusses Intangible Assets. Compare the two and note any major differences.

Small Business Analysis Purpose: To help you understand the importance of cash flows in the operation of a small business. You’ve made an appointment to take your year-end financial statements down to the bank. You know that your banker is usually concerned about two things, your net income and the amount of cash you have. You are a little concerned because you know that your current year net income was down a little bit from the prior year. You figure that a significant cause for the decline was due to a large equipment purchase you made early in the year, which resulted in a lot of depreciation expense. However, as you look at your balance sheet, it shows that cash increased from last year to this year. That’s a little puzzling, but you’re hoping the banker can figure it out. A couple of days later, you get a call from the banker. You’re expecting him to tell you the bank won’t be able to extend any more credit to you because your net income has declined. Imagine your surprise when he tells you how pleased he is with your financial performance this year and that he doesn’t anticipate any problems extending more credit to you. You want to know what he saw in your financial statements that you didn’t see, so you say to him, “Bob, thanks for the good news and the good report on my financial condition. Even though our cash increased this year, I was afraid that the decline in our income might cause you some concern. How come it didn’t?” Requirement 1. What kind of response do you think you might get from the banker regarding your net income as it relates to cash flow?

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 436

03/04/14 2:05 PM

Long-Term and Other Assets

437

Written Communication A client of yours notified you that she just closed a deal to purchase an existing business. It’s a pretty hefty purchase. As part of the purchase of the business, she received the land, the building, all the equipment, and the entire merchandise inventory of the company purchased. Your client e-mailed you a copy of the closing statement along with the breakdown of the purchase price shown below. In the e-mail, your client expressed concern about how to account for the $1,800,000 paid for the land and building. She also wanted to know the proper way to account for the merchandise inventory and the goodwill that was purchased.

Asset List Description

Amount

Land and Building ............................................................................................ Equipment........................................................................................................ Inventory.......................................................................................................... Goodwill........................................................................................................... Total Purchase Price ........................................................................................

$1,800,000 725,000 450,000 300,000 $3,275,000

Requirement 1. Prepare an e-mail to your client explaining how the $1,800,000 should be allocated between the land and building as well as how the merchandise inventory and goodwill should be accounted for. Self Check Answers 1. b 2. b 3. d 4. b 5. c 6. a 7. c 8. b 9. b 10. c 11. c 12. b

M08_KEMP9543_03_GE_C08.indd 437

03/04/14 2:05 PM

9 Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt Business, Accounting, and You Learning Objectives 1 Distinguish between known, estimated, and contingent liabilities

2 Account for current liabilities of a known amount

Ford has cash, accounts receivable, inventory, land, and buildings. It takes a lot of assets to operate Ford. But how does Ford purchase or fund these assets? It takes money to make money. Remember your accounting equation: Assets equal liabilities plus stockholders’ equity. The owners of Ford, the stockholders, provide money. But Ford also uses money obtained with debt, called liabilities. Liabilities are amounts owed to lenders, such as a bank, or other creditors, such as a supplier.

3 Account for liabilities of an uncertain amount

4 Account for contingent liabilities

5 Account for long-term debt 6 Report liabilities on the ­balance sheet

7 Compute the debt ratio and interest coverage ratio

8 (Appendix 9A) Account for payroll (Please visit MyAccountingLab)

438

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 438

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

439

By agreement, some liabilities need to be paid quickly. Suppliers deliver inventory to Ford with the understanding that Ford will pay the supplier within 30 to 60 days. Employees provide labor to Ford believing Ford will pay them within a few weeks. But by agreement, some liabilities are to be paid over long periods of time. Think about Ford spending millions of dollars to build a factory. If Ford borrows this money from a bank or other lender, Ford would probably want to repay that money over many years. That long period of time also means Ford will pay interest to the lender. Understanding liabilities is very important. Remember that if a business cannot pay its liabilities, it has taken too much risk and will fail. You need to know how a­ ccountants recognize, measure, record, and report liabilities. As an accountant or manager, you need to understand how and when a business borrows money and repays money.

Real World Accounting Video In the Real World Accounting video, Bill Mencer, Controller of Sheffield Pharmaceuticals, talks about borrowing money and accounting for liabilities (debt). Look at the video. Think about what Bill is saying. Think about the role of debt and the challenges in accounting for debt.

What Are the Differences Among Known, Estimated, and Contingent Liabilities? 1

Distinguish between known, estimated, and contingent liabilities

Contingent liability  A potential ­liability that depends on the outcome of a future event.

Liabilities can generally be broken down into three categories: • Known liabilities: The majority of a company’s liabilities fall into this category. Known liabilities can be defined as known obligations of known amounts. In other words, the business knows that it owes something and it knows how much it owes. Examples of known liabilities include accounts payable, notes payable, unearned ­revenues, and accrued liabilities, such as interest or taxes payable. • Estimated liabilities: An estimated liability is defined as a known obligation of an unknown amount. A business will sometimes encounter a situation where it knows that a liability exists but does not know the exact amount of the liability. In these situations, the amount of the liability must be estimated. A typical example is ­estimated warranties payable, which is common for companies like Ford and Apple. • Contingent liabilities: A contingent liability is a unique liability that differs from all other types of liabilities. A contingent liability arises because of a past event, but it is dependent upon the outcome of a future event. In other words, whether or not a company has an obligation depends upon the result of an event that has not yet occurred. In addition, the amount of a contingent liability may be either known or unknown. Current or pending litigation is an example of a contingent liability. As we learned in Chapter 4, a liability is classified as a current liability if the obligation will be settled within one year, or the operating cycle if the cycle is longer than one year. All liabilities not classified as current liabilities are classified as long-term debt. It is possible for known, estimated, and contingent liabilities to be classified as either current or long-term. We will begin our discussion of accounting for liabilities by looking at current liabilities of a known amount.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 439

03/04/14 2:31 PM

440

Chapter 9

How Do You Account for Current Liabilities of a Known Amount? 2

Account for current liabilities of a known amount

A large portion of liabilities for most companies will be made up of known liabilities that are due within one year. In the following paragraphs, we will learn how to account for the majority of the types of current liabilities of a known amount that most companies are likely to encounter.

Accounts Payable As we have learned in previous chapters, amounts owed for purchases on account are known as accounts payable. Because accounts payable are typically due in 30 to 45 days, they are classified as current liabilities. The largest portion of accounts payable for most merchandising companies is related to the purchase of inventory on account. Merchandising and service businesses also incur accounts payable when they purchase items such as supplies, electricity, or telephone service on account. Accounts payable transactions are recorded by debiting the related asset or expense account and crediting Accounts Payable. For example, assume that Mackay Industries receives a utility bill for $680. The bill represents prior electricity usage and is not due for 30 days. Mackay Industries would record the receipt of the bill as: DATE

ACCOUNTS Utilities Expense Accounts Payable Record utility bill due in 30 days.

POST REF.

DR. 680

CR. 680

When Mackay Industries pays the utility bill, it will record the payment on account as: DATE

ACCOUNTS Accounts Payable Cash Record payment on account.

POST REF.

DR. 680

CR. 680

Notes Payable When a business borrows money, usually from a financial institution, the signing of a promissory note is generally required. Businesses also often finance purchases of longterm assets through the use of notes payable. Any note payable that must be paid within one year from the balance sheet date is classified as a current liability. All notes not classified as a current liability are classified as long-term debt (discussed later in the chapter).

Classified as a Current Liability

Classified as a Long-Term Debt

Due date of note

Due date of note

Balance Sheet Date

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 440

One Year

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

441

In Chapter 7, we learned about promissory notes when we studied notes receivable. The terms and concepts we learned about then will also apply to notes payable. However, we are now learning about the promissory note transaction from the opposite perspective. To illustrate a note payable, assume that on September 1, 2014 Mackay Industries borrows $8,000 from First State Bank on a nine-month, 6% note payable. Mackay Industries would record the transaction as follows on September 1: DATE Sep 1

ACCOUNTS Cash Notes Payable Record 6%, nine-month note.

POST REF.

DR. 8,000

CR. 8,000

Assuming Mackay Industries uses a calendar year, at December 31, 2014, it is necessary for Mackay Industries to accrue interest expense for the four months from September to December (remember the matching principle). The accrued interest is recorded as: DATE ACCOUNTS Dec 31, 2014 Interest Expense Interest Payable Accrue four months’ interest expense.

POST REF.

DR. 160*

CR. 160

*$160  ($8,000  0.06  4/12)

The interest accrual at December 31, 2014, allocated $160 of the interest on this note to 2014. The remaining $200 ($8,000 * 0.06 * 5/12) of interest expense on this note will be allocated to 2015 at the time the note is paid off as follows: DATE ACCOUNTS Jun 1, 2014 Notes Payable Interest Payable Interest Expense Cash Repay 6%, nine-month note plus interest.

POST REF.

DR. 8,000 160 200

CR.

8,360

Notice that the $160 debit to Interest Payable zeros out the amount that was accrued in the liability account at December 31, 2014. The $8,000 debit to Notes Payable removes the note from Mackay Industries’ books. The $200 debit to Interest Expense records the interest expense for 2015. In addition, the $8,360 credit to Cash reflects the payment of the entire maturity value of the note. If the term of the note had not spanned the end of the accounting period, no adjusting entry to accrue interest would have been necessary. If this had been the case for Mackay Industries in the previous example, the final entry to repay the note would look like this: DATE

ACCOUNTS Notes Payable Interest Expense Cash Repay 6%, nine-month note plus interest.

POST REF.

DR. 8,000 360

CR.

8,360

Notice that Interest Expense is debited for the full amount of the interest on the note, $360. There is also no debit to Interest Payable because no interest had been accrued on the note.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 441

03/04/14 2:31 PM

442

Chapter 9

Sales Tax Payable Most states levy sales tax on retail sales. Retailers collect the sales tax from their customers in addition to the price of the item sold. The sales tax collected must then be remitted, or paid, to the state on a periodic basis, usually monthly or quarterly. Sales Tax Payable is a current liability because the retailer must pay the state in less than a year. Let’s apply this to Mackay Industries. Suppose December’s taxable sales for Mackay Industries totaled $22,000. Assume that Mackay Industries is required to collect an additional 8% sales tax, which would equal $1,760 ($22,000 * 0.08). Mackay Industries would record December sales (ignoring cost of goods sold) as: DATE

ACCOUNTS Accounts Receivable or Cash Sales Revenue Sales Tax Payable Record December sales.

POST REF.

DR. 23,760

CR. 22,000 1,760

The entry recorded when Mackay Industries remits the sales tax to the state looks like this: DATE

ACCOUNTS Sales Tax Payable Cash Remit sales tax.

POST REF.

DR. 1,760

CR. 1,760

Accrued Expenses (Accrued Liabilities) In Chapter 3, we learned that an accrued expense is any expense that has been incurred but has not yet been paid. That’s why accrued expenses are also called accrued liabilities. Most businesses will often have accrued liabilities for one or more of the following: • • • •

Interest Salaries and wages Payroll taxes Income taxes

Accrued liabilities are recorded by debiting the related expense account and crediting a liability account. For example, the entry to record $700 of accrued income tax would be: DATE

ACCOUNTS Income Tax Expense Income Tax Payable Record accrued income tax expense.

POST REF.

DR. 700

CR. 700

Unearned Revenues As we saw in Chapter 3, unearned revenues, also called deferred revenues, arise when a business receives cash in advance of providing goods or services. As a result, the business has an obligation to provide goods or services to the customer in the future. Unearned revenues are typically classified as current liabilities because customers do not usually pay for more than one year’s worth of goods or services in advance.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 442

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

443

Current Portion of Long-Term Debt Current portion of long-term debt  The principal portion of a longterm liability that is payable within one year.

Many long-term debt obligations (discussed later in this chapter) are paid in installments. The principal amount of these obligations, due within one year from the balance sheet  date, is referred to as current portion of long-term debt. Because it is due within one year from the balance sheet date, current portion of long-term debt is classified as a current liability on the balance sheet. Let’s assume that Mackay Industries signs a $30,000, 6% note payable on June 1, 2014. The note requires that annual installments of $6,000, plus interest, be paid on June 1 of each of the next five years. On Mackay Industries’ December 31, 2014, balance sheet, what amount will be reflected as current portion of long-term debt? Because the $6,000 payment that is due on June 1, 2015, is due within one year from the balance sheet date, it will be classified as current portion of long-term debt. The remaining $24,000 ($30,000  –  $6,000) will be classified as long-term.

Stop and Think… Jill and Alan work in the accounting department of a large retail business that has a significant amount of long-term debt. Jill was commenting to Alan how important it is to ensure that the current portion of the company’s long-term debt be properly classified as such on the balance sheet. Alan argued that it really doesn’t matter how the debt was classified as long as the correct total amount of debt was included somewhere on the balance sheet. Is Alan’s point of view correct?

Answer

No, Jill’s point of view is correct. In Chapter 7, we learned that the current ratio is one of the most widely used tools investors, creditors, and suppliers use to evaluate a company’s ability to pay its current obligations as they become due. So, even though a ­company includes the correct amount of total liabilities on the balance sheet, if the liabilities are not properly classified as current versus long-term, the current ratio will not be correct. As a result, investors, creditors, and suppliers will be unable to correctly assess the ability of a business to pay its current obligations as they come due. Therefore, it is very important for a business to analyze all of its long-term debt at the end of each a­ ccounting period to ensure that it is being properly classified as current versus long-term.

How Do You Account for Current Liabilities of an Uncertain Amount? 3

Account for liabilities of an uncertain amount

Warranty  A guarantee that a product or service is free from defect.

A business may know that a liability exists but not know the exact amount of the liability. It cannot simply ignore the liability. The liability must be reported on the balance sheet. Although there are other types of estimated liabilities, the most common example occurs when a company guarantees its products or services against defects under a warranty agreement. Therefore, we will focus our attention on accounting for estimated warranties.

Estimated Warranty Liability It is common for companies to provide either 90-day or one-year warranties on the goods or services they sell. The matching principle requires that warranty expense be recorded in the same period the revenue related to the warranty is recorded. The expense, therefore, is recorded when sales are made, not when warranty claims are settled. At the time of sale, the company does not know how many warranty claims will be filed. Therefore, the amount of warranty expense for a period is unknown and must be estimated. Assume that Mackay Industries makes sales of $75,000 during the month of August and that Mackay Industries extends to its customers a 90-day warranty on all products sold. Mackay Industries estimates that 2% of its products will require warranty repairs.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 443

03/04/14 2:31 PM

444

Chapter 9

The company would record sales (ignoring cost of goods sold) and warranty expense for the month of August as: DATE

ACCOUNTS Accounts Receivable or Cash Sales Revenue Record monthly sales.

POST REF.

DR. 75,000

CR. 75,000

Warranty Expense Estimated Warranty Payable Record estimated warranty expense.

1,500 1,500

Now assume that during September Mackay Industries paid $450 to settle warranty claims filed by customers. Mackay would make the following entry to record payment of the warranty claims: DATE

ACCOUNTS Estimated Warranty Payable Cash

POST REF.

DR. 450

CR. 450

Settled warranty claims.

If, instead of paying cash to settle the warranty claims, Mackay Industries had replaced the defective goods with new items, the entry would have been: DATE

ACCOUNTS Estimated Warranty Payable Inventory Settled warranty claims.

POST REF.

DR. 450

CR. 450

Estimated liabilities are generally current liabilities. However, if the estimated liability is expected to be settled more than one year from the balance sheet date, it would be classified as long-term.

How Do You Account for a Contingent Liability? 4

Account for contingent liabilities

As stated earlier, although a contingent liability arises as the result of a past event, it is dependent upon the outcome of a future event. Therefore, a contingent liability represents a potential, rather than an actual obligation. The outcome of the future event will determine whether a company will incur an obligation. Examples of contingent liabilities are: • Pending, or current, legal action • Potential fines resulting from investigations conducted by regulatory agencies, such as the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) or the Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA) • Loan guarantees that occur when one entity cosigns a note payable for another entity Suppose Mackay Industries is being sued by a former employee for wrongful termination. The lawsuit represents a contingent liability because it is the result of a past event (the termination) but is dependent upon the outcome of a future event (settlement of the lawsuit).

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 444

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

445

The accounting treatment of a contingent liability depends on the likelihood of an actual obligation occurring. Exhibit 9-1 outlines the accounting treatment of contingent liabilities.

Likelihood of Obligation Occurring

Accounting Treatment

Remote (very unlikely)

No action is necessary.

Reasonably Possible (it could occur)

Disclose the existence of the contingent liability in the financial statement footnotes. An explanation of the circumstances related to the contingent liability should be included in the footnote.

Probable (more likely than not)

If the amount of the potential obligation is known (or can be reasonably estimated), the contingent liability should be recorded. The circumstances related to the contingent liability should also be disclosed in the financial statement footnote. If the amount of the obligation is not known and cannot be reasonably estimated, then only footnote disclosure is required.

Exhibit 9-1 Let’s return to our example of the lawsuit from earlier. If Mackay Industries’ legal counsel believes the lawsuit is without merit and the chance of Mackay losing the suit is remote, no action is required. However, if instead it is determined that it is reasonably possible that Mackay Industries will lose the lawsuit, Mackay Industries should disclose the lawsuit as a contingent liability in the notes to its financial statements. Finally, if it is determined that it is probable Mackay will lose the lawsuit, the lawsuit should be disclosed in the financial statement notes. In addition, the amount that the lawsuit is expected to cost Mackay should be recorded in the accounting records if it can be reasonably estimated. The contingent liability would be recorded by debiting a loss account and crediting a liability account. Contingent liabilities are classified as current versus long-term based upon when the liability is expected to be paid.

How Do You Account for Long-Term Debt? 5

Account for long-term debt

The long-term debt of most companies is composed of the following types of obligations: • Notes payable • Bonds payable • Leases payable There are many similarities in the accounting for these different obligations. However, there are also some unique differences. Therefore, we will examine each of the three separately.

Notes Payable Mortgage  A long-term note payable that is secured by real estate. Collateral  Assets pledged to secure repayment of a loan. In the case of nonpayment by the borrower, the lender has the right to take the collateral.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 445

As discussed previously, a note payable is a debt obligation that is supported by a promissory note. Notes payable that are due to be repaid more than one year from the balance sheet date are classified as long-term debt. Most long-term notes payable represent loans taken out for the purchase of land, buildings, or both that are repaid over a long-term period. A note payable used to purchase land or buildings where the asset is used as collateral is a special type of note called a mortgage. A mortgage is an example of a s­ ecured note because it gives the lender the right to take specified assets, called collateral, if the borrower is unable to repay the loan.

03/04/14 2:31 PM

446

Chapter 9

Accounting in Your World

If you have ever borrowed money to purchase a car, then you probably know that you do not get clear title to the car until the loan has been paid off. The vehicle title represents legal ownership of the vehicle. Lenders often secure car loans by using the car as collateral for the loan and placing a lien on the title. This means that if the borrower fails to repay the loan, the lender has the right to repossess, or take back, the car to compensate it for the unpaid loan. Once the loan has been repaid, the lender will release the lien on the title. This conveys full legal ownership of the car to the borrower. The title to a vehicle is often referred to as the “pink slip.” So, if someone asks you if you have the pink slip to your car, he or she is asking if you owe any money on the car.

A mortgage is typically paid off through installment payments that include both principal and interest. The entries required to record mortgage note transactions are similar to those for note payable transactions. Let’s assume that Mackay Industries issues a $155,000, 8%, 20-year mortgage note on January 1, 2014, to finance the purchase of a new building. Payments of $7,831 on the mortgage will be made semiannually on June 30 and December 31 of each year. The purchase of the building is recorded as: DATE Jan 1

ACCOUNTS Buildings Mortgage Payable Issued mortgage to purchase building.

POST REF.

DR. 155,000

CR. 155,000

In order to keep track of the portion of each payment that is allocated to principal and to interest, an amortization schedule is usually prepared. Exhibit 9-2 illustrates an amortization schedule for the first four years of Mackay Industries’ mortgage:

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 446

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt A

Date 1/01/2014 6/30/2014 12/31/2014 6/30/2015 12/31/2015 6/30/2016 12/31/2016 6/30/2017 12/31/2017

B C Interest Principal Payment (D  0.08  1/2)* (A  B) $7,831 7,831 7,831 7,831 7,831 7,831 7,831 7,831

$6,200 6,135 6,067 5,996 5,923 5,847 5,767 5,685

$1,631 1,696 1,764 1,835 1,908 1,984 2,064 2,146

447

D Loan Balance (D  C) $155,000 153,369 151,673 149,909 148,074 146,166 144,182 142,118 139,972

*Rounded Column B is calculated by multiplying the loan balance from the prior period (column D) by the interest rate (8%) and then multiplying by 1/2 to account for the fact that the payment is made semiannually. Column C is calculated by subtracting the interest (column B) from the payment (column A). Column D is calculated by subtracting the principal portion of the payment (column C) from the loan balance from the prior period (column D).

Exhibit 9-2 Based on information found in Exhibit 9-2, Mackay Industries will record the June 30, 2014, loan payment as: DATE Jun 30

ACCOUNTS Interest Expense Mortgage Payable Cash Record semiannual loan payment.

POST REF.

DR. 6,200 1,631

CR.

7,831

As discussed previously in the chapter, the principal portion of any mortgage payments due within one year from the balance sheet date will be classified under current portion of long-term debt on the balance sheet.

Bonds Payable Bonds payable  Long-term, interest-bearing debt issued to lenders called bondholders.

Term bonds  Bonds that all mature at the same time. Serial bonds  Bonds from the same bond issuance that mature at different times. Secured bonds  Bonds that give bondholders the right to take specified assets of the issuer if the issuer fails to pay principal or interest.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 447

In addition to using notes payable to acquire needed cash, a business may obtain money by issuing bonds payable. Bonds payable are long-term, interest-bearing debt issued to lenders called bondholders. By issuing bonds, it is often possible for a business to borrow hundreds of thousands (or even millions) of dollars. Instead of depending on one large loan from a single bank or lender, with bonds, a large number of smaller amounts are borrowed, often from different investors. For example, Mackay Industries could raise $1,000,000 by borrowing $1,000 each from 1,000 different investors. Before we move on, let’s explore some of the terminology associated with bonds. • Term bonds all mature at the same specified time. For example, $500,000 of term bonds may all mature 10 years from today. With term bonds, the company issuing the bonds will have to repay all $500,000 at one time. • Serial bonds are bonds from the same bond issuance that mature at different times. For example, a $1,500,000 serial bond issuance may specify that one-third of the bonds mature in 10 years, one-third mature in 15 years, and one-third mature in 20 years. • Secured bonds are bonds that are backed with some form of collateral. Secured bonds give the bondholders the right to take specified assets of the issuer if the ­issuer fails to pay principal or interest.

03/04/14 2:31 PM

448

Chapter 9

Unsecured bonds  Bonds that are backed only by the general credit of the company issuing the bond; also called debentures. Convertible bonds  Bonds that may be converted into the common stock of the issuing company at the option of the investor. Callable bonds  Bonds that the ­issuer may call, or pay off, at a ­specified price before maturity. Principal amount  The amount a borrower must pay back to the bondholders on the maturity date; also called par value or maturity value. Maturity date  The date on which the bond issuer (the borrower) must repay the principal amount to the bondholders. Stated interest rate  Interest rate that determines the amount of cash interest the borrower pays and the investor receives each year. Market interest rate  Interest rate investors are expecting to receive for similar bonds of equal risk at the ­current time. Discount  Excess of a bond’s ­maturity value over its issue price; also called a bond discount. Premium  Excess of a bond’s issue price over its maturity value; also called bond premium.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 448

• Unsecured bonds are bonds that are not backed by any assets. They are backed only by the general credit of the company issuing the bond. Unsecured bonds are also called debentures. • Convertible bonds are bonds that give the bondholder the option of exchanging the bond for common stock in the company. • Callable bonds are bonds that may be bought back and retired (called) by the bond issuer at a pre-arranged price. • Principal amount is the amount the borrower must pay back to the bondholders on the maturity date. The principal amount is also called maturity value, or par value. • Maturity date is the date on which the borrower must repay the principal amount to the bondholders. • Stated interest rate determines the amount of cash interest the bond issuer pays each year. The stated interest rate is printed on the bond and does not change from year to year. For example, if a $1,000 bond has a stated interest rate of 9%, the bond issuer pays $90 of interest annually on the bond. • Market interest rate is the rate of interest investors are expecting to receive for similar bonds of equal risk at the current time. Bonds are often issued with a stated interest rate that differs from the market interest rate. This is due to the time gap ­between when the stated rate is determined and when the bonds are ­actually issued.

Bond Prices A bond can be issued (sold) at a price that is equal to the par value of the bond, below the par value of the bond, or above the par value of the bond. Whether a bond sells at par, below par, or above par depends on the relationship between the stated interest rate on the bond and the current market rate of interest at the time the bond is sold. Bonds sold at a price equal to par value are said to be sold “at par.” Bonds sold at a price below par are said to be sold “at a discount,” and bonds sold at a price above par are said to be sold “at a premium.” To illustrate, let’s assume that Mackay Industries issues 6% bonds when the market rate for similar bonds of equal risk is higher, say 6.5% or 7%. Mackay Industries will have a hard time attracting investors to buy its bonds when investors can earn a higher interest rate on similar bonds of other companies. Therefore, to attract investors, Mackay Industries will offer to sell its bonds at a price less than maturity value, or at a discount. So, for example, Mackay Industries may offer to sell its $1,000, 6% bonds for only $920 each. Mackay Industries will pay the investors yearly interest payments equal to $60 ($1,000 par value * 6% stated interest) on each bond. However, because the investors only paid $920 for each bond, the $60 interest payment represents a return of ­approximately 6.5% ($60 interest/$920 invested). On the other hand, if the market interest rate is 5% or 5.5%, Mackay Industries’ 6% bonds will be so attractive that investors will pay more than maturity value, or a premium, for them. So, for example, Mackay Industries may offer to sell its $1,000, 6% bonds for $1,085 each. Mackay Industries will still pay the investors yearly interest payments equal to $60 ($1,000 par value * 6% interest) on each bond. However, because the investors paid $1,085 for each bond, the $60 interest payment represents a return of a­ pproximately 5.5% ($60 interest/$1,085 invested). The actual selling price of a bond represents a price that makes the return on the bond effectively the same as the market rate of interest at the time the bond is sold. Exhibit 9-3 illustrates the relationship ­between the stated interest rate and the market interest rate and how it affects the sales price of a bond. The issue price of a bond determines the amount of cash the company receives when it issues the bond. However, the issue price of a bond does not affect the required payment at maturity. A company must always pay the maturity value (par value) of the bonds when they mature.

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

449

Relationship of Stated Interest Rate to Current Market Interest Rate

Bond Is Sold At

Why?

Stated rate  Market rate

Par

Investors are willing to pay the full maturity value for the bond because it offers the same interest rate as similar bonds with equal risk.

Stated rate  Market rate

Discount

Investors are willing to pay a lower price for the bond because they will receive a lower rate of interest from this bond than from similar bonds with equal risk.

Stated rate  Market rate

Premium

Investors are willing to pay a higher price for the bond because they will receive a higher rate of interest from this bond than from similar bonds with equal risk.

Exhibit 9-3 After bonds have been issued, investors may buy and sell them on the bond market just as they buy and sell stocks on the stock market. Bond prices are quoted as a percentage of maturity value. For example, • a $1,000 bond quoted at 100 is bought or sold for 100% of maturity value, ($1,000 * 1.00). • a $1,000 bond quoted at 96.4 has a price of $964 ($1,000 * 0.964). • a $1,000 bond quoted at 102.8 has a price of $1,028 ($1,000 * 1.028).

Issuing Bonds Payable at Par The journal entry to record the issuance of bonds payable depends on whether the bond is issued at par, at a discount, or at a premium. Let’s assume that on April 1, 2014, Mackay Industries issues $500,000 of 8% bonds payable that mature in 10 years. The bonds will pay interest semi-annually on March 31 and September 30. First, let’s ­assume that the market rate of interest on April 1, 2014, is 8%. Because the stated interest rate equals the market interest rate, Mackay Industries will issue these bonds at maturity (par) value. The journal entry to record the receipt of cash and issuance of bonds payable is:

DATE Apr 1

ACCOUNTS Cash Bonds Payable Issued bonds at par.

POST REF.

DR. 500,000

CR. 500,000

Interest payments occur on March 31 and September 30 each year. Mackay Industries’ first semiannual interest payment on September 30, 2014, is journalized as:

DATE Sep 30

ACCOUNTS Interest Expense Cash Paid semiannual interest.

POST REF.

DR. 20,000*

CR. 20,000

*$500,000 × 0.08 × 1/2

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 449

03/04/14 2:31 PM

450

Chapter 9

At maturity on March 31, 2022, after making the journal entry to record the final interest payment, Mackay Industries will record the repayment of the bonds as: DATE 2024 Mar 31

ACCOUNTS

POST REF.

DR.

CR.

500,000

Bonds Payable Cash Repaid bonds at maturity.

500,000

Now let’s look at how bonds issued at a discount are accounted for.

Issuing Bonds Payable at a Discount Suppose the market rate of interest is higher than 8% on April 1, 2014, when Mackay Industries issues the $500,000 of bonds. Remember from our previous discussion that, if the market rate of interest is higher than the stated rate of interest, bonds will sell at a discount. The calculation of the actual sales price of bonds that are not sold at par will be left to more advanced accounting courses. Therefore, for this example, we will assume that the Mackay Industries’ bonds sold for $478,000. This equals the par value of the bonds, $500,000, less a $22,000 discount. Mackay Industries makes the following journal entry to record the issuance of the bonds at a discount: DATE Apr 1

ACCOUNTS Cash Discount on Bonds Payable Bonds Payable Issued bonds at discount.

POST REF.

DR. 478,000 22,000

CR.

500,000

After posting, the bond accounts have the following balances: Bonds Payable

Discount on Bonds Payable 500,0000

Carrying amount  Bonds ­payable minus the discount or plus the premium.

22,000

Discount on Bonds Payable is a contra account to Bonds Payable and, therefore, has a debit balance. Bonds payable minus the discount gives the carrying amount of the bonds. The carrying amount of the bonds represents the “net” bond liability that is carried on the company’s books. The carrying value of Mackay Industries’ bonds immediately after issue would be:

Bonds Payable Less: Discount on Bonds Payable Carrying Value of Bonds Payable

$500,000 22,000 $478,000

Interest Expense on Bonds Payable with a Discount When Mackay Industries issued the bonds, it received $478,000, but it still must repay $500,000 when the bonds mature. The $22,000 difference between what it received and what it must pay back (the discount) ultimately represents additional interest expense to Mackay Industries. This additional interest effectively raises Mackay Industries’ true

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 450

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

451

interest rate on the bonds to the market interest rate, which was higher than the stated interest rate of 8%. The discount is allocated to interest expense through the process of amortization. The simplest way of amortizing a bond discount is by using straight-line amortization. This is very similar to the straight-line method of amortizing intangible assets, like patents, which we learned about in Chapter 8. Under straight-line amortization, an equal amount of the discount is allocated to interest expense at the time of each semiannual interest payment. In our example, the initial discount is $22,000, and there are 20 semiannual interest periods during the bonds’ 10-year life. Therefore, 1/20 of the $22,000 bond discount ($1,100) is amortized each interest period. Mackay Industries’ first semiannual interest payment is recorded as: DATE Sep 30

ACCOUNTS Interest Expense Discount on Bonds Payable Cash Paid semiannual interest and amortized bond discount.

POST REF.

DR. 21,100

CR. 1,100 20,000

The interest expense of $21,100 is the sum of • the $20,000 of stated interest, which is paid to the bondholders in cash, • plus the $1,100 amortization of the discount. Discount on Bonds Payable has a debit balance. Therefore, when the bond discount is amortized, the Discount on Bonds Payable is credited to reduce its balance. As the balance in the discount account is reduced, the carrying value of the bonds increases. At the maturity date, the discount will be reduced to zero and the carrying amount of the bonds payable will be $500,000.

Bonds Payable Less: Discount on Bonds Payable Carrying Value of Bonds Payable

$500,000 -0$500,000

At maturity, after making the journal entry to record the final interest payment, Mackay Industries will record the repayment of the bonds as: DATE 2024 Mar 31

ACCOUNTS Bonds Payable Cash Repaid bonds at maturity.

POST REF.

DR.

CR.

500,000 500,000

Notice that the entry to record the repayment of the bonds is the same as it was for bonds that were issued at par. This is because, at maturity, the carrying value of the bonds is equal to the par value of the bonds.

Issuing Bonds Payable at a Premium To illustrate a bond premium, let’s change the Mackay Industries example. Assume that the market interest rate is less than the stated rate of 8% when Mackay Industries issues its 10-year bonds. Mackay Industries’ 8% bonds are attractive when the market interest rate is less than 8%, so investors will pay a premium to acquire them. Assume the bonds are priced at 103 (103% of maturity value). In this case, Mackay Industries receives

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 451

03/04/14 2:31 PM

452

Chapter 9

$515,000 cash upon issuance. Mackay Industries’ entry to borrow money and issue these bonds is: DATE Apr 1

ACCOUNTS Cash Premium on Bonds Payable Bonds Payable Issued bonds at premium.

POST REF.

DR. 515,000

CR. 15,000 500,000

After posting, the bond accounts have the following balances: Bonds Payable

Premium on Bonds Payable 500,0000

Adjunct account  An account that is linked to another account (a companion account). An adjunct account will have a normal balance that is the same as its companion account.

15,000

Notice that Bonds Payable and Premium on Bonds Payable each have a credit balance. The Premium on Bonds Payable account is known as an adjunct account. Like a contra account, an adjunct account is a companion account to another account. However, unlike a contra account, an adjunct account serves to “add to” instead of “take away from” its companion account. Therefore, we add the Premium on Bonds Payable to Bonds Payable to determine the bonds’ carrying value. The carrying value of the Mackay Industries’ bonds immediately after issuance is:

Bonds Payable Add: Premium on Bonds Payable Carrying Value of Bonds Payable

$500,000 15,000 $515,000

Interest Expense on Bonds Payable with a Premium When Mackay Industries issued the bonds, it received $515,000 but it must pay back only $500,000 at maturity. The $15,000 difference between what it received and what it must pay back (the premium) ultimately represents a reduction of interest expense to Mackay Industries. This reduced interest effectively lowers Mackay Industries’ true interest rate on the bonds to the market interest rate that was lower than the stated interest rate of 8%. As with a discount, a premium is allocated to interest expense through the process of amortization. Only, in the case of a premium, the amortization decreases interest expense over the life of the bonds. In our example, the beginning premium is $15,000, and there are 20 semiannual interest periods during the bonds’ 10-year life. Therefore, 1/20 of the $15,000 ($750) of bond premium is amortized each interest period. Mackay Industries’ first semiannual interest entry is: DATE Sep 30

ACCOUNTS Interest Expense Premium on Bonds Payable Cash Paid semiannual interest and amortized bond premium.

POST REF.

DR. 19,250 750

CR.

20,000

The interest expense of $19,250 is • the $20,000 of stated interest which is paid to the bondholders in cash, • minus the $750 amortization of the premium.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 452

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

453

As the balance in the premium account is reduced, the carrying value of the bonds decreases. At maturity on March 31, 2022, the bond premium will have been fully amortized (it will have a zero balance), and the bond’s carrying amount will be $500,000 (the amount in the Bonds Payable account). Therefore, the entry to record the repayment of the bonds will be the same as it was when the bonds were issued at par or at a discount.

Adjusting Entries for Bonds Payable Interest payments on bonds seldom occur on December 31, so interest expense must be accrued at year-end. The accrual entry should also amortize any related bond discount or premium. Let’s return to our Mackay Industries example where Mackay Industries sold $500,000 of bonds at a discount for $478,000 on April 1, 2014. Mackay Industries made an interest payment on September 30, 2014. On December 31, 2014, Mackay Industries accrues interest and amortizes bond discount for three months (October, November, and December) as: DATE Dec 31

ACCOUNTS Interest Expense Discount on Bonds Payable Interest Payable Accrued bond interest and amortized bond discount.

POST REF.

DR. 10,550

CR. 550 10,000

The interest expense of $10,550 is the sum of • the $10,000 of stated interest for October, November, and December; • plus the $550 amortization of the discount for October, November, and December. Interest Payable is credited for the three months of interest owed to the bondholders, $10,000. The next semiannual interest payment occurs on March 31, 2015, and Mackay Industries makes the following journal entry: DATE Mar 31

ACCOUNTS Interest Expense Interest Payable Discount on Bonds Payable Cash Paid semiannual interest and amortized bond discount.

POST REF.

DR. 10,550 10,000

CR.

550 20,000

The interest expense of $10,550 is the sum of • the $10,000 of stated interest for January, February, and March; • plus the $550 amortization of the discount for January, February, and March. Interest Payable is debited for $10,000 to reflect the fact that the amount accrued at December 31, 2014, is being paid. The $20,000 credit to Cash represents the stated interest that is paid to the bondholders.

Lease Liabilities A lease is an agreement in which one party (the lessee) agrees to pay another party (the lessor) for the use of an asset. Many businesses enter into leases for • Equipment such as computers, phone systems, and manufacturing equipment. • Vehicles, such as automobiles and delivery trucks. • Real estate, such as offices or warehouses.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 453

03/04/14 2:31 PM

454

Chapter 9

Leases may be divided into two categories: operating leases and capital leases. The ­accounting treatment is different for each type of lease.1

Operating Leases Operating lease  A lease (rental) agreement that grants the use of an asset to the lessee for the duration of the lease in exchange for regular payments.

An operating lease is basically a rental agreement. An operating lease grants the use of an asset to the lessee for the duration of the lease in exchange for regular payments. At the end of the lease, the lessee must return the leased asset to the lessor. The title (ownership) of the asset remains with the lessor. The lease payments are treated as an expense by the lessee and as revenue by the lessor. For example, assume that Mackay Industries entered into a lease agreement for the use of a copy machine. The agreement was an o ­ perating lease that required monthly payments of $250 for a three-year period. Mackay Industries would make the following entry to record the monthly lease payments: DATE

ACCOUNTS Lease (or Rent) Expense Cash Record monthly lease payment.

POST REF.

DR. 250

CR. 250

At the end of the lease, Mackay Industries will return the copy machine to the lessor.

Capital Leases Capital lease  A lease agreement that is treated as a financed purchase of a long-term asset.

A capital lease is treated as a financed purchase of a long-term asset, such as equipment. In other words, it is treated as if the lessee had borrowed money to purchase the asset. If a lease meets any one of the following criteria, it is classified as a capital lease: 1. Title (ownership) of the leased asset is transferred to the lessee at the end of the lease term. 2. The lease contains a bargain purchase option. In other words, the lessee has the ­option to purchase the asset at a price significantly less than fair market value at the end of the lease term. 3. The duration of the lease is 75% or more of the estimated useful life of the leased asset. 4. The present value of the lease payments equals 90% or more of the market value of the leased asset. The concept of present value is discussed in Appendix B at the end of the book. Because a capital lease is treated as a financed purchase, the lessee will record the lease by debiting an asset account and crediting Lease Payable at the time the lease is entered into. For example, assume that Mackay Industries leases a delivery truck for a five-year period. The lease calls for monthly payments of $825 and has a bargain purchase option. Assume also that the liability under this capital lease is determined to be $38,000; the calculation of the amount due under a capital lease is left to more advanced accounting courses. Mackay Industries would record the lease as: DATE

ACCOUNTS Leased Delivery Truck Lease Payable Leased a truck under a capital lease.

POST REF.

DR. 38,000

CR. 38,000

1

As of September 2013 (during the writing of this edition of the textbook) both the FASB and the IASB were considering the adoption of new rules that would require operating leases (except short-term leases) to be a­ ccounted for as capital leases. Please check with your instructor to find out the status of these rules.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 454

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

455

Lease payments made under a capital lease agreement are similar to repayments of mortgage notes payable. The lessee allocates the lease payment between interest and principal, as demonstrated earlier in our discussion of accounting for mortgage note payments. Depreciation expense is recorded on a leased asset as it is for any other longterm asset, as described in Chapter 8. As with mortgages, the principal portion of capital lease payments due within one year from the balance sheet date will be classified as a current liability on the balance sheet.

Try It… James and Maria were discussing the concept of bond premiums and discounts. James commented that he did not understand why someone would pay more or less for a $1,000 bond than $1,000. How should Maria respond to James’s comment?

Answer

Maria should explain to James that when someone buys a $1,000 bond, he or she is buying cash flows (payments back to him or her) that include interest payments plus $1,000 paid sometime in the future. The interest payments he or she receives are based on the stated rate of interest on the bond. If the stated rate of interest is higher than the prevailing market rate of interest for a similar $1,000 bond, then he or she is buying a bond that will pay back more money than the market rate bond would. Because the bond with the higher interest rate offers a better value (more money back) than the market rate bond, he or she is willing to pay more for it than $1,000. The opposite is true if the stated interest rate on the bond is less than the market rate. The buyer will get less value from that bond than the market rate bond, so he or she is only willing to buy it if he or she can pay less than $1,000.

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guidelines

Analyze

If a business ­finances the purchase of ­assets with debt, is it ­better off ­using shortor long-term debt?

As a general rule, it is better to use current liabilities to finance current assets and long-term debt to finance long-term assets. For example, inventory is often financed with current liabilities, such as accounts payable. A long-term asset, like a building, is usually financed with long-term debt such as a mortgage or bonds payable.

A business must be reasonably sure that it will have s­ ufficient cash available to pay its debt when it comes due. Therefore, if a business believes the asset purchased will generate cash in less than one year, then it will usually use current liabilities to finance the purchase. However, if a business believes the asset purchased will generate cash over a p­ eriod of time that extends beyond one year, the company will usually use longterm liabilities to finance the purchase.

How Are Liabilities Reported on the Balance Sheet? 6

Report liabilities on the balance sheet

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 455

In Chapter 4, we learned how to prepare a classified balance sheet. Throughout this chapter, we have seen how all of a company’s liabilities are classified as either current liabilities or long-term liabilities. This classification determines where the liabilities are reported on the company’s classified balance sheet. An example of what the liabilities section of Mackay Industries’ balance sheet might look like is shown in Exhibit 9-4.

03/04/14 2:31 PM

456

Chapter 9

Mackay Industries Balance Sheet—Partial Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Payroll Taxes Payable Interest Payable Sales Tax Payable Estimated Warranty Payable Unearned Revenue Income Tax Payable Current Portion of Long-Term Debt Total Current Liabilities Long-Term Debt: Mortgage Payable Bonds Payable, Net of $20,350 Discount Lease Payable Total Long-Term Debt Total Liabilities

$

2,200 8,700 2,610 1,850 975 1,310 1,400 6,200 11,700 36,945

85,000 479,650 36,650 601,300 $638,245

Exhibit 9-4

Proper accounting for liabilities can also pose an ethical challenge. Classifying current liabilities as long-term, or vice versa, can have a big impact on a company’s current ratio. Owners and managers may also be tempted to overlook expenses and their related liabilities at the end of the accounting period in an effort to make a business look more profitable. For example, a company might neglect to accrue warranty expense and the related warranty liability. This will cause reported liabilities and total expenses to be understated. Net income will also be overstated. Contingent liabilities also pose an ethical challenge. Because contingencies are based on the outcome of a future event, they are easier to overlook. However, a contingency can turn into a real liability and can significantly change the company’s financial position. Successful people refuse to play games with their accounting. Falsification of ­financial statements can result, and has resulted, in a prison term.

Focus on Decision Making: “How Much Debt Should a Business Have?”

7

Compute the debt ratio and interest coverage ratio

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 456

A business needs assets. How does a business decide how to finance its assets? How does a business decide whether to use borrowed money called liabilities or use owners’ money called stockholders’ equity? The answer is that it depends. All money used to finance a business’s long-term operations and assets has a cost. Debt has a cost called interest. Interest is an expense. Stockholders’ money has a ­required rate of return that managers must appreciate. Although not an expense like interest, stockholders expect profits that compensate them for the use of their money over time and for the risk they accept. If stockholders do not get this profit or return, they will not provide the business with the money it needs. Without stockholders’ money, there is no business. The finance function in a business tries to keep the average cost of financing as low as possible. Debt is less expensive than stockholders’ money. Why? Because

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

457

stockholders take a lot more risk than lenders. Stockholders only get what is left over after all the expenses are paid, including interest. To keep the average cost of financing as low as possible, businesses like to use debt because of its lower cost. However, debt, if not paid, can cause a business to fail. Businesses like debt but worry about borrowing too much. So how much is too much? It depends on the predictability of a business’s profits from its operations. If a business is confident it will have the profits and cash flow to pay debt and interest payments in the future, it can use debt. If a business is uncertain about its future profits and cash flow, then it should use stockholders’ equity. Stockholders’ money is less restrictive and enables the business to be more flexible. To measure how a business is financed and whether it is financed with the correct mix of debt and stockholders’ equity, managers often use two measures. These measures are the debt ratio and the interest coverage ratio.

The Debt Ratio Debt ratio  The ratio of a company’s total liabilities (debt) to its total assets.

In Chapter 7, we learned how the current ratio is used to analyze a business’s ability to pay its current obligations as they come due. The debt ratio also uses liabilities to examine a business; however, instead of focusing on current liabilities, the debt ratio focuses on the total liabilities of an organization. The debt ratio is found by dividing the total liabilities (debt) of an organization by the total assets. The formula for the debt ratio is:

Debt Ratio 

Total Liabilities Total Assets

The debt ratio reveals the percentage of a business’s assets financed with liabilities. The remainder of the assets must be financed with stockholders’ equity. Let’s assume that Mackay Industries has assets totaling $685,000, total liabilities of $425,000, and total stockholders’ equity of $260,000. Mackay Industries’ debt ratio is:

Debt Ratio 

$425,000  0.62 $685,000

Mackay Industries’ debt ratio of 62% indicates that 62% of Mackay Industries’ assets are financed with liabilities and 38% are financed with stockholders’ equity. So how much debt should a business use? It depends on the amount and predictability of a business’s profits. To look at this issue, let’s look at a business’s interest coverage ratio.

The Interest Coverage Ratio

Earnings before interest and taxes (EBIT)  Sales less cost of goods sold and operating expenses.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 457

When a business borrows money, it invests the money in the assets of the business. This investment is made believing the profits from operations will be sufficient to repay the debt. In business, the income statement is often broken into two parts: an operating part and a financing part. Sales less cost of goods sold and operating expenses equals operating profit. Operating profit is often called earnings before interest and taxes or EBIT. EBIT less interest expense and taxes equals net income. This second part of the income statement is called the financing part of the income statement. This division of the income statement recognizes that a business acquires money, invests this money in assets, operates the business by hiring people and utilizing assets, and then uses the operating profit (EBIT) to compensate the providers of the money (lenders and stockholders). Lenders get interest and stockholders get what remains, net income.

03/04/14 2:31 PM

458

Chapter 9

THE INCOME STATEMENT

The Operating Part of the Income Statement

EBIT

The Financing Part of the Income Statement

Interest coverage ratio  EBIT ­divided by interest expense.

Sales  Cost of Goods Sold  Gross Profit  Operating Expenses  Earnings Before Interest and Taxes  Interest Expense  Taxable Income  Taxes  Net Income

The ability of a business to pay the interest on its debt is often measured with the interest coverage ratio. The interest coverage ratio is the ratio of operating profit (EBIT) divided by interest expense. The formula for the interest coverage ratio is:

Interest Coverage Ratio 

EBIT Interest Expense

Let’s look at an example. Assume Mackay Industries has interest expense of $10,000 and EBIT of $20,000. The interest coverage ratio for Mackay Industries is calculated as:

Interest Coverage Ratio 

$20,000 2 $10,000

Mackay has $2.00 of operating profit for every $1.00 in interest expense. So how much debt should a business use? The answer is found in the interest coverage ratio. Does the business generate enough operating profits (EBIT) to repay (cover) the interest? How predictable is EBIT? Can the business count on earning enough EBIT to repay the interest? If a business is unsure of its EBIT, then it will want a larger interest coverage ratio. It provides a business a bigger cushion in case EBIT is lower than expected. If a business is confident and sure of its EBIT, then it will settle for a lower interest coverage ratio.

How They Do It: A Look at Business

What are acceptable debt ratios and interest coverage ratios? The answer is “it depends on the business.” Different businesses can afford different amounts of debt. Let’s look at two businesses, Ford Motor Company and Amazon.com Inc. First, we’ll look at Ford Motor Company, the manufacturer of automobiles and trucks. It takes a lot of assets to produce and sell vehicles. Think of the large investment in facilities needed to design, test, manufacture, and distribute vehicles. Think about the stability of Ford and how it has been very profitable in good economic times and survived bad economic times. Although risky, Ford is one of the best-run automotive companies in the world. It knows how to predict its revenue, control its costs, and create value for its stakeholders, particularly its customers and stockholders. This results in a very stable and predictable operating profit (EBIT). This predictable operating profit can then be committed to paying off debt. Ford has the ability to borrow a lot of money and feel confident it will be able to repay this debt. At December 31, 2012, Ford had total

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 458

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

459

liabilities of $163,277. Liabilities that required interest payments were $99,488. Ford had a debt ratio of .92 and an interest coverage ratio of 2.7. Now let’s look at Amazon.com, the high-technology retail company. Amazon provides an Internet shopping service. Amazon is considered a leader in the ever-changing, high-risk, but very profitable technology business. Amazon is very profitable. However, it must constantly develop new and better products. It has a lot of competitors. Amazon’s future profitability is not certain. Technology is a very risky business. Because Amazon’s revenue, expenses, and operating profit are hard to predict, Amazon chooses not to borrow a lot of money from banks and other lenders. To finance its business, Amazon uses accounts payable and other short-term liabilities, plus stockholders’ equity. At December 31, 2012, Amazon had total liabilities of $24.4, but only $3,084 of that amount was debt that required interest payments. The remainder of the liabilities was predominantly shortterm such as accounts payable. At December 31, 2012, Amazon’s debt ratio was 75% and the interest coverage ratio was 7.4. Now let’s compare Ford and Amazon. Ford and Amazon are both successful companies. However Ford relies more on debt than Amazon to finance its assets and operations. The reason is Ford’s business is making and selling cars, which is different than Amazon’s business of making and selling high technology products.

Summary MyAccountingLab

1 2

Distinguish between known, estimated, and contingent liabilities Account for current liabilities of a known amount

3

Account for liabilities of an uncertain amount

4

Account for contingent liabilities

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 459

Here is what you should know after reading this chapter. The Study Plan in MyAccountingLab will help you identify what you know and where to go when you need practice.

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Liabilities consist of:

Contingent liability (p. 439)

• Known liabilities of known amounts such as accounts payable, notes payable, unearned ­revenues, and accrued liabilities.

Current portion of long-term debt (p. 443) Warranty (p. 443)

• Estimated liabilities, which are known obligations of unknown amounts such as warranties payable. • Contingent liabilities, which are the result of a past event but are dependent upon the outcome of a future event. Examples are current or pending litigation.

03/04/14 2:31 PM

460

5

Chapter 9

Account for long-term debt

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Long-term debt usually consists of notes payable, leases, and bonds payable. Bonds payable are sold at:

Adjunct account (p. 452)

• Par value, if the bond’s stated interest rate is equal to the market rate of interest.

Bonds payable (p. 447) Callable bonds (p. 448) Carrying amount (p. 450)

• A premium, if the bond’s stated interest rate is higher than the market rate of interest.

Collateral (p. 445)

• A discount, if the bond’s stated interest rate is less than the market rate of interest.

Debentures (p. 448)

Leases may be classified as either: • Operating leases, which are treated as rental agreements. • Capital leases, which are treated as a ­financed purchase of a long-term asset.

Convertible bonds (p. 448) Discount (p. 448) Market interest rate (p. 448) Maturity date (p. 448) Maturity value (p. 448) Mortgage (p. 445) Par value (p. 448) Premium (p. 448) Principal amount (p. 448) Secured bonds (p. 447) Serial bonds (p. 447) Stated interest rate (p. 448) Term bonds (p. 447) Unsecured bonds (p. 448) Capital lease (p. 454) Operating lease (p. 454)

6

Report liabilities on the balance sheet

Liabilities are reported on the balance sheet: • As current liabilities, if due within one year. Current liabilities must include the portion of any long-term debt that is due within one year. • As long-term debt if due beyond one year from the balance sheet date.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 460

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

7

8

Compute the debt ratio and interest coverage ratio

(Appendix 9A) Account for payroll (Please visit MyAccountingLab)

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Ratios often used to make decisions:

Debt ratio (p. 457)

• The debt ratio measures the percentage of a business’s assets financed with liabilities.

Earnings before interest and taxes (EBIT) (p. 457)

• The interest coverage ratio measures how many times a business could pay its interest expense with its operating profit (EBIT).

Interest coverage ratio (p. 458)

When recording entries related to payroll, companies need to account for:

Employee compensation

• The payroll expense and related liabilities. • The payroll tax expense and related liabilities.

461

FICA tax Gross pay Net pay Payroll Social Security tax Take-home pay Unemployment compensation taxes Withheld income tax

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 461

03/04/14 2:31 PM

462

Chapter 9

Accounting Practice Discussion Questions 1. Provide an example of a known liability, an estimated liability, and a contingent liability. 2. If a company with a 12/31 year-end were to borrow money in the form of a four-month note on 11/1, what accounts would be debited on 3/1 when it pays the note off? 3. What journal entry is made when unearned revenue is earned? 4. What is the difference between a current liability for an uncertain amount and a contingent liability? Give an example of each and demonstrate how they differ in respect of the difference that you identified in the first part of this question. 5. What is the distinguishing feature of the following types of bonds? a. Convertible b. Callable c. Secured d. Unsecured e. Serial f. Term 6. What do we know about the relationship between the market rate of interest and the stated interest rate for a particular bond when the bond is sold at a. par? b. a premium? c. a discount? 7. Will interest expense be greater than, less than, or equal to the interest payment made on bonds when the bonds are sold at a. par? b. a premium? c. a discount? 8. What happens to the difference between the carrying amount of bonds and the principal amount of the bonds over time? 9. What are the differences between an operating lease and a capital lease? 10. What are some ways that companies might use improper recording of liabilities to manipulate financial statements?

Self Check 1. Known liabilities of uncertain amounts should be a. ignored; record them when they are paid. b. estimated and accrued when they occur. c. described in the notes to the financial statements. d. reported on the income statement. 2. On January 1, 2014, you borrowed $15,000 on a five-year, 9% note payable. At December 31, 2014, you should record a journal entry that includes which of the following? a. Note Payable of $15,000 b. Nothing; the note has already been recorded c. Interest Payable of $1,350 d. Cash receipt of $15,000

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 462

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

463

3. Your company sells $90,000 of goods, and you collect sales tax of 8%. What current liability does the sale create? a. Sales Revenue of $97,200 b. Accounts Payable of $7,200 c. Unearned Revenue of $7,200 d. Sales Tax Payable of $7,200 4. Northern Electric owed Estimated Warranty Payable of $1,700 at the end of 2013. During 2014, Northern Electric made sales of $180,000 and expects product warranties to cost the company 3% of the sales. During 2014, Northern Electric paid $4,300 for warranties. What is Northern Electric’s Estimated Warranty Payable at the end of 2014? a. $8,000 b. $2,800 c. $7,100 d. $5,400 5. What is the term used to describe an unsecured bond? a. Mortgage bond b. Debenture bond c. Serial bond d. Callable bond 6. Which interest rate on a bond determines the amount of the semiannual interest payment? a. Effective rate b. Market rate c. Stated rate d. None of the above 7. Plavix Corporation’s bonds payable carry a stated interest rate of 7%, and the market rate of interest at the time of issuance is 8%. Plavix Corporation’s bonds will be sold at a. par value. b. a discount. c. maturity value. d. a premium. 8. Bonds issued at a premium always have a. interest expense equal to the interest payments. b. interest expense less than the interest payments. c. interest expense greater than the interest payments. d. none of the above. 9. Martin’s bonds pay interest semiannually on July 1 and January 1. If its fiscal year ends on September 30, which statement is true of Martin’s year-end adjusting journal entry for bond interest? a. Martin must record three months’ accrued interest expense and amortize three months’ discount or premium. b. Martin will record nine months’ accrued interest expense and amortize three months’ discount or premium. c. Martin will record nine months’ accrued interest expense and amortize nine months’ ­discount or premium. d. Martin must record three months’ accrued interest expense only.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 463

03/04/14 2:31 PM

464

Chapter 9 10. A company recognizes a lease as a capital lease when a. the lease transfers title of the leased asset to the lessee at the end of the lease term. b. the present value of the lease payments is less than 90% of the market value of the leased asset. c. the lease term is less than 75% of the estimated useful life of the leased asset. d. the lease has no option to purchase the asset at the end of the lease term. 11. In the Real World Accounting Video, Bill Mencer talks about being a controller. A controller is ________. a. the individual that controls the production of a product b. the individual that controls the hiring and firing of all personnel c. the individual that controls the customer experience and marketing d. the individual that is responsible for the accounting system and financial statements 12. According to the Real World Accounting Video, a working capital loan is used to finance _________. a. buildings and equipment b. intangible assets c. current assets d. tangible assets Answers are given after Written Communication.

MyAccountingLab

Short Exercises S9-1. Accounting for notes payable (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. On February 1, Moe Company borrows $200,000 by signing a 6-month, 6%, ­interest-bearing note. 1. Prepare the entry for February 1. 2. Prepare any adjusting entries necessary on June 30 assuming that financial ­statements are made semi-annually. S9-2. Accounting for notes payable (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. On April 30, 2014, Dawson, Co., borrowed $6,000 on a one-year, 9% note payable. What amounts would Dawson, Co., report for the note payable and the related interest payable on its balance sheet at July 31, 2014, and on its income statement for the year ended July 31, 2014? S9-3. Warranties (Learning Objective 3) 5–10 min. Sundaze Boats guarantees its boats for three years or 1,500 hours, whichever comes first. Past experience indicates that Sundaze can expect warranty costs will equal 4% of sales. Assume in its first year, Sundaze Boats had sales totaling $607,000, receiving cash for 35% of sales and notes receivable for the remainder. Warranty payments ­totaled $18,500 during the year. 1. Record the sales, warranty expense, and warranty payments for Sundaze Boats. Ignore cost of goods sold. 2. Post relevant portions of the journal entries to the Estimated Warranty Payable T-account. At the end of the first year, how much in estimated warranty payable does Sundaze owe its customers? 3. What amount of warranty expense will Sundaze report during its first year of o ­ perations? Does the warranty expense for the year equal the year’s cash ­payments for warranties? Which accounting principle addresses this situation?

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 464

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

465

S9-4. Commitments and contingencies (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. Phatboy Motorcycles, Inc., a motorcycle manufacturer, included the following note in its annual report: Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 9: Commitments and Contingencies The Company self-insures its product liability losses in the United States up to $1.5 million. Catastrophic coverage is maintained for individual claims in excess of $1.5 million up to $30 million. 1. Why are product liability losses considered contingent liabilities? 2. How can a contingent liability become a real liability for Phatboy Motorcycles? S9-5. Accounting for mortgages (Learning Objective 5) 10–15 min. Ling Company issued a $280,000, 4% mortgage on January 1, 2014, to purchase a building. Payments of $8,055 are made semiannually. Complete the following amortization schedule (partial) for Ling Company. Round to the nearest dollar. Date Jan 1, 2014 Jun 30, 2014 Dec 31, 2014 Jun 30, 2015 Dec 31, 2015

Payment

Interest

Principal

Loan Balance $280,000

$8,055

S9-6. Accounting for mortgages (Learning Objective 5) 5–10 min. Alby Corporation purchased a building by signing a long-term $800,000 mortgage with monthly payments of $6,200. The mortgage carries an interest rate of 9 ­percent. Prepare entries in journal form to record the purchase and the first two monthly ­payments. Round off figures to the nearest dollar. S9-7. Bond terms (Learning Objective 5) 5–10 min. Match the following terms with the correct definition. _____ 1. Bonds that all mature at the same time.

a. Convertible bonds

_____ 2. Interest rate investors are expecting to receive for similar bonds of equal risk.

b. Premium on bond

_____ 3. Unsecured bonds backed only by the good faith of the borrower.

d. Debentures

_____ 4. Amount of a bond’s issue price over its maturity value.

f. Serial bonds

_____ 5. Bonds that may be converted into the common stock of the issuing company at the option of the investor.

c. Callable bonds e. Term bonds g. Discount on bond h. Stated interest rate i. Market interest rate

_____ 6. Amount of a bond’s maturity value over its issue price. _____ 7. Interest rate that determines the amount of cash ­interest the borrower pays and the investor receives. _____ 8. Bonds in the same bond issuance that mature at ­different times. _____ 9. Bonds that the issuer may call or pay off at a ­specified price before maturity.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 465

03/04/14 2:31 PM

466

Chapter 9 S9-8. Determining the issue price for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 5–10 min. Determine whether the following bonds payable will be issued at par, at a premium, or at a discount: a. The market interest rate is 5%. Wilson, Corp., issues bonds payable with a stated rate of 6 1/2%. b. Apex, Inc., issued 6 1/2% bonds payable when the market rate was 7 1/4%. c. Huntwood Corporation issued 9% bonds when the market interest rate was 9%. d. Billings Company issued bonds payable that pay cash interest at the stated rate of 5%. At the date of issuance, the market interest rate was 6 1/4%. S9-9. Analyzing bond terms (Learning Objective 5) 10–15 min. Allison Supply, Inc. is planning to issue long-term bonds payable to borrow for a ­major expansion. For each of the following questions, identify whether the bond price involves a discount, a premium, or par value. a. The stated interest rate on the bonds is 6%, and the market interest rate is 7%. What type of price can Allison Supply, Inc., expect for the bonds? b. Allison Supply, Inc., could raise the stated interest rate on the bonds to 8% (market rate is 7%). In that case, what type of price can Allison Supply, Inc., expect for the bonds? c. At what type of bond price will Allison Supply, Inc., have total interest expense equal to the cash interest payments? d. At which type of price will Allison Supply, Inc.’s total interest expense be less than the cash interest payments? e. At which type of price will Allison Supply, Inc.’s total interest expense be greater than the cash interest payments? S9-10. Accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 15–20 min. Wilson, Corp., issued 6.5%, 10-year bonds payable with a maturity value of $30,000 on January 1, 2014. Journalize the following transactions and include an explanation for each entry. The market rate of interest equaled the stated rate at the date of issuance. a. Issuance of the bond payable at par on January 1, 2014. b. Payment of semiannual interest on July 1, 2014. c. Payment of the bonds payable at maturity; give the date. S9-11. Accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 15–20 min. Allied, Corp., issued 8%, five-year bonds payable with a maturity value of $50,000 at a price of $48,200 on January 1, 2014. Journalize the following transactions for Allied, Corp. Include an explanation for each entry. a. Issuance of the bond payable on January 1, 2014. b. Payment of semiannual interest and amortization of bond discount on July 1, 2014. Use the straight-line method to amortize the discount. S9-12. Accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 15–20 min. Allied, Corp., issued 8%, five-year bonds payable with a maturity value of $50,000 at a price of $52,420 on January 1, 2014. Journalize the following transactions for Allied, Corp. Include an explanation for each entry. a. Issuance of the bond payable on January 1, 2014. b. Payment of semiannual interest and amortization of bond premium on July 1, 2014. Use the straight-line method to amortize the premium.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 466

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

467

S9-13. Accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 15–20 min. Allied, Corp., issued 8%, five-year bonds payable with a maturity value of $50,000 at par on May 1, 2014. Assume that the fiscal year ends on December 31. Journalize the following transactions and include an explanation for each entry. Round calculations to the nearest dollar. a. Issuance of the bonds payable on May 1, 2014. b. Payment of the first semiannual interest amount on November 1, 2014. c. Accrual of interest expense on December 31, 2014. S9-14. Classification of liability accounts as current or long-term. (Learning Objective 6) 5–10 min. Identify the section of the balance sheet in which the following accounts would be located: Current Assets (CA), Long-Term Assets (LTA), Current Liabilities (CL), or ­Long-Term Liabilities (LTL).

_____ 1. Bonds Payable (due in 4 years) _____ 2. Interest Payable _____ 3. Leased Equipment _____ 4. Discount on Bonds Payable _____ 5. Accumulated Depreciation on Leased Equipment _____ 6. Lease Payable (due in four years) _____ 7. Mortgage Notes Payable (due in 10 years) S9-15. Balance sheet disclosure of long-term liabilities (Learning Objective 6) 5–10 min. Pangea Company has the following selected accounts after posting adjusting entries:

Accounts Payable............................................ Notes Payable, 3-month.................................. Accumulated Depreciation—Equipment ......... Notes Payable, 5-year, 8%.............................. Interest Expense ............................................. Interest Payable .............................................. Mortgage Payable ........................................... Sales Taxes Payable........................................

$45,000 60,000 25,000 65,000 8,000 4,000 80,000 13,000

Prepare the current liability section of Pangea Company’s balance sheet, assuming $15,000 of the mortgage is payable next year.

MyAccountingLab

Exercises (Group A) E9-16A. Sales tax payable (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Khoury Home billed its customers a total of $220,000 for the month of November. The total includes a 10% state sales tax. 1. Determine the proper amount of revenue to report for the month. 2. Prepare the general journal entry to record the revenue and related liabilities for the month.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 467

03/04/14 2:31 PM

468

Chapter 9 E9-17A. Accounting for notes payable (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. On May 15, Lacico borrowed some money on a 4-month note. The interest rate on the note was 8%. At the time the note was due the amount of interest owed was $1,200. Requirements 1. Determine the amount borrowed by Lacico. 2. Assume the amount borrowed was $54,000. What was the interest rate if the amount of interest owed was $900? 3. Prepare the entry for the initial borrowing and the repayment in point (1). E9-18A. Subscriptions (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Pugliese Publishing Company completed the following transactions during 2014:

Sep 1 Oct 15 Dec 31

Sold 36 six-month subscriptions, collecting cash of $1,800, plus sales tax of 7%. Remitted the sales tax to the state of Idaho. Made the necessary adjustment at year-end to record the amount of subscription revenue earned during the year. Requirements 1. Journalize these transactions. Explanations are not required. 2. What amounts would Pugliese Publishing Company report on the balance sheet at December 31, 2014?

Quick solution: 2. December 31, 2014 balance in Estimated Warranty Payable = $20,990

E9-19A. Warranties (Learning Objective 3) 5–10 min. The accounting records of Stevens Auto Repair showed a balance of $6,000 in Estimated Warranty Payable at December 31, 2013. In the past, Stevens’s warranty ­expense has been 9% of sales. During 2014, Stevens made sales of $311,000 on ­account and paid $13,000 to satisfy warranty claims. Requirements 1. Journalize Stevens’s sales, warranty expense, and cash payments made to satisfy ­warranty claims during 2014. Explanations are not required. Ignore cost of goods sold. 2. What balance of Estimated Warranty Payable will Stevens report on its balance sheet at December 31, 2014? What amount of warranty expense will Stevens ­report on its income statement for the year ended December 31, 2014? E9-20A. Accounting for mortgages (Learning Objective 5) 10–15 min. Clearwater, Corp., issued a $825,000, 5% mortgage on January 1, 2014, to purchase warehouses. Date Jan 1, 2014 Jun 30, 2014 Dec 31, 2014 Jun 30, 2015 Dec 31, 2015 Jun 30, 2016

Payment

Interest

Principal

Loan Balance $825,000

$26,692

1. Complete the amortization schedule for Clearwater, Corp., assuming payments are made semiannually. Round amounts to the nearest dollar. 2. Record the journal entries for (a) issuance of mortgage on January 1, 2014, and (b) the first semiannual payment on June 30, 2014.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 468

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

469

E9-21A. Accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 15–20 min. Minnie Corporation issued 3%, 20-year bonds payable with a maturity value of $590,000 on January 31. The bonds were issued at par and pay interest on January 31 and July 31. Record (a) issuance of the bonds on January 31, (b) payment of interest on July 31, and (c) accrual of interest on December 31. E9-22A. Accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 15–20 min. On January 1, Penestrie, Corp., issues 6%, 20-year bonds payable with a maturity value of $175,000. The bonds sell at 96 and pay interest on January 1 and July 1. Penestrie, Corp., amortizes any bond discount or premium by the straight-line method. Requirements 1. Record the issuance of the bonds on January 1. 2. Record the semiannual interest payment and amortization of any bond discount or premium on July 1. E9-23A. Accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 15–20 min. Lincoln, Inc., issued $540,000 of 10-year, 5% bonds payable on January 1. Lincoln, Inc., pays interest each January 1 and July 1 and amortizes any discount or premium by the straight-line method. Lincoln, Inc., can issue its bonds payable under various conditions: a. Issuance at par value b. Issuance at a price of $460,000 when the market rate was above 5% c. Issuance at a price of $600,000 when the market rate was below 5% Requirements 1. Journalize Lincoln’s issuance of the bonds and first semiannual interest payment for each situation. Explanations are not required. 2. Which condition results in the most interest expense for Lincoln, Inc.? Explain in detail. E9-24A. Classifying notes payable as current or long-term (Learning Objectives 5 & 6) 10–15 min. Associated Physicians Group borrowed $1,500,000 on July 1, 2014, by issuing a 7% long-term note payable that must be paid in three equal annual installments plus interest each July 1 for the next three years. Requirement 1. Insert the appropriate amounts to show how Associated Physicians Group would report its current and long-term liabilities.

2014 Current Liabilities: Current Portion of Long-Term Note Payable Interest Payable Long-Term Liabilities: Long-Term Note Payable

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 469

$

December 31 2015 $

2016 $

03/04/14 2:31 PM

470

Chapter 9 E9-25A. Balance sheet disclosure of liabilities (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. At December 31, 2014, Dior Drapes owes $53,000 on accounts payable, plus salaries payable of $15,000 and income tax payable of $10,000. Dior Drapes also has $230,000 of notes payable that requires payment of a $45,000 installment in 2015 and the remainder in later years. The notes payable also requires an interest payment of $6,000 on January 1, 2015. Report Dior Drapes’ liabilities on its December 31, 2014, classified balance sheet. E9-26A. Debt ratio and interest coverage ratio (Learning Objective 7) 5–10 min. Dabbani Corporation had the following balances as of December 31, 2013:

Cash.................................................................................................................... Accounts Receivable ........................................................................................... Inventories .......................................................................................................... Net Plant and Equipment..................................................................................... Total Current Liabilities ....................................................................................... Long-Term Bonds ............................................................................................... Interest Expense ................................................................................................. Earnings Before Interest and Taxes.....................................................................

$

10,000 375,000 615,000 1,000,000 310,000 754,000 88,000 440,000

Requirement 1. Calculate Dabbani Corporation’s debt ratio as of December 31, 2013. 2. Calculate Dabbani Corporation’s interest coverage ratio for 2013.

Exercises (Group B) E9-27B. Sales tax payable (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Make journal entries to record the following transactions. Explanations are not required.

May 31 Jun

6

Recorded cash sales of $630,000 for the month, plus sales tax of 7% collected for the state of Mississippi. Ignore cost of goods sold. Sent May sales tax to the state.

E9-28B. Accounting for notes payable (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Record the following note payable transactions of Conway, Corp., in the company’s journal. Explanations are not required.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 470

2014 Feb 1 Dec 31

Purchased equipment costing $55,000 by issuing a one-year, 6% note payable. Accrued interest on the note payable.

2015 Feb 1

Paid the note payable at maturity.

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

471

E9-29B. Subscriptions (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Ozark Publishing Company completed the following transactions during 2014:

Nov 1 Dec 15 31

Sold 50 six-month subscriptions, collecting cash of $2,400, plus sales tax of 4%. Remitted the sales tax to the state of Alabama. Made the necessary adjustment at year-end to record the amount of subscription revenue earned during the year. Requirements 1. Journalize these transactions. Explanations are not required. 2. What amounts would Ozark Publishing Company report on the balance sheet at December 31, 2014?

E9-30B. Warranties (Learning Objective 3) 5–10 min. The accounting records of Tim’s Auto Repair showed a balance of $1,600 in Estimated Warranty Payable at December 31, 2013. In the past, Tim’s warranty expense has been 3% of sales. During 2014, Tim’s made sales of $386,000 on account and paid $9,420 to satisfy warranty claims. Requirements 1. Journalize Tim’s sales, warranty expense, and cash payments made to satisfy warranty claims during 2014. Explanations are not required. Ignore cost of goods sold. 2. What balance of Estimated Warranty Payable will Tim’s report on its balance sheet at December 31, 2014? What amount of warranty expense will Tim’s report on its income statement for the year ended December 31, 2014? E9-31B. Accounting for mortgages (Learning Objective 5) 10–15 min. Venus, Corp., issued a $460,000, 8%, mortgage on January 1, 2014, to purchase warehouses. Date Jan 1, 2014 Jun 30, 2014 Dec 31, 2014 Jun 30, 2015 Dec 31, 2015 Jun 30, 2016

Payment

Interest

Principal

Loan Balance $460,000

$26,602

Requirements 1. Complete the amortization schedule for Venus, Corp., assuming payments are made semiannually. Round amounts to the nearest dollar. 2. Record the journal entries for (a) issuance of mortgage on January 1, 2014, and (b) the first semiannual payment on June 30, 2014. E9-32B. Accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 15–20 min. Rigby Corporation issued 6%, 15-year bonds payable with a maturity value of $850,000 on May 31. The bonds were issued at par and pay interest on May 31 and November 30. Requirements 1. Record the issuance of the bonds on May 31. 2. Record the payment of interest on November 30 and accrual of interest on December 31.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 471

03/04/14 2:31 PM

472

Chapter 9 E9-33B. Accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 15–20 min. On January 1, Doherty, Corp., issues 5%, 10-year bonds payable with a maturity value of $90,000. The bonds sell at 95 and pay interest on January 1 and July 1. Doherty, Corp., amortizes any bond discount or premium by the straight-line method. Record (a) the issuance of the bonds on January 1, and (b) the semiannual interest payment and amortization of any bond discount or premium on July 1. E9-34B. Accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 15–20 min. Peterson Machine Tool, Inc., issued $475,000 of 10-year, 7% bonds payable on January 1. Peterson Machine Tool, Inc., pays interest each January 1 and July 1 and ­amortizes any discount or premium by the straight-line method. Peterson Machine Tool, Inc., can issue its bonds payable under various conditions: a. Issuance at par value b. Issuance at a price of $460,000 when the market rate was above 7% c. Issuance at a price of $493,000 when the market rate was below 7% Requirements 1. Journalize Peterson’s issuance of the bonds and first semiannual interest payment for each situation. Explanations are not required. 2. Which condition results in the most interest expense for Peterson Machine Tool, Inc.? Explain in detail. E9-35B. Classifying notes payable as current or long-term (Learning Objectives 5 & 6) 10–15 min. Orthopedic Medical Group borrowed $2,100,000 on July 1, 2014, by issuing a 9% long-term note payable that must be paid in three equal annual installments plus ­interest each July 1 for the next three years. Requirement 1. Insert the appropriate amounts to show how Orthopedic would report its current and long-term liabilities.

2014 Current Liabilities: Current Portion of Long-Term Note Payable Interest Payable Long-Term Liabilities: Long-Term Note Payable

$

December 31 2015 $

2016 $

E9-36B. Balance sheet disclosure of liabilities (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. At December 31, 2014, Padilla Industrial owes $37,000 on accounts payable, plus salaries payable of $8,500 and income tax payable of $11,700. Padilla Industrial also has $180,000 of notes payable that requires payment of a $22,000 installment in 2015 and the remainder in later years. The notes payable also requires an interest payment of $9,000 on January 1, 2015. Report Padilla Industrial’s liabilities on its December 31, 2014, classified balance sheet.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 472

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

473

E9-37B. Debt ratio and interest coverage ratio (Learning Objective 7) 5–10 min. Sanchez Industrial Supply had the following balances as of December 31, 2014:

Total Current Assets............................................................................................ Total Long-Term Assets...................................................................................... Total Current Liabilities ....................................................................................... Total Long-Term Liabilities ................................................................................. Total Stockholders’ Equity .................................................................................. Earnings Before Interest and Taxes .................................................................... Interest Expense ................................................................................................ Income Tax Expense .......................................................................................... Net Income ........................................................................................................

$ 80,000 320,000 20,000 200,000 180,000 73,800 18,700 21,900 33,200

Requirements 1. Calculate Sanchez Industrial Supply’s debt ratio as of December 31, 2014. 2. Calculate Sanchez Industrial Supply’s interest coverage ratio for 2014. Round your answer to two decimal places.

MyAccountingLab

Problems (Group A) P9-38A. Accounting for several current liabilities (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 20–25 min. The following transactions of Dalton’s Marine Supply occurred during 2014 and 2015:

2014 Feb 3 28 Mar 7 Apr 30 Aug 3 Nov 30 Dec 31 31 2015 Feb 28 Apr 30

Purchased equipment for $26,000, signing a six-month, 5% note payable. Recorded the week’s sales of $87,000, one-third for cash, and two-thirds on account. All sales amounts are subject to a 7% sales tax. Ignore cost of goods sold. Sent last week’s sales tax to the state. Borrowed $225,000 on a four-year, 8% note payable that calls for annual payment of interest each April 30. Paid the six-month, 5% note at maturity. Purchased inventory at a cost of $7,200, signing a three-month, 6% note payable for that amount. Accrued warranty expense, which is estimated at 1.5% of total sales of $812,000. Accrued interest on all outstanding notes payable. Accrued interest for each note separately. Paid off the 6% inventory note, plus interest, at maturity. Paid the interest for one year on the long-term note payable. Requirement 1. Record the transactions in the company’s journal. Explanations are not required.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 473

03/04/14 2:31 PM

474

Chapter 9 P9-39A. Accounting for several current and long-term liabilities (Learning Objectives 2, 3, & 5) 20–25 min. Following are pertinent facts about events during the current year at Zepher Snowboards. a. December sales totaled $404,000, and Zepher collected sales tax of 7%. The sales tax will be sent to the state of Washington early in January. b. Zepher owes $80,000 on a long-term note payable. At December 31, 6% interest for the year plus $20,000 of principal are payable within one year. c. On August 31, Zepher signed a six-month, 7% note payable to purchase a machine costing $60,000. The note requires payment of principal and interest at maturity. d. Sales of $997,000 were covered by the Zepher product warranty. At January 1, ­estimated warranty payable was $11,700. During the year, Zepher recorded ­warranty expense of $27,500 and paid warranty claims of $30,300. e. On October 31, Zepher received cash of $5,232 in advance for the rent on a building. This rent will be earned evenly over six months. Requirement 1. For each item, indicate the account and the related amount to be reported as a current liability on Zepher’s December 31 balance sheet. P9-40A. Accounting for mortgages (Learning Objective 5) 20–25 min. Allez, Corp., completed the following transactions in 2014:

Jan 1 Jun 30 Dec 1 31 31

31

Purchased a building costing $315,000 and signed a 7%, 20-year mortgage note payable for the same amount. Made the first semiannual payment on the mortgage note payable. Signed a five-year lease to rent a warehouse for $4,800 per month due at the end of each month. The lease is considered an operating lease. Paid for one month’s rent on the warehouse. Leased 8 copiers and signed a four-year lease with the option to buy the copiers at the end of the fourth year at a bargain price. Under terms of the lease, monthly lease payments do not start until January 31, 2016. The present value of the lease payments is $43,500. Made the second semiannual payment on the mortgage note payable. Requirements 1. Complete the following amortization schedule for the first four mortgage payments on the $315,000 mortgage note, assuming semiannual payments of $14,751. Round amounts to the nearest dollar.

Date Jan 1, 2014 Jun 30, 2014 Dec 31, 2014 Jun 30, 2015 Dec 31, 2015

Payment

Interest

Principal

Loan Balance $315,000

$14,751

2. Record the journal entries for the 2014 transactions. 3. Prepare the long-term liabilities section of the balance sheet on December 31, 2014.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 474

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

475

P9-41A. Analyzing bond terms and accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 20–25 min. Assume that on April 1, 2014, Pacific, Corp., issues 5%, 10-year bonds payable with a maturity value of $900,000. The bonds pay interest on March 31 and September 30, and Pacific amortizes any premium or discount by the straight-line method. Pacific’s ­fiscal year-end is December 31. Requirements 1. If the market interest rate is 3.5% when Pacific, Corp., issues its bonds, will the bonds be priced at par, at a premium, or at a discount? Explain. 2. If the market interest rate is 6% when Pacific, Corp., issues its bonds, will the bonds be priced at par, at a premium, or at a discount? Explain. 3. Assume that the issue price of the bonds is $954,000. Journalize the following bonds payable transactions: a. Issuance of the bonds on April 1, 2014. b. Payment of interest and amortization of premium on September 30, 2014. c. Accrual of interest and amortization of premium on December 31, 2014. d. Payment of interest and amortization of premium on March 31, 2015. P9-42A. Analyzing bond terms and accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 20–25 min. On January 1, 2014, Sun Meadow Resorts issued $450,000 of 20-year, 8% bonds payable. The bonds were sold for $432,000. The bonds pay interest each June 30 and December 31, and any discount or premium is amortized using straight-line amortization. Requirements 1. Fill in the blanks to complete these statements: a. Sun Meadow Resorts’ bonds are priced at (express the price as a percentage) ____________. b. When Sun Meadow Resorts issued its bonds, the market interest rate was (higher than, lower than, or equal to) ____________ 8%. c. The amount of bond discount or premium is $____________. 2. Record the following transactions: a. Issuance of the bonds payable on January 1, 2014. b. Payment of interest (and amortization of discount or premium if any) on June 30, 2014. c. Payment of interest (and amortization of discount or premium if any) on December 31, 2014. Explanations are not required. 3. At what amount will Sun Meadow Resorts report the bonds on its balance sheet at December 31, 2014? Quick solution: Total current liabilities = $111,000; total long-term liabilities = $297,000

P9-43A. Balance sheet disclosure of long-term liabilities (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. The accounting records of Brown Industrial, Inc., include the following items at December 31, 2014:

Salaries Payable....................... Mortgage Notes Payable, Current Portion ................... Discount on Bonds Payable ..... Income Tax Payable .................

$15,000 25,000 8,000 9,000

Accounts Payable................... Mortgage Note Payable, Long-Term ........................ Interest Payable ..................... Bonds Payable (Due 2017) ....

$ 51,000 105,000 11,000 200,000

Requirement 1. Report these liabilities on Brown Industrial’s balance sheet at December 31, 2014, including headings.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 475

03/04/14 2:31 PM

476

Chapter 9 P9-44A. Calculation of debt ratio and interest coverage ratio (Learning Objective 7) 10–15 min. The classified balance sheet and selected income statement data for Barnett, Inc., as of December 31, 2014, are presented next.

Barnett, Inc. Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 Current Assets: Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Prepaid Rent Total Current Assets

$ 21,000 5,000 300 4,200 30,500

Fixed Assets: Land Equipment $ 62,000 Less Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment 8,000 Building Less Accumulated Depreciation, Building Total Fixed Assets Total Assets

50,000

Long-Term Debt: Mortgage Note Payable Bonds Payable Total Long-Term Debt

$

1,200 2,700 1,000 20,000 24,900

25,000 130,000 155,000

54,000

245,000 25,000

Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Unearned Service Revenue Note Payable Total Current Liabilities

220,000 324,000 $354,500

Stockholders’ Equity: Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

25,000 149,600 174,600 $354,500

Selected Income Statement Data

Gross Profit

$268,600

Operating Expenses

 147,400

Earnings Before Interest and Taxes

 121,200

Interest Expense

  14,800

Income Tax Expense

  30,300

Net Income

  76,100

Requirements 1. Calculate Barnett, Inc.’s debt ratio and interest coverage ratio as of December 31, 2014. Round to two decimal places. 2. What percentage of Barnett, Inc.’s assets belong to the stockholders? 3. Would you be willing to extend credit to Barnett, Inc.? Why or why not?

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 476

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

MyAccountingLab

477

Problems (Group B) P9-45B. Accounting for several current liabilities (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 20–25 min. The following transactions of Handy Andy’s stores occurred during 2014 and 2015:

2014 Feb 3 28 Mar 7 Apr 30 Aug 3 Nov 30 Dec 31 31 2015 Feb 28 Apr 30

Purchased equipment for $10,000, signing a six-month, 11% note payable. Recorded the week’s sales of $48,000, one-third for cash, and two-thirds on account. All sales amounts are subject to a 7% sales tax. Ignore cost of goods sold. Sent last week’s sales tax to the state. Borrowed $120,000 on a four-year, 6% note payable that calls for annual payment of interest each April 30. Paid the six-month, 11% note at maturity. Purchased inventory at a cost of $6,000, signing a three-month, 5% note payable for that amount. Accrued warranty expense, which is estimated at 6% of total sales of $580,000. Accrued interest on all outstanding notes payable. Accrued interest for each note separately. Paid off the 5% note, plus interest, at maturity. Paid the interest for one year on the long-term note payable. Requirement 1. Record the transactions in the company’s journal. Explanations are not required.

P9-46B. Accounting for several current and long-term liabilities (Learning Objectives 2, 3, & 5) 20–25 min. Following are pertinent facts about events during the current year at Snowking Snowboards. a. December sales totaled $371,000, and Snowking collected sales tax of 7%. The sales tax will be sent to the state of Montana early in January. b. Snowking owes $90,000 on a long-term note payable. At December 31, 6% interest for the year plus $25,000 of principal are payable within one year. c. On August 31, Snowking signed a six-month, 7% note payable to purchase a machine costing $126,000. The note requires payment of principal and interest at maturity. d. Sales of $1,276,000 were covered by a Snowking product warranty. At January 1, estimated warranty payable was $9,200. During the year, Snowking recorded ­warranty expense of $31,400 and paid warranty claims of $33,800. e. On October 31, Snowking received cash of $13,500 in advance for the rent on a building. This rent will be earned evenly over six months. Requirement 1. For each item, indicate the account and the related amount to be reported as a current liability on Snowking’s December 31 balance sheet.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 477

03/04/14 2:31 PM

478

Chapter 9 P9-47B. Accounting for mortgages (Learning Objective 5) 20–25 min. Paiscik, Corp., completed the following transactions in 2014:

Jan 1 Jun 30 Dec 1 31 31

31

Purchased a building costing $180,000 and signed an 11%, 30-year mortgage note payable for the same amount. Made the first semiannual payment on the mortgage note payable. Signed a five-year lease to rent a warehouse for $12,000 per month due at the end of each month. The lease is considered an operating lease. Paid for one month’s rent on the warehouse. Leased 10 copiers and signed a four-year lease with the option to buy the copiers at the end of the fourth year at a bargain price. Under terms of the lease, monthly lease payments do not start until January 31, 2016. The present value of the lease payments is $33,000. Made the second semiannual payment on the mortgage note payable. Requirements 1. Complete the following amortization schedule for the first four mortgage ­payments on the $180,000 mortgage note, assuming semiannual payments of $13,077. Round amounts to the nearest dollar.

Date Jan 1, 2014 Jun 30, 2014 Dec 31, 2014 Jun 30, 2015 Dec 31, 2015

Payment

Interest

Principal

Loan Balance $180,000

$13,077

2. Record the journal entries for the 2014 transactions. 3. Prepare the long-term liabilities section of the balance sheet on December 31, 2014. P9-48B. Analyzing bond terms and accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 20–25 min. Assume that on March 1, 2014, Simmons, Corp., issued 8%, 10-year bonds payable with maturity value of $900,000. The bonds pay interest on February 28 and August 31, and Simmons amortizes any premium or discount by the straight-line method. Simmons’ fiscal year-end is September 30. Requirements 1. If the market interest rate is 7.25% when Simmons, Corp., issues its bonds, will the bonds be priced at par, at a premium, or at a discount? Explain. 2. If the market interest rate is 9.5% when Simmons, Corp., issues its bonds, will the bonds be priced at par, at a premium, or at a discount? Explain. 3. Assume that the issue price of the bonds is $924,000. Journalize the following bonds payable transactions: a. Issuance of the bonds on March 1, 2014. b. Payment of interest and amortization of premium on August 31, 2014. c. Accrual of interest and amortization of premium on September 30, 2014. d. Payment of interest and amortization of premium on February 28, 2015.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 478

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

479

P9-49B. Analyzing bond terms and accounting for bonds (Learning Objective 5) 20–25 min. On January 1, 2014, The Meadows Golf Course issued $450,000 of 15-year, 6% bonds payable. The bonds were sold for $477,000. The bonds pay interest each June 30 and December 31, and any discount or premium is amortized using straight-line amortization. Requirements 1. Fill in the blanks to complete these statements: a. The Meadows Golf Course’s bonds are priced at (express the price as a ­percentage) ____________. b. When The Meadows Golf Course issued its bonds, the market interest rate was (higher than, lower than, or equal to) ____________ 6%. c. The amount of bond discount or premium is $ ____________. 2. Record the following transactions: a. Issuance of the bonds payable on January 1, 2014. Explanations are not required. b. Payment of interest (and amortization of discount or premium if any) on June 30, 2014. Explanations are not required. c. Payment of interest (and amortization of discount or premium if any) on December 31, 2014. Explanations are not required. 3. At what amount will The Meadows Golf Course report the bonds on its balance sheet at December 31, 2014? P9-50B. Balance sheet disclosure of long-term liabilities (Learning Objective 6) 15–20 min. The accounting records of Romero, Corp., include the following items at December 31, 2014:

Salaries Payable....................... Mortgage Note Payable, Current Portion ................... Discount on Bonds Payable ..... Income Tax Payable .................

$ 7,350 16,500 12,000 18,840

Accounts Payable................... Mortgage Note Payable, Long-Term ........................ Interest Payable ..................... Bonds Payable (Due 2017) ....

$ 23,450 126,000 9,800 235,000

Requirement 1. Report these liabilities on Romero’s balance sheet at December 31, 2014, including headings.

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 479

03/04/14 2:31 PM

480

Chapter 9 P9-51B. Calculation of debt ratio and interest coverage ratio (Learning Objective 7) 10–15 min. The classified balance sheet and selected income statement data for Quinn, Inc., as of December 31, 2014, are presented next.

Quinn, Inc. Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 ASSETS Current Assets: Cash Accounts Receivable Supplies Prepaid Rent Total Current Assets Fixed Assets: Land Equipment $ 55,000 Less: Accumulated Depreciation, Equipment 5,000 Building 220,000 Less: Accumulated Depreciation, Building 22,000 Total Fixed Assets Total Assets

$ 10,000 3,000 500 3,500 $ 17,000

60,000

LIABILITIES Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Unearned Service Revenue Note Payable Total Current Liabilities

$ 1,500 2,700 300 56,500 61,000

Long-Term Debt: Mortgage Note Payable Bonds Payable Total Long-Term Debt

25,000 148,000 173,000

50,000

198,000 308,000 $325,000

STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

30,000 61,000 91,000 $325,000

Selected Income Statement Data Gross Profit Operating Expenses

$163,400 135,600

Earnings Before Interest and Taxes

27,800

Interest Expense

18,700

Income Tax Expense

2,900

Net Income

6,200

Requirements 1. Calculate Quinn’s debt ratio and interest coverage ratio as of December 31, 2014. Round to two decimal places. 2. What percentage of Quinn’s assets belong to the stockholders? 3. Would you be willing to extend credit to Quinn, Inc.? Why or why not?

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 480

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

481

Continuing Exercise In this exercise, we will continue the accounting for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc. Assume that on October 31, 2014, Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., borrowed $12,000 from Central Bank, signing a ­nine-month, 9.5% note. The fiscal year-end is December 31. Requirement 1. Prepare the journal entries required on October 31, 2014, December 31, 2014, and July 31, 2015, to record the transactions related to the note. Round your ­answers to the nearest dollar.

Continuing Problem This continues the Aqua Magic, Inc., example from the Continuing Problem in Chapter 8. Aqua Magic, Inc., purchased some of its long-term assets during 2014 using long-term debt. The following table summarizes the nature of this long-term debt. Assume the fiscal year ends on December 31.

Date May 18

Item Note payable

Sep 1

Mortgage payable

Annual Interest Rate 6%

Amount $36,200

4% $150,000

Payment Terms Five equal annual payments of principal plus accrued interest are due on May 18 of each year. Semiannual payments of $4,315 due on March 1 and September 1 of each year.

Requirements 1. Calculate the interest expense that Aqua Magic, Inc., should accrue as of December 31, 2014. Round your answer to the nearest dollar. Use 365 days for the note payable. 2. Prepare the balance sheet presentation at December 31, 2014, for all long-term debt indicating the portion that should be classified as current and the portion that should be classified as long-term.

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem Return to Target’s 2012 annual report. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem in Chapter 2. On page 33 of the annual report, you’ll find Target’s income statement for the year ending February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Operations). On page 35, you’ll find Target’s balance sheet as of February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position). Now answer the ­following questions: 1. Look at Target’s balance sheet. What liabilities does Target owe as of February 2, 2013, and January 28, 2012? For these two years, how much of Target’s liabilities are current and how much are long-term, non-current?

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 481

03/04/14 2:31 PM

482

Chapter 9 2. Look over footnotes 17, 18, 19, 20, 22, 23, and 24 of the financial statements. These footnotes start on page 47 of the financial statements found in Target’s 2012 annual report. What are the different types of liabilities that Target owes? 3. Look at Target’s balance sheet and income statement. What are Target’s debt ratio and interest coverage ratio for the year ending February 2, 2013? What do these ratios tell you? 4. Looking back over your answers to questions 1 through 3, how do you think Target is performing? What do you think of how Target finances its assets?

Apply Your Knowledge Ethics in Action Case 1. Transco, Inc., was the largest company in the state specializing in rebuilding automobile transmissions. Every transmission rebuilt by the business was covered by a nine-month warranty. The owner, Don Adams, was meeting with his accountant to go over the yearly financial statements. In reviewing the balance sheet, Don became puzzled by the large amount of current liabilities being reported, so he asked his accountant to explain them. The accountant said that most of the current liabilities were the result of accruals, such as the estimated warranty payable, some additional wages payable, and interest accrued on the note owed to the bank. The employees were not actually paid until the first week of the new year, so some of their wages had to be recorded and properly matched against revenues in the current period. Also, several months of ­interest expense had to be accrued on a bank loan, but the largest amount of the accrued liabilities was due to the estimated warranty expense. Don asked whether the wages payable and the interest payable could be removed because they would be paid off shortly after the year ended. The accountant stated that accrued liabilities had to be properly recognized in the current accounting period, and, thus, they could not be removed. Don agreed but then asked about the large accrued liability based upon the estimated warranty amounts. Again, the accountant stated that, in previous years, the actual warranty cost had been about 4% of the total sales and, therefore, in the current year the estimate was accrued at 4%. Don then informed the accountant that a new conditioning lubricant had been added to each transmission rebuilt, which dramatically reduced the amount of rebuilt transmissions being returned under warranty. As a result, Don strongly felt that the warranty estimate should be reduced to only 3% of total sales and, thereby, the accrued warranty liability and related expense would also be reduced. The accountant argued that the only reason Don wanted to reduce the estimated percentage was to improve the financial statements, which would be unethical and inappropriate. Requirements 1. What is the impact of accrued liabilities on the financial statements? Should the accrued liabilities for wages and interest payable be removed from the balance sheet? 2. Does Don have a valid reason for wanting to reduce the estimated warranty ­liability? Are the concerns expressed by the accountant valid? 3. What ethical issues are involved? Case 2. Sherry Talbot, the CEO of Talbot Corporation, was meeting with the company controller to discuss a possible major lease of a new production facility. Talbot Corporation had a large amount of debt, and Sherry was concerned that adding more debt to acquire the production facility would worry the stockholders. Sherry knew that if the production facility could be classified as an operating lease rather than a capital lease, the lease obligation would not have to be reported on the balance sheet. Thus, the company could have a new production facility without having to report any additional debt. The accountant told Sherry that if the title to the production facility transferred automatically to Talbot at the end of the lease term, then the lease would have to be classified as a capital lease. Also, if the lease had a bargain purchase option, such that Talbot Corporation could simply purchase the facility at the end of the lease term for a small

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 482

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

483

amount, it would also be classified as a capital lease. Sherry said not to worry because she would make sure that the lease contract would not contain any title transfer or bargain purchase option. The accountant then said that the facility had a 25-year life and the lease was for 20 years, which was more than 75% of the economic life of the asset, so it would have to be classified as a capital lease. Sherry then said she would change the lease term to 18 years, so the lease term would be less than the 75% of the economic life of the facility. The accountant then computed the present value of all the lease payments, and the total was more than 90% of the market value of the facility. Again, Sherry said she would make any needed changes so that the total present value of the lease payments would be 89% of the current market value of the facility. At this point, the accountant became frustrated and told Sherry that the rules of accounting used to determine the proper classification of a lease were not meant to be used in order to misclassify a leased asset and, thereby, provide misleading information. Sherry then said the rules simply served as a guide for structuring the lease and that she was merely using the rules to allow the lease to be classified as an operating lease and, thus, the lease obligation would not have to be recorded. The accountant said that intentionally avoiding the rules was unethical and wrong. Requirements 1. Why does Sherry want to have the lease classified as an operating lease rather than a capital lease? 2. Does the accountant have a legitimate argument? Does Sherry have a legitimate argument? 3. What ethical issues are involved? 4. Do you have any other thoughts?

Know Your Business Financial Analysis Purpose: To help familiarize you with the financial reporting of a real company in order to further your understanding of the chapter material you are learning. This case focuses on the liabilities of Columbia Sportswear Company. Current liabilities are those obligations that will become due and payable within the next year or operating cycle (whichever is longer), while long-term liabilities are those that are due and payable more than one year from the balance sheet date. It is important to properly classify and report these liabilities ­because they affect liquidity. We will now consider the current and long-term liabilities of Columbia Sportswear Company. Refer to the Columbia Sportswear Company financial statements found in Appendix A. Also, consider notes 8, 9, 10, and 11 in the footnotes included in the annual report. Requirements 1. What was the balance of total current liabilities at December 31, 2012? What was the balance of total current liabilities at December 31, 2011? Did the amount of ending total current liabilities increase or decrease? What caused the biggest change in total current liabilities? 2. Look at the balance of accrued liabilities at December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011. Then look at the footnote that provides the breakdown of the total accrued liabilities. What makes up the accrued liabilities, and why would they be included in the current liability section? Which liability made up the biggest portion of the accrued liabilities? 3. Look at the financing activities section of the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows. Can you see the amount of additions to short-term and long-term debt over the past three years? Can you see the amount of reductions of short-term and long-term debt over the last three fiscal years? Does it appear that Columbia Sportswear Company is borrowing more than it repays or repaying more than it borrows?

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 483

03/04/14 2:31 PM

484

Chapter 9 4. Compare the total amount of current liabilities to the total amount of long-term liabilities at December 31, 2012. Is the amount of total current liabilities more than or less than the total long-term liabilities? What do these results mean? Is the amount of total stockholders’ equity more than or less than the total of all the liabilities at December 31, 2012? What does this result mean? 5. Examine the long-term liabilities section of the balance sheet. Can you determine what deferred income taxes are? Why does income taxes payable appear in both the current liabilities and long-term liabilities sections of the balance sheet?

Industry Analysis Purpose: To help you understand and compare the performance of two companies in the same industry. Find the Columbia Sportswear Company Annual Report located in Appendix A and go to the Consolidated Financial Statements starting on page 693. Now access the 2012 Annual Report for Under Armour, Inc., from the Internet. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Industry Analysis in Chapter 1. The company’s financial statements start on page 48. Requirement 1. Calculate the debt ratio for both companies for 2012 and 2011. Generally speaking, what does a debt ratio tell you? Specifically, what does the difference between the debt ratios for these two companies for the two years tell you?

Small Business Analysis Purpose: To help you understand the importance of cash flows in the operation of a small business. Your business has been doing pretty well since you first opened the doors five years ago. You’ve been thinking, for the past six months or so, about expanding the business. There is some property right next door that fits your expansion plans. It would take some renovations to the building, but in order to continue to grow, you know you’re going to need more room. But here’s the problem: How are you going to pay for the building and the renovations? Your cash account is in pretty good shape, but you remember the sage advice of the business consultant that helped you when you were just getting started. That advice was to always have enough available cash to cover three months’ worth of expenses just in case of some unexpected business interruption. Your available cash and short-term investments of $100,000 is right at that benchmark. Some preliminary investigation into the property next door indicates that the existing owner would probably be willing to accept $200,000 for the property. You also have a discussion with a contractor associate who tells you that the renovations to your specifications would cost about $50,000. So your dilemma is: How are you going to come up with $250,000? You figure that the best place to start is with a visit to your banker. At the meeting with the banker, he tells you: “Frank, we would be pleased to help you out with your expansion plans. We would require you to take out a mortgage on the building, and we would need a 20% down payment of the total amount up front. So the balance that we would be lending you would be 80% of the total you need, or $200,000. Your down payment amount would be $50,000. At 8% for 20 years, your monthly payments would be $1,672.88.” You are somewhat pleased with the outcome of the meeting, but you tell the banker you will get back to him in a day or two. You know that this is big step and a long-term investment for the business. Requirements 1. After thinking through the details of the plan the banker gave you, what are your thoughts? Because the down payment is going to use up about half of your available cash, how does that concern you? What about the long-term commitment of 20 years?

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 484

03/04/14 2:31 PM

Current Liabilities and Long-Term Debt

485

2. Assuming you go ahead with the mortgage and the purchase and renovation of the property, journalize the transactions to acquire the property and make the renovations. Where will the building and the renovations show up on your financial statements? Where will the mortgage show up on your financial statements? If the interest portion of your first payment is going to be $1,333.33, journalize the transaction to make your first mortgage payment.

Written Communication Your boss has just asked you to write a short note to one of his clients that had expressed some concerns about the difference between liabilities that are of an unknown amount versus contingent liabilities. The client is in the midst of a lawsuit with a governmental agency that its attorney thinks has about a 50–50 chance of winning. However, if the company loses, it could cost a substantial amount of money. The client is wondering if it needs to account for the lawsuit, and if so, how? Requirement 1. Write a note to the client explaining the difference between a liability of an ­unknown amount and a contingent liability. Also, make a suggestion as to how this particular situation might need to be accounted for. Self Check Answers 1. b 2. c 3. d 4. b 5. b 6. c 7. b 8. b 9. a 10. a 11. d 12. c

M09_KEMP9543_03_GE_C09.indd 485

03/04/14 2:31 PM

10 Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings Business, Accounting, and You Learning Objectives 1 Review the characteristics of a corporation

2 Describe the two sources of stockholders’ equity and the different classes of stock

Apple needs a lot of money to operate. It gets some of that money from lenders, such as banks. It also gets money from owners, who are called stockholders in a corporation. But why would someone want to own part of a company like Apple? Why would someone invest money in a company? The answer is that owners seek value. Owners seek net income that compensates them for the use of their money over time and for taking risks. How do Apple’s stockholders provide Apple with money? They do so in two ways. First, the stockholders of Apple can buy stock from Apple. The stockholders

3 Journalize the issuance of stock

4 Account for cash  dividends

5 Account for stock dividends and stock splits

6 Account for treasury stock

7 Report stockholders’ equity on the balance sheet

8 Evaluate return on stockholders’ equity

486

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 486

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

487

give Apple money and Apple gives the stockholders a certificate of ownership called a stock certificate. The stock certificate permits the stockholders to vote for who will manage the company. Second, Apple’s net income belongs to its stockholders. However, the business can decide to retain the net income or distribute the net ­income to stockholders. These distributions to stockholders are called dividends. If the net income is retained in the business, it can be used to grow the business, to pay off liabilities, or for other actions management feels are necessary. It’s important to understand how much money stockholders provide to a company. Every company tries to generate net income and so create value for stockholders. The investor must decide if the net income generated was worth the time and risk assumed. Remember, the objective of a business is to create value for its owners. Whether an accountant or manager, you need to know how accountants recognize, measure, record, and report stockholders’ equity.

Real World Accounting Video In the Real World Accounting Video, Howard Greenstone, President and CEO of Rosa Mexicano Restaurants, talks about operating a business. Look at the video. Think about how a business is financed. Think about the challenges accountants face in ­accounting for stockholders’ equity.

How Are Corporations Organized? 1

Review the characteristics of a corporation

Articles of incorporation  Describes the purpose, place, and other details of a corporation; also called corporate charter.

Capital stock  Represents the individual’s ownership of the ­corporation’s capital. Share  The basic unit of stock. Authorized stock  The number of shares of stock a corporation is authorized by a state to sell. Stock certificates  Certificates that provide evidence of stock ownership.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 487

As discussed in Chapter 1, a corporation is a separate legal entity from its owners. A corporation gets its legal standing from one of the 50 US states. The process of becoming a corporation is known as incorporating. To incorporate, an organization’s founders file articles of incorporation with the government of the state in which they wish to incorporate. The articles of incorporation, or corporate charter, describe the purpose, place of business, and other details of the corporation. Although a corporation may do business in multiple states, it is only incorporated in one state. Once a state gives approval to an organization to become a corporation, the organization is authorized to sell individuals an ownership interest, or stock, in the corporation. Because the stock represents an individual’s ownership of a corporation’s capital, it is also sometimes called capital stock. The basic unit of stock is a share. The number of shares of stock a company is authorized to sell is called authorized stock. Historically, a corporation would issue stock certificates to the stockholders when they buy stock. Today, many larger companies no longer issue physical stock certificates unless they are requested by the stockholders. Instead, records of stock ownership are maintained electronically. A corporation may issue a stock certificate for any number of shares. Exhibit 10-1 shows a stock certificate for 500 shares of Mackay Industries, Inc., common stock owned by Teresa Philips. The certificate shows: • Company name • Stockholder name • Number of shares owned by the stockholder

03/04/14 2:34 PM

488

Chapter 10

Company name Stockholder name

Number of shares owned by the stockholder

Exhibit 10-1

Outstanding stock  Stock in the hands of stockholders.

Stock that is held by the stockholders is said to be outstanding stock. The outstanding stock of a corporation represents 100% of its ownership. The number of outstanding shares cannot exceed the number of authorized shares and is usually less than the number of authorized shares. Corporations dominate business activity in the United States. Proprietorships and partnerships are more numerous, but corporations do much more business and are usually larger. Most well-known companies, such as General Motors and Best Buy, are corporations. Their full names include Corporation or Incorporated (abbreviated Corp. and Inc.) to show that they are corporations—for example, General Motors Corporation and Best Buy, Inc. The corporate form of organization is attractive for many reasons. Exhibit 10-2 summarizes some of the advantages and disadvantages of the corporate form of business.

Advantages •

Stockholders have limited liability because the corporation is a separate legal entity.



Corporations can raise more money than a proprietorship or partnership.



A corporation has a continuous life.



The transfer of corporate ownership is easy.

Disadvantages •

Government regulation is cumbersome and expensive.



Double taxation.

Exhibit 10-2

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 488

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

489

What Makes Up the Stockholders’ Equity of a Corporation? 2

Describe the two sources of stockholders’ equity and the different classes of stock

Recall from Chapter 1 that the stockholders’ equity of a corporation is divided into two categories: • Paid-in capital (also called contributed capital) represents amounts received from the stockholders. Common stock, discussed in Chapter 1, is the main source of p ­ aid-in capital. This is externally generated capital and results from transactions with outsiders. • Retained earnings represents capital that has been earned by profitable operations and not paid out as dividends. This is internally generated capital and results from internal corporate decisions and earnings.

Stockholders’ Rights There are four basic rights a stockholder may have: 1. Vote. Stockholders participate in management by voting on corporate matters. This is the only way in which a stockholder can help to manage the corporation. Normally, each share of common stock carries one vote. 2. Dividends. Stockholders receive a proportionate part of any dividend. Each share of stock receives an equal dividend, so, for example, a shareholder who owns 1% of the total shares in the company receives 1% of any dividend. 3. Liquidation. Stockholders receive their proportionate share of any assets remaining after the corporation pays its debts and liquidates (goes out of business). 4. Preemption. Stockholders can maintain their proportionate ownership in the corporation. Suppose you own 5% of a corporation’s stock. If the corporation issues 100,000 new shares of stock, it must offer you the opportunity to buy 5% (5,000) of the new shares. Most states require that preemptive rights be specifically set forth in the corporate charter. For most companies, preemptive rights are the exception rather than the rule.

Classes of Stock Common stock  The most typical kind of stock. It usually has voting rights, the right to receive dividends, and the right to receive assets if the company liquidates. Preferred stock  Stock that gives its owners certain advantages over common stockholders, such as the right to receive dividends before the common stockholders and the right to receive assets before the common stockholders if the corporation liquidates.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 489

Every corporation must issue common stock, which represents the basic ownership of the corporation. The real “owners” of the corporation are the common stockholders. Some companies issue Class A common stock, which carries the right to vote, and Class B common stock, which is non-voting. There must be at least one voting “class” of stock. However, there is no limit to the number or types of classes of stock that a corporation may issue. Each class of stock has a separate account. In addition to common stock, a corporation may also issue preferred stock. Preferred stock gives its owners certain advantages over the owners of common stock. Most notably, preferred stockholders receive dividends before the common stock­holders. They also receive assets before common stockholders if the corporation liquidates. Corporations pay a fixed dividend on preferred stock, which is printed on the face of the preferred stock certificate. Investors usually buy preferred stock to earn those fixed dividends. With these advantages, preferred stockholders take less investment risk than common stockholders. Owners of preferred stock may also have the four basic stockholders’ rights, unless a right is withheld. The right to vote, however, is usually withheld from preferred stock. Companies may issue different series of preferred stock (Series A and Series B, for ­example). Each series is recorded in a separate account.

03/04/14 2:34 PM

490

Chapter 10

Par Value, Stated Value, and No-Par Stock Par value  Arbitrary amount ­assigned to a share of stock.

Stated value  An arbitrary amount that is similar to par value but is assigned after a corporation is organized.

Stock may carry a par value, a stated value, or it may be no-par stock. Par value is an arbitrary amount assigned by a company to a share of its stock. The par value of Johnson & Johnson’s common stock is $1 per share. Dell, Inc., has common stock with a par value of $0.01 (1 cent) per share. Par value is arbitrary and is assigned when the organizers file the corporate charter with the state. There is no real “reason” for why par values vary. It is simply a choice made by the organizers of the corporation. A company may also issue stock that has a stated value. Stated value is an arbitrary amount similar to par value. Instead of being assigned when the corporate charter is filed, the stated value is assigned at a later date, such as when the company decides to ­issue stock. Most companies set par, or stated, value low to avoid legal difficulties that can occur if their stock is issued for a price below the par, or stated, value. It is also possible for a company to issue stock that has no par (or stated) value, known as no-par stock. In addition to its $1 par common stock, Johnson & Johnson has preferred stock with no par value. Let’s review some stock issuance examples to illustrate accounting for par, stated, and no-par stock.

Try It… John and Nancy are working on an assignment their accounting instructor gave them to do over the weekend. In the assignment, they are asked to record the issuance of 200,000 shares of $5 par value stock by a corporation for $30 per share. While working on the ­assignment, John commented to Nancy that he couldn’t believe any investor would be dumb enough to pay a company $30 for a share of stock that is only worth $5. How should Nancy respond to John’s comment?

Answer

Nancy should explain to John that the $5 par value has nothing to do with the worth of each share of stock. Par value is an arbitrary amount assigned to each share of stock by the organizers of the corporation. Arbitrary means that the amount was determined by individual preference or convenience, rather than by any underlying logic.

How Is the Issuance of Stock Recorded? 3

Journalize the issuance of stock

Underwriter  A firm, such as Morgan Stanley Smith Barney, that usually agrees to buy all the stock a company wants to issue if the firm cannot sell the stock to its clients.

Issue price  The initial selling price for a share of stock.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 490

Corporations such as IBM and Goodyear Tire need huge quantities of money to operate. They cannot finance all their operations through borrowing, so they raise capital by issuing stock. A company can sell its stock directly to stockholders, or it can use the services of an underwriter, such as the brokerage firm Morgan Stanley Smith Barney. An underwriter usually agrees to buy all the stock it cannot sell to its clients. When a company sells its stock directly to stockholders or to an underwriter, the sale occurs in what is known as the primary market. Once a company’s stock is in the hands of the stockholders, it can be traded (bought and sold) in the secondary market. It is important to note that when a company’s stock is traded in the secondary market there is no direct financial impact on the company. The price per share that the corporation receives from issuing stock is called the issue price. Usually, the issue price exceeds par value because par value is normally set quite low. In the following sections, we use Mackay Industries as an example to show how to ­account for the issuance of stock.

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

491

Issuing Common Stock Issuing Common Stock at Par Suppose Mackay Industries’ common stock carried a par value of $1 per share. The entry to record the issuance of 500,000 shares of stock at par value on January 1 would be: DATE Jan 1

ACCOUNTS Cash (500,000  $1) Common Stock Issued 500,000 shares of common stock for $1 per share.

POST REF.

DR. 500,000

CR. 500,000

Issuing Common Stock above Par

Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par  Paid-in capital that represents the amount by which the issue price of stock exceeds its par value; also called Additional Paid-in Capital.

As stated previously, most corporations set par value low and issue common stock for a price above par. Let’s assume that the 500,000 shares of Mackay Industries’ stock are issued for $15 a share on January 1. The $14 difference between the issue price ($15) and par value ($1) represents another type of paid-in capital account called Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par. It is also called Additional Paid-in Capital. Additional paid-in capital on the sale of common stock is not a gain, income, or profit for the corporation because the company is dealing with its own stock. This situation illustrates one of the fundamentals of accounting: a company can have no profit or loss when buying or selling its own stock. With a par value of $1, Mackay Industries’ entry to record the issuance of its stock at $15 per share on January 1 is: DATE Jan 1

ACCOUNTS Cash (500,000  $15) Common Stock (500,000  $1 par) Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common [500,000  ($15  $1)] Issued 500,000 shares of common stock for $15 per share.

POST REF.

DR. 7,500,000

CR. 500,000 7,000,000

The total paid-in capital should equal the amount of cash received. Altogether, it is the sum of the following:

Total Paid-in Capital  Common Stock  Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par $7,500,000



$500,000



$7,000,000

Issuing No-Par Stock When a company issues no-par stock, there can be no paid-in capital in excess of par because there isn’t any par of which to be in excess. Assume that, instead of $1 par value, Mackay Industries’ common stock was no-par. How would that change the recording of the issuance of 500,000 shares for $15 on January 1? The entry to record the issuance of 500,000 shares of no-par stock for $15 per share would be: DATE Jan 1

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 491

ACCOUNTS Cash (500,000  $15) Common Stock Issued 500,000 shares of no-par common stock for $15 per share.

POST REF.

DR. 7,500,000

CR. 7,500,000

03/04/14 2:34 PM

492

Chapter 10

With no-par stock, Cash is debited and Common Stock is credited for the cash received, regardless of the stock’s price. Notice that the total paid-in capital of $7,500,000 remains the same as when there was a par value per share:

Total Paid-in Capital  Common Stock  Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par $7,500,000



$7,500,000 

$0

Issuing No-Par Stock with a Stated Value Accounting for stock with a stated value is almost identical to accounting for par value stock. The only difference is that stock with a stated value uses an account titled Paid-in Capital in Excess of Stated Value to record amounts received above the stated value.

Issuing Stock for Assets Other than Cash A corporation may issue stock for assets other than cash. It records the assets received at their current market value and credits the stock accounts accordingly. The assets’ prior book value is irrelevant. Now, let’s reconsider the January 1 entry for Mackay Industries. Assume that, instead of cash, Mackay Industries received a building with a fair market value of $7,500,000 in exchange for the 500,000 shares of its $1 par common stock on January 1. How would the entry change? DATE Jan 1

ACCOUNTS POST REF. Building (fair market value) Common Stock (500,000  $1 par) Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common ($7,500,000  $500,000) Issued 500,000 shares of common stock in exchange for a building.

DR. 7,500,000

CR. 500,000 7,000,000

As you can see, the only change is in the asset received; the Building account is debited instead of Cash.

Issuing Preferred Stock Accounting for preferred stock is similar to the process illustrated for issuing common stock. Let’s assume that Mackay Industries decides to issue 10,000 shares of its $20 par, 10% preferred stock on February 15 for $25 per share. The entry to record the issuance would be: DATE Feb 15

ACCOUNTS Cash (10,000  $25) Preferred Stock (10,000  $20) Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Preferred [10,000  ($25  $20)] Issued 10,000 shares of preferred stock for $25 per share.

POST REF.

DR. 250,000

CR. 200,000 50,000

As with common stock, preferred stock can also be issued at par or it can be no-par stock.

How Are Cash Dividends Accounted For? 4

Account for cash dividends

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 492

As discussed in Chapter 1, a profitable corporation may distribute cash to the stockholders in the form of dividends. Dividends cause a decrease in both Assets and Stockholders’ Equity (Retained Earnings). Most states prohibit using the portion of

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

Legal capital  The portion of stockholders’ equity that cannot be used for dividends.

493

paid-in capital that is represented by the total par or stated value of stock for dividends. Accountants, therefore, use the term legal capital to refer to the portion of stockholders’ equity that cannot be used for dividends. Corporations declare cash dividends from Retained Earnings and then pay them with cash.

Dividend Dates A corporation declares a dividend before paying it. There are three dates associated with the declaration and payment of a cash dividend. 1. Declaration date. On the declaration date—say, March 5—the board of directors announces the intention to pay the dividend. The declaration of a cash dividend creates an obligation (liability) for the corporation. 2. Date of record. Those stockholders holding the stock at the end of business on the date of record—usually a week or two after declaration, say, March 19—will receive the dividend check. 3. Payment date. Payment of the dividend usually follows the record date by a week or two—say, March 31.

March 20

12 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 Payment Date

Declaration Date

Date of Record

Declaring and Paying Dividends The annual dividend rate on preferred stock is often expressed as a percentage of the preferred stock’s par value, such as 10%. But sometimes annual cash dividends on preferred stock are expressed as a flat dollar amount per share, such as $2 per share. Therefore, preferred dividends are computed two ways, depending on how the preferred stock dividend rate is expressed. Let’s look at the two ways to compute preferred dividends, using Mackay Industries’ 10,000 outstanding shares of 10%, $20 par preferred stock. (Mackay Industries’ flat rate instead of 10% could be stated as $2 per share.)

1. Outstanding shares  par value  preferred dividend rate  preferred dividend 10,000 shares  $20 par 

10%

 $20,000

OR 2. Outstanding shares 

flat dividend rate

10,000 shares

$2 per share



 preferred dividend  $20,000

Cash dividends on common stock are computed the second way because those cash dividends are not expressed as a percentage. Remember from Chapter 3 that the Dividends account is closed to Retained Earnings at the end of the year. So, instead of using the Dividends account, companies can ­record the declaration of a dividend by debiting the Retained Earnings account instead of Dividends. This practice will be used in this chapter. In this case, there will be no entry required at year-end to close the Dividends account. To account for Mackay Industries’

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 493

03/04/14 2:34 PM

494

Chapter 10

declaration of a cash dividend, we debit Retained Earnings (or Dividends) and credit Dividends Payable on the date of declaration: DATE Mar 5

ACCOUNTS Retained Earnings (or Dividends) Dividends Payable Declared a cash dividend.

POST REF.

DR. 20,000

CR. 20,000

On the date of record, no journal entry is required. On the payment date, Mackay Industries will record the payment of the dividend: DATE Mar 31

ACCOUNTS Dividends Payable Cash Paid cash dividend.

POST REF.

DR. 20,000

CR. 20,000

When a company has issued only common stock, the common stockholders will receive any dividend that is declared. However, if both preferred and common stock are issued, the preferred stockholders get their dividends first. The common stockholders receive dividends only if the total dividend declared is larger than the amount of dividends due to the preferred stockholders. In other words, the common stockholders get the leftovers. Let’s see how dividends are divided between preferred and common stockholders.

Dividing Dividends Between Preferred and Common Shareholders Assume that Mackay Industries has 500,000 shares of $1 par common stock outstanding and 10,000 shares of $20 par, 10% preferred stock outstanding at December 31, 2012. We calculated earlier that Mackay Industries’ annual preferred dividend was $20,000. So, total declared dividends must exceed $20,000 for the common stockholders to get anything. Exhibit 10-3 shows the division of dividends between preferred and common for two situations at December 31, 2012. Situation A—Total Dividend of $15,000: Preferred dividend (the full $15,000 goes to the preferred stockholders because the annual preferred dividend is $20,000) Common dividend (none because the total dividend did not cover the preferred annual dividend) Total dividend Situation B—Total Dividend of $30,000: Preferred dividend (10,000 shares  $20 par  10%) Common dividend ($30,000  $20,000) Total dividend

$15,000 0 $15,000

$20,000 10,000 $30,000

Exhibit 10-3 If Mackay Industries’ dividend is large enough to cover the preferred dividend (Situation B), the preferred stockholders get their regular dividend ($20,000) and the common stockholders get the remainder ($10,000). But if the year’s dividend falls below the annual preferred amount (Situation A), the preferred stockholders will receive the entire dividend and the common stockholders get nothing that year.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 494

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

495

Dividends on Cumulative and Noncumulative Preferred Stock Preferred stock can be either: • cumulative or • noncumulative.

Dividends in ­arrears  Cumulative, unpaid dividends on cumulative preferred stock. Cumulative preferred stock  Preferred stock whose owners must receive all dividends in arrears plus the current year dividend before the corporation pays dividends to the common stockholders.

Preferred stock is assumed to be cumulative unless it’s specifically designated as noncumulative. Most preferred stock is cumulative. Let’s see what effect the cumulative versus noncumulative designation has on the payment of dividends. As we saw with Mackay Industries in Situation A in Exhibit 10-3, a corporation may pay only part of the annual preferred dividend. This may happen if, for example, the company does not have enough cash to fund the entire dividend. This is called passing the dividend, and the dividends are called dividends in arrears. With cumulative preferred stock, shareholders must receive all dividends in arrears plus the current year dividend before the common stockholders get any dividend. The preferred stock of Mackay Industries is cumulative. How do we know this? Because it is not labeled as noncumulative. Suppose Mackay Industries passed the entire 2012 preferred dividend of $20,000. Before paying any common dividend in 2013, Mackay Industries must first pay preferred dividends of $20,000 for 2012 and $20,000 for 2013, a total of $40,000. In 2013, Mackay Industries declares a $75,000 dividend. How much of this dividend goes to preferred? How much goes to common? The allocation of this $75,000 dividend is:

Total dividend............................................................................. Preferred stockholders get: 2012 dividend (10,000  $20  10%)................................. 2013 dividend (10,000  $20  10%)................................. Total to preferred.............................................................. Common stockholders get the remainder..................................

$75,000 $20,000 20,000 40,000 $35,000

If Mackay Industries declared the $75,000 dividend on November 10, 2013, it would make the following entry: DATE Nov 10

ACCOUNTS Retained Earnings (or Dividends) Dividends Payable—Preferred Dividends Payable—Common Declared a cash dividend.

POST REF.

DR. 75,000

CR. 40,000 35,000

If the preferred stock is noncumulative, the corporation is not required to pay any unpaid dividends from prior years. Suppose Mackay Industries’ preferred stock was noncumulative and the company passed the 2012 dividend. The preferred stockholders would lose the 2012 dividend of $20,000 forever. Then, before paying any common dividends in 2013, Mackay Industries would only have to pay the 2013 preferred dividend of $20,000, which would leave $55,000 for the common stockholders. Dividends in arrears are not a liability. A liability for dividends arises only after the board of directors declares a dividend. It is possible that the board may never declare another dividend. However, a corporation does report cumulative preferred dividends in arrears in the notes to the financial statements. This shows the common stockholders how big the declared dividend will need to be for them to get any dividends in the future.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 495

03/04/14 2:34 PM

496

Chapter 10

Stop and Think… Jeffrey and Sandi were discussing cumulative preferred dividends one day after their ­accounting class. Jeffrey commented that dividends in arrears were a liability of the corporation and, as such, should appear on the company’s balance sheet. Sandi disagreed, saying that dividends in arrears are not a liability of the corporation and therefore are not reported on the company’s balance sheet. Who is correct?

Answer

Sandi is correct. When a company declares dividends, it is obliged to pay any dividends in arrears to the preferred stockholders before it can pay any dividends to common stockholders. However, the company is under no obligation to ever declare another dividend again. Until it declares a dividend, it has no obligation to pay either the preferred or common stockholders, so it does not have a liability.

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analyze

When is payment of a cash dividend appropriate?

Consider the amount of available cash, retained earnings, and the future needs of the business.

A cash dividend is a distribution of earnings to the company’s stockholders. So, a company cannot declare and distribute dividends unless the ­balance in retained earnings (counting the current year’s earnings) e­ xceeds the amount of the desired dividend. In addition, the company must have the cash available to pay the dividend if it is declared. A business should carefully analyze its future cash needs so that it does not deplete its cash with a dividend and end up with cash flow issues in the future.

How Are Stock Dividends and Stock Splits 1 Accounted For? Stock Dividends 5

Account for stock dividends and stock splits

Stock dividend  A distribution by a corporation of its own stock to stockholders.

A stock dividend is a distribution of a corporation’s own stock to its stockholders. Unlike cash dividends, with stock dividends, a company is not required to give any of its assets to the stockholders. Stock dividends: • Affect only stockholders’ equity accounts (including Retained Earnings and Common Stock). • Have no effect on total stockholders’ equity. • Have no effect on assets or liabilities.

1

The number of shares authorized to be issued is a part of the corporation’s Articles of Incorporation. When a company (by action of its Board of Directors) increases the number of shares outstanding with stock dividend or positive stock split, it must have a sufficient number of authorized shares. If the company does not have sufficient number of shares authorized, then it must go through the process of increasing the number of authorized shares by amending its Articles of Incorporation. Amending the Articles of Incorporation must be approved by a vote of the company’s shareholders. When a company does a reverse stock split, the numbers of shares decrease.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 496

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

497

A corporation distributes stock dividends to stockholders in proportion to the number of shares of stock they already own. Suppose you own 5,000 shares of Mackay Industries’ common stock. If Mackay Industries distributes a 5% stock dividend, you would receive 250 (5,000 × .05) additional shares. You would now own 5,250 shares of the stock. All other Mackay Industries’ stockholders also receive additional shares equal to 5% of the amount of stock they currently hold. Because the amount of stock every stockholder has increases by 5%, the stockholders would all own the same percentage share of Mackay Industries’ stock as they did before the stock dividend. Companies issue stock dividends for several reasons including: 1. To continue a history of declaring dividends while conserving cash. A company may wish to continue dividends to keep stockholders happy but need to keep its cash for operations. A stock dividend is a way to do so without using any cash. 2. To reduce the market price of its stock. A stock dividend will usually cause the company’s stock price to fall. This happens because, after the stock dividend, there will be more shares representing the same total amount of market value. Suppose that a share of Mackay Industries’ stock traded at $40 recently. Increasing the shares outstanding by issuing a 10% stock dividend would likely drop Mackay Industries’ stock market price to around $36 per share. The objective behind a stock dividend is to make the stock less expensive and, therefore, more available and ­attractive to investors. 3. To reward investors. Investors often feel like they’ve received something of value when they get a stock dividend.

Recording Stock Dividends As with a cash dividend, there are three dates associated with a stock dividend: • Declaration date • Date of record • Distribution date The board of directors announces the stock dividend on the declaration date. The date of record determines who will receive the additional shares. The distribution date is the date the additional shares are distributed to the stockholders. Unlike with a cash dividend, the declaration of a stock dividend does not create a liability. This is because the corporation is not obligated to distribute any assets to the stockholders; recall that a liability is a claim on assets. With a stock dividend, the corporation has simply declared its intention to distribute more of its stock. A stock dividend affects the following accounts: • Retained Earnings is reduced (or Dividends is increased) by debiting an amount equal to the number of shares being distributed times the current market price per share of the company’s stock. • Common Stock is increased (credited) by an amount equal to the number of shares being distributed times the par value per share of the company’s stock. • Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common is increased (credited) for the remainder. The net effect of a stock dividend is to transfer an amount equal to the market value of the dividend from Retained Earnings into Paid-in Capital.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 497

03/04/14 2:34 PM

498

Chapter 10

Assume that Mackay Industries has the following stockholders’ equity on June 15, prior to declaring a stock dividend:

Mackay Industries, Inc. Stockholders’ Equity June 15 Paid-in Capital: Preferred Stock, 10%, $20 par, 500,000 shares authorized, 10,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Preferred Common Stock, $1 par, 2,000,000 shares authorized, 500,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

$ 200,000 50,000 500,000 7,000,000 7,750,000 2,000,000 $9,750,000

Now, assume Mackay Industries declares and distributes a 5% common stock dividend on June 15 when the market value of Mackay Industries’ common stock is $40 per share. Although the declaration and distribution dates are normally different, we will assume they occurred on the same date for this example. Mackay would record the declaration and distribution of the stock dividend as: DATE ACCOUNTS POST REF. DR. Jun 15 Retained Earnings (or Dividends) (500,000  0.05  $40 market value) 1,000,000 Common Stock (500,000  0.05  $1 par) Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common Declared and distributed stock dividend.

CR. 25,000 975,000

As we did with cash dividends, we debited Retained Earnings directly instead of using the Dividends account. Remember that a stock dividend does not affect assets, liabilities, or total stockholders’ equity. A stock dividend merely rearranges the balances in the equity accounts, leaving total equity unchanged. Immediately after the stock dividend, Mackay Industries’ stockholders’ equity looks like this:

Mackay Industries, Inc. Stockholders’ Equity June 15 Paid-in Capital: Preferred Stock, 10%, $20 par, 500,000 shares authorized, 10,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Preferred Common Stock, $1 par, 2,000,000 shares authorized, 525,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 498

$ 200,000 50,000 525,000 7,975,000 8,750,000 1,000,000 $9,750,000

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

499

Note that the number of issued and outstanding shares is now 525,000 [500,000 + (500,000 : 0.05)]. Note also that total stockholders’ equity is still $9,750,000. The ­effect of the stock dividend was simply to transfer $1,000,000 from Retained Earnings to Paid-in Capital.

Stock Splits Stock split  An increase in the number of authorized, issued, and ­outstanding shares of stock coupled with a proportionate reduction in the par value per share of the stock.

Both a stock dividend and a stock split will increase the number of shares of stock issued and outstanding. However, a stock split is fundamentally different from a stock dividend. A stock split increases not only the number of issued and outstanding shares of stock, but also the number of authorized shares. A stock split also decreases the par value per share, whereas stock dividends do not affect the par value per share or the number of authorized shares. For example, if Mackay Industries splits its common stock 2-for-1, the number of outstanding shares is doubled and par value per share is cut in half. A stock split also decreases the market price of the stock. Assume the market price of a share of Mackay Industries common stock has been approximately $40. If Mackay Industries initiates a 2-for-1 split of its common stock on August 1, the market price per share will drop to around $20. A 2-for-1 stock split means that Mackay Industries will have twice as many shares of stock authorized, ­issued, and outstanding after the split as before. Each share’s par value is also cut in half. Exhibit 10-4 shows the before and after of how a 2-for-1 split affects Mackay Industries’ stockholders’ equity. Study the exhibit and you’ll see that a 2-for-1 stock split does the following: • Cuts par value per share in half. • Doubles the number of shares of stock authorized, issued, and outstanding. • Leaves all account balances and total equity unchanged.

Mackay Industries, Inc. Stockholders’ Equity—Before Split August 1 Paid-in Capital: Preferred Stock, 10%, $20 par, 500,000 shares authorized, 10,000 shares issued $ 200,000 and outstanding 50,000 Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Preferred Common Stock, $1 par, 2,000,000 shares authorized, 525,000 shares issued 525,000 and outstanding 7,975,000 Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common 8,750,000 Total Paid-in Capital 1,000,000 Retained Earnings $9,750,000 Total Stockholders’ Equity

Mackay Industries, Inc. Stockholders’ Equity—After Split August 1 Paid-in Capital: Preferred Stock, 10%, $20 par, 500,000 shares authorized, 10,000 shares issued $ 200,000 and outstanding 50,000 Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Preferred Common Stock, $0.50 par, 4,000,000 shares authorized, 1,050,000 shares issued 525,000 and outstanding 7,975,000 Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common 8,750,000 Total Paid-in Capital 1,000,000 Retained Earnings $9,750,000 Total Stockholders’ Equity

Exhibit 10-4

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 499

03/04/14 2:34 PM

500

Chapter 10

Accounting in Your World

Robert invited three friends over to watch a football game and share a “take-and-bake” pizza he had purchased. On game day, Robert pulled the pizza out of the oven and was just about to slice it into eight pieces (two slices for each of them) when he began to wonder if there was enough pizza. Robert had an idea. He figured that if he cut the pizza into twelve slices instead of eight slices, each person would get three slices of pizza instead of two. Robert knew that each person would still receive the same amount of pizza, but he figured that his friends would feel more satisfied if they received three slices instead of only two slices. It worked; no one complained that they did not get enough to eat. The logic behind a stock split is similar to the logic behind Robert slicing the pizza into more pieces. When a company splits its stock, each shareholder still owns the same amount of the company (think the whole pizza). However, the shareholders’ ownership is now represented by more shares of stock (think slices of pizza). For example, after a 3-for-2 stock split, each shareholder would own the same amount of the company. Each shareholder would just own three shares of stock now for every two shares he or she used to own.

Memorandum entry  A journal entry that “notes” a significant event but that has no debit or credit amount.

Because the stock split does not affect any account balances, no formal journal entry is needed to record a stock split. Instead, the split is recorded in a memorandum entry, a journal entry that “notes” a significant event but that has no debit or credit amount. Here is an example of a memorandum entry: DATE Aug 1

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 500

ACCOUNTS Split the common stock 2-for-1. OLD: 2,000,000 shares authorized; 525,000 shares issued and outstanding, $1 par NEW: 4,000,000 shares authorized; 1,050,000 shares issued and outstanding, $0.50 par

POST REF.

DR.

CR.

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

501

Stock Dividends and Stock Splits Compared Stock dividends and stock splits have some similarities and some differences. Exhibit 10-5 summarizes the effects of each on stockholders’ equity. Cash dividends have also been ­included in the exhibit for comparison purposes.

Event

Common Stock

Paid-In Capital in Excess of Par

Retained Earnings

Total Stockholders’ Equity

Cash dividend Stock dividend Stock split

No effect Increase No effect

No effect Increase No effect

Decrease Decrease No effect

Decrease No effect No effect

Exhibit 10-5

How Is Treasury Stock Accounted For? 6

Account for treasury stock

Treasury stock  A corporation’s own stock that it has issued and later reacquired.

After a company has issued stock, it is possible for that company to reacquire, or buy back, some of its stock at a later date. The reacquired shares are called treasury stock because they are, in effect, held in the company’s treasury. A corporation such as Mackay Industries may purchase treasury stock for several reasons: 1. Management hopes to buy the stock when the price is low and sell it when the price goes higher. 2. Management wants to support the company’s stock price. 3. Management wants to avoid a takeover by an outside party. If the company ­purchases the available shares, the shares are not available for others to purchase. 4. Management wants to reward valued employees with stock. Treasury stock can be given to employees as a reward. Treasury stock transactions are common among larger corporations.

Treasury Stock Basics Before we see how treasury stock is accounted for, let’s review some basic concepts related to treasury stock: • The Treasury Stock account is a contra-equity account. Therefore, Treasury Stock has a debit balance, which is the opposite of the other equity accounts. • Treasury Stock is recorded at cost (par value is ignored). • The Treasury Stock account is reported beneath Retained Earnings on the balance sheet as a reduction to total stockholders’ equity. Although shares of treasury stock are still considered to be issued shares, they ­ ecrease the company’s stock that is outstanding. This is because the shares are no lond ger held by outsiders (the stockholders). We compute outstanding stock as:

Outstanding stock  Issued stock  Treasury stock Outstanding shares are important because only outstanding shares have voting rights and receive dividends. Treasury stock doesn’t have voting rights, and it gets no dividends2. Now, let’s illustrate how to account for treasury stock, continuing with Mackay Industries. 2

In some cases, it is permissible for a company to issue stock dividends on treasury stock. In this text, stock ­dividends are assumed to be issued on outstanding shares only.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 501

03/04/14 2:34 PM

502

Chapter 10

Purchase of Treasury Stock Mackay Industries’ stockholders’ equity, after the stock split discussed earlier in the chapter, appears in Exhibit 10-6.

Mackay Industries, Inc. Stockholders’ Equity August 1 Paid-in Capital: Preferred Stock, 10%, $20 par, 500,000 shares authorized, 10,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Preferred Common Stock, $0.50 par, 4,000,000 shares authorized, 1,050,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

$ 200,000 50,000 525,000 7,975,000 8,750,000 1,000,000 $9,750,000

Exhibit 10-6 Assume that on August 10, Mackay Industries purchased 5,000 shares of the company’s issued common stock, paying $25 per share. To record the purchase, debit Treasury Stock and credit Cash: DATE Aug 10

ACCOUNTS Treasury Stock (5,000  $25) Cash Purchased 5,000 shares of treasury stock.

POST REF.

DR. 125,000

CR. 125,000

After posting the entry, the Treasury Stock account would look like this: Treasury Stock 8/10

125,000

Sale of Treasury Stock Companies buy their treasury stock hoping to sell it at a later date for more than they paid for it. However, companies may sell treasury stock at, above, or below what they paid for it.

Sale at Cost If treasury stock is sold for cost, the same price the corporation paid for it, then there is no difference between cost and sale price to journalize. Let’s assume Mackay Industries sells 500 of the treasury shares on September 5 for $25 each. The entry is: DATE Sep 5

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 502

ACCOUNTS Cash (500  $25) Treasury Stock Sold 500 shares of treasury stock.

POST REF.

DR. 12,500

CR. 12,500

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

503

After posting the entry, the Treasury Stock account would look like this: Treasury Stock 8/10

125,000 9/5

12,500

Sale Above Cost If treasury stock is sold for more than cost, the difference is credited to a new account, Paid-in Capital, Treasury Stock. This excess is additional paid-in capital because it came from the company’s stockholders. It has no effect on net income. Suppose Mackay Industries resold 500 of its treasury shares for $28 per share on October 2. (Recall that cost was $25.) The entry to sell treasury stock for a price above cost is: DATE Oct 2

ACCOUNTS Cash (500  $28) Treasury Stock (500  $25) Paid-in Capital, Treasury Stock (difference) Sold 500 shares of treasury stock.

POST REF.

DR. 14,000

CR. 12,500 1,500

Paid-in Capital, Treasury Stock is reported with the other paid-in capital accounts on the balance sheet, beneath Common Stock and Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par. After posting the entry, the Treasury Stock and Paid-in Capital, Treasury Stock accounts would look like this: Treasury Stock 8/10

125,000 9/5 10/2

Paid-in Capital, Treasury Stock 12,500 0 0 12,500

10/2

1,500

Sale Below Cost The resale price of treasury stock can be less than cost. The shortfall is debited first to  Paid-in Capital, Treasury Stock. If this account’s balance is too small, then Retained  Earnings is debited for the remaining amount. To illustrate, let’s assume Mackay Industries had two additional treasury stock sales. First, on October 28, Mackay Industries sold 1,000 treasury shares for $24 each. The entry to record the sale is: DATE Oct 28

ACCOUNTS Cash (1,000  $24) Paid-in Capital, Treasury Stock (difference) Treasury Stock (1,000  $25) Sold 1,000 shares of treasury stock.

POST REF.

DR. 24,000 1,000

CR.

25,000

The total difference between the cost and the selling price of the treasury shares is $1,000. Mackay Industries had sufficient paid-in capital from treasury stock transactions on the books from the October 2nd sale to absorb this $1,000 difference.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 503

03/04/14 2:34 PM

504

Chapter 10

Now what happens if Mackay Industries sells an additional 1,500 treasury shares for $22 each on November 1? DATE Nov 1

ACCOUNTS Cash (1,500  $22) Paid-in Capital, Treasury Stock ($1,500  $1,000) Retained Earnings Treasury Stock (1,500  $25) Sold 1,500 shares of treasury stock.

POST REF.

DR. 33,000 500 4,000

CR.

37,500

The difference between the cost and the selling price of the treasury stock is $4,500 [($25 cost per share minus $22 sales price per share) × 1,500 shares]. Only $500 remains in the Paid-in Capital, Treasury Stock account, so Mackay debits this account for $500. The remaining $4,000 ($4,500 – $500) is debited to Retained Earnings. So, what’s left in stockholders’ equity for Mackay Industries after the treasury stock transactions? First, let’s post the treasury stock activity to the affected accounts: Treasury Stock 8/10

Bal

125,000 9/5 10/2 10/28 11/1 37,500

Paid-in Capital, Treasury Stockk 12,500 0 0 12,500 0 25,000 37,500 0

10/28 11/1

1,000 500

10/2 Bal

1,500

Retained Earnings 11/1

4,000 8/1 Bal

1,000,000 996,000

-0-

Now, we can show the revised stockholders’ equity for Mackay Industries in Exhibit 10-7:

Mackay Industries, Inc. Stockholders’ Equity November 1 Paid-in Capital: Preferred Stock, 10%, $20 par, 500,000 shares authorized, 10,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Preferred Common Stock, $0.50 par, 4,000,000 shares authorized, 1,050,000 shares issued, 1,048,500 shares outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Subtotal Less: Treasury Stock at cost (1,500 shares @ $25) Total Stockholders’ Equity

$ 200,000 50,000 525,000 7,975,000 8,750,000 996,000 9,746,000 37,500 $9,708,500

Exhibit 10-7

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 504

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

505

How Is Stockholders’ Equity Reported on the Balance Sheet? 7

Report stockholders’ equity on the balance sheet

Companies often report their stockholders’ equity on the balance sheet in ways that differ from the examples we have shown in this chapter. In most cases, the information is less detailed because it is assumed that investors understand the details. Two common differences are: 1. The heading Paid-in Capital does not usually appear. It is commonly understood that Preferred Stock, Common Stock, and Additional Paid-in Capital are elements of paid-in capital. 2. All additional paid-in capital accounts are often combined and reported as a single amount labeled Additional Paid-in Capital. The Additional Paid-in Capital is most often reported following Common Stock. Also, many companies often report a separate statement of stockholders’ equity in addition to the regular financial statements. This statement is used to show investors the significant changes in all of the equity categories that occurred during the year. An e­ xample of a statement of stockholders’ equity is presented in Exhibit 10-8. Example Company Statement of Stockholders’ Equity Year Ended December 31, 2014

Balance, December 31, 2013 Issuance of Stock Net Income Cash Dividends Stock Dividends Purchase of Treasury Stock Sale of Treasury Stock Balance, December 31, 2014

Additional Common Stock Paid-in Capital $190,000 $120,000 90,000 20,000

13,000

28,000

$153,000

10,000 $318,000

Retained Earnings $160,000

Treasury Stock $(25,000)

66,000 (40,000) (41,000)

$145,000

(18,000) 9,000 $(34,000)

Total $445,000 110,000 66,000 (40,000) 0 (18,000) 19,000 $582,000

Exhibit 10-8 If a company has preferred stock, the statement would also include a column for Preferred Stock. Many companies will also have a column titled “Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income,” which reflects changes in stockholders’ equity from things such as unrealized gains on available-for-sale securities (which were discussed in Chapter 8).

Focus on Decision Making “What’s in It for the Stockholders?”

8

Evaluate return on stockholders’ equity

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 505

Why would stockholders put, or invest, money in a business? The answer is that they seek value. They seek value from profits. They seek profits that reward them for letting a business use their money over time and for taking risks. So how does an owner or manager determine whether profits are adequate to ­reward stockholders? People start with return on equity.

03/04/14 2:34 PM

506

Chapter 10

Return on Equity (ROE)

Return on equity (ROE) is the ratio of net income divided by average stockholders’ equity. The formula for computing return on equity is:

Return on Equity 

Return on equity (ROE)  Net income divided by average ­stockholders’ equity. It is a measure of profitability; also called rate of ­return on stockholders’ equity.

Net Income Net Income  Average Stockholders’ Equity ((Beginning Stockholders’ Equity  Ending Stockholders’ Equity)/2) Let’s look at an example. Mackay Industries had net income of $136,000, beginning stockholders’ equity of $825,000, and ending stockholders’ equity of $943,000. Mackay Industries’ return on stockholders’ equity is computed as:

Return on Equity 

$136,000 $136,000   15.38% (($825,000  $943,000)/2) $884,000

For every dollar, on average, stockholders provided Mackay Industries, the company earned its stockholders net income of a little over $0.15.

How They Do It: A Look at Business

What is a good ROE? It depends on the risk associated with a company. A higher-risk company should have a higher ROE than a company with lower risk. Let’s look at two businesses, Apple, Inc., and Dominion Resources, Inc. First let’s look at Apple, the groundbreaking technology company. Apple creates and sells a wide range of best-selling products, including iPads, iPhones and computers. Apple is considered a leader in the ever-changing, high-risk, but very profitable technology business. For the fiscal year ending September 29, 2012, Apple’s return on equity was 42.9%. Secondly, let’s look at Dominion Resources, the large utility company that sells electricity and natural gas in the mid-Atlantic area of the United States. Dominion Resources is a very successful power company. Its sales, costs, profits, and cash flow are very stable and predictable. All businesses have risks, but Dominion Resources is a very well-run company that is considered to be a low-risk business. For the fiscal year ending December 31, 2012, Dominion’s return on equity was 2.7%. Now let’s compare Apple and Dominion Resources. As expected, Apple’s ROE was higher than Dominion Resources’ ROE. Apple’s higher ROE can be attributed to a higher level of earnings relative to the amount of stockholders’ equity, when compared to Dominion Resources. Because Apple has a higher level of risk than Dominion Resources, Apple’s higher ROE compensates stockholders for the additional risk assumed.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 506

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

507

Summary MyAccountingLab

1 Review the characteristics of a corporation

2

3

Describe the two sources of stockholders’ equity and the different classes of stock Journalize the issuance of stock

Here is what you should know after reading this chapter. MyAccountingLab will help you identify what you know and where to go when you need practice.

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Corporations can raise money by selling:

Additional Paid-in Capital (p. 491)

• Common stock, which comes with voting rights.

Articles of incorporation (p. 487)

• Preferred stock, which typically does not come with voting rights but which provides preferential treatment regarding dividends and asset distribution upon liquidation.

Authorized stock (p. 487) Capital stock (p. 487) Common stock (p. 489) Corporate charter (p. 487) Issue price (p. 490) Outstanding stock (p. 488) Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par (p. 491) Par value (p. 490) Preferred stock (p. 489) Share (p. 487) Stated value (p. 490) Stock certificates (p. 487) Underwriter (p. 490)

4

Account for cash dividends

Cash dividends:

Cumulative preferred stock (p. 495)

• Represent a return of earnings to the stockholders. • Decrease a company’s cash and its retained earnings. Preferred dividends may be:

Dividends in arrears (p. 495)

• Cumulative, which means that any dividends not paid in a given year go into “arrears” and must be paid before any dividends can be paid to common stockholders.

Legal capital (p. 493)

• Noncumulative, which means that any dividends not paid in a given year are lost.

5 Account for stock

dividends and stock splits

Stock dividends and stock splits:

Memorandum entry (p. 500)

• Increase the number of issued and outstanding shares of a corporation’s stock.

Stock dividend (p. 496) Stock split (p. 499)

• Reduce the market value per share of a ­corporation’s stock.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 507

03/04/14 2:34 PM

508

6

Chapter 10

Account for treasury stock

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Treasury stock:

Treasury stock (p. 501)

• Represents a company’s own issued stock that is repurchased and held for future sale. • Is a contra-stockholders’ equity account whose balance is subtracted from other stockholders’ equity accounts in order to arrive at total stockholders’ equity.

7

Report stockholders’ equity on the balance sheet

8 Evaluate return on

stockholders’ equity

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 508

Many companies often report a separate statement of stockholders’ equity in addition to their other financial statements. A ratio often used to help make decisions is return on equity, which measures the percentage of the average stockholders’ equity that is earned as net income during the year.

Return on equity (ROE) (p. 506)

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

509

Accounting Practice Discussion Questions 1. What are the four basic rights of stockholders? 2. Assume that you are a CFO of a company that is attempting to raise additional capital to finance an expansion of its production facility. You are considering either issuing bonds or additional stock. What are some of the differences in the two options? 3. What accounts are involved in the journal entry to record the issuance of stock at a price above the par value of the stock? 4. What accounts, if any, are involved in the journal entries to record the events associated with each of the following dates associated with cash dividends? a. Declaration date b. Date of record c. Payment date 5. With which type of stock would dividends in arrears be associated? Why? 6. What accounts are affected by the declaration and distribution of a stock dividend? What is the effect of a stock dividend on a. Total Stockholders’ Equity? b. Total Assets? c. Total Liabilities? d. Cash? 7. What are some of the reasons for issuing a stock dividend? 8. What kind of account is Treasury Stock? What is its normal balance? Where would it be reported on the financial statements? 9. What could you reasonably conclude if a company reports more shares of stock issued than outstanding? 10. When considering whether to invest in a company, why would an investor want to examine the company’s return on equity?

Self Check 1. Which characteristic of a corporation is considered to be an advantage? a. Limited stockholder liability b. Indefinite life c. Ease of transferring ownership d. All of the above 2. Which of the following is a disadvantage of organizing as a corporation? a. Limited ability to raise capital b. Separate legal entity c. Double taxation d. Limited stockholder liability 3. What are the two basic sources of corporate capital? a. Common stock and preferred stock b. Paid-in capital and retained earnings c. Retained earnings and dividends d. Stock and bonds

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 509

03/04/14 2:34 PM

510

Chapter 10 4. Suppose House and Garden Furniture issued 250,000 shares of its $5 par common stock at $6 per share. Which journal entry correctly records the issuance of this stock? DATE a.

b. c.

d.

ACCOUNTS Common Stock Cash Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par Cash Common Stock Cash Common Stock Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par Common Stock Cash

POST REF.

DR. 1,500,000

CR. 1,250,000 250,000

1,500,000 1,500,000 1,500,000 1,250,000 250,000 1,500,000 1,500,000

5. Hallery Corporation has 15,000 shares of 5%, $1 par, cumulative preferred stock and 53,000 shares of common stock outstanding. Hallery Corporation declared no dividends in 2014. In 2015, Hallery Corporation declares a total dividend of $31,000. How much of the dividend goes to the common stockholders? a. $750 b. $1,500 c. $29,500 d. None; it all goes to preferred. 6. Theodore Company has 12,000 shares of $6 par common stock outstanding, which Theodore Company issued at $10 per share. Theodore Company also has retained earnings of $84,000. How much is Theodore Company’s total stockholders’ equity? a. $ 48,000 b. $ 120,000 c. $ 204,000 d. $ 72,000 7. What is the term for a company’s own stock that it has issued and repurchased? a. Outstanding stock b. Treasury stock c. Stock dividend d. Issued stock 8. What does a 10% stock dividend do? a. Increases Common Stock b. Has no effect on total equity c. Decreases Retained Earnings d. All of the above 9. What happens with a 2-for-1 stock split? a. Decreases the par value of the stock b. Increases the number of shares of stock issued c. Both a and b d. None of the above 10. Assume that TJ’s Wholesale pays $9 per share to purchase 1,100 of its $1 par common stock as treasury stock. What is the effect of purchasing the treasury stock? a. Decreases total stockholders’ equity by $1,100 b. Decreases total stockholders’ equity by $9,900 c. Increases total stockholders’ equity by $9,900 d. Increases total stockholders’ equity by $1,100

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 510

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

511

11. In the Real World Accounting Video, Howard Greenstone talks about the challenges of operating a business. According to Greenstone, what is the objective of a business? a. Create sales b. Create jobs c. Create value d. Create preferred dividends 12. According to the Real World Accounting Video, there are two types of stock a company can use to finance its assets and operations. The two types of stock are ___________________. a. common stock and uncommon stock b. preferred stock and designated stock c. common stock and preferred stock d. designated stock and common stock Answers are given after Written Communication.

MyAccountingLab

Short Exercises S10-1. Stockholders’ equity terminology (Learning Objectives 1 & 2) 10–15 min. Match the following terms with the correct definition. a. Common stock

_____ 1. Paid-in capital plus retained earnings.

b. Paid-in capital

_____ 2. C  apital from investments by the stockholders.

c. Dividends d. Legal capital e. Outstanding stock f. Par value g. Preferred stock h. Retained earnings i. Treasury stock j. Stockholders’ equity

_____ 3. C  apital earned through profitable ­ operation of the business. _____ 4. The basic form of capital stock. _____ 5. Stock in the hands of stockholders. _____ 6. D  istributions by a corporation to its stockholders. _____ 7. S tock that gives its owners certain ­advantages over common stockholders, such as the right to receive dividends ­before the common stockholders. _____ 8. A  rbitrary amount assigned to a share of stock at the time of incorporation. _____ 9. T he portion of stockholders’ equity ­maintained for the protection of creditors. _____10. A  corporation’s own stock that it reacquires.

S10-2. Stock issuance (Learning Objective 3) 5–10 min. Sullivan, Corp., issued stock above par on July 31. Answer the following questions about Sullivan, Corp. 1. Sullivan, Corp., received $6 million for the issuance of its stock. The par value of the Sullivan, Corp., stock was only $4.5 million. Was the excess amount of $1,500,000 a profit to Sullivan, Corp.? Did the excess affect net income? If not, what was it? 2. Suppose the par value of the Sullivan, Corp., stock had been $2 per share, $5 per share, or $10 per share. Would a change in the par value of the company’s stock affect Sullivan’s total paid-in capital? When issuing stock, what does affect total paid-in capital?

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 511

03/04/14 2:34 PM

512

Chapter 10 S10-3. Issuance of stock for cash and noncash assets (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. This exercise shows the similarity and the difference between two ways to acquire plant assets. Case A—Issue stock and buy the assets in separate transactions: Apex, Inc., issued 10,000 shares of its $10 par common stock for cash of $600,000. In a separate transaction, Apex, Inc. purchased a building for $475,000 and equipment for $125,000. Journalize the two transactions. Case B—Issue stock to acquire the assets: Apex, Inc., issued 10,000 shares of its $10 par common stock to acquire a building with a fair market value of $475,000 and equipment with a fair market value of $125,000. Journalize this single transaction. Compare the balances in all accounts after making both sets of entries. Are the ­account balances similar or different? S10-4. Stock issuance (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 5–10 min. Buckeye, Inc., reported the following on its balance sheet at December 31, 2014:

Common Stock, $3.00 par value, 550,000 shares authorized, 400,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par Retained Earnings

$ 1,200,000 425,000 2,640,000

1. Assume Buckeye, Inc., issued all of its stock during 2014 in one transaction. Journalize the company’s issuance of the stock for cash. 2. Was Buckeye, Inc.’s main source of stockholders’ equity paid-in capital or profitable operations? How can you tell? S10-5. Analyzing stockholders’ equity (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 5–10 min. At December 31, 2014, Sugarland Company reported the following on its comparative balance sheet, which included 2013 amounts for comparison (adapted, with all amounts in millions except par value per share):

December 31 2014 2013 Common Stock, $2.25 par value, 550,000 shares authorized, 400,000 shares issued and outstanding in 2014: 399,000 shares in 2013 Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par Retained Earnings

$

900,000 $ 897,750 395,500 362,000 2,400,000 2,175,000

1. How much did Sugarland Company’s total paid-in capital increase during 2014? What caused total paid-in capital to increase? How can you tell? 2. Did Sugarland Company have a profit or a loss for 2014? How can you tell?

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 512

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

513

S10-6. Stock issuance (Learning Objective 3) 5–10 min. In its first year of operations, Cedar Corporation had the following stock transactions. Journalize them. a. Issued 5,000 shares of $100 par preferred stock at $107 for cash. b. Issued 8,000 share of common stock with a par value of $10 for $120,000. c. Issued 100,000 shares of stock for land, which had a fair market value of $900,000. The stock is currently selling at $8.25 per share. S10-7. Accounting for cash dividends (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Baassir Corporation earned net income of $750,000 during the year ended December 31, 2013. It had 2,000,000 authorized shares of $20 par value common stock. As of June 30, 2014, there were 500,000 shares issued and outstanding. On June 30, 2014, the board of directors declared a $0.50 per share cash dividend to be paid on August 1, 2014. Prepare the necessary journal entries to be recorded on: a. the date of declaration. b. the date of payment. S10-8. Accounting for cash dividends (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Zepher, Inc., prepared the following stockholders’ equity section as of December 31, 2014. Stockholders’ Equity Paid-in Capital: Preferred Stock, 5%, $80 par, 6,000 shares authorized, 1,000 shares issued and outstanding Common Stock, $10 par, 25,000 shares authorized, 9,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

$ 80,000 90,000 85,000 $255,000 145,000 $400,000

Answer the following questions about Zepher, Inc.’s dividends: 1. How much in dividends must Zepher, Inc., declare each year before the common stockholders get any cash dividends for the year? 2. Suppose Zepher, Inc., declares cash dividends of $22,000 for 2014. How much of the dividends goes to preferred? How much goes to common? 3. Is Zepher, Inc.’s preferred stock cumulative or noncumulative? How can you tell? 4. Suppose Zepher, Inc., passed the preferred dividend in 2015 and 2016. In 2017, the company declares cash dividends of $19,000. How much of the dividends goes to preferred? How much goes to common? S10-9. Accounting for stock dividends and stock splits (Learning Objective 5) 10–15 min. Maxim Corporation has 40,000 shares of $20 par value common stock outstanding. Prepare entries in journal form without explanations for the following transactions. (Market value of the stock was $30.00 on December 16 and $31.00 on December 30.)

Dec 16 30

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 513

Declared and distributed a 15 percent stock dividend. Declared a 2-for-1 stock split.

03/04/14 2:34 PM

514

Chapter 10 S10-10. Comparing cash and stock dividends (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 10–15 min. Compare and contrast the accounting for cash dividends and stock dividends. In the space provided, insert either “Cash dividends,” “Stock dividends,” or “Both” to ­complete each of the following statements: 1. __________ increase paid-in capital by the same amount that they decrease ­retained earnings. 2. __________ decrease both total assets and total stockholders’ equity. 3. __________ decrease retained earnings. 4. __________ have no effect on a liability. S10-11. Accounting for stock splits (Learning Objective 5) 5–10 min. Suppose Nolan, Inc., has common stock, $8 par, 500,000 shares authorized, 120,000 shares issued and outstanding. The company also has Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par, common of $225,000 and Retained Earnings of $298,000. The company decided to split its common stock 2-for-1 in order to decrease the market price of its stock. The company’s stock was trading at $26 per share immediately before the split. 1. Show how the stockholders’ equity section of Nolan, Inc.’s balance sheet would appear after the stock split. 2. Which account balances changed after the stock split? Which account balances were unchanged? S10-12. Accounting for treasury stock (Learning Objective 6) 10–15 min. Liquidation World, Inc., began operations in 2014. After issuing its common stock to the public, Liquidation World, Inc., completed the following treasury stock transactions: a. Purchased 2,500 shares of the company’s $2 par common stock as treasury stock, paying cash of $5 per share. b. Sold 1,000 shares of the treasury stock for cash of $11 per share. Requirements 1. Journalize these transactions. Explanations are not required. 2. What kind of account is Treasury Stock? After completing the two transactions, how should Liquidation World, Inc., report the treasury stock on its balance sheet? S10-13. Balance sheet disclosure of stockholders’ equity (Learning Objective 7) 5–10 min. The financial statements of Timberview, Inc., reported the following accounts (in ­thousands except for par value):

Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par...... $172 Cost of Goods Sold ........................ 585 Common Stock, $7 par, 250 shares issued and outstanding ............. 1,750 Cash............................................... 240 Long-Term Debt............................. 73

Net Sales..................................... Accounts Payable........................ Retained Earnings ....................... Other Current Liabilities .............. Operating Expenses .................... Total Assets ................................

$1,090 30 140 55 413 ?

Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of Timberview, Inc.’s balance sheet. Net ­income has already been closed to Retained Earnings.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 514

03/04/14 2:34 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

515

S10-14. Analyzing stockholders’ equity (Learning Objective 7) 10–15 min. Use the statement of stockholders’ equity in Exhibit 10-8 to answer the following questions: 1. Make journal entries to record the declaration and payment of cash dividends ­during 2014. 2. How much cash did the issuance of common stock bring in during 2014? 3. What was the cost of the treasury stock that was purchased during 2014? What was the cost of the treasury stock that was sold during the year? For how much was the treasury stock sold during 2014?

MyAccountingLab

Exercises (Group A) E10-15A. Stock issuance (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Byblos Co. had these transactions during the current period.

Jun 11 Issued 50,000 shares of $3 par value common stock for cash of $250,000. Jul 12 Issued 2,000 shares of $100 par value preferred stock for cash at $108 per share. Nov 25 Issued 7,000 shares of stock in exchange for equipment that had a fair market value of $32,000. Requirements 1. Prepare the journal entries for the preceding transactions. 2. How much paid-in capital did these transactions generate for Byblos Co.? E10-16A. Stock issuance (Learning Objectives 3 & 7) 10–15 min. The charter for Watkins Inc. authorizes the company to issue 500,000 shares of $8, nopar preferred stock and 1,200,000 shares of common stock with $5 par value. During its start-up phase, Watkins Inc. completed the following transactions:

2014 Apr 6 12 14

Issued 500 shares of common stock to the promoters who organized the corporation, receiving cash of $17,000. Issued 600 shares of preferred stock for cash of $32,000. Issued 1,600 shares of common stock in exchange for land with a market value of $24,000.

Requirements 1. Record the transactions in the journal. 2. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of Watkins’s balance sheet at December 31, 2014. Assume that the company earned net income of $42,000 during this period. E10-17A. Stock issuance (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Elissar Corporation’s transactions pertaining to its $10 par value preferred stock are given below. Journalize the transactions. Indicate the amount to be reported for preferred stock and paid-in capital in excess of par value preferred stock at the end of the year.

May 1 Issued 8,000 shares for cash at $24 per share. Jul 1 Issued 6,000 shares for cash at $25 per share.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 515

03/04/14 2:34 PM

516

Chapter 10 E10-18A. Issuance of stock for cash and noncash assets (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. On December 1, Kadmous Corporation declares and distributes a 15% stock ­dividend when the market value of the stock is $16 per share. Indicate the balances in the ­stockholders’ equity accounts after the stock dividend has been distributed if its ­stockholders’ equity section is as follows:

Common stock, $8 par value .............................................. Paid-in capital in excess of par—Common Stock ................ Retained earnings ................................................................ Total stockholders’ equity ....................................................

$ 800,000 200,000 400,000 $1,400,000

E10-19A. Accounting for cash dividends (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. City Communications has the following stockholders’ equity: Quick solution: 2014 dividends = $7,600 ­preferred, $0 common; 2015 dividends = $27,600 preferred, $20,400 common

City Communications Stockholders’ Equity Paid-in Capital: Preferred Stock, 8%, $10 par, 100,000 shares authorized, 22,000 shares issued and outstanding Common Stock, $0.50 par, 500,000 shares authorized, 380,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

$ 220,000 190,000 640,000 $1,050,000 160,000 $1,210,000

Requirement 1. Assume the preferred stock is cumulative. Compute the amount of dividends to preferred and common shareholders for 2014 and 2015 if total dividends are $7,600 in 2014 and $48,000 in 2015. E10-20A. Accounting for cash dividends (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. The following elements of stockholders’ equity are adapted from the balance sheet of Wolfe Corporation.

Stockholders’ Equity Preferred Stock, cumulative, $5 par (Note 7), 60,000 shares issued and outstanding Common Stock, $0.25 par, 10,000,000 shares issued and outstanding

$ Thousands $ 300 2,500

Note 7. Preferred Stock: Designated annual cash dividend per share, $0.85.

Wolfe Corporation paid no preferred dividends in 2014, but paid the designated amount of cash dividends per share to preferred shareholders in all prior years. Requirement 1. Compute the dividends to preferred and common shareholders for 2015 if total dividends are $190,000.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 516

03/04/14 2:35 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

517

E10-21A. Accounting for stock dividends (Learning Objectives 5 & 7) 10–15 min. The stockholders’ equity for Dunelit, Inc., on December 31, 2013, follows:

Stockholders’ Equity Paid-in Capital: Common Stock, $1 par, 450,000 shares authorized, 50,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

$ 50,000 550,000 $600,000 290,000 $890,000

On January 31, 2014, the market price of Dunelit’s common stock was $17 per share and the company distributed a 20% stock dividend. Requirements 1. Journalize the declaration and distribution of the stock dividend. 2. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the balance sheet after the stock dividend. E10-22A. Accounting for cash and stock dividends (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 10–15 min. Cassel, Inc., is authorized to issue 700,000 shares of $2 par common stock. The company issued 80,000 shares at $9 per share, and all 80,000 shares are outstanding. When the market price of common stock was $20 per share, Cassel, Inc., declared and distributed a 10% stock dividend. Later, Cassel, Inc., declared and paid a $0.25 per share cash dividend. Requirements 1. Journalize the declaration and distribution of the stock dividend. 2. Journalize the declaration and the payment of the cash dividend. E10-23A. Accounting for stock splits (Learning Objectives 5 & 7) 10–15 min. Tour Dejour, Inc., had the following stockholders’ equity at January 31:

Stockholders’ Equity Paid-in Capital: Common Stock, $5 par, 500,000 shares authorized, 30,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

$ 150,000 450,000 $ 600,000 550,000 $1,150,000

On February 28, Tour Dejour, Inc., split its common stock 2-for-1. Requirements 1. Make any necessary entry to record the stock split. 2. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the balance sheet immediately after the split.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 517

03/04/14 2:35 PM

518

Chapter 10 E10-24A. Accounting for stock issuance, splits, and treasury stock (Learning Objectives 3, 5, & 6) 20–25 min. Consider each of the following transactions separately from every other transaction: a. Issuance of 40,000 shares of $8 par common at $12. b. Purchase of 2,100 shares of treasury stock (par value $0.75) at $2 per share. c. Issuance of a 15% stock dividend. Before the dividend, 300,000 shares of $5 par common stock were outstanding; market value was $7 at the time of the dividend. d. Sale of 450 shares of $3 par treasury stock for $7 per share. Cost of the treasury stock was $5 per share. e. Split stock 4-for-1. Prior to the split, 120,000 shares of $4 par common were outstanding. Requirement 1. Identify whether each transaction increased, decreased, or did not change total stockholders’ equity. E10-25A. Accounting for treasury stock (Learning Objectives 3 & 6) 20–25 min. Journalize the following transactions of All Sports, Inc., a chain of sports stores:

May 4 Jul 22 Nov 22

Issued 29,000 shares of no-par common stock at $5 per share. Purchased 1,000 shares of treasury stock at $4 per share. Sold 500 shares of treasury stock at $7 per share.

E10-26A. Accounting for treasury stock (Learning Objectives 6 & 7) 20–25 min. Swanson, Inc., had the following stockholders’ equity on November 30:

Stockholders’ Equity Paid-in Capital: Common Stock, $2 par, 750,000 shares authorized, 70,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

$140,000 420,000 $560,000 370,000 $930,000

On December 24, Swanson, Inc., purchased 12,000 shares of treasury stock at $8 per share. Requirements 1. Journalize the purchase of the treasury stock. 2. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the balance sheet at December 31.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 518

03/04/14 2:35 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

519

E10-27A. Balance sheet disclosure of stockholders’ equity (Learning Objective 7) 10–15 min. Oulette Manufacturing, Co., has the following selected account balances at August 31, 2014.

Common Stock, no par with $4 stated value, 40,000 shares authorized, issued, and outstanding ................. Accumulated Depreciation, Machinery and Equipment... Retained Earnings ...................

$160,000 101,000 125,000

Inventory................................. $146,000 Machinery and Equipment ...... 105,000 Preferred Stock, 10%, $25 par, 20,000 shares authorized, 8,000 shares issued and outstanding ........................ 200,000 Paid-in Capital in Excess of Stated Value—Common..... 50,000 Cost of Goods Sold ................. 76,000

Requirement 1. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the company’s balance sheet. E10-28A. Accounting for various stockholders’ equity transactions (Learning Objective 7) 20–25 min. At December 31, 2013, Dungy Corp. reported the following stockholders’ equity:

Paid-in Capital: Common Stock, $4 par, 200,000 authorized, 80,000 shares issued Additional Paid-in Capital Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Subtotal Less: Treasury Stock, 2,600 shares at cost Total Stockholders’ Equity

$ 320,000 130,000 $ 450,000 645,000 $1,095,000 (93,600) $1,001,400

During 2014, Dungy Corp. completed these transactions and events in this order: a. Sold 800 shares of treasury stock for $48 per share; the cost of these shares was $36 per share. b. Issued 1,200 shares of common stock at $26 per share. c. Net income for the year was $212,000. d. Declared and paid cash dividends of $160,000. Requirement 1. Prepare Dungy’s statement of stockholders’ equity for the year ended December 31, 2014.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 519

03/04/14 2:35 PM

520

Chapter 10 E10-29A. Accounting for various stockholders’ equity transactions (Learning Objectives 3, 5, & 7) 20–25 min. Oxford Communications, Inc., began 2014 with 2.8 million shares of $1 par common stock issued and outstanding. Beginning Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par was $6.5 million, and retained earnings was $7.5 million. In February 2014, Oxford Communications, Inc., issued 180,000 shares of stock at $9 per share. In October, when the stock’s market price was $17 per share, the board of directors distributed a 10% stock dividend. Requirements 1. Make the journal entries for the issuance of stock for cash and for the declaration and distribution of the 10% stock dividend. 2. Prepare the company’s statement of stockholders’ equity for the year ended December 31, 2014. Ignore net income. E10-30A. Calculating return on equity (Learning Objective 8) 10–15 min. Assume that Simmons, Inc., has the following data:

Net income for 2014 ........................................................................................ Preferred dividends for 2014 ........................................................................... Total stockholder’s equity, 12/31/2014............................................................ Total stockholder’s equity, 12/31/2013............................................................ Common stockholder’s equity, 12/31/2014 ..................................................... Common stockholder’s equity, 12/31/2013 .....................................................

$ 136,400 $ 21,800 $1,640,000 $1,590,000 $1,440,000 $1,350,000

Requirements 1. Calculate Simmons’ return on equity for 2014. 2. Comment on Simmons’ performance during 2014.

MyAccountingLab

Exercises (Group B) E10-31B. Stock issuance (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. TDR Systems completed the following stock issuance transactions:

Sep 19 Oct 3 11

Issued 1,500 shares of $6 par common stock for cash of $11.50 per share. Sold 250 shares of $4.00, no-par preferred stock for $12,000 cash. Received inventory with a market value of $27,000 and equipment with a market value of $16,000. Issued 3,500 shares of the $6 par common stock in exchange.

Requirements 1. Journalize the transactions. Explanations are not required. 2. How much paid-in capital did these transactions generate for TDR Systems?

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 520

03/04/14 2:35 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

521

E10-32B. Stock issuance (Learning Objectives 3 & 7) 10–15 min. The charter for Zoom, Inc., authorizes the company to issue 900,000 shares of $3, nopar preferred stock and 1,400,000 shares of common stock with $6 par value. During its start-up phase, Zoom, Inc., completed the following transactions:

2012 Oct 6 12 14

Issued 300 shares of common stock to the promoters who organized the corporation, receiving cash of $9,000. Issued 500 shares of preferred stock for cash of $26,000. Issued 1,600 shares of common stock in exchange for land with a market value of $18,000.

Requirements 1. Record the transactions in the journal. 2. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the Zoom’s balance sheet at December 31, 2014. Assume that the company earned net income of $32,000 during this period. E10-33B. Stock issuance (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Hastings, Corp., issued 12,000 shares of no-par common stock for $18 per share. Requirements 1. Record issuance of the stock if the stock: a. is no-par stock. b. has a stated value of $10 per share. 2. Which type of stock issuance results in more total paid-in capital? E10-34B. Issuance of stock for cash and noncash assets (Learning Objective 3)  10–15 min. Alley, Co., recently organized. The company issued no-par common stock to an attorney in exchange for his patent with a market value of $55,000. In addition, Alley, Co., received cash for 3,500 shares of its $50 par preferred stock sold at par value and for 9,000 shares of its no-par common stock sold at $6 per share. Retained earnings at the end of the first year was $39,000. Requirement 1. Without making journal entries, determine the total paid-in capital created by these transactions.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 521

03/04/14 2:35 PM

522

Chapter 10 E10-35B. Accounting for cash dividends (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Tri State Supply, Inc., has the following stockholders’ equity:

Tri State Supply, Inc. Stockholders’ Equity Paid-in Capital: Preferred Stock, 8%, $12 par, 100,000 shares authorized, 25,000 shares issued and outstanding Common Stock, $1.00 par, 500,000 shares authorized, 280,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par-Common Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

$ 300,000 280,000 410,000 990,000 216,000 $1,206,000

Requirement 1. Assume the preferred stock is cumulative. Compute the amount of dividends to preferred and common shareholders for 2014 and 2015 if total dividends are $18,600 in 2014 and $42,800 in 2015. E10-36B. Accounting for cash dividends (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. The following elements of stockholders’ equity are adapted from the balance sheet of Sandler Corporation.

Stockholders’ Equity Preferred Stock, cumulative, $2 par (Note 7), 65,000 shares issued and outstanding Common Stock, $0.10 par, 8,750,000 shares issued and outstanding

$ Thousands $130 875

Note 7. Preferred Stock: Designated annual cash dividend per share, $0.75.

Sandler Corporation paid no preferred dividends in 2014, but paid the designated amount of cash dividends per share to preferred shareholders in all prior years. Requirement 1. Compute the dividends to preferred and common shareholders for 2015 if total dividends are $175,000.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 522

03/04/14 2:35 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

523

E10-37B. Accounting for stock dividends (Learning Objectives 5 & 7) 10–15 min. The stockholders’ equity for Shamrock, Inc., on December 31, 2013, follows:

Stockholders’ Equity Paid-in Capital: Common Stock, $10 par, 900,000 shares authorized, 25,000 issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

$250,000 160,000 410,000 175,000 $585,000

On August 31, 2014, the market price of Shamrock, Inc.’s common stock was $21 per share and the company distributed a 15% stock dividend. Requirements 1. Journalize the declaration and distribution of the stock dividend. 2. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the balance sheet after the stock dividend. E10-38B. Accounting for cash and stock dividends (Learning Objectives 4 & 5) 10–15 min. Inland Machine Tool, Inc., is authorized to issue 700,000 shares of $5 par common stock. The company issued 71,000 shares at $5 per share, and all 71,000 shares are outstanding. When the market price of common stock was $9 per share, Inland Machine Tool, Inc., declared and distributed a 15% stock dividend. Later, Inland Machine Tool, Inc., declared and paid a $0.40 per share cash dividend. Requirements 1. Journalize the declaration and distribution of the stock dividend. 2. Journalize the declaration and the payment of the cash dividend. E10-39B. Accounting for stock splits (Learning Objectives 5 & 7) 10–15 min. Schmitz Construction, Inc., had the following stockholders’ equity at January 31:

Stockholders’ Equity Paid-in Capital: Common Stock, $2 par, 800,000 shares authorized, 60,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

$120,000 48,000 $168,000 214,000 $382,000

On February 28, Schmitz Construction, Inc., split its common stock 4-for-1. Requirements 1. Make any necessary entry to record the stock split. 2. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the balance sheet immediately after the split.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 523

03/04/14 2:35 PM

524

Chapter 10 E10-40B. Accounting for stock issuance, splits, and treasury stock (Learning Objectives 3, 5, & 6) 20–25 min. Consider each of the following transactions separately from every other transaction: a. Issuance of 58,000 shares of $14 par common at $22. b. Purchase of 1,100 shares of treasury stock (par value at $0.50) at $6 per share. c. Issuance of a 10% stock dividend. Before the dividend, 550,000 shares of $1 par common stock were outstanding; market value was $3 at the time of the dividend. d. Sale of 300 shares of $1 par treasury stock for $7 per share. Cost of the treasury stock was $4 per share. e. Split stocks 4-for-1. Prior to the split, 90,000 shares of $3 par common stock were outstanding. Requirement 1. Identify whether each transaction increased, decreased, or did not change total stockholders’ equity. E10-41B. Accounting for treasury stock (Learning Objectives 3 & 6) 20–25 min. Journalize the following transactions of Sinclair Sports, Inc., a chain of sports stores:

Mar 4 May 22 Sep 22

Issued 20,000 shares of no-par common stock at $10 per share. Purchased 1,500 shares of treasury stock at $6 per share. Sold 600 shares of treasury stock at $9 per share.

E10-42B. Accounting for treasury stock (Learning Objectives 6 & 7) 20–25 min. Frontier, Inc., had the following stockholders’ equity on November 30:

Stockholders’ Equity Paid-in Capital: Common Stock, $4 par, 500,000 shares authorized, 90,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

$ 360,000 450,000 810,000 550,000 $1,360,000

On December 10, Frontier purchased 2,000 shares of treasury stock at $13 per share. Requirements 1. Journalize the purchase of the treasury stock. 2. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the balance sheet at December 31.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 524

03/04/14 2:35 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

525

E10-43B. Balance sheet disclosure of stockholders’ equity (Learning Objective 7) 10–15 min. Mackay Manufacturing, Co., has the following selected account balances at January 31, 2014.

Common Stock, no par with $8 stated value, 50,000 shares authorized, issued, and outstanding ..... Accumulated Depreciation, Machinery and Equipment... Retained Earnings ...................

$400,000 57,000 123,000

Inventory................................. Machinery and Equipment ...... Preferred Stock, 7%, $12 par, 20,000 shares authorized, 10,000 shares issued and outstanding ........................ Paid-in Capital in Excess of Stated Value—Common..... Cost of Goods Sold .................

$ 16,000 121,000

120,000 65,000 82,000

Requirement 1. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the company’s balance sheet. E10-44B. Accounting for various stockholders’ equity transactions (Learning Objective 7) 20–25 min. At December 31, 2013, Fernandes, Corp., reported the following stockholders’ equity.

Paid-in Capital: Common Stock, $6 par, 200,000 shares authorized, 140,000 shares issued Additional Paid-in Capital Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Subtotal Less: Treasury stock, 2,200 shares at cost Total Stockholders’ Equity

$ 840,000 145,000 985,000 670,000 1,655,000 (63,800) $1,591,200

During 2014, Fernandes completed these transactions and events in this order: a. Sold 500 shares of treasury stock for $35 per share; the cost of these shares was $29 per share. b. Issued 1,100 shares of common stock at $20 per share. c. Net income for the year was $203,000. d. Declared and paid cash dividends of $40,000. Requirement 1. Prepare Fernandes’s statement of stockholders’ equity for the year ended December 31, 2014.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 525

03/04/14 2:35 PM

526

Chapter 10 E10-45B. Accounting for various stockholders’ equity transactions (Learning Objectives 3, 5, & 7) 20–25 min. Global Communications, Inc., began 2014 with 3 million shares of $2 par common stock issued and outstanding. Beginning Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par was $9.7 million, and Retained Earnings was $8 million. In June 2014, Global Communications, Inc., issued 120,000 shares of stock at $12 per share. In October, when the stock’s market price was $14 per share, the board of directors distributed a 5% stock dividend. Requirements 1. Make the journal entries for the issuance of stock for cash and for the declaration and distribution of the 5% stock dividend. 2. Prepare the company’s statement of stockholders’ equity for the year ended December 31, 2014. Ignore net income. E10-46B. Calculating return on equity (Learning Objective 8) 10–15 min. Assume that Hanson Industrial Supply, Inc., has the following data:

Net income for 2014 ........................................................................................ Preferred dividends for 2014 ........................................................................... Total stockholders’ equity, 12/31/2014............................................................ Total stockholders’ equity, 12/31/2013............................................................ Common stockholders’ equity, 12/31/2014 ..................................................... Common stockholders’ equity, 12/31/2013 .....................................................

$ 251,875 $ 5,875 $1,750,000 $1,500,000 $1,590,000 $1,410,000

Requirements 1. Calculate Hanson Industrial Supply’s return on equity for 2014. 2. Comment on Hanson Industrial Supply’s performance during 2014.

MyAccountingLab

Problems (Group A) P10-47A. Stock issuance (Learning Objectives 3 & 7) 10–15 min. Partners Pat and Quincy wish to avoid the unlimited personal liability of the partnership form of business, so they are incorporating the company as P & Q Services, Inc. The charter from the state of Texas authorizes the corporation to issue 25,000 shares of 5%, $100 par preferred stock and 300,000 shares of no-par common stock. In its first month, P & Q Services, Inc., completed the following transactions:

Jan 3 12 22

Issued 6,100 shares of common stock to Pat and 3,600 shares to Quincy, both for cash of $5 per share. Issued 900 shares of preferred stock to acquire a patent with a market value of $90,000. Issued 1,400 shares of common stock to other investors for $5 cash per share. Requirements 1. Record the transactions in the journal. 2. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the P & Q Services, Inc.’s balance sheet at December 31. The ending balance of Retained Earnings is $59,000.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 526

03/04/14 2:35 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

527

P10-48A. Analyzing stockholders’ equity (Learning Objectives 2, 3, 4, & 7) 20–25 min. Comstock Corporation was organized in 2013. At December 31, 2013, Comstock Corporation’s balance sheet reported the following stockholders’ equity:

Stockholders’ Equity Paid-in Capital: Preferred Stock, 5%, $8 par, 30,000 shares authorized, none issued Common Stock, $2 par, 120,000 shares authorized, 12,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings (deficit) Total Stockholders’ Equity

$

0

24,000 51,000 $75,000 (4,500) $70,500

Requirements Answer the following questions and make journal entries as needed: 1. What does the 5% mean for the preferred stock? After Comstock Corporation issues preferred stock, how much in annual cash dividends would Comstock Corporation expect to pay on 5,000 shares? 2. At what average price per share did Comstock Corporation issue the common stock during 2013? 3. Were first-year operations profitable? Give your reason. 4. During 2014, the company completed the following selected transactions. Journalize each transaction. Explanations are not required. a. Issued for cash 3,000 shares of preferred stock at par value. b. Issued for cash 2,600 shares of common stock at a price of $8.50 per share. 5. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the Comstock Corporation balance sheet at December 31, 2014. Assume net income for the year is $73,000.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 527

03/04/14 2:35 PM

528

Chapter 10 P10-49A. Analyzing stockholders’ equity (Learning Objectives 2, 3, & 4) 20–25 min. Malton Hotel, Inc., included the following stockholders’ equity on its year-end balance sheet at December 31, 2014, with all dollar amounts, except par value per share, adapted and in millions:

Stockholders’ Equity Paid-in Capital: Preferred Stock, 8% cumulative, par value $10 per share; 50,000,000 shares authorized, 6,200,000 shares issued and outstanding Common Stock, par value $3 per share; 750,000,000 shares authorized, 239,000,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

$ Millions $

62

717 68 $ 847 302 $1,149

Requirements 1. Identify the different issues of stock that Malton Hotel, Inc., has outstanding. 2. Give the two entries to record issuance of the Malton Hotel, Inc.’s stock. Assume that all the stock was issued for cash. Explanations are not required. 3. Assume that preferred dividends are in arrears for 2013 and 2014. Record the declaration of a $40 million cash dividend on December 30, 2015. Assume no change in the preferred stock account in 2015. Use separate Dividends Payable accounts for preferred and common stock. Round to the nearest $1 million. An explanation is not required. P10-50A. Accounting for cash dividends (Learning Objective 4) 15–20 min. Conway Consulting, Inc., has 10,000 shares of $4.50, no-par preferred stock and 30,000 shares of no-par common stock outstanding for 2012–2014. Conway Consulting, Inc., declared and paid the following dividends during a three-year period: 2012, $27,000; 2013, $86,000; and 2014, $116,000. Requirements 1. Compute the total dividends to preferred stockholders and to common stockholders for each of the three years if: a. preferred is noncumulative. b. preferred is cumulative. 2. For case 1(b), journalize the declaration of the 2014 dividends on December 28, 2014, and the payment of the dividends on January 17, 2015. Use separate Dividends Payable accounts for preferred and common stock.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 528

03/04/14 2:35 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

529

P10-51A. Accounting for various stockholders’ equity transactions (Learning Objectives 4, 5, & 6) 20–25 min. Littleton Corporation completed the following selected transactions during 2014:

Jan 6

Jan 20 Mar 21 Apr 18 Jun 18 Dec 22

Declared a cash dividend on the 12,000 shares of $2.25, no-par preferred stock outstanding. Declared a $0.10 per share dividend on the 9,000 shares of common stock outstanding. The date of record is January 17, and the payment date is January 20. Paid the cash dividends. Split common stock 2-for-1 by calling in the 9,000 shares of $10 par common stock and issuing new stock in its place. Declared and distributed a 15% stock dividend on the common stock. The market value of the common stock was $34 per share. Purchased 1,000 shares of treasury common stock at $30 per share. Sold 500 shares of treasury common stock for $33 per share.

Requirement 1. Record the transactions in the journal. P10-52A. Accounting for various stockholders’ equity transactions (Learning Objectives 5, 6, & 7) 20–25 min. The balance sheet of Britton, Inc., at December 31, 2013, reported 900,000 shares of $2 par common stock authorized with 180,000 shares issued and outstanding. Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par had a balance of $265,000. Retained Earnings had a balance of $226,000. During 2014, the company completed the following selected transactions:

Feb 15 Mar 8 Sep 28

Purchased 8,000 shares of treasury stock at $6 per share. Sold 2,000 shares of treasury stock for $13 per share. Declared and distributed a 10% stock dividend on the 174,000 shares of outstanding common stock. The market value of Britton’s common stock was $12 per share.

Requirements 1. Record the transactions in the journal. Explanations are not required. 2. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the balance sheet at December 31, 2014, assuming the company earned $84,000 of net income during the year.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 529

03/04/14 2:35 PM

530

Chapter 10 P10-53A. Analyzing stockholders’ equity (Learning Objective 7) 15–20 min. Market Analysts, Inc., reported the following statement of stockholders’ equity for the year ended September 30, 2014:

Market Analysts, Inc. Statement of Stockholders’ Equity Year Ended September 30, 2014 (Dollar amounts in thousands) Balance, September 30, 2013 Net Income Cash Dividends Issuance of Stock (4,000 shares) Stock Dividend Sale of Treasury Stock Balance, September 30, 2014

COMMON ADDITIONAL STOCK PAID-IN CAPITAL $171 $2,118

15 24 $210

RETAINED EARNINGS $1,704 519 (117)

51 93 7 $2,269

TREASURY STOCK $(20)

(117) $1,989

9 $(11)

TOTAL $3,973 519 (117) 66 0 16 $4,457

Requirements 1. What is the par value of the company’s common stock? 2. At what price per share did the company issue its common stock during the year?

Quick solution:

3. What was the cost of treasury stock sold during the year? What was the selling price of the treasury stock sold? What was the increase in total stockholders’ equity from selling the treasury stock?

1. $3.75 per share; 2. $16.50 per share; 3. Selling price of treasury stock = $16,000; 4. No effect

4. What overall effect did the stock dividend have on total stockholders’ equity?

Problems (Group B) P10-54B. Stock issuance (Learning Objectives 3 & 7) 10–15 min. Partners Rodriguez and Salizar wish to avoid the unlimited personal liability of the partnership form of business, so they are incorporating the company as R & S Services, Inc. The charter from the state of Texas authorizes the corporation to issue 100,000 shares of 6%, $80 par preferred stock and 500,000 shares of no-par common stock. In its first month, R & S Services, Inc., completed the following transactions:

Jan 3 12 22

Issued 4,800 shares of common stock to Rodriguez and 3,600 shares to Salizar, both for cash of $12 per share. Issued 1,200 shares of preferred stock to acquire a patent with a market value of $96,000. Issued 1,500 shares of common stock to other investors for $14 cash per share.

Requirements 1. Record the transactions in the journal. 2. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the R & S Services, Inc.’s balance sheet at December 31. The ending balance of Retained Earnings is $103,000.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 530

03/04/14 2:35 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

531

P10-55B. Analyzing stockholders’ equity (Learning Objectives 2, 3, 4, & 7) 20–25 min. Mackay, Inc., was organized in 2013. At December 31, 2013, Mackay, Inc.’s balance sheet reported the following stockholders’ equity:

Stockholders’ Equity Paid-in Capital: Preferred Stock, 6%, $8 par, 70,000 shares authorized, none issued Common Stock, $1 par, 140,000 shares authorized, 12,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings (deficit) Total Stockholders’ Equity

$

0

12,000 33,000 $45,000 (4,000) $41,000

Requirements Answer the following questions and make journal entries as needed: 1. What does the 6% mean for the preferred stock? After Mackay, Inc., issues preferred stock, how much in annual cash dividends would Mackay, Inc., expect to pay on 1,500 shares? 2. At what average price per share did Mackay, Inc., issue the common stock during 2013? 3. Were the first-year operations profitable? Give your reasons. 4. During 2014, the company completed the following selected transactions. Journalize each transaction. Explanations are not required. a. Issued for cash 5,000 shares of preferred stock at par value. b. Issued for cash 2,000 shares of common stock at a price of $7 per share. 5. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the Mackay, Inc.’s balance sheet at December 31, 2014. Assume net income for the year was $75,000.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 531

03/04/14 2:35 PM

532

Chapter 10 P10-56B. Analyzing stockholders’ equity (Learning Objectives 2, 3, & 4) 20–25 min. Davenport, Inc., included the following stockholders’ equity on its year-end balance sheet at December 31, 2014, with all dollar amounts, except par value per share, adapted and in millions:

Stockholders’ Equity Paid-in Capital: Preferred Stock, 8% cumulative, par value $50 per share; 10,000,000 shares authorized, 1,000,000 shares issued and outstanding Common Stock, par value $2 per share; 800,000,000 shares authorized, 160,000,000 shares issued and outstanding Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par—Common Total Paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity

$ Millions $ 50

320 82 $452 216 $668

Requirements 1. Identify the different issues of stock Davenport, Inc., has outstanding. 2. Give the two entries to record issuance of the Davenport, Inc.’s stock. Assume all the stock was issued for cash. Explanations are not required. 3. Assume that preferred dividends are in arrears for 2013 and 2014. Record the declaration of a $31 million cash dividend on December 30, 2015. Assume no change in the preferred stock account in 2015. Use separate Dividends Payable accounts for preferred and common stock. Round to the nearest $1 million. An explanation is not required. P10-57B. Accounting for cash dividends (Learning Objective 4) 15–20 min. Kahluna Consulting, Inc., has 8,000 shares of $5.00, no-par preferred stock and 70,000 shares of no-par common stock outstanding for 2012–2014. Kahluna declared and paid the following dividends during a three-year period: 2012, $22,000; 2013, $95,000; and 2014, $225,000. Requirements 1. Compute the total dividends to preferred stockholders and to common stockholders for each of the three years if: a. preferred is noncumulative. b. preferred is cumulative. 2. For case 1(b), journalize the declaration of the 2014 dividends on December 28, 2014, and the payment of dividends on January 17, 2015. Use separate Dividends Payable accounts for preferred and common stock.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 532

03/04/14 2:35 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

533

P10-58B. Accounting for various stockholders’ equity transactions (Learning Objectives 4, 5, & 6) 20–25 min. Sinclair Corporation completed the following selected transactions during 2014:

Jan 6

Jan 20 Mar 21 Apr 18 Jun 18 Dec 22

Declared a cash dividend on the 9,000 shares of $4.25, no-par preferred stock outstanding. Declared a $0.60 per share dividend on the 14,000 shares of common stock outstanding. The date of record is January 17, and the payment date is January 20. Paid the cash dividends. Split common stock 2-for-1 by calling in the 14,000 shares of $10 par common stock and issuing new stock in its place. Declared and distributed a 15% stock dividend on the common stock. The market value of the common stock was $32 per share. Purchased 1,400 shares of treasury common stock at $33 per share. Sold 600 shares of treasury common stock for $38 per share.

Requirement 1. Record the transactions in the journal. P10-59B. Accounting for various stockholders’ equity transactions (Learning Objectives 5, 6, 7) 20–25 min. The balance sheet of Relaxation, Inc., at December 31, 2013, reported 650,000 shares of $2 par common stock authorized with 120,000 shares issued and outstanding. Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par had a balance of $310,000. Retained Earnings had a balance of $140,000. During 2014, the company completed the following selected transactions:

Feb 15 Mar 8 Sep 28

Purchased 5,000 shares of treasury stock at $6 per share. Sold 1,000 shares of treasury stock for $13 per share. Declared and distributed a 5% stock dividend on the 116,000 shares of outstanding common stock. The market value of Relaxation’s common stock was $7 per share.

Requirements 1. Record the transactions in the journal. Explanations are not required. 2. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the balance sheet at December 31, 2014, assuming the company earned $74,000 of net income during the year.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 533

03/04/14 2:35 PM

534

Chapter 10 P10-60B. Analyzing stockholders’ equity (Learning Objective 7) 15–20 min. Columbia Analysts, Inc., reported the following statement of stockholders’ equity for the year ended September 30, 2014.

Columbia Analysts, Inc. Statement of Stockholders’ Equity Year Ended September 30, 2014 (Dollar amounts in thousands) Balance, September 30, 2013 Net Income Cash Dividends Issuance of Stock (5,000 shares) Stock Dividend Sale of Treasury Stock Balance, September 30, 2014

COMMON ADDITIONAL STOCK PAID-IN CAPITAL $180 $2,006

16 20 $216

56 83 6 $2,151

RETAINED EARNINGS $1,640 487 (106)

TREASURY STOCK $ (22)

(103) $1,918

12 $(10)

TOTAL $3,804 487 (106) 72 0 18 $4,275

Requirements 1. What is the par value of the company’s common stock? 2. At what price per share did the company issue its common stock during the year? 3. What was the cost of treasury stock sold during the year? What was the selling price of the treasury stock sold? What was the increase in total stockholders’ equity from selling the treasury stock? 4. What overall effect did the stock dividend have on total stockholders’ equity?

Continuing Exercise This exercise continues our accounting for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., from Chapter 9. In this exercise, we will account for the declaration and issuance of a cash dividend by Cole’s Yard Care, Inc. On October 15, 2014, Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., declared a $10,000 cash dividend. The dividend was payable to all common shareholders of record on October 31 and was paid on November 15, 2014. Requirements 1. Journalize the entries related to the dividends. 2. What was the effect of the dividend on the following? • Cash • Retained Earnings • Total Stockholders’ Equity

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 534

03/04/14 2:35 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

535

Continuing Problem This problem continues our accounting for Aqua Magic, Inc., from Chapter 9. Aqua Magic, Inc., has been authorized to sell 600,000 shares of $10 par value common stock and 150,000 shares of $8 par, 12% preferred stock. During the year, Aqua Magic had the following transactions related to stockholders’ equity:

May 1 Jun 13 Sep 18 Oct 6 Oct 22 Nov 14 Dec 15 Dec 21

Issued 4,500 shares of common stock to Greg Richards in exchange for $35,000 cash and a truck with a market value of $10,000. Issued an additional 1,000 shares of common stock to Greg Richards for $10,000 cash. Sold 4,000 shares of common stock to investors for $47,000. Sold 2,000 shares of preferred stock to investors for $28,000. Purchased 1,500 shares of common stock for $14 per share to hold in the company’s treasury. Declared a $8,000 dividend payable on December 15 to stockholders on record on December 1. Used separate payable accounts for preferred and common dividends. Paid the dividend. Sold 300 shares of treasury stock for $21 per share.

Requirements 1. Record the transactions in the journal. Explanations are not required. 2. Prepare the stockholders’ equity section of the balance sheet at December 31, 2014, assuming Aqua Magic, Inc., earned $129,500 of net income during the year. In addition to the dividends paid on December 15, $7,400 of dividends were paid earlier in the year.

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem Return to Target’s 2012 annual report. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem in Chapter 2. On page 33 of the annual report, you’ll find Target’s income statement for the year ending February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Operations). On page 35, you’ll find Target’s balance sheet as of February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position). On page 37, you’ll find Target’s statement reconciling the changes in each account in shareholders’ equity. The statement is called the Consolidated Statement of Shareholders’ Investment. Now answer the following questions: 1. Look at Target’s balance sheet. What are the different types of stockholders’ equity reported on Target’s balance sheet? Read the financial statements, including the statements of shareholders’ investment, and describe each type of stockholders’ equity. 2. Look at Target’s statement of shareholders’ investment. What happened during the years ending February 2, 2013, and January 28, 2012, in each account of the shareholders’ equity? Use the consolidated statements of comprehensive income on page 34 to help understand the change in accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss). 3. Look at Target’s balance sheet and income statement. What is Target’s return on equity (ROE) for the year ending February 2, 2013? What does this ratio tell you? 4. Looking back over your answers to questions 1 through 3, how do you think Target is performing? What do you think of Target’s ROE?

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 535

03/04/14 2:35 PM

536

Chapter 10

Apply Your Knowledge Ethics in Action Case 1. Tammy was a wealthy, 20% stockholder of TDS Corporation. She was looking over the financial statements of the corporation and saw that TDS Corporation was in need of a large loan. Furthermore, she knew that December sales were weaker than expected and that the yearly financial statements would show a lower net income than anticipated. She then decided to lend the company $2 million at 6% interest and also become a customer and purchase $280,000 of merchandise. By Tammy becoming a customer, it would increase the business’s December sales and net income and give the company sufficient cash to meet expenses. When approached with the ideas, the CEO objected, stating that the “loan” would have to be recorded as additional capital because a stockholder could not lend money to a company. Tammy stated that as long as the money was treated as a loan with interest and with the expectation of repayment, it should be allowed. The CEO then stated that it would be unethical for the company to “borrow” money from a stockholder. Also, it would be unethical for the company to “sell” merchandise to a stockholder because it would be done merely to improve the December sales. Tammy suggested that the loan agreement and 6% interest would make the arrangement reasonable. She stated that if the interest rate was 25%, then the CEO might have a valid ethical concern. Tammy also argued that the sale of merchandise to her was completely ethical because she was not going to return the merchandise. She further contended that it should not matter whether she was a stockholder because, in these transactions, she would be a lender and a customer, which would not involve any ethical issues. Can a stockholder lend money to the corporation? What potential ethical issues would be involved? Can a stockholder become a customer in order to make purchases just to improve the sales and net income? Does the amount of the purchase matter? Why do you think the CEO was concerned? Case 2. The board of directors for Atlantic Corporation met in January to address growing concerns about the declining stock price of the firm. Because the price per share was so low, the board decided that the company would buy back 10 million shares of outstanding stock. During the year, Atlantic Corporation repurchased the shares at a total cost of $62 million. With fewer shares in the hands of shareholders, the board of directors declared and paid a dividend on only those remaining shares outstanding. As a result of these activities, the price per share rose dramatically in only 10 months. The board of directors then felt it best to reissue the treasury stock at the highest per share price possible. Accordingly, Atlantic Corporation reissued the 10 million shares for $142 million. When the board of directors looked over the yearly financial statements, however, it could not find the $80 million “gain” from the treasury stock sale, equal to the reissue price of $142 million less the purchase cost of $62 million. The accountant had recorded the excess as “Additional Paid-in Capital” rather than as a gain on sale. The board of directors met with the accountant and demanded that a gain be recorded; the board wanted more revenue to be included on the income statement. It argued that stock had been sold at a price higher than it was purchased for, and, therefore, it really did not matter whether the stock was Atlantic Corporation stock or any other company’s stock, because all stock sales result in either a gain or loss. Why does the board of directors want to recognize the $80 million excess from the treasury stock transactions as a gain? Why does the accountant want to recognize the $80 million as an increase in total equity? Who is right, and are any ethical issues involved? Does the board of directors have a strong argument that it does not matter whether the stock was Atlantic Corporation stock or any other company because all stock is the same? Do you have any additional thoughts?

Know Your Business Financial Analysis Purpose: To help familiarize you with the financial reporting of a real company in order to further your understanding of the chapter material.

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 536

03/04/14 2:35 PM

Corporations: Paid-In Capital and Retained Earnings

537

This case continues our examination of Columbia Sportswear. We will now study the stockholders’ equity of Columbia Sportswear, which you will see titled as Shareholders’ Equity. Refer to the Columbia Sportswear financial statements in Appendix A. Look for the consolidated balance sheets as well as the consolidated statements of shareholders’ equity. Requirements 1. What was the balance of total stockholders’ equity at December 31, 2012? What was the balance of total stockholders’ equity at December 31, 2011? Did the amount of ending total stockholders’ equity increase or decrease? What seems to be the main reason for the change in total stockholders’ equity? What is the largest component of total stockholders’ equity? 2. Does Columbia Sportswear have any preferred stock authorized? Can you determine the par value of the preferred stock? How many shares of preferred stock are issued and outstanding? 3. What is the par value of the common stock? Does Columbia Sportswear have any additional paid-in capital? Why or why not? How many shares of common stock are authorized? How many shares are issued and outstanding at the end of 2012? How many shares are issued and outstanding at the beginning of the year? 4. Look at the consolidated statements of shareholders’ equity. Did Columbia Sportswear declare any dividends in 2012? If so, how much were the total dividends and what is the dividend per share? Has the amount of dividends per share increased or decreased from 2011 to 2012? Can you determine whether Columbia Sportswear has been repurchasing shares of its common stock? If so, has the amount of share repurchases been increasing or decreasing? What is the effect on total stockholders’ equity?

Industry Analysis Purpose: To help you understand and compare the performance of two companies in the same industry. Find the Columbia Sportswear Company Annual Report located in Appendix A and go to the Financial Statements starting on page 690. Now access the 2012 Annual Report for Under Armour, Inc., from the Internet. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Industry Analysis in Chapter 1. The company’s financial statements start on page 48. Requirement 1. On the Consolidated Balance Sheets for each company, look at the Stockholders’ (Shareholders’) Equity section. What type or class of stock has each company issued? How does the par value differ for each company? Do you see anything ­unusual with the Common Stock for Columbia Sportswear?

Small Business Analysis Purpose: To help you understand the importance of cash flows in the operation of a small business. You are the chief operating officer (COO) of a small public corporation. The company just completed its fiscal year, and the annual meeting is just a few weeks away. Your company has had a pretty good year, despite the rough economic climate your industry has been weathering; the stock price has maintained its high level. But here’s the dilemma: The corporation has paid out a cash dividend every year since its inception, but this year you have some concerns about continuing that tradition. Cash flows during the latter part of the year have been slow because your customers are taking longer to pay than they normally do. There’s also the concern about the lump sum payment on the mortgage that is due in a couple of months. You must have sufficient cash for that payment. You’ve already had some inquiries from stockholders about the amount of the dividend that the company will be paying out this year. You’ve answered all the inquiries with a very positive tone, but the entire time you’re wondering if there will even be a dividend

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 537

03/04/14 2:35 PM

538

Chapter 10 this year. You’re certain that the important stockholders would understand if the corporation had to forego paying a dividend this year. Or would they? You decide to have a meeting with the controller to discuss the situation. Requirement 1. What would be the most viable suggestion that your controller might make to you as an alternative to paying out a cash dividend this year? What are the implications of your recommendation?

Written Communication You just got off the telephone with one of your clients who wants to start a new business as a corporation. His question to you was concerning the different types of stock that can be issued to the potential stockholders of this new corporation. You had explained it to him during the telephone call, but you thought you should follow up your conversation with a letter. Requirement 1. Prepare a letter to your client explaining the different types or classes of stock that can be issued and the characteristics of each different type. Self Check Answers 1. d 2. c 3. b 4. c 5. c 6. c 7. b 8. d 9. c 10. b 11. c 12. c

M10_KEMP9543_03_GE_C10.indd 538

03/04/14 2:35 PM

11 The Statement of Cash Flows Business, Accounting, and You Close your eyes and imagine that you are the head accountant at Delta Airlines. Head accountants are often called controllers. As Delta Airlines’ controller, what is your role in the company? Your job is to provide understandable, relevant, and reliable information to decision makers. Many of those decisions deal with cash. Delta Airlines needs cash for a lot of things, including operating, investing in assets, and paying debts. Decisions about cash are very important. As noted in Chapter 7, a business must have enough cash to operate and pay its bills. But where does a business get cash, and how does it use cash? How does cash flow in and out of a business like Delta Airlines? You cannot tell by looking at the balance sheet. The balance sheet only tells how much cash a business has at a point in time. You cannot tell by looking at the income statement. Income statements are based on accrual accounting, where

Learning Objectives 1 Identify the purposes and importance of the statement of cash flows

2 Differentiate between cash flows from operating, investing, and financing activities

3 Prepare the statement of cash flows using the indirect method

4 Prepare the statement of cash flows using the direct method

5 Evaluate a company’s performance with respect to cash

539

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 539

03/04/14 2:39 PM

540

Chapter 11

Operating activities  Dayto-day activities that create revenues or expenses.

Investing activities  Activities that increase or decrease long-term assets.

Financing activities  Activities related to the issuance of, and repayment of, long-term debt, the issuance of stock, and the payment of dividends.

Statement of cash flows  A financial statement that shows all of the sources and all of the uses of cash for an accounting period; also called the cash flow statement.

revenues and expenses are recognized when they occur and not when the cash is received or paid. So accountants need to provide information in addition to a balance sheet and an income statement. They need to create a statement that reports where and when the business gets and uses cash during a period of time. Where does a business get and use cash? Well, where do you get and use cash? Everyone, including you and Delta Airlines, gets cash and uses cash from one of three activities: operating, investing, and financing. First, let’s look at your operating activities. Operating activities relate to the receipt and payment of cash for the revenues and expenses reported in the income statement. You go to work. You earn a salary. But you also have expenses. Let’s say you earn $500 for working a week. However, you have to wait an additional week before being paid. After finishing your work, you have a $500 receivable from your employer that will be paid in one week’s time. But you also have to pay for the gas you used to go to work. For the days you worked, you charged $100 on your credit card for gas. Your charge would be considered a payable. You’ll pay the $100 payable when you get your credit card bill at the end of the month. At the end of the week of work, your accrued net income is $400, $500 in revenue less $100 in expenses. However, you will not have any “cash flows” until you receive your paycheck and pay your credit card bill. Your cash flows occurred after the recognition of your net income of $400. Second, we’ll look at investing activities. Investing activities relate to the payment and receipt of cash to buy and sell long-term assets such as buildings and equipment. When you buy a car, you pay cash. When you sell a car, you receive cash. Buying and selling assets that last more than one year are investing activities. Third, let’s look at financing activities. Financing activities relate to the receipt and payment of cash for: (1) long-term liabilities and (2) stockholders’ equity. When a business borrows money, it receives cash. When a business repays the liability, it uses cash. When a business sells stock, it receives cash. When the business pays a dividend, it uses cash. An example of a financing activity is borrowing cash from a bank and agreeing to make loan payments for three years. This is a financing activity. You receive cash when you borrow the money and use cash when you repay the loan. Now look at business. Accountants at Delta Airlines and other businesses need to report how much cash their businesses have. The amount of cash they have is reported on their balance sheet. But they also need to report how cash changed during a period of time. Accountants need to report the activities of a business that provide and use cash and whether these activities are operating, investing, or financing activities. Accountants do this with the statement of cash flows.

Real World Accounting Video In the Real World Accounting Video, Peter Kranes, managing director of Fishs Eddy, talks about managing a growing business. Listen to what Peter is saying. Think about cash coming in and going out of the business. Think about managing so there is always enough cash to pay the bills and meet other needs.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 540

03/04/14 2:39 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

541

What Is the Statement of Cash Flows? 1

Identify the purposes and importance of the statement of cash flows

Cash is often considered to be the “lifeblood” of a business. As we have seen throughout this book, the balance sheet reports the amount of cash a business has at the end of the accounting period. Remember from Chapter 7, this cash balance typically includes cash as well as cash equivalents. When a balance sheet reports two consecutive years of data, readers of the information can see that cash increased or decreased from one point in time to another. However, a comparative balance sheet does not show why cash ­increased or decreased. Therefore, a statement of cash flows, or a cash flow statement, is ­usually prepared to show why the amount of cash changed during the year. The statement of cash flows reports: • All sources of cash during the period. In other words, it shows where a company got its cash during the year from operating, investing, and financing activities. • All uses of cash during the period. In other words, it shows where a company spent its cash during the year on operating, investing, and financing activities. • How the sources and uses of cash net to equal the change in the amount of cash a business holds between the beginning of the period and the end of the period.

Accounting in Your World Think about going to college. It’s a major step that requires hard work and sacrifice. However, it also takes money to pay for tuition, textbooks, and other items. Going to school requires a big cash outflow. Now think about where you’ll get the cash to pay for all these items. You begin to think of the past, the present, and the future. Do you already have cash that you can use to pay the bills? Can you go to work, earn a salary, and use your paycheck to pay the bills? Can you borrow the money to pay the bills? Can you sell an asset, such as your car or entertainment system, to pay the bills? What are you doing? You are thinking about cash flow.

Most people look at cash flow by looking at the cash in their purse or wallet, checking accounts, or saving accounts. They methodically take the beginning balance, add the deposits, and subtract the withdrawals, which results in the ending balance. They then analyze the deposits and withdrawals, separating them into categories such as paycheck and living expenses, big purchases, like cars, and borrowing and ­repaying debt. Businesses are like you; they worry about cash flow. Businesses need a statement that explains where they got and used cash. That statement is the statement of cash flows. The statement of cash flows shows: 1. The beginning cash balance, 2. The sources of cash, 3. The uses of cash, and 4. How these add up and become the ending cash balance. In showing the sources and uses of cash, the statement of cash flows categorizes the sources and uses into operating, investing, and financing activities.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 541

03/04/14 2:39 PM

542

Chapter 11

Stop and Think… Bob Hanson, the CEO of Allied Industrial Supply, was concerned. He was looking over the Income Statement for the second quarter of the year and it showed that Allied Industrial Supply had net income of $84,000. He thought to himself: “How can this be? There isn’t any money in the bank to pay bills with.” What are some things that could cause Allied Industrial Supply to be low on cash even though it earned $84,000 for the quarter?

Answer

It is important to remember that net income for most companies is calculated on the accrual basis instead of the cash basis, which means that the amount of net income for the period does not represent cash flow. There are many things that could cause Allied Industrial Supply to be low on cash even though it had $84,000 of net income for the quarter. For example, it could have had a significant amount of sales on account that have not yet been collected. This would increase the net income during the period without providing any cash. Allied Industrial Supply could have made a cash purchase of a ­substantial amount of inventory at the end of the quarter. This would reduce cash but have no effect on net income until the inventory is sold. Or, Allied Industrial Supply could have repaid a significant amount of the principal portion of debt during the period. Repaying principal on debt uses cash but does not affect the net income for the period (only the payment of interest affects net income).

How Does a Business Create a Statement of Cash Flows? 2

Differentiate between cash flows from operating, investing, and financing activities

Individuals and businesses need to understand cash flow. The method businesses use to create a statement of cash flows is different from the method used by individuals. Unlike individuals, businesses do not go to their cash account and look at the beginning balance, deposits, withdrawals, and ending balance. Businesses use the balance sheet and income statement to figure out where their cash came from and went. A business’s statement of cash flows is designed to supplement the balance sheet and income statement and to show how transactions reported in the balance sheet and income statement affect cash. As such, the statement of cash flows is a very important statement in giving the user a complete picture of a business’s operations. The balance sheet and income statement use accrual accounting to reflect the business’s assets, liabilities, stockholders’ equity, revenue, and expenses. The balance sheet and income statement reflect transactions when they occur, even though it may take time before cash is affected. The cash flow statement takes the December 31, 2013 (a point in time)

For the Year Ended December 31, 2014 (a period of time)

December 31, 2014 (a point in time)

Income Statement

Balance Sheet

Statement of Stockholders’ Equity

Balance Sheet

Statement of Cash Flows

Exhibit 11-1

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 542

03/04/14 2:39 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

543

information on the balance sheet and income statement and shows how these transactions affect or do not affect cash. In essence, the cash flow statement is the communicating link between the accrual-based balance sheet and income statement and the cash reported on the balance sheet. Exhibit 11-1 illustrates the relationships between the balance sheet, the income statement, the statement of stockholders’ equity, and the statement of cash flows.

The Logic of How the Statement of Cash Flows Is Prepared Unlike the balance sheet and income statement, the statement of cash flows does not have any unique accounts. It uses the accounts in the balance sheet and income statement to explain the change in cash over a period of time. Now, consider these points: • Balance sheets balance. • If you take a business’s balance sheet at the beginning of a period and its balance sheet at the end of that period, you can compute the change in each account. Each change is the net of all the transactions that occurred in that account during that ­period of time. • Given the beginning and ending balance sheets balance, the net change in the a­ ccounts must balance, just as with the accounting equation. The changes in the assets must equal the changes in the liabilities plus the changes in the stockholders’ equity. • Take the change in the cash account out of the change in assets. What happens? No longer does the change in assets equal the change in liabilities plus the change in stockholders’ equity. This imbalance is equal to the change in cash. A business prepares a statement of cash flows by analyzing the changes in the balance sheet accounts. The impact of these changes is reflected in the operating, investing, and financing sections of the statement of cash flows. We will explore the methods of preparation in more detail in the next section.

Sources and Uses of Cash: Categorizing Changes as Operating, Investing, or Financing What makes cash go up, and what makes cash go down? What are the sources of cash and uses of cash?

Sources of Cash Let’s look first at the sources of cash. A business gets cash from one of the following three activities: • Operating the business • Selling long-term assets for cash • Long-term borrowing of cash or having stockholders invest cash in the business When a business provides goods or services, it ultimately receives cash from its ­customers. If a business sells an asset such as a building, it typically receives cash. If a business borrows money, it receives cash. If a business issues stock to its stockholders, it receives cash.

Uses of Cash Now let’s look at how a business uses cash. A business uses cash in one of the following three activities: • Operating the business • Buying long-term assets with cash • Repaying long-term loans with cash, paying cash dividends, or repurchasing its stock with cash

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 543

03/04/14 2:39 PM

544

Chapter 11

A business incurs expenses in order to provide goods or services. Those expenses must ultimately be paid for with cash. If a business buys an asset such as a building, it typically pays cash for part, or all, of the purchase. If a business repays a loan, it pays cash. If a business pays a cash dividend or repurchases its stock (treasury stock), it pays cash. The statement of cash flows categorizes sources and uses of cash as operating, investing, and financing activities. Exhibit 11-2 shows the various parts of the balance sheet that the operating, investing, and financing cash flows affect. Operating cash flows affect the current asset and current liability accounts. Operating cash flows also affect stockholders’ equity through net income. Investing cash flows affect the long-term assets. Financing cash flows affect long-term liabilities and stockholders’ equity. Operating Cash Flows

Current Assets

Investing Cash Flows

Long-Term Assets

Current Liabilities Long-Term Liabilities Stockholders’ Equity

Operating Cash Flows Financing Cash Flows Operating Cash Flows

Exhibit 11-2

Operating Activities The net cash flow from operating activities is equal to cash basis net income or loss. Cash basis net income or loss is computed as follows: • • • • • • •

Accrual basis net income or loss (from the income statement). Plus noncash expenses and losses (from the income statement). Minus noncash revenues and gains (from the income statement). Plus decreases in noncash current assets (from the balance sheet). Minus increases in noncash current assets (from the balance sheet). Plus increases in current liabilities (from the balance sheet). Minus decreases in current liabilities (from the balance sheet).

If the net result is positive, operating activities are a source of cash. If the net result is negative, operating activities are a use of cash. Look at Exhibit 11-2 and visualize what are operating activities. What are you doing when you adjust net income for noncash items and changes in current assets and liabilities? You are converting accrual-based net income to cash-based net income. An example is adjusting net income for the change in Accounts Receivable. Adding or subtracting the change in Accounts Receivable recognizes that all revenue is not cash revenue. Another example is Accounts Payable. Adding or subtracting the change in Accounts Payable recognizes that all expenses are not cash expenses. Cast your mind back to the $500 you were owed from work. You had an Accounts Receivable. Now also think about the $100 you owed for gas. You also had an Accounts Payable. Although you earned $400 net income ($500 − $100), you had zero operating cash flows until you received the cash from your employer ($500) and paid the credit card bill ($100).

Investing Activities Investing activities occur when a business buys and sells long-term assets such as buildings, equipment, intangible assets, and long-term receivables. Cash flows from investing activities are computed as follows: • Increase or decrease in long-term assets (from the balance sheet). • Plus or minus noncash transactions that affect long-term assets (from the income statement and balance sheet). If the net result is positive, investing activities are a use of cash. If the net result is negative, investing activities are a source of cash. Look at Exhibit 11-2 and visualize what are investing activities. Think about trading in your old car for a new car. You own a car that has a book value of $2,000. You go to the car dealer who offers to buy your car for

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 544

03/04/14 2:39 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

545

$2,000 if you buy a new car for $10,000. You agree. You give the car dealer your old car and $8,000 in cash. The dealer gives you a new car worth $10,000. Your long-term assets have increased by $8,000 and you used $8,000 of cash.

Financing Activities Cash flows from financing activities occur when a business borrows money, repays loans, sells stock, repurchases stock (treasury stock), or pays dividends. Cash flows from ­financing activities are computed as: • Increase or decrease in long-term liabilities (from the balance sheet). • Plus the increase in common and preferred stock accounts when common or ­preferred stock is issued for cash (from the balance sheet). • Minus the increase in treasury stock when the company repurchases its stock for cash (from the balance sheet). • Minus the decrease in retained earnings due to paying cash dividends (from the ­balance sheet). If the net result is positive, financing activities are a source of cash. If the net result is negative, financing activities are a use of cash. Look at Exhibit 11-2 and visualize what are financing activities. Think about the cash involved when borrowing and repaying money, selling stock, and paying dividends.

Statement of Cash Flows: Two Formats Indirect method  Format of the operating activities section of the statement of cash flows; it starts with net income and reconciles to net cash provided by operating activities. Direct method  Format of the operating activities section of the statement of cash flows; it lists the cash receipts and cash payments resulting from a company’s day-to-day operations.

A business can use two formats to create the statement of cash flows, the indirect and direct methods. Investing and financing activities are formatted the same in both the indirect and direct methods. The difference between the indirect and direct methods is the format of operating activities. Both the indirect and direct methods report the same net cash flow from operations, but the format is different. • The indirect method starts with net income and adjusts it to net cash provided by operating activities. Most businesses use the indirect method because the user can more easily see how the income statement ties to the balance sheet and the change in cash. • The direct method shows all cash receipts and all cash payments from operating activities. The direct method restates each (accrual-based) item on the income ­statement to a cash basis.

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analyze

Is it important where a business gets and how it spends its cash?

Understanding where a business gets and how it spends its cash can be important in determining the financial health of a ­company. Look at the statement of cash flows to determine where a business got (sources) and spent (used) its cash during the period.

The statement of cash flows is divided into three areas: Operating activities—shows the cash flow from business operations. Investing activities—shows the cash flow from buying and selling long-term assets. Financing activities—shows the cash flow from borrowing and repaying long-term debt, as well as from stockholders’ equity transactions. For a business to remain successful, operating activities must be the main source of its cash over the long run.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 545

03/04/14 2:39 PM

546

Chapter 11

How Is the Statement of Cash Flows Prepared Using the Indirect Method? 3

Prepare the statement of cash flows using the indirect method

Most businesses prefer to use the indirect method because its format makes it easier to reconcile net income to the net cash flow from operating activities for the period. In order to prepare the statement of cash flows, you will need to have the other financial statements, as well as some supplemental information about the company’s operations. The format for the indirect method statement of cash flows for Mackay Industries is presented in Exhibit 11-3.

Mackay Industries, Inc. Statement of Cash Flows Year Ended December 31, 2014 Cash flows from operating activities: Net Income Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:  Depreciation / amortization expense  Loss on sale of long-term assets  Gain on sale of long-term assets  Increases in current assets other than cash  Decreases in current assets other than cash  Increases in current liabilities  Decreases in current liabilities Net cash provided by (used for) operating activities  Cash flows from investing activities:  Cash receipts from sales of long-term assets (investments, land, building, equipment, and so on)  Purchases of long-term assets Net cash provided by (used for) investing activities  Cash flows from financing activities:  Cash receipts from issuance of stock  Sale of treasury stock  Purchase of treasury stock  Cash receipts from issuance of notes or bonds payable (borrowing)  Payment of notes or bonds payable  Payment of dividends Net cash provided by (used for) financing activities  Net increase (decrease) in cash during the year  Cash at December 31, 2013  Cash at December 31, 2014

Exhibit 11-3

Mackay Industries’ financial statements are presented in Exhibit 11-4.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 546

03/04/14 2:39 PM

Exhibit 11-4

Mackay Industries, Inc. Income Statement Year Ended December 31, 2014

B

C A

Revenue: Sales Revenue Interest Revenue Dividend Revenue Total Revenues Expenses: Cost of Goods Sold Salaries Expense Depreciation Expense Other Operating Expense Interest Expense Income Tax Expense Loss on Sale of Fixed Assets Total Expenses Net Income

$268,000 13,000 5,000 $286,000 $137,000 48,000 18,000 12,000 11,000 9,000 3,000 238,000 $ 48,000

Mackay Industries, Inc. Statement of Retained Earnings Year Ended December 31, 2014

M

Retained Earnings, December 31, 2013 Add: Net Income for the Year Subtotal Less: Dividends Retained Earnings, December 31, 2014

$121,000 48,000 169,000 23,000 $146,000

Mackay Industries, Inc. Balance Sheet December 31, 2013 and 2014

D E H/I

F G J/K

L A/M N

2014

2013

INCREASE (DECREASE)

ASSETS Current: Cash Accounts Receivable Inventory Total Current Assets Fixed Assets, Net Total Assets

$ 18,000 76,000 132,000 226,000 385,000 $611,000

$ 11,000 93,000 124,000 228,000 315,000 $543,000

$ 7,000 (17,000) 8,000 (2,000) 70,000 $ 68,000

LIABILITIES Current: Accounts Payable Accrued Liabilities Total Current Liabilities Long-Term Notes Payable Total Liabilities

$ 84,000 12,000 96,000 147,000 243,000

$ 96,000 8,000 104,000 98,000 202,000

$(12,000) 4,000 (8,000) 49,000 41,000

STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY Common Stock Retained Earnings Less: Treasury Stock Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

240,000 146,000 (18,000) 368,000 $611,000

220,000 121,000 0 341,000 $543,000

20,000 25,000 (18,000) 27,000 $ 68,000 547

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 547

03/04/14 2:39 PM

548

Chapter 11

Using these financial statements, let’s prepare Mackay Industries’ statement of cash flows one section at a time. To make things easier to follow, each item on the statement of cash flows has been cross-referenced to the financial statements by a letter.

Cash Flows from Operating Activities The operating activities section of Mackay Industries’ statement of cash flows would look like this:

A

B C D E F G

Cash flows from operating activities: Net Income Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities: Depreciation Expense Loss on sale of fixed assets Decrease in Accounts Receivable Increase in Inventory Decrease in Accounts Payable Increase in Accrued Liabilities Net cash provided by operating activities

$48,000

$ 18,000 3,000 17,000 (8,000) (12,000) 4,000

22,000 70,000

Operating cash flows begin with net income, taken from the income statement. A

  Net Income 

The statement of cash flows—indirect method—begins with net income because revenues and expenses, which affect net income, produce cash receipts and cash payments. Revenues bring in cash receipts, and expenses must be paid. But net income is accrual based, and the accrual basis of revenues and expenses don’t always equal the cash flows (cash basis net income). For example, sales on account are revenues that increase net income, but the company hasn’t yet collected cash from those sales. Accrued expenses decrease your net income, but you haven’t paid cash if the expenses are accrued. To go from net income to net cash flow from operating activities, we must make some adjustments to Net Income on the statement of cash flows. These additions and subtractions follow net income and are labeled “Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities.” B

  Depreciation, Depletion, and Amortization Expenses 

These expenses are added back to net income to reconcile it to net cash flow from operations. Let’s see why. Depreciation expense is recorded as: DATE

ACCOUNTS Depreciation Expense Accumulated Depreciation

POST REF.

DR. 18,000

CR. 18,000

You can see that depreciation expense does not affect cash because there’s no Cash account in the journal entry. However, depreciation, like all the other expenses, decreases net income. Therefore, to go from net income to cash flows, we must add the depreciation expense back to net income. Example: Suppose you had only two transactions during the period: • $50,000 cash sale • Depreciation expense of $20,000

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 548

03/04/14 2:39 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

549

Accrual basis net income is $30,000 ($50,000 − $20,000). But net cash flow from operations is $50,000. To reconcile the net income of $30,000 to the net cash flow from operations of $50,000, add back the $20,000 of depreciation expense. You would also add back depletion and amortization expenses because they are noncash expenses similar to depreciation. C

  Gains and Losses on the Sale of Assets 

Sales of long-term assets such as land and buildings are investing activities. The total cash proceeds from these sales are included in the investing section of the statement of cash flows. However, these sales usually result in a gain or a loss, which is included in net income. Gains and losses do not represent cash flows. Gains and losses are simply the difference between the cash proceeds and the book value of the asset sold. Therefore, gains and losses must be removed from net income on the statement of cash flows. Mackay Industries’ income statement includes a loss on the sale of fixed assets. During 2014, Mackay Industries sold fixed assets resulting in a loss of $3,000 on the sale. Because the loss reduces net income, it is added back to net income to arrive at net cash flow from operating activities. On the other hand, a gain on the sale of fixed assets would increase net income. So, it would be subtracted from net income to arrive at net cash flow from operating activities. D

,

E

,

F

, & G   Changes in the Current Assets and the Current Liabilities 

Most current assets and current liabilities result from operating activities. For example, • Accounts receivable result from sales, • Inventory and accounts payable relate to cost of goods sold, • Prepaid assets and accrued liabilities relate to operating expenses, and so on. Changes in the current asset and current liability accounts create adjustments to net income on the cash flow statement: 1. A decrease in a current asset other than cash causes an increase in cash. Mackay Industries’ Accounts Receivable decreased by $17,000 D . What caused the ­decrease? During the year, Mackay Industries must have collected more cash from credit customers than the current year’s credit sales. This means that $17,000 more was collected from customers than what is represented by the Revenues on the ­income statement. Therefore, the $17,000 decrease in Accounts Receivable is added to net income to arrive at net cash flow from operating activities. A decrease in any current asset other than cash will be added to net income to arrive at net cash flow from operating activities. 2. An increase in a current asset other than cash causes a decrease in cash. It takes cash to acquire assets. If Accounts Receivable, Inventory, or Prepaid Expenses increase, then Cash decreases. Therefore, subtract the increase in the current a­ sset from net income to get net cash flow from operations. For example, Mackay Industries’ Inventory went up by $8,000 E . The $8,000 increase in inventory is not reflected in Cost of Goods Sold on the income statement. However, this ­increase required the payment of cash so it is deducted from net income to arrive at net cash flow from operating activities. An increase in any current asset other than cash will be subtracted from net income to arrive at net cash flow from ­operating activities. 3. A decrease in a current liability causes a decrease in cash. Mackay Industries’ Accounts Payable went down $12,000 F . This means that Mackay Industries paid $12,000 more on its payables than it charged during the current year. However, the amount that Mackay Industries charged on its payables is what is reflected in Cost of Goods Sold and Operating Expenses on the income statement. So, the $12,000 decrease in Accounts Payable is subtracted from net i­ncome to arrive at

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 549

03/04/14 2:39 PM

550

Chapter 11

net cash flow from operating activities. A decrease in any ­current ­liability will be subtracted from net income to arrive at net cash flow from ­operating activities. 4. An increase in a current liability causes an increase in cash. Mackay Industries’ Accrued Liabilities increased by $4,000 G . This means that $4,000 of the operating expenses on the income statement have not yet been paid for. Accordingly, even though net income was reduced by $4,000, cash was not reduced. Therefore, the $4,000 increase in accrued liabilities is added to net income to arrive at net cash flow from operations. An increase in any current liability will be added to net ­income to arrive at net cash flow from operating activities. During 2014, Mackay Industries’ operations provided net cash flow of $70,000. This amount exceeds net income (due to the various adjustments discussed previously). However, to fully evaluate a company’s cash flows, we must also examine its investing and financing activities.

Cash Flows from Investing Activities As shown in Exhibit 11-2, investing activities affect long-term assets, such as Fixed Assets and Investments. The investing section of Mackay Industries’ statement of cash flows is presented next:

H I

Cash flows from investing activities: Acquisition of fixed assets Proceeds from sale of fixed assets Net cash used in investing activities

$(195,000) 104,000 (91,000)

Computing Acquisitions and Sales of Fixed Assets Companies usually keep a separate account for each type of fixed asset. However, for computing investing cash flows, it is helpful to combine all the fixed assets into a single Fixed Assets account. We subtract Accumulated Depreciation from the assets’ cost in ­order to work with a single net figure for fixed assets, such as Fixed Assets, net, $385,000. This simplifies the computations. To illustrate, observe that Mackay Industries’ financial statements presented in Exhibit 11-4 show the following: • The balance sheet reports Fixed Assets, Net of $385,000 at the end of 2014 and $315,000 at the end of 2013. • The income statement shows depreciation expense of $18,000 and a $3,000 loss on sale of fixed assets. The increase in the net amount of fixed assets tells us that Mackay Industries ­acquired fixed assets during 2014. Let’s assume that Mackay Industries’ acquisitions of fixed assets during 2014 consisted of $195,000 of cash purchases. The $195,000 of cash used to purchase the fixed assets will be reported as a cash outflow H in the ­investing section of the statement of cash flows. If any portion of the purchase of fixed assets is financed with notes payable, the amount financed is not included in the cash outflow. The loss on sale of assets reported on the income statement indicates that Mackay Industries sold some older fixed assets. This gives us an incomplete T-account: Fixed Assets, Net 12/31/13 Bal Acquisitions 12/31/14 Bal

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 550

315,000 2012 Depr exp 195,000 Sales 385,000

18,000 ?

03/04/14 2:39 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

551

We can now solve for the net book value of the assets that were sold:

12/31/2013 Balance  Acquisitions  Depreciation Expense  Sales?  12/31/2014 Balance $315,000

 $195,000 

$ 18,000 $492,000

 Sales?   Sales?  Sales 

$385,000 $385,000 $107,000

Our completed T-account now looks like this:

Fixed Assets, Net 12/31/13 Bal Acquisitions 12/31/14 Bal

315,000 2014 Depr exp 195,000 Sales 385,000

18,000 107,000

Once we know the book value of the assets sold, we can calculate the amount of cash received from selling fixed assets by using the journal entry approach: DATE

ACCOUNTS Cash Loss of Sale of Fixed Assets Fixed Assets, Net

POST REF.

DR. ?????? 3,000

CR.

107,000

So, we compute the cash receipt from the sale as:

Cash  Fixed assets, net  loss Cash  $107,000  $3,000 Cash  $104,000

The cash receipt from the sale of fixed assets of $104,000 is shown as item I in the investing activities section of the statement of cash flows. Exhibit 11-5 summarizes the computation of the investing cash flows from the acquisition and sale of fixed assets. Items to be computed are shown in blue. The investing section of the statement of cash flows will also include cash outflows for the purchase of investments and for any amounts lent to others under long-term notes receivable. Cash inflows reported in the investing section of the statement of cash flows will include proceeds from the sale of investments and any payments received on long-term notes receivable. As we can see, Mackay Industries used $91,000 in investing activities. Now let’s examine the financing section of the statement of cash flows.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 551

03/04/14 2:40 PM

552

Chapter 11

Cash Receipts From sale of fixed assets

Beginning fixed  assets (net)

Cash receipt



Acquisition



Depreciation Book value of Ending fixed   Expense assets sold assets (net)

 Gain on sale Book value of or assets sold  Loss on sale

Cash Payments For acquisition of fixed assets

Beginning fixed  assets (net)

Acquisition* 

Depreciation Book value of Ending fixed   Expense assets sold assets (net)

*Any portion of the acquisition that is financed by a note payable must be deducted from the amount of cash paid.

Exhibit 11-5

Cash Flows from Financing Activities As shown in Exhibit 11-2, financing activities affect the long-term liability and stockholders’ equity accounts, such as Long-Term Notes Payable, Bonds Payable, Common Stock, and Retained Earnings (excluding net income). The financing section of Mackay Industries’ statement of cash flows is presented next:

J L K M N

Cash flows from financing activities: Proceeds from issuance of long-term notes payable Proceeds from issuance of common stock Payment of long-term notes payable Payment of dividends Purchase of treasury stock Net cash provided by financing activities

$ 75,000 20,000 (26,000) (23,000) (18,000) 28,000

Computing Issuances and Payments of Long-Term Notes Payable The beginning and ending balances of Notes Payable or Bonds Payable are found on the balance sheet. If either the amount of new issuances or payments is known, the other amount can be computed. For Mackay Industries, Inc., let’s assume that during 2014, $75,000 was borrowed on a long-term note payable. We can use the amount of the note proceeds and the beginning and ending balances of Notes Payable from Mackay Industries’ balance sheet in Exhibit 11-4 to create the following incomplete T-account: Long-Term Notes Payable Note payments

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 552

12/31/13 Bal ? New notes 12/31/14 Bal

98,000 75,000 147,000

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

553

Then solve for the missing payments value:

12/31/13 Bal  New notes issued  Note payments?  12/31/14 Bal $98,000



$ 75,000 $173,000

 Note payments?  $147,000  Note payments?  $147,000 Note payments  $ 26,000

The completed T-account looks like this: Long-Term Notes Payable Note payments

12/31/13 Bal 26,000 New notes 12/31/14 Bal

98,000 75,000 147,000

The $75,000 cash received is reflected as a cash inflow J in the financing section of the statement of cash flows. The payment of $26,000 is reflected as a cash outflow K in the financing section of the statement of cash flows.

Computing Issuances of Stock Cash flows for these financing activities can be determined by analyzing the stock accounts. We can see from looking at the data in Exhibit 11-4 that the balance in the Common Stock account increased by $20,000. Because we were not told about any stock retirements, we can assume there were none. Therefore, the $20,000 change in the Common Stock balance must be due to new stock issuances. We will assume the stock was issued in exchange for cash, so the $20,000 will be reflected as a cash inflow L in the financing section of the statement of cash flows.

Computing Dividend Payments The amount of dividends that were declared during the year can be found on the statement of retained earnings. From the statement of retained earnings in Exhibit 11-4, we see that Mackay Industries declared $23,000 of dividends during 2014. Remember, a stock dividend has no effect on Cash and is, therefore, not reported on the statement of cash flows. We will assume that all of Mackay Industries’ dividends were cash dividends. Because there were no beginning or ending balances in Dividends Payable on the balance sheet, we can conclude that the entire $23,000 (and no more) was paid during 2014. Therefore, the $23,000 will be reflected as a cash outflow M in the financing section of the statement of cash flows. If the statement of retained earnings is unavailable, the amount of dividends declared can be computed by analyzing the Retained Earnings account. Remember, Retained Earnings increases when companies earn net income. Retained Earnings also decreases when companies have a net loss and when they declare dividends. We can use the amount of the Net Income and the beginning and ending balances of Retained Earnings (from Mackay Industries’ financial statements in Exhibit 11-4) to create an incomplete T-account: Retained Earnings Dividends

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 553

12/31/13 Bal ? Net income 12/31/14 Bal

121,000 48,000 146,000

03/04/14 2:40 PM

554

Chapter 11

Then solve for the missing amount of dividends declared:

12/31/13 Bal  Net income  Dividends?  12/31/14 Bal $121,000  $ 48,000  Dividends?  $146,000 $169,000  Dividends?  $146,000 Dividends  $ 23,000 The completed T-account looks like this: Retained Earnings Dividends

12/31/13 Bal 23,000 Net income 12/31/14 Bal

121,000 48,000 146,000

Purchases and Sales of Treasury Stock The last item that changed on Mackay Industries’ balance sheet was Treasury Stock. Because we were not told that any treasury stock was sold, we must assume that 100% of the account change represents new acquisitions of treasury stock. So, $18,000 is shown as a cash outflow in the financing section of the cash flow statement for the purchase of treasury stock N .

Net Change in Cash and Cash Balances The cash provided by or used in operating, investing, and financing activities is totaled to arrive at the net increase of $7,000 in cash. Next, the beginning cash of $11,000 from December 31, 2013, is listed. The net increase of $7,000 is added to the beginning cash of $11,000 to get the ending cash balance on December 31, 2014, of $18,000. The completed statement of cash flows for Mackay Industries, Inc., is presented in Exhibit 11-6. You can see why the statement of cash flows is so valuable. It explains why the cash balance for Mackay Industries increased by only $7,000, even though the company reported net income for the year of $48,000.

Noncash Investing and Financing Activities The operating, investing, and financing sections of the statement of cash flows only reflect activity that results from the exchange of cash. But companies may make investments that do not require cash. They may also obtain financing for other reasons than to acquire cash. These types of transactions are called noncash investing and financing activities. Although these transactions do not affect cash, they still affect the long-term assets, long-term liabilities, and stockholders’ equity of a business. In order to provide financial statement users with complete information, all noncash investing and financing activities are reported. Noncash investing and financing activities can be reported in a separate schedule that accompanies the statement of cash flows or disclosed in a financial statement footnote.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 554

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

555

Mackay Industries Statement of Cash Flows Year Ended December 31, 2014 A

B C D E F G

H I

J L K M N

Cash flows from operating activities: Net Income Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities: Depreciation Expense Loss on sale of fixed assets Decrease in Accounts Receivable Increase in Inventory Decrease in Accounts Payable Increase in Accrued Liabilities Net cash provided by operating activities Cash flows from investing activities: Acquisition of fixed assets Proceeds from sale of fixed assets Net cash used in investing activities

$ 48,000

$ 18,000 3,000 17,000 (8,000) (12,000) 4,000

22,000 70,000

(195,000) 104,000 (91,000)

Cash flows from financing activities: Proceeds from issuance of long-term notes payable Proceeds from issuance of common stock Payment of long-term notes payable Payment of dividends Purchase of treasury stock Net cash provided by financing activities

75,000 20,000 (26,000) (23,000) (18,000) 28,000

Net increase in cash: Cash balance, December 31, 2013 Cash balance, December 31, 2014

7,000 11,000 $ 18,000

Exhibit 11-6 Our Mackay Industries example did not include noncash transactions because the company did not have any transactions of this type during the year. So, to illustrate the reporting of noncash transactions, let’s consider the following three noncash transactions for Tucker Enterprises. 1. Tucker Enterprises issues $450,000 of no-par common stock in exchange for a building. The journal entry to record the purchase would be: DATE

ACCOUNTS Building Common Stock Exchanged stock for a building.

POST REF.

DR. 450,000

CR. 450,000

The purchase of the building is an investing activity. The issuance of common stock is a financing activity. However, this transaction is not reported in the ­investing and financing sections of the statement of cash flows because no cash is exchanged. Instead, this transaction is reported as a noncash investing and ­financing activity.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 555

03/04/14 2:40 PM

556

Chapter 11

2. Tucker Enterprises acquired $120,000 of land by issuing a note. The journal entry to record the purchase would be: DATE

ACCOUNTS Land Notes Payable Purchased land.

POST REF.

DR. 120,000

CR. 120,000

The purchase of the land is an investing activity. The issuance of the note is a ­financing activity. Once again, this transaction is not reported in the investing and financing sections of the statement of cash flows because no cash is exchanged. Instead, this transaction is reported as a noncash investing and financing activity. 3. Tucker Enterprises issued $80,000 of no-par common stock to settle a debt. The journal entry to record the transaction would be: DATE

ACCOUNTS Notes Payable Common Stock Settled note payable by issuing common stock.

POST REF.

DR. 80,000

CR. 80,000

The settlement of the note and the issuance of the common stock are both financing activities. But, because no cash is involved, this transaction will not be reported in the financing section of the statement of cash flows. It is reported as a noncash investing and financing activity. Exhibit 11-7 illustrates how the noncash investing and financing activities for Tucker Enterprises would be presented. Tucker Enterprises Statement of Cash Flows—Partial Year Ended December 31, 2014 Noncash investing and financing activities: Issued 10,000 shares of common stock in exchange for a building Issued a note payable in exchange for land Issued 1,800 shares of common stock to settle note payable

$450,000 120,000 80,000

Exhibit 11-7

Try It… Alpine Manufacturing purchased a new piece of equipment costing $45,000. Alpine paid $5,000 cash down and signed a long-term note for the remainder. What types of activities (operating, financing, or investing) are represented by this transaction? How would this transaction be reported in Alpine Manufacturing’s statement of cash flows?

Answer

Because this transaction involves both the purchase of new fixed assets and the issuance of a long-term note payable, it represents both an investing activity and a financing activity. However, on Alpine Manufacturing’s statement of cash flows, only $5,000 will be reflected in the investing section as an outflow of cash for the purchase of fixed ­assets. The remaining $40,000 will be reflected as a noncash investing and financing activity in a separate schedule.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 556

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

557

How Is the Statement of Cash Flows Prepared Using the Direct Method? 4

Prepare the statement of cash flows using the direct method

Although most companies utilize the indirect method of reporting cash flows from operating activities, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) prefers the ­ ­direct method. The direct method provides clearer information about the sources and uses of cash from operating activities than the indirect method. Investing and financing cash flows are presented exactly the same under both direct and indirect methods. To illustrate how the operating section of the statement of cash flows differs for the direct method, we will be using the Mackay Industries, Inc., data we used with the indirect method. The format for the direct method statement of cash flows for Mackay Industries is presented in Exhibit 11-8.

Mackay Industries, Inc. Statement of Cash Flows Year Ended December 31, 2014 Cash flows from operating activities: Receipts: Collections from customers Interest received Dividends received on investments Total cash receipts Payments: To suppliers To employees For interest For income taxes Total cash payments Net cash provided by (used for) operating activities  Cash flows from investing activities:  Cash receipts from sales of long-term assets (investments, land, building, equipment, and so on)  Purchases of long-term assets Net cash provided by (used for) investing activities  Cash flows from financing activities:  Cash receipts from issuance of stock  Sale of treasury stock  Purchase of treasury stock  Cash receipts from issuance of notes or bonds payable (borrowing)  Payment of notes or bonds payable  Payment of dividends Net cash provided by (used for) financing activities  Net increase (decrease) in cash during the year  Cash at December 31, 2013  Cash at December 31, 2014

Exhibit 11-8

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 557

03/04/14 2:40 PM

558

Chapter 11

Mackay Industries’ completed direct method statement of cash flows for 2014 is ­presented in Exhibit 11-9.

Mackay Industries Statement of Cash Flows Year Ended December 31, 2014

A B C

D E F G

Cash flows from operating activities: Receipts: Collections from customers Interest received Dividends received Total cash receipts Payments: To suppliers To employees For interest For taxes Total cash payments Net cash provided by operating activities Cash flows from investing activities: Acquisition of fixed assets Proceeds from sale of fixed assets Net cash used in investing activities Cash flows from financing activities: Proceeds from issuance of long-term notes payable Proceeds from issuance of common stock Payment of long-term notes payable Payment of dividends Purchase of treasury stock Net cash provided by financing activities Net increase in cash: Cash balance, December 31, 2013 Cash balance, December 31, 2014

$ 285,000 13,000 5,000 $ 303,000 (165,000) (48,000) (11,000) (9,000) (233,000) 70,000

(195,000) 104,000 (91,000)

75,000 20,000 (26,000) (23,000) (18,000) 28,000 7,000 11,000 $ 18,000

Exhibit 11-9 Now, we’ll explain how we calculated each number.

Cash Flows from Operating Activities In the indirect method, we start with net income and then adjust it to “cash-basis” through a series of adjusting items. In the direct method, we convert each line item on the income statement from accrual to cash basis. So, in essence, the operating activities section of the direct method statement of cash flows is really just a cash-basis income statement.

Depreciation, Depletion, and Amortization Expense As these expenses do not require the payment of cash, they are not reported on the direct method statement of cash flows.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 558

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows A

559

  Cash Collections from Customers 

The first item on the income statement is Sales Revenue of $268,000. Sales Revenue represents the total of all sales, whether for cash or on account. The balance sheet accounts related to Sales Revenue are Accounts Receivable and Unearned Revenues. Accounts Receivable decreased $17,000 from $93,000 at December 31, 2013 to $76,000 at December 31, 2014. A decrease in Accounts Receivable means that Mackay Industries collected more cash than it made in sales during the current year. This means that the cash receipts from customers during the year are $17,000 greater than Sales Revenues. The balance sheet shows no unearned revenues, so no adjustment is needed for unearned revenues. We can calculate the cash received from customers:

Sales Revenue.................................................. Plus decrease in Accounts Receivable ............. Cash receipts from customers ......................... B

$268,000 17,000 $285,000

  Cash Receipts of Interest 

The second item on the income statement is Interest Revenue of $13,000. The balance sheet account related to Interest Revenue is Interest Receivable. Because there is no Interest Receivable account on the balance sheet, the Interest Revenue must have all been received in cash. So, the cash flow statement shows Interest Received of $13,000. Had there been Interest Receivable in either year, the accrual basis Interest Revenue would have been converted to cash basis in a manner similar to that used for Sales Revenue and Accounts Receivable. C

  Cash Receipts of Dividends 

Dividend Revenue is the third item reported on the income statement of $5,000. The balance sheet account related to Dividend Revenue is Dividends Receivable. As with the interest, there is no Dividends Receivable on the balance sheet. Therefore, the Dividend Revenue must have all been received in cash. So, the cash flow statement shows cash received from dividends of $5,000. D

  Payments to Suppliers 

Payments to suppliers include all payments for: • Inventory and • Operating expenses except employee compensation, interest, and income taxes. Suppliers are those entities that provide the business with its inventory and essential services. The accounts related to payments to suppliers for inventory are Cost of Goods Sold, Inventory, and Accounts Payable. Cost of Goods Sold on the income statement was $137,000. Inventory increased from $124,000 at 12/31/13 to $132,000 at 12/31/14. The $8,000 ($132,000 - $124,000) increase in Inventory means that Mackay Industries purchased more inventory than it sold during the year. This means that the total amount of inventory purchased during the year would be $145,000.

Cost of Goods Sold ........................ Plus increase in Inventory.............. Total inventory purchased ..............

$137,000 8,000 $145,000

Next, we need to consider the change in Accounts Payable to determine the total cash payments for inventory purchased during the year. Accounts Payable decreased from $96,000 at 12/31/13 to $84,000 at 12/31/14. The $12,000 decrease ($96,000 - $84,000)

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 559

03/04/14 2:40 PM

560

Chapter 11

in Accounts Payable means that Mackay Industries paid $12,000 more during the year than the amount of inventory purchased. So, the cash payments for inventory purchased during the year can be calculated as:

Total inventory purchased ............................ Plus decrease in Accounts Payable.............. Cash payments for inventory .......................

$145,000 12,000 $157,000

The accounts related to payments for other operating expenses are Other Operating Expenses, Prepaid Expenses, and Accrued Liabilities. Other Operating Expenses on the income statement were $12,000. There are no Prepaid Expenses on the balance sheet, so no adjustment is needed for changes in Prepaid Expenses. Accrued Liabilities increased from $8,000 at 12/31/13 to $12,000 at 12/31/14. This means that Mackay Industries incurred more operating expenses than it paid for during the year. By subtracting the $4,000 ($12,000 - $8,000) from the operating expenses, we get the amount of cash payments for other operating expenses:

Other Operating Expenses.................................. Less increase in Accrued Liabilities ................... Cash payments for other operating expenses ....

$12,000 4,000 $ 8,000

Finally, by adding the cash paid to suppliers for inventory to the cash paid to suppliers for other operating expenses, we get the total cash paid to suppliers of $165,000.

Cash payments for inventory ............................. Cash payments for other operating expenses .... Total cash payments to suppliers....................... E

$157,000 8,000 $165,000

  Payments to Employees 

This category includes payments for salaries, wages, and other forms of employee compensation. The accounts related to employee payments are Salaries Expense from the income statement and Salaries Payable from the balance sheet. Because there aren’t any Salaries Payable on the balance sheet, the Salaries Expense account must represent all amounts paid in cash to employees. So, the cash flow statement shows cash payments to employees of $48,000. Had there been any Salaries Payable, the Salaries Expense account would have been adjusted to arrive at the cash paid to employees in a manner similar to how other operating expenses were adjusted for accrued liabilities previously. F

  Payments for Interest Expense 

These cash payments are reported separately from the other expenses. The accounts related to interest payments are Interest Expense from the income statement and ­ Interest Payable from the balance sheet. Because there is no Interest Payable on the balance sheet, the Interest Expense from the income statement must represent all ­ amounts paid in cash for interest. So, the cash flow statement shows cash payments for interest of $11,000. G

  Payments for Income Tax Expense 

Like interest expense, these cash payments are reported separately from the other ­expenses. The accounts related to income tax payments are Income Tax Expense from the income statement and Income Tax Payable from the balance sheet. Again, because there is no Income Tax Payable on the balance sheet, the Income Tax Expense from the

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 560

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

561

income statement must represent all amounts paid in cash for income tax. Therefore, the cash flow statement shows cash payments for income tax of $9,000.

Gains and Losses on the Sale of Fixed Assets The last item on the income statement is a loss on sale of fixed assets of $3,000. Remember that gains and losses do not represent cash flows. The cash flow related to the sale of a fixed asset equals the proceeds from the sale of the asset. As with the indirect method, the proceeds from the sale of the asset are reported in the investing section, not the operating section.

Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities To calculate net cash provided by operating activities using the direct method, we add all the cash receipts and cash payments described previously and find the difference. For Mackay Industries, Inc., total Cash receipts were $303,000. Total Cash payments were $233,000. So, net cash provided by operating activities is $70,000. If you refer back to the indirect method cash flow statement shown in Exhibit 11-6, you will find that it showed the same $70,000 for net cash provided by operating activities—only the method by which it was calculated was different. The remainder of Mackay Industries’ cash flow statement using the direct method is exactly the same as what we calculated using the indirect method. (See Exhibit 11-6.)

Focus on Decision Making “How Do Businesses Manage Cash Flow?”

A business needs cash. If it doesn’t have enough cash, it will fail. However, it may also have too much cash. Managing and financing the asset cash is expensive. The benefits of holding cash should exceed the costs. So how do businesses look at and manage cash flow? They often use two measures, free cash flow and the cash conversion cycle.

5

Evaluate a company’s performance with respect to cash

Free cash flow  The amount of cash available from operations after paying for investments in long-term assets.

Free Cash Flow

The statement of cash flows is a useful tool for examining the sources and uses of cash during an accounting period. However, investors may want to know how much cash a company anticipates it can “free up” for new opportunities, to reduce debt, or to pay dividends. Free cash flow is the amount of cash available from operations after paying for investments in long-term assets. Free cash flow is fundamentally net cash flow from operations minus cash payments for investments in long-term assets. Free cash flow can be computed as:1

Free Cash Flow  Net Cash Flow from Operations  Cash Payments for Investments in Long-Term Assets Many companies use free cash flow to manage their operations. Suppose Tucker Enterprises has net cash provided by operations of $160,000 during the year. Tucker Enterprises also spent $85,000 to purchase new equipment. In this case, Tucker Enterprises’ free cash flow would be $75,000 ($160,000 − $85,000). If a good investment opportunity comes along (or an anticipated need for cash), Tucker Enterprises should have $75,000 of free cash available. It could also use the $75,000 to pay off debts or to pay dividends. 1

Free cash flow is often used to value a business. To do so, financial analysts measure free cash flow differently. Financial analysts add back the after-tax cost of interest to operating cash flow, producing an adjusted operating cash flow free of all transactions dealing with debt or stockholders’ equity. The revised free cash flow is then computed by subtracting investments in long-term assets from this adjusted operating cash flow. The total value of the business, both debt and stockholders’ equity, is then estimated using this revised free cash flow.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 561

03/04/14 2:40 PM

562

Chapter 11

Cash Conversion Cycle Cash conversion cycle  A measurement of the amount of time a company’s cash is tied up in its operations.

The cash conversion cycle represents the time it takes a company to sell its ­inventory and collect its receivables, less the time it takes the company to pay its payables. In other words, the cash conversion cycle represents the number of days a company’s cash is “tied up” in the operations of the business. The cash conversion cycle is calculated as:

Cash Conversion Cycle  (Days-Sales-In-Inventory)  (Receivable Collection Period)  (Accounts Payable Payment Period) Days-sales-in-inventory tells you how many days it takes to convert inventory into a sale. Look back at Chapter 5 and see how to compute days-sales-in-inventory. The receivable collection period tells you how many days it takes to convert the accounts receivable into cash. Look back at Chapter 7 and see how to compute the receivable collection period. The accounts payable payment period tells you how many days it takes to pay accounts payable. The accounts payable payment period is calculated as:

Accounts Payable Payment Period 

Average Accounts Payable (Cost of Goods Sold/365 Days)

Average accounts payable is computed by adding the beginning and ending accounts payable and dividing the total by two. Remember that balance sheet accounts, such as accounts payable, carry their balances from one period to the next. The ending accounts payable for one year becomes the beginning accounts payable for the next year. Let’s assume that Tucker Enterprises has a days-sales-in-inventory of 52 days, a receivable collection period of 34 days, and an accounts payable payment period of 39 days. Tucker Enterprises’ cash conversion cycle would equal 47 days (52 + 34 - 39). This means that, on average, Tucker Enterprises’ cash is tied up for 47 days. Generally, the lower the cash conversion cycle, the healthier the company. This is because cash is the lifeblood of a business, and the shorter the length of time it is “tied up,” the better. Over time, if the cash conversion cycle for a business grows longer, it can be a sign that the business may be facing a pending cash flow “crunch.” 45 – 90 days

onv er

days

flow crunch

Healthy ca sh c

sh

+ 90

sio n

er cash conversion

Ca

0–4 5 da ys

Long

How They Do It: A Look at Business

Let’s look at two businesses, Delta Airlines and Procter & Gamble. First, let’s look at Delta Airlines. Delta uses its airplanes to fly people all over the world. It buys its planes with long-term financing, both debt and stockholders’ equity.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 562

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

563

It then buys fuel and other supplies, using accounts payable. It does not pay cash. It charges passengers, like you and me, for flying us from one place to another. Typically, we do not pay cash. We pay Delta, or a travel agency such as Expedia, with a credit card, a promise of cash in the near future. If we pay a travel agency, then the travel agency collects the cash and pays Delta eventually. Delta then pays its accounts payable to suppliers, employees, and other operating obligations (renting of airport gates). This process creates operating cash flow that can then be used to make planned investments in long-term assets, such as new planes. What results is free cash flow. For the year ending December 31, 2012, Delta’s days-sales-in-inventory was 8.2 days, receivable collection period was 16.2 days, and accounts payable payment period was 20.6 days. Delta’s cash conversion cycle was 3.8 days (8.2 days + 16.2 days – 20.6 days = 3.8 days). Procter & Gamble (P&G) manufactures household products such as Cover Girl cosmetics, Gillette razors, Crest toothpaste, Duracell batteries, and Tide detergent. It buys ingredients and makes products. These ingredients and products are P&G’s inventory. It then sells its inventory to retailers such as Kroger food stores. However, Kroger does not immediately pay P&G, and P&G has a receivable from Kroger. When Kroger pays P&G, cash is received and the receivable goes away. P&G then is obligated to pay cash to pay its suppliers. This process creates operating cash flow that can then be used to make planned investments in long-term assets, such as new factories. What results is free cash flow. For the fiscal year ending June 30, 2012, P&G’s days-sales-in-inventory was 60.7 days, receivable collection period was 26.9 days, and accounts payable payment period was 68.6 days. P&G’s cash conversion cycle was 18.9 days (60.7 days + 26.9 days – 68.6 days = 19.0 days). Now think about Delta and P&G. Think about what they do and how they do it. Delta’s cash conversion cycle was 3.8 days versus P&G’s cash conversion cycle which was 19 days. P&G had more cash “tied up” in operations than Delta. Why the difference? It’s all about how they manage inventory, receivables, and payables.

The Statement of Cash Flows: Putting It All Together

The old adage that “cash is king” is true. A business that cannot manage its cash flows will fail. Managers and other decision makers need to understand a business’s cash flows. Remember that accrual accounting reports transactions when they occur, regardless if cash is received or paid. Remember that net income is not cash. So, how do accountants help managers and other decision makers understand where a business gets and uses its cash? The answer is that accountants create a statement that explains why a business’s cash increased or decreased during a period of time. This statement is called the statement of cash flows. The statement of cash flows shows the impact on cash of transactions reported on the income statement and balance sheet. The statement categorizes transactions affecting cash into either operating, investing, or financing activities. Operating activities relate to the receipt and payment of cash for the revenues and expenses reported in the income statement. Investing activities relate to the receipt and payment of cash to buy and sell long-term assets, such as buildings and equipment. Financing activities relate to the receipt and payment of cash from and to the providers of long-term financing, both lenders and stockholders. So, think about managing a business. Think about how the income statement, balance sheet, and statement of cash flows combine to create a complete picture of a business’s operations. Think about how accountants provide managers and other decision makers a complete picture of how a business generates value.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 563

03/04/14 2:40 PM

564

Chapter 11

Summary MyAccountingLab

1

2

Here is what you should know after reading this chapter. MyAccountingLab will help you identify what you know and where to go when you need practice.

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Identify the purposes and importance of the statement of cash flows

The statement of cash flows is the report created to ­explain why a business’s cash changed in a period of time.

Cash flow statement (p. 540)

Differentiate between cash flows from operating, investing, and financing activities

The statement of cash flows is created to show the sources and uses of cash from operating activities, investing activities, and financing activities. Operating activities relate to cash receipts from revenues and cash payments for expenses. Investing activities relate to cash transactions for the purchase and sale of long-term ­assets. Financing activities relate to cash transactions for the borrowing and repayment of long-term liabilities, the issuance of stock, the repurchase of stock, and the ­payments of dividends.

Direct method (p. 545)

3

Prepare the statement of cash flows using the indirect method

Businesses typically use the indirect method to create the statement of cash flows. The indirect method starts by reporting operating activities as net income, adjusted for noncash revenues/gains and expenses/losses, changes in noncash current assets, and changes in current liabilities. Investing activities are reported as changes in long-term assets, adjusted for noncash transactions. Financing activities are reported as changes in long-term liabilities and stockholders’ equity accounts, adjusted for noncash transactions. The payment of dividends is included as a financing activity.

4

Prepare the statement of cash flows using the direct method

Sometimes businesses create a statement of cash flows using the direct method. Investing and financing activities are reported just like with the indirect method. All that differs is how operating activities are reported. The cash provided by and used by the individual elements of the income statement are reported separately in the direct method, showing the cash provided and used by sales, cost of goods sold, operating expense, etc.

5

Evaluate a company’s performance with respect to cash

Cash is a critical resource of the business. A business cannot exist in the long term if it cannot pay its obligations. Thus, where a business gets and uses its cash is very important. The statement of cash flows helps ­address this concern.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 564

Statement of cash flows (p. 540)

Financing activities (p. 540) Indirect method (p. 545) Investing activities (p. 540) Operating activities (p. 540)

Cash conversion cycle (p. 562) Free cash flow (p. 561)

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

565

Accounting Practice Discussion Questions 1. What are some of the reasons why a statement of cash flows may be important to users of financial statements? 2. A company used cash to build a new factory and received cash when it sold off the machines in the old factory. In which section of the statement of cash flows would the cash flows from these activities be reported? 3. A company used cash to pay employees and received cash from performing services. In which section of the statement of cash flows would the cash flows from these activities be reported? 4. A company issued bonds during the year. Would this be reported as a source or use of cash on the statement of cash flows? In which section would it be reported? 5. Why is net income a good place to start when attempting to determine the cash flows from operating activities using the indirect method? Why is it not the same as the net cash flow from operating activities? 6. When using the indirect method, why are gains on the sale of fixed assets subtracted from net income in the operating activities section of the statement of cash flows? Why are losses on the sale of fixed assets added to net income? 7. Assuming the indirect method is used, how does an increase in accounts receivable during the year affect the statement of cash flows (if at all)? Why? 8. Why would a decrease in accounts payable be shown as a decrease in cash when using the indirect method of calculating the cash flows from operating activities? 9. How would the sale of treasury stock that was acquired three years ago appear in the statement of cash flows (if at all)? 10. A company’s cash conversion cycle increased from 55 days in year 1 to 68 days in year 3. What are the implications of this increase? What do you think happens to the cash conversion cycles of companies during a recession?

Self Check 1. The three main categories of cash flows reported on a cash flow statement are a. current, long-term, and fixed. b. short-term, long-term, and equity. c. direct, indirect, and hybrid. d. operating, investing, and financing. 2. Operating activities are most closely related to: a. long-term assets. b. current assets and current liabilities. c. long-term liabilities and stockholders’ equity. d. net income and dividends. 3. Financing activities are most closely related to a. long-term assets. b. current assets and current liabilities. c. long-term liabilities and stockholders’ equity. d. net income and dividends.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 565

03/04/14 2:40 PM

566

Chapter 11 4. Which item does not appear on a statement of cash flows prepared by the indirect method? a. Net income b. Gain on sale of land c. Collections from customers d. Depreciation expense 5. Finlay, Inc., earned net income of $63,000 after deducting depreciation expense of $12,000 and all other expenses. Current assets increased by $11,000, and current liabilities decreased by $13,000. Using the indirect method, how much was Finlay, Inc.’s net cash flow from operating activities? a. $37,000 b. $39,000 c. $51,000 d. $27,000 6. The Fixed Assets account of Hamilton, Inc., shows:

Fixed Assets, Net Beginning balance Purchase Ending balance

91,000 Depreciation expense 365,000 Sale 376,000

30,000 ?

Hamilton, Inc., sold fixed assets at an $18,000 gain. How much should Hamilton, Inc., report for the sale? a. Cash flows from investing activities, $18,000 b. Cash flows from investing activities, $68,000 c. Cash flows from investing activities, $32,000 d. Cash flows from investing activities, $50,000 7. Minot Corporation borrowed $14,000, issued common stock of $11,000, and paid dividends of $16,000. What was Minot Corporation’s net cash provided or used by financing activities? a. $(5,000) b. $16,000 c. $9,000 d. $41,000 8. Which item appears on a statement of cash flows prepared by the indirect method? a. Payment of income tax b. Payment to suppliers c. Collections from customers d. Net income 9. SRS Systems, Inc., had accounts receivable of $27,000 at the beginning of the year and $56,000 at year-end. Revenue for the year totaled $106,000. How much cash did SRS Systems collect from customers? a. $189,000 b. $162,000 c. $77,000 d. $133,000

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 566

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

567

10. Elliot Enterprises had operating expenses of $51,000. At the beginning of the year, Elliot Enterprises owed $10,000 on accrued liabilities. At year-end, accrued liabilities were $17,000. How much cash did Elliot Enterprises pay for operating expenses? a. $41,000 b. $44,000 c. $61,000 d. $58,000 11. According to the Real World Accounting Video, a ________________ is a business that sells product to other businesses for resale. a. retail business b. wholesale business c. mixed business d. flow-through 12. According to the Real World Accounting Video, Fishs Eddy uses a(n) ________________ to help finance its operations when there is a temporary need for cash. a. stock sale b. bond c. accounts payable d. line of credit Answers are given after Written Communication.

MyAccountingLab

Short Exercises S11-1. Purpose of the statement of cash flows (Learning Objective 1) 5–10 min. Describe how the statement of cash flows helps investors and creditors perform each of the following functions: 1. Predict future cash flows 2. Evaluate management decisions 3. Predict the ability to make debt payments to lenders and pay dividends to stockholders S11-2. Basics of statement of cash flows (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Answer these questions about the statement of cash flows: 1. What is the “check figure” for the statement of cash flows? Where do you get this check figure? 2. List the categories of cash flows in order of importance. 3. What is the first dollar amount reported using the indirect method? S11-3. Purpose of statement of cash flows (Learning Objective 1) 5–10 min. Icemountain, Inc., experienced an unbroken string of 10 years of growth in net income. Nevertheless, the business is facing bankruptcy. Creditors are calling all of Icemountain’s outstanding loans for immediate payment, and Icemountain, Inc., has no cash available to make these payments because managers placed undue emphasis on net income and gave too little attention to cash flows. Write a brief memo in your own words to explain to the managers of Icemountain, Inc., the purposes of the statement of cash flows.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 567

03/04/14 2:40 PM

568

Chapter 11 S11-4. Classification of items as operating, investing, or financing (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Identify each of the following transactions as one of the following:

• Operating activity (O) • Investing activity (I) • Financing activity (F) • Noncash investing and financing activity (NIF) For each item, indicate whether it represents an increase (+) or a decrease (–) in cash. The indirect method is used to report cash flows from operating activities. a. _____ Cash sale of land b. _____ Issuance of long-term note payable in exchange for cash c. _____ Depreciation expense of equipment d. _____ Purchase of treasury stock e. _____ Issuance of common stock for cash f. _____ Increase in Accounts Payable g. _____ Net income h. _____ Payment of cash dividend i. _____ Decrease in Accrued Liabilities j. _____ Loss on sale of land k. _____ Acquisition of building by issuance of notes payable l. _____ Payment of long-term debt m. _____ Acquisition of building by issuance of common stock n. _____ Decrease in Accounts Receivable o. _____ Decrease in Inventory p.  _____ Increase in prepaid expenses

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 568

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

569

S11-5. Classification of items as operating, investing, or financing (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Indicate whether each of the following transactions would result in an operating activity, an investing activity, a financing activity, or a transaction that does not affect cash for a statement of cash flows prepared by the indirect method. DATE a. b. c. d. e. f. g. h. i. j. k.

ACCOUNTS Equipment Cash Cash Long-Term Investment Bonds Payable Cash Building Notes Payable, Long-Term Loss on Disposal of Equipment Equipment Dividends Payable Cash Cash Common Stock Treasury Stock Cash Cash Sales Revenue Land Cash Depreciation Expense Accumulated Depreciation

POST REF.

DR. 13,000

CR. 13,000

7,500 7,500 500,000 500,000 180,000 180,000 1,000 1,000 15,000 15,000 80,000 80,000 10,000 10,000 65,000 65,000 83,500 83,500 9,200 9,200

S11-6. Operating activities—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Lake Norman Company reported a net income of $205,000 for the current year. Depreciation recorded on equipment amounted to $5,000 for the year. Balances of the current accounts at the beginning and end of the year are as follows:

Accounts Receivable ....................................... Accounts Payable............................................

End of Year

Beginning of Year

$32,000 18,000

$42,000 24,000

Prepare the cash flows from the operating activities section of the statement of cash flows using the indirect method.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 569

03/04/14 2:40 PM

570

Chapter 11 S11-7. Operating activities—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Barjawi Company reported a net income of $450,000 for 2014. Depreciation recorded on buildings and equipment amounted to $53,000 for the year. Balances of the ­current asset and current liability accounts at the beginning and end of the year are as below. Prepare the cash flows from the operating activities section of the statement of cash flows using the indirect method.

Cash................................................................ Accounts receivable ........................................ Inventory......................................................... Office supplies ................................................ Accounts payable............................................ Income taxes payable......................................

End of Year

Beginning of Year

$22,000 18,000 45,000 8,500 10,000 500

$15,000 30,000 75,000 5,000 19,000 1,300

S11-8. Operating activities—direct method (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. Nemo’s Spas began 2014 with cash of $32,000. During the year, Nemo’s Spas earned service revenue of $610,000 and collected $572,000 from customers. Expenses for the year totaled $449,000, of which Nemo’s Spas paid $417,000 in cash to suppliers and employees. Nemo’s Spas also paid $84,000 to purchase equipment and paid a cash dividend of $57,000 to its stockholders during 2014. Prepare the company’s statement of cash flows for the year ended December 31, 2014. Format cash flows from operating activities by the direct method. S11-9. Operating activities—direct method (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. The income statement of Al Baba, Inc., for the year ended December 31, 2014, ­reported the following condensed information:

Service revenue................................................................ Operating expenses.......................................................... Income from operations................................................... Income tax expense ......................................................... Net income.......................................................................

$800,000 450,000 350,000 140,000 $210,000

Patterson’s balance sheet contained the following comparative data on December 31:

Accounts Receivable ....................................... Accounts Payable............................................ Income Taxes Payable ....................................

2014

2013

$60,000 35,000 76,000

$70,000 48,000 74,000

Al Baba has no depreciable assets. Accounts payable pertains to operating expenses. Prepare the operating activities section of the statement of cash flows using the direct method.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 570

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

571

S11-10. Calculate certain operating information for direct method (Learning Objective 4) 5–10 min. Inland Medical Supply, Inc., reported the following financial statements for 2014:

Inland Medical Supply, Inc. Income Statement Year Ended December 31, 2014 Revenue: Sales Revenue Expenses: Cost of Goods Sold Depreciation Expense Other Expenses Total Expense Net Income

(in thousands) $684 $334 61 192 587 $ 97

Inland Medical Supply, Inc. Comparative Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 and 2013 (in thousands) ASSETS Current: Cash Accounts Receivable Inventory Prepaid Expenses Long-Term Investments Fixed Assets, Net

Total Assets

2014

2013

$ 25 63 77 10 72 226

$473

$ 10 43 84 4 91 180

$412

LIABILITIES Current: Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Accrued Liabilities Long-Term Notes Payable STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

2014

2013

$ 55 21 4 62

$ 32 11 9 75

41 290

30 255

$473

$412

Use the information in Inland Medical Supply, Inc.’s financial statements to compute the following: 1. Collections from customers 2. Payments for inventory S11-11. Calculate certain investing and financing information from financial statements (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Use the Inland Medical Supply, Inc., data in S11-10 to compute the amount of fixed assets acquired by Inland Medical Supply, Inc., assuming Inland sold no fixed assets in 2014.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 571

03/04/14 2:40 PM

572

Chapter 11 S11-12. Calculate certain investing and financing information from financial statements (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Use the Inland Medical Supply, Inc., data in S11-10 to compute the following amounts for 2014: 1. Borrowing or payment of long-term notes payable, assuming Inland had only one long-term note payable transaction during the year 2. Issuance of common stock, assuming Inland had only one common stock transaction during the year 3. Payment of cash dividends

MyAccountingLab

Exercises (Group A) E11-13A. Operating activities—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Use the following information to calculate the amount of cash flows from operating activities using the indirect method.

Net Income ............................................ Depreciation Expense............................. Beginning Accounts Receivable ............. Ending Accounts Receivable .................. Beginning Inventory............................... Ending Inventory.................................... Beginning Prepaid Insurance ................. Ending Prepaid Insurance ......................

$530,000 83,000 130,000 145,000 500,000 550,000 18,000 22,000

Beginning Accounts Payable....................... Ending Accounts Payable............................ Purchase of Equipment............................... Issuance of Long-term Bonds..................... Issuance of Stock for Cash ......................... Issuance of Stock for Long-term Assets ..... Purchase of Treasury Stock ........................ Sale of Long-term Investment at Cost.........

$100,000 130,000 430,000 200,000 240,000 102,000 38,000 33,000

E11-14A. Operating activities—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. The current sections of Al Houla, Inc.’s balance sheets at December 31, 2013 and 2014 are presented here. Al Houla’s net income for 2014 was $386,000. Depreciation expense was $46,000.

2014

2013

Current Assets Cash..................................................... Accounts Receivable ............................ Inventory.............................................. Prepaid Insurance ................................ Total Current Assets..................................

$106,000 90,000 160,000 26,000 $382,000

$ 99,000 89,000 173,000 22,000 $383,000

Current Liabilities Interest Payable ................................... Accounts Payable................................. Total Current Liabilities .............................

$ 15,000 80,000 $ 95,000

$

5,000 92,000 $ 97,000

Requirement 1. Prepare the net cash provided by operating activities section of the company’s statement of cash flows for the year ending December 31, 2014, using the indirect method.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 572

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

573

E11-15A. Prepare statement of cash flows—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 20–25 min. The income statement and additional data of Sunbelt Services, Inc., follow:

Sunbelt Services, Inc. Income Statement Year Ended September 30, 2014 Revenues: Sales Revenue Dividend Revenue Total Revenues Expenses: Cost of Goods Sold Salaries Expense Depreciation Expense Advertising Expense Interest Expense Income Tax Expense Total Expenses Net Income

$307,000 6,000 $313,000 $112,000 56,000 18,000 7,000 1,000 12,000 206,000 $107,000

Additional data follows: a. Acquisition of fixed assets totaled $131,000. Of this amount, $106,000 was paid in cash and a $25,000 note payable was signed for the remainder. b. Proceeds from sale of land totaled $23,000. No gain or loss was recognized on the sale. c. Proceeds from issuance of common stock totaled $37,000. d. Payment of long-term note payable was $13,000. e. Payment of dividends was $9,000. f. Data from the comparative balance sheet follow:

September 30 Current Assets: Cash.................................................................................................... Accounts Receivable ........................................................................... Inventory............................................................................................. Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable................................................................................ Accrued Liabilities...............................................................................

2014

2013

$87,000 43,000 33,000

$23,000 59,000 29,000

$31,000 12,000

$25,000 23,000

Requirements 1. Prepare Sunbelt Services’ statement of cash flows for the year ended September 30, 2014, using the indirect method. 2. Calculate Sunbelt Services’ free cash flow for the year ended September 30, 2014. 3. Evaluate Sunbelt Services’ cash flows for the year. In your evaluation, mention all three categories of cash flows as well as free cash flow and give the reason for your evaluation.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 573

03/04/14 2:40 PM

574

Chapter 11 E11-16A. Calculate cash conversion cycle (Learning Objective 5) 5–10 min. Use the data for Sunbelt Services from E11-15A. Requirements 1. Calculate the cash conversion cycle for Sunbelt Services. Round all calculations to two decimal places. Assume all sales on credit. 2. Comment on Sunbelt Services’ cash conversion cycle assuming that it was 76.39 days for the prior year. E11-17A. Calculate certain investing and financing information from financial statements (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Requirements Compute the following items for the statement of cash flows:

Quick solution: 1. Cash dividends = $26,000 2. Cash proceeds from sale = $11,000

1. The beginning and ending Retained Earnings balances are $47,000 and $82,000, respectively. Net income for the period is $61,000. How much are cash dividends? 2. The beginning and ending net Fixed Assets balances are $106,000 and $114,000, respectively. Depreciation expense for the period is $17,000, and acquisitions of new fixed assets total $38,000. Fixed assets were sold at a $2,000 loss. What were the cash proceeds of the sale? E11-18A. Operating activities—direct method (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. The accounting records of The Picket Fence, Inc., reveal:

Net Income ............................ Payment of income tax .......... Collection of dividend revenue ............... Payment to suppliers ............. Collections from customers ...

$ 41,000 20,000 6,000 36,000 133,000

Payment of salaries and wages .............. Depreciation Expense............... Payment of interest.................. Payment of dividends.............................

$30,000 10,000 22,000 6,000

Requirements 1. Compute cash flows from operating activities by the direct method. 2. Evaluate the operating cash flow of The Picket Fence, Inc. Give the reason for your evaluation.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 574

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

575

E11-19A. Prepare statement of cash flows—direct method (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. The income statement and additional data of Sunbelt Services, Inc., follow:

Sunbelt Services, Inc. Income Statement Year Ended September 30, 2014 Revenues: Sales Revenue Dividend Revenue Total Revenues Expenses: Cost of Goods Sold Salaries Expense Depreciation Expense Advertising Expense Interest Expense Income Tax Expense Total Expenses Net Income

$307,000 6,000 $313,000 $112,000 56,000 18,000 7,000 1,000 12,000 206,000 $107,000

Additional data follow: a. Collections from customers are $16,000 more than sales. b. Payments to suppliers are the sum of cost of goods sold plus advertising expense. c. Payments to employees are $9,000 more than salaries expense. d. Dividend revenue, interest expense, and income tax expense equal their cash amounts. e. Acquisition of fixed assets for cash is $106,000. f. Proceeds from sale of land total $23,000. g. Proceeds from issuance of common stock for cash total $37,000. h. Payment of long-term note payable is $13,000. i. Payment of dividends is $9,000. j. Cash balance, September 30, 2013, was $23,000. Requirement 1. Prepare Sunbelt Services’ statement of cash flows for the year ended September 30, 2014. Use the direct method. E11-20A. Calculate certain information for direct method (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Requirements Compute the following items for the statement of cash flows: 1. The beginning and ending Accounts Receivable balances are $30,000 and $32,000, respectively. Credit sales for the period total $60,000. How much are cash collections? 2. Cost of Goods Sold is $100,000. Beginning Inventory balance is $23,000, and ending Inventory balance is $17,000. Beginning and ending Accounts Payable are $15,000 and $13,000, respectively. How much are cash payments for inventory?

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 575

03/04/14 2:40 PM

576

Chapter 11 E11-21A. Calculate certain information for direct method (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. Good Life, Inc., a nationwide insurance chain, reported the following selected amounts in its financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2014 (adapted, in millions):

Income Statement Net Sales............................................................................................. Cost of Goods Sold ............................................................................. Depreciation Expense.......................................................................... Other Operating Expenses................................................................... Income Tax Expense ........................................................................... Net Income .........................................................................................

2014

2013

$27,391 19,412 276 4,853 742 2,108

$22,173 15,842 237 4,012 541 1,541

2014

2013

Balance Sheet Cash and Cash Equivalents ................................................................. Accounts Receivable ........................................................................... Inventories .......................................................................................... Property and Equipment, Net .............................................................. Accounts Payable................................................................................ Accrued Liabilities............................................................................... Long-Term Liabilities .......................................................................... Common Stock ................................................................................... Retained Earnings ...............................................................................

$

16 798 1,644 3,171 1,397 932 205 590 2,505

$

7 612 1,439 2,863 1,277 854 196 480 2,114

Requirement 1. Determine the following for Good Life, Inc., during 2014. (Enter all amounts in millions.) a. Collections from customers b. Payments for inventory c. Payments of operating expenses d. Acquisitions of property and equipment; no sales were made during 2014 e. Long-term borrowing, assuming Good Life, Inc., made no payments on longterm liabilities f. Proceeds from issuance of common stock g. Payment of cash dividends

MyAccountingLab

Exercises (Group B) E11-22B. Operating activities—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. The accounting records of Elite Talent Agency reveal:

Net Income ........................................................................................................... Depreciation Expense............................................................................................ Sales Revenue....................................................................................................... Decrease in current liabilities ................................................................................ Loss on sale of land .............................................................................................. Increase in current assets other than Cash ........................................................... Acquisition of land ................................................................................................

$40,000 3,000 13,000 24,000 2,000 15,000 39,000

Requirements 1. Compute cash flows from operating activities by the indirect method. Use the format of the operating activities section shown in Exhibit 11-3. 2. Evaluate the operating cash flow of Elite Talent Agency. Give the reason for your evaluation.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 576

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

577

E11-23B. Operating activities—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. The March accounting records of Penestrie, Inc., include these accounts:

Cash Mar 1 Receipts Mar 31

Accounts Receivable

8,000 Payments 448,000 5,000

451,0000

Mar 1 Sales Ma ar 31 Mar

Inventory Mar 1 Purchases Mar 31

18,000 Collections 454,000 12,000

460,000

Accounts Payable

19,000 Cost of goods sold 264,0000 278,000 33,000

Payments

Accumulated Depreciation

283,000 Mar 1 Purchases Mar 31

7,000 294,000 18,000

Retained Earnings

Mar 1 63,0000 Depreciation expense 9,0000 Mar 31 72,0000

Dividends

25,000 Mar 1 Net income Mar 31

84,000 73,000 132,000

Requirement 1. Compute Penestrie, Inc.’s net cash provided by operating activities during March. Use the indirect method. E11-24B. Prepare statement of cash flows—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 20–25 min. The income statement and additional data of Snyder Services, Inc., follow:

Snyder Services, Inc. Income Statement Year Ended November 30, 2014 Revenues: Sales Revenue Dividend Revenue Total Revenues Expenses: Cost of Goods Sold Salaries Expense Depreciation Expense Advertising Expense Interest Expense Income Tax Expense Total Expenses Net Income

$275,000 11,000 $286,000 $103,000 45,000 19,000 7,000 7,000 12,000 193,000 $ 93,000

Additional data follows: a. Acquisition of fixed assets totaled $102,000. Of this amount, $87,000 was paid in cash and a $15,000 note payable was signed for the remainder. b. Proceeds from the sale of land totaled $19,000. No gain or loss was recognized on the sale. c. Proceeds from issuance of common stock total $50,000.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 577

03/04/14 2:40 PM

578

Chapter 11 d. Payment of long-term note payable was $15,000. e. Payment of dividends was $16,000. f. Data from the comparative balance sheet follow:

November 30 Current Assets: Cash.................................................................................................... Accounts Receivable ........................................................................... Inventory............................................................................................. Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable................................................................................ Accrued Liabilities...............................................................................

2014

2013

$71,000 40,000 38,000

$11,000 55,000 24,000

$36,000 12,000

$27,000 25,000

Requirements 1. Prepare Snyder Services’ statement of cash flows for the year ended November 30, 2014, using the indirect method. 2. Calculate Snyder Services free cash flow for the year ended November 30, 2014. 3. Evaluate Snyder Services’ cash flows for the year. In your evaluation, mention all three categories of cash flows as well as free cash flow and give the reason for your evaluation. E11-25B. Calculate cash conversion cycle (Learning Objective 5) 5–10 min. Use the data for Snyder Services from E11-24B. Requirements 1. Calculate the cash conversion cycle for Snyder Services. Round all calculations to two decimal places. Assume all sales on credit. 2. Comment on Snyder Services’ cash conversion cycle assuming that it was 66.82 days for the prior year. E11-26B. Calculate certain investing and financing information from financial statements (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. Requirements Compute the following items for the statement of cash flows: 1. The beginning and ending Retained Earnings balances are $29,000 and $80,000, respectively. Net income for the period is $62,000. How much are cash dividends? 2. The beginning and ending net Fixed Assets balances are $101,000 and $110,000, respectively. Depreciation expense for the period is $16,000, and acquisitions of new fixed assets total $42,000. Fixed assets were sold at a $3,000 gain. What were the cash proceeds of the sale?

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 578

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

579

E11-27B. Operating activities—direct method (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. The accounting records of Caspian, Inc., reveal the following:

Net Income ............................ Payment of income tax .......... Collection of dividend revenue ............... Payment to suppliers ............. Collections from customers ...

$ 36,000 9,000 8,000 41,000 90,000

Payment of salaries and wages .............. Depreciation Expense............... Payment of interest.................. Payment of dividends.............................

$46,000 12,000 15,000 5,000

Requirements 1. Compute cash flows from operating activities by the direct method. 2. Evaluate the operating cash flow of Caspian, Inc. Give the reason for your evaluation. E11-28B. Prepare statement of cash flows—direct method (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. The income statement and additional data of Snyder Services, Inc., follow:

Snyder Services, Inc. Income Statement Year Ended November 30, 2014 Revenues: Sales Revenue Dividend Revenue Total Revenues Expenses: Cost of Goods Sold Salaries Expense Depreciation Expense Advertising Expense Interest Expense Income Tax Expense Total Expenses Net Income

$275,000 11,000 $286,000 $103,000 45,000 19,000 7,000 7,000 12,000 193,000 $ 93,000

Additional data follow: a. Collections from customers are $15,000 more than sales. b. Payments to suppliers are the sum of cost of goods sold plus advertising expense. c. Payments to employees are $18,000 more than salaries expense. d. Dividend revenue, interest expense, and income tax expense equal their cash amounts. e. Acquisition of fixed assets for cash is $87,000. f. Proceeds from sale of land total $19,000. g. Proceeds from issuance of common stock for cash total $50,000. h. Payment of long-term note payable is $15,000. i. Payment of dividends is $16,000. j. Cash balance, November 30, 2013, was $11,000. Requirement 1. Prepare Snyder Services’ statement of cash flows for the year ended November 30, 2014. Use the direct method.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 579

03/04/14 2:40 PM

580

Chapter 11 E11-29B. Calculate certain information for direct method (Learning Objective 4) 10–15 min. Requirements Compute the following items for the statement of cash flows: 1. The beginning and ending Accounts Receivable balances are $26,000 and $31,000, respectively. Credit sales for the period total $147,000. How much are cash collections? 2. Cost of Goods Sold is $94,000. Beginning Inventory balance is $31,000, and ending Inventory balance is $34,000. Beginning and ending Accounts Payable are $4,000 and $9,000, respectively. How much are cash payments for inventory? E11-30B. Calculate certain information for direct method (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. Pilgrim Corporation, a nationwide insurance chain, reported the following selected amounts in its financial statements for the year ended August 31, 2014 (adapted, in millions):

Income Statement Net Sales............................................................................................. Cost of Goods Sold ............................................................................. Depreciation Expense.......................................................................... Other Operating Expenses................................................................... Income Tax Expense ........................................................................... Net Income .........................................................................................

2014

2013

$24,859 18,162 288 4,883 532 994

$21,543 15,476 228 4,005 483 1,351

2014

2013

Balance Sheet 14 Cash and Cash Equivalents ................................................................... $ 581 Accounts Receivable ............................................................................. 2,888 Inventories ............................................................................................ 4,345 Property and Equipment, Net ................................................................ 1,610 Accounts Payable.................................................................................. 845 Accrued Liabilities................................................................................. 500 Long-Term Liabilities ............................................................................ 675 Common Stock ..................................................................................... 4,198 Retained Earnings .................................................................................

$

12 760 3,480 3,879 1,427 936 470 615 4,683

Requirement 1. Determine the following for Pilgrim Corporation during 2014. (Enter all amounts in millions.) a. Collections from customers b. Payments for inventory c. Payments of operating expenses d. Acquisitions of property and equipment; no sales were made during 2014 e. Long-term borrowing, assuming Pilgrim made no payments on long-term liabilities f. Proceeds from issuance of common stock g. Payment of cash dividends

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 580

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

MyAccountingLab

581

Problems (Group A) P11-31A. Prepare statement of cash flows—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 20–25 min. Loomis Corporation accountants assembled the following data for the year ended December 31, 2014:

Loomis Corporation December 31 Current Assets: Cash and Cash Equivalents ................................................................. Accounts Receivable ........................................................................... Inventory............................................................................................. Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable................................................................................ Income Tax Payable ............................................................................

2014

2013

$83,600 71,500 77,400

$21,200 63,700 81,600

$57,300 4,700

$55,100 6,300

Transaction Data for 2014: Net Income ......................................................................................................... Purchase of treasury stock ................................................................................. Issuance of common stock for cash ................................................................... Loss on sale of equipment .................................................................................. Payment of cash dividends ................................................................................. Depreciation Expense.......................................................................................... Issuance of long-term note payable in exchange for cash .................................. Purchase of building for cash ............................................................................. Retirement of bonds payable by issuing common stock..................................... Sale of equipment for cash .................................................................................

$ 58,700 18,900 30,000 8,000 16,500 20,600 35,000 115,000 58,000 63,500

Quick solution: 1. Net cash provided by operating activities = $84,300; Net cash used for investing activities = ($51,500); Net cash provided by financing ­activities = $29,600

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 581

Requirement 1. Prepare Loomis Corporation’s statement of cash flows using the indirect method to report operating activities. List noncash investing and financing activities on an accompanying schedule.

03/04/14 2:40 PM

582

Chapter 11 P11-32A. Prepare statement of cash flows—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 20–25 min. The comparative balance sheets for Concorde Company appear below. Prepare a ­statement of cash flows for the year ending December 31, 2014, using the indirect method.

CONCORDE COMPANY Comparative Balance Sheet Dec 31 2014

Dec 31 2013

Cash Accounts Receivable Inventory Office Supplies

$ 38,000 18,000 25,000 7,000

$13,000 14,000 15,000 9,000

Stock Investments Equipment Accumulated Depreciation—Equipment Total Assets

-060,000 (18,000) $130,000

18,000 30,000 (14,000) $85,000

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity Accounts Payable Bonds Payable Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

$ 25,000 37,000 40,000 28,000 $130,000

$ 7,000 45,000 23,000 10,000 $85,000

ASSETS

Additional data: a. Net income for the year ending December 31, 2014, was $30,000. b. Cash dividends of $12,000 were declared and paid during the year. c. Stock investments that had a book value of $18,000 were sold for $13,000. d. Sales for 2014 are $130,000.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 582

03/04/14 2:40 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

583

P11-33A. Prepare statement of cash flows—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 20–25 min. The 2014 comparative balance sheet and income statement of Charleston Medical Supply, Inc., are:

Charleston Medical Supply, Inc. Comparative Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 and 2013 2014 Current Assets: Cash and Cash Equivalents Accounts Receivable Inventory Fixed Assets: Land Equipment, Net Total Assets Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable Accrued Liabilities Long-Term Liabilities: Notes Payable Stockholders’ Equity: Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

$

6,900 24,300 91,700

2013 $

5,100 26,500 89,400

INCREASE (DECREASE) $ 1,800 (2,200) 2,300

88,400 54,600 $265,900

60,600 49,200 $230,800

27,800 5,400 $ 35,100

$ 29,700 31,400

$ 35,800 28,200

$ (6,100) 3,200

77,000

100,000

(23,000)

88,500 39,300 $265,900

64,100 2,700 $230,800

24,400 36,600 $ 35,100

Charleston Medical Supply, Inc. Income Statement Year Ended December 31, 2014 Revenues: Sales Revenue Interest Revenue Total Revenues Expenses: Cost of Goods Sold Salaries Expense Depreciation Expense Other Operating Expenses Interest Expense Income Tax Expense Total Expenses Net Income

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 583

$207,000 7,800 $214,800 $ 70,900 27,200 5,100 11,300 12,400 28,600 155,500 $ 59,300

03/04/14 2:41 PM

584

Chapter 11 Charleston Medical Supply, Inc., had no noncash investing and financing transactions during 2014. During the year, Charleston Medical Supply, Inc., made no sales of land or equipment, no issuance of notes payable, no retirement of stock, and no treasury stock transactions. Requirements 1. Prepare the 2014 statement of cash flows, formatting operating activities by the indirect method. 2. How will what you learned in this problem help you evaluate an investment in Charleston Medical Supply, Inc.? P11-34A. Prepare statement of cash flows—direct method (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. The accounting records for T. Houton Associates, Inc., for the year ended April 30, 2014, contain the following information: a. Purchase of fixed assets for cash, $49,000 b. Proceeds from issuance of common stock, $45,000 c. Payment of dividends, $44,400 d. Collection of interest, $7,500 e. Payment of salaries, $95,000 f. Proceeds from sale of fixed assets, $27,000 g. Collections from customers, $609,000 h. Cash receipt of dividend revenue, $5,500 i. Payments to suppliers, $368,500 j. Depreciation expense, $59,000 k. Proceeds from issuance of long-term notes, $39,100 l. Payments of long-term notes payable, $49,000 m. Interest expense and payments, $13,500 n. Income tax expense and payments, $43,000 o. Cash balances: April 30, 2013, $40,100; April 30, 2014, $110,800 Requirement 1. Prepare T. Houton Associates’ statement of cash flows for the year ended April 30, 2014. Use the direct method for cash flows from operating activities. P11-35A. Prepare statement of cash flows—direct method (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. Use the Charleston Medical Supply, Inc., data from P11-33A. The cash amounts for Interest Revenue, Salaries Expense, Interest Expense, and Income Tax Expense are the same as the accrual amounts for these items. Requirements 1. Prepare the 2014 statement of cash flows by the direct method. 2. How will what you learned in this problem help you evaluate an investment in Charleston Medical Supply, Inc.?

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 584

03/04/14 2:41 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

585

P11-36A. Prepare statement of cash flows—direct method (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. To prepare the statement of cash flows, accountants for C. Harrison, Inc., summarized 2014 activity in the Cash account as:

Cash Beginning balance Receipts of interest Collections from customers Issuance of common stock

Ending balance

100,400 23,300 492,300 90,000

81,900

Payment on accounts payable Payment of dividends Payment of salaries and wages Payment of interest Payment for equipment Payment of operating expenses Payment of notes payable Payment of income tax

300,000 22,000 143,800 21,600 9,900 31,000 79,000 16,800

Requirement 1. Prepare the statement of cash flows of C. Harrison, Inc., for the year ended December 31, 2014, using the direct method for operating activities.

Problems (Group B) P11-37B. Prepare statement of cash flows—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 20–25 min. Carlson Corporation accountants assembled the following data for the year ended December 31, 2014:

Carlson Corporation December 31 Current Assets: Cash and Cash Equivalents ................................................................. Accounts Receivable ........................................................................... Inventory............................................................................................. Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable................................................................................ Income Tax Payable ............................................................................

2014

2013

$82,600 69,700 80,300

$27,000 64,800 83,500

$57,200 14,500

$55,600 16,500

Transaction Data for 2014: Net Income ......................................................................................................... Purchase of treasury stock ................................................................................. Issuance of common stock for cash ................................................................... Loss on sale of equipment .................................................................................. Payment of cash dividends ................................................................................. Depreciation Expense.......................................................................................... Issuance of long-term note payable in exchange for cash .................................. Purchase of building for cash ............................................................................. Retirement of bonds payable by issuing common stock..................................... Sale of equipment for cash .................................................................................

$ 57,300 14,200 36,900 10,500 18,300 21,900 34,600 124,000 66,000 53,000

Requirement 1. Prepare Carlson Corporation’s statement of cash flows using the indirect method to report operating activities. List noncash investing and financing activities on an accompanying schedule.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 585

03/04/14 2:41 PM

586

Chapter 11 P11-38B. Prepare statement of cash flows—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 20–25 min. Data from the comparative balance sheet of Marsing Company at March 31, 2014, follow:

March 31 Current Assets: Cash and Cash Equivalents ................................................................. Accounts Receivable ........................................................................... Inventory............................................................................................. Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable................................................................................ Accrued Liabilities............................................................................... Income Tax Payable ............................................................................

2014

2013

$15,300 14,400 54,500

$ 5,600 21,600 52,800

$31,700 14,200 8,600

$28,300 16,300 4,800

Marsing Company’s transactions during the year ended March 31, 2014, included:

Payment of cash dividend ........ Purchase of equipment for cash ............. Issuance of long-term note payable in exchange for cash ...............................

$42,000 29,400 60,000

Depreciation Expense............... Purchase of building for cash ................. Net Income .............................. Issuance of common stock ....................

$18,300 99,200 76,400 15,000

Requirements 1. Prepare Marsing Company’s statement of cash flows for the year ended March 31, 2014, using the indirect method to report cash flows from operating activities. 2. Evaluate Marsing Company’s cash flows for the year. Mention all three categories of cash flows and give the reason for your evaluation.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 586

03/04/14 2:41 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

587

P11-39B. Prepare statement of cash flows—indirect method (Learning Objective 3) 20–25 min. The 2014 comparative balance sheet and income statement of Kahl Medical Supplies follow:

Kahl Medical Supplies Comparative Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 and 2013 2014 Current Assets: Cash and Cash Equivalents Accounts Receivable Inventory Fixed Assets: Land Equipment, Net Total Assets Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable Accrued Liabilities Long-Term Liabilities: Notes Payable Stockholders’ Equity: Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

$

6,600 25,000 91,900

2013 $

6,000 26,800 89,600

INCREASE (DECREASE) $

600 (1,800) 2,300

89,200 53,900 $266,600

60,400 49,500 $232,300

28,800 4,400 $ 34,300

$ 30,300 30,900

$ 35,800 28,300

$ (5,500) 2,600

73,000

101,000

(28,000)

88,500 43,900 $266,600

64,400 2,800 $232,300

24,100 41,100 $ 34,300

Kahl Medical Supplies Income Statement Year Ended December 31, 2014 Revenues: Sales Revenue Interest Revenue Total Revenues Expenses: Cost of Goods Sold Salaries Expense Depreciation Expense Other Operating Expenses Interest Expense Income Tax Expense Total Expenses Net Income

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 587

$213,000 8,300 $221,300 $ 70,500 27,700 4,600 10,300 11,400 29,000 153,500 $ 67,800

03/04/14 2:41 PM

588

Chapter 11 Kahl Medical Supplies had no noncash investing and financing transactions during 2014. During the year, Kahl Medical Supplies made no sales of land or equipment, no issuance of notes payable, no retirement of stock, and no treasury stock transactions. Requirements 1. Prepare the 2014 statement of cash flows, formatting operating activities by the indirect method. 2. How will what you learned in this problem help you evaluate an investment in Kahl Medical Supplies? P11-40B. Prepare statement of cash flows—direct method (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. The accounting records for Inez, Inc., for the year ended September 30, 2014, contain the following information: a. Purchase of fixed assets, $82,300 b. Proceeds from issuance of common stock, $55,000 c. Payment of dividends, $41,300 d. Collection of interest, $7,600 e. Payments of salaries, $87,400 f. Proceeds from sale of fixed assets, $17,800 g. Collections from customers, $637,000 h. Cash receipt of dividend revenue, $4,800 i. Payments to suppliers, $381,900 j. Depreciation expense, $63,400 k. Proceeds from issuance of long-term notes, $23,500 l. Payments of long-term notes payable, $46,800 m. Interest expense and payments, $13,200 n. Income tax expense and payments, $38,600 o. Cash balance: September 30, 2013, $26,700; September 30, 2014, $80,900 Requirement 1. Prepare Inez, Inc.’s statement of cash flows for the year ended September 30, 2014. Use the direct method for cash flows from operating activities. P11-41B. Prepare statement of cash flows—direct method (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. Use the Kahl Medical Supplies data from P11-39B. The cash amounts for Interest Revenue, Salaries Expense, Interest Expense, and Income Tax Expense are the same as the accrual amounts for these items. Requirements 1. Prepare the 2014 statement of cash flows by the direct method. 2. How will what you learned in this problem help you evaluate an investment in Kahl Medical Supplies?

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 588

03/04/14 2:41 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

589

P11-42B. Prepare statement of cash flows—direct method (Learning Objective 4) 20–25 min. To prepare the statement of cash flows, accountants for Nelson Industrial, Inc., summarized 2014 activity in the Cash account as:

Cash Beginning balance Receipts of interest Collections from customers Issuance of common stock

Ending balance

63,800 8,200 461,300 58,500

91,200

Payment on accounts payable Payment of dividends Payment of salaries and wages Payment of interest Payment for equipment Payment of operating expenses Payment of notes payable Payment of income tax

276,900 10,700 62,300 21,400 21,800 27,900 72,000 7,600

Requirement 1. Prepare the statement of cash flows of Nelson Industrial, Inc., for the year ended December 31, 2014, using the direct method for operating activities.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 589

03/04/14 2:41 PM

590

Chapter 11

Continuing Exercise This exercise continues the accounting for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., from the Continuing Exercise in Chapter 10. Assume that Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., had the following comparative balance sheet at the end of 2015, its second year of operations.

Cole’s Yard Care, Inc. Comparative Balance Sheet December 31, 2015 and 2014 2015

2014

Cash Accounts Receivable Lawn Supplies Equipment (Less Accumulated Depreciation) Total Assets

$23,020 1,230 210 5,200 (1,400) $28,260

$18,400 800 170 1,600 (300) $20,670

LIABILITIES Accounts Payable Notes Payable (long-term)

$ 180 $ 7,000

$

ASSETS

STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

330 12,000

4,300 16,780

2,000 6,340

$28,260

$20,670

Requirement 1. Prepare the statement of cash flows for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., for the year ending December 31, 2015 using the indirect method. The following additional information applies to 2015: • Common stock was issued at par value. • No dividends were declared or paid during the year. • No equipment was sold during the year, and all purchases of equipment were for cash.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 590

03/04/14 2:41 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

591

Continuing Problem In this problem, we continue our accounting for Aqua Magic, Inc., from Chapter 10. We will ­assume that Aqua Magic, Inc., is now in its second year of operations. Assume that the comparative balance sheet for Aqua Magic, Inc., at July 31, 2015, and the income statement for the month ended July 31, 2015, are:

Aqua Magic, Inc. Comparative Balance Sheets July 31 and June 30, 2015 July 31

June 30

ASSETS Cash Accounts Receivable, net Inventory Supplies Total Current Assets Fixed Assets Less: Accumulated Depreciation Net Fixed Assets Total Assets LIABILITIES Accounts Payable Unearned Revenue Salaries Payable Interest Payable Payroll Taxes Payable Dividend Payable Current Portion of Long-Term Debt Total Current Liabilities Notes Payable Mortgage Payable Total Liabilities STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY Preferred Stock Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par, Preferred Common Stock Paid-in Capital in Excess of Par, Common Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities & Stockholders’ Equity

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 591

$

8,126 91,647 18,241 164 118,178 357,600 (9,003) 348,597 $466,775

$

$

$

16,000 12,000 95,000 7,000 25,883 155,883 $466,775

16,000 12,000 95,000 7,000 21,628 151,628 $345,004

2,060 6,800 950 621 543 300 11,673 22,947 59,260 228,685 310,892

9,246 82,403 16,857 227 108,733 244,800 (8,529) 236,271 $345,004

1,280 2,700 875 180 — 800 9,896 15,731 28,960 148,685 193,376

03/04/14 2:41 PM

592

Chapter 11

Aqua Magic, Inc. Income Statement Month Ended July 31, 2015 Revenue Expenses: Cost of Goods Sold Depreciation Expense Rent Expense Interest Expense Insurance Expense Supplies Expense Salaries Expense Payroll Taxes Expense Bank Service Fees Net Income*

$45,691

34,276 474 1,050 843 240 122 2,746 543 15 $ 5,382

*Income taxes ignored

Additional information follows: During the month, Aqua Magic, Inc., purchased a $32,800 truck financed with a note payable; it purchased an $80,000 building site financed with a mortgage payable; and it did not sell any fixed assets during the month. Requirement 1. Prepare the statement of cash flows using the indirect method for the month of July.

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem Return to Target’s 2012 annual report. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem in Chapter 2. On page 33 of the annual report, you’ll find Target’s income statement for the year ending February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Operations). On page 35, you’ll find Target’s balance sheet as of February 2, 2013 (called the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position). On page 36, you’ll find Target’s Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows. Now answer these questions: 1. Look at Target’s balance sheet, income statement, and statement of cash flows. Find net income on the income statement and statement of cash flows for the year ending February 2, 2013. Find the ending balance of cash and cash equivalents on the balance sheet as of February 2, 2013, and January 28, 2012. How does the statement of cash flows for the year ending February 2, 2013 tie these amounts together? Show how Target’s statement of cash flows ties Target’s ­income statement and balance sheet together. 2. Look over Target’s statement of cash flows for the last two years. What are Target’s net cash flows from operating, investing, and financing activities? How have these cash flows changed over the last two years? 3. Look at Target’s balance sheet and income statement. What is Target’s cash conversion cycle for the year ending February 2, 2013? What does this cash conversion cycle tell you? Assume all sales are on account and ignore credit card revenue. 4. Looking back over your answers to questions 1 through 3, how do you think Target is performing? What do you think of Target’s management of cash and cash flow?

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 592

03/04/14 2:41 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

593

Apply Your Knowledge Ethics In Action Case 1. Design Incorporated experienced a downturn in December sales. To make matters worse, many of the recent sales were on account, and because many customers were not paying on their accounts, the ending balance of Accounts Receivable at December 31 was higher than the beginning balance. Because the business had a dramatic need for cash, a prime piece of land owned by the company was sold for cash in December at a substantial gain. Design had purchased the land 10 years earlier and properly classified it as a long-term investment. The CEO, Jim Shady, was looking over the financial statements and saw the company’s weak operating cash flows. He approached the accountant to ask why the December cash flows provided from operations were so weak, given that the land had been sold. The accountant explained that because the indirect method was used in preparing the cash flow statement, certain adjustments to net income were required. To begin with, the increase in accounts receivable was a decreasing adjustment made in arriving at the net cash provided from operating activities. Next, the large gain recognized on the sale of land had to be adjusted by subtracting it from the net income in arriving at the cash provided by operating activities. These large negative adjustments drastically reduced the reported cash provided from that category of cash flows. The accountant then explained that all the cash proceeds from the land sale were included as cash inflows in the investing activities section. Jim became worried because he remembered the bank telling him about the importance of strong operating cash flows, so he told the accountant to redo the statement but not to reduce the net income by the accounts receivable increase or the gain on the land sale. The accountant refused because these adjustments were necessary in order to properly arrive at the net cash provided from operating activities. If these adjustments were not made, then the net change in cash could not be reconciled. Jim finally agreed but then told the accountant to just include the cash proceeds from the sale of land in the operating activities rather than in the investing activities. The accountant said that would be wrong. Besides, everyone would know that proceeds from the sale of land should be an investing activity. Jim then suggested listing it as “other” in the operating section so no one would ever know that it wasn’t an operating cash flow. Why didn’t Jim want the accountant to decrease the net income by the increase in a­ ccounts receivable and the gain on the land sale? Why do you think Jim finally agreed with the accountant? Could the operating cash flows be increased by including the cash proceeds from the sale but ­listing them as “other” rather than as land sale proceeds? What ethical concerns are involved? Do you have any other thoughts? Case 2. Kevin Sailors, the CEO of Candle Corporation, was discussing the financial statements with the company accountant. Weak cash flows had resulted in the company borrowing a lot of money. Kevin wanted to know why the money borrowed was included as cash inflows in the financing section of the statement of cash flows but the interest paid on the amounts borrowed was not. The accountant replied that the interest paid on loans was an expense included in the calculation of net income, which was in the operating activities section. Kevin then asked why the dividends Candle Corporation paid to stockholders were included as an outflow of cash in the financing section. The accountant then explained that dividends paid, unlike interest paid, were a return to stockholders and not an expense; therefore, they would not be included in net income, nor would they appear in the operating activities section. Kevin replied that he did not care and instructed the accountant to include both the interest paid and the dividends paid in the financing section. The accountant said that such a move would not be proper. Kevin then said to not provide the statement of cash flows at all because too many people would see the weakening operating cash flows. He further stated that investors and creditors who really analyzed the income statements and balance sheets would be able to understand the company without the need for a statement of cash flows spelling out the net changes in cash flows. Why would Kevin want the interest paid to be included in the financing activities section? Why would the accountant state that interest paid should not be included in the financing activities section? Can the statement of cash flows be omitted? What ethical issues are involved? Do you have any additional thoughts?

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 593

03/04/14 2:41 PM

594

Chapter 11

Know Your Business Financial Analysis Purpose: To help to familiarize you with the financial reporting of a real company in order to further your understanding of the chapter material you are learning. This case focuses on the cash flows of Columbia Sportswear. Recall that inflows and outflows of cash are classified as operating activities, investing activities, or financing activities. The statement of cash flows presents cash flows from each of these three activities. It is, therefore, important to understand the information provided in this revealing financial statement. The statement of cash flows and additional related information for Columbia Sportswear are disclosed in its annual report found in Appendix A. Requirements 1. Look at the operating activities section of the statements of cash flows. Compare the net cash provided by operating activities to the net income for each of the three years presented. Are the net income amounts reported on the cash flow statement the same as on the income statement? How does the net cash flow provided by operations compare to the net income? Why do they differ? Is this difference good or bad? Have the net cash flows provided by operations been increasing or decreasing? Why are depreciation and amortization added back each year? 2. Look at the investing activities section of the statements of cash flows. What has created the largest inflows and outflows of cash related to investing activities in each of the three years presented? Can you determine whether Columbia Sportswear has been spending money to purchase more property and equipment? Did investing activities provide or use cash for the three years presented? 3. Look at the financing activities section of the statements of cash flows. Did financing activities provide or require cash for the three fiscal years presented? What is the significance of this information? What are the stock repurchase and dividend trends? What was the largest item in the financing section for the most recent year? 4. How do you feel about the overall sufficiency of cash flows? Does the net cash provided from operations cover the net cash required for investing activities for each of the three years? Does the net cash provided from operations cover the net cash required for financing activities for each of the three years? 5. What was the net change in cash and cash equivalents for the most recent fiscal year? Does the ending cash amount agree with the cash and cash equivalents reported on the balance sheet? Do you have any other observations about the statement of cash flows?

Industry Analysis Purpose: To help you understand and compare the performance of two companies in the same industry. Find the Columbia Sportswear Company Annual Report located in Appendix A and go to the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows on page 695. Now access the 2012 Annual Report for Under Armour, Inc., from the Internet. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Industry Analysis in Chapter 1. The company’s Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows is on page 52. Requirement 1. Which method (direct or indirect) does each of these companies use to prepare their statement of cash flows? How can you tell? Which activities provided cash for each of the companies for each of the three years? Which activities used cash for each of these companies for each of the three years? What conclusions can you draw from these results?

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 594

03/04/14 2:41 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

595

Small Business Analysis Purpose: To help you understand the importance of cash flows in the operation of a small business. You just received your year-end financial statements from your CPA. Although receiving the year-end financial package is important every year for your financing institutions and your investors, it is especially important this year because of the potential investment opportunity that just became available to you. Yesterday you got a telephone call from one of your competitors with whom you have been discussing the possibility of a merger. The gist of the conversation was that the board of directors wanted to sell outright to you instead of merging. You’re pretty happy about that except for the fact that it could create some potential cash flow problems. The other company wants $1,000,000 cash and it wants to do it soon or the deal is off. You’ve got that amount of cash and cash equivalents available right now, but you know there are some cash commitments coming up soon for capital expenditures and dividend payments. You decide to call one of your financial investors. She suggests that you calculate free cash flow at the end of the year to determine if that amount of cash is available to complete the deal. You look at your statement of cash flows and see that net cash flow from operations was $1,725,000 and that cash used to purchase long-term assets was $550,000. Requirement 1. Define free cash flow and calculate it based on the information previously provided. With your understanding of free cash flow, is this new investment something that this company should pursue?

Written Communication You have been asked by your accounting professor to prepare a paper outlining the importance of the statement of cash flows, the details of what is included in each of the three sections of the statement, and how it provides a link between the income statement and the balance sheet. Self Check Answers 1. d 2. b 3. c 4. c 5. c 6. b 7. c 8. d 9. c 10. b 11. b 12. d

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 595

03/04/14 2:41 PM

596

Chapter 11

Comprehensive Problem The Accounting Cycle and Preparation of Financial Statements Including a Statement of Cash Flows Haskins Supply, Inc., supplies industrial tools to local businesses. Haskins Supply’s November 30, 2014 Balance Sheet appears as:

Haskins Supply, Inc. Balance Sheet November 30, 2014 ASSETS Current Assets: Cash Accounts Receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $2,140 Inventory Supplies Prepaid Insurance Total Current Assets Long-term assets: Office Equipment Less: Accumulated Depreciation, Office Equipment Total Assets LIABILITIES Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable Salaries Payable Total Current Liabilities Long-Term Liabilities: Notes Payable, Long-Term Total Liabilities STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY Common Stock, $10 par value, 100,000 shares authorized, 3,000 shares issued and outstanding. Paid-in capital in Excess of Par, Common Total paid-in Capital Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 596

$ 26,487 43,350 87,244 682 4,800 162,563

19,460 4,880

14,580 $177,143

$ 25,673 885 26,558 7,500 34,058

30,000 10,000 40,000 103,085 143,085 $177,143

03/04/14 2:41 PM

The Statement of Cash Flows

597

During the month of December 2014, Haskins Supply, Inc., had the following transactions:

Dec 2 Paid the balance in Salaries Payable 3 Purchased $2,450 of inventory on account from Ensco, Inc. Terms, 2/10, n/30, FOB shipping point. 4 Paid freight charges of $160 on Dec 3 purchase from Ensco, Inc. 5 Purchased $400 of supplies on account from OfficeMaxx. Terms, 3/15, n/30, FOB destination. 9 Sold merchandise costing $1,120 to Allied, Inc. on account for $2,760. Terms, 2/10, n/30, FOB destination. 10 Paid $140 freight charges to deliver goods to Allied, Inc. 11 Paid amount owed to Ensco, Inc. on the Dec 3 purchase in full. 12 Sold 1,500 shares of common stock for $22,000 13 Sold merchandise costing $5,310 to a cash customer for $12,870 14 Received $4,240 from Noxon, Inc. as payment on a November 16 sale. Terms were n/30. 15 Granted a $360 allowance to Allied, Inc. on the Dec 9 sale due to damaged merchandise. 15 Purchased a delivery vehicle for $22,500, paying $5,000 cash and signing a 7%, 5-year, note payable for $17,500. The note requires annual payments of $3,500 plus interest on Dec 15 of each year. 18 Received payment in full from Allied, Inc., for the Dec 9 sale. 19 Paid for the supplies purchased on December 5. 22 Declared a $2 per share cash dividend 24 Sold office equipment for $1,000. Equipment originally cost $2,300 and had accumulated depreciation of $1,500 26 Paid $2,360 on account to Donovan, Inc. on a November 8 purchase. Terms were 2/15, net 60. 27 Wrote off the $980 account of XCR, Inc. as uncollectible. 28 Paid $7,500 on the long-term note payable plus interest. The note was a 1-year, 6% note dated December 28, 2013. No interest has been recorded to this point. 30 Paid current month’s rent, $1,400. 31 Paid sales commissions, 1,370. 31 Paid the dividend declared on Dec 22. Requirements 1. Open four-column general ledger accounts and enter the balances from the November 30 trial balance. 2. Record each transaction in the general journal. Explanations are not required. Post the journal entries to the general ledger, creating new ledger accounts as necessary. Omit posting references. Calculate the new account balances. 3. Prepare an unadjusted trial balance as of December 31, 2014. 4. Journalize and post the adjusting journal entries based on the following information, creating new ledger accounts as necessary: a. Depreciation on office equipment for the month is $146 and on vehicles is $375. b. Supplies on hand at December 31, $283. c. Accrued salary expense for the office receptionist is $1,025. d. Accrue interest on the December 15, $17,500 note payable (round to the nearest dollar).

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 597

03/04/14 2:41 PM

598

Chapter 11 e. The balance in prepaid insurance represents a six-month insurance policy that was purchased on November 31 of the current year. f. Based on an aging of Accounts Receivable, Haskins Supply estimates uncollectible accounts will equal $2,830. 5. Prepare an adjusted trial balance as of December 31, 2014. Use the adjusted trial balance to prepare Haskins Supply, Inc.’s multi-step income statement and statement of retained earnings for the month ending December 31, 2014. Also, prepare the comparative balance sheet at December 31, 2014. Use the financial statements and the monthly transaction data to prepare Haskins Supply’s statement of cash flows for the month ending December 31, 2014, using the indirect method. 6. Journalize and post the closing entries. 7. Prepare a post-closing trial balance at December 31, 2014.

M11_KEMP9543_03_GE_C11.indd 598

03/04/14 2:41 PM

12 Financial Statement Analysis Business, Accounting, and You In previous chapters, you learned about different types of transactions and how ­accountants classify those transactions. You learned how these transactions feed into the financial statements in order to show the extent of the business’s success to interested parties, creditors, vendors, and investors. Now let’s look at how these interested parties, or stakeholders, use this information in the financial statements. Let’s look at how to analyze a business’s financial statements to understand what the business is doing and whether the business is successful.

Learning Objectives 1 Understand the purpose and process of financial analysis

2 Perform financial analysis using financial statements

3 Use financial analysis to assess the value of a business

599

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 599

03/04/14 2:43 PM

600

Chapter 12

Go back and look over Chapter 1. Remember that businesses exist to create value. Think about the businesses we’ve looked at in this book: Disney, Google, Target, Kroger, Toys R Us, Hershey, John Deere, Apple, and others. How do you tell if these businesses are doing a good or bad job of creating value? Are these businesses creating enough net income to compensate shareholders for the use of their money over time and for taking risks? Would you buy stock in these companies? It’s time to consider what accountants tell us in the financial statements and how you can use that information to evaluate the value of a business. Accounting information is designed to be used by decision makers to help determine whether to invest, lend, or extend credit. In other words, it’s time to learn to analyze financial statements.

Real World Accounting Video In the Real World Accounting Video, David Drake of LDJ Capital, talks about investing in companies. Listen to what David is saying. Think about analyzing a company and deciding whether to invest in it.

What Is Financial Analysis? 1

Understand the purpose and process of financial analysis

Financial analysis  The process of using a business’s financial statements, and other related information, to evaluate whether a business is creating value. Financial analysts  People who perform financial analysis.

Financial analysis is the process of using a business’s financial statements, and other related information, to evaluate whether a business is creating value. Financial analysts, people who perform financial analysis, use the reports provided by accountants and others to evaluate the past and current performance of a business. Using this evaluation, analysts can begin to predict the future of the business and its value. Look once more at Chapter 1. Remember that a business exists to create value for all its stakeholders, particularly its owners. So how does a corporation create value for its owners? It creates value for its owners by acquiring money with debt and equity. It then invests that money in assets. Next, the business hires employees to use the assets and create sales. In the process of creating sales, the business incurs operating expenses such as cost of goods sold, salaries, depreciation, and advertising. The net result is an operating profit (Earnings Before Interest and Taxes, or EBIT). This operating profit is first used to pay interest, the cost of debt, and then the taxes that are due to the government. What remains is net income. Net income belongs to the owners, the business’s stockholders. What is the process that analysts, stockholders, and other decision makers use to conduct financial analysis? There is a logical way to look at all the information provided by accountants and others. That logical way is to first figure out the forces that affect a business. Then analysts can look at the financial statements to determine whether a business is operating successfully within these forces. The process of financial analysis has five steps. These steps are:

1. Understand a business’s model and strategy. 2. Understand the environment in which the business operates. 3. Analyze the content of the financial statements and other information, making adjustments if desired. 4. Analyze the business’s operations. 5. Use the financial analysis to make decisions.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 600

03/04/14 2:43 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

601

Step One: Understand a Business’s Model and Strategy

Management discussion and analysis (MD&A)  The section of a business’s annual report in which a business’s management discusses the results of operating the business, risks, challenges, and opportunities. Business model  A description of what a business does, the products it sells, and the customers who buy its products. Business strategy  A ­description of how a business uses its ­business model to create a competitive advantage.

Before looking at the financial statements, you need to figure out a business’s model and strategy. To do this, you should research and read the comments from management that accompany the financial statements. Financial statements are often a part of a business’s annual report. Annual reports typically start with a discussion, by management, of the business’s operations, risks, challenges, and opportunities. This discussion by management is called the management discussion and analysis, or MD&A. The MD&A is followed by the auditor’s opinion, the financial statements, and the notes that explain the numbers in the financial statements. A business model describes what a business does, the products it sells, and the customers who buy the products. Different businesses have different business models. Walmart buys and sells household products. This model depends on a lot of inventory and buildings. In contrast, Google creates and sells Internet services and advertising. Unlike Walmart, Google does not depend on inventory or real estate for its business model. A lot of Google’s assets are intangible, such as patents. Walmart and Google have different business models. After figuring out the business’s model, you should look at a business’s strategy. A business strategy is how a business uses its business model to create a competitive advantage. A business’s strategy deals with how a business makes customers want to buy their product and not the product of their competitors. Think about it. Walmart, Kmart, and Target are all large discount stores that sell clothing and household products. All three companies have the same business model. Now think. Do you prefer to shop at one over the others? If so, why? Think about what that business does to make you want to shop there. That’s strategy. Understanding a business’s model and strategy helps you look for the things that are critical to the success of the business. For example, it’s very important that Walmart manages its inventory efficiently because its strategy is based on low prices. However, trying to look at Google’s inventory is not important. Instead, you would look at how Google uses its equipment and intangible assets to deliver its search ­engine. Sound financial analysis starts with a solid understanding of a business’s model and strategy.

Step Two: Understand the Environment in Which a Business Operates

Economic environment  How a business is affected by the overall economy in which it operates.

Competitive environment  How a business competes for its customers, supplies, and other critical resources.

Benchmarking  The practice of comparing a company with other ­companies that are leaders in its industry.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 601

Next you should research and examine the environment in which a business operates. The MD&A of a business’s annual report is a good place to start when researching this issue. A business’s environment has two parts, economic and competitive. A business’s economic environment is how the business is affected by the overall economy in which it operates. Let’s take a look at Ford and Kroger. When the economy is strong and growing, people have a lot of money and buy automobiles. When the economy is not doing well, people do not have a lot of money and do not buy automobiles. Ford’s sales go up and down based on the strength or weakness of the economy. In contrast, Kroger’s sales do not fluctuate much based on the strength of the economy. People need and buy food in good and bad times. Next, you examine a business’s competitive environment. A business’s competitive environment is how a business competes for its customers, supplies, and other critical resources. An example is McDonald’s. McDonald’s has a lot of competitors. McDonald’s must constantly compete for customers by having better products, lower prices, and better facilities. On the other hand, Dominion Resources, the large electric utility, does not have competitors. It’s a monopoly. However, it is regulated by state and federal governments. Regulators tell Dominion how much electricity it must produce and how much it can charge its customers for the electricity. Benchmarking is a technique that helps you understand a business’s environment. Benchmarking is where an analyst compares a business with similar businesses, o ­ ften leading competitors. You compare McDonald’s to Burger King or to averages that reflect all businesses that operate in the fast food industry. You compare Dominion Resources to Pacific Gas and Electric (PG&E) or to averages that reflect all producers of electricity.

03/04/14 2:43 PM

602

Chapter 12

Accounting in Your World

So Just How Badly Did You Do on That Test? Have you ever received a test or an assignment back and, after looking at your score, were sure you failed? Then you found out your score wasn’t so bad after all because there were only 80 points possible. Or perhaps you found out that your score, although low, was higher than the class average. Until you had a point of reference, your raw score did not tell the whole story about your performance. The results of financial statement analysis are similar. The results of financial analysis have limited value without a point of reference. This is why, when conducting financial statement analysis, a company’s performance is compared to past performance and to the performance of its competitors.

Step Three: Analyze the Content of the Financial Statements and Other Information, Making Adjustments If Desired Before using information, you must determine if information is reliable and reflects the operations of the business. How do you do this? First, you look at the audit opinion. Look back in Chapter 6 and review the role of auditors and audit opinions. Do the ­financial statements conform to Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP)? Next, you need to decide whether the GAAP used by the business reflects what you, the analyst, feels is reality. Use the notes to financial statements to figure out which rules of GAAP a business chooses to use and why. An example is a company that purchased a building 20 years ago for $500,000. It is currently being used but is fully depreciated. It has a net value of zero on the company’s balance sheet. Analysts may ­determine through appraisals that the building currently has a market value of $1,000,000. If so, they may want to increase the value of buildings, and thus assets, by $1,000,000. They would also increase stockholders’ equity by $1,000,000 to reflect the perceived increase in the value of the business to its stockholders.

Step Four: Analyze the Business’s Operations Financial analysis asks questions about value. That means asking questions about the amount of net income, the time in which the net income is earned, and the risk associated with the net income. Financial analysis looks at how and when a business creates net income. Financial analysis attempts to see how net income changes over time. Typical questions you should ask are: • Question 1: Is the business a going concern? In others words, will the business exist in the near future? • Question 2: How is the business earning a net income or loss? • Question 3: Where is the business getting its money, and can it pay its debt obligations?

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 602

03/04/14 2:43 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

603

• Question 4: How is the business investing its money, and is it using its assets efficiently? • Question 5: Is the business generating enough net income to reward the stockholders for the use of their money? To answer these questions, you need to look at numbers and relationships. The relationships are called ratios. You also need to look at how the numbers and ratios change over time. Analyzing trends over time is very important because change is a major part of risk. You want to understand what a business is doing now and in the past and what has changed. This change helps the analyst forecast the future. Analysts use numbers, ratios, and trends to see if the business is doing a good or bad job acquiring money, ­investing money, and operating the business.

Step Five: Use the Financial Analysis to Make Decisions First, you must understand a business’s business model, strategy, and environment. Next, you assess the nature of information and make adjustments if they feel appropriate. Then you look at the numbers, ratios, and trends reflected in the financial statements. After all that work, it’s time to make decisions using these key questions: • • • •

How is the business performing? What’s the business’s value or worth? What would you pay for the business? Can the business operate more efficiently and improve its value?

Decision Guidelines Decision

Guideline

Analyze

How do I know if a business has ­created value?

The objective of a business is to create value for all its stakeholders, particularly stockholders. Financial analysis is conducted to understand how a business meets this objective.

Look at the balance sheet, income statement, statement of retained earnings, cash flow statement, and other supporting documents such as the auditor’s opinion. Now analyze the financial statements using a logical process that captures what a business does and how it does it. Does the business provide enough net income to justify stockholders’ investments? Is the net income sufficient to compensate stockholders for the use of their money over time and for accepting risk?

What Measures Does Someone Use to Analyze the Performance of a Business? 2

Perform financial analysis using financial statements

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 603

Analysts, which include you, use numbers, ratios, and trends to answer the questions noted earlier in step 4. So let’s look at the numbers, ratios, and trends used for each question. Let’s use an example to do this. Tucker Enterprises, Inc., buys bicycle parts and ­resells them to bicycle retailers and repair shops. The business is a corporation with 10,000 shares of common stock outstanding during 2012. The financial statements of Tucker Enterprises, Inc., can be found in Exhibits 12-1, 12-2, 12-3, and 12-4.

03/04/14 2:43 PM

604

Chapter 12

Tucker Enterprises, Inc. Income Statement Years Ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 (in thousands) Net Sales Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Selling, General, and Administrative Depreciation Expense Income Before Interest and Taxes Interest Expense Income Before Taxes Income Tax Expense Net Income

2014 $1,200 600 600

2013 $1,000 400 600

200 150 250 100 150 75 $ 75

200 100 300 70 230 115 $ 115

Exhibit 12-1 Tucker Enterprises, Inc. Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 and 2013 (in thousands) Assets Current Assets: Cash and Cash Equivalents Accounts Receivable, Net Inventory Total Current Assets Property, Plant, and Equipment, Net Total Assets Liabilities Current Liabilities Accounts Payable Accrued Liabilities Total Current Liabilities Long-Term Bank Loan Total Liabilities Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

2014

2013

$

50 100 250 400 3,000 $3,400

$ 100 80 220 400 2,000 $2,400

$

$

550 1,250 1,800 $3,400

100 1,200 1,300 $2,400

60 40 100 1,500 1,600

40 25 65 1,035 1,100

Exhibit 12-2

The Techniques of Financial Analysis Analysts use numbers found on the financial statements. It’s important to understand the sales, expenses, and net income of a business. It’s important to understand the amount of a business’s assets, liabilities, and stockholders’ equity. It’s important to understand how much cash a business has and where the business obtained and used cash. However, it’s also important to look at relationships called ratios. Let’s look at an example. You own two companies, Company A and Company B. This year, Company A

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 604

03/04/14 2:43 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

605

earned net income of $1,000 and Company B earned net income of $100. Which company performed the best? Looking only at numbers, you would say Company A outperformed Company B. Company A’s net income was 10 times as great as Company B’s net income. However, how would your perception change if you knew that Company A had $100,000 in assets and Company B had $100 in assets? The management of Company A only produced $1 of net income for every $100 of assets, while the management of Company B produced $1 of net income for every $1 of assets. The ratio of income to ­assets was much better for Company B. Given the resources each had, the management of Company B was able to use their assets more effectively and outperformed the management of Company A. Tucker Enterprises, Inc. Statement of Retained Earnings Year Ended December 31, 2014 (in thousands) Retained Earnings, January 1, 2014 Add: Net Income Subtotal Less: Dividends Retained Earnings, December 31, 2014

$1,200 75 1,275 25 $1,250

Exhibit 12-3 Tucker Enterprises, Inc. Statement of Cash Flows Year Ended December 31, 2014 (in thousands) Cash flows from operating activities: Net income Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities Depreciation Expense Increase in Accounts Receivable Increase in Inventory Increase in Accounts Payable Increase in Accrued Liabilities Net cash provided by operating activities Cash flows from investing activities: Acquisition of plant assets Net cash used in investing activities Cash flows from financing activities: Proceeds from long-term bank loan Proceeds from sale of common stock Payment of dividends Net cash provided by financing activities Net decrease in cash Cash balance, December 31, 2013 Cash balance, December 31, 2014

$

$

150 (20) (30) 20 15

75

135 210

(1,150) (1,150)

465 450 (25) 890

$

(50) 100 50

Exhibit 12-4 Important parts of financial statement analysis are vertical and horizontal analyses. Let’s first look at vertical analysis.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 605

03/04/14 2:43 PM

606

Chapter 12

Vertical Analysis Vertical analysis of a financial statement reflects each item on the financial statement

Vertical analysis  Analysis of a financial statement that reveals the relationship of each statement item to a specified base amount, which is the 100% figure.

as a percentage of another item (the base amount) on the financial statement. The vertical analysis percentages are calculated as:

Vertical analysis percentage 

Financial statement item $  100 Base amount $

On the income statement, net sales are used as the base amount and are shown as 100%. On the balance sheet, total assets are used as the base amount and are shown as 100%. Sometimes financial statements are prepared reflecting only the percentages for each line item without any of the actual dollar amounts. These are referred to as common-size statements. Formatting financial statements in this way reduces the bias that can occur when analyzing companies of differing sizes. The completed vertical analyses of Tucker Enterprises’ 2014 and 2013 income statements and balance sheets are presented in Exhibits 12-5 and 12-6.

Common-size statement  A financial statement that reports only percentages (no dollar amounts) for each line item on the financial statement.

Tucker Enterprises, Inc. Income Statement Years Ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 (in thousands) Net Sales Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses: Selling, General, and Administrative Depreciation Expense Income Before Interest and Taxes Interest Expense Income Before Taxes Income Tax Expense Net Income

2014 $1,200 600 600

PERCENT 100.0% 50.0 50.0

2013 $1,000 400 600

PERCENT 100.0% 40.0 60.0

200 150 250 100 150 75 $ 75

16.7 12.5 20.8 8.3 12.5 6.3 6.3%

200 100 300 70 230 115 $ 115

20.0 10.0 30.0 7.0 23.0 11.5 11.5%

Exhibit 12-5

A Note About Rounding An interesting issue often arises when preparing vertical analyses of financial statements. This issue occurs when the calculated percentage amounts are added or subtracted from each other in the same way that was used to prepare the financial statements (i.e., the Cost of Goods Sold percentage is subtracted from the Net Sales percentage to get the Gross Profit percentage, etc.). Some of the percentage amounts arrived at in this manner can differ slightly from the percentage amounts that were initially calculated when doing the vertical analysis. For example, in Exhibit 12-5, for 2014, if the calculated percentage for Income Tax Expense is subtracted from the calculated percentage for Income Before Taxes, the result for Net Income is 6.2 (12.5 – 6.3). This amount differs from the 6.3, which was calculated for Net Income when preparing the vertical analysis of the income statement. These differences are the result of the rounding that took place when calculating the percentages for the vertical analysis. These differences are insignificant and will be ignored for purposes of our discussion of vertical analysis. All of the amounts in the vertical analyses that are performed in this textbook will be based on the calculated percentages.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 606

03/04/14 2:43 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

607

Tucker Enterprises, Inc. Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 and 2013 (in thousands) Assets Current Assets: Cash and Cash Equivalents Accounts Receivable, Net Inventory Total Current Assets Property, Plant, and Equipment, Net Total Assets Liabilities Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable Accrued Liabilities Total Current Liabilities Long-Term Bank Loan Total Liabilities Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

2014

PERCENT

$

1.5% 2.9 7.4 11.8 88.2 100.0%

$

60 40 100 1,500 1,600

1.8% 1.2 2.9 44.1 47.1

550 1,250 1,800 $3,400

16.2 36.8 52.9 100.0%

50 100 250 400 3,000 $3,400

2013

PERCENT

$ 100 80 220 400 2,000 $2,400

4.2% 3.3 9.2 16.7 83.3 100.0%

40 25 65 1,035 1,100

1.7% 1.0 2.7 43.1 45.8

100 1,200 1,300 $2,400

4.2 50.0 54.2 100.0%

$

Exhibit 12-6

Horizontal Analysis Horizontal analysis  Study of dollar amount and percentage changes in line items on comparative financial statements.

Base period  The base period is the first and earliest period in computing changes in line items.

The study of percentage changes in the line items on comparative financial statements is called horizontal analysis. Although it can be useful to know if individual financial statement amounts (such as sales, wages expense, or accounts receivable) have increased or decreased from the prior period, the percentage change is often more relevant and, therefore, more helpful to know. For example, sales may have increased by $80,000, but considered alone, this fact is not very helpful. For some companies, an $80,000 increase in sales would be significant while for others it would be minor. It is better to know by what percentage sales have increased from the prior year. For instance, knowing that sales have increased by 15% is more meaningful than knowing sales increased by $80,000. To compute the percentage change in the line items on comparative financial statements, • Compute the dollar amount of the change from the earlier period to the later period. • Divide the dollar amount of change by the earlier period amount and multiply by 100. We call the earlier period the base period. To illustrate horizontal analysis, let’s consider the comparative income statement and balance sheet for Tucker Enterprises presented in Exhibits 12-1 and 12-2. The increase in Net Sales is computed as:

Step 1. Compute the dollar amount of change in sales from 2013 to 2014:

2014 amount  2013 amount  Dollar change $1,200  $1,000  $200

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 607

Step 2. Compute the percentage change for the period by dividing the dollar amount of change by the base period (2013) amount and multiplying the result by 100:

03/04/14 2:43 PM

608

Chapter 12

Percentage change 

Dollar change $200  100   20.0% Base period amount $1,000

The percentage changes in the remaining items are computed in the same manner. The completed horizontal analyses for Tucker Enterprises’ financial statements are shown in Exhibits 12-7 and 12-8.

Exhibit 12-7

Tucker Enterprises, Inc. Income Statement Years Ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 (in thousands) Net Sales Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses: Selling, General, and Administrative Depreciation Expense Income Before Interest and Taxes Interest Expense Income Before Taxes Income Tax Expense Net Income

Exhibit 12-8

2013 $1,000 400 600

200 150 250 100 150 75 $ 75

200 100 300 70 230 115 $ 115

INCREASE (DECREASE) AMOUNT PERCENTAGE 20.0 % $200 50.0 200 — — — 50 (50) 30 (80) (40) $ (40)

— 50.0 (16.7) 42.9 (34.8) (34.8) (34.8)%

Tucker Enterprises, Inc. Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 and 2013 (in thousands) Assets Current Assets: Cash and Cash Equivalents Accounts Receivable, Net Inventory Total Current Assets Property, Plant, and Equipment, Net Total Assets Liabilities Current Liabilities: Accounts Payable Accrued Liabilities Total Current Liabilities Long-Term Bank Loan Total Liabilities Stockholders’ Equity Common Stock Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 608

2014 $1,200 600 600

2014

2013

INCREASE (DECREASE) AMOUNT PERCENTAGE

$

50 100 250 400 3,000 $3,400

$ 100 80 220 400 2,000 $2,400

$ (50) 20 30 — 1,000 $1,000

$

$

$

550 1,250 1,800 $3,400

100 1,200 1,300 $2,400

450 50 500 $1,000

60 40 100 1,500 1,600

40 25 65 1,035 1,100

20 15 35 465 500

(50.0)% 25.0 13.6 0.0 50.0 41.7 %

50.0 60.0 53.8 44.9 45.5 450.0 4.2 38.5 41.7 %

03/04/14 2:43 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

609

Trend Percentages Trend percentages  A form of horizontal analysis in which ­percentages are computed by ­selecting a base year and then ­expressing amounts for following years as a percentage of the base year amount.

Trend percentages are a form of horizontal analysis. Trends indicate the direction a

business is taking. How have sales changed over a five-year period? What trend does net income show? These questions can be answered by looking at trend percentages over a period of time, such as three to five years. To calculate trend percentages, a base year must first be selected. The base year’s trend percentage is then set equal to 100%. Next, the amounts for each subsequent year are expressed as a percentage of the base year amount. To compute trend percentages, divide each item for the years following the base year by the base year amount and multiply the result by 100.

Trend percentage 

Any year $  100 Base year $

Let’s assume Tucker Enterprises’ Net Sales were $575,000 in 2010 and rose to $1,200,000 in 2014. To illustrate trend analysis, let’s review the trend of Net Sales ­during 2010–2014, with dollars in thousands. The base year is 2010, so that year’s trend percentage is set equal to 100. We compute the trend percentages by dividing each year’s net sales amount by the 2010 net sales amount and multiplying the result by 100. (in thousands)

2014

Net Sales............................................ $1,200 Trend Percentage............................... 208.7%

2013

2012

$1,000 $ 725 173.9% 126.1%

2011

2010

$ 630 $ 575 109.6% 100.0%

The trend analysis shows that Tucker Enterprises’ Net Sales increased moderately in 2009 and 2010 and then substantially in 2011 and 2012. You can perform a trend analysis on any one or multiple items you consider important. Trend analysis is widely used to predict future performance. As you can see, we look at numbers, ratios, and trends to analyze the performance of a business. So let’s analyze a business using the five key questions previously discussed.

Question 1: Is the Business a Going Concern?

Net working capital  Current assets minus current liabilities. It ­measures a business’s ability to meet its short-term obligations with its ­current assets.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 609

Will the business exist in the near future? Is the business able to pay its bills and obligations? If it will not, then financial analysis must focus on what lenders and owners will receive when the business stops operating and is liquidated. To answer this question, analysts look at the business’s liquidity. To begin, look at a business’s cash and assets that might be easily converted into cash. Look back to  Chapters 5, 7, and 8, and refresh your memory regarding Cash, Accounts Receivable, Inventory, and Marketable Securities. Accounts Receivable and Inventory may or may not be easily converted into cash depending on the business’s model and strategy. Besides the amount of cash and assets that can be converted into cash, analysts look at how these items change over time. Analysts use the statement of cash flows to help with this. To review, look at Chapter 11, The Statement of Cash Flows. Analysts also use horizontal analysis to appreciate trends. To look at liquidity, analysts look at a business’s net working capital, current ratio, quick or acid-test ratio, and cash conversion cycle. Net working capital represents how much current assets exceed current liabilities and is computed as:

Net Working Capital  Current Assets  Current Liabilities

03/04/14 2:43 PM

610

Chapter 12

Current ratio  Current assets ­divided by current liabilities. Measures a business’s ability to meet its ­short-term obligations with its ­current assets.

The current ratio measures a company’s ability to meet current obligations with its current assets and is computed as:

Quick ratio  Quick assets (cash, short-term investments, and net ­current receivables) divided by ­current liabilities. It measures a company’s ability to pay its current liabilities if they came due immediately; also called the ­acid-test ratio.

The quick ratio measures a company’s ability to use its near cash or quick assets to meet its current obligations and is computed as:

Current Ratio 

Quick Ratio 

Current Assets Current Liabilities

Quick Assets (Cash  Net Current Receivables  Short-Term Investments) Current Liabilities

Analysts also look at a business’s cash conversion cycle. Remember from Chapter 11 that the cash conversion cycle measures the time between when a company outlays cash for the purchase of inventory and when it collects cash from the sale of the inventory and is computed as:

Cash Conversion Cycle  (Days-Sales-In-Inventory)  (Receivable Collection Period)  (Accounts Payable Payment Period) Cash conversion cycle  The number of days it takes to collect cash from the sale of inventory versus the number of days it takes to pay for inventory. It is computed as the days-sales-in-inventory, plus accounts receivable collection period, less the accounts payable payment period.

Where:

Days-Sales-In-Inventory  Receivable Collection Period  Accounts Payable Payment Period 

Average Inventory (Cost of Goods Sold/365 Days) Average Net Accounts Receivable (Net Credit Sales/365 Days) Average Accounts Payable (Cost of Goods Sold/365 Days)

An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc. First, review Tucker Enterprises’ horizontal analysis of the balance sheet presented in Exhibit 12-8. Now look back at Exhibit 12-4 to see Tucker Enterprises’ statement of cash flows. Look where Tucker Enterprises is getting and using its cash. Lastly, compute Tucker Enterprises’ net working capital, current ratio, quick ratio, and cash conversion cycle. The 2014 net working capital, current ratio, and quick ratio for Tucker Enterprises are computed as:

Net Working Capital  $400  $100  $300

Current Ratio 

Quick Ratio 

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 610

$400 4 $100

($50  $100)  1.5 $100

03/04/14 2:43 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

611

The 2014 cash conversion cycle and related ratios of Tucker Enterprises are computed as (assuming all sales are credit sales):

Days-Sales-in-Inventory 

(($250  $220)/2)  143 Days ($600/365 days)

Receivable Collection Period 

(($100  $80)/2)  27 Days ($1200/365 days)

Accounts Payable Payment Period 

(($60  $40)/2)  30 Days ($600/365 days)

Cash Conversion Cycle  143 Days  27 Days  30 Days  140 Days So what does this tell you? Is Tucker Enterprises a going concern? Tucker Enterprises has $50,000 in cash at the end of 2014. This is a reduction of 50%, or $50,000 from the end of 2013. This raises a concern. However, in examining Tucker Enterprises’ statement of cash flows (Exhibit 12-4), it appears Tucker has used a lot of cash to increase its investment in long-term assets. This implies Tucker Enterprises is preparing to grow. So is Tucker Enterprises able to pay its bills and stay in business? It appears so. Tucker Enterprises has a strong net cash flow from operations (Exhibit 12-4). It also has good net working capital. Its current and quick ratios are strong. For every dollar of current liabilities, Tucker Enterprises has four dollars of current assets and one and a half dollars of quick assets. Also, as seen in the calculation of its cash conversion cycle, Tucker Enterprises can pay its accounts payable within 30 days. The bottom line is that it appears Tucker Enterprises is a going concern and analysts can assume it will not be liquidated in the near future. Although we do not have a competitor to benchmark, it appears the business will exist in the future to compete.

Question 2: How Is the Business Earning a Net Income or Loss?

Income or loss from ­continuing operations  Net ­income excluding the impact of discontinued operations and ­extraordinary items.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 611

The income statement tells the analyst if, how, and when a business is earning net income or loss. Analysts look at the notes that follow the financial statements to understand how the business is recognizing revenue and expenses. Before an analyst begins to analyze a business’s income, he or she must ask the question, “What is the income measure that should be used?” Sometimes a business experiences items that are not a normal part of its operations. A business may need to shut down permanently and discontinue part of its operations. A business may experience an extraordinary event such as a natural disaster. Analysts may want to evaluate the business by using only the income or loss from the recurring, continuing operations. Income or loss from continuing operations excludes the impact of discontinued operations and extraordinary items.

03/04/14 2:43 PM

612

Chapter 12

For illustration purposes, consider the income statement for Best Way, Inc., presented in Exhibit 12-9:

Best Way, Inc. Income Statement Year Ended December 31, 2014 Net Sales Revenue Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Operating Income Other Income (Expense): Interest Expense Loss on Sale of Fixed Assets Income from continuing operations before income tax Income tax expense Income from continuing operations Income from discontinued operations, net of income tax of $26,000 Income before extraordinary items Extraordinary loss from hurricane, net of tax savings of $17,000 Net Income

$1,877,000 1,145,000 732,000 423,000 309,000 (32,000) (14,000) 263,000 72,000 191,000 68,000 259,000 (42,000) $ 217,000

Exhibit 12-9

Income from Continuing Operations In Exhibit 12-9, the topmost section reports income from continuing operations. Continuing operations consist of business activities that will most likely continue from period to period. Reporting income from continuing operations, therefore, helps investors make predictions about a company’s future earnings. The continuing operations of Best Way, Inc., include two items that need explanation: • Other income (expense) includes items that, although a normal part of business operations, fall outside of a company’s core business activities. Therefore, these items are not included in sales, cost of goods sold, or operating expenses but are instead reported separately. Gains and losses on the sale of fixed assets, as well as interest income and interest expense, are examples of items reported as part of other income (expense). Best Way, Inc., reported interest expense of $32,000 and a loss on the sale of fixed assets of $14,000. • Income tax expense reflects the income tax expense that is assessed on the company’s operating income and other income (expense). Best Way, Inc., was assessed $72,000 of income tax on its operating income. After continuing operations, an income statement may include the following items: • Discontinued operations • Extraordinary gains and losses

Discontinued Operations Corporations often consist of many different business segments. A business segment is a distinguishable part of a business that is subject to a different set of risks and returns than other parts of the business. Information on any of the company’s segments that have been sold (or otherwise discontinued) is reported separately from the results of continuing operations. This is because the discontinued segment will not be part of the company’s operations in the future. The results of discontinued operations are generally reported net of income tax expense (or income tax savings in the case of a loss).

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 612

03/04/14 2:43 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

613

Best Way, Inc., reported net income from discontinued operations of $68,000. This amount represents income of $94,000 less income tax expense of $26,000.

Extraordinary Gains and Losses

Operating income  Profit or loss from operating the business. Operating income is computed as revenue less cost of goods sold, less operating expenses. Operating income is also called earnings before interest and taxes (EBIT).

Gross profit percentage  Sales, less cost of goods sold, divided by net sales. Net income percentage  Net income divided by net sales. Net income percentage is often called return on sales.

Extraordinary gains and losses, also called extraordinary items, are both unusual and infrequent in nature. Losses from natural disasters (floods, earthquakes, hurricanes, and tornadoes) and the taking of company assets by a foreign government (expropriation) are examples of extraordinary items. Extraordinary items are generally reported net of their income tax effects and are reported separately from continuing operations because of their infrequent nature. Best Way, Inc., reported an extraordinary loss from a hurricane of $42,000 (net). This amount represents a loss of $59,000, net of tax savings of $17,000. After determining the net income measure on which they will focus, analysts then look at the individual items in the income statement and how each changed from one year to another. They often divide the income statement into two parts, the operating part and the financing part. The operating part starts with revenue less cost of goods sold, which equals gross profit. Gross profit less operating expenses is operating income, often called income from operations or earnings before interest and taxes (EBIT). EBIT is the operating part of the income statement and is created by selling products, hiring people, and using assets. The financing part is EBIT less interest expense, which results in taxable income. After paying taxes, owners get what remains, net income or loss. EBIT provides the return to the providers of the money. Lenders get interest and owners get net income. Analysts use different measures and techniques to help understand how a business earns net income or loss. Analysts use vertical and horizontal analyses to understand the relationship of sales and expenses through time. A part of this analysis is computing the gross profit percentage and net income percentage. Look back to Chapter 4. The gross profit percentage measures the percentage of sales left after subtracting cost of goods sold and is computed as:

Gross Profit Percentage 

Gross Profit Net Sales

The net income percentage measures the percentage of sales left after subtracting cost of goods sold, all operating expenses, interest, and taxes and is computed as:

Net Income Percentage 

Net Income Net Sales

An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc. Look back at Tucker Enterprises’ income statement in Exhibit 12-1 to see how Tucker Enterprises is earning net income. Then look at Exhibits 12-5 and 12-7, which show the vertical and horizontal analyses of Tucker Enterprises’ income statement. Using these statements, you can see how Tucker Enterprises generated its net income and how that process changed over time. So what does this tell you? Is Tucker Enterprises earning a net income or loss? How is Tucker Enterprises doing this? How does Tucker Enterprises compare with similar businesses selling bicycle parts? Tucker Enterprises is profitable. However, its profitability is dropping. Look at these factors: 1. Per Exhibit 12-7, sales increased 20.0% from $1,000,000 in 2013 to $1,200,000 in 2014. However, net income dropped by 34.8%, or $40,000 (Exhibit 12-7). 2. Tucker Enterprises’ gross profit percentage decreased from 60.0% in 2013 to 50.0% in 2014 (Exhibit 12-5). 3. Its net income percentage has decreased from 11.5% in 2013 to 6.3% in 2014 (Exhibit 12-5).

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 613

03/04/14 2:43 PM

614

Chapter 12

There appears to be a problem with pricing the product and/or controlling expenses. Without a competitor to benchmark, it’s hard to determine if this is from Tucker Enterprises’ environment or if it is a problem with the business’s management. The bottom line is that Tucker Enterprises is profitable, but the trend is not good. There appears to be risk that Tucker Enterprises’ past performance may not be sustained in the future.

Question 3: Where Is the Business Getting Its Money, and Can It Pay Its Debt Obligations? Financing decision  How a business acquires money, debt or equity, to acquire assets.

Debt covenants  Conditions, stated in the debt contract, that specify the requirements agreed to by the lender and borrower. Collateral  Assets pledged by a borrower to guarantee the payment of a liability.

Debt ratio  Total liabilities ­ divided by total assets. It measures a ­business’s ability to pay liabilities.

Where a business decides to get money is called the financing decision. A business is financed with debt and stockholders’ equity. Both have a cost. The cost of debt is interest. The cost of stockholders’ equity is hard to determine but real. Owners will not let a business use their money unless they expect a return. Owners require net income that compensates them for time and risk. Go back to Chapter 9 and review the sections on liabilities. Analysts look at the balance sheet to determine the amount of, types of, and changes in the debt a business owes. They then read the notes to the financial statements to understand the interest rate being charged on the debt, when the debt is due, and any special features of the debt called covenants. Debt covenants are agreements between the lender and borrower. An example of a covenant is where the lender can take ownership of an asset if the borrower does not pay the loan. That asset is called collateral. Analysts also look at the amount of, types of, and changes in a business’s stockholders’ equity. They then read the notes to the financial statements to see what is happening in stockholders’ equity. Look back in Chapter 10 to refresh your memory regarding common stock, preferred stock, retained earnings, and dividends. Remember that the statement of retained earnings is a reconciliation of how retained earnings changed from the beginning to the end of the period. The goal of the financing decision is to obtain money at the lowest possible cost. Debt is less expensive than stockholders’ equity. However, a business does not want too much debt. A business will fail if it has more debt that it can pay back. To look at how much debt a business has relative to its stockholders’ equity, analysts often use vertical analysis. Analysts also use horizontal analysis to see how a business is changing the blend of liabilities and stockholders’ equity over time. To look at critical relationships, analysts use ratios. The first ratio in this area that analysts use is the debt ratio. The debt ratio tells the analysts the percentage of assets financed with debt. The debt ratio is computed as:

Debt Ratio 

Total Liabilities Total Assets

To see if a business can pay the interest on its debt, analysts look at a business’s Interest coverage ratio  Ratio of income from operations to interest expense. It measures the number of times that operating income can cover interest expense; also called the times interest earned ratio.

interest coverage ratio. The interest coverage ratio is computed as:

Interest Coverage Ratio 

EBIT Interest Expense

An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc. Look back at Tucker Enterprises’ statement of cash flows presented in Exhibit 12-4 to see how Tucker Enterprises is financing its assets. Then look at the vertical and horizontal analyses of Tucker Enterprises’ balance sheet presented in Exhibits 12-6 and 12-8.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 614

03/04/14 2:43 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

615

Next, look at Exhibit 12-3, Tucker Enterprises’ 2014 statement of retained earnings to see what is going in and out of the retained earnings in stockholders’ equity. Lastly, compute Tucker Enterprises’ debt ratio and interest coverage ratio. Tucker Enterprises’ 2014 debt ratio computes as:

Debt Ratio 

Total Liabilities $1,600   47.1% $3,400 Total Assets

The debt ratio can also be found on the vertical analysis of the balance sheet by looking at the total liabilities line item. Tucker Enterprises’ 2014 interest coverage ratio is computed as:

Interest Coverage Ratio 

$250 EBIT   2.5 $100 Interest Expense

So what does this tell you? Where is Tucker Enterprises getting its money, and can it pay its debt obligations? Tucker Enterprises uses a lot of debt to finance its assets. Per Exhibit 12-6, 47.1% of its assets are financed with debt and 52.9% with equity in 2014. This is approximately the same as in 2013. Can Tucker Enterprises pay its debt? The answer appears to be yes. 1. It has a strong operating cash flow (Exhibit 12-4). 2. Tucker Enterprises’ interest coverage ratio is 2.5, telling the analyst that in 2014 the business generated earnings before interest and taxes (EBIT) that was two and a half times the amount of its interest expense. Even if EBIT fell, Tucker Enterprises appears to have sufficient operating income to cover the interest expense. The bottom line is that it appears Tucker Enterprises is well financed. It is paying its debts. It appears its risk of defaulting on its debts is low for the foreseeable future. Regardless of how its competitors are financed, Tucker Enterprises appears to be doing well in this area.

Question 4: How Is the Business Investing Its Money, and Is It Using Its Assets Efficiently? Investing decision  How a ­business uses money to acquire assets.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 615

How a business uses its money to acquire assets is called the investing decision. Businesses invest money in assets such as cash, accounts receivable, inventory, buildings, and patents. The goal of the investing decision is to create operating income that rewards lenders and owners for the use of their money adequately. Analysts want to understand the types of assets in which a business invests and how those investments change over time. Look back at Chapters 5, 7, and 8. Analysts look at the balance sheet to determine the amount of, types of, and changes to the assets a business owns. They then read the notes to the financial statements to gain insights into the assets, such as depreciation assumptions. Analysts want to understand how the assets come together to produce income. Analysts want to understand the productivity of each asset and combination of all assets. They recognize each asset has a role in earning net income. Businesses use long-term assets, such as buildings, to produce and deliver products. Tangible products are inventory, which are sold for cash or accounts receivable. Inventory and accounts receivable must be converted into cash, which is used to pay debts, dividends, and other needs of the business. All assets, whether current or long-term, have a role in earning net income. However, it’s also important to understand how the assets work together. Analysts use different techniques and measures to understand how a business invests money in assets and uses the assets to earn net income or loss. Analysts often use vertical and horizontal analyses to see the relative importance of each asset through time.

03/04/14 2:43 PM

616

Chapter 12

Accounts receivable turnover  Measures a company’s ability to ­collect cash from credit customers. To compute accounts receivable ­turnover, divide net credit sales by ­average net accounts receivable.

Analysts then compute ratios to see the efficiency or productivity of each asset and assets in total. These ratios include the accounts receivable turnover, the inventory turnover, the fixed asset turnover, the total asset turnover, and return on assets (ROA). The accounts receivable turnover measures the ability to collect from credit customers and is computed as:

Accounts Receivable Turnover 

Net Credit Sales Average Net Accounts Receivable

Inventory turnover  Measures the number of times a company sells its average level of inventory during a year. To compute inventory turnover, divide cost of goods sold by average inventory.

The inventory turnover measures how many times inventory is sold over a period of time and is computed as:

Fixed asset turnover  A measure of how a business utilizes its property, plant, and equipment to generate sales. Fixed asset turnover is computed as sales divided by average fixed assets.

The fixed asset turnover measures a company’s ability to generate sales from fixed assets and is computed as:

Total asset turnover  A measure of how a business utilizes its total assets to generate sales. Total asset turnover is computed as sales divided by average total assets.

The total asset turnover measures a company’s efficiency in using all of its assets to generate sales and is computed as:

Return on assets (ROA)  Ratio of net income to average total assets. It measures a company’s effectiveness in using assets to generate earnings; also called rate of return on total assets.

The return on assets (ROA) measures the net income earned on each dollar of assets invested and is computed as:

Inventory Turnover 

Fixed Asset Turnover 

Total Asset Turnover 

Return on Assets 

Cost of Goods Sold Average Inventory

Sales Average Fixed Assets

Sales Average Total Assets

Net Income Average Total Assets

An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc. Once again, review Exhibit 12-4 to see how Tucker Enterprises is financing its assets. Then look at Exhibits 12-5, 12-6, 12-7, and 12-8 showing the vertical and horizontal analyses of Tucker Enterprises’ financial statements. Lastly, compute Tucker Enterprises’ 2014 ­accounts receivable turnover, inventory turnover, fixed asset turnover, total asset turnover, and return on assets. Tucker Enterprises’ accounts receivable turnover is computed as:

Accounts Receivable Turnover 

$1,200 Net Credit Sales   13.33 times Average Net Accounts Receivable (($100  $80)/2)

Tucker Enterprises’ inventory turnover is computed as:

Inventory Turnover 

$600 Cost of Goods Sold   2.55 times (($250  $220)/2) Average Inventory

Tucker Enterprises’ fixed asset turnover is computed as:

Fixed Asset Turnover 

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 616

$1,200 Sales   0.48 times Average Fixed Assets (($3,000  $2,000)/2)

03/04/14 2:43 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

617

Tucker Enterprises’ total asset turnover is computed as:

Total Asset Turnover 

$1,200 Sales   0.41 times Average Total Assets (($3,400  $2,400)/2)

Tucker Enterprises’ ROA is computed as:

Return on Assets 

$75 Net Income   2.6% Average Total Assets (($3,400  $2,400)/2)

Now what does this tell you? How is Tucker Enterprises investing its money, and is it using its assets efficiently? It’s hard to tell without understanding its environment and benchmarking its competitors. However, there are some concerns. As you can see in Exhibit 12-6, Tucker Enterprises has a lot of assets at the end of 2014 ($3,400,000). During 2014, it increased its investment in assets by 41.7%, from $2,400,000 at the end of 2013 to $3,400,000 at the end of 2014. This increase was from accounts receivable; inventory; and property, plant, and equipment. But is the investment producing superior results? 1. The accounts receivable turnover is 13.33 times for 2014. Tucker Enterprises is collecting its receivables every 27 days. This appears reasonable given its business model. 2. However, its 2014 inventory turnover is 2.55. After it buys inventory, it takes Tucker Enterprises 143 days to sell the inventory. This appears to be a very low turnover, indicating it has too much inventory. 3. Likewise, its fixed asset turnover is 0.48. Tucker Enterprises has a lot of, maybe too many, fixed assets (property, plant, and equipment) for the sales it generates. This all results in a 2014 ROA of only 2.6%. The bottom line is that Tucker Enterprises appears to have some room to improve its management of assets. For the sales it generates, it appears to have too many assets. Tucker Enterprises needs to increase ROA by either increasing net income or decreasing assets. This inefficiency creates concern and risk.

Question 5: Is the Business Generating Enough Net Income to Reward the Stockholders for the Use of Their Money?

Earnings per share (EPS)  Reflects the net income earned for each share of the company’s outstanding common stock.

Analysts want to know if owners are receiving enough benefits to justify their investment in the business. Stockholders invest money in corporations. Corporations use that money to generate net income and eventually pay dividends. But do the net income and dividends reward the stockholders enough for using their money over time and for taking risks? Analysts will first look at the financial statements using vertical and horizontal analyses. Analysts want to understand how a business generates net income (or loss) and dividends in a period of time and through time. They will then divide net income by the average number of common shares outstanding to compute the earnings per share (EPS).1 Earnings per share (EPS) measures the portion of a company’s net income allocated to each outstanding share of common stock and is computed as:

Earnings per Share (EPS) 

Net Income Average Number of Common Shares Outstanding

1

Some corporations must report two sets of EPS figures, a basic EPS and a diluted EPS. The difference is that basic EPS uses outstanding common shares and diluted EPS uses outstanding common shares plus the additional shares of common stock that would arise if convertible preferred stock (or other dilutive items) were exchanged for common shares. Diluted EPS is always lower than basic EPS.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 617

03/04/14 2:43 PM

618

Chapter 12

Dividends per share (DPS)  The dividends a business pays for each share of common stock ­outstanding. Dividends per share is computed as dividends divided by the average number of shares of common stock outstanding.

Dividend payout ratio  A measure of how much dividends a business is paying in a given period in relationship to the earnings in the same period. The dividend payout ratio is computed as dividends divided by net income. Return on equity (ROE)  Ratio of net income to average stockholders’ equity. It is a measure of profitability; also called rate of return on equity.

They will also divide dividends by the average number of common shares outstanding to compute the dividends per share (DPS). Dividends per share (DPS) is the amount of the dividend that shareholders receive for each share of common stock they own and is computed as:

Dividends Per Share (DPS) 

Dividends Average Number of Common Shares Outstanding

To see how dividends and earnings in a given period are related, analysts will compute a dividend payout ratio. The dividend payout ratio measures how well earnings support dividend payments and is computed as:

Dividend Payout Ratio 

Dividends Net Income

Finally, analysts will want to look at the ratio of net income to stockholders’ equity. This ratio is called return on equity (ROE). Return on equity (ROE) measures how much profit a company generates with the money shareholders have invested and is computed as:

Return on Equity (ROE) 

Net Income Average Stockholders’ Equity

Return on equity measures the benefits a business earned for its stockholders in relation to the investment made by the stockholders. ROE is the result of all processes that affect the earning of net income. Let’s decompose ROE into a few of its components.

ROE  Net Income/Average Stockholders’ Equity 

Net Income Average Total Assets Sales   Sales Average Total Assets Average Stockholders’ Equity

Now, let’s think through this equation. Net Income/Sales is the net income percentage and measures how a business operates to earn net income. Sales/Average Total Assets is a measure of the productivity of assets. Average Total Assets/Average Stockholders’ Equity is a measure of how the business finances its assets. ROE is a measure that combines all the elements of managing a business, including the financing, investing, and operating decisions.

An Example: Tucker Enterprises, Inc. Look back at Exhibits 12-1, 12-2, 12-3, and 12-4. Review the vertical and horizontal analyses shown in Exhibits 12-5, 12-6, 12-7, and 12-8. Compute Tucker Enterprises’ earnings per share, dividends per share, dividend payout ratio, and return on equity. Tucker Enterprises’ 2014 earnings per share is computed as:

Earnings per Share (EPS) 

$75,000 Net Income   $7.50 per Share Average Number of Common Shares Outstanding 10,000 Shares

In our example, Tucker Enterprises has 10,000 shares of common stock outstanding during 2014. Also remember that the financial statements are stated in thousands of dollars.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 618

03/04/14 2:43 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

619

Tucker Enterprises’ dividends per share is computed as:

Dividends per Share (DPS) 

$25,000 Dividends   $2.50 per Share Average Number of Common Shares Outstanding 10,000 Shares

Don’t forget that dividends are reported in the statement of retained earnings (Exhibit 12-3). Tucker Enterprises’ dividend payout ratio is computed as:

Dividend Payout Ratio 

$25,000 Dividends   0.33, or 33% $75,000 Net Income

Tucker Enterprises’ return on equity is computed as:

Return on Equity (ROE) 



Return on Equity 

Net Income Average Stockholders’ Equity Net Income Sales Average Total Assets   Sales Average Total Assets Average Stockholders’ Equity

Net Income $75   0.048, or 4.8% Average Stockholders’ Equity (($1,800  $1,300)/2)

Breaking down Tucker Enterprises’ return on equity, we see the following:

$75 Net Income   0.062 $1,200 Sales $1,200 Sales   0.414 Average Total Assets (($3,400  $2,400)/2) (($3,400  $2,400)/2) Average Total Assets   1.871 Average Stockholders’ Equity (($1,800  $1,300)/2)

Return on Equity  0.062  0.414  1.871  0.048  4.8% Now what does this tell you? Is Tucker Enterprises generating enough net income to reward the stockholders for the use of their money? It’s hard to tell without understanding Tucker Enterprises’ environment and benchmarking its competitors. However, there are certain measures to help answer this question. Tucker Enterprises is profitable. It generated an ROE of 4.8% in 2014. It’s good that it was able to compete, stay in business, and pay its bills. However, a 4.8% ROE doesn’t appear to be sufficient to justify owners providing money in the long term. Think about it. Tucker Enterprises has significant risks. These risks appear to come from asset and expense management. How much would you pay for a business like Tucker Enterprises that pays you a $2.50 dividend per share and earns a 4.8% ROE? Before you reach your answer, think about your other options, including putting your money in an insured, interest-bearing deposit in a safe bank.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 619

03/04/14 2:43 PM

620

Chapter 12

Stop and Think… Julie and Bryan were discussing the income statement one day after their accounting class. Julie commented that the best way to gauge the future performance of a business was to look at net income because it includes all aspects of a company’s performance. Bryan countered that it was better to focus on income from continuing operations when trying to assess the future performance of a business. Who has the strongest argument?

Answer

Bryan has the strongest argument. It is possible for a company’s net income to include income/loss from a segment of the business that has been terminated (discontinued operations) or income/loss from an event that was both unusual and infrequent (extraordinary item). Both discontinued operations and extraordinary items are not likely to recur in the future and, therefore, are not good indicators of future performance. Because income from continuing operations excludes both discontinued operations and extraordinary items, it is a better indicator of a company’s future performance.

Try It… Your friend owns a small business and she asks for your advice. For the past couple of years, her company has extended credit to its customers. She wonders how well her company manages its accounts receivable. During the most recent year, your friend’s company had net credit sales of $743,000. Net Accounts Receivable at the beginning of the year was $82,000. Ending net Accounts Receivable was $77,000. The company’s credit terms are net 30. What should you tell your friend regarding how well accounts receivable is managed?

Answer

In order to analyze how effectively the company is at managing its accounts receivable, you should calculate the accounts receivable turnover. The accounts receivable turnover is calculated as:

Net Credit Sales $743,000 = = 9.35 Average Net Accounts Receivable    $79,500   

With credit terms of 30 days, you would expect to have an accounts receivable turnover of closer to 12 (360 days/30 days) so you should tell your friend that it appears that the company is not managing its accounts receivable very well.

How Do You Put Everything Together to Make Decisions? 3

Use financial analysis to assess the value of a business

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 620

The purpose of financial analysis is to understand how a business creates value. Specifically, financial analysis looks at the financing, investing, and operating decisions that create net income. Financial analysis is a powerful tool to understand how a business creates value. Look at Exhibit 12-10 and see all five key questions for analysis and the corresponding ratios with which we’ve worked. Now reflect on what they tell you, how they are related, and how you can use them to make good business decisions.

03/04/14 2:43 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

Five Key Questions

Ratios used to analyze and make the decision

Is the business a going concern?

Use liquidity ratios to determine the following:

621

Net Working Capital  Current Assets  Current Liabilities Current Ratio 

Current Assets Current Liabilities

Quick Assets (Cash  Net Current Receivables  Short-Term Investments) Quick Ratio  Current Liabilities Cash Conversion Cycle  (Days-Sales-In-Inventory)  (Receivable Collection Period)  (Accounts Payable Payment Period) Days-Sales-In-Inventory  Receivable Collection Period  Accounts Payable Payment Period  How is the business earning a net income or loss?

Where is the business getting its money and can it pay its debt obligations?

Average Accounts Payable (Cost of Goods Sold/365 Days)

Gross Profit Percentage 

Gross Profit Net Sales

Net Income Percentage 

Net Income Net Sales

Use solvency ratios to determine the following:

Debt Ratio 

Total Liabilities Total Assets EBIT Interest Expense

Use asset management ratios to determine the following:

Accounts Receivable Turnover Ratio  Inventory Turnover Ratio 

Is the business generating enough net income to reward the stockholders for the use of their money?

Average Net Accounts Receivable (Net Credit Sales/365 Days)

Use profitability ratios to determine the following:

Interest Coverage Ratio  How is the business investing its money and is it using its assets efficiently?

Average Inventory (Cost of Goods Sold/365 Days)

Net Credit Sales Average Net Accounts Receivable Cost of Goods Sold Average Inventory

Fixed Asset Turnover Ratio 

Sales Average Fixed Assets

Total Asset Turnover Ratio 

Sales Average Total Assets

Return on Assets 

Net Income Average Total Assets

Use market analysis ratios to determine the following:

Earnings per Share (EPS) 

Net Income Average Number of Common Shares Outstanding

Dividends per Share (DPS) 

Dividends Average Number of Common Shares Outstanding

Dividend Payout Ratio  Return on Equity (ROE) 

Dividends Net Income Net Income Average Stockholders’ Equity

Exhibit 12-10

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 621

03/04/14 2:44 PM

622

Chapter 12

Seeing the Impact of Decisions Let’s use Tucker Enterprises to examine the impact of decisions. Let’s assume the stockholders of Tucker Enterprises believe its ROE is not sufficient to compensate them for the use of their money. The stockholders inform the management of Tucker Enterprises that they will find new management or liquidate the business unless management can improve ROE to at least 7%. The management of Tucker Enterprises meets and makes four decisions: 1. With better management, Tucker Enterprises can lower expenses and increase net income by $25,000. 2. With better inventory management, Tucker Enterprises can lower its average inventory by $100,000. 3. With better management of accounts receivable, Tucker Enterprises can lower its average accounts receivable by $50,000. 4. With the funds released by lowering inventory and accounts receivable, Tucker Enterprises can declare a one-time dividend, lowering average stockholders’ equity by $150,000. If the management of Tucker Enterprises had made those decisions this past year, what would the ROE be? The components of Tucker Enterprises’ revised ROE would be as shown here (in thousands):

1200 2750 100    7.1% 1200 2750 1400 The results of better management have been summarized in Exhibit 12-11. The actions of Tucker Enterprises’ management will create a better return on equity for stockholders.

Tucker Enterprises: Revised Return on Equity (ROE) Sales

Unchanged

Net Income

Net Income Increases from $75,000 to $100,000 from lowering expenses

Average Total Assets

Average Total Assets Decrease from $2,900,000 to $2,750,000 from lowering average inventory by $100,000 and average accounts receivable by $50,000

Average Stockholders’ Equity

Average Stockholders’ Equity Decreases from $1,550,000 to $1,400,000 from the one-time dividend

ROE (Revised)

ROE (Revised) Net Income/Average Stockholders’ Equity  $100,000/$1,400,000  0.071, or 7.1%

Exhibit 12-11

What Are Red Flags in Financial Statement Analysis? In reality, financial analysis looks like a precise science because it uses a lot of numbers. It’s not all science. There is a lot of art. That art requires insight and judgment. Financial analysis often discloses that a problem exists. It provides red flags that decision makers must recognize. To understand the causes of the problems may require the analyst to do significant research beyond the financial statements. Recent accounting

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 622

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

623

scandals highlight the importance of these red flags. The following conditions may be cause for concern. • Decreased cash flow. Cash flows from operations validates net income. Is net cash flow from operations consistently lower than net income? If so, the company is in trouble. Are the sales of plant assets a major source of cash? If so, the company may face a cash shortage. • Inability to collect receivables. Is the receivables collection period growing faster than for competitors? A cash shortage may be looming. • Buildup of inventories. Is inventory turnover too slow? If so, the company may have obsolete inventory, or it may be overstating inventory. • Movement of sales, inventory, and receivables. Sales, receivables, and inventory generally move together. Increased sales lead to higher receivables and require more inventory to meet demand. Unexpected or inconsistent movements among sales, inventory, and receivables make the financial statements look suspect. • Earnings problems. Has net income decreased significantly for several years in a row? Has income turned into a loss? Most companies cannot survive consecutive losses year after year. • Too much debt. How does the company’s debt ratio compare to that of major competitors? If the debt ratio is too high, the company may be unable to pay its debts. Based on our financial statement analysis of Tucker Enterprises, the company appears to be in a relatively strong financial condition. One area of concern could be the company’s cash position. Tucker Enterprises should monitor its cash position to ensure that it does not encounter any cash flow problems in the future.

Focus on Decision Making “How Do People Use Financial Analysis to Value a Business?”

There is nothing harder in the financial world than to put a value to a business. Forecasting the future performance of a company is very hard. It’s all about trying to use the past and present to see the future. Valuation of a business starts with financial analysis, but ultimately requires making assumptions about whether the future will be better or worse than the past and present. There are many techniques used to value a business. Analysts will use the past to project the future earnings and free cash flow of the business. They will then estimate how much the future earnings are worth today by using the time value of money noted in Chapter 9. This is a complicated process covered in more advanced texts. However, two measures that are often looked at in valuing a business are dividend yield and priceearnings ratio.

Dividend Yield

Dividends are important. Dividends are the payment of past and present earnings to the stockholders of the business. Although net income is important, stockholders cannot spend net income because it is an accrual measure. Stockholders can spend cash dividends. So why do some businesses pay dividends and others do not? The question is important; the answer is often complicated. However, the logic is based on the question, “What would the business do with the money if it did not pay a dividend?” Dividends are paid when a business does not have a better use for the money. If a business cannot invest the money and earn a return that adequately compensates the owners for their time and risk, then the business should pay the money to its owners. That payment is a dividend. If a business can invest the money and earn a return that adequately compensates the owners for their time and risk, then the business should retain the money and not pay a dividend. The future profits from the new investment will enable the business to pay bigger dividends in the future.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 623

03/04/14 2:44 PM

624

Chapter 12

Dividend yield  Ratio of ­dividends per share of stock to the stock’s market price per share. It tells the percentage of a stock’s market value that the company returns to stockholders annually as dividends.

A ratio used by analysts and stockholders to compare dividends to what stockholders would currently pay for the stock is called the dividend yield. The dividend yield shows how much a company pays out in dividends each year relative to its share price and is computed as:

Dividend Yield 

Dividend per Share Current Market Price per Share of Stock

A high dividend yield means the stockholder is receiving a large part of his or her return in the form of current dividends. A low dividend yield means the stockholder is receiving a small part of his or her return in the form of current dividends. This means the stockholder is anticipating that he or she will receive larger dividends in the future. Typically, businesses that are experiencing low growth have high dividend yields, and businesses with high growth have low dividend yields. Let’s look at Tucker Enterprises. Analysts believe that the future of Tucker Enterprises is very good. Tucker Enterprises’ current stock price is $200 per share. However, Tucker Enterprises has decided to retain all its net income and pay no dividends. Why? Because Tucker Enterprises has a lot of great investment opportunities that should make a lot of net income in the future. To finance these new opportunities, Tucker Enterprises is retaining all its current profits and pays no dividends. Zero dividends mean a zero dividend yield. Now let’s assume Tucker Enterprises’ future investment prospects dim. Their future is still good, but the need for money has diminished because the opportunities to invest that money have diminished. Tucker Enterprises decides there isn’t a good reason to retain its profits. It begins paying a $2.50 dividend per share. Because Tucker Enterprises’ future is not as bright, its stock price drops to $150. Stockholders are buying Tucker Enterprises’ stock for the current dividend more than for its bright future. Tucker Enterprises’ dividend yield would be 1.7%, calculated as:

Dividend Yield 

$2.50 Dividend per Share   1.7% $150 Current Market Price per Share of Stock

Price-Earnings Ratio (PE) Price-earnings (PE) ratio  Ratio of the market price of a share of ­common stock to the company’s ­earnings per share. It measures the value that the stock market places on $1 of a company’s earnings.

The price-earnings ratio (PE) is the ratio of the current price of a share of stock ­divided by the current earnings-per-share of the business. It is a measure of the price paid for a share relative to the annual net income earned by the company per share and is computed as:

Price Earnings Ratio (PE) 

Current Price per Share Current EPS

A high PE typically indicates that the future of the business is very good. The business is expected to be a high-growth company. A low PE typically indicates the business is not a high-growth company. Its future may be similar or worse than its present. Let’s assume Tucker Enterprises has current EPS of $7.50. Participants in the market believe that the future of Tucker Enterprises is very good. They believe Tucker Enterprises is worth 20 times its current earnings. Tucker Enterprises would have a PE of 20 and a stock price of $150 per share. Now, let’s assume something bad happens and the market revises its forecast for Tucker Enterprises. Participants in the market no longer believe the future for Tucker Enterprises is as good as they previously thought. The market revises its forecasts downward. The market now believes that Tucker Enterprises is worth half of what it used to be. Tucker Enterprises’ stock price would fall to $75 per share and its PE would decline to 10. Because the market believes the future of Tucker Enterprises is not as good as was expected, the market lowers the price of Tucker Enterprises’ stock, which causes the PE to decline.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 624

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

625

How They Do It: A Look at Business

Let’s look at two companies previously examined: Apple from Chapter 10 and Kroger from Chapter 1. First is Apple, the company that created the game-changing iPhone and iPad. Because of these successes, Apple is considered a leader in the ever-changing, high-risk, but very profitable technology sector. Apple is a growth company that reinvests most of its profits in new and innovative products. Apple pays a relatively small dividend compared with its net income. On September 29, 2012, Apple’s stock price was $667.11 per share. Apple’s dividend for the year ending September 29, 2012, was $2.65 per share. Its earnings per share, for the year ending September 29, 2012, was $44.64. Its dividend yield was less than 1%, and its price-earnings ratio was 15. Second, let’s look at Kroger, the large grocery store chain. Kroger is a very profitable seller of groceries. Its sales, costs, profits, and cash flow are very stable and predictable. Kroger is a very well-run company that is considered to be a low-risk, low-growth business. Kroger pays a relatively large dividend relative to its net income. On February 2, 2013, Kroger’s stock price was $27.67 per share. Kroger’s dividend for the year ending February 2, 2013, was $0.53 per share. Its earnings per share, for the year ending February 2, 2013, was $2.78. Its dividend yield was 1.9%, and its price-earnings ratio was 10. Think about and compare Apple and Kroger. Both are very successful businesses. Now think what the dividend yield and price-earnings ratio tell you. It appears that investors think the future of both Apple and Kroger is bright, but Apple is expected to grow more than Kroger.

MyAccountingLab

Summary Here is what you should know after reading this chapter. The Study Plan in MyAccountingLab will help you identify what you know and where to go when you need practice.

1

Understand the purpose and process of financial analysis

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Financial analysis is the process of using a ­business’s financial statements, and other related information, to evaluate whether a business is creating value. The process of financial analysis is composed of the following five steps:

Benchmarking (p. 601)

1. Understand a business’s model and strategy.

Economic environment (p. 601)

2. Understand the environment in which the ­business operates.

Financial analysis (p. 600)

3. Analyze the content of the financial statements and other information, making adjustments if desired.

Management discussion and analysis (MD&A) (p. 601)

Business model (p. 601) Business strategy (p. 601) Competitive environment (p. 601)

Financial analyst (p. 600)

4. Analyze the business’s operations. 5. Use the financial analysis to make decisions.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 625

03/04/14 2:44 PM

626

2

Chapter 12

Perform financial analysis using financial statements

Key Points

Key Accounting Terms

Financial analysis is about asking questions about value. Typical questions you should ask are:

Accounts receivable turnover (p. 616)

1. Is the business a going concern? 2. How is the business earning net income?

Base period (p. 607) Cash conversion cycle (p. 610) Collateral (p. 614)

3. Where is the business getting its money, and can it pay its debts?

Common-size statement (p. 606)

4. How is the business investing its money, and is it using its assets efficiently?

Debt covenants (p. 614)

5. Is the business generating enough net income to reward the stockholders for the use of their money? Analysts become concerned when they see certain “red flags” such as decreased net cash flow from operations, difficulty in collecting receivables, or too much debt.

Current ratio (p. 610) Debt ratio (p. 614) Dividend payout ratio (p. 618) Dividends per share (DPS) (p. 618) Earnings before interest and taxes (EBIT) (p. 613) Earnings per share (EPS) (p. 617) Financing decision (p. 614) Fixed asset turnover (p. 616) Gross profit percentage (p. 613) Horizontal analysis (p. 607) Income or loss from continuing ­operations (p. 611) Interest coverage ratio (p. 614) Inventory turnover (p. 616) Investing decision (p. 615) Net income percentage (p. 613) Net working capital (p. 609) Operating income (p. 613) Quick ratio (p. 610) Return on assets (ROA) (p. 616) Return on equity (ROE) (p. 618) Total asset turnover (p. 616) Trend percentages (p. 609) Vertical analysis (p. 606)

3

Use financial analysis to assess the value of a business

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 626

There is nothing harder in the financial world than the valuation of a business. The dividend yield and the price-earnings ratio are two measures often looked at in valuing a business.

Dividend yield (p. 624) Price-earnings (PE) ratio (p. 624)

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

627

Accounting Practice Discussion Questions 1. How is percentage change calculated? 2. Which amount is the base amount for vertical analysis on the income statement? 3. Which amount is the base amount for vertical analysis on the balance sheet? 4. What is the purpose of the common-size financial statement? 5. The Financial Accounting Standards Board and the International Accounting Standards Board have identified the goal of comparability of financial statements as one toward which all companies should strive and consistency as the means toward achieving that goal. How are these characteristics important to horizontal and vertical analysis? 6. What is benchmarking? What should a company that wishes to use benchmarking look for in establishing benchmarks? 7. What are the major goals of each of the following types of ratios? a. Liquidity ratios b. Asset management ratios c. Solvency ratios d. Profitability ratios e. Market analysis ratios 8. How would you expect a recession to affect asset management ratios? 9. What is a “red flag” with respect to financial statement analysis? 10. A company has experienced increases in accounts receivable and inventory turnover ratios and has net cash flow from operations that exceeds net income. All other things constant, what could you conclude about the company’s performance this year relative to last year?

MyAccountingLab

Self Check 1. Net income was $175,000 in 2012, $190,000 in 2013, and $209,000 in 2014. The change from 2013 to 2014 is an a. increase of 10%. b. increase of 9%. c. increase of 8%. d. increase of 19%. 2. Horizontal analysis of a financial statement shows a. the relationship of each statement item to a specified base. b. percentage changes in comparative balance sheets. c. percentage changes in comparative income statements. d. both b and c. 3. A statement that reports only percentages is called a. a comparative statement. b. a cumulative statement. c. a condensed statement. d. a common-size statement. 4. Net working capital is a. a measure of the ability to meet short-term obligations with current assets. b. defined as current assets minus current liabilities. c. defined as current assets divided by current liabilities. d. both a and b.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 627

03/04/14 2:44 PM

628

Chapter 12 5. Cash is $12,000, net accounts receivable amounts to $18,000, inventory is $21,000, prepaid expenses total $3,000, and current liabilities are $37,500. What is the quick ratio? a. 1.44 b. 1.36 c. 0.80 d. 0.88 6. A business’s economic environment is a. how a business competes for customers, suppliers, and other critical resources. b. how a business is affected by the overall economy. c. how a business uses its business model to create a competitive advantage. d. what a business does, the products it sells, and the customers who buy its products. 7. Rockport Company is experiencing a severe cash shortage due to its inability to collect accounts receivable. Which of the following would most likely identify this problem? a. Return on assets b. Current ratio c. Accounts receivable turnover d. Working capital 8. Which of the following statements is true of financial statement analysis? a. Ratio analysis is more important than either horizontal or vertical analysis. b. Vertical analysis involves comparing amounts from one year’s financial statements to another year’s statements. c. Horizontal analysis expresses all items on a financial statement as percentages of a common base. d. None of the above 9. Which statement is most likely to be true? a. An increase in inventory turnover indicates that inventory is not selling as quickly as it was. b. A decrease in inventory turnover indicates that inventory is not selling as quickly as it was. c. A change in inventory turnover cannot be accurately assessed without considering the change in profit margin. d. None of the above 10. How are financial ratios used in decision making? a. They can be used as a substitute for consulting financial statements. b. They eliminate uncertainty regarding cash flows. c. They are only used in evaluating business liquidity. d. They help to identify reasons for business success and failure. 11. According to the Real World Accounting Video, a VC is a _________________. a. veteran communicator b. victorious commercialization c. venture capitalist d. vendor conduit 12. According to the Real World Accounting Video, what is the most important thing ­investors look at when deciding to invest in a company? a. Sales b. Management c. Competitors d. Assets Answers are given after Written Communication.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 628

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

629

Short Exercises S12-1. Corporate financial statements (Learning Objective 2) 5–10 min. Identify whether each of the following items would be classified as:

• Income from continuing operations (C) • Income from discontinued operations (D) • An extraordinary item (E) _____ a. $12,000 insurance proceeds on a fully depreciated piece of equipment that was lost in a hurricane _____ b. $800 gain on the sale of office furniture _____ c. Income tax expense _____ d. $106,000 loss incurred as a result of closing the Walla Walla, Washington store location _____ e. $2,300 loss incurred as a result of a company vehicle being involved in an accident S12-2. Horizontal analysis (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Wolfe, Inc., had net sales of $212,000 and cost of goods sold of $128,000 in 2012, net sales of $263,000 and cost of goods sold of $161,000 in 2013, and net sales of $325,000 and cost of goods sold of $200,000 in 2014. Round answers to the nearest tenth of a percent. 1. Find the percentage of increase in net sales from 2012 to 2013 and from 2013 to 2014. 2. Find the percentage of increase in gross profit from 2012 to 2013 and from 2013 to 2014. S12-3. Vertical analysis (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. The 2014 accounting records of Sullivan, Inc., showed the following: Cash, $14,400; Net Accounts Receivable, $5,600; Inventory, $23,200; Prepaid Expenses, $2,400; Net Plant and Equipment, $34,400. Construct a vertical analysis of the asset section of Sullivan, Inc., balance sheet for 2014. S12-4. Ratio definitions (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 10–15 min. Match the following terms to their definitions: 1. Tells whether a company can pay all its current liabilities if they become due immediately. 2. Measures a company’s success in using assets to earn income. 3. The practice of comparing a company with other companies that are similar.

a. Inventory turnover b. Interest coverage ratio c. Quick ratio d. Dividend yield e. Return on assets f. Accounts receivable turnover

4. Indicates how rapidly inventory is sold.

g. Benchmarking

5. Shows the proportion of a company’s assets that is financed with debt.

h. Debt ratio

6. Tells the percentage of a stock’s m ­ arket value that the company returns to stockholders annually as dividends. 7. Measures a business’s ability to pay ­interest on its debt. 8. Measures a company’s ability to collect cash from credit customers.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 629

03/04/14 2:44 PM

630

Chapter 12 S12-5. Purpose of select ratios (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Identify which question each of the following ratios helps answer. 1. Is the business a going concern? 2. How is the business earning a net income or loss? 3. Where is the business getting its money, and can it pay its debt obligations? 4. How is the business investing its money, and is it using its assets efficiently? 5. Is the business generating enough net income to reward the stockholders for the use of their money? _____ a. Inventory turnover _____ b. Debt ratio _____ c. Return on equity _____ d. Fixed asset turnover _____ e. Quick ratio _____ f. Return on assets _____ g. Gross profit percentage _____ h. Accounts receivable turnover _____ i. Current ratio _____ j. Earnings per share _____ k. Interest coverage ratio _____ l. Net income percentage _____ m. Cash conversion cycle _____ n. Dividends per share _____ o. Total asset turnover S12-6. Accounts receivable turnover, Days’ sales in inventory, and Inventory turnover (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. Darazi Company had net credit sales of $4,290,000 and cost of goods sold of $3,000,000 for the year. The net accounts receivable balances at the beginning and end of the year were $600,000 and $700,000, respectively. The inventory balances at the beginning and end of the year were $150,000 and $200,000, respectively. The ­accounts payable balances at the beginning and end of the year were $180,000 and $195,000, respectively. Compute the accounts receivable turnover, days’ sales in inventory, and inventory turnover. S12-7. Current ratio and quick ratio (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. In addition to the information from S12-6, assume that at the end of the year the cash balance on the balance sheet was $50,000 and current liabilities totaled $450,000. Compute the following ratios at the end of the year: 1. Current ratio 2. Quick ratio 3. Cash conversion cycle

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 630

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

631

S12-8. Return on sales, return on assets, return on common equity, times interest-earned ratio, and debt ratio (Learning Objective 2) 10–15 min. The following information pertains to Joudi Company. The balance sheet shows total assets of $300,000, total liabilities of $150,000 for 2014. The income statement shows for 2014 net sales of $275,000, net income of $30,000, income from operations $200,000, cost of goods sold $75,000, dividends of $5,000, and interest expense of $25,000. Total assets and liabilities for 2013 were $280,000 and 135,000, respectively. Compute the following ratios for 2014: 1. Debt ratio 2. Interest coverage ratio 3. Return on assets 4. Dividend payout 5. Return on equity S12-9. EPS and price-earnings ratio (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 10–15 min. In addition to the information from S12-8, assume that Joudi has 50,000 shares of common stock outstanding in 2014 and had 40,000 shares of common stock ­outstanding in 2013. The market price of the stock is $25 per share. Compute the ­following for 2014: 1. Earnings per share 2. Price-earnings ratio S12-10. Dividend yield (Learning Objective 3) 10–15 min. In 2014, common stockholders received $6 per share in annual dividends. The market price per share for common stock was $24. Compute the dividend yield for common stock.

MyAccountingLab

Exercises (Group A) E12-11A. Horizontal analysis (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. What were the dollar and percentage changes in Meghan’s Design Services’ net working capital during 2013 and 2014? Is this trend favorable or unfavorable?

Total Current Assets Total Current Liabilities

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 631

2014

2013

2012

$450,000 261,000

$400,000 220,000

$350,000 200,000

03/04/14 2:44 PM

632

Chapter 12 E12-12A. Horizontal analysis (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Below is the comparative income statement of Wellington Supply, Inc.

Wellington Supply, Inc. Comparative Income Statement Years Ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 Revenue Expenses: Cost of Goods Sold Selling and General Expenses Interest Expense Income Tax Expense Total Expenses Net Income

2014 $515,200

2013 $470,700

223,800 96,400 51,600 26,500 398,300 $116,900

204,900 95,600 48,100 21,900 370,500 $100,200

Requirements 1. Prepare a horizontal analysis of the comparative income statement of Wellington Supply, Inc. Round percentage changes to the nearest tenth of a percent. 2. Why did net income increase by a higher percent than total revenues increased during 2014? E12-13A. Horizontal analysis (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Below are net sales and net income data for a five-year period.

Net Sales................. Net Income .............

Year 5

Year 4

Year 3

Year 2

Year 1

$2,650 767

$2,625 728

$2,575 670

$2,550 650

$2,500 650

Requirements 1. Compute trend percentages for net sales and net income for the five-year period, using year 1 as the base year. 2. Which grew faster during the period, net sales or net income?

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 632

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

633

E12-14A. Vertical analysis (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Peterson Painting, Inc., requested that you perform a vertical analysis of its balance sheet to determine the component percentages of its assets, liabilities, and stockholders’ ­equity. Round to the nearest tenth of a percent.

Peterson Painting Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 ASSETS Total Current Assets Long-Term Investments Property, Plant, and Equipment, Net

Total Assets

$127,000 55,000

LIABILITIES Total Current Liabilities Long-Term Debt Total Liabilities

$ 84,000 189,000 273,000

331,000

$513,000

STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

240,000 $513,000

E12-15A. Common-size income statement (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Prepare a comparative common-size income statement for Wellington Supply, Inc., ­using the 2014 and 2013 data of E12-12A. Round percentages to the nearest tenth of a percent. Quick solution: a. Current ratio = 1.5; b. Quick ratio = 1.25; c.  A/R turnover = 4.03; d. Inventory turnover = 4.4; e. Gross profit % = 0.45%; f. Net income % = 0.21%

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 633

E12-16A. Current ratio, quick ratio, inventory turnover, accounts receivable turnover, and days’ sales in accounts receivable (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. The following information pertains to Al Baraka Company. Assume that all ­balance sheet amounts represent both average and ending balance figures and that all sales were on credit. Compute: (a) current ratio, (b) quick ratio, (c) accounts ­receivable ­turnover, (d) inventory turnover, (e) gross profit percentage, and (f) net income percentage.

Assets Cash and Short-term Investments ...................................................... Accounts Receivable (net) .................................................................. Inventory............................................................................................. Property, Plant, and Equipment .......................................................... Total Assets ........................................................................................

$ 45,000 30,000 15,000 210,000 $300,000

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity Current Liabilities................................................................................ Long-term Liabilities ........................................................................... Stockholders’ Equity—Common......................................................... Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity............................................

$ 60,000 90,000 150,000 $300,000

Income Statement Sales Revenue..................................................................................... Cost of Goods Sold ............................................................................. Gross Profit......................................................................................... Operating Expenses ............................................................................ Net Income .........................................................................................

$121,000 66,000 55,000 30,000 $ 25,000

03/04/14 2:44 PM

634

Chapter 12 E12-17A. Current ratio, quick ratio, debt ratio, times-interest-earned ratio (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Selected information from the comparative financial statements of Barcelona Company for the year ending December 31 appears below:

Cash................................................................................................ Accounts Receivable (net) .............................................................. Inventory......................................................................................... Total Assets .................................................................................... Current Liabilities............................................................................ Long-term Debt............................................................................... Net Credit Sales .............................................................................. Cost of Goods Sold ......................................................................... Interest Expense ............................................................................. Income Tax Expense ....................................................................... Net Income ..................................................................................... Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities ......................................

2014

2013

70,000 175,000 130,000 1,100,000 140,000 410,000 900,000 600,000 40,000 60,000 120,000 250,000

$ 85,000 200,000 170,000 800,000 110,000 300,000 700,000 530,000 25,000 29,000 85,000 135,000

$

Requirement 1. Compute the following ratios for 2014 and 2013: (a) current ratio, (b) quick ratio, (c) debt ratio, and (d) interest coverage ratio. E12-18A. Financial statement analysis (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Consider the following comparative income statement and additional balance sheet data for Fessler Fashions, Inc.

Fessler Fashions, Inc. Income Statement Years Ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 2014 $236,000 134,000 102,000 63,500 38,500 9,300 29,200 6,600 $ 22,600

Net Sales Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Selling and General Expenses Income From Operations Interest Expense Income Before Income Tax Income Tax Expense Net Income

2013 $248,000 142,000 106,000 61,000 45,000 8,600 36,400 8,200 $ 28,200

Additional data follow:

Accounts receivable ..................................................... Inventory...................................................................... Total current assets ..................................................... Fixed assets ................................................................. Total Assets .................................................................

2014

2013

2012

23,000 13,000 44,000 262,000 $306,000

20,000 19,000 43,000 238,000 $281,000

16,000 12,000 39,000 217,000 $256,000

Requirements 1. For 2013 and 2014, compute the five ratios that measure how the business is investing its money and whether it is using its assets efficiently. Round each ratio to two decimal places. Assume all sales on credit. 2. Did the company’s performance improve or deteriorate during 2014?

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 634

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

635

E12-19A. Financial statement analysis (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Evaluate the common stock of Shamrock Incorporated as an investment. Utilize the four ratios that help determine if the business is generating enough net income to reward the stockholders for the use of their money; use this information to determine whether the stock increased or decreased in attractiveness during the past year. Round all ratios to two decimal places.

Net Income .......................................................................... Total Dividends .................................................................... Common Stockholders’ Equity at Year-End .................................................................... Number of shares of common stock outstanding at year-end .........................................

2014

2013

2012

$ 90,000 50,000

$ 80,000 40,000

$ 75,000 35,000

750,000

720,000

690,000

110,000

100,000

95,000

E12-20A. Complete financial statement given certain information (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. The following data (dollar amounts in millions) are adapted from the financial statements of Mountain West, Inc.

Total Current Assets............................................................................................ Accumulated Depreciation .................................................................................. Total Liabilities.................................................................................................... Debt Ratio ........................................................................................................... Current Ratio.......................................................................................................

$18,000 2,000 22,000 40% 1.2

Requirement 1. Complete the following condensed balance sheet. Report amounts rounded to the nearest $1 million:

Current Assets ............................................................................................... Property, Plant, and Equipment ..................................................................... Less: Accumulated Depreciation .................................................................... Total Assets ................................................................................................... Current Liabilities........................................................................................... Long-Term Liabilities ..................................................................................... Stockholders’ Equity ...................................................................................... Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity.......................................................

$ ? (?)

$ ? ? $ ? $ ? ? ? $ ?

Exercises (Group B) E12-21B. Horizontal analysis (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. What were the dollar and percentage changes in Paw’s Pet Shop’s net working capital during 2013 and 2014? Is this trend favorable or unfavorable?

Total Current Assets..................................................... Total Current Liabilities ................................................

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 635

2014

2013

2012

$336,250 232,705

$328,500 213,450

$315,000 185,000

03/04/14 2:44 PM

636

Chapter 12 E12-22B. Horizontal analysis (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Below is the comparative income statement of Horton, Inc. Horton, Inc. Comparative Income Statement Years Ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 Revenue Expenses: Cost of Goods Sold Selling and General Expenses Interest Expense Income Tax Expense Total Expenses Net Income

2014 $595,000

2013 $505,000

$270,000 120,000 48,000 30,000 468,000 $127,000

$227,000 110,000 41,000 35,000 413,000 $ 92,000

Requirements 1. Prepare a horizontal analysis of the comparative income statement of Horton, Inc. Round percentage changes to the nearest tenth of a percent. 2. Why did net income increase by a higher percent than total revenues increased during 2014? E12-23B. Horizontal analysis (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Below are net sales and net income data for a five-year period.

Net Sales................. Net Income .............

Year 5

Year 4

Year 3

Year 2

Year 1

$2,714 660

$2,530 630

$2,392 612

$2,346 606

$2,300 600

Requirements 1. Compute trend percentages for net sales and net income for the five-year period, using year 1 as the base year. 2. Which grew faster during the period, net sales or net income? E12-24B. Vertical analysis (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Natalie’s Nursing Home requested that you perform a vertical analysis of its balance sheet to determine the component percentages of its assets, liabilities, and stockholders’ equity. Round to the nearest tenth of a percent.

Natalie’s Nursing Home Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 ASSETS Total Current Assets Long-Term Investments Property, Plant, and Equipment, Net

Total Assets

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 636

$126,000 90,000

LIABILITIES Total Current Liabilities Long-Term Debt Total Liabilities

$120,000 202,000 322,000

376,000

$592,000

STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

270,000 $592,000

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

637

E12-25B. Common-size income statement (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Prepare a comparative common-size income statement for Horton, Inc., using the 2014 and 2013 data of E12-22B. Round percentages to the nearest tenth of a percent. E12-26B. Current ratio, quick ratio, inventory turnover, accounts receivable turnover, and days’ sales in accounts receivable (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. The financial statements of Oxford, Inc., include the following items:

Balance Sheet Cash ................................................................................. Short-Term Investments .................................................. Accounts Receivable, Net................................................. Inventory.......................................................................... Prepaid Expenses............................................................. Total Current Assets......................................................... Accounts Payable............................................................. Total Current Liabilities .................................................... Income Statement Net Sales .......................................................................... Cost of Goods Sold .......................................................... Net Income.......................................................................

Current Year

Previous Year

$ 28,000 20,000 64,000 77,000 6,000 195,000 54,000 118,000

$ 36,000 28,000 70,000 55,000 8,000 197,000 48,000 92,000

$488,000 293,000 61,000

Requirement 1. Compute the following ratios for the current year: (a) current ratio, (b) quick ratio, (c) cash conversion cycle, (d) accounts receivable turnover, (e) inventory turnover, (f) gross profit percentage, and (g) net income percentage. Round all calculations to two decimal places, days to full days, and percentages to the nearest tenth of a percent. Assume all sales on credit. E12-27B. Current ratio, quick ratio, debt ratio, times-interest-earned ratio (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. White Stone Winery requested that you determine whether the company’s ability to pay its current liabilities and long-term debts improved or deteriorated during 2014. Round all ratios to two decimal places. To answer this question, compute the following ratios for 2014 and 2013: (a) current ratio, (b) quick ratio, (c) debt ratio, and (d) interest coverage ratio. Round all ratios to two decimal places. Summarize the results of your analysis.

Cash................................................................................................ Short-Term Investments ................................................................. Accounts Receivable, Net ............................................................... Inventory......................................................................................... Prepaid Expenses............................................................................ Total Assets .................................................................................... Total Current Liabilities ................................................................... Long-Term Note Payable ................................................................ Income From Operations ................................................................ Interest Expense .............................................................................

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 637

2014

2013

$ 40,000 36,000 150,000 180,000 5,000 572,000 153,000 130,000 175,000 16,000

$ 25,000 22,000 136,000 192,000 4,000 560,000 161,000 165,000 158,000 19,500

03/04/14 2:44 PM

638

Chapter 12 E12-28B. Financial statement analysis (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Consider the following comparative income statement and additional balance sheet data for Iconic Fashions, Inc.

Iconic Fashions, Inc. Income Statement Years Ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 2014 $215,000 118,000 97,000 41,000 56,000 18,000 38,000 4,500 $ 33,500

Net Sales Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Selling and General Expenses Income From Operations Interest Expense Income Before Income Tax Income Tax Expense Net Income

2013 $200,000 110,000 90,000 36,500 53,500 17,500 36,000 4,000 $ 32,000

Additional data follow:

Accounts receivable ..................................................... Inventory...................................................................... Total current assets ..................................................... Fixed assets ................................................................. Total Assets .................................................................

2014

2013

2012

20,000 7,000 31,000 152,000 $183,000

22,000 6,000 32,000 148,000 $180,000

19,000 8,000 29,000 146,000 $175,000

Requirements 1. For 2013 and 2014, compute the five ratios that measure how the business is ­investing its money and whether it is using its assets efficiently. Round each ratio to two decimal places. Assume all sales on credit. 2. Did the company’s performance improve or deteriorate during 2014? E12-29B. Financial statement analysis (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. Evaluate the common stock of Sharp Systems Incorporated as an investment. Utilize the four ratios that help determine if the business is generating enough net income to reward the stockholders for the use of their money; use this information to determine whether the stock increased or decreased in attractiveness during the past year. Round all ratios to two decimal places.

Net Income ..................................................................................... Total Dividends ............................................................................... Common Stockholders’ Equity at Year-End ................................................................................ Number of shares of common stock outstanding at year-end ....................................................

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 638

2014

2013

2012

$110,000 45,000

$120,000 51,000

$145,000 52,000

640,000

603,000

580,000

105,000

100,000

97,000

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

639

E12-30B. Complete financial statement given certain information (Learning Objective 2) 15–20 min. The following data (dollar amounts in millions) are adapted from the financial statements of Meadowview, Inc.

Total Current Assets........................................................................................... Accumulated Depreciation ................................................................................. Total Liabilities................................................................................................... Debt Ratio .......................................................................................................... Current Ratio......................................................................................................

$30,000 5,000 45,000 60% 1.5

Requirement 1. Complete the following condensed balance sheet. Report amounts rounded to the nearest $1 million:

Current Assets ............................................................................................... Property, Plant, and Equipment ..................................................................... Less: Accumulated Depreciation .................................................................... Total Assets ................................................................................................... Current Liabilities........................................................................................... Long-Term Liabilities ..................................................................................... Stockholders’ Equity ...................................................................................... Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity.......................................................

MyAccountingLab

$ ? $ ? (?)

? $ ? $ ? ? ? $ ?

Problems (Group A) P12-31A. Horizontal and vertical analysis (Learning Objective 2) 20–25 min. Net sales, net income, and total assets for Columbia Construction, Inc., for a four-year period follow:

(in thousands)

2014

2013

Net Sales.......................................................... Net Income ...................................................... Ending Total Assets .........................................

$570 58 345

$550 56 305

2012 $510 42 270

2011 $500 40 250

Requirements 1. Compute trend percentages for each item for 2011–2014. Use 2011 as the base year. 2. Compute the return on assets for 2012–2014, rounding to three decimal places. 3. Columbia’s main competitor had a return on assets of just under 18% for the years 2012 through 2014. How does Columbia Construction, Inc.’s return on ­assets compare with its main competitor?

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 639

03/04/14 2:44 PM

640

Chapter 12 P12-32A. Common-size financial statements and profitability ratios (Learning Objective 2) 20–25 min. Motion Used Auto Sales asked for your help in comparing the company’s profit performance and financial position with the average for the auto sales industry. The proprietor has given you the company’s income statement and balance sheet as well as the industry average data for retailers of used autos.

Motion Used Auto Sales Income Statement Compared with Industry Average Year Ended December 31, 2014

Net Sales Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Operating Income Other Expenses Net Income

MOTION $952,800 608,700 344,100 230,600 113,500 6,200 $107,300

INDUSTRY AVERAGE 100.0% 62.1% 37.9% 27.8% 10.1% 0.4% 9.7%

Motion Used Auto Sales Balance Sheet Compared with Industry Average December 31, 2014

Current Assets Fixed Assets, Net Intangible Assets, Net Other Assets Total Assets Current Liabilities Long-Term Liabilities Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

MOTION $478,700 160,600 7,400 42,900 $689,600

INDUSTRY AVERAGE 70.9% 23.6% 0.8% 4.7% 100.0%

$294,800 118,500 276,300 $689,600

48.1% 16.6% 35.3% 100.0%

Requirements 1. Prepare a two-column, common-size income statement and a two-column, common-size balance sheet for Motion Used Auto Sales. The first column of each statement should present Motion Used Auto Sales’ common-size statement and the second column should show the industry averages. 2. For the profitability analysis, examine Motion Used Auto Sales’ (a) ratio of gross profit to net sales, (b) ratio of operating income to net sales, and (c) ratio of net income to net sales. Compare these figures with the industry averages. Is Motion’s profit performance better or worse than the industry average? 3. For the analysis of financial position, examine Motion Used Auto Sales’ (a) ratio of current assets to total assets, and (b) ratio of stockholders’ equity to total ­assets. Compare these ratios with the industry averages. Is Motion Used Auto Sales’ ­financial position better or worse than the industry average?

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 640

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

641

P12-33A. Current ratio, debt ratio, EPS (Learning Objective 2) 20–25 min. Financial statement data of Southwest Fencing, Inc., include the following items:

Cash..................................................................................................................... Short-Term Investments ...................................................................................... Accounts Receivable, Net..................................................................................... Inventory.............................................................................................................. Prepaid Expenses................................................................................................. Total Assets ......................................................................................................... Short-Term Notes Payable ................................................................................... Accounts Payable................................................................................................. Accrued Liabilities................................................................................................ Long-Term Notes Payable.................................................................................... Other Long-Term Liabilities ................................................................................. Net Income .......................................................................................................... Number of Common Shares Outstanding ............................................................

$ 19,000 24,000 80,600 118,300 8,400 562,000 40,000 81,000 39,200 150,600 32,700 64,800 55,000

Quick solution:

Requirements

1. Current ratio = 1.56, Debt ratio = 61.12%, EPS = 1.18; 2. a. Current ratio = 1.45, Debt ratio = 63.82%, EPS = 1.18; 2.b. Current ratio = 2.00, Debt ratio = 54.35%, EPS = 1.05; 2.c. Current ratio = 2.25, Debt ratio = 67.49%, EPS = 1.18; 2.d. Current ratio = 1.56, Debt ratio = 61.12%, EPS = 1.18

1. Compute Southwest Fencing’s current ratio, debt ratio, and earnings per share. Assume that the company had no preferred stock outstanding. Round all ratios to two decimal places. 2. Compute each of the same three ratios, after evaluating the effect of each ­independent transaction that follows. a. Purchased merchandise of $42,000 on account, debiting Inventory. b. Issued 7,000 shares of common stock, receiving cash of $70,000. Use total shares outstanding at year-end instead of average shares outstanding. c. Borrowed $110,000 on a long-term note payable. d. Received cash on account, $23,000. P12-34A. Calculate various ratios for analysis (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 20–25 min. Comparative financial statement data of Comfort Way Furniture Company follow:

Comfort Way Furniture Company Income Statement Years Ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 Net Sales Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Income from Operations Interest Expense Income Before Income Tax Income Tax Expense Net Income

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 641

2014 $490,000 240,000 250,000 132,000 118,000 10,000 108,000 32,000 $ 76,000

2013 $453,000 231,000 222,000 133,000 89,000 16,000 73,000 27,000 $ 46,000

03/04/14 2:44 PM

642

Chapter 12

Comfort Way Furniture Company Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 and 2013 (Selected 2012 amounts given for computation of ratios) 2014

2013

Current Assets: Cash Accounts Receivable, Net Inventory Prepaid Expenses Total Current Assets Property, Plant, and Equipment, Net Total Assets

$105,000 76,000 168,000 30,000 379,000 191,000 $570,000

$109,000 84,000 156,000 22,000 371,000 182,000 $553,000

Total Current Liabilities Long-Term Liabilities Total Liabilities Common Stockholders’ Equity, No Par Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

$210,000 129,000 339,000 231,000 $570,000

$230,000 118,000 348,000 205,000 $553,000

2012

$96,000 187,000

201,000

Other information follows: a. Market price of common stock was $50.50 at December 31, 2014, and $33.00 at December 31, 2013. b. Average common shares outstanding were 13,000 during 2014 and 8,000 during 2013. Requirements 1. Compute the following ratios for 2014 and 2013. Round to two decimal places. Assume all sales on credit. a. Current ratio b. Inventory turnover c. Accounts receivable turnover d. Interest coverage ratio e. Return on equity f. Earnings per share of common stock g. Price-earnings ratio 2. Decide: (a) whether Comfort Way Furniture Company’s performance improved or deteriorated during 2014; and (b) whether the investment attractiveness of its common stock appears to have increased or decreased. 3. How will what you learned in this problem help you evaluate an investment? P12-35A. Calculate various ratios for analysis (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 20–25 min. Assume you are purchasing an investment and decide to invest in a company in the home remodeling business. You narrow the choice to Remco, Inc., or Home Makeover, Corp. You assemble the following selected data: Selected income statement data for the current year:

Net Sales........................................................ Cost of Goods Sold ........................................ EBIT ............................................................... Interest Expense ............................................ Net Income ....................................................

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 642

Remco, Inc.

Home Makeover, Corp.

$198,000 102,000 88,000 17,000 61,000

$224,000 141,000 95,000 8,000 82,000

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

643

Selected balance sheet and market price data at the end of the current year:

Current Assets: Cash .......................................................... Short-Term Investments ........................... Accounts Receivable, Net.......................... Inventory................................................... Prepaid Expenses...................................... Total Current Assets.................................. Total Assets ................................................... Total Current Liabilities .................................. Total Liabilities............................................... Common Stock, $2.00 Par, 6,000 Shares ...... $5.00 Par, 5,000 Shares ...... Total Stockholders’ Equity ............................. Market price per share of common stock.......

Remco, Inc.

Home Makeover, Corp.

$ 27,000 32,000 35,000 51,000 6,000 151,000 246,000 73,000 97,000

$ 61,000 43,000 26,000 50,000 2,000 182,000 237,000 47,000 90,000 12,000

25,000 149,000 $ 51

147,000 54

$

Selected balance sheet data at the beginning of the current year:

Accounts Receivable, Net Inventory Total Assets Common Stock, $2.00 Par, 6,000 Shares $5.00 Par, 5,000 Shares Total Stockholders’ Equity

Remco, Inc.

Home Makeover, Corp.

$ 39,000 73,000 251,000

$ 13,000 62,000 174,000 12,000

25,000 126,000

167,000

Your investment strategy is to purchase the stock of the company that has a low priceearnings ratio but appears to be in good shape financially. Assume that you analyzed all other factors and your decision depends on the results of the ratio analysis to be performed. Requirement 1. Compute the following ratios for both companies for the current year and decide which company’s stock better fits your investment strategy. Assume all sales on credit. a. Quick ratio b. Debt ratio c. Interest coverage ratio d. Accounts receivable turnover e. Inventory turnover f. Total asset turnover g. Return on assets h. Return on equity i. Earnings per share j. Price-earnings ratio

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 643

03/04/14 2:44 PM

644

Chapter 12 P12-36A. Financial statement ratio analysis (Learning Objective 2) 20–25 min. You have been hired as an investment analyst at Eleanor Regal Securities, Inc. It is your job to recommend investments for your client. You have the following information for two different companies.

Ratio

Madden Sport, Co.

Accounts receivable turnover................................ Inventory turnover ................................................ Gross profit percentage ........................................ Net income as a percent of sales .......................... Interest coverage ratio .......................................... Return on equity ................................................... Return on assets...................................................

Ultimate Gamer, Inc.

13 14 51% 11% 20 25% 10%

10 18 48% 14% 18 21% 12%

Requirement 1. Write a memo to your client recommending the company you believe to be a more attractive investment. Explain the reasons for your recommendation.

Problems (Group B) P12-37B. Horizontal and vertical analysis (Learning Objective 2) 20–25 min. Net sales, net income, and total assets for Regal Clothing Emporium for a four-year period are:

(in thousands) Net Sales......................................................................... Net Income ..................................................................... Ending Total Assets ........................................................

2014

2013

2012

2011

$1,350 $1,200 $1,150 $1,025 82 77 53 49 650 620 550 500

Requirements 1. Compute trend percentages for each item for 2011–2014. Use 2011 as the base year. 2. Compute the return on assets for 2012–2014, rounding to three decimal places. 3. Regal’s main competitor had a return on assets of just under 12% for the years 2012 through 2014. How does Regal Clothing Emporium’s return on assets compare with its main competitor?

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 644

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

645

P12-38B. Common-size financial statements and profitability ratios (Learning Objective 2) 20–25 min. Johnson Auto Sales asked for your help in comparing the company’s profit ­performance and financial position with the average for the auto sales industry. The proprietor has given you the company’s income statement and balance sheet, as well as the industry average data for retailers of used autos.

Johnson Auto Sales Income Statement Compared with Industry Average Year Ended December 31, 2014

Net Sales Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Operating Income Other Expenses Net Income

JOHNSON $961,100 577,800 383,300 302,400 80,900 5,600 $ 75,300

INDUSTRY AVERAGE 100.0% 63.2% 36.8% 27.5% 9.3% 0.5% 8.8%

Johnson Auto Sales Balance Sheet Compared with Industry Average December 31, 2014

Current Assets Fixed Assets, Net Intangible Assets, Net Other Assets Total Assets Current Liabilities Long-Term Liabilities Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

JOHNSON $287,300 95,900 2,600 20,800 $406,600

INDUSTRY AVERAGE 71.2% 24.3% 0.7% 3.8% 100.0%

$200,500 75,900 130,200 $406,600

48.4% 16.1% 35.5% 100.0%

Requirements 1. Prepare a two-column, common-size income statement and a two-column, common-size balance sheet for Johnson Auto Sales. The first column of each statement should present Johnson Auto Sales’ common-size statement and the second column should show the industry averages. 2. For the profitability analysis, examine Johnson Auto Sales’: (a) ratio of gross profit to net sales; (b) ratio of operating income to net sales; and (c) ratio of net income to net sales. Compare these figures with the industry averages. Is Johnson Auto Sales’ profit performance better or worse than the industry average? 3. For the analysis of financial position, examine Johnson Auto Sales’: (a) ratio of current assets to total assets; and (b) ratio of stockholders’ equity to total assets. Compare these ratios with the industry averages. Is Johnson Auto Sales’ financial position better or worse than the industry average?

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 645

03/04/14 2:44 PM

646

Chapter 12 P12-39B. Current ratio, debt ratio, EPS (Learning Objective 2) 20–25 min. Financial statement data of New England Fencing, Inc., include:

Cash.................................................................................................................... Short-Term Investments ..................................................................................... Accounts Receivable, Net.................................................................................... Inventory............................................................................................................. Prepaid Expenses................................................................................................ Total Assets ........................................................................................................ Short-Term Notes Payable .................................................................................. Accounts Payable................................................................................................ Accrued Liabilities............................................................................................... Long-Term Notes Payable................................................................................... Other Long-Term Liabilities ................................................................................ Net Income ......................................................................................................... Number of Common Shares Outstanding ...........................................................

$ 17,000 22,000 103,000 119,000 10,000 660,000 45,000 105,000 40,000 157,000 34,000 75,400 35,000

Requirements 1. Compute New England Fencing’s current ratio, debt ratio, and earnings per share. Assume that the company had no preferred stock outstanding. Round all ratios to two decimal places. 2. Compute each of the same three ratios after evaluating the effect of each independent transaction that follows: a. Purchased merchandise of $26,000 on account, debiting Inventory. b. Issued 4,000 shares of common stock, receiving cash of $44,000. Use total shares outstanding at year-end instead of average shares outstanding. c. Borrowed $75,000 on a long-term note payable. d. Received cash on account, $18,000. P12-40B. Calculate various ratios for analysis (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 20–25 min. Comparative financial statement data of Barton Furniture Company follow:

Barton Furniture Company Income Statement Years Ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 Net Sales Cost of Goods Sold Gross Profit Operating Expenses Income from Operations Interest Expense Income Before Income Tax Income Tax Expense Net Income

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 646

2014 $492,000 241,000 251,000 143,000 108,000 10,000 98,000 33,000 $ 65,000

2013 $449,000 231,000 218,000 138,000 80,000 16,000 64,000 22,000 $ 42,000

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

647

Barton Furniture Company Balance Sheet December 31, 2014 and 2013 (Selected 2012 amounts given for computation of ratios) 2014

2013

Current Assets: Cash Accounts Receivable, Net Inventory Prepaid Expenses Total Current Assets Property, Plant, and Equipment, Net Total Assets

$ 92,000 86,000 165,000 31,000 374,000 192,000 $566,000

$ 98,000 89,000 154,000 22,000 363,000 174,000 $537,000

Total Current Liabilities Long-Term Liabilities Total Liabilities Common Stockholders’ Equity, No Par Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

$210,000 128,000 338,000 228,000 $566,000

$231,000 113,000 344,000 193,000 $537,000

2012

$102,000 191,000

198,000

Other information follows: 1. Market price of common stock was $48.72 at December 31, 2014, and $33.28 at December 31, 2013. 2. Average common shares outstanding were 11,000 during 2014 and 10,000 during 2013. Requirements 1. Compute the following ratios for 2014 and 2013. Round to two decimal places. Assume all sales on credit. a. Current ratio b. Inventory turnover c. Accounts receivable turnover d. Interest coverage ratio e. Return on equity f. Earnings per share of common stock g. Price-earnings ratio 2. Decide: (a) whether Barton Furniture Company’s performance improved or deteriorated during 2014; and (b) whether the investment attractiveness of its common stock appears to have increased or decreased. 3. How will what you learned in this problem help you evaluate an investment?

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 647

03/04/14 2:44 PM

648

Chapter 12 P12-41B. Calculate various ratios for analysis (Learning Objectives 2 & 3) 20–25 min. Assume you are purchasing an investment and decide to invest in a company in the home ­remodeling business. You narrow the choice to Here To Stay, Inc., or Dream Home, Corp. You assemble the following selected data. Assume all sales on credit. Selected income statement data for the current year:

Here To Stay, Inc. Net Sales........................................................ Cost of Goods Sold ........................................ EBIT ............................................................... Interest Expense ............................................ Net Income ....................................................

Dream Home, Corp.

$395,000 155,000 83,000 13,000 43,000

$333,000 125,000 63,000 11,000 49,000

Selected balance sheet and market price data at the end of the current year:

Here To Stay, Inc. Current Assets: Cash ......................................................... Short-Term Investments .......................... Accounts Receivable, Net......................... Inventory.................................................. Prepaid Expenses..................................... Total Current Assets................................. Total Assets .................................................. Total Current Liabilities ................................. Total Liabilities.............................................. Common Stock, $1.00 Par, 6,000 Shares ..... $2.50 Par, 3,000 Shares ..... Total Stockholders’ Equity ............................ Market price per share of common stock......

Dream Home, Corp.

$ 12,000 11,000 28,000 60,000 1,000 112,000 197,000 59,000 75,000

$ 13,000 12,000 25,000 52,000 1,000 103,000 189,000 65,000 74,000 6,000

7,500 122,000 $ 45

115,000 35

$

Selected balance sheet data at the beginning of the current year:

Here To Stay, Inc. Accounts Receivable, Net.............................. Inventory....................................................... Total Assets .................................................. Common Stock, $1.00 Par, 6,000 Shares ..... $2.50 Par, 3,000 Shares ..... Total Stockholders’ Equity ............................

$ 29,000 53,000 162,000 7,500 79,000

Dream Home, Corp. $ 24,000 56,000 155,000 6,000 118,000

Your investment strategy is to purchase the stock of the company that has a low priceearnings ratio but appears to be in good shape financially. Assume that you analyzed all other factors and your decision depends on the results of the ratio analysis to be performed. Requirement 1. Compute the following ratios for both companies for the current year and decide which company’s stock better fits your investment strategy. a. Quick ratio b. Debt ratio c. Interest coverage ratio d. Accounts receivable turnover e. Inventory turnover f. Total asset turnover g. Return on assets h. Return on equity i. Earnings per share j. Price-earnings ratio

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 648

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

649

P12-42B. Financial statement ratio analysis (Learning Objective 2) 20–25 min. You have been hired as an investment analyst at Walker Securities, Inc. It is your job to ­recommend investments for your client. You have the following information for two different companies.

Ratio

Anderson Supply, Co.

Accounts receivable turnover.......................... 9.3 Inventory turnover .......................................... 8.7 Gross profit percentage .................................. 44% Net income as a percent of sales .................... 24% Interest coverage ratio .................................... 7.4 Return on equity ............................................. 12.2% Return on assets............................................. 11.8%

Mutual Materials, Inc. 13.4 6.4 21% 21% 9.3 16.7% 14.1%

Requirement 1. Write a memo to your client recommending the company you believe to be a more attractive investment. Explain the reasons for your recommendation.

Continuing Exercise This concludes the accounting for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., that we began in Chapter 1. For this exercise, refer to the comparative balance sheet that was presented in the Continuing Exercise in Chapter 11. Requirements 1. Prepare a horizontal analysis of the balance sheet for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc. Round percentages to one-tenth of a percent. 2. Prepare a vertical analysis of the balance sheet for Cole’s Yard Care, Inc. Round percentages to one-tenth of a percent.

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 649

03/04/14 2:44 PM

650

Chapter 12

Continuing Problem In Chapter 11, we prepared a cash flow statement for Aqua Magic, Inc. Now, we will analyze Aqua Magic’s financial statements using the tools we learned in this chapter. Following are the balance sheets for the months ended July 31 and June 30, 2015, and the income statement for the month ended July 31, 2015, for Aqua Magic, Inc.

Aqua Magic, Inc. Comparative Balance Sheets July 31 and June 30, 2015 JULY 31 Assets Cash Accounts Receivable, Net Inventory Supplies Total Current Assets Fixed Assets Less: Accumulated Depreciation Net Fixed Assets Total Assets Liabilities Accounts Payable Unearned Revenue Salary Payable Interest Payable Payroll Taxes Payable Dividend Payable Current Portion of Long-Term Debt Total Current Liabilities Notes Payable Mortgage Payable Total Liabilities Stockholders’ Equity Preferred Stock Additional Paid-In Capital, Preferred Common Stock Additional Paid-In Capital, Common Retained Earnings Total Stockholders’ Equity Total Liabilities & Stockholders’ Equity

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 650

JUNE 30

$

8,126 91,647 18,241 164 118,178 357,600 (9,003) 348,597 $466,775

$

$

$

16,000 12,000 95,000 7,000 25,883 155,883 $466,775

16,000 12,000 95,000 7,000 21,628 151,628 $345,004

2,060 6,800 950 621 543 300 11,673 22,947 59,260 228,685 310,892

9,246 82,403 16,857 227 108,733 244,800 (8,529) 236,271 $345,004 1,280 2,700 875 180 0 800 9,896 15,731 28,960 148,685 193,376

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

651

Aqua Magic, Inc. Income Statement Month Ended July 31, 2015 Net Sales Expenses: Cost of Goods Sold Depreciation Expense Rent Expense Interest Expense Insurance Expense Supplies Expense Salaries Expense Payroll Taxes Expense Bank Service Fees Net Income*

$45,691 34,276 474 1,050 843 240 122 2,746 543 15 $ 5,382

*Income taxes ignored

Requirements 1. Prepare a vertical analysis of the income statement using a multi-step income statement. Round percentages to one-tenth of a percent. 2. Calculate the current ratio for Aqua Magic, Inc., at July 31, 2015. 3. Calculate the quick ratio for Aqua Magic, Inc., at July 31, 2015. 4. Why do you think the current and quick ratios are favorable? Do you believe that this is a temporary situation or a long-term situation?

Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem Let’s look at Target one last time. Think about Target and all you’ve learned. Look again at Target’s 2012 annual report. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Continuing Financial Statement Analysis Problem in Chapter 2. Now let’s do some financial ­analysis and answer the following questions: 1. Compute the ratios in Exhibit 12-10 for Target for 2012. Compute the ratios in Exhibit 12-10 for Walmart for 2012. As with Target, Walmart’s financial statements can be found in its annual report. You can access the annual report online in the investor relations area of Walmart’s web site at www.walmart.com. For both companies, assume that all sales are credit sales. Compare the ratios of Target and Walmart. Which company do you think is doing a better job in managing the following? a. Liquidity b. Net income or loss c. Financing with debt and equity d. Investing in assets e. Rewarding its stockholders 2. Compute Target’s ROE for the year ending February 2, 2013, including the elements of net income/sales, sales/average total assets, and average total assets/average stockholders’ equity. What does this analysis tell you about how Target generates its ROE? 3. What are Target’s dividends per share and dividend payout ratio for the past two years? Why do you think Target pays a dividend? How do you think Target determines the amount of dividend they will pay? 4. Given Target’s stock price was $60 per share at February 2, 2013, what was Target’s PE ratio as of that date? If the average PE for companies is 15, what does this tell you the market is saying about Target’s future? 5. Looking back over your answers to questions 1 through 4, how do you think Target is performing? Would you buy the stock of Target? If so, why? If not, why not? Do you have any ideas of how to improve Target’s performance and its value?

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 651

03/04/14 2:44 PM

652

Chapter 12

Apply Your Knowledge Ethics in Action Case 1. Robin Peterson, the CEO of Teldar Incorporated, was reviewing the financial statements for the first three months of the year. He saw that sales and net income were lower than ­expected. Because the reported net income and the related earnings per share were below expectations, the price of the stock declined. Robin held a meeting with top management and expressed his concerns over the declining trend in sales and income. He stated that the reduced profitability meant that he needed to formulate a plan to somehow increase the earnings per share. The vice president of marketing suggested that more advertising might help sales increase. Robin stated that spending more money on advertising would not guarantee an increase in sales. Then he announced that the excess company cash would instead be used to buy back shares of outstanding common stock; this move would help increase the earnings per share because fewer shares would be outstanding. Robin reminded everyone that the yearly financial statements would be analyzed and the current year would be compared to previous years’ results. He then stated that the treasury stock would lower the total stockholders’ equity, which could then provide a stronger EPS so the current year would not look as bad. Finally, Robin reminded everyone that with fewer shares of stock outstanding, the dividend per share could be increased and that would help make Teldar stock more attractive. The CFO argued that buying back stock merely to increase performance measures such as EPS was manipulative and unethical and financial analysts would easily see what Teldar was trying to do. Why did the CEO want to repurchase shares of Teldar common stock? Would the repurchase of common stock really have any impact on the financial ratios? Would an investor or financial analyst be able to see that financial performance measures were improved because of the stock repurchase? Are any ethical issues involved? Were the concerns expressed by the CFO valid? Do you have any other thoughts? Case 2. Crane Corporation was in the process of completing the financial statements for the latest fiscal year. Susan Randal, Crane’s CEO, was reviewing the comparative financial statements and expressed some concerns. In comparing the current year’s income statement against those of the prior years, she noticed that total sales had decreased slightly. Furthermore, the salaries expense had increased while the advertising and research and development expenses had ­decreased. Although the total operating expenses were essentially the same, Susan was concerned that the increased salaries expense would be questioned by the investors and financial analysts in light of the decreases in advertising and research and development. She knew that the lower sales would be blamed on reduced advertising and less spending on research and development. As a result, Susan ordered the accountants to issue a condensed income statement that would present all operating expenses as a single amount. Also, during the year Crane Corporation had purchased another company for a price higher than the total fair market value of the purchased business. Crane properly recorded the excess cost as goodwill, but the total amount of goodwill had increased substantially because of this purchase. Susan was concerned that this rather large increase in goodwill would be seen as an unnecessary purchase and investors and analysts would become upset. Thus, Susan ordered that the goodwill be lumped in with the other assets rather than listed separately on the balance sheet where it could easily be seen. The accountants argued that attempting to hide these items from investors and analysts would be unethical. They further argued that GAAP required full disclosure and that if Susan insisted on providing condensed statements, details would need to be provided in the footnotes anyway. Susan reluctantly agreed to the disclosure, knowing that often footnotes are not read. Why would Susan want all the operating expenses lumped together? Why would Susan want the goodwill included as other assets? Were the ethical concerns raised by the accountants valid? Are any ethical issues involved in providing condensed information with the details ­included in the footnotes? Do you have any additional thoughts?

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 652

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Financial Statement Analysis

653

Know Your Business Financial Analysis Purpose: To help familiarize you with the financial reporting of a real company in order to ­further your understanding of the chapter material. This case focuses on the financial statement analysis of Columbia Sportswear. Recall from this chapter that stakeholders use numerous ways to analyze and so better understand the financial position and results of operations of a company. Tools such as vertical and horizontal analyses are available; in addition, financial ratios can be used to gain further insight into areas such as liquidity and profitability. Other measures include earnings per share and ratios that consider the share price of the company. Finally, nonfinancial information provides additional insights into the performance and financial position of the company. We will now apply some of the analytical tools contained in the chapter. Refer to the Columbia Sportswear annual report found in Appendix A. Requirements 1. Perform a vertical analysis on the income statements (Consolidated Statements of Operations) for all three years. Discuss your results. What benefit do you see in performing this analysis? Perform a horizontal analysis of the balance sheets (Consolidated Balance Sheets) for both years. Discuss your results. What benefit do you see in performing this analysis? 2. Look at the income statements (Consolidated Statements of Operations). Can you find the Basic EPS for each fiscal year presented? Has the Basic Earnings per Share increased or decreased each year? Why do you think the Basic EPS has been changing? 3. Determine the liquidity of Columbia Sportswear by computing the net working capital, current ratio, and quick ratio at December 31, 2012, and December 31, 2011. Has Columbia Sportswear’s liquidity improved or deteriorated? Compute the return on sales and the return on equity ratio for 2012 and 2011. Use ending e­ quity balance instead of average for 2011. Has Columbia Sportswear’s ­profitability i­mproved or deteriorated? 4. The market price for a share of Columbia Sportswear’s common stock was $53.36 on December 31, 2012. Using this price, determine the price-earnings ratio and the dividend yield at December 31, 2012 (the dividends per share can be found on the Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity). What do your results mean? Assume that the industry average PE ratio was 20 times earnings and the dividend yield was 1.8% for the industry. Evaluate your results against the industry averages.

Industry Analysis Purpose: To help you understand and compare the performance of two companies in the same industry. Find the Columbia Sportswear Company Annual Report located in Appendix A and go to the Selected Financial Data starting on page 676. Now access the 2012 Annual Report for Under Armour, Inc. from the Internet. For instructions on how to access the report online, see the Industry Analysis in Chapter 1. The company’s Selected Financial Data start on page 26. The Selected Financial Data is the area of the annual report where companies supply the reader of the financial statements with five years of data to analyze. It is then up to the reader to determine the trend of the company. Requirement 1. In your opinion and based on what you have learned from this chapter, what is the trend of each of these companies? And based on this data, which company would you invest in?

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 653

03/04/14 2:44 PM

654

Chapter 12

Small Business Analysis Purpose: To help you understand the importance of cash flows in the operation of a small business. You just returned from a meeting with your bank loan officer and you were a little taken aback by his comments. You’ve been doing business with this bank for a number of years, and the officer always seemed happy with your company’s performance. This is why you can’t understand the bank’s hesitation to continue extending credit to your company. At this meeting, you had supplied him with the current year’s financial information and even ran some of the financial ratios about which you know the bank asks. You thought the numbers looked decent for the current year; maybe not the best, but respectable. Admittedly, sales had fallen a little bit since the previous year, but they were still fairly sound. So when the discussion turned to a comparison of the last couple of years’ financial information with this year’s, you had to question why that was relevant: “Why shouldn’t each and every year stand by itself?” you asked the banker. His comments to you were, “A company’s performance is best evaluated by examining more than one year’s data. This is why most financial statements cover at least two periods. In fact, most financial analysis covers trends of up to five years.” He also said that a company’s performance is best evaluated by comparing it against its own past performance, the performance of competitors, and the industry averages for the industry the company is in. Requirement 1. Following are some selected financial data from the past four years. Calculate the trend percentages using 2011 as the base year and the return on sales for these four years and see if you can figure out the concern the banker has for the financial health of your company.

2014 Total Sales ............................................... Total Expenses......................................... Net Income ..............................................

2013

2012

2011

1,010,000 1,050,000 1,080,000 1,000,000 896,000 888,000 880,000 800,000 114,000 162,000 200,000 200,000

Written Communication Following are selected financial data for your client for the current year and corresponding data for the client’s industry.

Company Return on Sales ................................................................................. Return on Assets ............................................................................... Current Ratio...................................................................................... Inventory Turnover ............................................................................ Accounts Receivable Turnover........................................................... Debt Ratio ..........................................................................................

12.8% 22.1% 1.5 8.6 9.1 58.7%

Industry 10.7% 19.3% 1.4 7.3 12.2 53.1%

Requirement 1. Write a memo to your client comparing his or her business to the industry averages and explain to the client the value of common-size financial statements. Self Check Answers 1. a 2. d 3. d 4. d 5. c 6. b 7. c 8. d 9. b 10. d 11. c 12. b

M12_KEMP9543_03_GE_C12.indd 654

03/04/14 2:44 PM

Appendix A 

Columbia Sportswear Company 2012 Annual Report

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 655

03/04/14 2:45 PM

656

Appendix A

Reprinted by permission of Columbia Sportswear, Inc.

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 656

03/04/14 2:46 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 657

657

03/04/14 2:46 PM

658

Appendix A

Reprinted by permission of Columbia Sportswear, Inc.

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 658

03/04/14 2:46 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 659

659

03/04/14 2:46 PM

660

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 660

03/04/14 2:46 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 661

661

03/04/14 2:46 PM

662

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 662

03/04/14 2:46 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 663

663

03/04/14 2:46 PM

664

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 664

03/04/14 2:46 PM

Appendix A

665

Reprinted by permission of Columbia Sportswear, Inc.

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 665

03/04/14 2:46 PM

666

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 666

03/04/14 2:46 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 667

667

03/04/14 2:46 PM

668

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 668

03/04/14 2:46 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 669

669

03/04/14 2:47 PM

670

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 670

03/04/14 2:47 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 671

671

03/04/14 2:47 PM

672

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 672

03/04/14 2:47 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 673

673

03/04/14 2:47 PM

674

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 674

03/04/14 2:47 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 675

675

03/04/14 2:47 PM

676

Appendix A

Columbia Sportswear Company 2012 Annual Report

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 676

03/04/14 2:47 PM

Appendix A

677

Columbia Sportswear Company 2012 Annual Report

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 677

03/04/14 2:47 PM

678

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 678

03/04/14 2:47 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 679

679

03/04/14 2:47 PM

680

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 680

03/04/14 2:47 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 681

681

03/04/14 2:47 PM

682

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 682

03/04/14 2:47 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 683

683

03/04/14 2:47 PM

684

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 684

03/04/14 2:47 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 685

685

03/04/14 2:47 PM

686

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 686

03/04/14 2:47 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 687

687

03/04/14 2:48 PM

688

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 688

03/04/14 2:48 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 689

689

03/04/14 2:48 PM

690

Appendix A

Columbia Sportswear Company 2012 Annual Report

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 690

03/04/14 2:48 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 691

691

03/04/14 2:48 PM

692

Appendix A



Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 692

03/04/14 2:48 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 693

693

03/04/14 2:48 PM

694

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 694

03/04/14 2:48 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 695

695

03/04/14 2:48 PM

696

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 696

03/04/14 2:48 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 697

697

03/04/14 2:48 PM

698

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 698

03/04/14 2:48 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 699

699

03/04/14 2:48 PM

700

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 700

03/04/14 2:48 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 701

701

03/04/14 2:48 PM

702

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 702

03/04/14 2:48 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 703

703

03/04/14 2:48 PM

704

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 704

03/04/14 2:48 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 705

705

03/04/14 2:49 PM

706

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 706

03/04/14 2:49 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 707

707

03/04/14 2:49 PM

708

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 708

03/04/14 2:49 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 709

709

03/04/14 2:49 PM

710

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 710

03/04/14 2:49 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 711

711

03/04/14 2:49 PM

712

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 712

03/04/14 2:49 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 713

713

03/04/14 2:49 PM

714

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 714

03/04/14 2:49 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 715

715

03/04/14 2:49 PM

716

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 716

03/04/14 2:49 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 717

717

03/04/14 2:49 PM

718

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 718

03/04/14 2:49 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 719

719

03/04/14 2:49 PM

720

Appendix A

Reprinted by permission of Columbia Sportswear, Inc.

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 720

03/04/14 2:49 PM

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 721

721

03/04/14 2:49 PM

722

Appendix A

Z01_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPA.indd 722

03/04/14 2:49 PM

Appendix B  Time Value of Money—Future and Present Value Concepts Time value of money  The concept that states that a dollar today is worth more than a dollar received in the future.

Money earns interest over time, a fact called the time value of money. The time value of money idea is based on the thought that $1 today is worth more than $1 received in the future. This is because $1 today can be invested and earn interest and therefore ­become worth more than $1 at a later date.

Future Value Future value  The amount that a given sum of money will be “worth” at a specified time in the future assuming a certain interest rate.

Future value refers to the amount that a given sum of money will be “worth” at a specified time in the future assuming a certain interest rate. The main application of future value is calculating the future value of an amount invested today (a present value) that earns a constant rate of interest over time. For example, assume that you invest $4,545 and it earns 10% interest per year. After one year, the $4,545 invested grows to a future value of $5,000, as shown next.

Present Value

Future Value

Time 0 $4,545 Present value $4,545

Compound interest  Interest earned not only on principal but also on the interest to date.

1 year $5,000

Roll forward (accumulate)  

(1  Interest rate) 1.10

 

Future value $5,000

If the money was invested for five years, you would have to perform five such calculations. You would also have to consider the compound interest your investment is e­ arning. Compound interest is the interest you earn not only on your principal amount, but also on the interest to date. Most business applications include compound interest. The following table shows the interest calculations for the first two years:

End of Year

Interest

Future Value

0 1 2

— $4,545  0.10  $455 5,000  0.10  500

$4,545 5,000 5,500

Earning 10%, a $4,545 investment grows to $5,000 at the end of one year, to $5,500 at the end of two years, and so on. (Throughout this discussion, we round dollar amounts to the nearest dollar.) 723

Z02_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPB.indd 723

03/04/14 3:01 PM

724

Appendix B

Future-Value Tables Mathematical tables make computing a future value easy. Exhibit B-1 shows the table used to calculate the future value of $1 for various interest rates over various time periods. Future value depends on three factors: 1. The amount of the investment 2. The length of time the amount is invested 3. The interest rate The heading in Exhibit B-1 states that the future value of $1 is being calculated. Future-value and present-value tables are based on $1 because $1 is so easy to work with. Look at the Period column and the interest rate columns from 4% to 16%.

Period 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10

4% 1.040 1.082 1.125 1.170 1.217 1.265 1.316 1.369 1.423 1.480

5% 1.050 1.103 1.158 1.216 1.276 1.340 1.407 1.477 1.551 1.629

6% 1.060 1.124 1.191 1.262 1.338 1.419 1.504 1.594 1.689 1.791

Future Value of $1 7% 8% 9% 1.070 1.080 1.090 1.145 1.166 1.188 1.225 1.260 1.295 1.311 1.360 1.412 1.403 1.469 1.539 1.501 1.587 1.677 1.606 1.714 1.828 1.718 1.851 1.993 1.838 1.999 2.172 1.967 2.159 2.367

10% 1.100 1.210 1.331 1.464 1.611 1.772 1.949 2.144 2.358 2.594

12% 1.120 1.254 1.405 1.574 1.762 1.974 2.211 2.476 2.773 3.106

14% 1.140 1.300 1.482 1.689 1.925 2.195 2.502 2.853 3.252 3.707

16% 1.160 1.346 1.561 1.811 2.100 2.436 2.826 3.278 3.803 4.411

Exhibit B-1

In business applications, interest rates are always stated for a one-year period unless specified otherwise. However, an interest rate can be stated for any period, such as 3% per quarter or 5% for a six-month period. For example, an investment may offer a return of 3% per quarter for two years. In that case, you would be working with 3% interest for eight periods (two years multiplied by four quarters per year). It would be incorrect to use 3% for two years because the interest in this case is 3% compounded quarterly, and different future values would result. Take care when calculating future-value and present-value problems to select the proper interest rate and the appropriate number of periods. Let’s demonstrate using the table in Exhibit B-1. The future value of $1.00 invested at 8% for one year is $1.08 ($1.00 * 1.080, which appears at the intersection of the 8% column and the Period 1 row). The future value factor 1.080 includes both the principal (1.000) and the compound interest for one period (0.080). Suppose you deposit $5,000 in a savings account that pays annual interest of 8%. The account balance at the end of one year will be $5,400. To compute the future value of $5,000 at 8% for one year, multiply $5,000 by 1.080 to get $5,400. Now suppose you invest $5,000 in a 10-year, 8% certificate of deposit (CD). What will be the future value of the CD at maturity? To compute the future value of $5,000 at 8% for 10 periods, multiply $5,000 by 2.159 (from Exhibit B-1) to get $10,795. This future value of $10,795 indicates that $5,000 earning 8% interest compounded annually grows to $10,795 at the end of 10 years. You can find any present amount’s future value at a particular future date.

Z02_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPB.indd 724

03/04/14 3:01 PM

Appendix B

725

Future Value of an Annuity Annuities  Multiple investments of an equal periodic amount at fixed intervals over the length of the investment.

In the preceding example, we made an investment of a single amount. Other investments, called annuities, include multiple investments of an equal periodic amount at fixed intervals over the length of the investment. Consider the Gomez family members investing for their child’s education. Let’s assume the Gomez family can invest $4,000 at the end of each year for three years to accumulate a college fund for 15-year-old Daniel. The investment can earn 7% annually until Daniel turns 18—a three-year investment. How much will be available for Daniel on the date of the last investment? The investment will have a future value of $12,860 as calculated next.

End of Year 0 1 2 3

Annual  Investment — $4,000 4,000 4,000

Interest



— —  ($4,000  0.07  $280)   ($8,280  0.07  $580) 

Increase for Future Value the Year of Annuity — $4,000 4,280 4,580

0 $ 4,000 8,280 12,860

As with the Future Value of $1 table, mathematical tables make calculating the future value of annuities much easier. Exhibit B-2, Future Value of Annuity of $1, gives the future value of a series of investments, each of equal amount, made at regular intervals at the end of each period.

Future Value of Annuity of $1 Period 4% 5% 6% 7% 8% 9% 10% 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000 1.000 1 2.040 2.050 2.060 2.070 2.080 2.090 2.100 2 3.122 3.153 3.184 3.215 3.246 3.278 3.310 3 4.246 4.310 4.375 4.440 4.506 4.573 4.641 4 5.416 5.526 5.637 5.751 5.867 5.985 6.105 5 6.633 6.802 6.975 7.153 7.336 7.523 7.716 6 7.898 8.142 8.394 8.654 8.923 9.200 9.487 7 9.214 9.549 9.897 10.260 10.637 11.028 11.436 8 10.583 11.027 11.491 11.978 12.488 13.021 13.579 9 12.006 12.578 13.181 13.816 14.487 15.193 15.937 10

12% 1.000 2.120 3.374 4.779 6.353 8.115 10.089 12.300 14.776 17.549

14% 1.000 2.140 3.440 4.921 6.610 8.536 10.730 13.233 16.085 19.337

16% 1.000 2.160 3.506 5.066 6.877 8.977 11.414 14.240 17.519 21.321

Exhibit B-2

What is the future value of an annuity of three investments of $1 each, made at the end of each year, that earn 7%? The answer is $3.215. The factor can be found in the 7% column and across from 3 in the Period column of Exhibit B-2. This factor can be used to compute the future value of the investment for Daniel’s education, as follows:

Amount of Each  Future Value of  Future Value Periodic Investment Annuity of $1(Exhibit B-2) of Investment $4,000



3.215



$12,860

You can compute the future value of any investment consisting of equal periodic amounts at regular intervals. Businesses make periodic investments to accumulate funds for plant expansion and other uses.

Z02_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPB.indd 725

03/04/14 3:01 PM

726

Appendix B

Present Value Present value  The value on a given date of a future amount, adjusted to reflect the time value of money.

Often a person knows a future amount and needs to know the related present value. Present value is the value on a given date of a future amount, adjusted to reflect the time value of money. Suppose an investment promises to pay you $5,000 at the end of one year. How much would you pay now to acquire this investment? You would be willing to pay the present value of the $5,000 future amount. The present value of a future amount depends on three factors: 1. The amount of the future payment (or receipt) 2. The time span between investment and future payment (or receipt) 3. The interest rate

Discounting  Computing a present value.

Computing a present value is called discounting because the present value is always less than the future value. In our example, the future receipt is $5,000. The investment period is one year. Assume that you demand an annual interest rate of 10% on your investment. With all three factors specified, you can compute the present value of $5,000 at 10% for one year as follows:

Future Value $5,000   $4,545 (1  Interest Rate) 1.10 By turning the data around into a future-value problem, we verify the present-value computation: Amount Invested (present value) ............................................................................ Expected Earnings ($4,545  0.10)........................................................................ Amount to Be Received One Year from Now (future value).....................................

$4,545 455 $5,000

This example illustrates that present value and future value are based on the same equation:

Present Value  (1  Interest Rate)  Future Value Future Value  Present Value (1  Interest Rate) If the $5,000 is to be received two years from now, you will pay only $4,132 for the investment, as shown next:

Present Value

Future Value 1 year Retreat in time (discount)

Time 0 $4,132

Z02_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPB.indd 726

$4,545  $4,132 1.10

$4,545

2 years $5,000  $4,545 1.10

$5,000

03/04/14 3:01 PM

Appendix B

727

By turning the data around, we verify that $4,132 accumulates to $5,000 at 10% for two years: Amount Invested (present value) ............................................................................ Expected Earnings for First Year ($4,132  0.10) .................................................. Amount of Investment after One Year ..................................................................... Expected Earnings for Second Year ($4,545  0.10) ............................................. Amount to Be Received Two Years from Now (future value) ..................................

$4,132 413 4,545 455 $5,000

You would pay $4,132, the present value of $5,000, to receive the $5,000 future amount at the end of two years at 10% per year. The $868 difference between the amount invested, $4,132, and the amount to be received, $5,000 is the return on the investment; it is the sum of the two interest receipts: $413 + $455 = $868.

Present-Value Tables We have shown the simple formula for computing present value. However, figuring present value this way for investments spanning many years is tedious. Present-value tables ease our work. Let’s reexamine our examples of present value by using Exhibit B-3, Present Value of $1.

Period 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10

4% 0.962 0.925 0.889 0.855 0.822 0.790 0.760 0.731 0.703 0.676

5% 0.952 0.907 0.864 0.823 0.784 0.746 0.711 0.677 0.645 0.614

6% 0.943 0.890 0.840 0.792 0.747 0.705 0.665 0.627 0.592 0.558

Present Value of $1 7% 8% 0.935 0.926 0.873 0.857 0.816 0.794 0.763 0.735 0.713 0.681 0.666 0.630 0.623 0.583 0.582 0.540 0.544 0.500 0.508 0.463

10% 0.909 0.826 0.751 0.683 0.621 0.564 0.513 0.467 0.424 0.386

12% 0.893 0.797 0.712 0.636 0.567 0.507 0.452 0.404 0.361 0.322

14% 0.877 0.769 0.675 0.592 0.519 0.456 0.400 0.351 0.308 0.270

16% 0.862 0.743 0.641 0.552 0.476 0.410 0.354 0.305 0.263 0.227

Exhibit B-3 For the 10% investment for one year, we find the intersection of the 10% column and the first row of the Period column. The factor 0.909 is computed as follows: 1>1.10 = 0.909. In preparing the table, this work has been done for us, so only the resulting present value factors are given in the table. The heading in Exhibit B-3 states that the present value of $1 is being determined. To figure present value for $5,000, we multiply $5,000 by 0.909. The result is $4,545, which matches the result we obtained previously by hand. For the two-year investment, we read down the 10% column and across the Period 2 row. We multiply 0.826 by $5,000 and get $4,130, which confirms our preceding computation of $4,132; the difference is due to rounding in the present-value table. Using the table, we can compute the present value of any single future amount.

Present Value of an Annuity Annuity investments provide multiple receipts of an equal amount at fixed intervals over the investment’s length.

Z02_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPB.indd 727

03/04/14 3:01 PM

728

Appendix B

Consider an investment that promises annual cash receipts of $10,000 to be received at the end of each of three years. Assume that you demand a 12% return on your investment. What is the investment’s present value? What would you pay today to acquire the investment? The investment spans three periods, and you would pay the sum of three present values. The computation follows:

Year

Annual Cash  Present Value of $1 at 12%  Present Value of Receipt (Exhibit B-3) Annual Cash Receipt

1 2 3

$10,000 10,000 10,000

  0.893   0.797   0.712 Total Present Value of Investment 

$ 8,930 7,970 7,120 $24,020

The present value of this annuity is $24,020. By paying this amount today, you will receive $10,000 at the end of each of the three years while earning 12% on your investment. The example illustrates repetitive computations of the three future amounts. One way to ease the computational burden is to add the three present value factors of $1 from Exhibit B-3, 0.893 + 0.797 + 0.712, and multiply their sum of 2.402 by the annual cash receipt of $10,000 to obtain the present value of the annuity, $24,020 ($10,000 * 2.402). An easier approach is to use a present value of an annuity table. Exhibit B-4 shows the present value of an annuity of $1 to be received at the end of each period for a given number of periods. The present value factor of a three-period annuity at 12% is 2.402, the junction of the Period 3 row and the 12% column. Thus, the present value of $10,000 received annually at the end of each of three years, discounted at 12%, is $24,020 ($10,000 * 2.402).

Period 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10

4% 0.962 1.886 2.775 3.630 4.452 5.242 6.002 6.733 7.435 8.111

5% 0.952 1.859 2.723 3.546 4.329 5.076 5.786 6.463 7.108 7.722

Present Value of Annuity of $1 6% 7% 8% 10% 0.943 0.935 0.926 0.909 1.833 1.808 1.783 1.736 2.673 2.624 2.577 2.487 3.465 3.387 3.312 3.170 4.212 4.100 3.993 3.791 4.917 4.767 4.623 4.355 5.582 5.389 5.206 4.868 6.210 5.971 5.747 5.335 6.802 6.515 6.247 5.759 7.360 7.024 6.710 6.145

12% 0.893 1.690 2.402 3.037 3.605 4.111 4.564 4.968 5.328 5.650

14% 0.877 1.647 2.322 2.914 3.433 3.889 4.288 4.639 4.946 5.216

16% 0.862 1.605 2.246 2.798 3.274 3.685 4.039 4.344 4.607 4.833

Exhibit B-4

Z02_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPB.indd 728

03/04/14 3:01 PM

Appendix B

729

Accounting Practice Exercises EB-1A. Calculate present and future values. 10–15 min. Presented next are four independent situations related to future and present values. Requirement 1. Using the tables in the appendix, calculate the future or present value of each item as needed. a. $8,000 is deposited in the bank today for a period of six years. Calculate the value of the $8,000 at the end of six years assuming it earns 7% interest. b. How much must you invest today in order to receive $3,000 at the end of each year for the next four years assuming you can earn 12% interest? c. $4,500 will be invested at the end of each year for a period of three years. Calculate the value of the investment at the end of three years assuming it earns 10% interest. d. The company you work for wants to purchase a new piece of equipment that is estimated to cost $29,000 ten years from now. How much must they invest today in order to have the $29,000 necessary to purchase the equipment if they can earn 6% interest? EB-2A. Future value concepts. 15–20 min. John Resch is considering two plans for building an education fund for his children. Plan A—Invest $3,000 at the end of each year for ten years. This investment will earn 8% annual interest. Plan B—Invest $25,000 now, earning 6% annual interest for ten years. Requirement 1. Before making any calculations, which plan would you expect to provide the larger future amount? Using the tables provided in the appendix, calculate the future value of each plan. Which plan provides the larger amount at the end of ten years? EB-3A. Present value concepts. 15–20 min. Hobart Parts, Inc., needs new manufacturing equipment. Two companies can provide similar equipment but under different payment plans: a. Tanner Manufacturing offers to let Hobart Parts, Inc., pay $55,000 at the end of each year for four years. The payments include interest at 8% per year. b. Phoenix, Corp., will let Hobart Parts, Inc., make a single payment of $250,000 at the end of four years. This payment includes both principal and interest at 8%. Requirements 1. Calculate the present value cost of each payment plan. 2. In addition to the present value cost of the equipment, what other factors should Hobart Parts consider when deciding which company to purchase the equipment from?

Z02_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPB.indd 729

03/04/14 3:01 PM

Z02_KEMP9543_03_GE_APPB.indd 730

03/04/14 3:01 PM

Company Index

Note: Company names in bold are real companies

Alpine Manufacturing, 556 Alvery Industries, 432

A

Amazon.com, 458–459

ABC Wines, 36, 243

American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA), 306

Abdo Company, 222 Accessories Unlimited, 196–198, 202, 204 Acme Electronics, Inc., 219 Acrofab, Inc., 330–332 Action Advertising, Inc., 128 Activities Unlimited, Inc., 171 Addison Picture Frames, 365 Advanced Energy Solutions, Inc., 318 Advantage Advertising, Inc., 177 Al Ahlia Company, 362, 418 Alan’s Lightworks, Corp., 68 Al Baba, Inc., 570 Al Baraka Company, 633 Alby Corporation, 465 Alden Consulting, Inc., 73 Al Houla, Inc., 572 Allen & Associates, 162 Alley, Co., 521 Allez, Corp., 474 Alliance Software, Inc., 227 Allied, Corp., 466–467 Allied Electrical, Inc., 168 Allied Enterprises, 336–346

Amusement Theater, Inc., 176 Anderson Realty, Inc., 164 Anderson’s Outdoor Equipment, Inc., 254 Annabel Marshall, Attorney at Law, Inc., 124 Anthony’s Restaurant, 312 Antoine Co., 363 A-1 Sports, 220 Apex, Inc., 384, 512 Apex Auto Parts, Inc., 273 Apex Consulting, Inc., 126 Apex Industries, 389–400, 403–407 Apple Computer, Inc., 40, 41, 486–487, 506, 600, 625 Aqua Magic, Inc., 82, 131–132, 186–187, 236–238, 285, 377, 433–434, 481, 535, 591–592, 650–651 Ash Tennis Equipment, 370 ASR, Inc., 160 Associated Physicians Group, 469 Atlantic Corporation, 536 AT&T, 387, 409–411 Auberge Agency, 116 Audio Masters, Corp., 115 Azul Enterprises, Inc., 428–429

Allied Industrial Supply, 542 Allied Security, Inc., 127

B

Allison Supply, Inc., 466

Baassir Corporation, 513

All Sports, Inc., 518

Backcountry, Inc., 162

Alpha, Inc., 80

Bailey, Inc., 228

Alphabet City Beer Company, 323, 353

Baily Realty, Inc., 117–118

Alpine Audio, Inc., 223

Baker Consulting, Inc., 130 731

Z03_KEMP9543_03_GE_CIDX.indd 731

03/04/14 6:49 PM

732

Company Index

BAL, Inc., 265

CellTel, Inc., 204

Baldwin Realty, Inc., 77

Cellular Connect, Inc., 196–202, 204–213, 261

Bargain Hardware, 264

Chance Brothers, 424

BargainHunter, 317–318

Charleston Medical Supply, Inc., 583–584

Bargain Oil, 419

Charly’s Automotive, 361

Barjawi Company, 570

Cherokee Equipment, 363–364

Barnett, Inc., 476

Chester’s Produce, 360

Barton Furniture Company, 646–647

Christianson & Associates, Inc., 174

BCS Consultants, Inc., 85

Christopher Foley, Attorney, Inc., 111

Best Buy, Inc., 488

Cindy’s Office Supplies, Co., 71

Bestbuy Tire, Co., 233

Citibank, 362

Best Way, Inc., 175

City Communications, 516

Bike World, Inc., 288–289

City Delivery, 386

Blackstone, Inc., 83

Classy Chassis, Inc., 76

Blue Mountain, Inc., 361

Clearwater, Corp., 468

Blue Ox Restaurant, 111

Cliff’s Construction, 364–365

Blue Oyster Restaurants, 372

Cole Consulting, Inc., 70

Boehms, Inc., 65

Cole’s Furniture, 219

Borden’s Furniture, Inc., 227 Brava Company, 169

Cole’s Yard Care, Inc., 82, 131, 185–186, 236, 284–285, 377, 433, 481, 534, 590, 649

Brava Landscaping, Inc., 191–192

Columbia Analysts, Inc., 534

Brazington Bikes, 271

Columbia Construction, Inc., 639

Brendan’s Hamburgers, 369–370

Columbia Sportswear Company, 84, 133–134, 188–189, 239–240, 286–287, 319–320, 379, 435–436, 483–484, 537, 594, 653

Brimhall Mining, 423 Britton, Inc., 529 Brown Industrial, Inc., 475

Columbia Sportswear Company, 2012 Annual Report, 655

Buckeye, Inc., 512

Analysis of Financial Condition, 677–689

Buck Insurance Agency, 371

Business, 658–675

Budget Decor, Inc., 232

Financial Statements, 690–696

Burger King, 601

Notes to Financial Statements, 697–719

Burnt Finger Restaurant, 71

Selected Financial Data, 676

Byblos Co., 162, 515

Comfort Way Furniture Company, 641–642 Comstock Corporation, 527

C

Conan Consultants, Inc., 190

C. Harrison, Inc., 585

Consolidated Systems, Inc., 239

Candle Corporation, 593

Conway, Corp., 470

Candy’s Candies, 71

Conway Consulting, Inc., 528

Carlson Corporation, 585

Coral Cove, Inc., 130

Carl’s Restaurants, 429

Costmart, 328

Casey’s Collectibles, 378

Cottage Cafe, 268, 432

Caspian, Inc., 579

Crane Corporation, 652

Cassel, Inc., 517

Credit Financier Co., 167

Cathy’s Catering, Inc., 110

Cunnington, Inc., 67

Cedar Corporation, 513

Cunnington Enterprises, 420

Z03_KEMP9543_03_GE_CIDX.indd 732

03/04/14 6:49 PM

Company Index

Cunnington Furniture, 266

F

Cyclone Construction, Inc., 171–172

Facebook, 40, 41, 57–58

733

Fast and Fit, Inc., 76 D

Fernandes, Corp., 525

Dabbani Corporation, 470

Fesler Industries, 365

Dagher Company, 162

Fessler Fashions, Inc., 634

Dalton’s Marine Supply, 473

Fidelity Freightway, 428

Dandachli Corporation, 429

First State Bank, 441

Darazi Company, 630

Fishs Eddy, 88, 194, 540, 567

Davenport, Inc., 532

Fitzgerald, Inc., 373

Dawson, Co., 464

Five Star Catering, Inc., 173

Dell, Inc., 490

Flores & Associates, Inc., 120

Delta Airlines, 539–540, 562–563

Ford Motor Company, 40, 41, 407, 419, 438–439, 458–459, 601

Delta Alarm, Inc., 166 Desert Sun Tanning Salon, 424 Design Incorporated, 593 Dialex Supply, 371 Dillon, Corp., 426 Dior Drapes, 470

Fox Theater, Inc., 181 Freeze It Corp., 283 Fresh Foods, Inc., 234 Frontier, Inc., 524 Fun Time Daycare, Inc., 121

Discount Drug, 314 Doherty, Corp., 472

G

Dolly Jo’s Café, 239

Gate Technologies, 291

Dominion Resources, Inc., 506, 601

General Motors Corporation, 488

Don’s Diners, 432

Ghandour, Inc., 70

Dream Home, Corp., 648

Global Communications, Inc., 526

Dunelit, Inc., 517

Going Green, Inc., 121–122

Dungy Corp., 519

Gomez Auto Parts, Inc., 277 Goodguys Tire Company, 298

E

Good Life, Inc., 576

EasternTextile, 362

Goodyear Tire, 490

Edwards Equipment, Inc., 423

Google, 291–292, 307, 600, 601

Eleanor Regal Securities, Inc., 644

Great Gadget, Inc., 230

Elissar Corporation, 515

Grinko, Inc., 122

Elite Talent Agency, 576 Ellen’s Lawncare Service, 65

H

Elliot Enterprises, 567

Habitat for Humanity, 41

Elm Street Motors, 385

Halco, Inc., 166

Energize Soft Drinks, Inc., 328

Hallery Corporation, 510

Environmental Protection Agency (EPA), 444

Hamilton, Inc., 566

Essex County Transport, 422

Hamilton Printing, 422

Evergreen Supply, Co., 280

Handy Andy’s, 477

Ewing Oil Company, 429–430

Handyman Hardware, Inc., 228

Excell Corporation, 422

Hani Company, 357

Expedia, 563

Hanson Freight, 421

Z03_KEMP9543_03_GE_CIDX.indd 733

03/04/14 6:49 PM

734

Company Index

Hanson Industrial Supply, Inc., 526

Jonah Enterprises, 363

Hardigan Corporation, 425

Joudi Company, 631

Harry’s Hot Dogs, 418

Julie’s Coffee Shop, 72

Haskins Supply, Inc., 596–598

Julie’s Flower Shop, 162

Haskin’s Wholesale, 269

Julio’s Hamburgers, 374

Hasse Landscaping, 266 Hastings & Associates, Inc, 73, 380 Here To Stay, Inc., 648 Hershey’s, 322, 348–349, 600 Hobart Parts, Inc., 661 Hobby House, Inc., 225 Holiboards, Inc., 218 Home Makeover, Corp., 642 Horizon Furnishings, Inc., 279 Horton, Inc., 636 House and Garden Furniture, 510 Husky Foods, 328 I Ibanez Industries, 433 IBM, 107, 407, 490 Icemountain, Inc., 567 Iconic Fashions, Inc., 638 Inchirah Toys, 69

K Kadmous Corporation, 516 Kadmous Watch Store, 223 Kahl Medical Supplies, 587–588 Kahluna Consulting, Inc., 532 Kamal Co., 220 Kamaplast Company, 417 K & B Furniture Warehouse, 229 Keystone Electronics, Inc., 284 Khouloud Company, 223 Khoury Home, 467 King’s Tennis Equipment, 375 KLP Engineering, Inc., 120 KLR, Inc., 185 Kmart, 601 Kroger, 37–38, 40, 41, 57–58, 563, 600, 601, 625

Inez, Inc., 588 Inland Empire Supply, Inc., 283

L

Inland Industrial Supply, 269

Lakeland Restaurants, 376–377

Inland Machine Tool, Inc., 523

Lake Norman Company, 569

Inland Medical Supply, Inc., 571–572

Lakeside Industries, 282

Inland Northwest National Bank, 333

LanWan Software, Inc., 224

Intel, 406

Lavery’s Department Store, 225

Interiors by Dennise, Inc., 75

Lawn Boyz Lawnservice, Inc., 133

Interiors by Jill, Inc., 79

LDJ Capital, 600 Liberty Physical Therapy, Inc., 133

J

Ling Company, 465

Jack’s Java Coffee Shop, 64

Ling Supply, Co., 283

Jamison, Corp., 426

Liquidation World, Inc., 280, 514

Jammin’ Joe’s, 220

Lithonia Lighting, 425

Janson, Corp., 385

Littleton Corporation, 529

Jilian’s Java, 188

LM Enterprises, Inc., 83

John Deere (Deere & Co.), 409, 410–411, 600

Loomis Corporation, 581

Johnson Auto Sales, 645

Lori’s Music School, 384

Johnson & Johnson, 407, 490

Luca’s Limousine, 434–435

Jo Jo Music, 372

Lynne’s Designs, 68

Jona and Son Electrical, 173

Lynn’s Music School, 385

Z03_KEMP9543_03_GE_CIDX.indd 734

03/04/14 6:49 PM

Company Index

M

New England Fencing, Inc., 646

Mackay Industries, 347–348, 410, 440–458, 487, 490–506, 531, 546–555, 557–561

Nile Valley Company, 352

Mackay Machine Works, 402, 406–407

Nolan Consulting, Inc., 123, 514

Mackay Manufacturing, Co., 525

North Country Bike World, 275

Macy’s, 41

Northern Electric, 463

Major League Baseball, 406

Northwest Airways, 415

Malton Hotel, Inc., 528

Northwest Outfitters, Inc., 246–253

Maple Valley Transport, 426

Novelty Nook, Inc., 182

Maria’s Mocha, 221

Noxon, Inc., 417

735

Nisrine, Inc., 359

Market Analysts, Inc., 530 Marsing Company, 586 Martin’s, 463 Maxim Corporation, 513

O O’Brien Oil Company, 432

McCormack Tire, 271

Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA), 444

McDonalds, 291, 307, 601

Ocean Realty, Inc., 184

McKnight, Inc., 80

Oklahoma City Insurance Agency, 376

Meadows Golf Course, The, 479

Old Time Bakery, 273

Meadowview, Inc., 639

On Call Realty, Inc., 81

Media Unlimited, 165

Opportunity Advertising, Inc., 124

Mega Mobile, 196–197

Orthopedic Medical Group, 472

Meghan’s Design Services, 631

Osborne Consulting, Inc., 49–56, 94–105, 140–154

Mercy Medical Center, 425

Oulette Manufacturing, Co., 519

Micro Apps, 419

Outdoor Adventure, Inc., 274

Microsoft, 406

Outerbanks, Inc., 366

Midas Muffler, 406

Oxford, Inc., 636

Middleton Company, 424

Oxford Communications, Inc., 520

Midwest Equipment, 368

Ozark Publishing Company, 471

Minnie Corporation, 469 Minot Corporation, 566 Mobile Audio, 277 Moe Company, 66, 464 Morgan Stanley Smith Barney, 490 Morris Printing, 426 Motion Used Auto Sales, 640 Mountain Drycleaners, 68 Mountain Mania, Inc., 180–181 Mountain West, Inc., 635 Munro Consulting, Inc., 119

P Pacific, Corp., 475 Pacific Equipment, 286 Pacific Gas and Electric (PG&E), 601 Padilla Industrial, 472 Paiscik, Corp., 478 Panco Corporation, 435 Pangea Company, 467 Party Place, 385–386 Paul’s Hardware, 221 Paw’s Pet Shop, 635

N

PDQ, Inc., 317

Natalie’s Nursing Home, 636

Pegusus Gold, 407–408

Nazira Company, 267

Pembrook Freight, 425

Nelson Industrial, Inc., 589

Penestrie, Corp., 469

Nemo’s Spas, 570

Penestrie, Inc., 232, 577

Z03_KEMP9543_03_GE_CIDX.indd 735

03/04/14 6:49 PM

736

Company Index

Perfect Picture Photography, 218

Relaxation, Inc., 533

Perfect Portraits, Inc., 168

Remco, Inc., 642

Performance Tire, Inc., 275

Richards Manufacturing, 366

Peter’s Hardware, 221, 313

Richardson Equipment, Inc., 427

Peterson Machine Tool, Inc., 472

Ridgeview Resources, 276

Peterson Painting, Inc., 633

Rigby Corporation, 471

Pete’s Plants, 278

Riley Electronics, Inc., 218

Petrov, Inc., 368–369

Riley’s Sports Shop, 270

Phatboy Motorcycles, Inc., 465

Rimrock, Inc., 167

Phoenix, Corp., 661

RJ Enterprises, 286

Photo Finish, Inc., 174

Robertson and Associates, Inc., 188

Picket Fence, Inc., The, 574

Robinson Consulting, Inc., 53

Pierce Systems, 420

Rockport Company, 628

Pilgrim Corporation, 580

Rocky Mountain, Inc., 266

Plavix Corporation, 463

Romero, Corp., 479

Pool Palace, 220

Rosa Mexicano Restaurants, 137, 487

Power’s Sporting Goods, 314

R & S Services, Inc., 530

P & Q Services, Inc., 526

Russell Freightway, 431

Prescott Manufacturing, 430

RV Repair Service Company, 222

Prime Produce, Inc., 246

RV Wholesale, Inc., 110

Pring’s Picture Frames, 360–361 Pro Clean Services, 319 Procter & Gamble (P&G), 563 Pro Powersports, Inc., 175–176 Pugliese Enterprises, 280 Pugliese Publishing Company, 468

S Safe Systems, Inc., 125–126 Salem Food Wholesale, Inc., 225 Samantha Luden M.D., Inc., 72 Samia Corp., 220 Samia Kaakour, Inc., 66

Q

Sanchez Enterprises, 367

Quinn, Inc., 480

Sanchez Hardwoods, 314

Qwick Care Clinic, Inc., 65

Sanchez Industrial Supply, 473 Sanchez Towing Service, Inc., 65

R

Sanchez Wholesale, Inc., 281

R. S. Furniture Warehouse, 233

Sandler Corporation, 522

Rabie Sadek, 69

Schmitz Construction, Inc., 523

Rabih & Moe Co, 164

Seattle Mariners, 406

Raleigh Golf Pros, 279

Shamrock Incorporated, 523, 635

Ramirez Industries, Inc., 235

Shanon Company, 65

Ramirez Transfer, 420

Sharp Systems Incorporated, 638

Ramsco, Inc., 421

Sheffield Pharmceuticals, 439

Rauscher, Corp., 422

Shop Mart, 314

Rawlins Equipment, Inc., 118

Shore and Associates, Inc., 78

Red Cross, The, 41

Simmons, Corp., 478

Regal Clothing Emporium, 644

Simmons, Inc., 520

Regal Spas, Inc., 220

Simpson’s Department Store, 222

Z03_KEMP9543_03_GE_CIDX.indd 736

03/04/14 6:49 PM

Company Index

Simpson Supply Company, 318–319, 375

Tanner Manufacturing, 661

Sinclair Bike Shop, Inc., 162

Target, 37, 41, 83, 107, 132–133, 187, 238, 285–286, 314–315, 326, 377–378, 434, 481–482, 535, 592, 600, 601, 651

Sinclair Corporation, 533 Sinclair Food Services, 354–355 Sinclair Sports, Inc., 524 Skate Shed, Inc., The, 221–222 Sky Way, Corp., 183 Snowking Snowboards, 477 Snyder Services, Inc., 577–578, 579 SoCal Sporting Goods, 282 Social Security Administration, 317 Sony, 406, 407 Soothing Sounds Music, 376 Sounds on Wheels, 273 Southwest Airlines, 37 Southwest Fencing, Inc., 641 Sparkle Lighting, 422 Sparky’s Electrical Supply, Inc., 224 Specialty Systems, 424 Spices and More, Inc., 355 SRS Systems, Inc., 566 Steamed Sensation, Inc., 180 Stevens and Associates, Inc., 74 Stevens Auto Repair, 468 Stop and Go, 316–317 Subway, 406 Sugarland Company, 512 Sullivan, Corp., 511 Sullivan, Inc., 629 Sullivan Industrial, Inc., 225 Sunbelt Services, Inc., 573–575 Sunbelt Systems, Inc., 431

737

Taylor Snowboards, 327 TDR Systems, 520 TDS Corporation, 536 Teck Automotive, 366 Teldar Incorporated, 652 Texas State Bank, 367 Theodore Company, 510 Thomson Company, 268 Tiffany & Co., 214, 261–262 Timberview, Inc., 514 Tim’s Auto Repair, 471 Tina Dalton, Attorney at Law, Inc., 127 Tiny Tykes Daycare, Inc., 117 Tireboyz Tire, Inc., 229 Titan Realty, Inc., 179 Titan Trucking, 417–418 TJ’s Wholesale, 510 Top Line Equipment, 281–282 Top Ten Sporting Goods, 327 Tour Dejour, Inc., 517 Toys R Us, 193–194, 214, 242–243, 261–262, 600 Transco, Inc., 482 Tri-State Manufacturing, 427–428 Tri State Supply, Inc., 522 Troy, Corp., 178 Tucker Enterprises, Inc., 555–556, 561–562, 603–624 Tucker’s Fine Furnishings, 229 TXL Publishing, 418

Sundaze Boats, 464 Sundaze Sunglasses, 272

U

Sunglass Bungalow, 276

Umbrella.com, 357

Sun Graphics and Designs Center, 415

Under Armour, Inc., 84, 156–157, 436

Sun Meadow Resorts, 475

Underwater World, 274–275

Sunshine Tanning Salon, 421

US Department of Labor, 304

Swanson, Incorporated, 269, 518 V T

Valley Gift and Collectibles, Inc., 226

T. Houton Associates, Inc., 584

Venus, Corp., 471

Talbot Corporation, 482–483

Verizon, 406

Tanaka’s Antique Furniture, 233

Vermont Resources, 272

Z03_KEMP9543_03_GE_CIDX.indd 737

03/04/14 6:49 PM

738

Company Index

W

Williams Supply Company, 316

Wael Company, 115, 222

Wilson, Corp., 466

Walker Securities, Inc., 649

Wilson Industries, Inc., 231

Walmart, 40, 57, 348–349, 601

Wilson’s Auto Repair, 357

Walsh & Associates, Inc., 117

Wilson Supply, 384

Walt Disney Company, 136, 156, 600

Wissam Printing, Inc., 116

Washup Plumbing, Inc., 120

Wolfe, Inc., 629

Water Works Pool Supply, Inc., 218

Wolfe Corporation, 516

Watkins Electric Supply, 314

Wolfe Wholesale, Inc., 226

Watkins Equipment, 278–279

World Wide Travel, 356

Watkins Inc., 515 Wave Rider, 63

X

Waverly, Inc., 163

XYZ, Inc., 172

Waves Salon, Inc., 168

XYZ Systems, Inc., 129

Welcome Diners, 429 Wellington Supply, Inc., 632, 633

Z

Wellness Medical Center, 421

Zepher, Inc., 513

Whalen Mining, 426

Zepher Snowboards, 474

White Stone Winery, 637

Zoom, Inc., 521

Williams Industrial, Inc., 172

Zorro, Corp., 423

Z03_KEMP9543_03_GE_CIDX.indd 738

03/04/14 6:49 PM

Glindex

A Combined Glossary and Subject Index

A Accelerated depreciation method. A depreciation method that writes off more of the asset’s cost near the start of its useful life than the straight-line method does, 396 Accountants, 304–306 accountability of, 305 ethical responsibilities of, 305–306 legal responsibilities of, 304–305 Account form. A balance sheet format that lists assets on the left of the report and liabilities and stockholders’ equity on the right, just as those accounts appear in the accounting equation, 212 Accounting. The process of recognizing, measuring, recording, and reporting information about a business’s transactions, 36, 58. See also Business transactions; specific types of accountants role in, 304–306 accrual, 46, 138 business, role in, 35, 45–46 cash, 46, 138 Certified Public Accountant for, 302–304 concepts of, 43–45 defined, 36, 58 double-entry, 90–92 ethics of, 44–45 financial, 43 fraud and, 299–301 internal control system for, 295–298 principles of, 43–45 rules governing, 291–295 understanding, 291 Accounting cycle. The sequence of steps used to record and report business transactions, 106 closing entries in, 152–154 completing, 151–152 post-closing trial balance in, 154 preparing for, 151–156

Accounting period. Generally, the time period reflected by a set of financial statements, 103 Accounting Standards Codification (ASC). A system used by the Financial Accounting Standards Board to organize and code all accounting pronouncements, 292 Accounts. The basic summary device of accounting; the detailed record of all the changes in a specific asset, liability, or stockholders’ equity item as a result of transactions, 88. See also specific types of on, 51 adjunct, 452 allowance for doubtful/uncollectible, 337 for assets, 89 for business transactions, 88–90 chart of, 89 control, 337 for liabilities, 89 organization of, 88–89 permanent, 152 recovery of, previously written off, 336, 341 for stockholder’s equity, 89–90 T-, 90 temporary, 151–152 uncollectible, 325, 340–341 Accounts payable. A liability incurred by a business when purchasing goods and services, 50, 52, 440 Accounts receivable. An asset that represents amounts owed to the business by customers, 51, 140–141 balance sheet, reporting on, 342 internal control over, 335 types of, 334 uncollectible, 335–342 Accounts receivable turnover. (1) Net Credit Sales divided by average Net Accounts Receivable; it measures a company’s ability to collect cash from its credit customers. (2) Measures a company’s ability to collect cash from credit customers. To compute accounts receivable turnover, divide net credit sales by average net accounts receivable, 347–348, 615–617 739

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 739

03/04/14 2:53 PM

740

Glindex

Accrual accounting. (1) Accounting that recognizes a business transaction when it occurs, whether or not cash is received or disbursed. (2) Accounting method that records revenues when earned and expenses when incurred without regard to when cash is exchanged, 46, 138

Allowance for doubtful accounts. A contra-asset account that holds the estimated amount of uncollectible accounts receivable, 337

Accruals. Revenues earned or expenses incurred before cash has been exchanged, 138

Allowance method. A method of accounting for uncollectible accounts that utilizes estimates of the amount of Accounts Receivable that are not expected to be collected in the future, 337, 340–341

Accrued expenses. Expenses that have been incurred prior to being paid for, 141, 442 Accrued interest revenue, 345–346 Accrued liabilities, 442 Accrued revenues, 140–141 Accumulated depreciation. A contra-asset account that reflects all of the depreciation recorded for an asset to date, 145–147 Acid-test ratio. (1) Ratio that reveals how well the entity can pay its current liabilities. (2) Quick assets (cash, short-term investments, and net current receivables) divided by current liabilities. It measures a company’s ability to pay its current liabilities if they came due immediately, 347, 610 Actual cost. Actual cost of assets and services acquired., 44 Additional paid-in capital. Paid-in capital that represents the amount by which the issue price of stock exceeds its par value, 491 Adjunct account. An account that is linked to another account (a companion account). An adjunct account will have a normal balance that is the same as its companion account, 452

Allowance for uncollectible accounts. A contra-asset account that holds the estimated amount of uncollectible accounts receivable, 337

American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA). The professional organization that supports and improves the practice of public accounting in the United States, 302 Amortization. Systematic reduction of an intangible asset’s carrying value on the books. An expense that applies to intangible assets in the same way depreciation applies to fixed assets and depletion to natural resources, 405, 548–549, 558 Annuities. Multiple investments of an equal periodic amount at fixed intervals over the length of the ­investment, 725 future value of, 725 present value of, 727–728 Articles of incorporation. Describes the purpose, place, and other details of a corporation, 487 Asset. An economic resource that a business owns and can use to operate the business, 39. See also specific types of accounts for, 89 basket purchase of, 391–392

adjusted deferred expenses, 142–147

business, management of, 409–410

adjusted deferred revenues, 141–142

common stock for, 492

Adjusted trial balance. A list of all the accounts of a business with their adjusted balances, 147–151

current, 211, 346, 549–550

defined, 147 financial statements, preparing, 149–151 Adjusting entries. Journal entries made at the end of the accounting period to measure the period’s income accurately and bring the related asset and liability accounts to correct balances before the financial statements are prepared, 138–147 for accrued expenses, 141 for accrued revenues, 140–141 for adjusted deferred expenses, 142–147 for adjusted deferred revenues, 141–142 for bonds payable, 453 Aging method. The method of estimating uncollectible accounts that focuses on accounts receivable; the accountant calculates the end-of-period allowance balance based on an aging of the Accounts Receivable, 338, 340

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 740

fixed, 211, 388 full depreciation of, 400 intangible, 388, 405–407 long-term, 145, 211 lump-sum purchase of, 391–392 of merchandising business, 211 plant, 211, 388 quick, 347 return on, 410, 616 sale of, gains and losses on, 549 tangible, 388 Audit. An examination of the validity and reliability of accounting information, 292 by Certified Public Accountant, 302 Audit opinion. The opinion, issued by the CPA auditing a business, which indicates whether the financial

03/04/14 2:53 PM

Glindex

statements are prepared in accordance with Generally Accepted Accounting Principles, 303–304

a cash account and a bank’s record of the same cash account, 328

Audit trail. A trail of business documents and records that provides evidence of transactions, 297

bank side of, 329

Authorized stock. The number of shares of stock a corporation is authorized by a state to sell, 487

illustrated example of, 330–332

Available-for-sale securities. Equity or debt securities that cannot be classified as either trading securities or heldto-maturity securities, 408

741

book side of, 329–333 journalizing transactions from, 333 preparing, 328–329

Average cost. Inventory costing method where, after each purchase of inventory, a new weighted average cost per unit is computed and is used to value ending inventory and cost of goods sold, 244, 250–251

Bank statement. A document the bank prepares to report the changes in the depositor’s cash account for a period of time. It shows the beginning bank account balance, lists the month’s cash transactions, and shows the ending bank account balance, 328

B

Base period. The base period is the first and earliest period in computing changes in line items, 607

Bad debt. An account receivable that is unable to be collected., 325

Basket purchase. Purchase of multiple assets for one price, 391–392

Bad debt expense. Selling expense caused by uncollectible accounts, 335

Benchmarking. The practice of comparing a company with other companies that are leaders in its industry, 601

Balance. The difference between an account’s total debit and total credit amounts; the ending value of an account, 101 bank, 328

Betterment. Expenditure that increases the capacity or productivity of an asset, 402 Bond discount. See Discount

book, 328

Bond premium. See Premium

normal, 92

Bonds

trial, 103–106, 140, 147, 154 Balance sheet. A financial statement that reports the assets, liabilities, and stockholders’ equity of a business at a specific point in time, 56 accounts receivable reported on, 342 for business transactions, reporting of, 56 cash reported on, 334 current liabilities reported on, 455–456

callable, 448 convertible, 448 payable at a premium, 451–453 payable at discount, 450–451 payable at par, 449–450 prices of, 448–449 secured, 447

inventory reported on, 256

serial, 447

long-term assets reported on, 409

term, 447

long-term debt reported on, 455–456

unsecured, 448

for merchandising business, 211–212 stockholder’s equity reported on, 505

Bonds payable. Long-term, interest-bearing debt issued to lenders called bondholders, 447–453. See also Bonds

Balance sheet approach. The method of estimating uncollectible accounts that focuses on accounts receivable. The accountant calculates the end-of-period allowance balance based on an aging of the Accounts Receivable, 338, 340

Book balance. The balance in a company’s bank account according to the company’s accounting records, or books, 328

Bank balance. The balance in the company’s bank account according to the bank, 328 Bank collection. Collection of money by the bank on behalf of a depositor, 329

Book value of stockholders’ equity. The book value of assets minus the book value of liabilities. The value reported on a company’s balance sheet for stockholders’ equity, 306

Bank reconciliation. A document that identifies and explains the differences between a depositor’s record of

Brand names. Rights to use distinctive identifications of a product or service, 406

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 741

Book value. The asset’s cost minus its accumulated depreciation, 146, 306

03/04/14 2:53 PM

742

Glindex

Bribe. The payment of money in order to influence the conduct of a person, 300 buildings, costs of, 390 Business. A business is a legal organization that attempts to create value by exchanging products with customers for money, 36, 57, 59. See also specific types of

Business model. A description of what a business does, the products it sells, and the customers who buy its products, 601 Business strategy. A description of how a business uses its business model to create a competitive advantage, 601 Business transactions

accounting, role in, 35, 45–46

accounting, role in reporting, 106–107

accounts receivable turnover of, 615–617

accounts for organizing, 88–90

assets, management of, 409–410

double-entry accounting and, 90–92

cash flow, management of, 561

financial statements, reporting of, 54–57

debt covenants of, 614–615

fundamental accounting equation for recording, 47–53

debt of, 456–457

general journal/ledger for keeping track of, 92–103

defined, 36, 59

measuring, 46–47

earnings per share of, 617–619

recognizing, 46

elements of, 36–37

trial balance and, preparing and using, 103–106

environment of, 601 financing decisions of, 614–615 for-profit, 40 goal of, 39 growing concerns of, 609–611 income or loss from continuing operations, earning of, 611–614 investing decisions of, 615–617 legal forms of, 41–42 manufacturing, 41 merchandise, 41 net income vs. loss, earning of, 611–614 not-for-profit, 41 operation of, 39–40, 602–603

C Callable bonds. Bonds that the issuer may call, or pay off, at a specified price before maturity, 448 Capital expenditure. Expenditure that increases the capacity or productivity of an asset or extends its useful life. Capital expenditures are debited to an asset account, 402 Capitalized. The process of debiting (increasing) an asset account for the cost of an asset, 390 Capital lease. A lease agreement that is treated as a financed purchase of a long-term asset, 454–455 Capital stock. Represents the individual’s ownership of the corporation’s capital, 487 Carrying amount. Bonds payable minus the discount or plus the premium, 450

organization of, 40–43

Carrying value. The asset’s cost minus its accumulated depreciation, 146

owners of, 38

Cash

performance of, 603–620

balance sheet, reporting on, 334

profitability of, 212

conversion cycle for, 562

purpose of, 37

customers, collecting from, 559

retail, 41

internal control of, 325–334

service, 41

net change in, 554

stakeholders in, 38

payments with, 326

statement of cashflows of, 542–545

purchases with, 196

stockholder’s investment in, 505–506

receipts for, 325–326, 559

types of, 40–41

sources of, 543

value of, 37–38, 306, 623

uses of, 543–544

wholesale, 41 Business entity principle. The business entity principle dictates that the financial affairs of a business organization must be kept separate from the personal financial affairs of the business owners, 44

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 742

Cash accounting. Accounting that only recognizes business transactions when cash is received or disbursed, 46, 138 Cash-basis accounting. Accounting method that records revenues when cash is received and expenses when cash is paid, 138

03/04/14 2:53 PM

Glindex

743

Cash conversion cycle. (1) A measurement of the amount of time a company’s cash is tied up in its operations. (2) The number of days it takes to collect cash from the sale of inventory versus the number of days it takes to pay for inventory. It is computed as the days-sales-ininventory, plus accounts receivable collection period, less the accounts payable payment period, 562, 610

Collusion. Two or more individuals working together to commit fraud, 298

Cash dividends, 492–496

Common stock. (1) The stockholders’ equity that is the result of the owners of the business investing money (or other assets) into the business. (2) The most typical kind of stock. It usually has voting rights, the right to receive dividends, and the right to receive assets if the company liquidates, 48, 489, 491–492

declaring, 493–494 dividend dates for, 493 paying, 493–494 on preferred stock, 495 between shareholders, 494 Cash equivalents. Highly liquid, highly safe investments that so closely resemble cash that they may be shown with cash on the balance sheet, 334 Cash flow statement. (1) A financial statement that reports the sources and uses of cash for a given period of time. (2) A financial statement that shows all of the sources and all of the uses of cash for an accounting period, 56, 540–541 business, management of, 561 from financing activities, 552–554 of inventory, 244–247 from investing activities, 550–552 from operating activities, 548–550, 558–561 Cash register schemes. A fraud scheme in which an employee steals cash by processing false refunds, 299 Cash sales, 199, 323

Common shareholders, 494 Common-size statement. A financial statement that reports only percentages (no dollar amounts) for each line item on the financial statements, 606

Communication of information, 297 Competitive environment. How a business competes for its customers, supplies, and other critical resources, 601 Compound interest. Interest earned not only on principal but also on the interest to date, 723 Compound journal entry. (1) A journal entry that affects more than two accounts. (2) A journal entry affecting more than two accounts; an entry that has more than one debit and/or more than one credit, 100, 199 Conservatism. Accounting principle that states that a business must report all items in the financial statements at amounts that lead to the most cautious immediate results, 254 Consistency principle. Accounting principle that states that a business should use the same accounting methods and procedures from period to period, 253 Contingent liability. A potential liability that depends on the outcome of a future event, 439, 444–445

Certified Public Accountant (CPA). An accountant, licensed by a state, who serves the general public by auditing businesses and reporting whether the business’s financial statements are in accordance with Generally Accepted Accounting Principles, 302–304

Contra-account. An account that is linked to another account. A contraaccount will have a normal balance opposite of the account it is linked to, 146

Chart of accounts. A list of all the accounts of a business and the numbers assigned to those accounts, 89

Control activities. The policies and procedures implemented in an internal control system, 296–297

Check tampering. A fraud scheme in which an employee writes a fraudulent check and makes the check payable to himself or herself, or obtains a check intended for an outside party, endorses the check, and then cashes it, 299 Classified balance sheet. A balance sheet that separates assets and liabilities into current and long-term classes,  211 Closing entries. Journal entries that are prepared at the end of the accounting period. Closing entries zero out the revenue, expense, and dividend accounts so accounting can begin for the next period, 151–154 Collateral. (1) Assets pledged to secure repayment of a loan. In the case of nonpayment by the borrower, the lender has the right to take the collateral. (2) Assets pledged by a borrower to guarantee the payment of a liability, 445, 614

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 743

Control account. An account in the general ledger that summarizes the details of an account balance, 337

Control environment. The overall attitude, awareness, and actions of management and staff regarding the internal control system and its importance to the business, 296 Controller. The individual in an organization responsible for the accounting system and financial statements, 327 Convertible bonds. Bonds that may be converted into the common stock of the issuing company at the option of the investor, 448 Copyright. Exclusive right to reproduce and sell a book, musical composition, film, other work of art, or computer program. Issued by the federal government, copyrights extend 70 years beyond the author’s life, 406 Corporate charter. Describes the purpose, place, and other details of a corporation, 487

03/04/14 2:53 PM

744

Glindex

Corporation. A legal entity, chartered under state law, that is empowered to conduct business. The corporation and owners are considered as separate for legal and tax purposes, 41 cash dividends of, 492–496 issuance of stock by, 490–492 organization of, 487–488 stock dividends in, 496–501 stockholder’s equity of, 489–490 stock splits in, 496–501

year dividend before the corporation pays dividends to the common stockholders, 495 Current assets. (1) Assets that are expected to be converted to cash, sold, or consumed within one year or the business’s operating cycle if the cycle is longer than a year. (2) Cash, short-term investments, accounts receivable, inventory, and prepaid expenses, 211, 346, 549–550 Current liabilities. Debts due to be paid with cash or fulfilled with goods and services within one year or the entity’s operating cycle if the cycle is longer than a year, 211, 455–456 changes in, 549–550

treasury stock in, 501–504 Cost. The amount of money or money substitutes that a business pays to receive an item used in operating a business, 37 actual, 44 average, 244 depreciable, 394 freight, 203–208 of goods, 199, 246

Current portion of long-term debt. The principal portion of a long-term liability that is payable within one year, 443 Current ratio. (1) The ratio of current assets to current liabilities. (2) Current assets divided by current liabilities. Measures a business’s ability to meet its short-term obligations with its current assets, 346–347, 610 Customer. A person or organization that purchases a ­product from a business, 37

historical, 44

cash, collecting from, 559

of long-term assets, 389–392

relationships with, 194–195

of lump-sum purchase of assets, 391–392 prepaid shipping, 204–207 of repairing long-term assets, 401–402 of research and development, 407 selling, 207 Cost of goods available for sale. The cost of inventory on hand at the beginning of the period plus the net cost of inventory purchased during the period, 246 Cost of goods sold. The cost of the inventory that the business has sold to customers, 199 Cost principle. The cost principle states that when a business acquires assets or services, they should be recorded at their actual cost, 44 Credit. The right side of any account; an entry made to the right side of an account, 49–51, 90 Credit cards, 324–325 Credit memorandum. A document that supports the return of goods from the customer or an allowance for unsatisfactory goods and the adjustment to the customer’s account balance, 200–201 Creditor. The entity to whom the debtor promises future payment, 343 Credit purchases, 196 Credit sales, 199–200 Credit terms. The payment terms for customers who buy on account, 197 Cumulative preferred stock. Preferred stock whose owners must receive all dividends in arrears plus the current

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 744

D Days-sales-in-inventory. The average number of day that it took to sell the average inventory held during the year, 261 Debentures. Bonds that are backed only by the general credit of the company issuing the bond, 448 Debit. The left side of any account; an entry made to the left side of an account, 90 Debit cards, 324–325 Debt bad, 325 of business, 456–457 long-term, 443, 445–455 Debt covenants. Conditions, stated in the debt contract, that specify the requirements agreed to by the lender and borrower, 614–615 Debtor. The entity that promises future payment, 343 Debt ratio. (1) The ratio of a company’s total liabilities (debt) to its total assets. (2) Total liabilities divided by total assets. It measures a business’s ability to pay liabilities, 457, 614 Debt securities, 408 Decisions of business financial statement analysis for making, 603, 620–623 financing, 614–615 investing, 615–617

03/04/14 2:53 PM

Glindex

Deferrals. Cash received or paid before revenues have been earned or expenses have been incurred, 138 Deferred expenses. Amounts that are assets of a business because they represent items which have been paid for but will be used later, 142–147 Deferred revenue. A liability created when a business collects cash from customers in advance of providing goods or services, 139, 141–142

Discounting. Computing a present value, 726 Discount period. Period in which the customer can make early payment for a purchase and receive a discount on that purchase, 198 Dividend. The payment of past and current profits, less losses, previously retained in the business, 41, 48 cash, 492–496 cash receipts for, 559

Delivering goods to customers, costs related to, 205–207 Depletion. Systematic reduction of a natural resource’s carrying value on the books. Expense that applies to natural resources in the same way depreciation applies to fixed assets and amortization to intangible assets. It is computed in a similar fashion as units-of-production depreciation, 407, 548–549, 558 Deposits in transit. Deposits that have been recorded by a company but not yet by its bank, 329 Depreciable cost. The cost of a fixed asset minus its ­estimated residual value, 394 Depreciation. Allocation of the cost of a long-term asset to expense over its useful life, 145 accumulated, 145–147 of assets, full, 400 of long-term assets, 145–147, 392–401 measuring, 393–394 methods of, 394–398 operating activities and, 548–549, 558 partial year, 398–399 useful life of, changing of, 399–400 Direct method. Format of the operating activities section of the statement of cash flows; it lists the cash receipts and cash payments resulting from a company’s day-today operations, 545, 557–561 Direct write-off method. The method of accounting for uncollectible accounts in which a customer’s account is written off as uncollectible when the business determines that the customer will not pay, 335–336 Disbursement schemes. A form of employee embezzlement in which an employee tricks a company into giving up cash for an invalid reason. Examples include check tampering, cash register schemes, and expense schemes, 299 Discontinued operations, 612–613 Discount. Excess of a bond’s maturity value over its issue price, 448 bond, 448 bonds payable at, 450–451 purchase, 197–198 sales, 202

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 745

745

closing entries for, 152–154 payments for, 553–554 stock, 496–497 Dividend dates, 493 Dividend payout ratio. A measure of how much dividends a business is paying in a given period in relationship to the earnings in the same period. The dividend payout ratio is computed as dividends divided by net income, 618 Dividends in arrears. Cumulative, unpaid dividends on cumulative preferred stock, 495 Dividends per share (DPS). The dividends a business pays for each share of common stock outstanding. Dividends per share is computed as dividends divided by the average number of shares of common stock outstanding, 618 Dividend yield. Ratio of dividends per share of stock to the stock’s market price per share. It tells the percentage of a stock’s market value that the company returns to stockholders annually as dividends, 623–624 Double-declining-balance (DDB) method. An accelerated depreciation method that computes annual depreciation by multiplying the asset’s decreasing book value by a constant percent that is two times the straight-line rate, 396–397 Double-entry accounting. The rule of accounting that specifies every transaction involves at least two accounts and is recorded with equal amounts of debits and ­credits, 90–92 E Earnings before interest and taxes (EBIT). (1) Gross profit minus operating expenses. (2) Profit or loss from operating the business. Operating income is computed as revenue less cost of goods sold, less operating expenses. (3) Sales less cost of goods sold and operating expenses, 209, 457, 613 Earnings per share (EPS). (1) Reflects the net income earned for each share of the company’s outstanding common stock. (2) The portion of a company’s earnings allocated to each outstanding share of common stock. Earnings per share serves as an indicator of a company’s profitability, 212, 617–619

03/04/14 2:53 PM

746

Glindex

Economic environment. How a business is affected by the overall economy in which it operates, 601 Electronic data interchange (EDI). Direct electronic ­communication between suppliers and retailers, 327–328 Electronic funds transfer (EFT). System that transfers cash by electronic communication rather than by paper documents, 328 Employee embezzlement. Fraud where employees steal from employers by taking assets or engaging in ­disbursement schemes to steal cash, 299–300 Employees. People, hired by a business, for a period of time to operate the business, 39 embezzlement by, 299–300 payments to, 560 eom. Credit term specifying that payment for a purchase is due by the end of the month, 197 Environment of business, 296, 601 Equipment, costs of, 390 Equity securities, 408 Estimated liabilities, 443–444 Estimated warranty liability, 443–444 Ethics. The set of moral values an individual or society holds that specify how people and organizations should act, 305 of accountants, responsibilities of, 305–306 of accounting, 44–45 Expense. Money or other value surrendered due to the sale of goods or services or the operating of the business, 39, 48. See also specific types of

External audit. An audit of a company’s financial statements performed by independent Certified Public Accountants (CPAs), 302 Extraordinary gains/losses, 613 Extraordinary repair. Repair work that extends the useful life of an asset, 401 F Financial accounting. The process of recognizing, measuring, recording, and reporting information about a business’s transactions to stakeholders outside the business, including stockholders (owners) and lenders, 43 Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB). (1) A seven-person group primarily responsible for the establishment of standards of financial accounting and reporting called GAAP. (2) The organization that has been designated by the US government to establish Generally Accepted Accounting Principles in the United States, 43, 292 Financial analysis. The process of using a business’s financial statements, and other related information, to evaluate whether a business is creating value, 600, 604–605 Financial analysts. People who perform financial analysis, 600 Financial statements. Historical, objective reports, prepared according to GAAP, that communicate financial information about a business, 54 adjusted trial balance, preparing of, 149–151 adjustments in, 601 analysis of, 601 for business performance, 603–620

accrued, 141

business transactions, reporting of, 54–57

adjusted deferred, 142–147

financial analysis and, 600, 604–605

amortization, 548–549, 558

inventory, impact on errors in, 257–258

bad debt, 335

for making decisions, 603, 620–623

closing entries for, 152–154

for merchandising business, 208–212

deferred, 142

red flags in, 622–623

general and administrative, 209

steps of, 602–603

income tax, 560–561 interest, 450–451, 560 operating, 209 other, 209 prepaid, 50, 140, 142 selling, 207 uncollectible accounts, 335 Expense schemes. A fraud scheme in which an employee overcharges the company for travel and other businessrelated expenses, such as lunches, hotels, parking fees, and cab fares, 299–300

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 746

Financing activities. (1) Actions that generate the receipt or payment of cash to pay long-term liabilities or to raise capital. (2) Activities related to the issuance of, and repayment of, long-term debt, the issuance of stock, and the payment of dividend, 56, 540, 545, 552–556 Financing decision. How a business acquires money, debt or equity, to acquire assets, 614–615 Finished goods. Inventory of goods ready to sell, 243 First-in, first-out (FIFO). Inventory costing method in which the first inventory costs incurred are the first costs to be assigned to cost of goods sold. FIFO leaves

03/04/14 2:53 PM

Glindex

in ending inventory the last, most recent costs incurred, 244, 248–249 Fiscal year. Any consecutive, 12-month period that a business adopts as its accounting year, 137 Fixed assets. (1) The long-lived assets of a business including land, buildings, furniture, fixtures, and equipment. (2) Tangible assets such as buildings and equipment, 211, 388, 561 Fixed asset turnover. (1) The ratio of sales to average fixed assets, which indicates the sales generated for every dollar invested in fixed assets. (2) A measure of how a business utilizes its property, plant, and equipment to generate sales. Fixed asset turnover is computed as sales divided by average fixed assets, 410, 616 Fixtures, costs of, 391 Footnotes. Disclosures that accompany the financial statements, 256 For-profit business. A business that attempts to create an exchange, or sale, where revenue exceeds expenses, creating a profit, 40

747

Fundamental accounting equation. The equation that states that total assets equal the sum of total liabilities and total stockholders’ equity, 47–53 for recording business transactions, 47–53 for stockholders’ equity, 48–53 for transaction analysis, 48 Furniture, costs of, 391 Future value. The amount that a given sum of money will be “worth” at a specified time in the future assuming a certain interest rate, 723–725 G General and administrative expenses. Office expenses, such as the salaries of the company president and office employees, depreciation of items used in administration, rent, utilities, and property taxes on the office building, 209 General journal. The chronological accounting record of the transactions of a business, 92

Franchises. Privileges granted by a private business or a government to sell a product or service under specified conditions, 406

for keeping track of business transactions, 92–103

Fraud. Deceit or trickery involving intentional actions that cause harm to a business, its stakeholders, or both, 299–301

General ledger. The accounting record summarizing, in accounts, the transactions of a business and showing the resulting ending account balances, 92

Fraud triangle. The combination of perceived pressure, rationalization, and perceived opportunity necessary to commit fraud, 300

for keeping track of business transactions, 92–103

Free cash flow. The amount of cash available from operations after paying for investments in long-term assets, 561 Free on board (FOB) destination. A shipping term specifying that title to goods passes to the buyer when the goods are received at the buyer’s destination; thus, the seller pays the cost of shipping the goods to this destination, 203, 205–206 Free on board (FOB) shipping point. A shipping term specifying that title to goods passes to the buyer when the goods are shipped at the seller’s place of business; thus, the buyer pays the cost of shipping the goods to its location, 203, 204–207 Freight charges. The cost of shipping merchandise from the seller to the buyer, 203–208 for delivering goods to customers, 205–207 for receipt of goods from suppliers, 204–205

for T-accounts, balancing of, 101–103 for transaction analysis, 94

for T-accounts, balancing of, 101–103 for transaction analysis, 94 Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP). The rules, principles, and concepts established by the accounting profession that govern financial accounting, 43–44, 291 around the world, 293–294 in United States, 292–293 Generally Accepted Auditing Standards (GAAS). The ­procedures used by CPAs to audit companies, 302 Goods. A good is a physical item that can be touched and felt. Goods are tangible, 36, 243 Goodwill. Excess of the cost of an acquired company over the market value of its net assets (assets minus liabilities), 406–407 Gross margin. Net sales revenue minus cost of goods sold, 209

Full-disclosure principle. Accounting principle that states that a company’s financial statements should report enough information for users to make knowledgeable decisions about the company, 256

Gross profit. Net sales revenue minus cost of goods sold, 209

Fully depreciated. An asset that has reached the end of its estimated useful life. No more depreciation is recorded for the asset, 395, 400

Gross profit percentage. (1) A measure of profitability equal to gross profit divided by net sales revenue. (2) Sales, less cost of goods sold, divided by net sales, 213, 613

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 747

Gross profit method. A way to estimate ending inventory by using the gross profit percentage, 259

03/04/14 2:53 PM

748

Glindex

H Held-to-maturity securities. Debt securities that a company intends and is able to hold until maturity, 408 Historical cost. (1) The cost principle states that when a business acquires assets or services, they should be recorded at their actual cost. (2) Actual cost of assets and services acquired, 44 Horizontal analysis. Study of dollar amount and percentage changes in line items on comparative financial ­statements, 607–608 I

Interest. (1) The expense of using borrowed money for a period of time. (2) The fee for using money; revenue to the creditor for loaning money; expense to the debtor for borrowing money, 39, 343 cash receipts of, 559 compound, 723 on notes receivable, 344–345 Interest coverage ratio. (1) EBIT divided by interest expense. (2) Ratio of income from operations to interest expense. It measures the number of times that operating income can cover interest expense, 457–458, 614 Interest expense, 450–451, 560

Income accruals of, 138 accurately reporting, 138–139 deferrals of, 138 matching principles for, 138 net, 39, 156, 252–254, 548 operating, 209, 613 revenue recognition principles for, 138 Income from operations. (1) Gross profit minus operating expenses. (2) Profit or loss from operating the business. Operating income is computed as revenue less cost of goods sold, less operating expenses. (3) Sales less cost of goods sold and operating expenses, 209, 457, 613 Income or loss from continuing operations. Net income excluding the impact of discontinued operations and extraordinary items, 611–612

Interest rate. The percentage rate of interest specified by the note; almost always stated for a period of one year, 343, 448 Internal audit. An audit and assessment of a company’s compliance with laws and regulations, operating controls, and policies and procedures. An internal audit is performed by employees of the company, 302 Internal control. A system implemented within an organization to help it safeguard assets, operate efficiently and effectively, report financial information properly, and comply with applicable laws and regulations, 295–298 of accounts receivable, 335 bank reconciliation and, 328–333 elements of, 295–298 limitations of, 298 of online banking, 333–334

business, earning of, 611–614

of payments, 326

discontinued operations and, 612–613

of purchase and payment process, 327–328

extraordinary, 613 Income statement. A financial statement that reports the revenue and expenses of a business during a given period of time, 54–55, 57 for business transactions, reporting of, 54–55 for merchandising business, 208–210 Income statement approach. The method of estimating uncollectible accounts that focuses on net credit sales, 337, 338 Income tax expense, 560–561 Indirect method. Format of the operating activities section of the statement of cash flows; it starts with net income and reconciles to net cash provided by operating activities, 545–556. See also Cashflow cash/cash balance and, net change in, 554 noncash investing and, 554–556 Information, communication of, 297 Intangible assets. Assets with no physical form. They are valuable because of the special rights they carry. Examples include patents and copyrights, 388, 405–407

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 748

of receipts, 325–326 International Accounting Standards Board (IASB). The international organization developing and promoting accounting standards to be used throughout the world, 293–294 International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS). Accounting standards developed by the International Accounting Standards Board for use throughout the world, 44, 293–294 Inventory. Goods purchased for resale to customers in the normal course of merchandising operations, 194. See also Inventory costing methods balance sheet, reporting on, 256 cost flows of, 244–245, 246–247 days-sales-in-, 261 destruction of, 258–260 financial statements, impact of errors on, 257–258 journalizing transactions for, 251–252 merchandise, 194 physical flow of, 244–245

03/04/14 2:53 PM

Glindex

purchases of, 196–198 sales of, 198–202

Liabilities. A liability is an amount owed to a lender or other creditor, 39, 439

shrinkage of, 256

accounts for, 89

turnover of, 260–261

of accounts payable, 440

valuing, 254–256, 258–260

accrued, 442

Inventory costing methods, 243–246. See also Inventory

contingent, 439, 444–445

applying, 246–252

current, 211, 455–456, 549–550

average cost, 250–251

estimated, 443–444

first-in, first-out, 248–249

known, 440–443

last-in, first-out, 249–250

leased, 453–455

net income, effect on, 252–254

long-term, 212, 443

specific-identification, 247

of merchandising business, 211–212

Inventory layer. A record of the quantity of and the cost of inventory items made in a single purchase, 245

of notes payable, 440–441

Inventory shrinkage. The loss of inventory, 256

of unearned revenues, 442

Inventory turnover. (1) The ratio of cost of goods sold to average inventory. (2) Measures the number of times a company sells its average level of inventory during a year. To compute inventory turnover, divide cost of goods sold by average inventory, 260–261, 616 Investing activities. (1) Decisions made by management to buy and sell long-term assets. (2) Activities that increase or decrease long-term assets, 56, 540, 544–545, 550–552 Investing decision. How a business uses money to acquire assets, 615–617 Issue price. The initial selling price for a share of stock, 490 J Journalize. Entering a transaction in a journal, 92, 251–252, 333 K Kickback. The payment of money in order to influence the conduct of a person, 300 Known liabilities, 440–443

749

of sales tax payable, 442 Licenses. Privileges granted by a private business or a government to sell a product or service under specified conditions, 406 Like-kind exchange. Exchanging one fixed asset for another fixed asset that has similar functionality, 403 Limited liability company. A hybrid business entity having characteristics of both a corporation and a partnership, 42 Liquidity. The ability to convert an asset to cash quickly, 211 Liquidity management. The management of cash, specifically the amount and timing of cash receipts and ­payments, 346 Lock-box system. A system in which customers send payments to a post office box of a business. The bank collects payments from the box and deposits them into the business’s account, 329 Long-term assets. (1) Long-lived, tangible assets such as land, buildings, equipment, and furniture used in the operation of a business lasting for more than a year. (2) Assets other than those that are current, 145, 211 balance sheet, reporting of, 409 costs of, calculating of, 389–392

L

depreciation of, 145–147, 392–401

Land improvements. Depreciable improvements to land, such as fencing, sprinkler systems, paving, signs, and lighting, 389–390

disposing of, 402–405

Last-in, first-out (LIFO). Inventory costing method in which the last inventory costs incurred are the first costs to be assigned to cost of goods sold. LIFO leaves in ending inventory the first, oldest costs incurred, 244, 249–250 Leased liabilities, 453–455 Legal capital. The portion of stockholders’ equity that cannot be used for dividends, 493

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 749

recording costs of repairing, 401–402 types of, 388–389 Long-term debt, 445–455 balance sheet, reporting of, 455–456 bonds payable and, 447–453 leased liabilities and, 453–455 liabilities of, 443 notes payable and, 445–447

03/04/14 2:53 PM

750

Glindex

Long-term liabilities. Liabilities other than those that are current, 212 Long-term notes payable, 552–553 Loss. A loss is a negative profit, which occurs when the cost of a sale is greater than the revenue from the sale, 38 Lower-of-cost-or-market (LCM) rule. The rule that a business must report inventory in the financial statements at whichever is lower, the historical cost or the market value, of each inventory item, 255 Lump-sum purchase. Purchase of multiple assets for one price, 391–392

(the ­borrower) must repay the principal amount to the bondholders, 343–344, 448 Maturity value. (1) The amount a borrower must pay back to the bondholders on the maturity date. (2) The sum of the principal of a note plus interest due at maturity, 343, 448 Memorandum entry. A journal entry that “notes” a significant event but that has no debit or credit amount, 500 Merchandise business. A business that sells physical goods or products to its customers, 41 financial statements for, 208–212 freight charges for, 203–208

M

inventory for, 196–202

Machinery, costs of, 390

periodic inventory systems of, 195

Maker of a note. The entity that promises future ­payment, 343

perpetual inventory systems of, 195 relationships within, 194–195

Management discussion and analysis (MD&A). The section of a business’s annual report in which a business’s management discusses the results of operating the business, risks, challenges, and opportunities, 601

Merchandise inventory. Goods purchased for resale to customers in the normal course of merchandising operations, 194

Management fraud. Management’s intentional misstatement of the financial statements, driven by greed or the pressure to show that a business is more profitable than it really is, 299

Mortgage. A long-term note payable that is secured by real estate, 445–447

Managerial audit. An audit and assessment of a company’s compliance with laws and regulations, operating controls, and policies and procedures. An internal audit is performed by employees of the company, 302 Manufacturers, relationships with, 194–195 Manufacturing business. A business that produces the physical goods that it sells to its customers, 41 Marketable securities. Readily tradable equity or debt securities, 408 Market capitalization. The current market price per share times the number of shares outstanding, 306 Market interest rate. Interest rate investors are expecting to receive for similar bonds of equal risk at the current time, 448 Market value. The current market price per share times the number of shares outstanding, 306 Matching principle. Recording expenses in the time period they were incurred to produce revenues, thus matching them against the revenues earned during that same period, 138

Money, 40, 723. See also Cash

Multi-step income statement. Income statement format that calculates net income or net loss by listing important subtotals, such as gross profit and operating income, 208 N Natural resources. Assets that come from the earth. Examples include minerals, gas, oil, and timber, 388, 407–408 Net credit sales. The total credit sales less sales discounts and sales returns and allowances related to the credit sales, 337 Net income. Operating profit less interest expense, computed as revenue, less operating expenses, less interest expense, 39, 156, 548. See also Income or loss from continuing operations inventory costing methods, effect on, 252–254 Net income percentage. (1) A measure of profitability equal to net income divided by net sales revenue. (2) Net income divided by net sales, 213, 613 n/eom. Credit term specifying that payment for a purchase is due by the end of the month, 197

Materiality. Accounting principle that states that a company must perform strictly proper accounting only for items that are significant for the business’s financial statements. Information is significant, or material, when its presentation in the financial statements would cause someone to change a decision, 255–256

n/30. Credit term specifying that payment for a purchase is due within 30 days after the date of the invoice, 197

Maturity date. (1) The date when final payment of a note is due. (2) The date on which the bond issuer

Net sales revenue. Sales revenue less sales discounts and sales returns and allowances, 208–209

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 750

Net realizable value. The net amount that the business expects to collect; the net realizable value of receivables is calculated by subtracting Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts from Accounts Receivable, 337

03/04/14 2:53 PM

Glindex

Net value. The amount found by subtracting the balance of a contra-account from the balance of the account it is linked to, 146 Net working capital. Current assets minus current liabilities. It measures a business’s ability to meet its shortterm obligations with its current assets, 609 Noncash investing, 554–556 Noncumulative preferred stock, 495 Nonsufficient funds (NSF) check. A check drawn against a bank account that has insufficient money to pay the check, 329 No-par stock, 490–492 Normal balance. The balance that appears on the side of an account where increases are recorded; the expected balance of an account, 92 Note payable. A liability that is represented by a written promise that requires future payment, 50 liabilities of, 440–441 long-term debt and, 445–447 Notes receivable, 343–346 accrued interest revenue and, 345–346 interest on, 344–345 maturity date of, 343–344 origination of, 344 Note term. The time span of the note during which interest is computed; it extends from the original date of the note to the maturity date, 343

751

Operating income is computed as revenue less cost of goods sold, less operating expenses, 209, 613 Operating lease. A lease (rental) agreement that grants the use of an asset to the lessee for the duration of the lease in exchange for regular payments, 454 Ordinary repair. Repair work that is necessary to maintain an asset in normal operating condition, 401 Other revenues and expenses. Revenues and expenses that fall outside the main operations of a business, such as interest expense and a loss on the sale of long-term assets, 209 Outstanding checks. Checks that have been issued by a company and recorded in its books but have not yet been paid by its bank, 329 Outstanding stock. Stock in the hands of stockholders, 488 Over-the-counter cash receipts, 326 Owners’ equity. Money provided to the business by owners either through an initial investment or the retention of profits, 39, 48–53 Owners of business, 38 P Paid-in capital in excess of par. Paid-in capital that represents the amount by which the issue price of stock exceeds its par value, 491 Par, bonds payable at, 449–450 Partial year depreciation, 398–399

Not-for-profit business. A business that attempts to create an exchange or sale where revenue equals costs, 41

Partnership. A business that has more than one owner, where, for legal and tax purposes, the business and the owners are considered the same, 41

O

Par value. (1) Arbitrary amount assigned to a share of stock. (2) The amount a borrower must pay back to the bondholders on the maturity date, 448, 490

Objectivity principle. Information should be verifiable, confirmable by any independent observer, 44 On account. Buying or selling on credit, 51 Online banking, 333–334 Operating activities. (1) Activities that create revenue and/or expense in the entity’s major line of business. (2) Day-to-day activities that create revenues or expenses, 56, 540, 544

Patent. An intangible asset that is a federal government grant conveying an exclusive 20-year right to produce and sell a process, product, or technology, 405–406 Payee of a note. The entity to whom the debtor promises future payment, 343 Payments with cash, 326

cash flows from, 548–550, 558–561

for dividends, 553–554

depreciation and, 558

to employees, 560

Operating cycle. The time span during which the business obtains resources, uses them to sell goods and services to customers, and collects cash from these customers, 211 Operating expenses. Expenses of operating a business other than cost of goods sold. Examples include depreciation, rent, salaries, utilities, advertising, delivery expense, property taxes, and supplies expense, 209 Operating income. (1) Gross profit minus operating expenses. (2) Profit or loss from operating the business.

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 751

for income tax expense, 560–561 for interest expense, 560 internal control over process of, 327–328 shipping company, directly to, 204 to suppliers, 559–560 Perceived opportunity. An element of the fraud triangle in which the employee believes a chance exists to commit fraud, conceal it, and avoid punishment, 301

03/04/14 2:53 PM

752

Glindex

Perceived pressure. An element of the fraud triangle in which the employee feels a need to obtain cash or other assets, 300–301

Present value. The value on a given date of a future amount, adjusted to reflect the time value of money, 726–728

Percent of sales method. The method of estimating uncollectible accounts that focuses on net credit sales, 337–338

Price-earnings (PE) ratio. Ratio of the market price of a share of common stock to the company’s earnings per share. It measures the value that the stock market places on $1 of a company’s earnings, 624

Performance of business, 603–620 horizontal analysis for measuring, 607–608 trend percentages for measuring, 609 vertical analysis for measuring, 606 Periodic inventory system. An inventory system in which the business does not keep a continuous record of inventory on hand. At the end of the accounting period, a physical count of inventory is taken and is used to determine the cost of ending inventory and the cost of the goods sold, 195 Permanent accounts. The asset, liability, common stock and retained earnings accounts; these accounts are not closed at the end of the accounting period, 152 Perpetual inventory record. A record that tracks the quantity of, and cost assigned to, inventory items as they are purchased and sold, 248 Perpetual inventory system. An inventory system in which the business keeps a continuous record of inventory on hand and the cost of the goods sold, 195 Petty cash. Fund containing a small amount of cash that is used to pay for minor expenditures, 334 changing, 383 replenishing, 382 setting up, 381–382 Physical flow of inventory, 244–245 Plant assets. (1) The long-lived assets of a business including land, buildings, furniture, fixtures, and equipment. (2) Tangible assets such as buildings and equipment, 211, 388

Principal. The amount loaned out by the payee and borrowed by the maker of the note, 343 Principal amount. The amount a borrower must pay back to the bondholders on the maturity date, 448 Product. A good or service purchased or produced by a business to be sold, 36 Profit. The revenue from a sale less the cost of the sale, 37, 209, 212 Promissory note. (1) A written pledge to pay a fixed amount of money at a later date. (2) A written promise to pay a specified amount of money at a particular future date, 89, 343 Property, plant, and equipment. A heading often seen on the balance sheet used to describe fixed, or plant, assets, 211 Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (PCAOB). A private sector, nonprofit corporation that oversees the auditors of publicly traded companies. The PCAOB reports to the US Securities and Exchange Commission, 305 Purchase discount. Discount received on purchases by paying early within a discount period, 197–198 Purchase order. A document showing details of merchandise being ordered from a supplier, 327 Purchase returns and allowances. A reduction in the amount owed for a purchase due to returning merchandise or accepting unsatisfactory goods, 196–197 Purchases

Post-closing trial balance. A list of the accounts and their balances at the end of the accounting period after closing entries have been journalized and posted, 154

cash, 196 credit, 196 discounts for, 197–198

Posting. Copying information from the general journal to accounts in the general ledger, 92

internal control over process for, 327–328

Posting reference. A notation in the journal and ledger that links these two accounting records together, 93

of inventory, 196–198

Preferred shareholders, 494

of treasury stock, 502, 554

Preferred stock. Stock that gives its owners certain advantages over common stockholders, such as the right to receive dividends before the common stockholders and the right to receive assets before the common stockholders if the corporation liquidates, 489, 492 Premium. Excess of a bond’s issue price over its maturity value, 448, 451–453 Prepaid expenses. Amounts that are assets of a business because they represent items that have been paid for but will be used later, 50, 140, 142–143, 204–207

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 752

returns and allowances for, 196–197 Purchasing agent. The individual in an organization responsible for placing orders to purchase goods for that organization, 327 Q Quick assets. Cash, short-term investments, and accounts receivable, 347 Quick ratio. (1) Ratio that reveals how well the entity can pay its current liabilities. (2) Quick assets (cash,

03/04/14 2:53 PM

Glindex

short-term investments, and net current receivables) divided by current liabilities. It measures a company’s ability to pay its current liabilities if they came due immediately, 346–347, 610

Revenue. The amount of money or money substitutes that a business receives from the sale of a product, 37, 48 accrued, 140–141, 345–346 closing entries for, 152–154 deferred, 139, 141–142

R

net sales, 208–209

Rate of return on stockholders’ equity. See Return on equity (ROE)

other, 209 sales, 199

Rate of return on total assets. See Return on assets (ROA) Rationalization. An element of the fraud triangle in which the employee justifies his or her actions and convinces himself or herself that fraud is not wrong, 301 Raw materials. Inventory items used in the production of goods, 243 Receipts for cash, 325–326 Receivable collection period. Average Net Accounts Receivable divided by daily credit sales. It measures how many days it takes to collect accounts receivable, 348 Receiving report. A document evidencing the receipt of goods purchased, 327 Reconciliation. See also Bank reconciliation Record. Entering a transaction in a journal, 92 Reliability principle. Information should be verifiable, confirmable by any independent observer, 44 Report form. A balance sheet format that reports assets at the top of the report, followed by liabilities, and ending with stockholders’ equity at the end of the report, 212

unearned, 139, 141–142 Revenue expenditure. Expenditure that is debited to an expense account, 401 Revenue recognition principle. Recording revenues when they are earned by providing goods or services to customers, 138 Risk. Risk is the uncertainty that could result in an outcome not desired, 38 Risk assessment. The process of identifying risks and taking steps to mitigate them, 296 Rounding, 606 S Salaries payable, 141 Sale. The exchange between a business and customer where the business provides a customer a product and the business receives money or money substitutes, 37 on accounts, 325

Research and development (R&D), 407

of assets, 549

Residual value. Expected cash value of an asset at the end of its useful life, 394

cash, 199, 323

Retail business. A business that sells products to the final consumer of the product, 41

with credit cards, 324–325

Retailers. Businesses that buy goods from manufacturers or wholesalers and resell them to the general public, 194–195

of fixed assets, 561

Retained earnings. The stockholders’ equity that is the result of the business having net income, or earnings, that have been retained in the business, 48

753

credit, 199–200 with debit cards, 324–325 of inventory, 198–202 net credit, 337 return on, 213, 613

Return on assets (ROA). (1) The ratio of net income divided by average total assets, which indicates the profit earned on each dollar invested in total assets. (2) Ratio of net income to average total assets. It ­measures a company’s effectiveness in using assets to generate earnings, 410, 616

Sales allowances, 201

Return on equity (ROE). (1) Net income divided by average stockholders’ equity. It is a measure of profitability. (2) Ratio of net income to average stockholders’ equity. It is a measure of profitability, 506, 618

Sales invoice. A bill that documents the sale of goods to a customer, 197

Return on sales. (1) A measure of profitability equal to net income divided by net sales revenue. (2) Net income divided by net sales, 213, 613

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 753

of treasury stock, 554 types of, 323–325 Sales discount. Discount granted on sales for the customer’s early payment within a discount period; a contraaccount to sales revenue, 202

Sales returns and allowances. A reduction in the amount of sales due to customers returning merchandise or accepting unsatisfactory goods; a contra-account to sales revenue, 200–201

03/04/14 2:53 PM

754

Glindex

Sales revenue. The amount that a business earns from selling its inventory, 199 Sales tax payable, 442 Salvage value. (1) The estimated value of a long-term asset at the end of its useful life. (2) Expected cash value of an asset at the end of its useful life, 145, 394 Sarbanes-Oxley Act (SOX). A law passed in 2002 by the US Congress requiring a business’s management to accept responsibility for providing the information needed by stakeholders outside the business, 305 S-corporation. A small corporation that has met the legal requirements to act as a corporation but elected to be taxed at individual rates, 42 Secured bonds. Bonds that give bondholders the right to take specified assets of the issuer if the issuer fails to pay principal or interest, 447 Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC). The government agency in the United States that is responsible for regulating U.S financial markets that sell stocks, 292 Selling costs, 207 Selling expenses. Expenses related to advertising and selling products including sales salaries, sales commissions, advertising, depreciation on items used in sales, and delivery expense, 207 Serial bonds. Bonds from the same bond issuance that mature at different times, 447 Service business. A business that sells a service to its customers, 41

Stated value. An arbitrary amount that is similar to par value but is assigned after a corporation is organized, 490 Statement of cash flows. (1) A financial statement that reports the sources and uses of cash for a given period of time. (2) A financial statement that shows all of the sources and all of the uses of cash for an accounting period, 56, 540–541 business, creation of, 542–545 for business transactions, reporting of, 56 defined, 541 direct method for preparing, 557–561 indirect method for preparing, 546–556 logic of preparing, 543 Statement of financial position. A financial statement that reports the assets, liabilities, and stockholders’ equity of a business at a specific point in time, 56 Statement of retained earnings. A financial statement that reports the amount of accumulated net profits that a business has retained and not paid in dividends since inception. The statement reports the beginning balance of retained earnings, plus net income or minus net loss in the given period, less the dividends during the given period, equaling ending retained earnings, 56, 211 Stock authorized, 487 capital, 487

Services. A service is an activity that exists but cannot be touched and felt. Services are intangible, 37

classes of, 489

Share. The basic unit of stock, 487

cumulative preferred, 495

Shareholders, 494

issuance of, 490–492, 553

Shipping company, payment directly to, 204

outstanding, 488

Single-step income statement. Income statement format that groups all revenues together and lists all expenses together, subtracting total expenses from total revenues and calculating net income or net loss without computing any subtotals, 208

preferred, 489, 492

Sole proprietorship. A business entity that has one owner, where, for legal and tax purposes, the business and the owner are considered the same, 41 Specific-identification. Inventory costing method in which a business uses the specific cost of each unit of inventory, 243–244, 247 Specific-unit-cost method. Inventory costing method in which a business uses the specific cost of each unit of inventory, 243–244, 247 Stakeholder. A stakeholder is a person or organization that is affected by a business, 38 Stated interest rate. Interest rate that determines the amount of cash interest the borrower pays and the investor receives each year, 448

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 754

common, 48, 489, 491–492

treasury, 501–504 Stock certificates. Certificates that provide evidence of stock ownership, 487 Stock dividend. A distribution by a corporation of its own stock to stockholders, 496–497 recording, 497–499 stock splits vs., 501 Stockholder. An owner of part of a corporation, 41 business, investment in, 505–506 rights of, 489 Stockholders’ equity. Money provided to the business by owners either through an initial investment or the retention of profits, 39, 48–53, 489–490 accounts for, 89–90 balance sheet, reporting of, 505 book value of, 306

03/04/14 2:53 PM

Glindex

fundamental accounting equation for recording, 48–53 market value of, 306

Transaction. An event that has a financial impact on a business entity, 92. See also Business transactions

no-par stock and, 490

fundamental accounting equation for, 48

par value of, 490

general journal/ledger for keeping track of, 94–101

stated value of, 490 stock for, 489 stockholder’s rights and, 489 Stock split. An increase in the number of authorized, issued, and outstanding shares of stock coupled with a proportionate reduction in the par value per share of the stock, 499–501 Straight-line (SL) depreciation method. (1) A method of estimating depreciation (Cost of the Asset - Salvage Value)/ Useful Life of the Asset. (2) Depreciation method in which an equal amount of depreciation expense is assigned to each year of asset use, 145, 394–395 Streamlined payment procedures, 327–328 Subsidiary ledger. An accounting record that contains details, such as a list of customers and the accounts receivable due from each or a list of suppliers and the accounts payable due to each, 196

755

Treasurer. The individual in an organization responsible for the custody of assets, such as cash, 327 Treasury stock. A corporation’s own stock that it has issued and later reacquired, 501–504 basics of, 501 purchase of, 502, 554 sale of, 502–504, 554 Trend percentages. A form of horizontal analysis in which percentages are computed by selecting a base year and then expressing amounts for following years as a percentage of the base year amount, 609 Trial balance. A list of all the accounts of a business and their balances; its purpose is to verify that total debits equal total credits, 103–106 adjusted, 147–151 correcting errors in, 104 financial statements and, 105–106

Suppliers, payments to, 559–560

post-closing, 154

Supplies, 144–145

unadjusted, 140

T

U

T-account. An informal account form used to summarize transactions, where the top of the T holds the account title and the base divides the debit and credit sides of the account, 90, 101–103

Unadjusted trial balance. A trial balance that is prepared at the end of the accounting period prior to the adjusting entries being made, 140

Tangible assets. Assets that are physical in form. They can be seen, touched, or held, 388 Temporary accounts. The revenue, expense, and dividend accounts; these accounts are closed at the end of the accounting period, 151–152 Term bonds. Bonds that all mature at the same time, 447 Times interest earned ratio. See Interest coverage ratio Time value of money. The concept that states that a dollar today is worth more than a dollar received in the future, 723 Title. Legally recognized rights to the possession and ownership of property, 203 Total asset turnover. A measure of how a business utilizes its total assets to generate sales. Total asset turnover is computed as sales divided by average total assets, 616 Trademarks. Rights to use distinctive identifications of a product or service, 406

Uncollectible account. An account receivable that is unable to be collected., 325, 335–342 allowance method for, 337 direct write-off method for, 335–336 estimating amount of, 337–340 Uncollectible accounts expense. Selling expense caused by uncollectible accounts, 335 Underwriter. A firm, such as Morgan Stanley Smith Barney, that usually agrees to buy all the stock a company wants to issue if the firm cannot sell the stock to its clients, 490 Unearned revenue. A liability created when a business collects cash from customers in advance of providing goods or services, 139, 141–142, 442 United States, Generally Accepted Accounting Principles in, 292–293

Trade names. Rights to use distinctive identifications of a product or service, 406

Units-of-production (UOP) depreciation method. Depreciation method by which a fixed amount of depreciation is assigned to each unit of output produced by an asset, 395–396

Trading securities. Equity or debt securities that are actively managed in order to maximize profit, 408

Unsecured bonds. Bonds that are backed only by the general credit of the company issuing the bond, 448

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 755

03/04/14 2:53 PM

756

Glindex

Useful life. The expected life of an asset during which it is anticipated to generate revenues. May be expressed in years or units of output, 393–394, 399–400 V

salvage, 145, 394 stated, 490 Vertical analysis. Analysis of a financial statement that reveals the relationship of each statement item to a specified base amount, which is the 100% figure, 606

Value. The price someone is willing to pay for an item, 37 book, 146, 306

W

of business, 37–38, 306, 623

Warranty. A guarantee that a product or service is free from defect, 443–444

carrying, 146 future, 723–725 of inventory, 254–256, 258–260 market, 306 maturity, 343, 448 net, 146 net realizable, 337 no-par stock with stated, 492 par, 448, 490 present, 726–728 residual, 394

Z04_KEMP9543_03_GE_GIDX.indd 756

Whistleblower. A person who reports illegal or unethical behavior, 304 Wholesale business. A business that sells products to other businesses for resale, 41 Wholesalers. Businesses that buy goods from manufacturers and resell them to retailers, 194–195 Work in process. Inventory of partially completed goods, 243 Write off. Removing a customer’s receivable from the accounting records because it is considered ­uncollectible, 335

03/04/14 2:53 PM

Photo Credits

Frontmatter: Page 7, top: Courtesy of Robert Kemp; ­bottom: Courtesy of Jeffrey Waybright

Chapter 7: Page 322: © Andrew Clark/Alamy; Page 330: © FreezeFrameStudio/iStockphoto

Chapter 1: Page 35: © Rick Wilking/Reuters/Corbis; Page 45: © Sergey Turanov/iStockphoto

Chapter 8: Page 387: © World Photo Collection/Alamy; Page 388 left: © Comstock/JupiterImages; center: © DPA Picture Alliance/Alamy; right: © ImagineGolf/­ iStockphoto; Page 391: left: © Haoliang/Shutterstock; center: © Photos.com/Jupiter Images; right: © Lcholakov/ Dreamstime; Page 393: Thinkstock/Jupiter Unlimited

Chapter 2: Page 87: © Philip Scalia/Alamy; Page 91 top: © Diego_cervo/iStockphoto; bottom left: © BananaStock/ JupiterImages; bottom center: © Steve Collender/­ Shutterstock; bottom right: © Comstock/JupiterImages Chapter 3: Page 136: © Katja Kreder/Imagebroker/Alamy; Page 143: © Godfried Edelman/iStockphoto Chapter 4: Page 193: © Patti McConville/Alamy; Page 204: © Photos.com/Jupiter Images Chapter 5: Page 242: © Jeff Greenberg/Alamy; Page 244: © Photos.com/Jupiter Images Chapter 6: Page 290: © Bikeriderlondon/Shutterstock; Page 297: © Photos.com/Jupiter Images

Chapter 9: Page 438: © B. Christopher/Alamy; Page 446: © Scott Rothstein/Shutterstock Chapter 10: Page 486: © Sergey Nivens/Fotolia; Page 500: © ITStock Free/JupiterImages Chapter 11: Page 539: © Gunnar Kullenberg/Purestock/ Alamy; Page 541: © Razvan/iStockphoto Chapter 12: Page 599: Newphotoservice/Shutterstock; Page 602: Maxkateusa/Dreamstime

757

Z05_KEMP9543_03_GE_CRED.indd 757

03/04/14 2:54 PM

MyAccountingLab

®

For Instructors EASE OF USE AND FLEXIBLE CONTENT DELIVERY Homework assignments, quizzes, and tests directly correlate to the textbook.



Learning aids are available on demand to help students ­understand key concepts.



Assess your students your way with multiple assignment options and maximum flexibility with a wide range of questions tied to end-of-chapter content including:



Choose between book/static and algorithmic versions.



Open response questions are available for journal entry and financial statement problems to better prepare students for the paper exam by requiring that students type account names rather than select from a drop-down menu or use type ahead.



NEW! Excel—Select end-of-chapter automatically graded ­algorithmic questions in a simulated Excel environment provide students with practice opportunities on a tool they’ll use in the real world. Remediation and learning aids will be available within each question to help guide students through both Accounting and Excel concepts.



NEW! General Ledger—Students can launch General Ledger software in MyAccountingLab, where they will be able to record transactions and adjust entries, post to the ledger, close periods, and see the effects in the ledger ­accounts. Their work will be auto-graded, and grades will then ­automatically flow to the MyAccountingLab Gradebook.

NEW! Real World Accounting Video Series—features real, emerging companies that demonstrate financial and managerial accounting concepts. Students can see how the course topics are applied in recent start-ups or companies that started small and are now a success. These engaging videos, tied to in-text examples presented at the start of each chapter, help students further understand the course material and also demonstrate how Accounting will apply to their future careers regardless of their major.





NEW! Worked Out Solutions—provide step-by-step explanations on how to solve select problems using the exact numbers and data that were presented in the problem. Instructors will have access to the Worked Out Solutions in preview and review mode.

when calculating scores, and the ability to omit results of individual assignments. AACSB and Student Learning Outcomes mapping allow instructors to track accreditation information and print reports on assessment in a few clicks.





NEW! Algorithmic Test Bank—New to this edition, ­instructors have the ability to create multiple versions of a test for extra practice for students.

DEPARTMENT-WIDE SOLUTIONS Coordinator Courses allow one point of control for multiple sections, simplifying departmental implementation.





Instructor and student single sign on are available through NEW Blackboard integration.



COURSE MANAGEMENT TOOLS AND GRADEBOOK Automatic grading tracks students’ results on tests, homework, and tutorials.



Flexible Gradebook features numerous student data views, weighted assignments, choice on which attempts to include



Z06_KEMP9543_03_GE_END.indd 758

03/04/14 6:54 PM

For Students MEANINGFUL HELP and FEEDBACK Personalized interactive learning aids are available for point-of-use help and immediate feedback. These learning aids include:



Help Me Solve This walks students through solving an algorithmic version of the questions they are working, with additional detailed tutorial reminders. These informational cues assist the students and help them understand concepts and mechanics.



Demo Docs are entire problems worked through step by step from start to finish, replicating the in-class experience for students anytime, anywhere.



Accounting Simplified videos give students a 3- to 5-minute lesson on concepts. Our new videos are engaging whiteboard animations that help illustrate concepts for students.



NEW! Accounting Cycle Tutorial provides students with an interactive and simulated exercise to reinforce the concepts critical to success in Accounting.



eText links students directly to the concept covered in the problem they are completing.



Homework and practice exercises with additional algorithmically generated problems are available for further practice and mastery.



NEW! Worked Out Solutions—now available to students when they are reviewing their submitted and graded homework. The Worked Out Solutions provide step-by-step explanations on how to solve select problems using the exact numbers and data that were presented to the student in the problem.



NEW! Dynamic Study Modules—Using a highly personalized, algorithmically driven process, Dynamic Study Modules continuously assess students’ performance and provide additional practice in the areas where they struggle the most.



PERSONALIZED AND ADAPTIVE STUDY PATH Assist students in monitoring their own progress by offering them a customized study plan powered by Knewton, based on Homework, Quiz, and Test results.



Regenerated exercises offer unlimited practice and the opportunity to prove mastery through Quizzes on recommended learning objectives.



Z06_KEMP9543_03_GE_END.indd 759

03/04/14 6:54 PM

Z06_KEMP9543_03_GE_END.indd 760

03/04/14 6:54 PM

Z06_KEMP9543_03_GE_END.indd 761

03/04/14 6:54 PM

Z06_KEMP9543_03_GE_END.indd 762

03/04/14 6:54 PM

Z06_KEMP9543_03_GE_END.indd 763

03/04/14 6:54 PM

Z06_KEMP9543_03_GE_END.indd 764

03/04/14 6:54 PM

Z06_KEMP9543_03_GE_END.indd 765

03/04/14 6:54 PM

Z06_KEMP9543_03_GE_END.indd 766

03/04/14 6:54 PM

Z06_KEMP9543_03_GE_END.indd 767

03/04/14 6:54 PM

Z06_KEMP9543_03_GE_END.indd 768

03/04/14 6:54 PM